REJ09B0259-0700 The revision list can be viewed directly by clicking the title page. The revision list summarizes the locations of revisions and additions. Details should always be checked by referring to the relevant text. 16 H8/3048 Group, H8/3048 F-ZTAT Hardware Manual Renesas 16-Bit Single-Chip Microcomputer H8 Family/H8/300H Series H8/3048 H8/3047 H8/3045 H8/3044 H8/3048F Rev. 7.00 Revision Date: Sep 21, 2005 HD6473048, HD6433048 HD6433047 HD6433045 HD6433044 HD64F3048 Keep safety first in your circuit designs! 1. Renesas Technology Corp. puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor products better and more reliable, but there is always the possibility that trouble may occur with them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire or property damage. Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i) placement of substitutive, auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of nonflammable material or (iii) prevention against any malfunction or mishap. Notes regarding these materials 1. These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection of the Renesas Technology Corp. product best suited to the customer's application; they do not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any other rights, belonging to Renesas Technology Corp. or a third party. 2. Renesas Technology Corp. assumes no responsibility for any damage, or infringement of any thirdparty's rights, originating in the use of any product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in these materials. 3. All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs and algorithms represents information on products at the time of publication of these materials, and are subject to change by Renesas Technology Corp. without notice due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore recommended that customers contact Renesas Technology Corp. or an authorized Renesas Technology Corp. product distributor for the latest product information before purchasing a product listed herein. The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Renesas Technology Corp. assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability, or other loss rising from these inaccuracies or errors. Please also pay attention to information published by Renesas Technology Corp. by various means, including the Renesas Technology Corp. Semiconductor home page (http://www.renesas.com). 4. When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs, and algorithms, please be sure to evaluate all information as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of the information and products. Renesas Technology Corp. assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability or other loss resulting from the information contained herein. 5. Renesas Technology Corp. semiconductors are not designed or manufactured for use in a device or system that is used under circumstances in which human life is potentially at stake. Please contact Renesas Technology Corp. or an authorized Renesas Technology Corp. product distributor when considering the use of a product contained herein for any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for transportation, vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea repeater use. 6. The prior written approval of Renesas Technology Corp. is necessary to reprint or reproduce in whole or in part these materials. 7. If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control restrictions, they must be exported under a license from the Japanese government and cannot be imported into a country other than the approved destination. Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan and/or the country of destination is prohibited. 8. Please contact Renesas Technology Corp. for further details on these materials or the products contained therein. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page ii of xxiv Preface The H8/3048 Group is a series of high-performance microcontrollers that integrate system supporting functions together with an H8/300H CPU core. The H8/300H CPU has a 32-bit internal architecture with sixteen 16-bit general registers, and a concise, optimized instruction set designed for speed. It can address a 16-Mbyte linear address space. The on-chip supporting functions include ROM, RAM, a 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), a programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), a watchdog timer (WDT), a serial communication interface (SCI), an A/D converter, a D/A converter, I/O ports, a direct memory access controller (DMAC), a refresh controller, and other facilities. Of the two SCI channels, one has been expanded to support the ISO/IEC7816-3 smart card interface. Functions have also been added to reduce power consumption in battery-powered applications: individual modules can be placed in standby, and the frequency of the system clock supplied to the chip can be divided down under software control. The address space is divided into eight areas. The data bus width and access cycle length can be selected independently in each area, simplifying the connection of different types of memory. Seven operating modes (modes 1 to 7) are provided, offering a choice of data bus width and address space size. With these features, the H8/3048 Group can be used to implement compact, high-performance systems easily. In addition to its mask ROM versions, the H8/3048 Group has a ZTAT™*1 version with userprogrammable on-chip PROM and an F-ZTAT™*2 version with on-chip flash memory that can be programmed on-board. These versions enable users to respond quickly and flexibly to changing application specifications. The on-chip emulator (E10T) is installed on the H8/3048F-ONE in the H8/3048 Group microcomputer. Refer to the H8/3048F-ONE Hardware Manual for details. This manual describes the H8/3048 Group hardware. For details of the instruction set, refer to the H8/300H Series Programming Manual. Notes: 1. ZTAT™ (Zero Turn-Around-Time) is a trademark of Renesas Technology, Corp. 2. F-ZTAT™ (Flexible ZTAT) is a trademark of Renesas Technology, Corp. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page iii of xxiv Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page iv of xxiv Comparison of H8/3048 Group Product Specifications 1 There are seven members of the H8/3048 Group; the H8/3048F-ZTAT (H8/3048F* , H8/3048FONE*2), H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 mask ROM version, H8/3047 mask ROM version, H8/3045 mask ROM version, and H8/3044 mask ROM version. The specifications of each model is compared below. Notes: 1. H8/3048F has dual power supply with flash memory installed. 2. H8/3048F-ONE has single power supply with flash memory and E10T installed. Refer to the H8/3048F-ONE Hardware Manual (revision 1) for details. Hardware Manual ROM Type H8/3048 Group ZTAT H8/3048F-ONE Mask ROM F-ZTAT Model Type H8/3048 H8/3048 mask ROM version H8/3048F H8/3047 mask ROM version H8/3045 mask ROM version H8/3044 mask ROM version H8/3048F-ONE Model Spec PROM model Mask ROM model Dual power supply, flash memory is installed Single power supply, flash memory installed, internal step-down, high-speed operation model Refer to 1.4, Differences between H8/3048F and H8/3048F-ONE. Refer to 1.4.3, Differences between H8/3048F and H8/3048F-ONE. HD64F3048 HD64F3048B Model Type No. HD6473048 HD6433048 HD6433047 HD6433045 HD6433044 Pin Assignment Refer to figure 1.2, Pin Arrangement of H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 Mask ROM Version, H8/3047 Mask ROM Version, H8/3045 Mask ROM Version, H8/3044 Mask ROM Version, and H8/3048F (FP-100B or TFP-100B, Top View), in section 1. 5-V operation models have a VCL pin and an external capacitor must be connected. Refer to figure 1.3, H8/3048F-ONE Pin Arrangement (FP-100B or TFP-100B, Top View), in section 1. RAM Capacity 4 kbytes H8/3048: 4 kbytes H8/3047: 4 kbytes H8/3045: 2 kbytes H8/3044: 2 kbytes 4 kbytes 4 kbytes Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page v of xxiv Hardware Manual ROM Type ROM Capacity Flash Memory H8/3048 Group ZTAT Mask ROM 128 kbytes H8/3048: 128 kbytes H8/3047: 96 kbytes H8/3045: 64 kbytes H8/3044: 32 kbytes — — H8/3048F-ONE F-ZTAT 128 kbytes 128 kbytes Refer to section 19, ROM (H8/3048F). Refer to section 18, Flash Memory (H8/3048F-ONE Single Power Supply). Clock Pulse Generator Refer to section 20, Clock Pulse Generator. Refer to section 19, Clock Pulse Generator. Power-Down State Refer to section 21, Power-Down State. Refer to section 20, Power-Down State. Clock oscillator settling time: Waiting time of up to 131072 states Clock oscillator settling time: Waiting time of up to 262144 states Refer to table 22.1, Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048 Group Products, in section 22. Refer to table 21.1, Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048 Group Products, in section 21. 1 to 18 MHz 5 V operation models: 2 to 25 MHz, 3 V operation models: 2 to 25 MHz. Electrical Characteristics (Clock Rate) 1 to 16 MHz List of Registers Refer to table B.1, Comparison of H8/3048 Group Internal I/O Register Specifications, in appendix B. Refer to appendix B.1, Addresses. Notes on Usage — — — Refer to section 1.4, Notes on H8/3048FONE (Single Power Supply). On-chip Emulator (E10T) — — — On-chip emulator (E10T) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page vi of xxiv Main Revisions for this Edition Item Page Revision (See Manual for Details) All All references to Hitachi, Hitachi, Ltd., Hitachi Semiconductors, and other Hitachi brand names changed to Renesas Technology Corp. Designation for categories changed from “series” to “group” 13.2.6 Serial Control 461 Register (SCR) Table amended Bit 6-Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE) Bit 6: RIE Description 0 Receive-data-full (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are disabled* (Initial value) 1 Receive-data-full (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are enabled 19.5.3 Programming 606 Flowchart and Sample Program Flowchart for Programming One Byte Figure 19.9 Programming Flowchart Figure amended Enable watchdog timer*2 Select program mode (P bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) µs Clear P bit Disable watchdog timer Select program-verify mode (PV bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (tVS1) µs *4 Verify (read memory)*3 OK Notes: 1. Write the data to be programmed using a byte transfer instruction. 2. Set the watchdog timer overflow interval by setting CKS2 and CKS1 to 0 and CKS0 to 1. 3. Read to verify data from the memory using a byte transfer instruction. Programming ends 4. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs N: 6 (set N so that total programming time does not exceed 1 ms) 5. Programming time x, which is determined by the initial time × 2n–1 (n = 1 to 6), increases in proportion to n. Thus, set the initial time to 15.8 µs or less to make total programming time 1 ms or less. No good Clear PV bit Clear PV bit n ≥ N? Clear erase block register (clear bit of programmed block to 0) Clear VPP E bit Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be programmed to 0) Verify ends No n+1→n Double the programming time (x × 2 → x)*5 End (1-byte data programmed) Clear VPP E bit Programming error Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page vii of xxiv Item Page Revision (See Manual for Details) 19.5.6 Erasing Flowchart and Sample Program 610 Figure amended 5. tVS1: z: tVS2: N: Set top address in block as verify address Flowchart for Erasing One Block Wait initial value setting x = 6.25 ms 6. The erase time x is successively incremented by the initial set value × 2n–1 (n = 1, 2, 3, 4). An initial value of 6.25 ms or less should be set, and the time for one erasure should be 50 ms or less. Enable watchdog timer*2 Figure 19.10 Erasing Flowchart Select erase mode (E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) ms Clear E bit 4 µs 5 to 10 µs 2 µs 602 Erasing ends Disable watchdog timer Select erase-verify mode (EV bit = 1) Wait (tVS1) µs*5 Dummy write to verify address*3 (flash memory latches address) Wait (tVS2) µs*5 Verify (read memory)*4 No Address + 1 → address No good Clear EV bit OK Last address? n ≥ N? Yes Clear EV bit Clear erase block register (clear bit of erased block to 0) Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be erased to 0) Erase-verify ends No n+1→n n ≥ 5? No Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page viii of xxiv Clear VPP E bit Clear VPP E bit End of block erase Erase error Double the erase time*6 (x × 2 → x) Yes Item Page Revision (See Manual for Details) 19.5.6 Erasing Flowchart and Sample Program 611 Figure amended Prewrite Flowchart Figure 19.11 Prewrite Flowchart Notes: 1. Use a byte transfer instruction. 2. Set the watchdog timer overflow interval by setting CKS2 = 0, CKS1 = 0 and CKS0 = 1. 3. In prewrite-verify mode P, E, PV, and EV are all cleared to 0 and 12 V is applied to VPP. Use a byte transfer instruction. 4. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs N: 6 (set N so that total Programming ends programming time does not exceed 1 ms) Write H'00 to flash memory (flash memory latches write address and write data)*1 Enable watchdog timer*2 Select program mode (set P bit to 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) µs Clear P bit Disable watchdog timer Wait (tVS1) µs*4 Prewrite verify*3 (read data = H'00?) No good n ≥ N? No OK Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be erased to 0) n+1→n Double the programming time (x × 2 → x) Clear VPPE bit Programming error Last address? No Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be erased to 0) Clear VPP E bit End of prewrite Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page ix of xxiv Item Page Revision (See Manual for Details) 19.5.6 Erasing Flowchart and Sample Program 616 Figure amended 5. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs Wait initial value setting x = 6.25 ms Flowchart for Erasing Multiple Blocks Enable watchdog timer*2 Select erase mode (E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) ms Erasing ends Clear E bit Figure 19.12 Multiple-Block Erase Flowchart Disable watchdog timer tVS2: 2 µs N: 602 6. The erase time x is successively incremented by the initial set value × 2n–1 (n = 1, 2, 3, 4). An initial value of 10 ms or less should be set, and the time for one erasure should be 50 ms or less. Select erase-verify mode (EV bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (tVS1) µs *5 Set top address of block as verify address Erase-verify next block Dummy write to verify address*3 (flash memory latches address) Wait (tVS2) µs *5 Verify (read memory) Erase-verify next block No good OK Address + 1 → address No Last address in block? All erased blocks verified? Yes No Yes Clear EBR bit of erase-verified block *4 No All erased blocks verified? Yes Clear EV bit All blocks erased? (EBR1 = EBR2 = 0?) Yes Clear VPP E bit End of erase No n ≥ 4? Yes No Double the erase time (x × 2 → x)*6 n ≥ N? No Yes Clear erase block registers (clear bits of blocks to be erased to 0) Clear VPP E bit Erase error Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page x of xxiv n+1→n Contents Section 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 Overview........................................................................................................... 1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 1 Block Diagram .................................................................................................................. 7 Pin Description.................................................................................................................. 8 1.3.1 Pin Arrangement .................................................................................................. 8 1.3.2 Pin Assignments in Each Mode ........................................................................... 10 1.3.3 Pin Functions ....................................................................................................... 15 Differences between H8/3048F and H8/3048F-ONE ....................................................... 20 Section 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 CPU .................................................................................................................... Overview........................................................................................................................... 2.1.1 Features ................................................................................................................ 2.1.2 Differences from H8/300 CPU ............................................................................ CPU Operating Modes ...................................................................................................... Address Space ................................................................................................................... Register Configuration ...................................................................................................... 2.4.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 2.4.2 General Registers ................................................................................................. 2.4.3 Control Registers ................................................................................................. 2.4.4 Initial CPU Register Values ................................................................................. Data Formats ..................................................................................................................... 2.5.1 General Register Data Formats ............................................................................ 2.5.2 Memory Data Formats ......................................................................................... Instruction Set ................................................................................................................... 2.6.1 Instruction Set Overview...................................................................................... 2.6.2 Instructions and Addressing Modes ..................................................................... 2.6.3 Tables of Instructions Classified by Function...................................................... 2.6.4 Basic Instruction Formats .................................................................................... 2.6.5 Notes on Use of Bit Manipulation Instructions.................................................... Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation ..................................................... 2.7.1 Addressing Modes ............................................................................................... 2.7.2 Effective Address Calculation.............................................................................. Processing States............................................................................................................... 2.8.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 2.8.2 Program Execution State...................................................................................... 2.8.3 Exception-Handling State .................................................................................... 2.8.4 Exception-Handling Sequences ........................................................................... 25 25 25 26 27 28 29 29 30 31 32 33 33 35 36 36 37 38 47 48 50 50 52 56 56 57 57 59 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xi of xxiv 2.9 2.8.5 Bus-Released State............................................................................................... 2.8.6 Reset State............................................................................................................ 2.8.7 Power-Down State ............................................................................................... Basic Operational Timing ................................................................................................. 2.9.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 2.9.2 On-Chip Memory Access Timing........................................................................ 2.9.3 On-Chip Supporting Module Access Timing....................................................... 2.9.4 Access to External Address Space ....................................................................... Section 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 MCU Operating Modes ................................................................................ 65 Overview........................................................................................................................... 3.1.1 Operating Mode Selection ................................................................................... 3.1.2 Register Configuration......................................................................................... Mode Control Register (MDCR) ...................................................................................... System Control Register (SYSCR) ................................................................................... Operating Mode Descriptions ........................................................................................... 3.4.1 Mode 1 ................................................................................................................. 3.4.2 Mode 2 ................................................................................................................. 3.4.3 Mode 3 ................................................................................................................. 3.4.4 Mode 4 ................................................................................................................. 3.4.5 Mode 5 ................................................................................................................. 3.4.6 Mode 6 ................................................................................................................. 3.4.7 Mode 7 ................................................................................................................. Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode ............................................................................ Memory Map in Each Operating Mode ............................................................................ Section 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 60 60 60 61 61 61 62 63 Exception Handling ....................................................................................... Overview........................................................................................................................... 4.1.1 Exception Handling Types and Priority............................................................... 4.1.2 Exception Handling Operation............................................................................. 4.1.3 Exception Vector Table ....................................................................................... Reset ................................................................................................................................. 4.2.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 4.2.2 Reset Sequence .................................................................................................... 4.2.3 Interrupts after Reset............................................................................................ Interrupts ........................................................................................................................... Trap Instruction................................................................................................................. Stack Status after Exception Handling.............................................................................. Notes on Stack Usage ....................................................................................................... Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xii of xxiv 65 65 66 66 67 69 69 69 69 69 69 70 70 70 71 81 81 81 81 82 84 84 84 87 88 89 89 90 Section 5 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 Interrupt Controller ........................................................................................ Overview........................................................................................................................... 5.1.1 Features ................................................................................................................ 5.1.2 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 5.1.3 Pin Configuration................................................................................................. 5.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 5.2.1 System Control Register (SYSCR) ...................................................................... 5.2.2 Interrupt Priority Registers A and B (IPRA, IPRB)............................................. 5.2.3 IRQ Status Register (ISR).................................................................................... 5.2.4 IRQ Enable Register (IER) .................................................................................. 5.2.5 IRQ Sense Control Register (ISCR) .................................................................... Interrupt Sources ............................................................................................................... 5.3.1 External Interrupts................................................................................................ 5.3.2 Internal Interrupts................................................................................................. 5.3.3 Interrupt Vector Table.......................................................................................... Interrupt Operation............................................................................................................ 5.4.1 Interrupt Handling Process................................................................................... 5.4.2 Interrupt Sequence ............................................................................................... 5.4.3 Interrupt Response Time...................................................................................... Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 5.5.1 Contention between Interrupt and Interrupt-Disabling Instruction ...................... 5.5.2 Instructions that Inhibit Interrupts........................................................................ 5.5.3 Interrupts during EEPMOV Instruction Execution .............................................. 5.5.4 Usage Notes on External Interrupts ..................................................................... 5.5.5 Notes on Non-Maskable Interrupts (NMI)........................................................... Section 6 6.1 6.2 Bus Controller ................................................................................................. Overview........................................................................................................................... 6.1.1 Features ................................................................................................................ 6.1.2 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 6.1.3 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 6.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 6.2.1 Bus Width Control Register (ABWCR)............................................................... 6.2.2 Access State Control Register (ASTCR) ............................................................. 6.2.3 Wait Control Register (WCR).............................................................................. 6.2.4 Wait State Controller Enable Register (WCER) .................................................. 6.2.5 Bus Release Control Register (BRCR) ................................................................ 6.2.6 Chip Select Control Register (CSCR).................................................................. 91 91 91 92 93 93 94 94 95 102 103 104 105 105 106 106 110 110 115 116 117 117 118 118 118 120 123 123 123 124 125 126 126 126 127 128 129 130 131 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xiii of xxiv 6.3 6.4 Operation .......................................................................................................................... 6.3.1 Area Division....................................................................................................... 6.3.2 Chip Select Signals .............................................................................................. 6.3.3 Data Bus............................................................................................................... 6.3.4 Bus Control Signal Timing .................................................................................. 6.3.5 Wait Modes.......................................................................................................... 6.3.6 Interconnections with Memory (Example) .......................................................... 6.3.7 Bus Arbiter Operation.......................................................................................... Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 6.4.1 Connection to Dynamic RAM and Pseudo-Static RAM...................................... 6.4.2 Register Write Timing ......................................................................................... 6.4.3 BREQ Input Timing............................................................................................. 6.4.4 Transition To Software Standby Mode ................................................................ Section 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 Refresh Controller .......................................................................................... Overview........................................................................................................................... 7.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 7.1.2 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 7.1.3 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 7.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 7.2.1 Refresh Control Register (RFSHCR)................................................................... 7.2.2 Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTMCSR) ............................................ 7.2.3 Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT)........................................................................ 7.2.4 Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR) ......................................................... Operation .......................................................................................................................... 7.3.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 7.3.2 DRAM Refresh Control....................................................................................... 7.3.3 Pseudo-Static RAM Refresh Control ................................................................... 7.3.4 Interval Timer ...................................................................................................... Interrupt Source ................................................................................................................ Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... Section 8 8.1 133 133 134 136 137 145 151 153 156 156 156 158 158 159 159 159 160 161 161 162 162 165 166 167 168 168 170 185 189 195 195 DMA Controller ............................................................................................. 197 Overview........................................................................................................................... 8.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 8.1.2 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 8.1.3 Functional Overview............................................................................................ 8.1.4 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 8.1.5 Register Configuration......................................................................................... Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xiv of xxiv 197 197 198 199 201 201 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 Register Descriptions (Short Address Mode).................................................................... 8.2.1 Memory Address Registers (MAR) ..................................................................... 8.2.2 I/O Address Registers (IOAR) ............................................................................. 8.2.3 Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR) .......................................................... 8.2.4 Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR) ............................................................ Register Descriptions (Full Address Mode)...................................................................... 8.3.1 Memory Address Registers (MAR) ..................................................................... 8.3.2 I/O Address Registers (IOAR) ............................................................................. 8.3.3 Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR) .......................................................... 8.3.4 Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR) ............................................................ Operation........................................................................................................................... 8.4.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 8.4.2 I/O Mode.............................................................................................................. 8.4.3 Idle Mode............................................................................................................. 8.4.4 Repeat Mode ........................................................................................................ 8.4.5 Normal Mode ....................................................................................................... 8.4.6 Block Transfer Mode ........................................................................................... 8.4.7 DMAC Activation................................................................................................ 8.4.8 DMAC Bus Cycle ................................................................................................ 8.4.9 DMAC Multiple-Channel Operation ................................................................... 8.4.10 External Bus Requests, Refresh Controller, and DMAC ..................................... 8.4.11 NMI Interrupts and DMAC.................................................................................. 8.4.12 Aborting a DMA Transfer.................................................................................... 8.4.13 Exiting Full Address Mode .................................................................................. 8.4.14 DMAC States in Reset State, Standby Modes, and Sleep Mode.......................... Interrupts ........................................................................................................................... Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 8.6.1 Note on Word Data Transfer................................................................................ 8.6.2 DMAC Self-Access.............................................................................................. 8.6.3 Longword Access to Memory Address Registers ................................................ 8.6.4 Note on Full Address Mode Setup ....................................................................... 8.6.5 Note on Activating DMAC by Internal Interrupts ............................................... 8.6.6 NMI Interrupts and Block Transfer Mode ........................................................... 8.6.7 Memory and I/O Address Register Values .......................................................... 8.6.8 Bus Cycle when Transfer is Aborted ................................................................... Section 9 9.1 9.2 I/O Ports ............................................................................................................ Overview........................................................................................................................... Port 1................................................................................................................................. 9.2.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 203 203 204 205 206 209 209 209 210 212 218 218 220 222 225 229 232 237 239 245 246 247 248 249 250 251 252 252 252 252 252 252 254 254 255 257 257 261 261 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xv of xxiv 9.2.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... Port 2................................................................................................................................. 9.3.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.3.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.4 Port 3................................................................................................................................. 9.4.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.4.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.5 Port 4................................................................................................................................. 9.5.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.5.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.6 Port 5................................................................................................................................. 9.6.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.6.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.7 Port 6................................................................................................................................. 9.7.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.7.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.8 Port 7................................................................................................................................. 9.8.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.8.2 Register Description............................................................................................. 9.9 Port 8................................................................................................................................. 9.9.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.9.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.10 Port 9................................................................................................................................. 9.10.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.10.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.11 Port A................................................................................................................................ 9.11.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.11.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.11.3 Pin Functions ....................................................................................................... 9.12 Port B ................................................................................................................................ 9.12.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 9.12.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................... 9.12.3 Pin Functions ....................................................................................................... 9.3 262 264 264 265 268 268 268 270 270 271 274 274 275 278 278 279 282 282 283 284 284 285 289 289 290 294 294 296 298 306 306 308 310 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) .......................................................... 315 10.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 10.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 10.1.2 Block Diagrams ................................................................................................... 10.1.3 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 10.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xvi of xxiv 315 315 318 323 324 10.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 10.2.1 Timer Start Register (TSTR)................................................................................ 10.2.2 Timer Synchro Register (TSNC) ......................................................................... 10.2.3 Timer Mode Register (TMDR) ............................................................................ 10.2.4 Timer Function Control Register (TFCR)............................................................ 10.2.5 Timer Output Master Enable Register (TOER) ................................................... 10.2.6 Timer Output Control Register (TOCR) .............................................................. 10.2.7 Timer Counters (TCNT) ...................................................................................... 10.2.8 General Registers (GRA, GRB)........................................................................... 10.2.9 Buffer Registers (BRA, BRB).............................................................................. 10.2.10 Timer Control Registers (TCR) ........................................................................... 10.2.11 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR) ..................................................................... 10.2.12 Timer Status Register (TSR)................................................................................ 10.2.13 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER) .............................................................. 10.3 CPU Interface.................................................................................................................... 10.3.1 16-Bit Accessible Registers ................................................................................. 10.3.2 8-Bit Accessible Registers ................................................................................... 10.4 Operation........................................................................................................................... 10.4.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 10.4.2 Basic Functions.................................................................................................... 10.4.3 Synchronization ................................................................................................... 10.4.4 PWM Mode.......................................................................................................... 10.4.5 Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode......................................................................... 10.4.6 Complementary PWM Mode ............................................................................... 10.4.7 Phase Counting Mode .......................................................................................... 10.4.8 Buffering .............................................................................................................. 10.4.9 ITU Output Timing .............................................................................................. 10.5 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................... 10.5.1 Setting of Status Flags.......................................................................................... 10.5.2 Clearing of Status Flags ....................................................................................... 10.5.3 Interrupt Sources and DMA Controller Activation.............................................. 10.6 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 327 327 328 330 333 335 337 338 339 340 341 343 345 347 349 349 351 352 352 353 362 364 368 371 380 382 389 391 391 393 394 395 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller............................................... 411 11.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 11.1.1 Features ................................................................................................................ 11.1.2 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 11.1.3 TPC Pins .............................................................................................................. 11.1.4 Registers............................................................................................................... 11.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 411 411 412 413 414 415 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xvii of xxiv 11.2.1 Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) ........................................................... 11.2.2 Port A Data Register (PADR).............................................................................. 11.2.3 Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) ........................................................... 11.2.4 Port B Data Register (PBDR) .............................................................................. 11.2.5 Next Data Register A (NDRA) ............................................................................ 11.2.6 Next Data Register B (NDRB)............................................................................. 11.2.7 Next Data Enable Register A (NDERA).............................................................. 11.2.8 Next Data Enable Register B (NDERB) .............................................................. 11.2.9 TPC Output Control Register (TPCR) ................................................................. 11.2.10 TPC Output Mode Register (TPMR) ................................................................... 11.3 Operation .......................................................................................................................... 11.3.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 11.3.2 Output Timing...................................................................................................... 11.3.3 Normal TPC Output............................................................................................. 11.3.4 Non-Overlapping TPC Output ............................................................................. 11.3.5 TPC Output Triggering by Input Capture ............................................................ 11.4 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 11.4.1 Operation of TPC Output Pins ............................................................................. 11.4.2 Note on Non-Overlapping Output........................................................................ 415 415 416 416 417 419 421 422 423 425 427 427 428 429 431 433 434 434 434 Section 12 Watchdog Timer ............................................................................................. 437 12.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 12.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 12.1.2 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 12.1.3 Pin Configuration................................................................................................. 12.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 12.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 12.2.1 Timer Counter (TCNT)........................................................................................ 12.2.2 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)................................................................ 12.2.3 Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR) ............................................................ 12.2.4 Notes on Register Access..................................................................................... 12.3 Operation .......................................................................................................................... 12.3.1 Watchdog Timer Operation ................................................................................. 12.3.2 Interval Timer Operation ..................................................................................... 12.3.3 Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF) ......................................................... 12.3.4 Timing of Setting of Watchdog Timer Reset Bit (WRST) .................................. 12.4 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................... 12.5 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 12.6 Notes ................................................................................................................................. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xviii of xxiv 437 437 438 438 439 439 439 440 442 443 445 445 446 446 447 448 448 449 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface ................................................................ 13.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 13.1.1 Features ................................................................................................................ 13.1.2 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 13.1.3 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 13.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 13.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 13.2.1 Receive Shift Register (RSR)............................................................................... 13.2.2 Receive Data Register (RDR) .............................................................................. 13.2.3 Transmit Shift Register (TSR) ............................................................................. 13.2.4 Transmit Data Register (TDR)............................................................................. 13.2.5 Serial Mode Register (SMR)................................................................................ 13.2.6 Serial Control Register (SCR).............................................................................. 13.2.7 Serial Status Register (SSR)................................................................................. 13.2.8 Bit Rate Register (BRR) ...................................................................................... 13.3 Operation........................................................................................................................... 13.3.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 13.3.2 Operation in Asynchronous Mode ....................................................................... 13.3.3 Multiprocessor Communication........................................................................... 13.3.4 Synchronous Operation........................................................................................ 13.4 SCI Interrupts.................................................................................................................... 13.5 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 451 451 451 453 454 454 455 455 455 456 456 457 460 464 468 480 480 482 491 498 506 507 Section 14 Smart Card Interface ..................................................................................... 14.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 14.1.1 Features ................................................................................................................ 14.1.2 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 14.1.3 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 14.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 14.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 14.2.1 Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR) .................................................................... 14.2.2 Serial Status Register (SSR)................................................................................. 14.2.3 Serial Mode Register (SMR)................................................................................ 14.2.4 Serial Control Register (SCR).............................................................................. 14.3 Operation........................................................................................................................... 14.3.1 Overview.............................................................................................................. 14.3.2 Pin Connections ................................................................................................... 14.3.3 Data Format ......................................................................................................... 14.3.4 Register Settings .................................................................................................. 14.3.5 Clock.................................................................................................................... 509 509 509 510 511 511 512 512 513 515 516 517 517 517 519 520 522 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xix of xxiv 14.3.6 Transmitting and Receiving Data ........................................................................ 524 14.4 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 531 Section 15 A/D Converter ................................................................................................. 15.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 15.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 15.1.2 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 15.1.3 Input Pins ............................................................................................................. 15.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 15.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 15.2.1 A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD) ............................................. 15.2.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) ............................................................... 15.2.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR) ............................................................................ 15.3 CPU Interface.................................................................................................................... 15.4 Operation .......................................................................................................................... 15.4.1 Single Mode (SCAN = 0) .................................................................................... 15.4.2 Scan Mode (SCAN = 1)....................................................................................... 15.4.3 Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time ......................................................... 15.4.4 External Trigger Input Timing............................................................................. 15.5 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................... 15.6 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 535 535 535 536 537 538 539 539 540 542 543 544 544 546 548 549 550 550 Section 16 D/A Converter ................................................................................................. 16.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 16.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 16.1.2 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 16.1.3 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 16.1.4 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 16.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 16.2.1 D/A Data Registers 0 and 1 (DADR0/1).............................................................. 16.2.2 D/A Control Register (DACR) ............................................................................ 16.2.3 D/A Standby Control Register (DASTCR).......................................................... 16.3 Operation .......................................................................................................................... 16.4 D/A Output Control .......................................................................................................... 16.5 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 557 557 557 558 559 559 560 560 560 562 563 564 564 Section 17 RAM .................................................................................................................. 17.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 17.1.1 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 17.1.2 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 565 565 566 566 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xx of xxiv 17.2 System Control Register (SYSCR) ................................................................................... 567 17.3 Operation........................................................................................................................... 568 Section 18 ROM (H8/3048ZTAT and Mask-ROM Versions) ............................... 569 18.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 18.1.1 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 18.2 PROM Mode..................................................................................................................... 18.2.1 PROM Mode Setting............................................................................................ 18.2.2 Socket Adapter and Memory Map ....................................................................... 18.3 PROM Programming ........................................................................................................ 18.3.1 Programming and Verification............................................................................. 18.3.2 Programming Precautions .................................................................................... 18.3.3 Reliability of Programmed Data .......................................................................... 18.4 Notes on Ordering Mask ROM Version Chip................................................................... 569 570 571 571 571 573 574 578 579 580 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) ....... 583 19.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 583 19.2 Flash Memory Overview................................................................................................... 584 19.2.1 Flash Memory Operation ..................................................................................... 584 19.2.2 Mode Programming and Flash Memory Address Space...................................... 585 19.2.3 Features ................................................................................................................ 586 19.2.4 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................... 587 19.2.5 Input/Output Pins ................................................................................................. 588 19.2.6 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 588 19.3 Flash Memory Register Descriptions ................................................................................ 589 19.3.1 Flash Memory Control Register........................................................................... 589 19.3.2 Erase Block Register 1......................................................................................... 592 19.3.3 Erase Block Register 2......................................................................................... 593 19.3.4 RAM Control Register (RAMCR) ....................................................................... 595 19.4 On-Board Programming Modes ........................................................................................ 596 19.4.1 Boot Mode ........................................................................................................... 597 19.4.2 User Program Mode ............................................................................................. 602 19.5 Programming and Erasing Flash Memory......................................................................... 604 19.5.1 Program Mode ..................................................................................................... 605 19.5.2 Program-Verify Mode.......................................................................................... 605 19.5.3 Programming Flowchart and Sample Program .................................................... 606 19.5.4 Erase Mode .......................................................................................................... 609 19.5.5 Erase-Verify Mode............................................................................................... 609 19.5.6 Erasing Flowchart and Sample Program.............................................................. 610 19.5.7 Prewrite-Verify Mode .......................................................................................... 624 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xxi of xxiv 19.6 19.7 19.8 19.9 19.5.8 Protect Modes ...................................................................................................... 19.5.9 NMI Input Masking ............................................................................................. Flash Memory Emulation by RAM................................................................................... Flash Memory PROM Mode............................................................................................. 19.7.1 PROM Mode Setting............................................................................................ 19.7.2 Socket Adapter and Memory Map ....................................................................... 19.7.3 Operation in PROM Mode................................................................................... Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply) .................. Notes when Converting the F-ZTAT (Dual-Power Supply) Application Software to the Mask-ROM Versions .............................................................................................. 625 628 629 631 631 632 634 643 651 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator .................................................................................. 653 20.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 20.1.1 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 20.2 Oscillator Circuit............................................................................................................... 20.2.1 Connecting a Crystal Resonator........................................................................... 20.2.2 External Clock Input ............................................................................................ 20.3 Duty Adjustment Circuit................................................................................................... 20.4 Prescalers .......................................................................................................................... 20.5 Frequency Divider ............................................................................................................ 20.5.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 20.5.2 Division Control Register (DIVCR) .................................................................... 20.5.3 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................... 653 654 655 655 657 659 659 660 660 660 661 Section 21 Power-Down State ......................................................................................... 663 21.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 663 21.2 Register Configuration...................................................................................................... 665 21.2.1 System Control Register (SYSCR) ...................................................................... 665 21.2.2 Module Standby Control Register (MSTCR) ...................................................... 667 21.3 Sleep Mode ....................................................................................................................... 669 21.3.1 Transition to Sleep Mode..................................................................................... 669 21.3.2 Exit from Sleep Mode.......................................................................................... 669 21.4 Software Standby Mode.................................................................................................... 669 21.4.1 Transition to Software Standby Mode ................................................................. 669 21.4.2 Exit from Software Standby Mode ...................................................................... 670 21.4.3 Selection of Waiting Time for Exit from Software Standby Mode...................... 670 21.4.4 Sample Application of Software Standby Mode.................................................. 672 21.4.5 Note...................................................................................................................... 672 21.5 Hardware Standby Mode .................................................................................................. 673 21.5.1 Transition to Hardware Standby Mode ................................................................ 673 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xxii of xxiv 21.5.2 Exit from Hardware Standby Mode ..................................................................... 21.5.3 Timing for Hardware Standby Mode ................................................................... 21.6 Module Standby Function ................................................................................................. 21.6.1 Module Standby Timing ...................................................................................... 21.6.2 Read/Write in Module Standby............................................................................ 21.6.3 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................... 21.7 System Clock Output Disabling Function......................................................................... 673 673 674 674 674 675 676 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics.............................................................................. 22.1 Electrical Characteristics for H8/3048 ZTAT (PROM) and On-Chip Mask ROM Versions ............................................................................................................................ 22.1.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ................................................................................ 22.1.2 DC Characteristics ............................................................................................... 22.1.3 AC Characteristics ............................................................................................... 22.1.4 A/D Conversion Characteristics........................................................................... 22.1.5 D/A Conversion Characteristics........................................................................... 22.2 Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048F (Dual-Power Supply) .......................................... 22.2.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ................................................................................ 22.2.2 DC Characteristics ............................................................................................... 22.2.3 AC Characteristics ............................................................................................... 22.2.4 A/D Conversion Characteristics........................................................................... 22.2.5 D/A Conversion Characteristics........................................................................... 22.2.6 Flash Memory Characteristics.............................................................................. 22.3 Operational Timing ........................................................................................................... 22.3.1 Bus Timing........................................................................................................... 22.3.2 Refresh Controller Bus Timing............................................................................ 22.3.3 Control Signal Timing ......................................................................................... 22.3.4 Clock Timing ....................................................................................................... 22.3.5 TPC and I/O Port Timing..................................................................................... 22.3.6 ITU Timing .......................................................................................................... 22.3.7 SCI Input/Output Timing ..................................................................................... 22.3.8 DMAC Timing..................................................................................................... 677 Appendix A A.1 A.2 A.3 679 679 680 686 693 694 695 695 696 703 709 710 711 712 712 716 721 723 723 724 725 726 Instruction Set ............................................................................................. 727 Instruction List .................................................................................................................. 727 Operation Code Map ......................................................................................................... 742 Number of States Required for Execution ........................................................................ 745 Appendix B B.1 Internal I/O Register ................................................................................. 755 Addresses .......................................................................................................................... 756 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xxiii of xxiv B.2 Function ............................................................................................................................ 764 Appendix C C.1 C.2 C.3 C.4 C.5 C.6 C.7 C.8 C.9 C.10 C.11 I/O Port Block Diagrams ......................................................................... Port 1 Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... Port 2 Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... Port 3 Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... Port 4 Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... Port 5 Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... Port 6 Block Diagrams...................................................................................................... Port 7 Block Diagrams...................................................................................................... Port 8 Block Diagrams...................................................................................................... Port 9 Block Diagrams...................................................................................................... Port A Block Diagrams ..................................................................................................... Port B Block Diagrams ..................................................................................................... 844 844 845 846 847 848 849 853 854 857 861 865 Appendix D D.1 D.2 Pin States...................................................................................................... 869 Port States in Each Mode .................................................................................................. 869 Pin States at Reset ............................................................................................................. 872 Appendix E Timing of Transition to and Recovery from Hardware Standby Mode ............................................................................................................. 875 Appendix F Product Code Lineup ................................................................................ 876 Appendix G Package Dimensions ................................................................................. 877 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page xxiv of xxiv Section 1 Overview Section 1 Overview 1.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group is a series of microcontrollers (MCUs) that integrate system supporting functions together with an H8/300H CPU core having an original Renesas Technology architecture. The H8/300H CPU has a 32-bit internal architecture with sixteen 16-bit general registers, and a concise, optimized instruction set designed for speed. It can address a 16-Mbyte linear address space. Its instruction set is upward-compatible at the object-code level with the H8/300 CPU, enabling easy porting of software from the H8/300 Series. The on-chip system supporting functions include ROM, RAM, a 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), a programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), a watchdog timer (WDT), a serial communication interface (SCI), an A/D converter, a D/A converter, I/O ports, a direct memory access controller (DMAC), a refresh controller, and other facilities. The four members of the H8/3048 Group are the H8/3048, the H8/3047, H8/3045, and the H8/3044. The H8/3048 has 128 kbytes of ROM and 4 kbytes of RAM. The H8/3047 has 96 kbytes of ROM and 4 kbytes of RAM. The H8/3045 has 64 kbytes of ROM and 2 kbytes of RAM. The H8/3044 has 32 kbytes of ROM and 2 kbytes of RAM. Seven MCU operating modes offer a choice of data bus width and address space size. The modes (modes 1 to 7) include one single-chip mode and six expanded modes. In addition to the mask ROM versions of the H8/3048 Group, the H8/3048 has a ZTAT™*1 version with user-programmable on-chip PROM and an F-ZTAT™*2 version with on-chip flash memory that can be programmed on-board. These versions enable users to respond quickly and flexibly to changing application specifications, growing production volumes, and other conditions. The F-ZTAT™ version H8/3048F-ONE includes the on-chip emulator E10T. Table 1.1 summarizes the features of the H8/3048 Group. Notes: 1. ZTAT (Zero Turn-Around Time) is a trademark of Renesas Technology Corp. 2. F-ZTAT (Flexible ZTAT) is a trademark of Renesas Technology Corp. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 1 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Table 1.1 Features Feature Description CPU Upward-compatible with the H8/300 CPU at the object-code level • General-register machine Sixteen 16-bit general registers (also usable as sixteen 8-bit registers + eight 16-bit registers or eight 32bit registers) • High-speed operation (flash memory version) H8/3048F Maximum clock rate: 16 MHz Add/subtract: 125 ns Multiply/divide: 875 ns • High-speed operation (mask ROM and PROM versions) Maximum clock rate: 18 MHz Add/subtract: 111 ns Multiply/divide: 778 ns • 16-Mbyte address space • Instruction features 8/16/32-bit data transfer, arithmetic, and logic instructions Signed and unsigned multiply instructions (8 bits × 8 bits, 16 bits × 16 bits) Signed and unsigned divide instructions (16 bits ÷ 8 bits, 32 bits ÷ 16 bits) Bit accumulator function Bit manipulation instructions with register-indirect specification of bit positions Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 2 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Feature Description Memory • H8/3048, H8/3048F ROM: 128 kbytes RAM: 4 kbytes • H8/3047 ROM: 96 kbytes RAM: 4 kbytes • H8/3045 ROM: 64 kbytes RAM: 2 kbytes • H8/3044 ROM: 32 kbytes RAM: 2 kbytes Interrupt controller Bus controller Refresh controller • Seven external interrupt pins: NMI, IRQ0 to IRQ5 • 30 internal interrupts • Three selectable interrupt priority levels • Address space can be partitioned into eight areas, with independent bus specifications in each area • Chip select output available for areas 0 to 7 • 8-bit access or 16-bit access selectable for each area • Two-state or three-state access selectable for each area • Selection of four wait modes • Bus arbitration function • DRAM refresh Directly connectable to 16-bit-wide DRAM CAS-before-RAS refresh Self-refresh mode selectable • Pseudo-static RAM refresh Self-refresh mode selectable • Usable as an interval timer Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 3 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Feature Description DMA controller (DMAC) • Short address mode Maximum four channels available Selection of I/O mode, idle mode, or repeat mode Can be activated by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3, transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts from SCI channel 0, or external requests • Full address mode Maximum two channels available Selection of normal mode or block transfer mode Can be activated by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3, external requests, or auto-request 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) Programmable timing pattern controller (TPC) Watchdog timer (WDT), 1 channel • Five 16-bit timer channels, capable of processing up to 12 pulse outputs or 10 pulse inputs • 16-bit timer counter (channels 0 to 4) • Two multiplexed output compare/input capture pins (channels 0 to 4) • Operation can be synchronized (channels 0 to 4) • PWM mode available (channels 0 to 4) • Phase counting mode available (channel 2) • Buffering available (channels 3 and 4) • Reset-synchronized PWM mode available (channels 3 and 4) • Complementary PWM mode available (channels 3 and 4) • DMAC can be activated by compare match/input capture A interrupts (channels 0 to 3) • Maximum 16-bit pulse output, using ITU as time base • Up to four 4-bit pulse output groups (or one 16-bit group, or two 8-bit groups) • Non-overlap mode available • Output data can be transferred by DMAC • Reset signal can be generated by overflow • Reset signal can be output externally • Usable as an interval timer Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 4 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Feature Description Serial communication interface (SCI), 2 channels • Selection of asynchronous or synchronous mode • Full duplex: can transmit and receive simultaneously • On-chip baud-rate generator • Smart card interface functions added (SCI0 only) • Resolution: 10 bits • Eight channels, with selection of single or scan mode • Variable analog conversion voltage range • Sample-and-hold function • A/D conversion can be externally triggered • Resolution: 8 bits A/D converter D/A converter I/O ports Operating modes Power-down state • Two channels • D/A outputs can be sustained in software standby mode • 70 input/output pins • 8 input-only pins • Seven MCU operating modes Mode Address Space Address Pins Initial Bus Width Max. Bus Width Mode 1 1 Mbyte A19 to A0 8 bits 16 bits Mode 2 1 Mbyte A19 to A0 16 bits 16 bits Mode 3 16 Mbytes A23 to A0 8 bits 16 bits Mode 4 16 Mbytes A23 to A0 16 bits 16 bits Mode 5 1 Mbyte A19 to A0 8 bits 16 bits Mode 6 16 Mbytes A23 to A0 8 bits 16 bits Mode 7 1 Mbyte — — — • On-chip ROM is disabled in modes 1 to 4 • Sleep mode • Software standby mode • Hardware standby mode • Module standby function • Programmable system clock frequency division Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 5 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Feature Description Other features • Product lineup Model (5 V) On-chip clock pulse generator Model (3 V) Package ROM Flash memory HD64F3048TF HD64F3048VTF 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HD64F3048F HD64F3048VF 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) HD6473048TF HD6473048VTF 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HD6473048F HD6473048VF 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) HD6433048TF HD6433048VTF 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HD6433048F HD6433048VF 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) HD6433047TF HD6433047VTF 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HD6433047F HD6433047VF 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) HD6433045TF HD6433045VTF 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HD6433045F HD6433045VF 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) HD6433044TF HD6433044VTF 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HD6433044F HD6433044VF 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 6 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 PROM Mask ROM Mask ROM Mask ROM Mask ROM Section 1 Overview 1.2 Block Diagram Port 3 P40/D0 P41/D1 P42/D2 P43/D3 P44/D4 P45/D5 P46/D6 P47/D7 P30/D8 P31/D9 P32/D10 P33/D11 P34/D12 P35/D13 P36/D14 P37/D15 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VCC VCC VCC Figure 1.1 shows an internal block diagram. Port 4 Address bus Data bus (upper) MD1 Data bus (lower) Port 5 P53/A19 MD2 MD0 P52/A18 P51/A17 P50/A16 EXTAL P27/A15 Clock pulse generator STBY RES VPP/RESO * NMI DMA controller (DMAC) P65/HWR P24/A12 P23/A11 P22/A10 P21/A9 P20/A8 P17/A7 P16/A6 P15/A5 P61/BREQ Port 1 P62/BACK ROM (mask ROM, PROM, or flash memory) Port 6 P63/AS P25/A13 Interrupt controller P66/LWR P64/RD P26/A14 H8/300H CPU Port 2 φ Bus controller XTAL Refresh controller P60/WAIT P14/A4 P13/A3 P12/A2 RAM P11/A1 P84/CS0 P82/CS2/IRQ2 P81/CS3/IRQ1 Port 8 P83/CS1/IRQ3 P10/A0 Watchdog timer (WDT) 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) P80/RFSH/IRQ0 Serial communication interface (SCI) × 2 channels P95/SCK1/IRQ5 Programmable timing pattern controller (TPC) P94/SCK0/IRQ4 Port 9 A/D converter D/A converter P93/RxD1 P92/RxD0 P91/TxD1 P90/TxD0 P70/AN0 P71/AN1 P72/AN2 P73/AN3 P74/AN4 P75/AN5 P76/AN6/DA0 P77/AN7/DA1 AVSS AVCC VREF PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB Port 7 PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD PA4/TP4/TIOCA1/A23/CS6 PA5/TP5/TIOCB1/A22/CS5 PA6/TP6/TIOCA2/A21/CS4 PA7/TP7/TIOCB2/A20 PB0/TP8/TIOCA3 PB1/TP9/TIOCB3 Port A PB2/TP10/TIOCA4 PB3/TP11/TIOCB4 PB4/TP12/TOCXA4 PB5/TP13/TOCXB4 PB6/TP14/DREQ0/CS7 PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG Port B Note: * For the mask ROM version, this pin is also used as the RESO (output) terminal. For the flash memory version dual power supply (VPP = 12 V) and for the PROM version, this pin is also used as the RESO (output)/VPP (input) terminal. Figure 1.1 Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 7 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview 1.3 Pin Description 1.3.1 Pin Arrangement Figure 1.2 shows the pin arrangement of the H8/3048 Group. The pin arrangement of the H8/3048 Group is shown in figure 1.2. Differences in the H8/3048 Group pin arrangements are shown in table 1.2. Except for the differences shown in table 1.2, the pin arrangements are the same. Table 1.2 Package FP-100B (TFP-100B) Comparison of H8/3048 Group Pin Arrangements Pin Number H8/3048 ZTAT H8/3048 Mask ROM Version H8/3047 Mask ROM Version H8/3045 Mask ROM Version H8/3044 Mask ROM Version H8/3048F 1 VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC 10 VPP/RESO RESO RESO RESO RESO VPP/RESO Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 8 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 MD2 MD1 MD0 P66 /LWR P65 /HWR P64 /RD P63 /AS VCC XTAL EXTAL VSS NMI RES STBY ø P62 /BACK P61 /BREQ P60 /WAIT VSS P53 /A 19 P52 /A 18 P51 /A 17 P50 /A 16 P27 /A 15 P26 /A 14 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 Section 1 Overview D15/P37 PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA 93 33 D14/P36 PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB 94 32 D13/P35 PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC 95 31 D12/P34 PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD 96 30 D11/P33 PA4/TP4/TIOCA1/A23/CS6 97 29 D10/P32 PA5/TP5/TIOCB1/A22/CS5 98 28 D9/P31 PA6/TP6/TIOCA2/A21/CS4 99 27 D8/P30 100 26 D7/P47 PA7/TP7/TIOCB2/A20 25 34 D6 /P4 6 92 24 VCC VSS D5 /P4 5 35 23 91 D4 /P4 4 A0/P10 P84/CS0 22 36 VSS 90 21 A1/P11 P83/CS1/IRQ3 D3 /P4 3 37 20 89 D2 /P4 2 A2/P12 P82/CS2/IRQ2 19 38 D1 /P4 1 (FP-100B, TFP-100B) 18 88 D0 /P4 0 A3/P13 P81/CS3/IRQ1 17 39 IRQ 5/SCK1 /P9 5 Top view 16 87 IRQ 4/SCK0 /P9 4 A4/P14 P80/RFSH/IRQ0 15 40 RxD1 /P9 3 86 14 A5/P15 AVSS RxD0 /P9 2 41 13 85 TxD1 /P9 1 A6/P16 P77/AN7/DA1 12 42 TxD0 /P9 0 84 11 A7/P17 P76/AN6/DA0 VSS 43 10* 83 VPP/RESO VSS P75/AN5 9 44 ADTRG/DREQ 1 /TP15 /PB 7 82 8 A8/P20 P74/AN4 CS7/DREQ 0 /TP14 /PB 6 45 7 81 TOCXB4 /TP13 /PB 5 A9/P21 P73/AN3 6 46 TOCXA4 /TP12 /PB 4 80 5 A10/P22 P72/AN2 TIOCB4 /TP11 /PB 3 A11/P23 47 4 48 79 TIOCA4 /TP10 /PB 2 78 P71/AN1 3 P70/AN0 TIOCB3 /TP 9 /PB 1 A12/P24 2 A13/P25 49 1 50 77 VCC 76 VREF TIOCA3 /TP 8 /PB 0 AVCC Note: * For the mask ROM version, this pin is also used as the RESO terminal. For the PROM version and the flash memory version dual power method, this pin is also used as the RESO/VPP terminal. For the flash memory version with single power method. Figure 1.2 Pin Arrangement of H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 Mask ROM Version, H8/3047 Mask ROM Version, H8/3045 Mask ROM Version, H8/3044 Mask ROM Version, and H8/3048F (FP-100B or TFP-100B, Top View) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 9 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview 1.3.2 Pin Assignments in Each Mode Table 1.3 lists the pin assignments in each mode. Table 1.3 Pin Assignments in Each Mode (FP-100B or TFP-100B) Pin Name Pin No. PROM Mode Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 EPROM Flash Remarks 1* VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC Mask ROM version, PROM version and flash memory version with dual power supply. 2 PB0/TP8/ B0/TP8/ TIOCA3 TIOCA3 B0/TP8/ TIOCA3 B0/TP8/ TIOCA3 B0/TP8/ TIOCA3 B0/TP8/ TIOCA3 B0/TP8/ TIOCA3 NC NC 3 PB1/TP9/ PB1/TP9/ PB1/TP9/ PB1/TP9/ PB1/TP9/ PB1/TP9/ PB1/TP9/ NC TIOCB3 TIOCB3 TIOCB3 TIOCB3 TIOCB3 TIOCB3 TIOCB3 NC 4 PB2/TP10/ PB2/TP10/ PB2/TP10/ PB2/TP10/ PB2/TP10/ PB2/TP10/ PB2/TP10/ NC TIOCA4 TIOCA4 TIOCA4 TIOCA4 TIOCA4 TIOCA4 TIOCA4 NC 5 PB3/TP11/ PB3/TP11/ PB3/TP11/ PB3/TP11/ PB3/TP11/ PB3/TP11/ PB3/TP11/ NC TIOCB4 TIOCB4 TIOCB4 TIOCB4 TIOCB4 TIOCB4 TIOCB4 NC 6 PB4/TP12/ PB4/TP12/ PB4/TP12/ PB4/TP12/ PB4/TP12/ PB4/TP12/ PB4/TP12/ NC TOCXA4 TOCXA4 TOCXA4 TOCXA4 TOCXA4 TOCXA4 TOCXA4 NC 7 PB5/TP13/ PB5/TP13/ PB5/TP13/ PB5/TP13/ PB5/TP13/ PB5/TP13/ PB5/TP13/ NC TOCXB4 TOCXB4 TOCXB4 TOCXB4 TOCXB4 TOCXB4 TOCXB4 NC 8 PB6/TP14/ PB6/TP14/ PB6/TP14/ PB6/TP14/ PB6/TP14/ PB6/TP14/ PB6/TP14/ NC DREQ0/ DREQ0/ DREQ0/ DREQ0/ DREQ0/ DREQ0/ DREQ0 CS7 CS7 CS7 CS7 CS7 CS7 NC 9 PB7/TP15/ PB7/TP15/ PB7/TP15/ PB7/TP15/ PB7/TP15/ PB7/TP15/ PB7/TP15/ NC DREQ1/ DREQ1/ DREQ1/ DREQ1/ DREQ1/ DREQ1/ DREQ1/ ADTRG ADTRG ADTRG ADTRG ADTRG ADTRG ADTRG NC 3 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 10 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Pin Name Pin No. PROM Mode Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 EPROM Flash Remarks 10* RESO RESO RESO RESO RESO RESO RESO VPP VPP Mask ROM version, PROM version and flash memory version with dual power supply. 11 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 12 P90/TxD0 P90/TxD0 P90/TxD0 P90/TxD0 P90/TxD0 P90/TxD0 P90/TxD0 NC NC 13 P91/TxD1 P91/TxD1 P91/TxD1 P91/TxD1 P91/TxD1 P91/TxD1 P91/TxD1 NC NC 14 P92/RxD0 P92/RxD0 P92/RxD0 P92/RxD0 P92/RxD0 P92/RxD0 P92/RxD0 NC NC 15 P93/RxD1 P93/RxD1 P93/RxD1 P93/RxD1 P93/RxD1 P93/RxD1 P93/RxD1 NC NC 16 P94/SCK0 P94/SCK0 P94/SCK0 P94/SCK0 P94/SCK0 P94/SCK0 P94/SCK0 NC / / / / / / / IRQ4 IRQ4 IRQ4 IRQ4 IRQ4 IRQ4 IRQ4 NC 17 P95/SCK1 P95/SCK1 P95/SCK1 P95/SCK1 P95/SCK1 P95/SCK1 P95/SCK1 NC / / / / / / / IRQ5 IRQ5 IRQ5 IRQ5 IRQ5 IRQ5 IRQ5 NC 18 P40/D0*1 P40/D0*2 P40/D0*1 P40/D0*2 P40/D0*1 P40/D0*1 P40 NC NC 19 1 P41/D1* 2 P41/D1* 1 P41/D1* 2 P41/D1* 1 P41/D1* 1 P41/D1* P41 NC NC 20 P42/D2*1 P42/D2*2 P42/D2*1 P42/D2*2 P42/D2*1 P42/D2*1 P42 NC NC 21 P43/D3*1 P43/D3*2 P43/D3*1 P43/D3*2 P43/D3*1 P43/D3*1 P43 NC NC 22 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 23 P44/D4*1 P44/D4*2 P44/D4*1 P44/D4*2 P44/D4*1 P44/D4*1 P44 NC NC 24 P45/D5*1 P45/D5*2 P45/D5*1 P45/D5*2 P45/D5*1 P45/D5*1 P45 NC NC 25 1 2 1 2 1 P46/D6*1 P46 NC NC 1 1 4 P46/D6* 1 P46/D6* 2 P46/D6* 1 P46/D6* 2 P46/D6* 26 P47/D7* P47/D7* P47/D7* P47/D7* P47/D7* P47/D7* P47 NC NC 27 D8 D8 D8 D8 D8 D8 P30 EO0 I/O0 28 D9 D9 D9 D9 D9 D9 P31 EO1 I/O1 29 D10 D10 D10 D10 D10 D10 P32 EO2 I/O2 30 D11 D11 D11 D11 D11 D11 P33 EO3 I/O3 31 D12 D12 D12 D12 D12 D12 P34 EO4 I/O4 32 D13 D13 D13 D13 D13 D13 P35 EO5 I/O5 33 D14 D14 D14 D14 D14 D14 P36 EO6 I/O6 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 11 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Pin Name PROM Mode Pin No. Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 EPROM Flash 34 D15 D15 D15 D15 D15 D15 P37 EO7 I/O7 35 VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC 36 A0 A0 A0 A0 P10/A0 P10/A0 P10 EA0 A0 37 A1 A1 A1 A1 P11/A1 P11/A1 P11 EA1 A1 38 A2 A2 A2 A2 P12/A2 P12/A2 P12 EA2 A2 39 A3 A3 A3 A3 P13/A3 P13/A3 P13 EA3 A3 40 A4 A4 A4 A4 P14/A4 P14/A4 P14 EA4 A4 41 A5 A5 A5 A5 P15/A5 P15/A5 P15 EA5 A5 42 A6 A6 A6 A6 P16/A6 P16/A6 P16 EA6 A6 43 A7 A7 A7 A7 P17/A7 P17/A7 P17 EA7 A7 44 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 56 A19 A19 A19 A19 P53/A19 P53/A19 P53 NC NC 57 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 58 P60/ WAIT P60/ WAIT P60/ WAIT P60/ WAIT P60/ WAIT P60/ WAIT P60 EA15 A15 59 P61/ BREQ P61/ BREQ P61/ BREQ P61/ BREQ P61/ BREQ P61/ BREQ P61 NC NC 60 P62/ BACK P62/ BACK P62/ BACK P62/ BACK P62/ BACK P62/ BACK P62 NC NC 61 φ φ φ φ φ φ φ NC NC 62 STBY STBY STBY STBY STBY STBY STBY VSS VCC 63 RES RES RES RES RES RES RES NC RES 64 NMI NMI NMI NMI NMI NMI NMI EA9 A9 65 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 66 EXTAL EXTAL EXTAL EXTAL EXTAL EXTAL EXTAL NC EXTAL 67 XTAL XTAL XTAL XTAL XTAL XTAL XTAL NC XTAL 68 VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC VCC 69 AS AS AS AS AS AS P63 NC A16 70 RD RD RD RD RD RD P64 NC NC 71 HWR HWR HWR HWR HWR HWR P65 NC VCC 72 LWR LWR LWR LWR LWR LWR P66 NC NC 73 MD0 MD0 MD0 MD0 MD0 MD0 MD0 VSS VSS 74 MD1 MD1 MD1 MD1 MD1 MD1 MD1 VSS VSS 75 MD2 MD2 MD2 MD2 MD2 MD2 MD2 VSS VSS Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 12 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Remarks Section 1 Overview Pin Name PROM Mode Pin No. Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 EPROM Flash 76 AVCC AVCC AVCC AVCC AVCC AVCC AVCC VCC VCC 77 VREF VREF VREF VREF VREF VREF VREF VCC VCC 78 P70/AN0 P70/AN0 P70/AN0 P70/AN0 P70/AN0 P70/AN0 P70/AN0 NC NC 79 P71/AN1 P71/AN1 P71/AN1 P71/AN1 P71/AN1 P71/AN1 P71/AN1 NC NC 80 P72/AN2 P72/AN2 P72/AN2 P72/AN2 P72/AN2 P72/AN2 P72/AN2 NC NC 81 P73/AN3 P73/AN3 P73/AN3 P73/AN3 P73/AN3 P73/AN3 P73/AN3 NC NC 82 P74/AN4 P74/AN4 P74/AN4 P74/AN4 P74/AN4 P74/AN4 P74/AN4 NC NC 83 P75/AN5 P75/AN5 P75/AN5 P75/AN5 P75/AN5 P75/AN5 P75/AN5 NC NC 84 P76/AN6/ P76/AN6/ P76/AN6/ P76/AN6/ P76/AN6/ P76/AN6/ P76/AN6/ NC DA0 DA0 DA0 DA0 DA0 DA0 DA0 NC 85 P77/AN7/ P77/AN7/ P77/AN7/ P77/AN7/ P77/AN7/ P77/AN7/ P77/AN7/ NC DA1 DA1 DA1 DA1 DA1 DA1 DA1 NC 86 AVSS AVSS AVSS AVSS AVSS AVSS AVSS VSS 87 P80/ RFSH/ IRQ0 P80/ RFSH/ IRQ0 P80/ RFSH/ IRQ0 P80/ RFSH/ IRQ0 P80/ RFSH/ IRQ0 P80/ RFSH/ IRQ0 P80/IRQ0 EA16 NC 88 P81/CS3/ P81/CS3/ P81/CS3/ P81/CS3/ P81/CS3/ P81/CS3/ P81/IRQ1 PGM IRQ1 IRQ1 IRQ1 IRQ1 IRQ1 IRQ1 NC 89 P82/CS2/ P82/CS2/ P82/CS2/ P82/CS2/ P82/CS2/ P82/CS2/ P82/IRQ2 NC IRQ2 IRQ2 IRQ2 IRQ2 IRQ2 IRQ2 VCC 90 P83/CS1/ P83/CS1/ P83/CS1/ P83/CS1/ P83/CS1/ P83/CS1/ P83/IRQ3 NC IRQ3 IRQ3 IRQ3 IRQ3 IRQ3 IRQ3 WE 91 P84/CS0 P84/CS0 P84/CS0 P84/CS0 P84/CS0 P84/CS0 P84 NC NC 92 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 93 PA0/TP0/ PA0/TP0/ PA0/TP0/ PA0/TP0/ PA0/TP0/ PA0/TP0/ PA0/TP0/ NC TEND0/ TEND0/ TEND0/ TEND0/ TEND0/ TEND0/ TEND0/ TCLKA TCLKA TCLKA TCLKA TCLKA TCLKA TCLKA NC 94 PA1/TP1/ PA1/TP1/ PA1/TP1/ PA1/TP1/ PA1/TP1/ PA1/TP1/ PA1/TP1/ NC TEND1/ TEND1/ TEND1/ TEND1/ TEND1/ TEND1/ TEND1/ TCLKB TCLKB TCLKB TCLKB TCLKB TCLKB TCLKB NC 95 PA2/TP2/ PA2/TP2/ PA2/TP2/ PA2/TP2/ PA2/TP2/ PA2/TP2/ PA2/TP2/ NC TIOCA0/ TIOCA0/ TIOCA0/ TIOCA0/ TIOCA0/ TIOCA0/ TIOCA0/ TCLKC TCLKC TCLKC TCLKC TCLKC TCLKC TCLKC NC 96 PA3/TP3/ PA3/TP3/ PA3/TP3/ PA3/TP3/ PA3/TP3/ PA3/TP3/ PA3/TP3/ NC TIOCB0/ TIOCB0/ TIOCB0/ TIOCB0/ TIOCB0/ TIOCB0/ TIOCB0/ TCLKD TCLKD TCLKD TCLKD TCLKD TCLKD TCLKD NC VSS Remarks Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 13 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Pin Name Pin No. PROM Mode Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 EPROM Flash 97 PA4/TP4/ PA4/TP4/ PA4/TP4/ PA4/TP4/ PA4/TP4/ PA4/TP4/ PA4/TP4/ NC TIOCA1/ TIOCA1/ TIOCA1/ TIOCA1/ TIOCA1/ TIOCA1/ TIOCA1 CS6 CS6 CS6 CS6 CS6 A23/CS6 NC 98 PA5/TP5/ PA5/TP5/ PA5/TP5/ PA5/TP5/ PA5/TP5/ PA5/TP5/ PA5/TP5/ NC TIOCB1/ TIOCB1/ TIOCB1/ TIOCB1/ TIOCB1/ TIOCB1/ TIOCB1 CS5 CS5 CS5 CS5 CS5 A22/CS5 NC 99 PA6/TP6/ PA6/TP6/ PA6/TP6/ PA6/TP6/ PA6/TP6/ PA6/TP6/ PA6/TP6/ NC TIOCA2/ TIOCA2/ TIOCA2/ TIOCA2/ TIOCA2/ TIOCA2/ TIOCA2 CS4 CS4 CS4 CS4 CS4 A21/CS4 NC 100 PA7/TP7/ PA7/TP7/ A20 TIOCB2 TIOCB2 NC A20 PA7/TP7/ A20 TIOCB2 PA7/TP7/ NC TIOCB2 Remarks Notes: 1. In modes 1, 3, 5, and 6 the P40 to P47 functions of pins P40/D0 to P47/D7 are selected after a reset, but they can be changed by software. 2. In modes 2 and 4 the D0 to D7 functions of pins P40/D0 to P47/D7 are selected after a reset, but they can be changed by software. 3. For the H8/3048 ZTAT version, H8/3048F version, H8/3048 mask ROM version, H8/3047 mask ROM version, H8/3045 mask ROM version, and H8/3044 mask ROM version, this pin is also used as the VCC terminal. 4. For the H8/3048 ZTAT version, H8/3048F version, H8/3048 mask ROM version, H8/3047 mask ROM version, H8/3045 mask ROM version, and H8/3044 mask ROM version, this pin is used as the RESO terminal. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 14 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview 1.3.3 Pin Functions Table 1.4 summarizes the pin functions. Table 1.4 Pin Functions Type Symbol Pin No. I/O Name and Function Power VCC 1, 35, 68 Input Power: For connection to the power supply. Connect all VCC pins to the system power supply. VSS 11, 22, 44, 57, 65, 92 Input Ground: For connection to ground (0 V). Connect all VSS pins to the 0-V system power supply. XTAL 67 Input For connection to a crystal resonator. For examples of crystal resonator and external clock input, see section 20, Clock Pulse Generator. EXTAL 66 Input For connection to a crystal resonator or input of an external clock signal. For examples of crystal resonator and external clock input, see section 20, Clock Pulse Generator. φ 61 Output System clock: Supplies the system clock to external devices. Input Mode 2 to mode 0: For setting the operating mode, as follows. Inputs at these pins must not be changed during operation. Clock Operating mode MD2 to MD0 75 to 73 control MD2 MD1 MD0 Operating Mode 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 — Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 15 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin No. I/O Name and Function System control RES 63 Input Reset input: When driven low, this pin resets the chip RESO 10 Output Reset output: For the mask ROM version, outputs a reset signal to external devices Also used as a power supply for on-board programming of the flash memory version with dual power supply. (RESO/VPP) STBY 62 Input Standby: When driven low, this pin forces a transition to hardware standby mode BREQ 59 Input Bus request: Used by an external bus master to request the bus right BACK 60 Output Bus request acknowledge: Indicates that the bus has been granted to an external bus master NMI 64 Input Nonmaskable interrupt: Requests a nonmaskable interrupt IRQ5 to IRQ0 17, 16, 90 to 87 Input Interrupt request 5 to 0: Maskable interrupt request pins Address bus A23 to A0 97 to 100, 56 to 45, 43 to 36 Output Address bus: Outputs address signals Data bus D15 to D0 34 to 23, 21 to 18 Input/ output Data bus: Bidirectional data bus Bus control CS7 to CS0 8, 97 to 99, 88 to 91 Output Chip select: Select signals for areas 7 to 0 AS 69 Output Address strobe: Goes low to indicate valid address output on the address bus RD 70 Output Read: Goes low to indicate reading from the external address space HWR 71 Output High write: Goes low to indicate writing to the external address space; indicates valid data on the upper data bus (D15 to D8). LWR 72 Output Low write: Goes low to indicate writing to the external address space; indicates valid data on the lower data bus (D7 to D0). WAIT 58 Input Wait: Requests insertion of wait states in bus cycles during access to the external address space Interrupts Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 16 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin No. I/O Name and Function Refresh controller RFSH 87 Output Refresh: Indicates a refresh cycle CS3 88 Output Row address strobe RAS: RAS Row address strobe signal for DRAM connected to area 3 RD 70 Output Column address strobe CAS: CAS Column address strobe signal for DRAM connected to area 3; used with 2WE DRAM. Write enable WE: WE Write enable signal for DRAM connected to area 3; used with 2CAS DRAM. HWR 71 Output Upper write UW: UW Write enable signal for DRAM connected to area 3; used with 2WE DRAM. Upper column address strobe UCAS: UCAS Column address strobe signal for DRAM connected to area 3; used with 2CAS DRAM. LWR 72 Output Lower write LW: LW Write enable signal for DRAM connected to area 3; used with 2WE DRAM. Lower column address strobe LCAS: LCAS Column address strobe signal for DRAM connected to area 3; used with 2CAS DRAM. DREQ1, DREQ0 9, 8 Input DMA request 1 and 0: DMAC activation requests TEND1, TEND0 94, 93 Output Transfer end 1 and 0: These signals indicate that the DMAC has ended a data transfer 16-bit integrated TCLKD to timer unit (ITU) TCLKA 96 to 93 Input Clock input D to A: External clock inputs TIOCA4 to TIOCA0 4, 2, 99, 97, 95 Input/ output Input capture/output compare A4 to A0: GRA4 to GRA0 output compare or input capture, or PWM output TIOCB4 to TIOCB0 5, 3, 100, 98, 96 Input/ output Input capture/output compare B4 to B0: GRB4 to GRB0 output compare or input capture TOCXA4 6 Output Output compare XA4: PWM output TOCXB4 7 Output Output compare XB4: PWM output DMA controller (DMAC) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 17 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Type Pin No. I/O Name and Function Programmable TP15 to TP0 timing pattern controller (TPC) 9 to 2, 100 to 93 Output TPC output 15 to 0: Pulse output Serial communication interface (SCI) 13, 12 Output Transmit data (channels 0 and 1): SCI data output RxD1, RxD0 15, 14 Input Receive data (channels 0 and 1): SCI data input SCK1, SCK0 17, 16 Input/ output Serial clock (channels 0 and 1): SCI clock input/output AN7 to AN0 85 to 78 Input Analog 7 to 0: Analog input pins ADTRG 9 Input A/D trigger: External trigger input for starting A/D conversion D/A converter DA1, DA0 85, 84 Output Analog output: Analog output from the D/A converter A/D and D/A converters AVCC 76 Input Power supply pin for the A/D and D/A converters. Connect to the system power supply (VCC) when not using the A/D and D/A converters. AVSS 86 Input Ground pin for the A/D and D/A converters. Connect to system ground (VSS). VREF 77 Input Reference voltage input pin for the A/D and D/A converters. Connect to the system power supply (VCC) when not using the A/D and D/A converters. P17 to P10 43 to 36 Input/ output Port 1: Eight input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 1 data direction register (P1DDR). P27 to P20 52 to 45 Input/ output Port 2: Eight input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 2 data direction register (P2DDR). P37 to P30 34 to 27 Input/ output Port 3: Eight input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 3 data direction register (P3DDR). P47 to P40 26 to 23, 21 to 18 Input/ output Port 4: Eight input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 4 data direction register (P4DDR). P53 to P50 56 to 53 Input/ output Port 5: Four input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 5 data direction register (P5DDR). A/D converter I/O ports Symbol TxD1, TxD0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 18 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Type Symbol Pin No. I/O Name and Function I/O ports P66 to P60 72 to 69, 60 to 58 Input/ output Port 6: Seven input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 6 data direction register (P6DDR). P77 to P70 85 to 78 Input Port 7: Eight input pins P84 to P80 91 to 87 Input/ output Port 8: Five input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 8 data direction register (P8DDR). P95 to P90 17 to 12 Input/ output Port 9: Six input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port 9 data direction register (P9DDR). PA7 to PA0 100 to 93 Input/ output Port A: Eight input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port A data direction register (PADDR). PB7 to PB0 9 to 2 Input/ output Port B: Eight input/output pins. The direction of each pin can be selected in the port B data direction register (PBDDR). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 19 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview 1.4 Differences between H8/3048F and H8/3048F-ONE Table 1.5 shows the differences between the H8/3048F (dual power supply model) and H8/3048FONE (single power supply model). Table 1.5 Differences between H8/3048F and H8/3048F-ONE Item Pin specifications Models with Dual Power Supply: H8/3048F Models with Single Power Supply: H8/3048F-ONE* Pin 1: VCC Pin 1: VCL (when a model which operates at 5 V is used) Connected to VSS with 0.1 µF externally applied. Pin 1 becomes VCC when a model which operates at 3 V is used. Pin 10: VPP/RESO Pin 10: FWE ROM/RAM 128-kbyte flash memory with dual power supply, RAM: 4 kbytes 128-kbyte flash memory with single power supply, RAM: 4 kbytes Units of onboard writing Writing in 1-byte units Writing in 128-byte units Write/erase voltage 12 V is externally applied from VPP pin Application of 12 V is not required. VCC single power supply VPP pin functions Multiplexes with RESO FWE function only (no RESO function) RESO = 12 V FWE = 1 Boot mode settings Settings for user program mode MD2 MD1 Mode 5 12 V 0 Mode 6 12 V 1 Mode 7 12 V 1 Cancelled by reset MD0 1 0 1 RESO = 12 V Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 MD2 1 1 1 Cancelled by reset MD2 MD1 0 0 0 1 0 1 Set to mode 1 in mode 5 Set to mode 2 in mode 6 Set to mode 3 in mode 7 Cancelled by reset Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 MD0 1 0 1 FWE = 1 MD1 0 1 MD0 1 0 1 1 MD2 MD1 1 0 1 1 1 1 Cancelled by reset Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 MD0 1 0 1 Prewrite processing Necessary before erasing Not necessary Erasing blocks More than one block can be erased at the same time (verifies in block units and erases only the unerased blocks) Erases in one block units. More than one block cannot be erased at the same time (the erasing flow is different) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 20 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Item Models with Dual Power Supply: H8/3048F Models with Single Power Supply: H8/3048F-ONE* Write processing Before writing, sets the block with the address to be written to EBR1/EBR2 No setting FLMCR FLMCR (H'FF40) FLMCR1 (H'FF40) VPP VPPE — — EV PV E P FWE SWE ESU PSU EV PV E P — — — — FLMCR2 (H'FF41) FLER EBR LB6 LB5 — — EBR (H'FF42) EBR1 (H'FF42) LB7 — LB4 LB3 LB2 LB1 LB0 EBR2 (H'FF43) SB7 SB6 SB5 SB4 SB3 SB2 SB1 SB0 EB7 EB6 EB5 EB4 EB3 EB2 EB1 EB0 Only one block can be selected(setting for erasing) More than one block can be selected (setting for writing/erasing) RAMCR RAMCR (H'FF48) FLER Division of flash memory block — — RAMCR (H'FF47) — RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 Division in 16 blocks 16 kbytes × 7: LB0 to LB6 12 kbytes × 1: LB7 512 kbytes × 8: SB0 to SB7 — — — RAMS RAM2 RAM1 — Division in 8 blocks 1 kbyte × 4: EB0 to EB3 28 kbytes × 1: EB4 32 kbytes × 3: EB5 to EB7 Flash memory Flash memory LB0 (16 kbytes) LB1 (16 kbytes) LB2 (16 kbytes) LB3 (16 kbytes) LB4 (16 kbytes) LB5 (16 kbytes) LB6 (16 kbytes) LB7 (12 kbytes) SB0 (512 bytes) SB1 (512 bytes) SB2 (512 bytes) SB3 (512 bytes) SB4 (512 bytes) — H'00000 H'00000 EB0 (1 kbyte) EB1 (1 kbyte) EB2 (1 kbyte) EB3 (1 kbyte) EB4 (28 kbytes) EB5 (32 kbytes) EB6 (32 kbytes) EB7 (32 kbytes) H'1FFFF SB5 (512 bytes) SB6 (512 bytes) SB7 (512 bytes) H'1FFFF Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 21 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Item Models with Dual Power Supply: H8/3048F Division of RAM emulation block On-chip RAM Flash memory H'EF10 Models with Single Power Supply: H8/3048F-ONE* On-chip RAM Flash memory H'00000 H'F000 H'F1FF H'EF10 H'00000 H'00400 H'F000 H'00800 H'00C00 H'1EFFF H'1F000 H'F3FF H'01000 H'1F200 H'1F400 H'FF0F H'1F600 H'FF0F H'1F800 H'1FA00 H'1FC00 H'1FE00 H'1FFFF H'1FFFF Reset during operation The RES signal must be kept low during The RES signal must be kept low during at least 6 system clock (6φ) cycles. at least 20 system clock (20φ) cycles. (RES pulse width tRESW = min. 6.0 tcyc) (RES pulse width tRESW = min. 20 tcyc) A/D ADCR ADCR (H'FFE9) ADCR (H'FFE9) Initial value: H'7F Initial value: H'7E Only bit 7 can be read or written. Only bit 7 can be read or written. Other bits are reserved and always read Bit 0 is reserved and must not be set to 1. as 1; writing to these bits is invalid. Other bits are reserved and always read as 1; writing to these bits is invalid. WDT RSTCSR RSTCSR (H'FFAB) RSTCSR (H'FFAB) Initial value: H'3F Initial value: H'3F Only bits 7 and 6 can be read or written. Only bit 7 can be read or written. Other bits are reserved and always read Bit 6 is reserved and must not be set to 1. as 1; writing to these bits is invalid. Other bits are reserved and always read as 1; writing to these bits is invalid. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 22 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Item Models with Dual Power Supply: H8/3048F Clock oscillator Setting of standby timer select settling time bits 2 to 0 (SYSCR STS2– STS2 STS1 STS0 Description STS0) 0 1 0 0 8,192 states 1 1 0 16,384 states 32,768 states 1 65,536 states 0 0 131,072 states 1 1 — 1,024 states Illegal setting Models with Single Power Supply: H8/3048F-ONE* Setting of standby timer select bits 2 to 0 STS2 STS1 STS0 0 0 0 8,192 states 1 1 0 16,384 states 32,768 states 1 65,536 states 0 131,072 states 1 262,144 states 0 1 1,024 states Illegal setting 1 0 1 Description Details on flash Refer to section 19, Flash Memory memory (H8/3048F, Dual Power Supply). Refer to section 18, Flash Memory (H8/3048F-ONE, Single Power Supply) Electrical characteristics (clock rate) Clock rate: 1 to 16 MHz Clock rate: 2 to 25 MHz Refer to section 22, Table 22.1 Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048 Group Products. Refer to section 21, Table 21.1 Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048 Group Products. List of registers Refer to appendix B, Table B.1 Comparison of H8/3048 Group Internal I/O Register Specification On-chip emulator Refer to appendix B, Table B.1 Comparison of H8/3048 Group Internal I/O Register Specification Refer to appendix B.1, Addresses (For H8/3048F, H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 mask-ROM, H8/3047 maskROM, H8/3045 mask-ROM, and H8/3044 mask-ROM Versions) Refer to appendix B.1, Addresses (For H8/3048F-ONE) — On-chip emulator (E10T) Note: * Refer to the “H8/3048F-ONE, H8/3048F-ZTAT™ Hardware Manual” for information about H8/3048F-ONE. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 23 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 1 Overview Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 24 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Section 2 CPU 2.1 Overview The H8/300H CPU is a high-speed central processing unit with an internal 32-bit architecture that is upward-compatible with the H8/300 CPU. The H8/300H CPU has sixteen 16-bit general registers, can address a 16-Mbyte linear address space, and is ideal for realtime control. 2.1.1 Features The H8/300H CPU has the following features. Upward compatibility with H8/300 CPU Can execute H8/300 Series object programs General-register architecture Sixteen 16-bit general registers (also usable as sixteen 8-bit registers or eight 32-bit registers) Sixty-two basic instructions 8/16/32-bit data transfer and arithmetic and logic instructions Multiply and divide instructions Powerful bit-manipulation instructions Eight addressing modes Register direct [Rn] Register indirect [@ERn] Register indirect with displacement [@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:24, ERn)] Register indirect with post-increment or pre-decrement [@ERn+ or @–ERn] Absolute address [@aa:8, @aa:16, or @aa:24] Immediate [#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32] Program-counter relative [@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC)] Memory indirect [@@aa:8] 16-Mbyte linear address space High-speed operation All frequently-used instructions execute in two to four states Maximum clock frequency: Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 25 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 18 MHz (H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 mask ROM, H8/3047 mask ROM, H8/3045 mask ROM, H8/3044 mask ROM) 16 MHz (H8/3048F) 8/16/32-bit register-register add/subtract: 111 ns @ 18 MHz/125 ns @ 16 MHz 8 × 8-bit register-register multiply: 778 ns @ 18 MHz/875 ns @ 16 MHz 16 ÷ 8-bit register-register divide: 778 ns @ 18 MHz/875 ns @ 16 MHz 16 × 16-bit register-register multiply: 1,221 ns @ 18 MHz/1,375 ns @ 16 MHz 32 ÷ 16-bit register-register divide: 1,221 ns @ 18 MHz/1,375 ns @ 16 MHz Two CPU operating modes Normal mode (not available in the H8/3048 Group) Advanced mode Low-power mode Transition to power-down state by SLEEP instruction 2.1.2 Differences from H8/300 CPU In comparison to the H8/300 CPU, the H8/300H has the following enhancements. • More general registers Eight 16-bit registers have been added. • Expanded address space Advanced mode supports a maximum 16-Mbyte address space. Normal mode supports the same 64-kbyte address space as the H8/300 CPU. (Normal mode is not available in the H8/3048 Group.) • Enhanced addressing The addressing modes have been enhanced to make effective use of the 16-Mbyte address space. • Enhanced instructions Data transfer, arithmetic, and logic instructions can operate on 32-bit data. Signed multiply/divide instructions and other instructions have been added. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 26 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.2 CPU Operating Modes The H8/300H CPU has two operating modes: normal and advanced. Normal mode supports a maximum 64-kbyte address space. Advanced mode supports up to 16 Mbytes. See figure 2.1. The H8/3048 Group can be used only in advanced mode. (Information from this point on will apply to advanced mode unless otherwise stated.) Normal mode Maximum 64 kbytes, program and data areas combined Advanced mode Maximum 16 Mbytes, program and data areas combined CPU operating modes Figure 2.1 CPU Operating Modes Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 27 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.3 Address Space The maximum address space of the H8/300H CPU is 16 Mbytes. The H8/3048 Group has various operating modes (MCU modes), some providing a 1-Mbyte address space, the others supporting the full 16 Mbytes. Figure 2.2 shows the address ranges of the H8/3048 Group. For further details see section 3.6, Memory Map in Each Operating Mode. The 1-Mbyte operating modes use 20-bit addressing. The upper 4 bits of effective addresses are ignored. H'00000 H'000000 H'FFFFF H'FFFFFF a. 1-Mbyte modes b. 16-Mbyte modes Figure 2.2 Memory Map Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 28 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.4 Register Configuration 2.4.1 Overview The H8/300H CPU has the internal registers shown in figure 2.3. There are two types of registers: general registers and control registers. Figure 2.3 CPU Internal Registers Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 29 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.4.2 General Registers The H8/300H CPU has eight 32-bit general registers. These general registers are all functionally alike and can be used without distinction between data registers and address registers. When a general register is used as a data register, it can be accessed as a 32-bit, 16-bit, or 8-bit register. When the general registers are used as 32-bit registers or as address registers, they are designated by the letters ER (ER0 to ER7). The ER registers divide into 16-bit general registers designated by the letters E (E0 to E7) and R (R0 to R7). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum sixteen 16-bit registers. The E registers (E0 to E7) are also referred to as extended registers. The R registers divide into 8-bit general registers designated by the letters RH (R0H to R7H) and RL (R0L to R7L). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum sixteen 8-bit registers. Figure 2.4 illustrates the usage of the general registers. The usage of each register can be selected independently. • Address registers • 32-bit registers • 16-bit registers • 8-bit registers E registers (extended registers) E0 to E7 RH registers R0H to R7H ER registers ER0 to ER7 R registers R0 to R7 RL registers R0L to R7L Figure 2.4 Usage of General Registers Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 30 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU General register ER7 has the function of stack pointer (SP) in addition to its general-register function, and is used implicitly in exception handling and subroutine calls. Figure 2.5 shows the stack. Free area SP (ER7) Stack area Figure 2.5 Stack 2.4.3 Control Registers The control registers are the 24-bit program counter (PC) and the 8-bit condition code register (CCR). Program Counter (PC): This 24-bit counter indicates the address of the next instruction the CPU will execute. The length of all CPU instructions is 2 bytes (one word) or a multiple of 2 bytes, so the least significant PC bit is ignored. When an instruction is fetched, the least significant PC bit is regarded as 0. Condition Code Register (CCR): This 8-bit register contains internal CPU status information, including the interrupt mask bit (I) and half-carry (H), negative (N), zero (Z), overflow (V), and carry (C) flags. • Bit 7—Interrupt Mask Bit (I): Masks interrupts other than NMI when set to 1. NMI is accepted regardless of the I bit setting. The I bit is set to 1 at the start of an exception-handling sequence. • Bit 6—User Bit or Interrupt Mask Bit (UI): Can be written and read by software using the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. This bit can also be used as an interrupt mask bit. For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller. • Bit 5—Half-Carry Flag (H): When the ADD.B, ADDX.B, SUB.B, SUBX.B, CMP.B, or NEG.B instruction is executed, this flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 3, and cleared to 0 otherwise. When the ADD.W, SUB.W, CMP.W, or NEG.W instruction is executed, the H flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 11, and cleared to 0 otherwise. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 31 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU When the ADD.L, SUB.L, CMP.L, or NEG.L instruction is executed, the H flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 27, and cleared to 0 otherwise. • Bit 4—User Bit (U): Can be written and read by software using the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. • Bit 3—Negative Flag (N): Indicates the most significant bit (sign bit) of data. • Bit 2—Zero Flag (Z): Set to 1 to indicate zero data, and cleared to 0 to indicate non-zero data. • Bit 1—Overflow Flag (V): Set to 1 when an arithmetic overflow occurs, and cleared to 0 at other times. • Bit 0—Carry Flag (C): Set to 1 when a carry occurs, and cleared to 0 otherwise. Used by: Add instructions, to indicate a carry Subtract instructions, to indicate a borrow Shift and rotate instructions, to store the value shifted out of the end bit The carry flag is also used as a bit accumulator by bit manipulation instructions. Some instructions leave flag bits unchanged. Operations can be performed on CCR by the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. The N, Z, V, and C flags are used by conditional branch (Bcc) instructions. For the action of each instruction on the flag bits, see appendix A.1, Instruction List. For the I and UI bits, see section 5, Interrupt Controller. 2.4.4 Initial CPU Register Values In reset exception handling, PC is initialized to a value loaded from the vector table, and the I bit in CCR is set to 1. The other CCR bits and the general registers are not initialized. In particular, the stack pointer (ER7) is not initialized. The stack pointer must therefore be initialized by an MOV.L instruction executed immediately after a reset. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 32 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.5 Data Formats The H8/300H CPU can process 1-bit, 4-bit (BCD), 8-bit (byte), 16-bit (word), and 32-bit (longword) data. Bit-manipulation instructions operate on 1-bit data by accessing bit n (n = 0, 1, 2, …, 7) of byte operand data. The DAA and DAS decimal-adjust instructions treat byte data as two digits of 4-bit BCD data. 2.5.1 General Register Data Formats Figures 2.6 and 2.7 show the data formats in general registers. Data Type General Register 1-bit data RnH Data Format 7 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Don’t care 7 1-bit data 7 4-bit BCD data RnH 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Don’t care RnL 4 3 0 Don’t care Upper digit Lower digit 7 4-bit BCD data Byte data Byte data Don’t care RnL 4 3 0 Upper digit Lower digit 7 0 MSB LSB Don’t care RnH RnL 0 7 0 MSB LSB Don’t care Figure 2.6 General Register Data Formats (1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 33 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Data Type General Register Word data Rn Word data Data Format 15 0 MSB LSB 15 0 MSB LSB En 31 16 15 0 Longword data ERn MSB Legend ERn: General register En: General register E Rn: General register R RnH: General register RH RnL: General register RL MSB: Most significant bit LSB: Least significant bit Figure 2.7 General Register Data Formats (2) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 34 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 LSB Section 2 CPU 2.5.2 Memory Data Formats Figure 2.8 shows the data formats on memory. The H8/300H CPU can access word data and longword data on memory, but word or longword data must begin at an even address. If an attempt is made to access word or longword data at an odd address, no address error occurs but the least significant bit of the address is regarded as 0, so the access starts at the preceding address. This also applies to instruction fetches. Data Type Address Data Format 7 1-bit data Address L 7 Byte data Address L MSB Word data Address 2M MSB 0 6 5 4 Address 2N 2 1 0 LSB Address 2M + 1 Longword data 3 LSB MSB Address 2N + 1 Address 2N + 2 Address 2N + 3 LSB Figure 2.8 Memory Data Formats When ER7 (SP) is used as an address register to access the stack, the operand size should be word size or longword size. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 35 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.6 Instruction Set 2.6.1 Instruction Set Overview The H8/300H CPU has 62 types of instructions, which are classified in table 2.1. Table 2.1 Instruction Classification Function Instruction Types Data transfer 1 1 2 2 MOV, PUSH* , POP* , MOVTPE* , MOVFPE* 3 Arithmetic operatiozns ADD, SUB, ADDX, SUBX, INC, DEC, ADDS, SUBS, DAA, DAS, MULXU, MULXS, DIVXU, DIVXS, CMP, NEG, EXTS, EXTU 18 Logic operations AND, OR, XOR, NOT 4 Shift operations SHAL, SHAR, SHLL, SHLR, ROTL, ROTR, ROTXL, ROTXR 8 Bit manipulation BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BTST, BAND, BIAND, BOR, BIOR, BXOR, BIXOR, BLD, BILD, BST, BIST 14 Branch Bcc* , JMP, BSR, JSR, RTS 3 5 System control TRAPA, RTE, SLEEP, LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, XORC, NOP 9 Block data transfer EEPMOV 1 Total 62 types Notes: 1. POP.W Rn is identical to MOV.W @SP+, Rn. PUSH.W Rn is identical to MOV.W Rn, @–SP. POP.L ERn is identical to MOV.L @SP+, Rn. PUSH.L ERn is identical to MOV.L Rn, @–SP. 2. Not available in the H8/3048 Group. 3. Bcc is a generic branching instruction. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 36 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.6.2 Instructions and Addressing Modes Table 2.2 indicates the instructions available in the H8/300H CPU. Table 2.2 Instructions and Addressing Modes @(d:24,ERn) @ERn+/@–ERn @aa:8 @aa:16 @aa:24 BWL BWL BWL BWL B BWL BWL — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — WL MOVFPE*, MOVTPE* — — — — — — — B — — — — — Arithmetic operations ADD, CMP BWL BWL — — — — — — — — — — — WL BWL — — — — — — — — — — — ADDX, SUBX B B — — — — — — — — — — — ADDS, SUBS — L — — — — — — — — — — — INC, DEC — BWL — — — — — — — — — — — DAA, DAS — B — — — — — — — — — — — MULXU, MULXS, DIVXU, DIVXS — BW — — — — — — — — — — — NEG — BWL — — — — — — — — — — — EXTU, EXTS — WL — — — — — — — — — — Logic operations — BWL BWL — — — — — — — — — — — SUB AND, OR, XOR NOT Shift instructions — BWL — — — — — — — — — — — — BWL — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — Bit manipulation — B B — — — B — — Branch Bcc, BSR — — — — — — — — — JMP, JSR — — — — — — — RTS — — — — — — — — TRAPA — — — — — — — RTE — — — — — — — SLEEP — — — — — — LDC B B W W W STC — B W W W ANDC, ORC, XORC B — — — — System control NOP Block data transfer — @(d:16,ERn) BWL — MOV @@aa:8 @ERn Data transfer Instruction @(d:16,PC) Rn BWL POP, PUSH Function @(d:8,PC) #xx Addressing Modes — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — W — W W — — — W — W W — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — BW Legend B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 37 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Note: * Not availabe in the H8/3048 Group. 2.6.3 Tables of Instructions Classified by Function Tables 2.3 to 2.10 summarize the instructions in each functional category. The operation notation used in these tables is defined next. Operation Notation Rd General register (destination)* Rs General register (source)* Rn General register* ERn General register (32-bit register or address register) (EAd) Destination operand (EAs) Source operand CCR Condition code register N N (negative) flag of CCR Z Z (zero) flag of CCR V V (overflow) flag of CCR C C (carry) flag of CCR PC Program counter SP Stack pointer #IMM Immediate data disp Displacement + Addition – Subtraction × Multiplication ÷ Division ∧ AND logical ∨ OR logical ⊕ Exclusive OR logical → Move ¬ NOT (logical complement) :3/:8/:16/:24 3-, 8-, 16-, or 24-bit length Note: * General registers include 8-bit registers (R0H to R7H, R0L to R7L), 16-bit registers (R0 to R7, E0 to E7), and 32-bit data or address registers (ER0 to ER7). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 38 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.3 Data Transfer Instructions Instruction Size* Function MOV B/W/L (EAs) → Rd, Rs → (EAd) Moves data between two general registers or between a general register and memory, or moves immediate data to a general register. MOVFPE B (EAs) → Rd Cannot be used in the H8/3048 Group. MOVTPE B Rs → (EAs) Cannot be used in the H8/3048 Group. POP W/L @SP+ → Rn Pops a general register from the stack. POP.W Rn is identical to MOV.W @SP+, Rn. Similarly, POP.L ERn is identical to MOV.L @SP+, ERn. PUSH W/L Rn → @–SP Pushes a general register onto the stack. PUSH.W Rn is identical to MOV.W Rn, @–SP. Similarly, PUSH.L ERn is identical to MOV.L ERn, @–SP. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 39 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.4 Arithmetic Operation Instructions Instruction Size* Function ADD, SUB B/W/L Rd ± Rs → Rd, Rd ± #IMM → Rd Performs addition or subtraction on data in two general registers, or on immediate data and data in a general register. (Immediate byte data cannot be subtracted from data in a general register. Use the SUBX or ADD instruction.) ADDX, SUBX B Rd ± Rs ± C → Rd, Rd ± #IMM ± C → Rd Performs addition or subtraction with carry or borrow on data in two general registers, or on immediate data and data in a general register. INC, DEC B/W/L Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd Increments or decrements a general register by 1 or 2. (Byte operands can be incremented or decremented by 1 only.) ADDS, SUBS L Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd, Rd ± 4 → Rd Adds or subtracts the value 1, 2, or 4 to or from data in a 32-bit register. DAA, DAS B Rd decimal adjust → Rd Decimal-adjusts an addition or subtraction result in a general register by referring to CCR to produce 4-bit BCD data. MULXU B/W Rd × Rs → Rd Performs unsigned multiplication on data in two general registers: either 8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits. MULXS B/W Rd × Rs → Rd Performs signed multiplication on data in two general registers: either 8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 40 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Instruction Size* Function DIVXU B/W Rd ÷ Rs → Rd Performs unsigned division on data in two general registers: either 16 bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits → 16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder. DIVXS B/W Rd ÷ Rs → Rd Performs signed division on data in two general registers: either 16 bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder, or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits → 16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder. CMP B/W/L Rd – Rs, Rd – #IMM Compares data in a general register with data in another general register or with immediate data, and sets CCR according to the result. NEG B/W/L 0 – Rd → Rd Takes the two’s complement (arithmetic complement) of data in a general register. EXTS W/L Rd (sign extension) → Rd Extends byte data in the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word data, or extends word data in the lower 16 bits of a 32-bit register to longword data, by extending the sign bit. EXTU W/L Rd (zero extension) → Rd Extends byte data in the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word data, or extends word data in the lower 16 bits of a 32-bit register to longword data, by padding with zeros. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 41 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.5 Logic Operation Instructions Instruction Size* Function AND B/W/L Rd ∧ Rs → Rd, Rd ∧ #IMM → Rd Performs a logical AND operation on a general register and another general register or immediate data. OR B/W/L Rd ∨ Rs → Rd, Rd ∨ #IMM → Rd Performs a logical OR operation on a general register and another general register or immediate data. XOR B/W/L Rd ⊕ Rs → Rd, Rd ⊕ #IMM → Rd Performs a logical exclusive OR operation on a general register and another general register or immediate data. NOT B/W/L ¬ Rd → Rd Takes the one’s complement of general register contents. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Table 2.6 Shift Instructions Instruction Size* Function SHAL, SHAR B/W/L Rd (shift) → Rd SHLL, SHLR B/W/L ROTL, ROTR B/W/L ROTXL, ROTXR B/W/L Performs an arithmetic shift on general register contents. Rd (shift) → Rd Performs a logical shift on general register contents. Rd (rotate) → Rd Rotates general register contents. Rd (rotate) → Rd Rotates general register contents through the carry bit. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word L: Longword Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 42 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.7 Bit Manipulation Instructions Instruction Size* Function BSET B 1 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Sets a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 1. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general register. BCLR B 0 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Clears a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 0. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general register. BNOT B ¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Inverts a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general register. BTST B ¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → Z Tests a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and sets or clears the Z flag accordingly. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general register. BAND B C ∧ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C ANDs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. BIAND B C ∧ [¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C ANDs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 43 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Instruction Size* Function BOR B C ∨ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. BIOR B C ∨ [¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. BXOR B C ⊕ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C Exclusive-ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. BIXOR B C ⊕ [¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C Exclusive-ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. BLD B (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C Transfers a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to the carry flag. BILD B ¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C Transfers the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. BST B C → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Transfers the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. BIST B C → ¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) Transfers the inverse of the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 44 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.8 Branching Instructions Instruction Size Function Bcc — Branches to a specified address if a specified condition is true. The branching conditions are listed below. Mnemonic Description Condition BRA (BT) Always (true) Always BRN (BF) Never (false) Never BHI High C∨Z=0 BLS Low or same C∨Z=1 Bcc (BHS) Carry clear (high or same) C=0 BCS (BLO) Carry set (low) C=1 BNE Not equal Z=0 BEQ Equal Z=1 BVC Overflow clear V=0 BVS Overflow set V=1 BPL Plus N=0 BMI Minus N=1 BGE Greater or equal N⊕V=0 BLT Less than N⊕V=1 BGT Greater than Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 0 BLE Less or equal Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 1 JMP — Branches unconditionally to a specified address BSR — Branches to a subroutine at a specified address JSR — Branches to a subroutine at a specified address RTS — Returns from a subroutine Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 45 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.9 System Control Instructions Instruction Size* Function TRAPA — Starts trap-instruction exception handling RTE — Returns from an exception-handling routine SLEEP — Causes a transition to the power-down state LDC B/W (EAs) → CCR Moves the source operand contents to the condition code register. The condition code register size is one byte, but in transfer from memory, data is read by word access. STC B/W CCR → (EAd) Transfers the CCR contents to a destination location. The condition code register size is one byte, but in transfer to memory, data is written by word access. ANDC B ORC B CCR ∧ #IMM → CCR Logically ANDs the condition code register with immediate data. CCR ∨ #IMM → CCR Logically ORs the condition code register with immediate data. XORC B CCR ⊕ #IMM → CCR Logically exclusive-ORs the condition code register with immediate data. NOP — PC + 2 → PC Only increments the program counter. Note: * Size refers to the operand size. B: Byte W: Word Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 46 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.10 Block Transfer Instruction Instruction Size Function EEPMOV.B — if R4L ≠ 0 then repeat until @ER5+ → @ER6+, R4L – 1 → R4L R4L = 0 else next; EEPMOV.W — if R4 ≠ 0 then repeat until @ER5+ → @ER6+, R4 – 1 → R4 R4 = 0 else next; Transfers a data block according to parameters set in general registers R4L or R4, ER5, and ER6. R4L or R4: Size of block (bytes) ER5: Starting source address ER6: Starting destination address Execution of the next instruction begins as soon as the transfer is completed. 2.6.4 Basic Instruction Formats The H8/300H instructions consist of 2-byte (1-word) units. An instruction consists of an operation field (OP field), a register field (r field), an effective address extension (EA field), and a condition field (cc). Operation Field: Indicates the function of the instruction, the addressing mode, and the operation to be carried out on the operand. The operation field always includes the first 4 bits of the instruction. Some instructions have two operation fields. Register Field: Specifies a general register. Address registers are specified by 3 bits, data registers by 3 bits or 4 bits. Some instructions have two register fields. Some have no register field. Effective Address Extension: Eight, 16, or 32 bits specifying immediate data, an absolute address, or a displacement. A 24-bit address or displacement is treated as 32-bit data in which the first 8 bits are 0 (H'00). Condition Field: Specifies the branching condition of Bcc instructions. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 47 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Figure 2.9 shows examples of instruction formats. Operation field only op NOP, RTS, etc. Operation field and register fields op rn rm ADD.B Rn, Rm, etc. Operation field, register fields, and effective address extension op rn rm MOV.B @(d:16, Rn), Rm EA (disp) Operation field, effective address extension, and condition field op cc EA (disp) BRA d:8 Figure 2.9 Instruction Formats 2.6.5 Notes on Use of Bit Manipulation Instructions The BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BST, and BIST instructions read a byte of data, modify a bit in the byte, then write the byte back. Care is required when these instructions are used to access registers with write-only bits, or to access ports. The BCLR instruction can be used to clear flags in the internal I/O registers. In an interrupthandling routine, for example, if it is known that the flag is set to 1, it is not necessary to read the flag ahead of time. Step Description 1 Read Read data (byte unit) at the specified address 2 Bit manipulation Modify the specified bit in the read data 3 Write Write the modified data (byte unit) to the specified address In the following example, a BCLR instruction is executed on the data direction register (DDR) of port 4. P47 and P46 are set as input pins, and are inputting low-level and high-level signals, respectively. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 48 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU P45 to P40 are set as output pins, and are in the low-level output state. In this example, the BCLR instruction is used to make P40 an input port. Before Execution of BCLR Instruction P47 P46 P45 P44 P43 P42 P41 P40 Input/output Input Input Output Output Output Output Output Output DDR 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 DR 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Execution of BCLR Instruction BCLR ; Execute BCLR instruction on DDR #0, @P4DDR After Execution of BCLR Instruction Input/output P47 P46 P45 P44 P43 P42 P41 P40 Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Input DDR 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 DR 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Explanation of BCLR Instruction To execute the BCLR instruction, the CPU begins by reading P4DDR. Since P4DDR is a writeonly register, it is read as H'FF, even though its true value is H'3F. Next the CPU clears bit 0 of the read data, changing the value to H'FE. Finally, the CPU writes this value (H'FE) back to DDR to complete the BCLR instruction. As a result, P40DDR is cleared to 0, making P40 an input pin. In addition, P47DDR and P46DDR are set to 1, making P47 and P46 output pins. The BCLR instruction can be used to clear flags in the internal I/O registers to 0. In an interrupthandling routine, for example, if it is known that the flag is set to 1, it is not necessary to read the flag ahead of time. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 49 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.7 Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation 2.7.1 Addressing Modes The H8/300H CPU supports the eight addressing modes listed in table 2.11. Each instruction uses a subset of these addressing modes. Arithmetic and logic instructions can use the register direct and immediate modes. Data transfer instructions can use all addressing modes except programcounter relative and memory indirect. Bit manipulation instructions use register direct, register indirect, or absolute (@aa:8) addressing mode to specify an operand, and register direct (BSET, BCLR, BNOT, and BTST instructions) or immediate (3-bit) addressing mode to specify a bit number in the operand. Table 2.11 Addressing Modes No. Addressing Mode Symbol 1 Register direct Rn 2 Register indirect @ERn 3 Register indirect with displacement @(d:16, ERn)/@(d:24, ERn) 4 Register indirect with post-increment @ERn+ Register indirect with pre-decrement @–ERn 5 Absolute address @aa:8/@aa:16/@aa:24 6 Immediate #xx:8/#xx:16/#xx:32 7 Program-counter relative @(d:8, PC)/@(d:16, PC) 8 Memory indirect @@aa:8 1 Register Direct—Rn: The register field of the instruction code specifies an 8-, 16-, or 32-bit register containing the operand. R0H to R7H and R0L to R7L can be specified as 8-bit registers. R0 to R7 and E0 to E7 can be specified as 16-bit registers. ER0 to ER7 can be specified as 32-bit registers. 2 Register Indirect—@ERn: The register field of the instruction code specifies an address register (ERn), the lower 24 bits of which contain the address of the operand. 3 Register Indirect with Displacement—@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:24, ERn): A 16-bit or 24-bit displacement contained in the instruction code is added to the contents of an address register (ERn) specified by the register field of the instruction, and the lower 24 bits of the sum specify the address of a memory operand. A 16-bit displacement is sign-extended when added. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 50 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 4 Register Indirect with Post-Increment or Pre-Decrement—@ERn+ or @–ERn: • Register indirect with post-increment—@ERn+ The register field of the instruction code specifies an address register (ERn) the lower 24 bits of which contain the address of a memory operand. After the operand is accessed, 1, 2, or 4 is added to the address register contents (32 bits) and the sum is stored in the address register. The value added is 1 for byte access, 2 for word access, or 4 for longword access. For word or longword access, the register value should be even. • Register indirect with pre-decrement—@–ERn The value 1, 2, or 4 is subtracted from an address register (ERn) specified by the register field in the instruction code, and the lower 24 bits of the result become the address of a memory operand. The result is also stored in the address register. The value subtracted is 1 for byte access, 2 for word access, or 4 for longword access. For word or longword access, the resulting register value should be even. 5 Absolute Address—@aa:8, @aa:16, or @aa:24: The instruction code contains the absolute address of a memory operand. The absolute address may be 8 bits long (@aa:8), 16 bits long (@aa:16), or 24 bits long (@aa:24). For an 8-bit absolute address, the upper 16 bits are all assumed to be 1 (H'FFFF). For a 16-bit absolute address the upper 8 bits are a sign extension. A 24-bit absolute address can access the entire address space. Table 2.12 indicates the accessible address ranges. Table 2.12 Absolute Address Access Ranges Absolute Address 1-Mbyte Modes 16-Mbyte Modes 8 bits (@aa:8) H'FFF00 to H'FFFFF (1048320 to 1048575) H'FFFF00 to H'FFFFFF (16776960 to 16777215) 16 bits (@aa:16) H'00000 to H'07FFF, H'F8000 to H'FFFFF (0 to 32767, 1015808 to 1048575) H'000000 to H'007FFF, H'FF8000 to H'FFFFFF (0 to 32767, 16744448 to 16777215) 24 bits (@aa:24) H'00000 to H'FFFFF (0 to 1048575) H'000000 to H'FFFFFF (0 to 16777215) 6 Immediate—#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32: The instruction code contains 8-bit (#xx:8), 16-bit (#xx:16), or 32-bit (#xx:32) immediate data as an operand. The instruction codes of the ADDS, SUBS, INC, and DEC instructions contain immediate data implicitly. The instruction codes of some bit manipulation instructions contain 3-bit immediate data specifying a bit number. The TRAPA instruction code contains 2-bit immediate data specifying a vector address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 51 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 7 Program-Counter Relative—@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC): This mode is used in the Bcc and BSR instructions. An 8-bit or 16-bit displacement contained in the instruction code is signextended to 24 bits and added to the 24-bit PC contents to generate a 24-bit branch address. The PC value to which the displacement is added is the address of the first byte of the next instruction, so the possible branching range is –126 to +128 bytes (–63 to +64 words) or –32766 to +32768 bytes (–16383 to +16384 words) from the branch instruction. The resulting value should be an even number. 8 Memory Indirect—@@aa:8: This mode can be used by the JMP and JSR instructions. The instruction code contains an 8-bit absolute address specifying a memory operand. This memory operand contains a branch address. The memory operand is accessed by longword access. The first byte of the memory operand is ignored, generating a 24-bit branch address. See figure 2.10. The upper bits of the 8-bit absolute address are assumed to be 0 (H'0000), so the address range is 0 to 255 (H'000000 to H'0000FF). Note that the first part of this range is also the exception vector area. For further details see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Specified by @aa:8 Reserved Branch address Figure 2.10 Memory-Indirect Branch Address Specification When a word-size or longword-size memory operand is specified, or when a branch address is specified, if the specified memory address is odd, the least significant bit is regarded as 0. The accessed data or instruction code therefore begins at the preceding address. See section 2.5.2, Memory Data Formats. 2.7.2 Effective Address Calculation Table 2.13 explains how an effective address is calculated in each addressing mode. In the 1-Mbyte operating modes the upper 4 bits of the calculated address are ignored in order to generate a 20-bit effective address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 52 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Table 2.13 Effective Address Calculation No. Addressing Mode and Instruction Format 1 Register direct (Rn) op 2 Effective Address Calculation Effective Address Operand is general register contents rm rn Register indirect (@ERn) 31 0 23 0 General register contents op 3 r Register indirect with displacement @(d:16, ERn)/@(d:24, ERn) 31 0 General register contents op r 0 23 0 23 0 disp Sign extension 4. 23 disp Register indirect with post-increment or pre-decrement Register indirect with post-increment @ERn+ 31 0 General register contents op r 1, 2, or 4 Register indirect with pre-decrement @–ERn 31 0 General register contents op r 1, 2, or 4 1 for a byte operand, 2 for a word operand, 4 for a longword operand Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 53 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU No. 5 Addressing Mode and Instruction Format Effective Address Calculation Effective Address Absolute address @aa:8 @aa:8 op 23 87 0 H'FFFF abs @aa:16 op abs 23 16 15 Sign extension 0 23 0 @aa:24 op abs 6 Immediate #xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32 op 7 Operand is immediate data IMM Program-counter relative @(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC) 0 23 PC contents Sign extension op disp Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 54 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 disp 23 0 Section 2 CPU No. Addressing Mode and Instruction Format 8 Memory indirect @@aa:8 • Effective Address Calculation Effective Address Normal mode op abs 23 87 0 abs H'0000 0 15 Memory contents • 23 16 15 0 H'00 Advanced mode op abs 23 87 H'0000 0 abs 0 31 23 0 Memory contents Legend: r, rm, rn: Register field op: Operation field disp: Displacement IMM: Immediate data abs: Absolute address Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 55 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.8 Processing States 2.8.1 Overview The H8/300H CPU has five processing states: the program execution state, exception-handling state, power-down state, reset state, and bus-released state. The power-down state includes sleep mode, software standby mode, and hardware standby mode. Figure 2.11 classifies the processing states. Figure 2.13 indicates the state transitions. Processing states Program execution state The CPU executes program instructions in sequence Exception-handling state A transient state in which the CPU executes a hardware sequence (saving PC and CCR, fetching a vector, etc.) in response to a reset, interrupt, or other exception Bus-released state The external bus has been released in response to a bus request signal from a bus master other than the CPU Reset state The CPU and all on-chip supporting modules are initialized and halted Power-down state Sleep mode The CPU is halted to conserve power Software standby mode Hardware standby mode Figure 2.11 Processing States Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 56 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.8.2 Program Execution State In this state the CPU executes program instructions in normal sequence. 2.8.3 Exception-Handling State The exception-handling state is a transient state that occurs when the CPU alters the normal program flow due to a reset, interrupt, or trap instruction. The CPU fetches a starting address from the exception vector table and branches to that address. In interrupt and trap exception handling the CPU references the stack pointer (ER7) and saves the program counter and condition code register. Types of Exception Handling and Their Priority: Exception handling is performed for resets, interrupts, and trap instructions. Table 2.14 indicates the types of exception handling and their priority. Trap instruction exceptions are accepted at all times in the program execution state. Table 2.14 Exception Handling Types and Priority Priority Type of Exception Detection Timing Start of Exception Handling High Reset Synchronized with clock Exception handling starts immediately when RES changes from low to high Interrupt End of instruction execution or end of exception handling* When an interrupt is requested, exception handling starts at the end of the current instruction or current exception-handling sequence Trap instruction When TRAPA instruction is executed Exception handling starts when a trap (TRAPA) instruction is executed ↑ Low Note: * Interrupts are not detected at the end of the ANDC, ORC, XORC, and LDC instructions, or immediately after reset exception handling. Figure 2.12 classifies the exception sources. For further details about exception sources, vector numbers, and vector addresses, see section 4, Exception Handling, and section 5, Interrupt Controller. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 57 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Reset External interrupts Exception sources Interrupt Internal interrupts (from on-chip supporting modules) Trap instruction Figure 2.12 Classification of Exception Sources End of bus release Bus request Program execution state End of bus release Bus request Exception SLEEP instruction with SSBY = 0 Bus-released state End of exception handling Exception-handling state Sleep mode Interrupt NMI, IRQ 0 , IRQ 1, or IRQ 2 interrupt SLEEP instruction with SSBY = 1 Software standby mode RES = 1 Reset state*1 STBY = 1, RES = 0 *2 Hardware standby mode Power-down state Notes: 1. From any state except hardware standby mode, a transition to the reset state occurs whenever RES goes low. 2. From any state, a transition to hardware standby mode occurs when STBY goes low. Figure 2.13 State Transitions Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 58 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.8.4 Exception-Handling Sequences Reset Exception Handling: Reset exception handling has the highest priority. The reset state is entered when the RES signal goes low. Reset exception handling starts after that, when RES changes from low to high. When reset exception handling starts the CPU fetches a start address from the exception vector table and starts program execution from that address. All interrupts, including NMI, are disabled during the reset exception-handling sequence and immediately after it ends. Interrupt Exception Handling and Trap Instruction Exception Handling: When these exception-handling sequences begin, the CPU references the stack pointer (ER7) and pushes the program counter and condition code register on the stack. Next, if the UE bit in the system control register (SYSCR) is set to 1, the CPU sets the I bit in the condition code register to 1. If the UE bit is cleared to 0, the CPU sets both the I bit and the UI bit in the condition code register to 1. Then the CPU fetches a start address from the exception vector table and execution branches to that address. Figure 2.14 shows the stack after the exception-handling sequence. SP–4 SP (ER7) SP–3 SP+1 SP–2 SP+2 SP–1 SP (ER7) CCR PC SP+3 Stack area Before exception handling starts SP+4 Even address Pushed on stack After exception handling ends Legend CCR: Condition code register SP: Stack pointer Notes: 1. PC is the address of the first instruction executed after the return from the exception-handling routine. 2. Registers must be saved and restored by word access or longword access, starting at an even address. Figure 2.14 Stack Structure after Exception Handling Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 59 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.8.5 Bus-Released State In this state the bus is released to a bus master other than the CPU, in response to a bus request. The bus masters other than the CPU are the DMA controller, the refresh controller, and an external bus master. While the bus is released, the CPU halts except for internal operations. Interrupt requests are not accepted. For details see section 6.3.7, Bus Arbiter Operation. 2.8.6 Reset State When the RES input goes low all current processing stops and the CPU enters the reset state. The I bit in the condition code register is set to 1 by a reset. All interrupts are masked in the reset state. Reset exception handling starts when the RES signal changes from low to high. The reset state can also be entered by a watchdog timer overflow. For details see section 12, Watchdog Timer. 2.8.7 Power-Down State In the power-down state the CPU stops operating to conserve power. There are three modes: sleep mode, software standby mode, and hardware standby mode. Sleep Mode: A transition to sleep mode is made if the SLEEP instruction is executed while the SSBY bit is cleared to 0 in the system control register (SYSCR). CPU operations stop immediately after execution of the SLEEP instruction, but the contents of CPU registers are retained. Software Standby Mode: A transition to software standby mode is made if the SLEEP instruction is executed while the SSBY bit is set to 1 in SYSCR. The CPU and clock halt and all on-chip supporting modules stop operating. The on-chip supporting modules are reset, but as long as a specified voltage is supplied the contents of CPU registers and on-chip RAM are retained. The I/O ports also remain in their existing states. Hardware Standby Mode: A transition to hardware standby mode is made when the STBY input goes low. As in software standby mode, the CPU and all clocks halt and the on-chip supporting modules are reset, but as long as a specified voltage is supplied, on-chip RAM contents are retained. For further information see section 21, Power-Down State. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 60 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU 2.9 Basic Operational Timing 2.9.1 Overview The H8/300H CPU operates according to the system clock (φ). The interval from one rise of the system clock to the next rise is referred to as a “state.” A memory cycle or bus cycle consists of two or three states. The CPU uses different methods to access on-chip memory, the on-chip supporting modules, and the external address space. Access to the external address space can be controlled by the bus controller. 2.9.2 On-Chip Memory Access Timing On-chip memory is accessed in two states. The data bus is 16 bits wide, permitting both byte and word access. Figure 2.15 shows the on-chip memory access cycle. Figure 2.16 indicates the pin states. Bus cycle T1 state T2 state φ Internal address bus Address Internal read signal Internal data bus (read access) Read data Internal write signal Internal data bus (write access) Write data Figure 2.15 On-Chip Memory Access Cycle Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 61 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU T1 T2 φ Address bus , , Address , High High impedance D15 to D0 Figure 2.16 Pin States during On-Chip Memory Access 2.9.3 On-Chip Supporting Module Access Timing The on-chip supporting modules are accessed in three states. The data bus is 8 or 16 bits wide, depending on the register being accessed. Figure 2.17 shows the on-chip supporting module access timing. Figure 2.18 indicates the pin states. Bus cycle T1 state T2 state T3 state φ Address bus Read access Address Internal read signal Internal data bus Read data Internal write signal Write access Internal data bus Write data Figure 2.17 Access Cycle for On-Chip Supporting Modules Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 62 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus , , Address , High High impedance D15 to D0 Figure 2.18 Pin States during Access to On-Chip Supporting Modules 2.9.4 Access to External Address Space The external address space is divided into eight areas (areas 0 to 7). Bus-controller settings determine whether each area is accessed via an 8-bit or 16-bit bus, and whether it is accessed in two or three states. For details see section 6, Bus Controller. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 63 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 2 CPU Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 64 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.1 Overview 3.1.1 Operating Mode Selection The H8/3048 Group has seven operating modes (modes 1 to 7) that are selected by the mode pins (MD2 to MD0) as indicated in table 3.1. The input at these pins determines the size of the address space and the initial bus mode. Table 3.1 Operating Mode Selection Mode Pins Description Address Space Initial Bus Mode*1 On-Chip ROM On-Chip RAM 0 — — — — 0 1 Expanded mode 8 bits Disabled Enabled*2 0 1 0 Expanded mode 16 bits Disabled Enabled*2 Mode 3 0 1 1 Expanded mode 8 bits Disabled Enabled*2 Mode 4 1 0 0 Expanded mode 16 bits Disabled Enabled*2 Mode 5 1 0 1 Expanded mode 8 bits Enabled Enabled*2 Mode 6 1 1 0 Expanded mode 8 bits Enabled Enabled*2 Mode 7 1 1 1 Single-chip advanced mode — Enabled Enabled Operating Mode MD2 MD1 MD0 — 0 0 Mode 1 0 Mode 2 Notes: 1. In modes 1 to 6, an 8-bit or 16-bit data bus can be selected on a per-area basis by settings made in the area bus width control register (ABWCR). For details see section 6, Bus Controller. 2. If the RAME bit in SYSCR is cleared to 0, these addresses become external addresses. For the address space size there are two choices: 1 Mbyte or 16 Mbytes. The external data bus is either 8 or 16 bits wide depending on ABWCR settings. If 8-bit access is selected for all areas, the external data bus is 8 bits wide. For details see section 6, Bus Controller. Modes 1 to 4 are externally expanded modes that enable access to external memory and peripheral devices and disable access to the on-chip ROM. Modes 1 and 2 support a maximum address space of 1 Mbyte. Modes 3 and 4 support a maximum address space of 16 Mbytes. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 65 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Modes 5 and 6 are externally expanded modes that enable access to external memory and peripheral devices and also enable access to the on-chip ROM. Mode 5 supports a maximum address space of 1 Mbyte. Mode 6 supports a maximum address space of 16 Mbytes. Mode 7 is a single-chip mode that operates using the on-chip ROM, RAM, and internal I/O registers, and makes all I/O ports available. Mode 7 supports a 1-Mbyte address space. The H8/3048 Group can be used only in modes 1 to 7. The inputs at the mode pins must select one of these seven modes. The inputs at the mode pins must not be changed during operation. 3.1.2 Register Configuration The H8/3048 Group has a mode control register (MDCR) that indicates the inputs at the mode pins (MD2 to MD0), and a system control register (SYSCR). Table 3.2 summarizes these registers. Table 3.2 Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFF1 Mode control register MDCR R Undetermined H'FFF2 System control register SYSCR R/W H'0B Note: * The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated. 3.2 Mode Control Register (MDCR) MDCR is an 8-bit read-only register that indicates the current operating mode of the H8/3048 Group. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — MDS2 MDS1 MDS0 Initial value 1 1 0 0 0 —* —* —* Read/Write — — — — — R R R Reserved bits Reserved bits Note: * Determined by pins MD 2 to MD0 . Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bits 5 to 3—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 66 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Mode select 2 to 0 Bits indicating the current operating mode Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Bits 2 to 0—Mode Select 2 to 0 (MDS2 to MDS0): These bits indicate the logic levels at pins MD2 to MD0 (the current operating mode). MDS2 to MDS0 correspond to MD2 to MD0. MDS2 to MDS0 are read-only bits. The mode pin (MD2 to MD0) levels are latched into these bits when MDCR is read. 3.3 System Control Register (SYSCR) SYSCR is an 8-bit register that controls the operation of the H8/3048 Group. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSBY STS2 STS1 STS0 UE NMIEG — RAME Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W — R/W RAM enable Enables or disables on-chip RAM Reserved bit NMI edge select Selects the valid edge of the NMI input User bit enable Selects whether to use the UI bit in CCR as a user bit or an interrupt mask bit Standby timer select 2 to 0 These bits select the waiting time at recovery from software standby mode Software standby Enables transition to software standby mode Bit 7—Software Standby (SSBY): Enables transition to software standby mode. (For further information about software standby mode see section 21, Power-Down State.) When software standby mode is exited by an external interrupt, this bit remains set to 1. To clear this bit, write 0. Bit 7: SSBY Description 0 SLEEP instruction causes transition to sleep mode 1 SLEEP instruction causes transition to software standby mode (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 67 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Bits 6 to 4—Standby Timer Select (STS2 to STS0): These bits select the length of time the CPU and on-chip supporting modules wait for the internal clock oscillator to settle when software standby mode is exited by an external interrupt. When using a crystal oscillator, set these bits so that the waiting time will be at least 7 ms at the system clock rate. For further information about waiting time selection, see section 21.4.3, Selection of Waiting Time for Exit from Software Standby Mode. Bit 6: STS2 Bit 5: STS1 Bit 4: STS0 Description 0 0 0 Waiting time = 8,192 states 1 Waiting time = 16,384 states 0 Waiting time = 32,768 states 1 Waiting time = 65,536 states 0 Waiting time = 131,072 states 1 Waiting time = 1,024 states — Illegal setting 1 1 0 1 (Initial value) Bit 3—User Bit Enable (UE): Selects whether to use the UI bit in the condition code register as a user bit or an interrupt mask bit. Bit 3: UE Description 0 UI bit in CCR is used as an interrupt mask bit 1 UI bit in CCR is used as a user bit (Initial value) Bit 2—NMI Edge Select (NMIEG): Selects the valid edge of the NMI input. Bit 2: NMIEG Description 0 An interrupt is requested at the falling edge of NMI 1 An interrupt is requested at the rising edge of NMI (Initial value) Bit 1—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Bit 0—RAM Enable (RAME): Enables or disables the on-chip RAM. The RAME bit is initialized by the rising edge of the RES signal. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bit 0: RAME Description 0 On-chip RAM is disabled 1 On-chip RAM is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 68 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.4 Operating Mode Descriptions 3.4.1 Mode 1 Ports 1, 2, and 5 function as address pins A19 to A0, permitting access to a maximum 1-Mbyte address space. The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. If at least one area is designated for 16-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 16 bits. 3.4.2 Mode 2 Ports 1, 2, and 5 function as address pins A19 to A0, permitting access to a maximum 1-Mbyte address space. The initial bus mode after a reset is 16 bits, with 16-bit access to all areas. If all areas are designated for 8-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 8 bits. 3.4.3 Mode 3 Ports 1, 2, and 5 and part of port A function as address pins A23 to A0, permitting access to a maximum 16-Mbyte address space. The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. If at least one area is designated for 16-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 16 bits. A23 to A21 are valid when 0 is written in bits 7 to 5 of the bus release control register (BRCR). (In this mode A20 is always used for address output.) 3.4.4 Mode 4 Ports 1, 2, and 5 and part of port A function as address pins A23 to A0, permitting access to a maximum 16-Mbyte address space. The initial bus mode after a reset is 16 bits, with 16-bit access to all areas. If all areas are designated for 8-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 8 bits. A23 to A21 are valid when 0 is written in bits 7 to 5 of BRCR. (In this mode A20 is always used for address output.) 3.4.5 Mode 5 Ports 1, 2, and 5 can function as address pins A19 to A0, permitting access to a maximum 1-Mbyte address space, but following a reset they are input ports. To use ports 1, 2, and 5 as an address bus, the corresponding bits in their data direction registers (P1DDR, P2DDR, and P5DDR) must be set to 1. The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. If at least one area is designated for 16-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 16 bits. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 69 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.4.6 Mode 6 Ports 1, 2, and 5 and part of port A function as address pins A23 to A0, permitting access to a maximum 16-Mbyte address space, but following a reset they are input ports. To use ports 1, 2, and 5 as an address bus, the corresponding bits in their data direction registers (P1DDR, P2DDR, and P5DDR) must be set to 1. For A23 to A21 output, clear bits 7 to 5 of BRCR to 0. (In this mode A20 is always used for address output.) The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. If at least one area is designated for 16-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 16 bits. 3.4.7 Mode 7 This mode operates using the on-chip ROM, RAM, and internal I/O registers. All I/O ports are available. Mode 7 supports a 1-Mbyte address space. 3.5 Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode The pin functions of ports 1 to 5 and port A vary depending on the operating mode. Table 3.3 indicates their functions in each operating mode. Table 3.3 Port Port 1 Pin Functions in Each Mode Mode 1 Mode 2 A7 to A0 Mode 3 A7 to A0 A7 to A0 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 A7 to A0 P17 to P10*2 P17 to P10*2 P17 to P10 P27 to P20*2 P27 to P20 D15 to D8 P37 to P30 Port 2 A15 to A8 A15 to A8 A15 to A8 A15 to A8 P27 to P20*2 Port 3 D15 to D8 D15 to D8 D15 to D8 D15 to D8 D15 to D8 Port 4 Port 5 Port A 1 P47 to P40* A19 to A16 PA7 to PA4 1 D7 to D0* A19 to A16 PA7 to PA4 1 P47 to P40* 1 1 D7 to D0* P47 to P40* 2 1 P47 to P40 2 P47 to P40* P53 to P50* P53 to P50* P53 to P50 PA7 to PA5* , PA7 to PA5* , PA7 to PA4 A20 A20 PA7 to PA5, A20*3 PA7 to PA4 A19 to A16 A19 to A16 3 3 Notes: 1. Initial state. The bus mode can be switched by settings in ABWCR. These pins function as P47 to P40 in 8-bit bus mode, and as D7 to D0 in 16-bit bus mode. 2. Initial state. These pins become address output pins when the corresponding bits in the data direction registers (P1DDR, P2DDR, P5DDR) are set to 1. 3. Initial state. A20 is always an address output pin. PA7 to PA5 are switched over to A23 to A21 output by writing 0 in bits 7 to 5 of BRCR. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 70 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes 3.6 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode Figure 3.1 shows a memory map of the H8/3048. Figure 3.2 shows a memory map of the H8/3047. Figure 3.3 shows a memory map of the H8/3044. Figure 3.4 shows a memory map of the H8/3045. The address space is divided into eight areas. The initial bus mode differs between modes 1 and 2, and also between modes 3 and 4. The address locations of the on-chip RAM and internal I/O registers differ between the 1-Mbyte modes (modes 1, 2, 5, and 7) and 16-Mbyte modes (modes 3, 4, and 6). The address range specifiable by the CPU in the 8- and 16-bit absolute addressing modes (@aa:8 and @aa:16) also differs. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 71 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'07FFF H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'000000 Vector area H'0000FF H'007FFF 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Modes 3 and 4 (16-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Modes 1 and 2 (1-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Area 0 Area 0 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 1 Area 1 Area 2 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 Area 2 Area 4 H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 Area 6 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 External address space Area 3 Area 4 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 H'FFF1B H'FFF1C H'FFFFF External address space Internal I/O registers Area 5 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 Area 6 H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 H'FF8000 On-chip RAM * H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF External address space Internal I/O registers 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFEF0F H'FFEF10 16-bit absolute addresses On-chip RAM * H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 8-bit absolute addresses H'FEF0F H'FEF10 16-bit absolute addresses H'F8000 Note: * External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.1 H8/3048 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 72 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'0000FF On-chip ROM H'007FFF H'00000 Vector area H'000FF On-chip ROM H'07FFF 16-bit absolute addresses Vector area Mode 7 (single-chip advanced mode) Memory-indirect branch addresses On-chip ROM H'07FFF H'000000 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Mode 6 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Mode 5 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) H'1FFFF Area 1 Area 2 Area 4 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 H'FFFFF 16-bit absolute addresses Internal I/O registers 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFF1B H'FFF1C External address space Area 3 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 Area 4 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 Area 5 H'FEF10 Area 6 H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'F8000 On-chip RAM H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 H'FFF1C H'FF8000 Internal I/O registers H'FFFFF On-chip RAM * H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C External address space Internal I/O registers H'FFFFFF 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFEF0F H'FFEF10 16-bit absolute addresses Area 6 Area 2 External address space 8-bit absolute addresses H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 H'FEF0F H'FEF10 H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 Area 1 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 H'F8000 On-chip RAM * Area 0 16-bit absolute addresses H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'01FFFF H'020000 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 0 Note: * External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.1 H8/3048 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode (cont) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 73 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'07FFF H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'000000 Vector area H'0000FF H'007FFF 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Modes 3 and 4 (16-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Modes 1 and 2 (1-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Area 0 Area 0 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 1 Area 1 Area 2 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 Area 2 Area 4 H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 Area 6 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 External address space Area 3 Area 4 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 H'FFF1B H'FFF1C H'FFFFF External address space Internal I/O registers Area 5 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 Area 6 H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 H'FF8000 On-chip RAM * H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF External address space Internal I/O registers 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFEF0F H'FFEF10 16-bit absolute addresses On-chip RAM * H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 8-bit absolute addresses H'FEF0F H'FEF10 16-bit absolute addresses H'F8000 Note: * External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.2 H8/3047 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 74 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'007FFF H'017FFF H'018000 H'01FFFF H'020000 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 0 Area 1 H'FFFFF H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 Area 6 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 16-bit absolute addresses Internal I/O registers H'07FFF H'17FFF 16-bit absolute addresses Area 0 Area 1 Area 4 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFF1B H'FFF1C External address space On-chip ROM Reserved*1 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 H'FEF0F H'FEF10 H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 H'000FF Area 2 H'F8000 On-chip RAM*2 On-chip ROM Vector area Area 2 External address space Area 3 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 Area 4 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 Area 5 H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 6 H'F8000 H'FEF10 On-chip RAM H'FFF00 H'FFF0F Area 7 H'FFF1C H'FF8000 Internal I/O registers H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF External address space Internal I/O registers 8-bit absolute addresses On-chip RAM*2 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFFFF H'FFEF0F H'FFEF10 16-bit absolute addresses Reserved *1 H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'0000FF H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses H'07FFF H'17FFF H'18000 Vector area Mode 7 (single-chip advanced mode) 8-bit absolute addresses On-chip ROM H'000000 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Mode 6 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Mode 5 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Notes: 1. Do not access the reserved area. 2. External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.2 H8/3047 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode (cont) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 75 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'07FFF H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'000000 Vector area H'0000FF H'007FFF 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Modes 3 and 4 (16-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Modes 1 and 2 (1-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Area 0 Area 0 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 1 Area 1 Area 2 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 Area 2 Area 4 H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 Area 6 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 External address space Area 3 Area 4 External address space Internal I/O registers Area 6 H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 H'FF8000 H'FFEF10 H'FFF70F H'FFF710 H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF Reserved*1 On-chip RAM*2 External address space Internal I/O registers 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFFFF On-chip RAM Area 5 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFF1B H'FFF1C *2 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 Reserved*1 8-bit absolute addresses H'F8000 H'FEF10 H'FF70F H'FF710 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 Notes: 1. Do not access the reserved area. 2. External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.3 H8/3044 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 76 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'0000FF On-chip ROM H'007FFF H'008000 H'00000 Vector area H'000FF On-chip ROM H'07FFF 16-bit absolute addresses Vector area Mode 7 (single-chip advanced mode) Memory-indirect branch addresses On-chip ROM H'07FFF H'08000 H'000000 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Mode 6 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Mode 5 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Reserved*1 Reserved*1 Area 1 Area 1 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 2 Area 2 Area 3 H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 4 Area 5 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 6 External address space Area 3 Area 4 Area 7 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 External address space Internal I/O registers H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 H'FFF1C H'FF8000 H'FFEF10 H'FFF70F H'FFF710 H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF Internal I/O registers H'FFFFF Reserved*1 On-chip RAM*2 External address space Internal I/O registers 8-bit absolute addresses On-chip RAM On-chip RAM Area 6 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFFFF *2 H'FF710 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFF1B H'FFF1C Reserved 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 Area 5 *1 8-bit absolute addresses H'F8000 H'FEF10 H'FF70F H'FF710 H'F8000 16-bit absolute addresses H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 Area 0 H'01FFFF H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 0 Notes: 1. Do not access the reserved area. 2. External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.3 H8/3044 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode (cont) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 77 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'07FFF H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'000000 Vector area H'0000FF H'007FFF 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Modes 3 and 4 (16-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Modes 1 and 2 (1-Mbyte expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled) Area 0 Area 0 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 1 Area 1 Area 2 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 Area 2 Area 4 H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 Area 6 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 External address space Area 3 Area 4 Internal I/O registers Area 6 H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 H'FF8000 H'FFEF10 H'FFF70F H'FFF710 H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F H'FFFF10 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF Reserved*1 On-chip RAM*2 External address space Internal I/O registers 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFFFF External address space Area 5 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFF1B H'FFF1C On-chip RAM*2 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 Reserved*1 8-bit absolute addresses H'F8000 H'FEF10 H'FF70F H'FF710 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 Notes: 1. Do not access the reserved area. 2. External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.4 H8/3045 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 78 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes H'00FFFF H'010000 H'01FFFF H'020000 *1 Area 1 Area 1 Area 2 H'3FFFFF H'400000 Area 3 Area 2 Area 4 H'5FFFFF H'600000 Area 5 Area 6 H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 7 External address space Area 3 H'F8000 On-chip RAM H'BFFFFF H'C00000 H'FFF00 H'FFF0F Area 6 H'DFFFFF H'E00000 H'FFF1C Area 7 Internal I/O registers H'FFFFF H'FF8000 H'FFEF10 H'FFF70F H'FFF710 H'FFFF1B H'FFFF1C H'FFFFFF Reserved*1 On-chip RAM*2 External address space Internal I/O registers 16-bit absolute addresses Internal I/O registers H'FF710 Area 5 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFFFF External address space 16-bit absolute addresses H'FFF1B H'FFF1C On-chip RAM 8-bit absolute addresses H'FFF00 H'FFF0F H'FFF10 16-bit absolute addresses Area 0 H'1FFFFF H'200000 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 *2 On-chip ROM H'0FFFF Reserved*1 Area 0 Reserved*1 H'000FF H'07FFF Area 4 H'F8000 H'FEF10 H'FF70F H'FF710 Vector area Memory-indirect branch addresses On-chip ROM H'00000 16-bit absolute addresses Reserved H'0000FF H'007FFF H'0FFFF H'10000 H'1FFFF H'20000 H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFF H'60000 External address space H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 H'DFFFF H'E0000 Vector area Mode 7 (single-chip advanced mode) 8-bit absolute addresses On-chip ROM H'07FFF H'000000 16-bit absolute addresses H'000FF Mode 6 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Memory-indirect branch addresses Vector area 16-bit absolute addresses H'00000 Memory-indirect branch addresses Mode 5 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) Notes: 1. Do not access the reserved area. 2. External addresses can be accessed by disabling on-chip RAM. Figure 3.4 H8/3045 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode (cont) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 79 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 3 MCU Operating Modes Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 80 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling Section 4 Exception Handling 4.1 Overview 4.1.1 Exception Handling Types and Priority As table 4.1 indicates, exception handling may be caused by a reset, trap instruction, or interrupt. Exception handling is prioritized as shown in table 4.1. If two or more exceptions occur simultaneously, they are accepted and processed in priority order. Trap instruction exceptions are accepted at all times in the program execution state. Table 4.1 Exception Types and Priority Priority Exception Type Start of Exception Handling High Reset Starts immediately after a low-to-high transition at the RES pin Interrupt Interrupt requests are handled when execution of the current instruction or handling of the current exception is completed Trap instruction (TRAPA) Started by execution of a trap instruction (TRAPA) ↑ Low 4.1.2 Exception Handling Operation Exceptions originate from various sources. Trap instructions and interrupts are handled as follows. 1. The program counter (PC) and condition code register (CCR) are pushed onto the stack. 2. The CCR interrupt mask bit is set to 1. 3. A vector address corresponding to the exception source is generated, and program execution starts from the address indicated in that address. Note: For a reset exception, steps 2 and 3 above are carried out. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 81 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.1.3 Exception Vector Table The exception sources are classified as shown in figure 4.1. Different vectors are assigned to different exception sources. Table 4.2 lists the exception sources and their vector addresses. • Reset External interrupts: NMI, IRQ 0 to IRQ5 Exception sources • Interrupts • Trap instruction Internal interrupts: 30 interrupts from on-chip supporting modules Figure 4.1 Exception Sources Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 82 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling Table 4.2 Exception Vector Table Exception Source Vector Number Vector Address*1 Reset 0 H'0000 to H'0003 Reserved for system use 1 H'0004 to H'0007 2 H'0008 to H'000B 3 H'000C to H'000F 4 H'0010 to H'0013 5 H'0014 to H'0017 6 H'0018 to H'001B External interrupt (NMI) 7 H'001C to H'001F Trap instruction (4 sources) 8 H'0020 to H'0023 9 H'0024 to H'0027 10 H'0028 to H'002B 11 H'002C to H'002F External interrupt IRQ0 12 H'0030 to H'0033 External interrupt IRQ1 13 H'0034 to H'0037 External interrupt IRQ2 14 H'0038 to H'003B External interrupt IRQ3 15 H'003C to H'003F External interrupt IRQ4 16 H'0040 to H'0043 External interrupt IRQ5 17 H'0044 to H'0047 Reserved for system use 18 H'0048 to H'004B 19 H'004C to H'004F 20 to 60 H'0050 to H'0053 to H'00F0 to H'00F3 Internal interrupts*2 Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. For the internal interrupt vectors, see section 5.3.3, Interrupt Vector Table. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 83 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.2 Reset 4.2.1 Overview A reset is the highest-priority exception. When the RES pin goes low, all processing halts and the chip enters the reset state. A reset initializes the internal state of the CPU and the registers of the on-chip supporting modules. Reset exception handling begins when the RES pin changes from low to high. The chip can also be reset by overflow of the watchdog timer. For details see section 12, Watchdog Timer. 4.2.2 Reset Sequence The chip enters the reset state when the RES pin goes low. To ensure that the chip is reset, hold the RES pin low for at least 20 ms at power-up. To reset the chip during operation, hold the RES pin low for at least 10 system clock (φ) cycles. See appendix D.2, Pin States at Reset, for the states of the pins in the reset state. When the RES pin goes high after being held low for the necessary time, the chip starts reset exception handling as follows. • The internal state of the CPU and the registers of the on-chip supporting modules are initialized, and the I bit is set to 1 in CCR. • The contents of the reset vector address (H'0000 to H'0003) are read, and program execution starts from the address indicated in the vector address. Figure 4.2 shows the reset sequence in modes 1 and 3. Figure 4.3 shows the reset sequence in modes 2 and 4. Figure 4.4 shows the reset sequence in modes 5, 6 and 7. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 84 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (2) (4) (3) (6) (5) (8) (7) Internal processing Address of reset vector: (1) = H'00000, (3) = H'00001, (5) = H'00002, (7) = H'00003 Start address (contents of reset vector) Start address First instruction of program High (1) Note: After a reset, the wait-state controller inserts three wait states in every bus cycle. (1), (3), (5), (7) (2), (4), (6), (8) (9) (10) D15 to D8 HWR , LWR RD Address bus RES φ Vector fetch (10) (9) Prefetch of first program instruction Section 4 Exception Handling Figure 4.2 Reset Sequence (Modes 1 and 3) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 85 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling Internal processing Vector fetch Prefetch of first program instruction φ RES Address bus (1) (3) (5) RD HWR , LWR D15 to D0 (1), (3) (2), (4) (5) (6) High (2) (4) (6) Address of reset vector: (1) = H'000000, (3) = H'000002 Start address (contents of reset vector) Start address First instruction of program Note: After a reset, the wait-state controller inserts three wait states in every bus cycle. Figure 4.3 Reset Sequence (Modes 2 and 4) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 86 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling Internal processing Vector fetch Prefetch of first program instruction φ RES Internal address bus (1) (3) (5) Internal read signal Internal write signal Internal data bus (16 bits wide) (1), (3) (2), (4) (5) (6) (2) (4) (6) Address of reset vector ((1) = H'000000, (2) = H'000002) Start address (contents of reset vector) Start address First instruction of program Figure 4.4 Reset Sequence (Modes 5, 6, and 7) 4.2.3 Interrupts after Reset If an interrupt is accepted after a reset but before the stack pointer (SP) is initialized, PC and CCR will not be saved correctly, leading to a program crash. To prevent this, all interrupt requests, including NMI, are disabled immediately after a reset. The first instruction of the program is always executed immediately after the reset state ends. This instruction should initialize the stack pointer (example: MOV.L #xx:32, SP). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 87 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.3 Interrupts Interrupt exception handling can be requested by seven external sources (NMI, IRQ0 to IRQ5) and 30 internal sources in the on-chip supporting modules. Figure 4.5 classifies the interrupt sources and indicates the number of interrupts of each type. The on-chip supporting modules that can request interrupts are the watchdog timer (WDT), refresh controller, 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), DMA controller (DMAC), serial communication interface (SCI), and A/D converter. Each interrupt source has a separate vector address. NMI is the highest-priority interrupt and is always accepted. Interrupts are controlled by the interrupt controller. The interrupt controller can assign interrupts other than NMI to two priority levels, and arbitrate between simultaneous interrupts. Interrupt priorities are assigned in interrupt priority registers A and B (IPRA and IPRB) in the interrupt controller. For details on interrupts see section 5, Interrupt Controller. External interrupts NMI (1) IRQ 0 to IRQ 5 (6) Internal interrupts WDT *1 (1) Refresh controller *2 (1) ITU (15) DMAC (4) SCI (8) A/D converter (1) Interrupts Notes: Numbers in parentheses are the number of interrupt sources. 1. When the watchdog timer is used as an interval timer, it generates an interrupt request at every counter overflow. 2. When the refresh controller is used as an interval timer, it generates an interrupt request at compare match. Figure 4.5 Interrupt Sources and Number of Interrupts Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 88 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.4 Trap Instruction Trap instruction exception handling starts when a TRAPA instruction is executed. If the UE bit is set to 1 in the system control register (SYSCR), the exception handling sequence sets the I bit to 1 in CCR. If the UE bit is 0, the I and UI bits are both set to 1. The TRAPA instruction fetches a start address from a vector table entry corresponding to a vector number from 0 to 3, which is specified in the instruction code. 4.5 Stack Status after Exception Handling Figure 4.6 shows the stack after completion of trap instruction exception handling and interrupt exception handling. SP-4 SP-3 SP-2 SP-1 SP (ER7) → Stack area SP (ER7) → SP+1 SP+2 SP+3 SP+4 CCR PC E PC H PC L Even address Before exception handling After exception handling Pushed on stack Legend PCE: Bits 23 to 16 of program counter (PC) PCH: Bits 15 to 8 of program counter (PC) PCL: Bits 7 to 0 of program counter (PC) CCR: Condition code register SP: Stack pointer Notes: 1. PC indicates the address of the first instruction that will be executed after return. 2. Registers must be saved in word or longword size at even addresses. Figure 4.6 Stack after Completion of Exception Handling Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 89 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 4 Exception Handling 4.6 Notes on Stack Usage When accessing word data or longword data, the H8/3048 Group regards the lowest address bit as 0. The stack should always be accessed by word access or longword access, and the value of the stack pointer (SP:ER7) should always be kept even. Use the following instructions to save registers: PUSH.W Rn (or MOV.W Rn, @–SP) PUSH.L ERn (or MOV.L ERn, @–SP) Use the following instructions to restore registers: POP.W Rn POP.L ERn (or MOV.W @SP+, Rn) (or MOV.L @SP+, ERn) Setting SP to an odd value may lead to a malfunction. Figure 4.7 shows an example of what happens when the SP value is odd. CCR SP R1L H'FFFEFA H'FFFEFB SP PC PC H'FFFEFC H'FFFEFD H'FFFEFF SP TRAPA instruction executed SP set to H'FFFEFF MOV. B R1L, @-ER7 Data saved above SP CCR contents lost Legend CCR: Condition code register PC: Program counter R1L: General register R1L SP: Stack pointer Note: The diagram illustrates modes 3 and 4. Figure 4.7 Operation when SP Value is Odd Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 90 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.1 Overview 5.1.1 Features The interrupt controller has the following features: • Interrupt priority registers (IPRs) for setting interrupt priorities Interrupts other than NMI can be assigned to two priority levels on a module-by-module basis in interrupt priority registers A and B (IPRA and IPRB). • Three-level masking by the I and UI bits in the CPU condition code register (CCR) • Independent vector addresses All interrupts are independently vectored; the interrupt service routine does not have to identify the interrupt source. • Seven external interrupt pins NMI has the highest priority and is always accepted; either the rising or falling edge can be selected. For each of IRQ0 to IRQ5, sensing of the falling edge or level sensing can be selected independently. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 91 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 5.1 shows a block diagram of the interrupt controller. CPU ISCR IER IPRA, IPRB NMI input IRQ input section ISR IRQ input OVF TME . . . . . . . ADI ADIE Priority decision logic Interrupt request Vector number . . . I UI Interrupt controller UE SYSCR Legend ISCR: IER: ISR: IPRA: IPRB: SYSCR: IRQ sense control register IRQ enable register IRQ status register Interrupt priority register A Interrupt priority register B System control register Figure 5.1 Interrupt Controller Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 92 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 CCR Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.1.3 Pin Configuration Table 5.1 lists the interrupt pins. Table 5.1 Interrupt Pins Name Abbreviation I/O Function Nonmaskable interrupt NMI Input Nonmaskable interrupt, rising edge or falling edge selectable External interrupt request 5 to 0 IRQ5 to IRQ0 Input Maskable interrupts, falling edge or level sensing selectable 5.1.4 Register Configuration Table 5.2 lists the registers of the interrupt controller. Table 5.2 Address* Interrupt Controller Registers 1 Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFF2 System control register SYSCR R/W H'0B H'FFF4 IRQ sense control register ISCR R/W H'00 H'FFF5 IRQ enable register IER R/W H'00 H'FFF6 IRQ status register ISR 2 R/(W)* H'00 H'FFF8 Interrupt priority register A IPRA R/W H'00 H'FFF9 Interrupt priority register B IPRB R/W H'00 Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 93 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.2 Register Descriptions 5.2.1 System Control Register (SYSCR) SYSCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls software standby mode, selects the action of the UI bit in CCR, selects the NMI edge, and enables or disables the on-chip RAM. Only bits 3 and 2 are described here. For the other bits, see section 3.3, System Control Register (SYSCR). SYSCR is initialized to H'0B by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSBY STS2 STS1 STS0 UE NMIEG — RAME Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W — R/W RAM enable Reserved bit Standby timer select 2 to 0 Software standby Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 94 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 NMI edge select Selects the NMI input edge User bit enable Selects whether to use the UI bit in CCR as a user bit or interrupt mask bit Section 5 Interrupt Controller Bit 3—User Bit Enable (UE): Selects whether to use the UI bit in CCR as a user bit or an interrupt mask bit. Bit 3: UE Description 0 UI bit in CCR is used as interrupt mask bit 1 UI bit in CCR is used as user bit (Initial value) Bit 2—NMI Edge Select (NMIEG): Selects the NMI input edge. Bit 2: NMIEG Description 0 Interrupt is requested at falling edge of NMI input 1 Interrupt is requested at rising edge of NMI input 5.2.2 (Initial value) Interrupt Priority Registers A and B (IPRA, IPRB) IPRA and IPRB are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control interrupt priority. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 95 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Interrupt Priority Register A (IPRA): IPRA is an 8-bit readable/writable register in which interrupt priority levels can be set. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IPRA7 IPRA6 IPRA5 IPRA4 IPRA3 IPRA2 IPRA1 IPRA0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Priority level A0 Selects the priority level of ITU channel 2 interrupt requests Priority level A1 Selects the priority level of ITU channel 1 interrupt requests Priority level A2 Selects the priority level of ITU channel 0 interrupt requests Priority level A3 Selects the priority level of WDT and refresh controller interrupt requests Priority level A4 Selects the priority level of IRQ4 and IRQ 5 interrupt requests Priority level A5 Selects the priority level of IRQ 2 and IRQ 3 interrupt requests Priority level A6 Selects the priority level of IRQ1 interrupt requests Priority level A7 Selects the priority level of IRQ 0 interrupt requests IPRA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 96 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Bit 7—Priority Level A7 (IPRA7): Selects the priority level of IRQ0 interrupt requests. Bit 7: IPRA7 Description 0 IRQ0 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) 1 IRQ0 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) (Initial value) Bit 6—Priority Level A6 (IPRA6): Selects the priority level of IRQ1 interrupt requests. Bit 6: IPRA6 Description 0 IRQ1 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) 1 IRQ1 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) (Initial value) Bit 5—Priority Level A5 (IPRA5): Selects the priority level of IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests. Bit 5: IPRA5 Description 0 IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 4—Priority Level A4 (IPRA4): Selects the priority level of IRQ4 and IRQ5 interrupt requests. Bit 4: IPRA4 Description 0 IRQ4 and IRQ5 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 IRQ4 and IRQ5 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 3—Priority Level A3 (IPRA3): Selects the priority level of WDT and refresh controller interrupt requests. Bit 3: IPRA3 Description 0 WDT and refresh controller interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 WDT and refresh controller interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 97 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Bit 2—Priority Level A2 (IPRA2): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 0 interrupt requests. Bit 2: IPRA2 Description 0 ITU channel 0 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 ITU channel 0 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 1—Priority Level A1 (IPRA1): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 1 interrupt requests. Bit 1: IPRA1 Description 0 ITU channel 1 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 ITU channel 1 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 0—Priority Level A0 (IPRA0): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 2 interrupt requests. Bit 0: IPRA0 Description 0 ITU channel 2 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 ITU channel 2 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 98 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Interrupt Priority Register B (IPRB): IPRB is an 8-bit readable/writable register in which interrupt priority levels can be set. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IPRB7 IPRB6 IPRB5 — IPRB3 IPRB2 IPRB1 — Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bit Priority level B1 Selects the priority level of A/D converter interrupt request Priority level B2 Selects the priority level of SCI channel 1 interrupt requests Priority level B3 Selects the priority level of SCI channel 0 interrupt requests Reserved bit Priority level B5 Selects the priority level of DMAC interrupt requests (channels 0 and 1) Priority level B6 Selects the priority level of ITU channel 4 interrupt requests Priority level B7 Selects the priority level of ITU channel 3 interrupt requests IPRB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 99 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Bit 7—Priority Level B7 (IPRB7): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 3 interrupt requests. Bit 7: IPRB7 Description 0 ITU channel 3 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 ITU channel 3 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 6—Priority Level B6 (IPRB6): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 4 interrupt requests. Bit 6: IPRB6 Description 0 ITU channel 4 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 ITU channel 4 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 5—Priority Level B5 (IPRB5): Selects the priority level of DMAC interrupt requests (channels 0 and 1). Bit 5: IPRB5 Description 0 DMAC interrupt requests (channels 0 and 1) have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 DMAC interrupt requests (channels 0 and 1) have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 4—Reserved: This bit can be written and read, but it does not affect interrupt priority. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 100 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Bit 3—Priority Level B3 (IPRB3): Selects the priority level of SCI channel 0 interrupt requests. Bit 3: IPRB3 Description 0 SCI0 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) 1 SCI0 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) (Initial value) Bit 2—Priority Level B2 (IPRB2): Selects the priority level of SCI channel 1 interrupt requests. Bit 2: IPRB2 Description 0 SCI1 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) 1 SCI1 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) (Initial value) Bit 1—Priority Level B1 (IPRB1): Selects the priority level of A/D converter interrupt requests. Bit 1: IPRB1 Description 0 A/D converter interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority) (Initial value) 1 A/D converter interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority) Bit 0—Reserved: This bit can be written and read, but it does not affect interrupt priority. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 101 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.2.3 IRQ Status Register (ISR) ISR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that indicates the status of IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupt requests. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — IRQ5F IRQ4F IRQ3F IRQ2F IRQ1F IRQ0F Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Reserved bits IRQ 5 to IRQ0 flags These bits indicate IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupt request status Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear flags. ISR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 0. Bits 5 to 0—IRQ5 to IRQ0 Flags (IRQ5F to IRQ0F): These bits indicate the status of IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupt requests. Bits 5 to 0: IRQ5F to IRQ0F Description 0 [Clearing conditions] (Initial value) 0 is written in IRQnF after reading the IRQnF flag when IRQnF = 1. IRQnSC = 0, IRQn input is high, and interrupt exception handling is carried out. IRQnSC = 1 and IRQn interrupt exception handling is carried out. 1 [Setting conditions] IRQnSC = 0 and IRQn input is low. IRQnSC = 1 and IRQn input changes from high to low. Note: n = 5 to 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 102 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.2.4 IRQ Enable Register (IER) IER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupt requests. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — IRQ5E IRQ4E IRQ3E IRQ2E IRQ1E IRQ0E Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits IRQ 5 to IRQ0 enable These bits enable or disable IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupts IER is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits can be written and read, but they do not enable or disable interrupts. Bits 5 to 0—IRQ5 to IRQ0 Enable (IRQ5E to IRQ0E): These bits enable or disable IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupts. Bits 5 to 0: IRQ5E to IRQ0E Description 0 IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupts are disabled 1 IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupts are enabled (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 103 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.2.5 IRQ Sense Control Register (ISCR) ISCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects level sensing or falling-edge sensing of the inputs at pins IRQ5 to IRQ0. Bit 7 6 — — 5 4 3 2 1 0 IRQ5SC IRQ4SC IRQ3SC IRQ2SC IRQ1SC IRQ0SC Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits IRQ 5 to IRQ0 sense control These bits select level sensing or falling-edge sensing for IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupts ISCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits can be written and read, but they do not select level or falling-edge sensing. Bits 5 to 0—IRQ5 to IRQ0 Sense Control (IRQ5SC to IRQ0SC): These bits select whether interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 are requested by level sensing of pins IRQ5 to IRQ0, or by falling-edge sensing. Bits 5 to 0: IRQ5SC to IRQ0SC Description 0 Interrupts are requested when IRQ5 to IRQ0 inputs are low 1 Interrupts are requested by falling-edge input at IRQ5 to IRQ0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 104 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.3 Interrupt Sources The interrupt sources include external interrupts (NMI, IRQ0 to IRQ5) and 30 internal interrupts. 5.3.1 External Interrupts There are seven external interrupts: NMI, and IRQ0 to IRQ5. Of these, NMI, IRQ0, IRQ1, and IRQ2 can be used to exit software standby mode. NMI: NMI is the highest-priority interrupt and is always accepted, regardless of the states of the I and UI bits in CCR. The NMIEG bit in SYSCR selects whether an interrupt is requested by the rising or falling edge of the input at the NMI pin. NMI interrupt exception handling has vector number 7. IRQ0 to IRQ5 Interrupts: These interrupts are requested by input signals at pins IRQ0 to IRQ5. The IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupts have the following features. • ISCR settings can select whether an interrupt is requested by the low level of the input at pins IRQ0 to IRQ5, or by the falling edge. • IER settings can enable or disable the IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupts. Interrupt priority levels can be assigned by four bits in IPRA (IPRA7 to IPRA4). • The status of IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupt requests is indicated in ISR. The ISR flags can be cleared to 0 by software. Figure 5.2 shows a block diagram of interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5. IRQnSC IRQnE IRQnF Edge/level sense circuit IRQn input S Q IRQn interrupt request R Clear signal Note: n = 5 to 0 Figure 5.2 Block Diagram of Interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 105 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Figure 5.3 shows the timing of the setting of the interrupt flags (IRQnF). φ IRQn input pin IRQnF Note: n = 5 to 0 Figure 5.3 Timing of Setting of IRQnF Interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5 have vector numbers 12 to 17. These interrupts are detected regardless of whether the corresponding pin is set for input or output. When using a pin for external interrupt input, clear its DDR bit to 0 and do not use the pin for chip select output, refresh output, or SCI input or output. 5.3.2 Internal Interrupts Thirty internal interrupts are requested from the on-chip supporting modules. • Each on-chip supporting module has status flags for indicating interrupt status, and enable bits for enabling or disabling interrupts. • Interrupt priority levels can be assigned in IPRA and IPRB. • ITU and SCI interrupt requests can activate the DMAC, in which case no interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller, and the I and UI bits are disregarded. 5.3.3 Interrupt Vector Table Table 5.3 lists the interrupt sources, their vector addresses, and their default priority order. In the default priority order, smaller vector numbers have higher priority. The priority of interrupts other than NMI can be changed in IPRA and IPRB. The priority order after a reset is the default order shown in table 5.3. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 106 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Table 5.3 Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Priority Interrupt Source Origin Vector Number Vector Address* IPR Priority NMI External pins 7 H'001C to H'001F — High IRQ0 12 H'0030 to H'0033 IPRA7 IRQ1 13 H'0034 to H0037 IPRA6 IRQ2 14 H'0038 to H'003B IPRA5 IRQ3 15 H'003C to H'003F IRQ4 16 H'0040 to H'0043 IRQ5 17 H'0044 to H'0047 18 H'0048 to H'004B 19 H'004C to H'004F Reserved — WOVI (interval timer) Watchdog timer 20 H'0050 to H'0053 CMI (compare match) Refresh controller 21 H'0054 to H'0057 Reserved — 22 H'0058 to H'005B 23 H'005C to H'005F 24 H'0060 to H'0063 25 H'0064 to H'0067 IMIA0 (compare match/ input capture A0) ITU channel 0 IMIB0 (compare match/ input capture B0) OVI0 (overflow 0) 26 H'0068 to H'006B Reserved — 27 H'006C to H'006F IMIA1 (compare match/ input capture A1) ITU channel 1 28 H'0070 to H'0073 IMIB1 (compare match/ input capture B1) 29 H'0074 to H'0077 OVI1 (overflow 1) 30 H'0078 to H'007B 31 H'007C to H'007F Reserved — IPRA4 IPRA3 IPRA2 IPRA1 ↑ Low Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 107 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Interrupt Source Origin Vector Number Vector Address* IPR Priority IMIA2 (compare match/ input capture A2) ITU channel 2 32 H'0080 to H'0083 IPRA0 High IMIB2 (compare match/ input capture B2) 33 H'0084 to H'0087 OVI2 (overflow 2) 34 H'0088 to H'008B Reserved — 35 H'008C to H'008F IMIA3 (compare match/ input capture A3) ITU channel 3 36 H'0090 to H'0093 37 H'0094 to H'0097 IMIB3 (compare match/ input capture B3) OVI3 (overflow 3) 38 H'0098 to H'009B Reserved — 39 H'009C to H'009F IMIA4 (compare match/ input capture A4) ITU channel 4 40 H'00A0 to H'00A3 IMIB4 (compare match/ input capture B4) 41 H'00A4 to H'00A7 OVI4 (overflow 4) 42 H'00A8 to H'00AB Reserved — 43 H'00AC to H'00AF DEND0A DMAC 44 H'00B0 to H'00B3 DEND0B 45 H'00B4 to H'00B7 DEND1A 46 H'00B8 to H'00BB DEND1B 47 H'00BC to H'00BF 48 H'00C0 to H'00C3 49 H'00C4 to H'00C7 50 H'00C8 to H'00CB 51 H'00CC to H'00CF Reserved — IPRB7 IPRB6 IPRB5 — ↑ Low Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 108 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Interrupt Source Origin Vector Number Vector Address* IPR Priority ERI0 (receive error 0) SCI channel 0 52 H'00D0 to H'00D3 IPRB3 High RXI0 (receive data full 0) 53 H'00D4 to H'00D7 TXI0 (transmit data empty 0) 54 H'00D8 to H'00DB TEI0 (transmit end 0) 55 H'00DC to H'00DF 56 H'00E0 to H'00E3 IPRB2 RXI1 (receive data full 1) 57 H'00E4 to H'00E7 TXI1 (transmit data empty 1) 58 H'00E8 to H'00EB TEI1 (transmit end 1) 59 H'00EC to H'00EF 60 H'00F0 to H'00F3 ↑ ERI1 (receive error 1) ADI (A/D end) SCI channel 1 A/D IPRB1 Low Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 109 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.4 Interrupt Operation 5.4.1 Interrupt Handling Process The H8/3048 Group handles interrupts differently depending on the setting of the UE bit. When UE = 1, interrupts are controlled by the I bit. When UE = 0, interrupts are controlled by the I and UI bits. Table 5.4 indicates how interrupts are handled for all setting combinations of the UE, I, and UI bits. NMI interrupts are always accepted except in the reset and hardware standby states. IRQ interrupts and interrupts from the on-chip supporting modules have their own enable bits. Interrupt requests are ignored when the enable bits are cleared to 0. Table 5.4 UE, I, and UI Bit Settings and Interrupt Handling SYSCR CCR UE I UI Description 1 0 — All interrupts are accepted. Interrupts with priority level 1 have higher priority. 1 — No interrupts are accepted except NMI. 0 — All interrupts are accepted. Interrupts with priority level 1 have higher priority. 1 0 NMI and interrupts with priority level 1 are accepted. 1 No interrupts are accepted except NMI. 0 UE = 1: Interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5 and interrupts from the on-chip supporting modules can all be masked by the I bit in the CPU’s CCR. Interrupts are masked when the I bit is set to 1, and unmasked when the I bit is cleared to 0. Interrupts with priority level 1 have higher priority. Figure 5.4 is a flowchart showing how interrupts are accepted when UE = 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 110 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Program execution state No Interrupt requested? Yes Yes NMI No No Pending Priority level 1? Yes IRQ 0 No Yes IRQ 1 IRQ 0 No Yes No IRQ 1 Yes No Yes ADI ADI Yes Yes No I=0 Yes Save PC and CCR I ←1 Read vector address Branch to interrupt service routine Figure 5.4 Process Up to Interrupt Acceptance when UE = 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 111 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller • If an interrupt condition occurs and the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller. • When the interrupt controller receives one or more interrupt requests, it selects the highestpriority request, following the IPR interrupt priority settings, and holds other requests pending. If two or more interrupts with the same IPR setting are requested simultaneously, the interrupt controller follows the priority order shown in table 5.3. • The interrupt controller checks the I bit. If the I bit is cleared to 0, the selected interrupt request is accepted. If the I bit is set to 1, only NMI is accepted; other interrupt requests are held pending. • When an interrupt request is accepted, interrupt exception handling starts after execution of the current instruction has been completed. • In interrupt exception handling, PC and CCR are saved to the stack area. The PC value that is saved indicates the address of the first instruction that will be executed after the return from the interrupt service routine. • Next the I bit is set to 1 in CCR, masking all interrupts except NMI. • The vector address of the accepted interrupt is generated, and the interrupt service routine starts executing from the address indicated by the contents of the vector address. UE = 0: The I and UI bits in the CPU’s CCR and the IPR bits enable three-level masking of IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupts and interrupts from the on-chip supporting modules. • Interrupt requests with priority level 0 are masked when the I bit is set to 1, and are unmasked when the I bit is cleared to 0. • Interrupt requests with priority level 1 are masked when the I and UI bits are both set to 1, and are unmasked when either the I bit or the UI bit is cleared to 0. For example, if the interrupt enable bits of all interrupt requests are set to 1, IPRA is set to H'20, and IPRB is set to H'00 (giving IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests priority over other interrupts), interrupts are masked as follows: a. If I = 0, all interrupts are unmasked (priority order: NMI > IRQ2 > IRQ3 >IRQ0 …). b. If I = 1 and UI = 0, only NMI, IRQ2, and IRQ3 are unmasked. c. If I = 1 and UI = 1, all interrupts are masked except NMI. Figure 5.5 shows the transitions among the above states. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 112 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller I←0 a. All interrupts are unmasked I←0 b. Only NMI, IRQ 2 , and IRQ 3 are unmasked I ← 1, UI ← 0 Exception handling, or I ← 1, UI ← 1 UI ← 0 Exception handling, or UI ← 1 c. All interrupts are masked except NMI Figure 5.5 Interrupt Masking State Transitions (Example) Figure 5.6 is a flowchart showing how interrupts are accepted when UE = 0. • If an interrupt condition occurs and the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller. • When the interrupt controller receives one or more interrupt requests, it selects the highestpriority request, following the IPR interrupt priority settings, and holds other requests pending. If two or more interrupts with the same IPR setting are requested simultaneously, the interrupt controller follows the priority order shown in table 5.3. • The interrupt controller checks the I bit. If the I bit is cleared to 0, the selected interrupt request is accepted regardless of its IPR setting, and regardless of the UI bit. If the I bit is set to 1 and the UI bit is cleared to 0, only NMI and interrupts with priority level 1 are accepted; interrupt requests with priority level 0 are held pending. If the I bit and UI bit are both set to 1, only NMI is accepted; all other interrupt requests are held pending. • When an interrupt request is accepted, interrupt exception handling starts after execution of the current instruction has been completed. • In interrupt exception handling, PC and CCR are saved to the stack area. The PC value that is saved indicates the address of the first instruction that will be executed after the return from the interrupt service routine. • The I and UI bits are set to 1 in CCR, masking all interrupts except NMI. • The vector address of the accepted interrupt is generated, and the interrupt service routine starts executing from the address indicated by the contents of the vector address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 113 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Program execution state No Interrupt requested? Yes Yes NMI No No Pending Priority level 1? Yes IRQ 0 No IRQ 0 Yes IRQ 1 No Yes No IRQ 1 Yes No Yes ADI ADI Yes Yes No I=0 No I=0 Yes Yes No UI = 0 Yes Save PC and CCR I ← 1, UI ← 1 Read vector address Branch to interrupt service routine Figure 5.6 Process Up to Interrupt Acceptance when UE = 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 114 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (2) (1) (4) High (3) (8) (7) (10) (9) (12) (11) Vector fetch (14) (13) (6), (8) PC and CCR saved to stack (9), (11) Vector address (10), (12) Starting address of interrupt service routine (contents of vector address) (13) Starting address of interrupt service routine; (13) = (10), (12) (14) First instruction of interrupt service routine (6) (5) Stack Note: Mode 2, with program code and stack in external memory area accessed in two states via 16-bit bus. (1) Instruction prefetch address (not executed; return address, same as PC contents) (2), (4) Instruction code (not executed) Instruction prefetch address (not executed) (3) SP – 2 (5) SP – 4 (7) D15 to D0 , Address bus Interrupt request signal φ Instruction Internal prefetch processing Prefetch of interrupt Internal service routine processing instruction 5.4.2 Interrupt level decision and wait for end of instruction Interrupt accepted Section 5 Interrupt Controller Interrupt Sequence Figure 5.7 shows the interrupt sequence in mode 2 when the program code and stack are in an external memory area accessed in two states via a 16-bit bus. Figure 5.7 Interrupt Sequence (Mode 2, Two-State Access, Stack in External Memory) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 115 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.4.3 Interrupt Response Time Table 5.5 indicates the interrupt response time from the occurrence of an interrupt request until the first instruction of the interrupt service routine is executed. Table 5.5 Interrupt Response Time External Memory No. On-Chip Memory Item 1 8-Bit Bus 2 States 1 16-Bit Bus 3 States 1 1 1 Interrupt priority decision 2* 2* 2* 2 Maximum number of states until end of current instruction 1 to 23 1 to 27 1 to 31* 3 Saving PC and CCR to stack 4 8 12* 4 Vector fetch 4 8 12* 3 States 1 2* 2* 1 to 23 1 to 25* 4 4 6* 4 4 6* 4 4 4 4 4 2 4 8 12* 4 6* 3 4 4 4 4 4 19 to 41 31 to 57 43 to 73 19 to 41 25 to 49 5 Instruction prefetch* 6 Internal processing* Total 2 States 4 Notes: 1. 1 state for internal interrupts. 2. Prefetch after the interrupt is accepted and prefetch of the first instruction in the interrupt service routine. 3. Internal processing after the interrupt is accepted and internal processing after prefetch. 4. The number of states increases if wait states are inserted in external memory access. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 116 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.5 Usage Notes 5.5.1 Contention between Interrupt and Interrupt-Disabling Instruction When an instruction clears an interrupt enable bit to 0 to disable the interrupt, the interrupt is not disabled until after execution of the instruction is completed. If an interrupt occurs while a BCLR, MOV, or other instruction is being executed to clear its interrupt enable bit to 0, at the instant when execution of the instruction ends the interrupt is still enabled, so its interrupt exception handling is carried out. If a higher-priority interrupt is also requested, however, interrupt exception handling for the higher-priority interrupt is carried out, and the lower-priority interrupt is ignored. This also applies to the clearing of an interrupt flag. Figure 5.8 shows an example in which an IMIEA bit is cleared to 0 in TIER of the ITU. TIER write cycle by CPU IMIA exception handling φ Internal address bus TIER address Internal write signal IMIEA IMIA IMFA interrupt signal Figure 5.8 Contention between Interrupt and Interrupt-Disabling Instruction This type of contention will not occur if the interrupt is masked when the interrupt enable bit or flag is cleared to 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 117 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller 5.5.2 Instructions that Inhibit Interrupts The LDC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions inhibit interrupts. When an interrupt occurs, after determining the interrupt priority, the interrupt controller requests a CPU interrupt. If the CPU is currently executing one of these interrupt-inhibiting instructions, however, when the instruction is completed the CPU always continues by executing the next instruction. 5.5.3 Interrupts during EEPMOV Instruction Execution The EEPMOV.B and EEPMOV.W instructions differ in their reaction to interrupt requests. When the EEPMOV.B instruction is executing a transfer, no interrupts are accepted until the transfer is completed, not even NMI. When the EEPMOV.W instruction is executing a transfer, interrupt requests other than NMI are not accepted until the transfer is completed. If NMI is requested, NMI exception handling starts at a transfer cycle boundary. The PC value saved on the stack is the address of the next instruction. Programs should be coded as follows to allow for NMI interrupts during EEPMOV.W execution: L1: EEPMOV.W MOV.W R4,R4 BNE 5.5.4 L1 Usage Notes on External Interrupts The IRQnF flag specification calls for the flag to be cleared by writing 0 to it after it has been read while set to 1. However, it is possible for the IRQnF flag to be cleared by mistake simply by writing 0 to it, irrespective of whether it has been read while set to 1, with the result that interrupt exception handling is not executed. This occurs when the following conditions are fulfilled. • Setting conditions 1. Multiple external interrupts (IRQa, IRQb) are being used. 2. Different clearing methods are being used: clearing by writing 0 for the IRQaF flag, and clearing by hardware for the IRQbF flag. 3. A bit manipulation instruction is used on the IRQ status register to clear the IRQaF flag, or else ISR is read as a byte unit, the IRQaF flag bit is cleared, and the values read in the other bits are written as a byte unit. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 118 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller • Occurrence conditions 1. When IRQaF = 1, for the IRQaF flag to clear, ISR register read is executed. Thereafter interrupt processing is carried out and IRQbF flag clears. 2. IRQaF flag clear and IRQbF flag generation compete (IRQaF flag setting). (The ISR read needed for IRQaF flag clear was at IRQbF = 0 but in the time taken for ISR write, IRQbF = 1 was reached.) In all of the setting conditions 1 to 3 and occurrence conditions 1 and 2 are generated, IRQbF clears in error during ISR write for occurrence condition 2 and interrupt processing is not carried out. However, if IRQbF flag reaches 0 between occurrence conditions 1 and 2, IRQbF flag does not clear in error. IRQaF Read Write 1 0 Read Write 1 0 Read Write IRQb 1 1 Execution Read Write 0 0 IRQbF Clear in error Occurrence condition 1 Occurrence condition 2 Figure 5.9 IRQnF Flag When Interrupt Processing Is Not Conducted Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 119 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller In this situation, conduct one of the following countermeasures. Countermeasure 1: When clears IRQaF flag, do not use the bit manipulation instruction, read the ISR in bytes. Then write a value in bytes which sets IRQnF flag to 0 and other bits to 1. For example, if a = 0 MOV.B @ISR,R0L MOV.B #HFE,R0L MOV.B R0L,@ISR Countermeasure 2: During IRQb interrupt exception processing, carry out IRQbF flag clear dummy processing. For example, if b = 1 IRQB MOV.B #HFD,R0L MOV.B R0L,@ISR · · · 5.5.5 Notes on Non-Maskable Interrupts (NMI) NMI is an exception processing that can be executed by the interrupt controller and CPU when the chip internal circuits are operating normally under a specified electrical characteristics. If an NMI is executed when the circuits are not operating normally due to some factors such as software or abnormal interrupt of input to the pins (runaway execution), the operation will not be guaranteed. Incorrect NMI Operation Factors: Software 1. When an interrupt exception processing is executed in an H8/300H CPU, it is assumed that the stack pointer (SP(ER7)) has already been set by software, and that the stack pointer (SP(ER7)) points to the stack area set in a system such as RAM. If the program is in a runaway execution, the stack pointer may be overflowed and updated illegally. Therefore, normal operation will not be guaranteed. 2. Requests for NMIs can be accepted on the rising or falling edge of a pin. Acceptance of the rising or falling edge depends on the setting of the bit NMIEG in the system control register (SYSCR). It is necessary for the customer to set the bit according to the designated system. When the program is in a runaway execution, this bit may be rewritten illegally. Therefore, the system may not operate as expected. 3. This chip has a break function to implement on-board emulation for specific customers. To use this break function, execute the BRK instruction (H’5770). Note that the BRK instruction is Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 120 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller usually undefined. Therefore, if the CPU accidentally executes the instruction, the chip will perform exceptional processing and will enter the break mode. In the break mode, interrupts including the NMI are inhibited and the count of the watch dog timer will be stopped. Then by executing the RTB (H’56F0) instruction, the break mode will be cancelled, and usual program execution will resume. When the execution is reset during break mode, the CPU enters the reset state and the break mode is cancelled. Once the reset has been cancelled, normal program execution will resume after the reset exception processing has been executed. Incorrect NMI Operation Factors: Abnormal Interrupts Input to the Chip Pins If an abnormal interrupt which was not specified in the electrical characteristics is input to a pin during a chip operation, the chip may be destroyed. In this case, the operation of the chip will not be guaranteed. When an abnormal interrupt has been input to a pin, the chip may not be destroyed; however, the internal circuits of the chip may partially or wholly malfunction, and the CPU may enter an unimagined undefined state when the CPU was designed. If this occurs, it will be impossible to control the operation of the chip by external pins other than the external reset and standby pins, and the operation of the NMI will not be guaranteed. In this case, after some specified signals have been input to the pins, input an external reset so that the chip can enter the normal program execution state again. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 121 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 5 Interrupt Controller Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 122 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Section 6 Bus Controller 6.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has an on-chip bus controller that divides the address space into eight areas and can assign different bus specifications to each. This enables different types of memory to be connected easily. A bus arbitration function of the bus controller controls the operation of the DMA controller (DMAC) and refresh controller. The bus controller can also release the bus to an external device. 6.1.1 Features Features of the bus controller are listed below. • Independent settings for address areas 7 to 0 128-kbyte areas in 1-Mbyte modes; 2-Mbyte areas in 16-Mbyte modes. Chip select signals (CS7 to CS0) can be output for areas 7 to 0. Areas can be designated for 8-bit or 16-bit access. Areas can be designated for two-state or three-state access. • Four wait modes Programmable wait mode, pin auto-wait mode, and pin wait modes 0 and 1 can be selected. Zero to three wait states can be inserted automatically. • Bus arbitration function A built-in bus arbiter arbitrates the bus right to the CPU, DMAC, refresh controller, or an external bus master. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 123 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 6.1 shows a block diagram of the bus controller. CS7 to CS0 ABWCR Internal address bus ASTCR Area decoder WCER Chip select control signals CSCR Internal signals Bus mode control signal Bus control circuit Bus size control signal Access state control signal Internal data bus Wait request signal Wait-state controller WAIT WCR Internal signals CPU bus request signal DMAC bus request signal Refresh controller bus request signal CPU bus acknowledge signal DMAC bus acknowledge signal Refresh controller bus acknowledge signal BRCR Bus arbiter BACK Legend ABWCR: ASTCR: WCER: WCR: BRCR: CSCR: Bus width control register Access state control register Wait state controller enable register Wait control register Bus release control register Chip select control register BREQ Figure 6.1 Block Diagram of Bus Controller Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 124 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.1.3 Input/Output Pins Table 6.1 summarizes the bus controller’s input/output pins. Table 6.1 Bus Controller Pins Name Abbreviation I/O Function Chip select 7 to 0 CS7 to CS0 Output Strobe signals selecting areas 7 to 0 Address strobe AS Output Strobe signal indicating valid address output on the address bus Read RD Output Strobe signal indicating reading from the external address space High write HWR Output Strobe signal indicating writing to the external address space, with valid data on the upper data bus (D15 to D8) Low write LWR Output Strobe signal indicating writing to the external address space, with valid data on the lower data bus (D7 to D0) Wait WAIT Input Wait request signal for access to external three-state-access areas Bus request BREQ Input Request signal for releasing the bus to an external device Bus acknowledge BACK Output Acknowledge signal indicating the bus is released to an external device Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 125 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.1.4 Register Configuration Table 6.2 summarizes the bus controller’s registers. Table 6.2 Bus Controller Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Modes 1, 3, 5, 6 Modes 2, 4, 7 H'FFEC Bus width control register ABWCR R/W H'FF H'00 H'FFED Access state control register ASTCR R/W H'FF H'FF H'FFEE Wait control register WCR R/W H'F3 H'F3 H'FFEF Wait state controller enable register WCER R/W H'FF H'FF H'FFF3 Bus release control register BRCR R/W H'FE H'FE H'FF5F Chip select control register CSCR R/W H'0F H'0F Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. 6.2 Register Descriptions 6.2.1 Bus Width Control Register (ABWCR) ABWCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects 8-bit or 16-bit access for each area. Bit Initial value 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ABW7 ABW6 ABW5 ABW4 ABW3 ABW2 ABW1 ABW0 Mode 1, 3, 5, 6 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Mode 2, 4, 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Read/Write Bits selecting bus width for each area When ABWCR contains H'FF (selecting 8-bit access for all areas), the chip operates in 8-bit bus mode: the upper data bus (D15 to D8) is valid, and port 4 is an input/output port. When at least one bit is cleared to 0 in ABWCR, the chip operates in 16-bit bus mode with a 16-bit data bus (D15 to D0). In modes 1, 3, 5, and 6 ABWCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In modes 2, 4, and 7 ABWCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. ABWCR is not initialized in software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 126 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Bits 7 to 0—Areas 7 to 0 Bus Width Control (ABW7 to ABW0): These bits select 8-bit access or 16-bit access to the corresponding address areas. Bits 7 to 0: ABW7 to ABW0 Description 0 Areas 7 to 0 are 16-bit access areas 1 Areas 7 to 0 are 8-bit access areas ABWCR specifies the bus width of external memory areas. The bus width of on-chip memory and internal I/O registers is fixed and does not depend on ABWCR settings. These settings are therefore meaningless in single-chip mode (mode 7). 6.2.2 Access State Control Register (ASTCR) ASTCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects whether each area is accessed in two states or three states. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 AST7 AST6 AST5 AST4 AST3 AST2 AST1 AST0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Bits selecting number of states for access to each area ASTCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 0—Areas 7 to 0 Access State Control (AST7 to AST0): These bits select whether the corresponding area is accessed in two or three states. Bits 7 to 0: AST7 to AST0 Description 0 Areas 7 to 0 are accessed in two states 1 Areas 7 to 0 are accessed in three states (Initial value) ASTCR specifies the number of states in which external areas are accessed. On-chip memory and internal I/O registers are accessed in a fixed number of states that does not depend on ASTCR settings. These settings are therefore meaningless in single-chip mode (mode 7). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 127 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.2.3 Wait Control Register (WCR) WCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the wait mode for the wait-state controller (WSC) and specifies the number of wait states. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — WMS1 WMS0 WC1 WC0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Wait count 1/0 These bits select the number of wait states inserted Wait mode select 1/0 These bits select the wait mode WCR is initialized to H'F3 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 4—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bits 3 and 2—Wait Mode Select 1 and 0 (WMS1/0): These bits select the wait mode. Bit 3: WMS1 Bit 2: WMS0 Description 0 0 Programmable wait mode 1 No wait states inserted by wait-state controller 0 Pin wait mode 1 1 Pin auto-wait mode 1 (Initial value) Bits 1 and 0—Wait Count 1 and 0 (WC1/0): These bits select the number of wait states inserted in access to external three-state-access areas. Bit 1: WC1 Bit 0: WC0 Description 0 0 No wait states inserted by wait-state controller 1 1 state inserted 0 2 states inserted 1 3 states inserted 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 128 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 6 Bus Controller 6.2.4 Wait State Controller Enable Register (WCER) WCER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables wait-state control of external three-state-access areas by the wait-state controller. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WCE7 WCE6 WCE5 WCE4 WCE3 WCE2 WCE1 WCE0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Wait-state controller enable 7 to 0 These bits enable or disable wait-state control WCER is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 0—Wait-State Controller Enable 7 to 0 (WCE7 to WCE0): These bits enable or disable wait-state control of external three-state-access areas. Bits 7 to 0: WCE7 to WCE0 Description 0 Wait-state control disabled (pin wait mode 0) 1 Wait-state control enabled (Initial value) Since WCER enables or disables wait-state control of external three-state-access areas, these settings are meaningless in single-chip mode (mode 7). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 129 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.2.5 Bus Release Control Register (BRCR) BRCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables address output on bus lines A23 to A21 and enables or disables release of the bus to an external device. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 A23E A22E A21E — — — — BRLE Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 Read/ Mode 1, 2, 5, 7 — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W — — — — R/W Write Mode 3, 4, 6 Address 23 to 21 enable These bits enable PA 6 to PA 4 to be used for A 23 to A 21 address output Reserved bits Bus release enable Enables or disables release of the bus to an external device BRCR is initialized to H'FE by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bit 7—Address 23 Enable (A23E): Enables PA4 to be used as the A23 address output pin. Writing 0 in this bit enables A23 address output from PA4. In modes other than 3, 4, and 6 this bit cannot be modified and PA4 has its ordinary input/output functions. Bit 7: A23E Description 0 PA4 is the A23 address output pin 1 PA4 is the PA4/TP4/TIOCA1 input/output pin (Initial value) Bit 6—Address 22 Enable (A22E): Enables PA5 to be used as the A22 address output pin. Writing 0 in this bit enables A22 address output from PA5. In modes other than 3, 4, and 6 this bit cannot be modified and PA5 has its ordinary input/output functions. Bit 6: A22E Description 0 PA5 is the A22 address output pin 1 PA5 is the PA5/TP5/TIOCB1 input/output pin Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 130 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 6 Bus Controller Bit 5—Address 21 Enable (A21E): Enables PA6 to be used as the A21 address output pin. Writing 0 in this bit enables A21 address output from PA6. In modes other than 3, 4, and 6 this bit cannot be modified and PA6 has its ordinary input/output functions. Bit 5: A21E Description 0 PA6 is the A21 address output pin 1 PA6 is the PA6/TP6/TIOCA2 input/output pin (Initial value) Bits 4 to 1—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 0—Bus Release Enable (BRLE): Enables or disables release of the bus to an external device. Bit 0: BRLE Description 0 The bus cannot be released to an external device; BREQ and BACK can be used as input/output pins (Initial value) 1 The bus can be released to an external device 6.2.6 Chip Select Control Register (CSCR) CSCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables output of chip select signals (CS7 to CS4). If a chip select signal (CS7 to CS4) output is selected in this register, the corresponding pin functions as a chip select signal (CS7 to CS4) output, this function taking priority over other functions. CSCR cannot be modified in single-chip mode. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CS7E CS6E CS5E CS4E — — — — Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W — — — — Chip select 7 to 4 enable These bits enable or disable chip select signal output Reserved bits CSCR is initialized to H'0F by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 131 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Bits 7 to 4—Chip Select 7 to 4 Enable (CS7E to CS4E): These bits enable or disable output of the corresponding chip select signal. Bit n: CSnE Description 0 Output of chip select signal CSn is disabled 1 Output of chip select signal CSn is enabled Note: n = 7 to 4 Bits 3 to 0—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 132 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 6 Bus Controller 6.3 Operation 6.3.1 Area Division The external address space is divided into areas 0 to 7. Each area has a size of 128 kbytes in the 1-Mbyte modes, or 2 Mbytes in the 16-Mbyte modes. Figure 6.2 shows a general view of the memory map. H'000000 H'00000 H'1FFFF H'20000 H'1FFFFF H'200000 H'3FFFFF H'400000 H'7FFFFF H'800000 H'FFFFF Area 7 (128 kbytes) Area 7 (2 Mbytes) Area 4 (2 Mbytes) H'9FFFFF H'A00000 Area 5 (128 kbytes) Area 5 (2 Mbytes) H'BFFFFF H'C00000 H'BFFFF H'C0000 Area 6 (128 kbytes) Area 6 (2 Mbytes) H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 3 (2 Mbytes) H'7FFFFF H'800000 Area 4 (128 kbytes) Area 5 (2 Mbytes) Area 6 (128 kbytes) Area 2 (2 Mbytes) Area 3 (128 kbytes) H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'BFFFFF H'C00000 Area 1 (2 Mbytes) H'5FFFFF H'600000 H'7FFFF H'80000 H'9FFFFF H'A00000 Area 5 (128 kbytes) H'DFFFF H'E0000 H'1FFFFF H'200000 Area 2 (128 kbytes) Area 4 (2 Mbytes) Area 4 (128 kbytes) H'BFFFF H'C0000 On-chip ROM *1 Area 0 (2 Mbytes) H'3FFFFF H'400000 H'5FFFF H'60000 Area 3 (2 Mbytes) Area 3 (128 kbytes) H'9FFFF H'A0000 H'000000 Area 1 (128 kbytes) H'3FFFF H'40000 H'5FFFFF H'600000 H'7FFFF H'80000 H'1FFFF H'20000 Area 2 (2 Mbytes) Area 2 (128 kbytes) H'5FFFF H'60000 On-chip ROM *1 Area 0 (128 kbytes) Area 1 (2 Mbytes) Area 1 (128 kbytes) H'3FFFF H'40000 H'00000 Area 0 (2 Mbytes) Area 0 (128 kbytes) H'DFFFF H'E0000 Area 7 (128 kbytes) Area 6 (2 Mbytes) H'DFFFFF H'E00000 Area 7 (2 Mbytes) On-chip RAM * 1 *2 On-chip RAM * 1 *2 On-chip RAM * 1 *2 On-chip RAM * 1 *2 External address space*3 External address space*3 External address space*3 External address space*3 Internal I/O registers *1 a. 1-Mbyte modes with on-chip ROM disabled (modes 1 and 2) H'FFFFFF Internal I/O registers *1 b. 16-Mbyte modes with on-chip ROM disabled (modes 3 and 4) H'FFFFF Internal I/O registers *1 H'FFFFFF c. 1-Mbyte mode with on-chip ROM enabled (mode 5) Internal I/O registers *1 d. 16-Mbyte mode with on-chip ROM enabled (mode 6) Notes: 1. The on-chip ROM, on-chip RAM, and internal I/O registers have a fixed bus width and are accessed in a fixed number of states. 2. When the RAME bit is cleared to 0 in SYSCR, this area conforms to the specifications of area 7. 3. This external address area conforms to the specifications of area 7. Figure 6.2 Access Area Map for Modes 1 to 6 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 133 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Chip select signals (CS7 to CS0) can be output for areas 7 to 0. The bus specifications for each area can be selected in ABWCR, ASTCR, WCER, and WCR as shown in table 6.3. Table 6.3 Bus Specifications ABWCR ASTCR WCER WCR ABWn ASTn WCEn WMS1 WMS0 Bus Width Access States Wait Mode 0 0 — — — 16 2 Disabled 1 0 — — 16 3 Pin wait mode 0 1 0 0 16 3 Programmable wait mode 1 16 3 Disabled 0 16 3 Pin wait mode 1 1 16 3 Pin auto-wait mode — 8 2 Disabled 1 1 Bus Specifications 0 — — 1 0 — — 8 3 Pin wait mode 0 1 0 0 8 3 Programmable wait mode 1 8 3 Disabled 0 8 3 Pin wait mode 1 1 8 3 Pin auto-wait mode 1 Note: n = 0 to 7 6.3.2 Chip Select Signals For each of areas 7 to 0, the H8/3048 Group can output a chip select signal (CS7 to CS0) that goes low to indicate when the area is selected. Figure 6.3 shows the output timing of a CSn signal (n = 0 to 7). Output of CS3 to CS0: Output of CS3 to CS0 is enabled or disabled in the data direction register (DDR) of the corresponding port. In the expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled, a reset leaves pin CS0 in the output state and pins CS3 to CS1 in the input state. To output chip select signals CS3 to CS1, the corresponding DDR bits must be set to 1. In the expanded modes with on-chip ROM enabled, a reset leaves pins CS3 to CS0 in the input state. To output chip select signals CS3 to CS0, the corresponding DDR bits must be set to 1. For details see section 9, I/O Ports. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 134 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Output of CS7 to CS4: Output of CS7 to CS4 is enabled or disabled in the chip select control register (CSCR). A reset leaves pins CS7 to CS4 in the input state. To output chip select signals CS7 to CS4, the corresponding CSCR bits must be set to 1. For details see section 9, I/O Ports. φ Address bus External address in area n CSn Figure 6.3 CSn Output Timing (n = 7 to 0) When the on-chip ROM, on-chip RAM, and internal I/O registers are accessed, CS7 and CS0 remain high. The CSn signals are decoded from the address signals. They can be used as chip select signals for SRAM and other devices. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 135 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.3.3 Data Bus The H8/3048 Group allows either 8-bit access or 16-bit access to be designated for each of areas 7 to 0. An 8-bit-access area uses the upper data bus (D15 to D8). A 16-bit-access area uses both the upper data bus (D15 to D8) and lower data bus (D7 to D0). In read access the RD signal applies without distinction to both the upper and lower data bus. In write access the HWR signal applies to the upper data bus, and the LWR signal applies to the lower data bus. Table 6.4 indicates how the two parts of the data bus are used under different access conditions. Table 6.4 Access Conditions and Data Bus Usage Access Read/W Size rite Address Valid Strobe Upper Data Bus (D15 to D8) Lower Data Bus (D7 to D0) 8-bit-access area — Valid Invalid 16-bit-access area Byte Area Read — RD Write — HWR Read Even RD Odd Word Undetermined data Valid Invalid Invalid Valid Write Even HWR Valid Undetermined data Odd LWR Undetermined data Valid Read — RD Valid Valid Write — HWR, LWR Valid Valid Note: Undetermined data means that unpredictable data is output. Invalid means that the bus is in the input state and the input is ignored. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 136 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.3.4 Bus Control Signal Timing 8-Bit, Three-State-Access Areas: Figure 6.4 shows the timing of bus control signals for an 8-bit, three-state-access area. The upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access these areas. The LWR pin is always high. Wait states can be inserted. Bus cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus External address in area n CS n AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Invalid HWR Write access LWR High D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Undetermined data Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.4 Bus Control Signal Timing for 8-Bit, Three-State-Access Area Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 137 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 8-Bit, Two-State-Access Areas: Figure 6.5 shows the timing of bus control signals for an 8-bit, two-state-access area. The upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access these areas. The LWR pin is always high. Wait states cannot be inserted. Bus cycle T1 T2 φ Address bus External address in area n CSn AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Invalid HWR LWR High Write access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Undetermined data Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.5 Bus Control Signal Timing for 8-Bit, Two-State-Access Area Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 138 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Areas: Figures 6.6 to 6.8 show the timing of bus control signals for a 16-bit, three-state-access area. In these areas, the upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access even addresses and the lower address bus (D7 to D0) is used to access odd addresses. Wait states can be inserted. Bus cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus Even external address in area n CS n AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Invalid HWR Write access LWR High D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Undetermined data Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.6 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Area (1) (Byte Access to Even Address) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 139 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Bus cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus Odd external address in area n CS n AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Invalid D 7 to D 0 Valid HWR Write access High LWR D15 to D8 Undetermined data D 7 to D 0 Valid Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.7 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Area (2) (Byte Access to Odd Address) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 140 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Bus cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus External address in area n CS n AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Valid HWR LWR Write access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Valid Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.8 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Area (3) (Word Access) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 141 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Areas: Figures 6.9 to 6.11 show the timing of bus control signals for a 16-bit, two-state-access area. In these areas, the upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access even addresses and the lower address bus (D7 to D0) is used to access odd addresses. Wait states cannot be inserted. Bus cycle T1 T2 φ Address bus Even external address in area n CS n AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Invalid HWR Write access LWR High D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Undetermined data Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.9 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Area (1) (Byte Access to Even Address) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 142 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Bus cycle T1 T2 φ Address bus Odd external address in area n CSn AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Invalid D 7 to D 0 Valid HWR Write access High LWR D15 to D8 Undetermined data D 7 to D 0 Valid Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.10 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Area (2) (Byte Access to Odd Address) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 143 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Bus cycle T1 T2 φ Address bus External address in area n CSn AS RD Read access D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Valid HWR Write access LWR D15 to D8 Valid D 7 to D 0 Valid Note: n = 7 to 0 Figure 6.11 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Area (3) (Word Access) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 144 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.3.5 Wait Modes Four wait modes can be selected as shown in table 6.5. Table 6.5 Wait Mode Selection ASTCR WCER WCR ASTn Bit WCEn Bit WMS1 Bit WMS0 Bit WSC Control Wait Mode 0 — — — Disabled No wait states 1 0 — — Disabled Pin wait mode 0 1 0 0 Enabled Programmable wait mode 1 Enabled No wait states 1 0 Enabled Pin wait mode 1 1 Enabled Pin auto-wait mode Note: n = 7 to 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 145 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Wait Mode in Areas Where Wait-State Controller is Disabled External three-state access areas in which the wait-state controller is disabled (ASTn = 1, WCEn = 0) operate in pin wait mode 0. The other wait modes are unavailable. The settings of bits WMS1 and WMS0 are ignored in these areas. Pin Wait Mode 0: Wait states can only be inserted by WAIT pin control. During access to an external three-state-access area, if the WAIT pin is low at the fall of the system clock (φ) in the T2 state, a wait state (TW) is inserted. If the WAIT pin remains low, wait states continue to be inserted until the WAIT signal goes high. Figure 6.12 shows the timing. Inserted by WAIT signal T1 φ T2 TW * * TW T3 * WAIT pin Address bus External address AS RD Read access Read data Data bus HWR , LWR Write access Data bus Write data Note: * Arrows indicate time of sampling of the WAIT pin. Figure 6.12 Pin Wait Mode 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 146 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Wait Modes in Areas Where Wait-State Controller is Enabled External three-state access areas in which the wait-state controller is enabled (ASTn = 1, WCEn = 1) can operate in pin wait mode 1, pin auto-wait mode, or programmable wait mode, as selected by bits WMS1 and WMS0. Bits WMS1 and WMS0 apply to all areas, so all areas in which the waitstate controller is enabled operate in the same wait mode. Pin Wait Mode 1: In all accesses to external three-state-access areas, the number of wait states (TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are inserted. If the WAIT pin is low at the fall of the system clock (φ) in the last of these wait states, an additional wait state is inserted. If the WAIT pin remains low, wait states continue to be inserted until the WAIT signal goes high. Pin wait mode 1 is useful for inserting four or more wait states, or for inserting different numbers of wait states for different external devices. If the wait count is 0, this mode operates in the same way as pin wait mode 0. Figure 6.13 shows the timing when the wait count is 1 (WC1 = 0, WC0 = 1) and one additional wait state is inserted by WAIT input. T1 Inserted by wait count Inserted by WAIT signal TW TW T2 φ * T3 * WAIT pin Address bus External address AS Read access RD Read data Data bus HWR, LWR Write access Data bus Write data Note: * Arrows indicate time of sampling of the WAIT pin. Figure 6.13 Pin Wait Mode 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 147 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Pin Auto-Wait Mode: If the WAIT pin is low, the number of wait states (TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are inserted. In pin auto-wait mode, if the WAIT pin is low at the fall of the system clock (φ) in the T2 state, the number of wait states (TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are inserted. No additional wait states are inserted even if the WAIT pin remains low. Pin auto-wait mode can be used for an easy interface to low-speed memory, simply by routing the chip select signal to the WAIT pin. Figure 6.14 shows the timing when the wait count is 1. T1 φ T2 T3 * T1 T2 TW T3 * WAIT Address bus External address External address AS RD Read access Read data Read data Data bus HWR , LWR Write access Data bus Write data Note: * Arrows indicate time of sampling of the WAIT pin. Figure 6.14 Pin Auto-Wait Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 148 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Write data Section 6 Bus Controller Programmable Wait Mode: The number of wait states (TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are inserted in all accesses to external three-state-access areas. Figure 6.15 shows the timing when the wait count is 1 (WC1 = 0, WC0 = 1). T1 T2 TW T3 φ Address bus External address AS RD Read access Read data Data bus HWR, LWR Write access Data bus Write data Figure 6.15 Programmable Wait Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 149 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Example of Wait State Control Settings: A reset initializes ASTCR and WCER to H'FF and WCR to H'F3, selecting programmable wait mode and three wait states for all areas. Software can select other wait modes for individual areas by modifying the ASTCR, WCER, and WCR settings. Figure 6.16 shows an example of wait mode settings. Area 0 Area 1 3-state-access area, programmable wait mode (3 states inserted) 3-state-access area, programmable wait mode (3 states inserted) Area 2 3-state-access area, pin wait mode 0 Area 3 3-state-access area, pin wait mode 0 Area 4 2-state-access area, no wait states inserted Area 5 2-state-access area, no wait states inserted Area 6 2-state-access area, no wait states inserted Area 7 2-state-access area, no wait states inserted Bit: ASTCR H'0F: 7 0 6 0 5 0 4 0 3 1 2 1 1 1 0 1 WCER H'33: 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 WCR H'F3: — — — — 0 0 1 1 Note: Wait states cannot be inserted in areas designated for two-state access by ASTCR. Figure 6.16 Wait Mode Settings (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 150 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.3.6 Interconnections with Memory (Example) For each area, the bus controller can select two- or three-state access and an 8- or 16-bit data bus width. In three-state-access areas, wait states can be inserted in a variety of modes, simplifying the connection of both high-speed and low-speed devices. Figure 6.18 shows an example of interconnections between the H8/3048 Group and memory. Figure 6.17 shows a memory map for this example. A 256-kword × 16-bit EPROM is connected to area 0. This device is accessed in three states via a 16-bit bus. Two 32-kword × 8-bit SRAM devices (SRAM1 and SRAM2) are connected to area 1. These devices are accessed in two states via a 16-bit bus. One 32-kword × 8-bit SRAM (SRAM3) is connected to area 2. This device is accessed via an 8-bit bus, using three-state access with an additional wait state inserted in pin auto-wait mode. H'000000 EPROM H'07FFFF Area 0 16-bit, three-state-access area Not used H'1FFFFF H'200000 SRAM 1, 2 Area 1 16-bit, two-state-access area H'20FFFF H'210000 Not used H'3FFFFF H'400000 SRAM 3 H'407FFF Area 2 8-bit, three-state-access area (one auto-wait state) Not used H'5FFFFF On-chip RAM H'FFFFFF Internal I/O registers Figure 6.17 Memory Map (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 151 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller EPROM A19 to A 1 A 18 to A 0 I/O 15 to I/O8 H8/3048 Group I/O 7 to I/O 0 CS 0 CE OE CS 1 CS 2 SRAM1 (even addresses) A15 to A 1 A14 to A 0 I/O 7 to I/O 0 WAIT CS RD OE WE HWR LWR SRAM2 (odd addresses) A15 to A 1 A 14 to A 0 A 23 to A 0 I/O 7 to I/O 0 CS OE WE D15 to D 8 D 7 to D 0 SRAM3 A14 to A 0 A 14 to A 0 I/O 7 to I/O 0 CS OE WE Figure 6.18 Interconnections with Memory (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 152 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.3.7 Bus Arbiter Operation The bus controller has a built-in bus arbiter that arbitrates between different bus masters. There are four bus masters: the CPU, DMA controller (DMAC), refresh controller, and an external bus master. When a bus master has the bus right it can carry out read, write, or refresh access. Each bus master uses a bus request signal to request the bus right. At fixed times the bus arbiter determines priority and uses a bus acknowledge signal to grant the bus to a bus master, which can then operate using the bus. The bus arbiter checks whether the bus request signal from a bus master is active or inactive, and returns an acknowledge signal to the bus master if the bus request signal is active. When two or more bus masters request the bus, the highest-priority bus master receives an acknowledge signal. The bus master that receives an acknowledge signal can continue to use the bus until the acknowledge signal is deactivated. The bus master priority order is: (High) External bus master > refresh controller > DMAC > CPU (Low) The bus arbiter samples the bus request signals and determines priority at all times, but it does not always grant the bus immediately, even when it receives a bus request from a bus master with higher priority than the current bus master. Each bus master has certain times at which it can release the bus to a higher-priority bus master. CPU: The CPU is the lowest-priority bus master. If the DMAC, refresh controller, or an external bus master requests the bus while the CPU has the bus right, the bus arbiter transfers the bus right to the bus master that requested it. The bus right is transferred at the following times: • The bus right is transferred at the boundary of a bus cycle. If word data is accessed by two consecutive byte accesses, however, the bus right is not transferred between the two byte accesses. • If another bus master requests the bus while the CPU is performing internal operations, such as executing a multiply or divide instruction, the bus right is transferred immediately. The CPU continues its internal operations. • If another bus master requests the bus while the CPU is in sleep mode, the bus right is transferred immediately. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 153 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller DMAC: When the DMAC receives an activation request, it requests the bus right from the bus arbiter. If the DMAC is bus master and the refresh controller or an external bus master requests the bus, the bus arbiter transfers the bus right from the DMAC to the bus master that requested the bus. The bus right is transferred at the following times. The bus right is transferred when the DMAC finishes transferring 1 byte or 1 word. A DMAC transfer cycle consists of a read cycle and a write cycle. The bus right is not transferred between the read cycle and the write cycle. There is a priority order among the DMAC channels. For details see section 8.4.9, DMAC Multiple-Channel Operation. Refresh Controller: When a refresh cycle is requested, the refresh controller requests the bus right from the bus arbiter. When the refresh cycle is completed, the refresh controller releases the bus. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller. External Bus Master: When the BRLE bit is set to 1 in BRCR, the bus can be released to an external bus master. The external bus master has highest priority, and requests the bus right from the bus arbiter by driving the BREQ signal low. Once the external bus master gets the bus, it keeps the bus right until the BREQ signal goes high. While the bus is released to an external bus master, the H8/3048 Group holds the address bus and data bus control signals (AS, RD, HWR, and LWR) in the high-impedance state, holds the chip select signals high (CSn: n = 7 to 0), and holds the BACK pin in the low output state. The bus arbiter samples the BREQ pin at the rise of the system clock (φ). If BREQ is low, the bus is released to the external bus master at the appropriate opportunity. The BREQ signal should be held low until the BACK signal goes low. When the BREQ pin is high in two consecutive samples, the BACK signal is driven high to end the bus-release cycle. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 154 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller Figure 6.19 shows the timing when the bus right is requested by an external bus master during a read cycle in a two-state-access area. There is a minimum interval of two states from when the BREQ signal goes low until the bus is released. CPU cycles T1 External bus released CPU cycles T2 φ High-impedance Address bus Address High level CSn High-impedance Data bus AS , RD High-impedance High High-impedance HWR , LWR BREQ BACK Minimum 2 cycles 1 2 3 4 5 6 n = 7 to 0 1 2 3 4, 5 6 Low BREQ signal is sampled at rise of T1 state. BACK signal goes low at end of CPU read cycle, releasing bus right to external bus master. BREQ pin continues to be sampled while bus is released to external bus master. High BREQ signal is sampled twice consecutively. BREQ signal goes high, ending bus-release cycle. Figure 6.19 External-Bus-Released State (Two-State-Access Area, During Read Cycle) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 155 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller 6.4 Usage Notes 6.4.1 Connection to Dynamic RAM and Pseudo-Static RAM A different bus control signal timing applies when dynamic RAM or pseudo-static RAM is connected to area 3. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller. 6.4.2 Register Write Timing ABWCR, ASTCR, and WCER Write Timing: Data written to ABWCR, ASTCR, or WCER takes effect starting from the next bus cycle. Figure 6.20 shows the timing when an instruction fetched from area 0 changes area 0 from three-state access to two-state access. T1 T2 T3 T1 T2 T3 T1 T2 φ Address bus ASTCR address 3-state access to area 0 Figure 6.20 ASTCR Write Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 156 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 2-state access to area 0 Section 6 Bus Controller DDR Write Timing: Data written to a data direction register (DDR) to change a CSn pin from CSn output to generic input, or vice versa, takes effect starting from the T3 state of the DDR write cycle. Figure 6.21 shows the timing when the CS1 pin is changed from generic input to CS1 output. T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus CS1 P8DDR address High impedance Figure 6.21 DDR Write Timing BRCR Write Timing: Data written to switch between A23, A22, or A21 output and generic input or output takes effect starting from the T3 state of the BRCR write cycle. Figure 6.22 shows the timing when a pin is changed from generic input to A23, A22, or A21 output. T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus A 23 to A 21 BRCR address High impedance Figure 6.22 BRCR Write Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 157 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 6 Bus Controller BREQ Input Timing 6.4.3 After driving the BREQ pin low, hold it low until BACK goes low. If BREQ returns to the high level before BACK goes low, the bus arbiter may operate incorrectly. To terminate the external-bus-released state, hold the BREQ signal high for at least three states. If BREQ is high for too short an interval, the bus arbiter may operate incorrectly. 6.4.4 Transition To Software Standby Mode If contention occurs between a transition to software standby mode and a bus request from an external bus master, the bus may be released for one state just before the transition to software standby mode (see figure 6.23). When using software standby mode, clear the BRLE bit to 0 in BRCR before executing the SLEEP instruction. Bus-released state Software standby mode φ BREQ BACK Address bus Strobe Figure 6.23 Contention between Bus-Released State and Software Standby Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 158 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has an on-chip refresh controller that enables direct connection of 16-bit-wide DRAM or pseudo-static RAM (PSRAM). DRAM or pseudo-static RAM can be directly connected to area 3 of the external address space. A maximum 128 kbytes can be connected in modes 1, 2, and 5 (1-Mbyte modes). A maximum 2 Mbytes can be connected in modes 3, 4, and 6 (16-Mbyte modes). Systems that do not need to refresh DRAM or pseudo-static RAM can use the refresh controller as an 8-bit interval timer. When the refresh controller is not used, it can be independently halted to conserve power. For details see section 21.6, Module Standby Function. 7.1.1 Features The refresh controller can be used for one of three functions: DRAM refresh control, pseudo-static RAM refresh control, or 8-bit interval timing. Features of the refresh controller are listed below. Features as a DRAM Refresh Controller • Enables direct connection of 16-bit-wide DRAM • Selection of 2CAS or 2WE mode • Selection of 8-bit or 9-bit column address multiplexing for DRAM address input Examples: 1-Mbit DRAM: 8-bit row address × 8-bit column address 4-Mbit DRAM: 9-bit row address × 9-bit column address 4-Mbit DRAM: 10-bit row address × 8-bit column address • CAS-before-RAS refresh control • Software-selectable refresh interval • Software-selectable self-refresh mode • Wait states can be inserted Features as a Pseudo-Static RAM Refresh Controller Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 159 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller • RFSH signal output for refresh control • Software-selectable refresh interval • Software-selectable self-refresh mode • Wait states can be inserted Features as an Interval Timer • Refresh timer counter (RTCNT) can be used as an 8-bit up-counter • Selection of seven counter clock sources: φ/2, φ/8, φ/32, φ/128, φ/512, φ/2048, φ/4096 • Interrupts can be generated by compare match between RTCNT and the refresh time constant register (RTCOR) 7.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 7.1 shows a block diagram of the refresh controller. φ/2, φ/8, φ/32, φ/128, φ/512, φ/2048, φ/4096 Refresh signal Clock selector Control logic CMI interrupt Module data bus Legend RTCNT: RTCOR: RTMCSR: RFSHCR: Refresh timer counter Refresh time constant register Refresh timer control/status register Refresh control register Figure 7.1 Block Diagram of Refresh Controller Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 160 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Internal data bus Bus interface RFSHCR RTMCSR RTCOR RTCNT Comparator Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.1.3 Input/Output Pins Table 7.1 summarizes the refresh controller’s input/output pins. Table 7.1 Refresh Controller Pins Signal Pin Name Abbr. I/O Function RFSH Refresh RFSH Output Goes low during refresh cycles; used to refresh DRAM and PSRAM HWR Upper write/upper column address strobe UW/UCAS Output Connects to the UW pin of 2WE DRAM or UCAS pin of 2CAS DRAM LWR Lower write/lower column address strobe LW/LCAS Output Connects to the LW pin of 2WE DRAM or LCAS pin of 2CAS DRAM RD Column address strobe/ write enable CAS/WE Output Connects to the CAS pin of 2WE DRAM or WE pin of 2CAS DRAM CS3 Row address strobe RAS Output Connects to the RAS pin of DRAM 7.1.4 Register Configuration Table 7.2 summarizes the refresh controller’s registers. Table 7.2 Refresh Controller Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFAC Refresh control register RFSHCR R/W H'02 H'FFAD Refresh timer control/status register RTMCSR R/W H'07 H'FFAE Refresh timer counter RTCNT R/W H'00 H'FFAF Refresh time constant register RTCOR R/W H'FF Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 161 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.2 Register Descriptions 7.2.1 Refresh Control Register (RFSHCR) RFSHCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the operating mode of the refresh controller. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 SRFMD PSRAME DRAME CAS/WE M9/M8 2 1 0 RFSHE — RCYCE Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W — R/W Refresh cycle enable Enables or disables insertion of refresh cycles Reserved bit Refresh pin enable Enables refresh signal output from the refresh pin Address multiplex mode select Selects the number of column address bits Strobe mode select Selects 2CAS or 2WE strobing of DRAM PSRAM enable and DRAM enable These bits enable or disable connection of pseudo-static RAM and DRAM Self-refresh mode Selects self-refresh mode RFSHCR is initialized to H'02 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 162 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Bit 7—Self-Refresh Mode (SRFMD): Specifies DRAM or pseudo-static RAM self-refresh during software standby mode. When PSRAME = 1 and DRAME = 0, after the SRFMD bit is set to 1, pseudo-static RAM can be self-refreshed when the H8/3048 Group enters software standby mode. When PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 1, after the SRFMD bit is set to 1, DRAM can be selfrefreshed when the H8/3048 Group enters software standby mode. In either case, the normal access state resumes on exit from software standby mode. Bit 7: SRFMD Description 0 DRAM or PSRAM self-refresh is disabled in software standby mode (Initial value) 1 DRAM or PSRAM self-refresh is enabled in software standby mode Bit 6—PSRAM Enable (PSRAME) and Bit 5—DRAM Enable (DRAME): These bits enable or disable connection of pseudo-static RAM and DRAM to area 3 of the external address space. When DRAM or pseudo-static RAM is connected, the bus cycle and refresh cycle of area 3 consist of three states, regardless of the setting in the access state control register (ASTCR). If AST3 = 0 in ASTCR, wait states cannot be inserted. When the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1, bits 0, 2, 3, and 4 in RFSHCR and registers RTMCSR, RTCNT, and RTCOR are write-disabled, except that the CMF flag in RTMCSR can be cleared by writing 0. Bit 6: PSRAME Bit 5: DRAME Description 0 0 Can be used as an interval timer 1 DRAM can be directly connected 0 PSRAM can be directly connected 1 Illegal setting (Initial value) (DRAM and PSRAM cannot be directly connected) 1 Bit 4—Strobe Mode Select (CAS/WE WE): WE Selects 2CAS or 2WE mode. The setting of this bit is valid when PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 1. This bit is write-disabled when the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1. Bit 4: CAS/WE WE Description 0 2WE mode 1 2CAS mode (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 163 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Bit 3—Address Multiplex Mode Select (M9/M8 M8): M8 Selects 8-bit or 9-bit column addressing. The setting of this bit is valid when PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 1. This bit is write-disabled when the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1. Bit 3: M9/M8 M8 Description 0 8-bit column address mode 1 9-bit column address mode (Initial value) Bit 2—Refresh Pin Enable (RFSHE): Enables or disables refresh signal output from the RFSH pin. This bit is write-disabled when the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1. Bit 2: RFSHE Description 0 Refresh signal output at the RFSH pin is disabled (the RFSH pin can be used as a generic input/output port) (Initial value) 1 Refresh signal output at the RFSH pin is enabled Bit 1—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Bit 0—Refresh Cycle Enable (RCYCE): Enables or disables insertion of refresh cycles. The setting of this bit is valid when PSRAME = 1 or DRAME = 1. When PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 0, refresh cycles are not inserted regardless of the setting of this bit. Bit 0: RCYCE Description 0 Refresh cycles are disabled 1 Refresh cycles are enabled for area 3 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 164 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.2.2 Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTMCSR) RTMCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the clock source for RTCNT. It also enables or disables interrupt requests when the refresh controller is used as an interval timer. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMF CMIE CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 — — — Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 Read/Write R/(W)* R/W R/W R/W R/W — — — Clock select 2 to 0 These bits select an internal clock source for input to RTCNT Reserved bits Compare match interrupt enable Enables or disables the CMI interrupt requested by CMF Compare match flag Status flag indicating that RTCNT has matched RTCOR Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. Bits 7 and 6 are initialized by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 5 to 3 are initialized by a reset and in hardware standby mode, but retain their previous values on transition to software standby mode. Bit 7—Compare Match Flag (CMF): This status flag indicates that the RTCNT and RTCOR values have matched. Bit 7: CMF Description 0 [Clearing condition] Cleared by reading CMF when CMF = 1, then writing 0 in CMF 1 [Setting condition] When RTCNT = RTCOR Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 165 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Bit 6—Compare Match Interrupt Enable (CMIE): Enables or disables the CMI interrupt requested when the CMF flag is set to 1 in RTMCSR. The CMIE bit is always cleared to 0 when PSRAME = 1 or DRAME = 1. Bit 6: CMIE Description 0 The CMI interrupt requested by CMF is disabled 1 The CMI interrupt requested by CMF is enabled (Initial value) Bits 5 to 3—Clock Select 2 to 0 (CKS2 to CKS0): These bits select an internal clock source for input to RTCNT. When used for refresh control, the refresh controller outputs a refresh request at periodic intervals determined by compare match between RTCNT and RTCOR. When used as an interval timer, the refresh controller generates CMI interrupts at periodic intervals determined by compare match. These bits are write-disabled when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1. Bit 5: CKS2 Bit 4: CKS1 Bit 3: CKS0 Description 0 0 0 Clock input is disabled 1 φ/2 clock source 0 φ/8 clock source 1 φ/32 clock source 1 1 0 1 0 φ/128 clock source 1 φ/512 clock source 0 φ/2048 clock source 1 φ/4096 clock source (Initial value) Bits 2 to 0—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. 7.2.3 Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT) RTCNT is an 8-bit readable/writable up-counter. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RTCNT is an up-counter that is incremented by an internal clock selected by bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR. When RTCNT matches RTCOR (compare match), the CMF flag is set to 1 and RTCNT is cleared to H'00. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 166 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller RTCNT is write-disabled when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1. RTCNT is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. 7.2.4 Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR) RTCOR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that determines the interval at which RTCNT is compare matched. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RTCOR and RTCNT are constantly compared. When their values match, the CMF flag is set to 1 in RTMCSR, and RTCNT is simultaneously cleared to H'00. RTCOR is write-disabled when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1. RTCOR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous value. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 167 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.3 Operation 7.3.1 Overview One of three functions can be selected for the H8/3048 Group refresh controller: interfacing to DRAM connected to area 3, interfacing to pseudo-static RAM connected to area 3, or interval timing. Table 7.3 summarizes the register settings when these three functions are used. Table 7.3 Refresh Controller Settings Usage Register Settings DRAM Interface PSRAM Interface Interval Timer RFSHCR SRFMD Selects self-refresh mode Selects self-refresh mode Cleared to 0 PSRAME Cleared to 0 Set to 1 Cleared to 0 DRAME Set to 1 Cleared to 0 Cleared to 0 CAS/WE Selects 2CAS or 2WE mode — — M9/M8 Selects column addressing mode — — RFSHE Selects RFSH signal output Selects RFSH signal output Cleared to 0 RCYCE Selects insertion of refresh cycles Selects insertion of refresh cycles — Refresh interval setting Refresh interval setting Interrupt interval setting CMF Set to 1 when RTCNT = RTCOR Set to 1 when RTCNT = RTCOR Set to 1 when RTCNT = RTCOR CMIE Cleared to 0 Cleared to 0 Enables or disables interrupt requests P8DDR P81DDR Set to 1 (CS3 output) Set to 1 (CS3 output) Set to 0 or 1 ABWCR ABW3 Cleared to 0 — — RTCOR RTMCSR CKS2 to CKS0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 168 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller DRAM Interface: To set up area 3 for connection to 16-bit-wide DRAM, initialize RTCOR, RTMCSR, and RFSHCR in that order, clearing bit PSRAME to 0 and setting bit DRAME to 1. Set bit P81DDR to 1 in the port 8 data direction register (P8DDR) to enable CS3 output. In ABWCR, make area 3 a 16-bit-access area. Pseudo-Static RAM Interface: To set up area 3 for connection to pseudo-static RAM, initialize RTCOR, RTMCSR, and RFSHCR in that order, setting bit PSRAME to 1 and clearing bit DRAME to 0. Set bit P81DDR to 1 in P8DDR to enable CS3 output. Interval Timer: When PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 0, the refresh controller operates as an interval timer. After setting RTCOR, select an input clock in RTMCSR and set the CMIE bit to 1. CMI interrupts will be requested at compare match intervals determined by RTCOR and bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR. When setting RTCOR, RTMCSR, and RFSHCR, make sure that PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 0. Writing is disabled when either of these bits is set to 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 169 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.3.2 DRAM Refresh Control Refresh Request Interval and Refresh Cycle Execution: The refresh request interval is determined by the settings of RTCOR and bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR. Figure 7.2 illustrates the refresh request interval. RTCOR RTCNT H'00 Refresh request Figure 7.2 Refresh Request Interval (RCYCE = 1) Refresh requests are generated at regular intervals as shown in figure 7.2, but the refresh cycle is not actually executed until the refresh controller gets the bus right. Table 7.4 summarizes the relationship among area 3 settings, DRAM read/write cycles, and refresh cycles. Table 7.4 Area 3 Settings, DRAM Access Cycles, and Refresh Cycles Read/Write Cycle by CPU or DMAC Refresh Cycle 2-state-access area (AST3 = 0) 3 states 3 states Wait states cannot be inserted Wait states cannot be inserted 3-state-access area (AST3 = 1) 3 states 3 states Wait states can be inserted Wait states can be inserted Area 3 Settings To insert refresh cycles, set the RCYCE bit to 1 in RFSHCR. Figure 7.3 shows the state transitions for execution of refresh cycles. When the first refresh request occurs after exit from the reset state or standby mode, the refresh controller does not execute a refresh cycle, but goes into the refresh request pending state. Note this point when using a DRAM that requires a refresh cycle for initialization. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 170 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller When a refresh request occurs in the refresh request pending state, the refresh controller acquires the bus right, then executes a refresh cycle. If another refresh request occurs during execution of the refresh cycle, it is ignored. Exit from reset or standby mode Refresh request Refresh request pending state End of refresh cycle* Refresh request Refresh request * Requesting bus right Bus granted Refresh request * Executing refresh cycle Note: * A refresh request is ignored if it occurs while the refresh controller is requesting the bus right or executing a refresh cycle. Figure 7.3 State Transitions for Refresh Cycle Execution Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 171 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Address Multiplexing: Address multiplexing depends on the setting of the M9/M8 bit in RFSHCR, as described in table 7.5. Figure 7.4 shows the address output timing. Address output is multiplexed only in area 3. Table 7.5 Address Multiplexing Address Pins A23 to A9 A10 Address signals during row address output A23 to A10 Address signals during column address output M9/M8 = 0 M9/M8 = 1 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 A23 to A10 A9 A9 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A0 A23 to A10 A18 A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A0 T1 T2 T3 φ A 23 to A 9, A 0 A 23 to A 9 , A 0 Address bus A 8 to A 1 A 8 to A1 A 16 to A 9 Row address Column address a. M9/ M8 = 0 T1 T2 T3 φ A 23 to A10 , A 0 A 23 to A10 , A 0 Address bus A 9 to A 1 A 9 to A1 A 18 to A 10 Row address Column address b. M9/ M8 = 1 Figure 7.4 Multiplexed Address Output (Example without Wait States) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 172 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 2CAS CAS and 2WE WE Modes: The CAS/WE bit in RFSHCR can select two control modes for 16-bitwide DRAM: one using UCAS and LCAS; the other using UW and LW. These DRAM pins correspond to H8/3048 Group pins as shown in table 7.6. Table 7.6 DRAM Pins and H8/3048 Group Pins DRAM Pin H8/3048 Group Pin CAS/WE WE = 0 (2WE WE Mode) CAS/WE WE = 1 (2CAS CAS Mode) HWR UW UCAS LWR LW LCAS RD CAS WE CS3 RAS RAS Figure 7.5 (1) shows the interface timing for 2WE DRAM. Figure 7.5 (2) shows the interface timing for 2CAS DRAM. Read cycle Write cycle* Refresh cycle φ Address bus Row Column Row Column Area 3 top address CS 3 (RAS ) RD (CAS ) HWR (UW ) LWR (LW ) RFSH AS Note: * 16-bit access Figure 7.5(1) DRAM Control Signal Output Timing (2WE WE Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 173 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Read cycle Write cycle* Refresh cycle φ Address bus Row Column Row Column Area 3 top address CS3 (RAS) HWR (UCAS) HWR (UW) LWR (LW) RFSH AS Note: * 16-bit access Figure 7.5(2) DRAM Control Signal Output Timing (2CAS CAS Mode) Refresh Cycle Priority Order: When there are simultaneous bus requests, the priority order is: (High) External bus master > refresh controller > DMA controller > CPU (Low) For details see section 6.3.7, Bus Arbiter Operation. Wait State Insertion: When bit AST3 is set to 1 in ASTCR, bus controller settings can cause wait states to be inserted into bus cycles and refresh cycles. For details see section 6.3.5, Wait Modes. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 174 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Self-Refresh Mode: Some DRAM devices have a self-refresh function. After the SRFMD bit is set to 1 in RFSHCR, when a transition to software standby mode occurs, the CAS and RAS outputs go low in that order so that the DRAM self-refresh function can be used. On exit from software standby mode, the CAS and RAS outputs both go high. Table 7.7 shows the pin states in software standby mode. Figure 7.6 shows the signal output timing. Table 7.7 Pin States in Software Standby Mode (1) (PSRAME = 0, DRAME = 1) Software Standby Mode SRFMD = 0 SRFMD = 1 (self-refresh mode) Signal CAS/WE WE = 0 CAS/WE WE = 1 CAS/WE WE = 0 CAS/WE WE = 1 HWR High-impedance High-impedance High Low LWR High-impedance High-impedance High Low RD High-impedance High-impedance Low High CS3 High High Low Low RFSH High High Low Low Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 175 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Software standby mode Oscillator settling time φ High-impedance Address bus CS 3 (RAS) RD (CAS) HWR (UW) High LWR (LW) High RFSH a. 2 WE mode (SRFMD = 1) Software standby mode Oscillator settling time φ Address bus High-impedance CS 3 (RAS) HWR (UCAS) LWR (LCAS) RD (WE) RFSH b. 2 CAS mode (SRFMD = 1) Figure 7.6 Signal Output Timing in Self-Refresh Mode (PSRAME = 0, DRAME = 1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 176 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Operation in Power-Down State: The refresh controller operates in sleep mode. It does not operate in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode RTCNT is initialized, but RFSHCR, RTMCSR bits 5 to 3, and RTCOR retain their settings prior to the transition to software standby mode. Example 1: Connection to 2WE WE 1-Mbit DRAM (1-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7.7 shows typical interconnections to a 2WE 1-Mbit DRAM, and the corresponding address map. Figure 7.8 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example. After power-up the DRAM must be refreshed to initialize its internal state. Initialization takes a certain length of time, which can be measured by using an interrupt from another timer module, or by counting the number of times RTMCSR bit 7 (CMF) is set. Note that no refresh cycle is executed for the first refresh request after exit from the reset state or standby mode (the first time the CMF flag is set; see figure 7.3). When using this example, check the DRAM device characteristics carefully and use a procedure that fits them. 2 WE 1-Mbit DRAM with × 16-bit organization H8/3048 Group A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 CS 3 RD HWR LWR RAS CAS UW LW OE D15 to D 0 I/O 15 to I/O 0 a. Interconnections (example) H'60000 DRAM area Area 3 (1-Mbyte mode) H'7FFFF b. Address map Figure 7.7 Interconnections and Address Map for 2WE WE 1-Mbit DRAM (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 177 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Set area 3 for 16-bit access Set P81 DDR to 1 for 3 output Set RTCOR Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR Write H'23 in RFSHCR Wait for DRAM to be initialized DRAM can be accessed Figure 7.8 Setup Procedure for 2WE WE 1-Mbit DRAM (1-Mbyte Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 178 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Example 2: Connection to 2WE WE 4-Mbit DRAM (16-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7.9 shows typical interconnections to a single 2WE 4-Mbit DRAM, and the corresponding address map. Figure 7.10 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example. The DRAM in this example has 10-bit row addresses and 8-bit column addresses. Its address area is H'600000 to H'67FFFF. 2 WE 4-Mbit DRAM with 10-bit row address, 8-bit column address, and × 16-bit organization H8/3048 Group A18 A17 A9 A8 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 CS 3 RD HWR LWR RAS CAS UW LW OE D15 to D 0 I/O 15 to I/O 0 a. Interconnections (example) H'600000 DRAM area H'67FFFF H'680000 Area 3 (16-Mbyte mode) Not used H'7FFFFF b. Address map Figure 7.9 Interconnections and Address Map for 2WE WE 4-Mbit DRAM (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 179 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Set area 3 for 16-bit access Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS3 output Set RTCOR Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR Write H'23 in RFSHCR Wait for DRAM to be initialized DRAM can be accessed Figure 7.10 Setup Procedure for 2WE WE 4-Mbit DRAM with 10-Bit Row Address and 8-Bit Column Address (16-Mbyte Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 180 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Example 3: Connection to 2CAS CAS 4-Mbit DRAM (16-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7.11 shows typical interconnections to a single 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM, and the corresponding address map. Figure 7.12 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example. The DRAM in this example has 9-bit row addresses and 9-bit column addresses. Its address area is H'600000 to H'67FFFF. 2 CAS 4-Mbit DRAM with 9-bit row address, 9-bit column address, and × 16-bit organization A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 H8/3048 Group A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 CS 3 HWR LWR RD RAS UCAS LCAS WE OE D15 to D 0 I/O 15 to I/O 0 a. Interconnections (example) H'600000 DRAM area H'67FFFF H'680000 Not used Area 3 (16-Mbyte mode) H'7FFFFF b. Address map Figure 7.11 Interconnections and Address Map for 2CAS CAS 4-Mbit DRAM (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 181 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Set area 3 for 16-bit access Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS3 output Set RTCOR Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR Write H'3B in RFSHCR Wait for DRAM to be initialized DRAM can be accessed Figure 7.12 Setup Procedure for 2CAS CAS 4-Mbit DRAM with 9-Bit Row Address and 9-Bit Column Address (16-Mbyte Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 182 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Example 4: Connection to Multiple 4-Mbit DRAM Chips (16-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7.13 shows an example of interconnections to two 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM chips, and the corresponding address map. Up to four DRAM chips can be connected to area 3 by decoding upper address bits A19 and A20. Figure 7.14 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example. The DRAM in this example has 9-bit row addresses and 9-bit column addresses. Both chips must be refreshed simultaneously, so the RFSH pin must be used. 2 CAS 4-Mbit DRAM with 9-bit row address, 9-bit column address, and × 16-bit organization A 8 to A 0 H8/3048 Group RAS A19 A 9 to A 1 UCAS No. 1 LCAS WE OE I/O15 to I/O 0 A 8 to A 0 CS 3 RAS HWR UCAS LWR RD LCAS WE RFSH No. 2 OE D15 to D 0 I/O15 to I/O 0 a. Interconnections (example) H'600000 H'67FFFF H'680000 H'6FFFFF H'700000 No. 1 DRAM area No. 2 DRAM area Area 3 (16-Mbyte mode) Not used H'7FFFFF b. Address map Figure 7.13 Interconnections and Address Map for Multiple 2CAS CAS 4-Mbit DRAM Chips (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 183 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Set area 3 for 16-bit access Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS 3 output Set RTCOR Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR Write H'3F in RFSHCR Wait for DRAM to be initialized DRAM can be accessed Figure 7.14 Setup Procedure for Multiple 2CAS CAS 4-Mbit DRAM Chips with 9-Bit Row Address and 9-Bit Column Address (16-Mbyte Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 184 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.3.3 Pseudo-Static RAM Refresh Control Refresh Request Interval and Refresh Cycle Execution: The refresh request interval is determined as in a DRAM interface, by the settings of RTCOR and bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR. The numbers of states required for pseudo-static RAM read/write cycles and refresh cycles are the same as for DRAM (see table 7.4). The state transitions are as shown in figure 7.3. Pseudo-Static RAM Control Signals: Figure 7.15 shows the control signals for pseudo-static RAM read, write, and refresh cycles. Read cycle Write cycle * Refresh cycle φ Address bus Area 3 top address CS 3 RD HWR LWR RFSH AS Note: * 16-bit access Figure 7.15 Pseudo-Static RAM Control Signal Output Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 185 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Refresh Cycle Priority Order: When there are simultaneous bus requests, the priority order is: (High) External bus master > refresh controller > DMA controller > CPU (Low) For details see section 6.3.7, Bus Arbiter Operation. Wait State Insertion: When bit AST3 is set to 1 in ASTCR, the wait state controller (WSC) can insert wait states into bus cycles and refresh cycles. For details see section 6.3.5, Wait Modes. Self-Refresh Mode: Some pseudo-static RAM devices have a self-refresh function. After the SRFMD bit is set to 1 in RFSHCR, when a transition to software standby mode occurs, the H8/3048 Group’ CS3 output goes high and its RFSH output goes low so that the pseudo-static RAM self-refresh function can be used. On exit from software standby mode, the RFSH output goes high. Table 7.8 shows the pin states in software standby mode. Figure 7.16 shows the signal output timing. Table 7.8 Pin States in Software Standby Mode (2) (PSRAME = 1, DRAME = 0) Software Standby Mode Signal SRFMD = 0 SRFMD = 1 (Self-Refresh Mode) CS3 High High RD High-impedance High-impedance HWR High-impedance High-impedance LWR High-impedance High-impedance RFSH High Low Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 186 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Software standby mode Oscillator settling time φ High-impedance Address bus CS3 High High-impedance RD High-impedance HWR High-impedance LWR RFSH Figure 7.16 Signal Output Timing in Self-Refresh Mode (PSRAME = 1, DRAME = 0) Operation in Power-Down State: The refresh controller operates in sleep mode. It does not operate in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode RTCNT is initialized, but RFSHCR, RTMCSR bits 5 to 3, and RTCOR retain their settings prior to the transition to software standby mode. Example: Pseudo-static RAM may have separate OE and RFSH pins, or these may be combined into a single OE/RFSH pin. Figure 7.17 shows an example of a circuit for generating an OE/RFSH signal. Check the device characteristics carefully, and design a circuit that fits them. Figure 7.18 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program. H8/3048 Group PSRAM RD OE/RFSH RFSH Figure 7.17 Interconnection to Pseudo-Static RAM with OE/RFSH OE RFSH Signal (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 187 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS 3 output Set RTCOR Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR Write H'47 in RFSHCR Wait for PSRAM to be initialized PSRAM can be accessed Figure 7.18 Setup Procedure for Pseudo-Static RAM Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 188 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.3.4 Interval Timer To use the refresh controller as an interval timer, clear the PSRAME and DRAME both to 0. After setting RTCOR, select a clock source with bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR, and set the CMIE bit to 1. Timing of Setting of Compare Match Flag and Clearing by Compare Match: The CMF flag in RTCSR is set to 1 by a compare match signal output when the RTCOR and RTCNT values match. The compare match signal is generated in the last state in which the values match (when RTCNT is updated from the matching value to a new value). Accordingly, when RTCNT and RTCOR match, the compare match signal is not generated until the next counter clock pulse. Figure 7.19 shows the timing. φ RTCNT RTCOR N H'00 N Compare match signal CMF flag Figure 7.19 Timing of Setting of CMF Flag Operation in Power-Down State: The interval timer function operates in sleep mode. It does not operate in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode RTCNT and RTMCSR bits 7 and 6 are initialized, but RTMCSR bits 5 to 3 and RTCOR retain their settings prior to the transition to software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 189 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Contention between RTCNT Write and Counter Clear: If a counter clear signal occurs in the T3 state of an RTCNT write cycle, clearing of the counter takes priority and the write is not performed. See figure 7.20. RTCNT write cycle by CPU T2 T1 T3 φ Address bus RTCNT address Internal write signal Counter clear signal RTCNT N H'00 Figure 7.20 Contention between RTCNT Write and Clear Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 190 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Contention between RTCNT Write and Increment: If an increment pulse occurs in the T3 state of an RTCNT write cycle, writing takes priority and RTCNT is not incremented. See figure 7.21. RTCNT write cycle by CPU T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus RTCNT address Internal write signal RTCNT input clock RTCNT N M Counter write data Figure 7.21 Contention between RTCNT Write and Increment Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 191 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Contention between RTCOR Write and Compare Match: If a compare match occurs in the T3 state of an RTCOR write cycle, writing takes priority and the compare match signal is inhibited. See figure 7.22. RTCOR write cycle by CPU T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus RTCNT address Internal write signal RTCNT N N+1 RTCOR N M RTCOR write data Compare match signal Inhibited Figure 7.22 Contention between RTCOR Write and Compare Match RTCNT Operation at Internal Clock Source Switchover: Switching internal clock sources may cause RTCNT to increment, depending on the switchover timing. Table 7.9 shows the relation between the time of the switchover (by writing to bits CKS2 to CKS0) and the operation of RTCNT. The RTCNT input clock is generated from the internal clock source by detecting the falling edge of the internal clock. If a switchover is made from a high clock source to a low clock source, as in case No. 3 in table 7.9, the switchover will be regarded as a falling edge, an RTCNT clock pulse will be generated, and RTCNT will be incremented. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 192 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Table 7.9 Internal Clock Switchover and RTCNT Operation No. CKS2 to CKS0 Write Timing 1 Low → low switchover* RTCNT Operation 1 Old clock source New clock source RTCNT clock RTCNT N N+1 CKS bits rewritten 2 Low → high switchover* 2 Old clock source New clock source RTCNT clock RTCNT N N+1 N+2 CKS bits rewritten Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 193 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller No. CKS2 to CKS0 Write Timing 3 High → low RTCNT Operation switchover*3 Old clock source New clock source *4 RTCNT clock RTCNT N N+1 N+2 CKS bits rewritten 4 High → high switchover*4 Old clock source New clock source RTCNT clock RTCNT N N+1 N+2 CKS bits rewritten Notes: 1. Including switchovers from a low clock source to the halted state, and from the halted state to a low clock source. 2. Including switchover from the halted state to a high clock source. 3. Including switchover from a high clock source to the halted state. 4. The switchover is regarded as a falling edge, causing RTCNT to increment. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 194 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller 7.4 Interrupt Source Compare match interrupts (CMI) can be generated when the refresh controller is used as an interval timer. Compare match interrupt requests are masked/unmasked with the CMIE bit of RTMCSR. 7.5 Usage Notes When using the DRAM or pseudo-static RAM refresh function, note the following points: • With the refresh controller, if directly connected DRAM or PSRAM is disconnected*, the P80/RFSH/IRQ0 pin and the P81/CS3/IRQ1 pin may both become low-level outputs simultaneously. Note: * When the DRAM enable bit (DRAME) or PSRAM enable bit (PSRAME) in the refresh control register (RFSHCR) is cleared to 0 after being set to 1. Address bus Area 3 start address P80/RFSH/IRQ0 P81/CS3/IRQ1 Figure 7.23 Operation when DRAM/PSRAM Connection is Switched • Refresh cycles are not executed while the bus is released, during software standby mode, and when a bus cycle is greatly prolonged by insertion of wait states. When these conditions occur, other means of refreshing are required. • If refresh requests occur while the bus is released, the first request is held and one refresh cycle is executed after the bus-released state ends. Figure 7.24 shows the bus cycles in this case. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 195 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 7 Refresh Controller Bus-released state Refresh cycle CPU cycle Refresh cycle φ RFSH Refresh request BACK Figure 7.24 Refresh Cycles when Bus is Released • If a bus cycle is prolonged by insertion of wait states, the first refresh request is held, as in the bus-released state. • If there is contention with a bus request from an external bus master when making a transition to software standby mode, a one-state bus-released state may occur immediately before the transition to software standby mode (see figure 7.25). When using software standby mode, clear the BRLE bit to 0 in BRCR before executing the SLEEP instruction. When making a transition to self-refresh mode, the strobe waveform output may not be guaranteed due to the same kind of contention. This, too, can be prevented by clearing the BRLE bit to 0 in BRCR. External bus released state Software standby mode φ BREQ BACK Address bus Strobe Figure 7.25 Contention between Bus-Released State and Software Standby Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 196 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Section 8 DMA Controller 8.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has an on-chip DMA controller (DMAC) that can transfer data on up to four channels. When the DMA controller is not used, it can be independently halted to conserve power. For details see section 21.6, Module Standby Function. 8.1.1 Features DMAC features are listed below. • Selection of short address mode or full address mode Short address mode 8-bit source address and 24-bit destination address, or vice versa Maximum four channels available Selection of I/O mode, idle mode, or repeat mode Full address mode 24-bit source and destination addresses Maximum two channels available Selection of normal mode or block transfer mode • Directly addressable 16-Mbyte address space • Selection of byte or word transfer • Activation by internal interrupts, external requests, or auto-request (depending on transfer mode) 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) compare match/input capture interrupts (four) Serial communication interface (SCI channel 0) transmit-data-empty/receive-data-full interrupts External requests Auto-request Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 197 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 8.1 shows a DMAC block diagram. Internal address bus Address buffer IMIA0 IMIA1 IMIA2 IMIA3 TXI0 RXI0 DREQ0 DREQ1 TEND0 TEND1 Arithmetic-logic unit MAR0A Channel 0A Control logic Channel 0 MAR0B Channel 0B DTCR0A Interrupt DEND0A signals DEND0B DEND1A DEND1B ETCR0B Channel 1A DTCR1A MAR1B Internal data bus Legend DTCR: Data transfer control register MAR: Memory address register IOAR: I/O address register ETCR: Execute transfer count register Figure 8.1 Block Diagram of DMAC Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 198 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 IOAR1A ETCR1A Channel 1 Channel 1B Data buffer IOAR0B MAR1A DTCR0B DTCR1B IOAR0A ETCR0A IOAR1B ETCR1B Module data bus Internal interrupts Section 8 DMA Controller 8.1.3 Functional Overview Table 8.1 gives an overview of the DMAC functions. Table 8.1 DMAC Functional Overview Address Reg. Length Transfer Mode Activation Source Destination Short address mode • Compare match/ input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3 24 8 • Transmit-data-empty interrupt from SCI channel 0 • Receive-data-full interrupt from SCI channel 0 8 24 • External request 24 8 I/O mode • Transfers one byte or one word per request • Increments or decrements the memory address by 1 or 2 • Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers Idle mode • Transfers one byte or one word per request • Holds the memory address fixed • Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers Repeat mode • Transfers one byte or one word per request • Increments or decrements the memory address by 1 or 2 • Executes a specified number (1 to 255) of transfers, then returns to the initial state and continues Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 199 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Address Reg. Length Transfer Mode Activation Source Destination Full address mode Normal mode • Auto-request 24 24 • • External request • Compare match/ input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3 24 24 • External request Auto-request Retains the transfer request internally Executes a specified number (1 to 65,536) of transfers continuously Selection of burst mode or cycle-steal mode • External request Transfers one byte or one word per request Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers Block transfer • Transfers one block of a specified size per request • Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers • Allows either the source or destination to be a fixed block area • Block size can be 1 to 255 bytes or words Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 200 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.1.4 Input/Output Pins Table 8.2 lists the DMAC pins. Table 8.2 DMAC Pins Channel Name Abbreviation Input/ Output Function 0 DMA request 0 DREQ0 Input External request for DMAC channel 0 Transfer end 0 TEND0 Output Transfer end on DMAC channel 0 DMA request 1 DREQ1 Input External request for DMAC channel 1 Transfer end 1 TEND1 Output Transfer end on DMAC channel 1 1 Note: External requests cannot be made to channel A in short address mode. 8.1.5 Register Configuration Table 8.3 lists the DMAC registers. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 201 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Table 8.3 DMAC Registers Channel Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value 0 H'FF20 Memory address register 0AR MAR0AR R/W Undetermined H'FF21 Memory address register 0AE MAR0AE R/W Undetermined H'FF22 Memory address register 0AH MAR0AH R/W Undetermined H'FF23 Memory address register 0AL MAR0AL R/W Undetermined H'FF26 I/O address register 0A IOAR0A R/W Undetermined H'FF24 Execute transfer count register 0AH ETCR0AH R/W Undetermined H'FF25 Execute transfer count register 0AL ETCR0AL R/W Undetermined 1 H'FF27 Data transfer control register 0A DTCR0A R/W H'00 H'FF28 Memory address register 0BR MAR0BR R/W Undetermined H'FF29 Memory address register 0BE MAR0BE R/W Undetermined H'FF2A Memory address register 0BH MAR0BH R/W Undetermined H'FF2B Memory address register 0BL MAR0BL R/W Undetermined H'FF2E I/O address register 0B IOAR0B R/W Undetermined H'FF2C Execute transfer count register 0BH ETCR0BH R/W Undetermined H'FF2D Execute transfer count register 0BL ETCR0BL R/W Undetermined H'FF2F Data transfer control register 0B DTCR0B R/W H'00 H'FF30 Memory address register 1AR MAR1AR R/W Undetermined H'FF31 Memory address register 1AE MAR1AE R/W Undetermined H'FF32 Memory address register 1AH MAR1AH R/W Undetermined H'FF33 Memory address register 1AL MAR1AL R/W Undetermined H'FF36 I/O address register 1A IOAR1A R/W Undetermined H'FF34 Execute transfer count register 1AH ETCR1AH R/W Undetermined H'FF35 Execute transfer count register 1AL ETCR1AL R/W Undetermined H'FF37 Data transfer control register 1A DTCR1A R/W H'00 H'FF38 Memory address register 1BR MAR1BR R/W Undetermined H'FF39 Memory address register 1BE MAR1BE R/W Undetermined H'FF3A Memory address register 1BH MAR1BH R/W Undetermined H'FF3B Memory address register 1BL MAR1BL R/W Undetermined H'FF3E I/O address register 1B IOAR1B R/W Undetermined H'FF3C Execute transfer count register 1BH ETCR1BH R/W Undetermined H'FF3D Execute transfer count register 1BL ETCR1BL R/W Undetermined H'FF3F Data transfer control register 1B R/W H'00 Note: * The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 202 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 DTCR1B Section 8 DMA Controller 8.2 Register Descriptions (Short Address Mode) In short address mode, transfers can be carried out independently on channels A and B. Short address mode is selected by bits DTS2A and DTS1A in data transfer control register A (DTCRA) as indicated in table 8.4. Table 8.4 Selection of Short and Full Address Modes Channel Bit 2: DTS2A Bit 1: DTS1A 0 1 1 1 Other than above DMAC channels 0A and 0B operate as two independent channels in short address mode 1 DMAC channel 1 operates as one channel in full address mode 1 Other than above 8.2.1 Description DMAC channel 0 operates as one channel in full address mode DMAC channels 1A and 1B operate as two independent channels in short address mode Memory Address Registers (MAR) A memory address register (MAR) is a 32-bit readable/writable register that specifies a source or destination address. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. An MAR consists of four 8-bit registers designated MARR, MARE, MARH, and MARL. All bits of MARR are reserved: they cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Initial value 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 1 1 1 1 MARR 1 1 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Undetermined MARE MARH MARL Source or destination address An MAR functions as a source or destination address register depending on how the DMAC is activated: as a destination address register if activation is by a receive-data-full interrupt from the serial communication interface (SCI) (channel 0), and as a source address register otherwise. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 203 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller The MAR value is incremented or decremented each time one byte or word is transferred, automatically updating the source or destination memory address. For details, see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). The MARs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode. 8.2.2 I/O Address Registers (IOAR) An I/O address register (IOAR) is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies a source or destination address. The IOAR value is the lower 8 bits of the address. The upper 16 address bits are all 1 (H'FFFF). Bit 7 6 5 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined Initial value Read/Write 4 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Source or destination address An IOAR functions as a source or destination address register depending on how the DMAC is activated: as a source address register if activation is by a receive-data-full interrupt from the SCI (channel 0), and as a destination address register otherwise. The IOAR value is held fixed. It is not incremented or decremented when a transfer is executed. The IOARs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 204 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.2.3 Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR) An execute transfer count register (ETCR) is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the number of transfers to be executed. These registers function in one way in I/O mode and idle mode, and another way in repeat mode. • I/O mode and idle mode Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Transfer counter In I/O mode and idle mode, ETCR functions as a 16-bit counter. The count is decremented by 1 each time one transfer is executed. The transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000. • Repeat mode Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCRH Transfer counter Bit 7 6 5 R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 4 3 Undetermined R/W R/W ETCRL Initial count In repeat mode, ETCRH functions as an 8-bit transfer counter and ETCRL holds the initial transfer count. ETCRH is decremented by 1 each time one transfer is executed. When ETCRH reaches H'00, the value in ETCRL is reloaded into ETCRH and the same operation is repeated. The ETCRs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 205 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.2.4 Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR) A data transfer control register (DTCR) is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the operation of one DMAC channel. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer enable Enables or disables data transfer Data transfer select These bits select the data transfer activation source Data transfer size Selects byte or word size Data transfer interrupt enable Enables or disables the CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer Data transfer increment/decrement Selects whether to increment or decrement the memory address register Repeat enable Selects repeat mode The DTCRs are initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Data Transfer Enable (DTE): Enables or disables data transfer on a channel. When the DTE bit is set to 1, the channel waits for a transfer to be requested, and executes the transfer when activated as specified by bits DTS2 to DTS0. When DTE is 0, the channel is disabled and does not accept transfer requests. DTE is set to 1 by reading the register when DTE is 0, then writing 1. Bit 7: DTE Description 0 Data transfer is disabled. In I/O mode or idle mode, DTE is cleared to 0 when the specified number of transfers have been completed. (Initial value) 1 Data transfer is enabled If DTIE is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested when DTE is cleared to 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 206 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Bit 6—Data Transfer Size (DTSZ): Selects the data size of each transfer. Bit 6: DTSZ Description 0 Byte-size transfer 1 Word-size transfer (Initial value) Bit 5—Data Transfer Increment/Decrement (DTID): Selects whether to increment or decrement the memory address register (MAR) after a data transfer in I/O mode or repeat mode. Bit 5: DTID Description 0 MAR is incremented after each data transfer 1 • If DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after each transfer • If DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after each transfer MAR is decremented after each data transfer • If DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after each transfer • If DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after each transfer MAR is not incremented or decremented in idle mode. Bit 4—Repeat Enable (RPE): Selects whether to transfer data in I/O mode, idle mode, or repeat mode. Bit 4: RPE Bit 3: DTIE Description 0 0 I/O mode (Initial value) 1 1 0 Repeat mode 1 Idle mode Operations in these modes are described in sections 8.4.2, I/O Mode, 8.4.3, Idle Mode, and 8.4.4, Repeat Mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 207 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Bit 3—Data Transfer Interrupt Enable (DTIE): Enables or disables the CPU interrupt (DEND) requested when the DTE bit is cleared to 0. Bit 3: DTIE Description 0 The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is disabled 1 The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is enabled (Initial value) Bits 2 to 0—Data Transfer Select (DTS2, DTS1, DTS0): These bits select the data transfer activation source. Some of the selectable sources differ between channels A and B.* Note: * Refer to section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). Bit 2: DTS2 Bit 1: DTS1 Bit 0: DTS0 Description 0 0 0 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0 (Initial value) 1 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1 0 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2 1 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3 0 Transmit-data-empty interrupt from SCI channel 0 1 Receive-data-full interrupt from SCI channel 0 0 Falling edge of DREQ input (channel B) 1 1 0 1 Transfer in full address mode (channel A) 1 Low level of DREQ input (channel B) Transfer in full address mode (channel A) The same internal interrupt can be selected as an activation source for two or more channels at once. In that case the channels are activated in a priority order, highest-priority channel first. For the priority order, see section 8.4.9, DMAC Multiple-Channel Operation. When a channel is enabled (DTE = 1), its selected DMAC activation source cannot generate a CPU interrupt. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 208 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.3 Register Descriptions (Full Address Mode) In full address mode the A and B channels operate together. Full address mode is selected as indicated in table 8.4. 8.3.1 Memory Address Registers (MAR) A memory address register (MAR) is a 32-bit readable/writable register. MARA functions as the source address register of the transfer, and MARB as the destination address register. An MAR consists of four 8-bit registers designated MARR, MARE, MARH, and MARL. All bits of MARR are reserved: they cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Initial value 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 1 1 1 1 MARR 1 1 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Undetermined MARE MARH MARL Source or destination address The MAR value is incremented or decremented each time one byte or word is transferred, automatically updating the source or destination memory address. For details, see section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). The MARs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode. 8.3.2 I/O Address Registers (IOAR) The I/O address registers (IOARs) are not used in full address mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 209 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.3.3 Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR) An execute transfer count register (ETCR) is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the number of transfers to be executed. The functions of these registers differ between normal mode and block transfer mode. • Normal mode ETCRA Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Transfer counter ETCRB: Is not used in normal mode. In normal mode ETCRA functions as a 16-bit transfer counter. The count is decremented by 1 each time one transfer is executed. The transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000. ETCRB is not used. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 210 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller • Block transfer mode ETCRA Bit 7 6 5 4 Initial value Read/Write 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCRAH Block size counter Bit 7 6 5 4 Initial value Read/Write 3 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCRAL Initial block size ETCRB Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Block transfer counter In block transfer mode, ETCRAH functions as an 8-bit block size counter. ETCRAL holds the initial block size. ETCRAH is decremented by 1 each time one byte or word is transferred. When the count reaches H'00, ETCRAH is reloaded from ETCRAL. Blocks consisting of an arbitrary number of bytes or words can be transferred repeatedly by setting the same initial block size value in ETCRAH and ETCRAL. In block transfer mode ETCRB functions as a 16-bit block transfer counter. ETCRB is decremented by 1 each time one block is transferred. The transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000. The ETCRs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 211 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.3.4 Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR) The data transfer control registers (DTCRs) are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control the operation of the DMAC channels. A channel operates in full address mode when bits DTS2A and DTS1A are both set to 1 in DTCRA. DTCRA and DTCRB have different functions in full address mode. DTCRA Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ SAID SAIDE DTIE DTS2A DTS1A DTS0A Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer enable Enables or disables data transfer Data transfer size Selects byte or word size Data transfer interrupt enable Enables or disables the CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer Source address increment/decrement Source address increment/ decrement enable These bits select whether the source address register (MARA) is incremented, decremented, or held fixed during the data transfer DTCRA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 212 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Data transfer select 0A Selects block transfer mode Data transfer select 2A and 1A These bits must both be set to 1 Section 8 DMA Controller Bit 7—Data Transfer Enable (DTE): Together with the DTME bit in DTCRB, this bit enables or disables data transfer on the channel. When the DTME and DTE bits are both set to 1, the channel is enabled. If auto-request is specified, data transfer begins immediately. Otherwise, the channel waits for transfers to be requested. When the specified number of transfers have been completed, the DTE bit is automatically cleared to 0. When DTE is 0, the channel is disabled and does not accept transfer requests. DTE is set to 1 by reading the register when DTE is 0, then writing 1. Bit 7: DTE Description 0 Data transfer is disabled (DTE is cleared to 0 when the specified number of transfers have been completed) (Initial value) 1 Data transfer is enabled If DTIE is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested when DTE is cleared to 0. Bit 6—Data Transfer Size (DTSZ): Selects the data size of each transfer. Bit 6: DTSZ Description 0 Byte-size transfer 1 Word-size transfer (Initial value) Bit 5—Source Address Increment/Decrement (SAID) and Bit 4—Source Address Increment/Decrement Enable (SAIDE): These bits select whether the source address register (MARA) is incremented, decremented, or held fixed during the data transfer. Bit 5: SAID Bit 4: SAIDE Description 0 0 MARA is held fixed 1 MARA is incremented after each data transfer 1 (Initial value) • If DTSZ = 0, MARA is incremented by 1 after each transfer • If DTSZ = 1, MARA is incremented by 2 after each transfer 0 MARA is held fixed 1 MARA is decremented after each data transfer • If DTSZ = 0, MARA is decremented by 1 after each transfer • If DTSZ = 1, MARA is decremented by 2 after each transfer Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 213 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Bit 3—Data Transfer Interrupt Enable (DTIE): Enables or disables the CPU interrupt (DEND) requested when the DTE bit is cleared to 0. Bit 3: DTIE Description 0 The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is disabled 1 The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is enabled (Initial value) Bits 2 and 1—Data Transfer Select 2A and 1A (DTS2A, DTS1A): A channel operates in full address mode when DTS2A and DTS1A are both set to 1. Bit 0—Data Transfer Select 0A (DTS0A): Selects normal mode or block transfer mode. Bit 0: DTS0A Description 0 Normal mode 1 Block transfer mode (Initial value) Operations in these modes are described in sections 8.4.5, Normal Mode, and 8.4.6, Block Transfer Mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 214 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller DTCRB Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTME — DAID DAIDE TMS DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer master enable Enables or disables data transfer, together with the DTE bit, and is cleared to 0 by an interrupt Reserved bit Transfer mode select Selects whether the block area is the source or destination in block transfer mode Destination address increment/decrement Destination address increment/decrement enable These bits select whether the destination address register (MARB) is incremented, decremented, or held fixed during the data transfer Data transfer select 2B to 0B These bits select the data transfer activation source DTCRB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Data Transfer Master Enable (DTME): Together with the DTE bit in DTCRA, this bit enables or disables data transfer. When the DTME and DTE bits are both set to 1, the channel is enabled. When an NMI interrupt occurs DTME is cleared to 0, suspending the transfer so that the CPU can use the bus. The suspended transfer resumes when DTME is set to 1 again. For further information on operation in block transfer mode, see section 8.6.6, NMI Interrupts and Block Transfer Mode. DTME is set to 1 by reading the register while DTME = 0, then writing 1. Bit 7: DTME Description 0 Data transfer is disabled (DTME is cleared to 0 when an NMI interrupt occurs) (Initial value) 1 Data transfer is enabled Bit 6—Reserved: Although reserved, this bit can be written and read. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 215 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Bit 5—Destination Address Increment/Decrement (DAID) and Bit 4—Destination Address Increment/Decrement Enable (DAIDE): These bits select whether the destination address register (MARB) is incremented, decremented, or held fixed during the data transfer. Bit 5: DAID Bit 4: DAIDE Description 0 0 MARB is held fixed 1 MARB is incremented after each data transfer 1 (Initial value) • If DTSZ = 0, MARB is incremented by 1 after each data transfer • If DTSZ = 1, MARB is incremented by 2 after each data transfe 0 MARB is held fixed 1 MARB is decremented after each data transfer • If DTSZ = 0, MARB is decremented by 1 after each data transfer • If DTSZ = 1, MARB is decremented by 2 after each data transfer Bit 3—Transfer Mode Select (TMS): Selects whether the source or destination is the block area in block transfer mode. Bit 3: TMS Description 0 Destination is the block area in block transfer mode 1 Source is the block area in block transfer mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 216 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 8 DMA Controller Bits 2 to 0—Data Transfer Select 2B to 0B (DTS2B, DTS1B, DTS0B): These bits select the data transfer activation source. The selectable activation sources differ between normal mode and block transfer mode. • Normal mode Bit 2: DTS2B Bit 1: DTS1B Bit 0: DTS0B Description 0 0 0 Auto-request (burst mode) 1 Cannot be used 1 0 Auto-request (cycle-steal mode) 1 Cannot be used 0 Cannot be used 1 Cannot be used 0 Falling edge of DREQ 1 Low level input at DREQ 1 0 1 (Initial value) • Block transfer mode Bit 2: DTS2B Bit 1: DTS1B Bit 0: DTS0B 0 0 0 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0 (Initial value) 1 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1 0 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2 1 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3 0 0 Cannot be used 1 Cannot be used 1 0 Falling edge of DREQ 1 Cannot be used 1 1 Description The same internal interrupt can be selected to activate two or more channels. The channels are activated in a priority order, highest priority first. For the priority order, see section 8.4.9, DMAC Multiple-Channel Operation. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 217 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4 Operation 8.4.1 Overview Table 8.5 summarizes the DMAC modes. Table 8.5 DMAC Modes Transfer Mode Short address mode I/O mode Idle mode Repeat mode Activation Notes Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channels 0 to 3 • Up to four channels can operate independently • Only the B channels support external requests • A and B channels are paired; up to two channels are available Transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts from SCI channel 0 External request Full address mode Normal mode Auto-request External request Block transfer mode Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU • channels 0 to 3 External request Burst mode or cycle-steal mode can be selected for auto-requests A summary of operations in these modes follows. I/O Mode: One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers are executed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the designated number of transfers. One 24-bit address and one 8-bit address are specified. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. Idle Mode: One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers are executed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the designated number of transfers. One 24-bit address and one 8-bit address are specified. The addresses are held fixed. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. Repeat Mode: One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers are executed. When the designated number of transfers are completed, the initial address and counter value are restored and operation continues. No CPU interrupt is requested. One 24-bit address and one 8-bit address are specified. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 218 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Normal Mode • Auto-request The DMAC is activated by register setup alone, and continues executing transfers until the designated number of transfers have been completed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the transfers. Both addresses are 24-bit addresses. Cycle-steal mode The bus is released to another bus master after each byte or word is transferred. Burst mode Unless requested by a higher-priority bus master, the bus is not released until the designated number of transfers have been completed. • External request One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers are executed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the designated number of transfers. Both addresses are 24-bit addresses. Block Transfer Mode: One block of a specified size is transferred per request. A designated number of block transfers are executed. At the end of each block transfer, one address is restored to its initial value. When the designated number of blocks have been transferred, a CPU interrupt can be requested. Both addresses are 24-bit addresses. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 219 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.2 I/O Mode I/O mode can be selected independently for each channel. One byte or word is transferred at each transfer request in I/O mode. A designated number of these transfers are executed. One address is specified in the memory address register (MAR), the other in the I/O address register (IOAR). The direction of transfer is determined automatically from the activation source. The transfer is from the address specified in IOAR to the address specified in MAR if activated by an SCI channel 0 receive-data-full interrupt, and from the address specified in MAR to the address specified in IOAR otherwise. Table 8.6 indicates the register functions in I/O mode. Table 8.6 Register Functions in I/O Mode Function Activated by SCI 0 ReceiveData-Full Other Interrupt Activation Register 23 7 All 1s Destination address register Source address register Destination or source address Incremented or decremented once per transfer 0 Source address register Destination address register Source or destination address Held fixed Transfer counter Transfer counter Number of transfers Decremented once per transfer until H'0000 is reached and transfer ends IOAR 15 0 ETCR Operation 0 MAR 23 Initial Setting Legend MAR: Memory address register IOAR: I/O address register ETCR: Execute transfer count register MAR and IOAR specify the source and destination addresses. MAR specifies a 24-bit source or destination address, which is incremented or decremented as each byte or word is transferred. IOAR specifies the lower 8 bits of a fixed address. The upper 16 bits are all 1s. IOAR is not incremented or decremented. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 220 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.2 illustrates how I/O mode operates. Transfer Address T IOAR 1 byte or word is transferred per request Address B Legend L = initial setting of MAR N = initial setting of ETCR Address T = L Address B = L + (–1) DTID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1) Figure 8.2 Operation in I/O Mode The transfer count is specified as a 16-bit value in ETCR. The ETCR value is decremented by 1 at each transfer. When the ETCR value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared and the transfer ends. If the DTIE bit is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested at this time. The maximum transfer count is 65,536, obtained by setting ETCR to H'0000. Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3, transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts from SCI channel 0, and external request signals. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 221 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller For the detailed settings see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). Figure 8.3 shows a sample setup procedure for I/O mode. I/O mode setup Set source and destination addresses 1 Set transfer count 2 Read DTCR 3 Set DTCR 4 1. Set the source and destination addresses in MAR and IOAR. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. 2. Set the transfer count in ETCR. 3. Read DTCR while the DTE bit is cleared to 0. 4. Set the DTCR bits as follows. • Select the DMAC activation source with bits DTS2 to DTS0. • Set or clear the DTIE bit to enable or disable the CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer. • Clear the RPE bit to 0 to select I/O mode. • Select MAR increment or decrement with the DTID bit. • Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit. • Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable the transfer. I/O mode Figure 8.3 I/O Mode Setup Procedure (Example) 8.4.3 Idle Mode Idle mode can be selected independently for each channel. One byte or word is transferred at each transfer request in idle mode. A designated number of these transfers are executed. One address is specified in the memory address register (MAR), the other in the I/O address register (IOAR). The direction of transfer is determined automatically from the activation source. The transfer is from the address specified in IOAR to the address specified in MAR if activated by an SCI channel 0 receive-data-full interrupt, and from the address specified in MAR to the address specified in IOAR otherwise. Table 8.7 indicates the register functions in idle mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 222 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Table 8.7 Register Functions in Idle Mode Function Activated by SCI 0 ReceiveData-Full Other Interrupt Activation Register 23 7 All 1s Destination address register Source address register Destination or source address Held fixed 0 Source address register Destination address register Source or destination address Held fixed Transfer counter Transfer counter Number of transfers Decremented once per transfer until H'0000 is reached and transfer ends IOAR 15 0 ETCR Operation 0 MAR 23 Initial Setting Legend MAR: Memory address register IOAR: I/O address register ETCR: Execute transfer count register MAR and IOAR specify the source and destination addresses. MAR specifies a 24-bit source or destination address. IOAR specifies the lower 8 bits of a fixed address. The upper 16 bits are all 1s. MAR and IOAR are not incremented or decremented. Figure 8.4 illustrates how idle mode operates. MAR Transfer IOAR 1 byte or word is transferred per request Figure 8.4 Operation in Idle Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 223 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller The transfer count is specified as a 16-bit value in ETCR. The ETCR value is decremented by 1 at each transfer. When the ETCR value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared, the transfer ends, and a CPU interrupt is requested. The maximum transfer count is 65,536, obtained by setting ETCR to H'0000. Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3, transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts from SCI channel 0, and external request signals. For the detailed settings see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). Figure 8.5 shows a sample setup procedure for idle mode. Idle mode setup Set source and destination addresses 1 Set transfer count 2 Read DTCR 3 Set DTCR 4 1. Set the source and destination addresses in MAR and IOAR. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. 2. Set the transfer count in ETCR. 3. Read DTCR while the DTE bit is cleared to 0. 4. Set the DTCR bits as follows. • Select the DMAC activation source with bits DTS2 to DTS0. • Set the DTIE and RPE bits to 1 to select idle mode. • Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit. • Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable the transfer. Idle mode Figure 8.5 Idle Mode Setup Procedure (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 224 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.4 Repeat Mode Repeat mode is useful for cyclically transferring a bit pattern from a table to the programmable timing pattern controller (TPC) in synchronization, for example, with ITU compare match. Repeat mode can be selected for each channel independently. One byte or word is transferred per request in repeat mode, as in I/O mode. A designated number of these transfers are executed. One address is specified in the memory address register (MAR), the other in the I/O address register (IOAR). At the end of the designated number of transfers, MAR and ETCR are restored to their original values and operation continues. The direction of transfer is determined automatically from the activation source. The transfer is from the address specified in IOAR to the address specified in MAR if activated by an SCI channel 0 receive-datafull interrupt, and from the address specified in MAR to the address specified in IOAR otherwise. Table 8.8 indicates the register functions in repeat mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 225 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Table 8.8 Register Functions in Repeat Mode Function Register 23 0 Activated by SCI 0 ReceiveData-Full Interrupt Other Activation Destination address register Initial Setting Operation Source address register Destination or source address Incremented or decremented at each transfer until H'0000, then restored to initial value Source address register Destination address register Source or destination address Held fixed Transfer counter Transfer counter Number of transfers Decremented once per transfer until H'0000 is reached, then reloaded from ETCRL Initial transfer count Initial transfer Number of count transfers MAR 7 23 All 1s 0 IOAR 7 0 ETCRH 7 0 ETCRL Held fixed Legend MAR: Memory address register IOAR: I/O address register ETCR: Execute transfer count register In repeat mode ETCRH is used as the transfer counter while ETCRL holds the initial transfer count. ETCRH is decremented by 1 at each transfer until it reaches H'00, then is reloaded from ETCRL. MAR is also restored to its initial value, which is calculated from the DTSZ and DTID bits in DTCR. Specifically, MAR is restored as follows: MAR ← MAR – (–1)DTID · 2DTSZ · ETCRL ETCRH and ETCRL should be initially set to the same value. In repeat mode transfers continue until the CPU clears the DTE bit to 0. After DTE is cleared to 0, if the CPU sets DTE to 1 again, transfers resume from the state at which DTE was cleared. No CPU interrupt is requested. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 226 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller As in I/O mode, MAR and IOAR specify the source and destination addresses. MAR specifies a 24-bit source or destination address. IOAR specifies the lower 8 bits of a fixed address. The upper 16 bits are all 1s. IOAR is not incremented or decremented. Figure 8.6 illustrates how repeat mode operates. Address T Transfer IOAR 1 byte or word is transferred per request Address B Legend L = initial setting of MAR N = initial setting of ETCRH and ETCRL Address T = L Address B = L + (–1) DTID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1) Figure 8.6 Operation in Repeat Mode The transfer count is specified as an 8-bit value in ETCRH and ETCRL. The maximum transfer count is 255, obtained by setting both ETCRH and ETCRL to H'FF. Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3, transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts from SCI channel 0, and external request signals. For the detailed settings see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 227 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.7 shows a sample setup procedure for repeat mode. Repeat mode Set source and destination addresses 1 Set transfer count 2 Read DTCR 3 Set DTCR 4 1. Set the source and destination addresses in MAR and IOAR. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source. 2. Set the transfer count in both ETCRH and ETCRL. 3. Read DTCR while the DTE bit is cleared to 0. 4. Set the DTCR bits as follows. • Select the DMAC activation source with bits DTS2 to DTS0. • Clear the DTIE bit to 0 and set the RPE bit to 1 to select repeat mode. • Select MAR increment or decrement with the DTID bit. • Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit. • Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable the transfer. Repeat mode Figure 8.7 Repeat Mode Setup Procedure (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 228 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.5 Normal Mode In normal mode the A and B channels are combined. One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers are executed. Addresses are specified in MARA and MARB. Table 8.9 indicates the register functions in I/O mode. Table 8.9 Register Functions in Normal Mode Register 23 Function Initial Setting Operation 0 Source address register Source address Incremented or decremented once per transfer, or held fixed 0 Destination address register Destination address Incremented or decremented once per transfer, or held fixed 0 Transfer counter Number of transfers Decremented once per transfer MARA 23 MARB 15 ETCRA Legend MARA: Memory address register A MARB: Memory address register B ETCRA: Execute transfer count register A The source and destination addresses are both 24-bit addresses. MARA specifies the source address. MARB specifies the destination address. MARA and MARB can be independently incremented, decremented, or held fixed as data is transferred. The transfer count is specified as a 16-bit value in ETCRA. The ETCRA value is decremented by 1 at each transfer. When the ETCRA value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared and the transfer ends. If the DTIE bit is set, a CPU interrupt is requested at this time. The maximum transfer count is 65,536, obtained by setting ETCRA to H'0000. Figure 8.8 illustrates how normal mode operates. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 229 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Transfer Address TA Address BA Address T B Address B B Legend L A = initial setting of MARA L B = initial setting of MARB N = initial setting of ETCRA TA = LA BA = L A + SAIDE • (–1)SAID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1) TB = LB BB = L B + DAIDE • (–1)DAID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1) Figure 8.8 Operation in Normal Mode Transfers can be requested (activated) by an external request or auto-request. An auto-requested transfer is activated by the register settings alone. The designated number of transfers are executed automatically. Either cycle-steal or burst mode can be selected. In cycle-steal mode the DMAC releases the bus temporarily after each transfer. In burst mode the DMAC keeps the bus until the transfers are completed, unless there is a bus request from a higher-priority bus master. For the detailed settings see section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 230 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.9 shows a sample setup procedure for normal mode. Normal mode Set initial source address 1 Set initial destination address 2 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Set transfer count 3 Set DTCRB (1) 4 Set DTCRA (1) 5 Read DTCRB 6 Set DTCRB (2) 7 Read DTCRA 8 Set DTCRA (2) 9 6. 7. 8. 9. Set the initial source address in MARA. Set the initial destination address in MARB. Set the transfer count in ETCRA. Set the DTCRB bits as follows. • Clear the DTME bit to 0. • Set the DAID and DAIDE bits to select whether MARB is incremented, decremented, or held fixed. • Select the DMAC activation source with bits DTS2B to DTS0B. Set the DTCRA bits as follows. • Clear the DTE bit to 0. • Select byte or word size with the DTSZ bit. • Set the SAID and SAIDE bits to select whether MARA is incremented, decremented, or held fixed. • Set or clear the DTIE bit to enable or disable the CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer. • Clear the DTS0A bit to 0 and set the DTS2A and DTS1A bits to 1 to select normal mode. Read DTCRB with DTME cleared to 0. Set the DTME bit to 1 in DTCRB. Read DTCRA with DTE cleared to 0. Set the DTE bit to 1 in DTCRA to enable the transfer. Normal mode Note: Carry out settings 1 to 9 with the DEND interrupt masked in the CPU. If an NMI interrupt occurs during the setup procedure, it may clear the DTME bit to 0, in which case the transfer will not start. Figure 8.9 Normal Mode Setup Procedure (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 231 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.6 Block Transfer Mode In block transfer mode the A and B channels are combined. One block of a specified size is transferred per request. A designated number of block transfers are executed. Addresses are specified in MARA and MARB. The block area address can be either held fixed or cycled. Table 8.10 indicates the register functions in block transfer mode. Table 8.10 Register Functions in Block Transfer Mode Register 23 Function Initial Setting Operation 0 Source address register Source address Incremented or decremented once per transfer, or held fixed 0 Destination address register Destination address Incremented or decremented once per transfer, or held fixed 0 Block size counter Block size Decremented once per transfer until H'00 is reached, then reloaded from ETCRAL Initial block size Block size Held fixed Block transfer counter Number of block transfers Decremented once per block transfer until H'0000 is reached and the transfer ends MARA 23 MARB 7 ETCRAH 7 0 ETCRAL 15 0 ETCRB Legend MARA: MARB: ETCRA: ETCRB: Memory address register A Memory address register B Execute transfer count register A Execute transfer count register B The source and destination addresses are both 24-bit addresses. MARA specifies the source address. MARB specifies the destination address. MARA and MARB can be independently incremented, decremented, or held fixed as data is transferred. One of these registers operates as a block area register: even if it is incremented or decremented, it is restored to its initial value at the end of each block transfer. The TMS bit in DTCRB selects whether the block area is the source or destination. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 232 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller If M (1 to 255) is the size of the block transferred at each request and N (1 to 65,536) is the number of blocks to be transferred, then ETCRAH and ETCRAL should initially be set to M and ETCRB should initially be set to N. Figure 8.10 illustrates how block transfer mode operates. In this figure, bit TMS is cleared to 0, meaning the block area is the destination. TA Address T B Transfer Block 1 Block area BA Address B B Block 2 M bytes or words are transferred per request Block N Legend L A = initial setting of MARA L B = initial setting of MARB M = initial setting of ETCRAH and ETCRAL N = initial setting of ETCRB T A = LA B A = L A + SAIDE • (–1) SAID • (2 DTSZ • M – 1) T B = LB B B = L B + DAIDE • (–1)DAID • (2 DTSZ • M – 1) Figure 8.10 Operation in Block Transfer Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 233 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller When activated by a transfer request, the DMAC executes a burst transfer. During the transfer MARA and MARB are updated according to the DTCR settings, and ETCRAH is decremented. When ETCRAH reaches H'00, it is reloaded from ETCRAL to restore the initial value. The memory address register of the block area is also restored to its initial value, and ETCRB is decremented. If ETCRB is not H'0000, the DMAC then waits for the next transfer request. ETCRAH and ETCRAL should be initially set to the same value. The above operation is repeated until ETCRB reaches H'0000, at which point the DTE bit is cleared to 0 and the transfer ends. If the DTIE bit is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested at this time. Figure 8.11 shows examples of a block transfer with byte data size when the block area is the destination. In (a) the block area address is cycled. In (b) the block area address is held fixed. Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU channels 0 to 3, and by external request signals. For the detailed settings see section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 234 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Start (DTE = DTME = 1) Transfer requested? Start (DTE = DTME = 1) No Transfer requested? Yes No Yes Get bus Get bus Read from MARA address Read from MARA address MARA = MARA + 1 MARA = MARA + 1 Write to MARB address Write to MARB address MARB = MARB + 1 ETCRAH = ETCRAH – 1 ETCRAH = ETCRAH – 1 No ETCRAH = H'00 No ETCRAH = H'00 Yes Yes Release bus Release bus ETCRAH = ETCRAL MARB = MARB – ETCRAL ETCRAH = ETCRAL ETCRB = ETCRB – 1 ETCRB = ETCRB – 1 ETCRB = H'0000 No ETCRB = H'0000 Yes No Yes Clear DTE to 0 and end transfer Clear DTE to 0 and end transfer a. DTSZ = TMS = 0 SAID = DAID = 0 SAIDE = DAIDE = 1 b. DTSZ = TMS = 0 SAID = 0 SAIDE = 1 DAIDE = 0 Figure 8.11 Block Transfer Mode Flowcharts (Examples) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 235 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.12 shows a sample setup procedure for block transfer mode. Block transfer mode Set source address 1 Set destination address 2 Set block transfer count 3 Set block size 4 Set DTCRB (1) 5 Set DTCRA (1) 6 Read DTCRB 7 Set DTCRB (2) 8 Read DTCRA 9 Set DTCRA (2) 10 Set the source address in MARA. Set the destination address in MARB. Set the block transfer count in ETCRB. Set the block size (number of bytes or words) in both ETCRAH and ETCRAL. 5. Set the DTCRB bits as follows. • Clear the DTME bit to 0. • Set the DAID and DAIDE bits to select whether MARB is incremented, decremented, or held fixed. • Set or clear the TMS bit to make the block area the source or destination. • Select the DMAC activation source with bits DTS2B to DTS0B. 6. Set the DTCRA bits as follows. • Clear the DTE to 0. • Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit. • Set the SAID and SAIDE bits to select whether MARA is incremented, decremented, or held fixed. • Set or clear the DTIE bit to enable or disable the CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer. • Set bits DTS2A to DTS0A all to 1 to select block transfer mode. 7. Read DTCRB with DTME cleared to 0. 8. Set the DTME bit to 1 in DTCRB. 9. Read DTCRA with DTE cleared to 0. 10. Set the DTE bit to 1 in DTCRA to enable the transfer. 1. 2. 3. 4. Block transfer mode Note: Carry out settings 1 to 10 with the DEND interrupt masked in the CPU. If an NMI interrupt occurs during the setup procedure, it may clear the DTME bit to 0, in which case the transfer will not start. Figure 8.12 Block Transfer Mode Setup Procedure (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 236 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.7 DMAC Activation The DMAC can be activated by an internal interrupt, external request, or auto-request. The available activation sources differ depending on the transfer mode and channel as indicated in table 8.11. Table 8.11 DMAC Activation Sources Short Address Mode Channels 0A and 1A Channels 0B and 1B Normal Block IMIA0 Yes Yes No Yes IMIA1 Yes Yes No Yes IMIA2 Yes Yes No Yes IMIA3 Yes Yes No Yes TXI0 Yes Yes No No RXI0 Yes Yes No No Falling edge of DREQ No Yes Yes Yes Low input at DREQ No Yes Yes No No No Yes No Activation Source Internal interrupts External requests Auto-request Full Address Mode Activation by Internal Interrupts: When an interrupt request is selected as a DMAC activation source and the DTE bit is set to 1, that interrupt request is not sent to the CPU. It is not possible for an interrupt request to activate the DMAC and simultaneously generate a CPU interrupt. When the DMAC is activated by an interrupt request, the interrupt request flag is cleared automatically. If the same interrupt is selected to activate two or more channels, the interrupt request flag is cleared when the highest-priority channel is activated, but the transfer request is held pending on the other channels in the DMAC, which are activated in their priority order. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 237 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Activation by External Request: If an external request (DREQ pin) is selected as an activation source, the DREQ pin becomes an input pin and the corresponding TEND pin becomes an output pin, regardless of the port data direction register (DDR) settings. The DREQ input can be levelsensitive or edge-sensitive. In short address mode and normal mode, an external request operates as follows. If edge sensing is selected, one byte or word is transferred each time a high-to-low transition of the DREQ input is detected. If the next edge is input before the transfer is completed, the next transfer may not be executed. If level sensing is selected, the transfer continues while DREQ is low, until the transfer is completed. The bus is released temporarily after each byte or word has been transferred, however. If the DREQ input goes high during a transfer, the transfer is suspended after the current byte or word has been transferred. When DREQ goes low, the request is held internally until one byte or word has been transferred. The TEND signal goes low during the last write cycle. In block transfer mode, an external request operates as follows. Only edge-sensitive transfer requests are possible in block transfer mode. Each time a high-to-low transition of the DREQ input is detected, a block of the specified size is transferred. The TEND signal goes low during the last write cycle in each block. Activation by Auto-Request: The transfer starts as soon as enabled by register setup, and continues until completed. Cycle-steal mode or burst mode can be selected. In cycle-steal mode the DMAC releases the bus temporarily after transferring each byte or word. Normally, DMAC cycles alternate with CPU cycles. In burst mode the DMAC keeps the bus until the transfer is completed, unless there is a higherpriority bus request. If there is a higher-priority bus request, the bus is released after the current byte or word has been transferred. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 238 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.8 DMAC Bus Cycle Figure 8.13 shows an example of the timing of the basic DMAC bus cycle. This example shows a word-size transfer from a 16-bit two-state access area to an 8-bit three-state access area. When the DMAC gets the bus from the CPU, after one dead cycle (Td), it reads from the source address and writes to the destination address. During these read and write operations the bus is not released even if there is another bus request. DMAC cycles comply with bus controller settings in the same way as CPU cycles. CPU cycle T1 T2 T1 DMAC cycle (word transfer) T2 Td T1 T2 T1 T2 T3 T1 T2 CPU cycle T3 T1 T2 T1 T2 φ Source address Destination address Address bus RD HWR LWR Figure 8.13 DMA Transfer Bus Timing (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 239 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.14 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by low input at a DREQ pin. This example shows a word-size transfer from a 16-bit two-state access area to another 16-bit two-state access area. The DMAC continues the transfer while the DREQ pin is held low. CPU cycle T1 T2 T3 DMAC cycle Td T1 T2 T1 DMAC cycle (last transfer cycle) CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 Td T1 T2 T1 T2 CPU cycle T1 φ DREQ Source Destination address address Source Destination address address Address bus RD HWR , LWR TEND Figure 8.14 Bus Timing of DMA Transfer Requested by Low DREQ Input Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 240 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 T2 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.15 shows an auto-requested burst-mode transfer. This example shows a transfer of three words from a 16-bit two-state access area to another 16-bit two-state access area. CPU cycle T1 T2 DMAC cycle Td T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 φ Source address Destination address Address bus RD HWR , LWR Figure 8.15 Bus Timing of Burst Mode DMA Transfer When the DMAC is activated from a DREQ pin there is a minimum interval of four states from when the transfer is requested until the DMAC starts operating. The DREQ pin is not sampled during the time between the transfer request and the start of the transfer. In short address mode and normal mode, the pin is next sampled at the end of the read cycle. In block transfer mode, the pin is next sampled at the end of one block transfer. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 241 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.16 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by the falling edge of DREQ in normal mode. CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 T1 CPU cycle DMAC cycle T2 Td T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 DMAC cycle Td T1 T2 DREQ Address bus RD HWR, LWR Minimum 4 states Next sampling point Figure 8.16 Timing of DMAC Activation by Falling Edge of DREQ in Normal Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 242 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.17 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by level-sensitive low DREQ input in normal mode. CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 T1 DMAC cycle T2 Td T1 T2 T1 CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 φ DREQ Address bus RD HWR , LWR Minimum 4 states Next sampling point Figure 8.17 Timing of DMAC Activation by Low DREQ Level in Normal Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 243 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Figure 8.18 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by the falling edge of DREQ in block transfer mode. End of 1 block transfer DMAC cycle T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 DMAC cycle Td T1 T2 φ DREQ Address bus RD HWR , LWR TEND Next sampling Minimum 4 states Figure 8.18 Timing of DMAC Activation by Falling Edge of DREQ in Block Transfer Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 244 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.9 DMAC Multiple-Channel Operation The DMAC channel priority order is: channel 0 > channel 1 and channel A > channel B. Table 8.12 shows the complete priority order. Table 8.12 Channel Priority Order Short Address Mode Full Address Mode Priority Channel 0A Channel 0 High Channel 0B Channel 1A Channel 1B Channel 1 ↑ Low If transfers are requested on two or more channels simultaneously, or if a transfer on one channel is requested during a transfer on another channel, the DMAC operates as follows. 1. When a transfer is requested, the DMAC requests the bus right. When it gets the bus right, it starts a transfer on the highest-priority channel at that time. 2. Once a transfer starts on one channel, requests to other channels are held pending until that channel releases the bus. 3. After each transfer in short address mode, and each externally-requested or cycle-steal transfer in normal mode, the DMAC releases the bus and returns to step 1. After releasing the bus, if there is a transfer request for another channel, the DMAC requests the bus again. 4. After completion of a burst-mode transfer, or after transfer of one block in block transfer mode, the DMAC releases the bus and returns to step 1. If there is a transfer request for a higher-priority channel or a bus request from a higher-priority bus master, however, the DMAC releases the bus after completing the transfer of the current byte or word. After releasing the bus, if there is a transfer request for another channel, the DMAC requests the bus again. Figure 8.19 shows the timing when channel 0A is set up for I/O mode and channel 1 for burst mode, and a transfer request for channel 0A is received while channel 1 is active. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 245 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller DMAC cycle (channel 1) T1 T2 CPU cycle T1 T2 DMAC cycle (channel 0A) Td T1 T2 T1 CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 DMAC cycle (channel 1) Td T1 T2 T1 T2 φ Address bus RD HWR , LWR Figure 8.19 Timing of Multiple-Channel Operations 8.4.10 External Bus Requests, Refresh Controller, and DMAC During a DMA transfer, if the bus right is requested by an external bus request signal (BREQ) or by the refresh controller, the DMAC releases the bus after completing the transfer of the current byte or word. If there is a transfer request at this point, the DMAC requests the bus right again. Figure 8.20 shows an example of the timing of insertion of a refresh cycle during a burst transfer on channel 0. Refresh cycle DMAC cycle (channel 0) T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 DMAC cycle (channel 0) Td T1 T2 T1 φ Address bus RD HWR , LWR Figure 8.20 Bus Timing of Refresh Controller and DMAC Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 246 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 T2 T1 T2 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.11 NMI Interrupts and DMAC NMI interrupts do not affect DMAC operations in short address mode. If an NMI interrupt occurs during a transfer in full address mode, the DMAC suspends operations. In full address mode, a channel is enabled when its DTE and DTME bits are both set to 1. NMI input clears the DTME bit to 0. After transferring the current byte or word, the DMAC releases the bus to the CPU. In normal mode, the suspended transfer resumes when the CPU sets the DTME bit to 1 again. Check that the DTE bit is set to 1 and the DTME bit is cleared to 0 before setting the DTME bit to 1. Figure 8.21 shows the procedure for resuming a DMA transfer in normal mode on channel 0 after the transfer was halted by NMI input. Resuming DMA transfer in normal mode 1. Check that DTE = 1 and DTME = 0. 2. Read DTCRB while DTME = 0, then write 1 in the DTME bit. 1 DTE = 1 DTME = 0 No Yes Set DTME to 1 DMA transfer continues 2 End Figure 8.21 Procedure for Resuming a DMA Transfer Halted by NMI (Example) For information about NMI interrupts in block transfer mode, see section 8.6.6, NMI Interrupts and Block Transfer Mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 247 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.12 Aborting a DMA Transfer When the DTE bit in an active channel is cleared to 0, the DMAC halts after transferring the current byte or word. The DMAC starts again when the DTE bit is set to 1. In full address mode, the DTME bit can be used for the same purpose. Figure 8.22 shows the procedure for aborting a DMA transfer by software. DMA transfer abort Set DTCR 1. Clear the DTE bit to 0 in DTCR. To avoid generating an interrupt when aborting a DMA transfer, clear the DTIE bit to 0 simultaneously. 1 DMA transfer aborted Figure 8.22 Procedure for Aborting a DMA Transfer Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 248 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.13 Exiting Full Address Mode Figure 8.23 shows the procedure for exiting full address mode and initializing the pair of channels. To set the channels up in another mode after exiting full address mode, follow the setup procedure for the relevant mode. Exiting full address mode Halt the channel 1 Initialize DTCRB 2 Initialize DTCRA 3 1. Clear the DTE bit to 0 in DTCRA, or wait for the transfer to end and the DTE bit to be cleared to 0. 2. Clear all DTCRB bits to 0. 3. Clear all DTCRA bits to 0. Initialized and halted Figure 8.23 Procedure for Exiting Full Address Mode (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 249 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.4.14 DMAC States in Reset State, Standby Modes, and Sleep Mode When the chip is reset or enters hardware or software standby mode, the DMAC is initialized and halts. DMAC operations continue in sleep mode. Figure 8.24 shows the timing of a cycle-steal transfer in sleep mode. Sleep mode CPU cycle T2 DMAC cycle Td T1 T2 T1 DMAC cycle T2 Td T1 T2 T1 T2 φ Address bus RD HWR , LWR Figure 8.24 Timing of Cycle-Steal Transfer in Sleep Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 250 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Td Section 8 DMA Controller 8.5 Interrupts The DMAC generates only DMA-end interrupts. Table 8.13 lists the interrupts and their priority. Table 8.13 DMAC Interrupts Description Interrupt Short Address Mode Full Address Mode Interrupt Priority DEND0A End of transfer on channel 0A End of transfer on channel 0 High DEND0B End of transfer on channel 0B — DEND1A End of transfer on channel 1A End of transfer on channel 1 DEND1B End of transfer on channel 1B — ↑ Low Each interrupt is enabled or disabled by the DTIE bit in the corresponding data transfer control register (DTCR). Separate interrupt signals are sent to the interrupt controller. The interrupt priority order among channels is channel 0 > channel 1 and channel A > channel B. Figure 8.25 shows the DMA-end interrupt logic. An interrupt is requested whenever DTE = 0 and DTIE = 1. DTE DMA-end interrupt DTIE Figure 8.25 DMA-End Interrupt Logic The DMA-end interrupt for the B channels (DENDB) is unavailable in full address mode. The DTME bit does not affect interrupt operations. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 251 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.6 Usage Notes 8.6.1 Note on Word Data Transfer Word data cannot be accessed starting at an odd address. When word-size transfer is selected, set even values in the memory and I/O address registers (MAR and IOAR). 8.6.2 DMAC Self-Access The DMAC itself cannot be accessed during a DMAC cycle. DMAC registers cannot be specified as source or destination addresses. 8.6.3 Longword Access to Memory Address Registers A memory address register can be accessed as longword data at the MARR address. Example MOV.L MOV.L #LBL, ER0 ER0, @MARR Four byte accesses are performed. Note that the CPU may release the bus between the second byte (MARE) and third byte (MARH). Memory address registers should be written and read only when the DMAC is halted. 8.6.4 Note on Full Address Mode Setup Full address mode is controlled by two registers: DTCRA and DTCRB. Care must be taken to prevent the B channel from operating in short address mode during the register setup. The enable bits (DTE and DTME) should not be set to 1 until the end of the setup procedure. 8.6.5 Note on Activating DMAC by Internal Interrupts When using an internal interrupt to activate the DMAC, make sure that the interrupt selected as the activating source does not occur during the interval after it has been selected but before the DMAC has been enabled. The on-chip supporting module that will generate the interrupt should not be activated until the DMAC has been enabled. If the DMAC must be enabled while the onchip supporting module is active, follow the procedure in figure 8.26. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 252 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Enabling of DMAC Yes Interrupt handling by CPU Selected interrupt requested? 1 No Clear selected interrupt’s enable bit to 0 2 Enable DMAC 3 Set selected interrupt’s enable bit to 1 4 1. While the DTE bit is cleared to 0, interrupt requests are sent to the CPU. 2. Clear the interrupt enable bit to 0 in the interrupt-generating on-chip supporting module. 3. Enable the DMAC. 4. Enable the DMAC-activating interrupt. DMAC operates Figure 8.26 Procedure for Enabling DMAC while On-Chip Supporting Module is Operating (Example) If the DTE bit is set to 1 but the DTME bit is cleared to 0, the DMAC is halted and the selected activating source cannot generate a CPU interrupt. If the DMAC is halted by an NMI interrupt, for example, the selected activating source cannot generate CPU interrupts. To terminate DMAC operations in this state, clear the DTE bit to 0 to allow CPU interrupts to be requested. To continue DMAC operations, carry out steps 2 and 4 in figure 8.26 before and after setting the DTME bit to 1. When an ITU interrupt activates the DMAC, make sure the next interrupt does not occur before the DMA transfer ends. If one ITU interrupt activates two or more channels, make sure the next interrupt does not occur before the DMA transfers end on all the activated channels. If the next interrupt occurs before a transfer ends, the channel or channels for which that interrupt was selected may fail to accept further activation requests. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 253 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.6.6 NMI Interrupts and Block Transfer Mode If an NMI interrupt occurs in block transfer mode, the DMAC operates as follows. • When the NMI interrupt occurs, the DMAC finishes transferring the current byte or word, then clears the DTME bit to 0 and halts. The halt may occur in the middle of a block. It is possible to find whether a transfer was halted in the middle of a block by checking the block size counter. If the block size counter does not have its initial value, the transfer was halted in the middle of a block. • If the transfer is halted in the middle of a block, the activating interrupt flag is cleared to 0. The activation request is not held pending. • While the DTE bit is set to 1 and the DTME bit is cleared to 0, the DMAC is halted and does not accept activating interrupt requests. If an activating interrupt occurs in this state, the DMAC does not operate and does not hold the transfer request pending internally. Neither is a CPU interrupt requested. For this reason, before setting the DTME bit to 1, first clear the enable bit of the activating interrupt to 0. Then, after setting the DTME bit to 1, set the interrupt enable bit to 1 again. See section 8.6.5, Note on Activating DMAC by Internal Interrupts. • When the DTME bit is set to 1, the DMAC waits for the next transfer request. If it was halted in the middle of a block transfer, the rest of the block is transferred when the next transfer request occurs. Otherwise, the next block is transferred when the next transfer request occurs. 8.6.7 Memory and I/O Address Register Values Table 8.14 indicates the address ranges that can be specified in the memory and I/O address registers (MAR and IOAR). Table 8.14 Address Ranges Specifiable in MAR and IOAR 1-Mbyte Mode 16-Mbyte Mode MAR H'00000 to H'FFFFF (0 to 1048575) H'000000 to H'FFFFFF (0 to 16777215) IOAR H'FFF00 to H'FFFFF (1048320 to 1048575) H'FFFF00 to H'FFFFFF (16776960 to 16777215) MAR bits 23 to 20 are ignored in 1-Mbyte mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 254 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller 8.6.8 Bus Cycle when Transfer is Aborted When a transfer is aborted by clearing the DTE bit or suspended by an NMI that clears the DTME bit, if this halts a channel for which the DMAC has a transfer request pending internally, a dead cycle may occur. This dead cycle does not update the halted channel’s address register or counter value. Figure 8.27 shows an example in which an auto-requested transfer in cycle-steal mode on channel 0 is aborted by clearing the DTE bit in channel 0. CPU cycle T1 T2 DMAC cycle Td T1 T2 T1 DMAC cycle CPU cycle T2 T1 T2 T3 Td Td CPU cycle T1 T2 φ Address bus RD HWR, LWR DTE bit is cleared Figure 8.27 Bus Timing at Abort of DMA Transfer in Cycle-Steal Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 255 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 8 DMA Controller Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 256 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Section 9 I/O Ports 9.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has 10 input/output ports (ports 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, A, and B) and one input port (port 7). Table 9.1 summarizes the port functions. The pins in each port are multiplexed as shown in table 9.1. Each port has a data direction register (DDR) for selecting input or output, and a data register (DR) for storing output data. In addition to these registers, ports 2, 4, and 5 have an input pull-up MOS control register (PCR) for switching input pull-up MOS transistors on and off. Ports 1 to 6 and port 8 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. Ports 9, A, and B can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. Ports 1 to 6 and 8 to B can drive a darlington pair. Ports 1, 2, 5, and B can drive LEDs (with 10-mA current sink). Pins P82 to P80, PA7 to PA0, and PB3 to PB0 have Schmitt-trigger input circuits. For block diagrams of the ports see appendix C, I/O Port Block Diagrams. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 257 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.1 Port Port Functions Description Pins Port 1 • 8-bit I/O port P17 to P10/ A7 to A0 • Can drive LEDs Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Address output pins (A7 to A0) Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 Address output (A7 Generic to A0) and generic input/ output input DDR = 0: generic input DDR = 1: address output Port 2 • 8-bit I/O port P27 to P20/ • Input pull-up A15 to A8 Address output pins (A15 to A8) MOS Address output (A15 Generic to A8) and generic input/ input output DDR = 0: generic input • Can drive LEDs DDR = 1: address output Port 3 • 8-bit I/O port P37 to P30/ D15 to D8 Data input/output (D15 to D8) Generic input/ output Port 4 • 8-bit I/O port P47 to P40/ • Input pull-up D7 to D0 Data input/output (D7 to D0) and 8-bit generic input/output Generic input/ output MOS 8-bit bus mode: generic input/output 16-bit bus mode: data input/output Port 5 • 4-bit I/O port P53 to P50/ • Input pull-up A19 to A16 Address output (A19 to A16) MOS Address output (A19 Generic to A16) and 4-bit input/ generic input output DDR = 0: generic input • Can drive LEDs DDR = 1: address output Port 6 • 7-bit I/O port P66/LWR, P65/HWR, P64/RD, P63/AS P62/BACK, P61/BREQ, P60/WAIT Port 7 • 8-bit I/O port P77/AN7/DA1, P76/AN6/DA0 P75 to P70/ AN5 to AN0 Bus control signal output (LWR, HWR, RD, AS) Generic input/ output Bus control signal input/output (BACK, BREQ, WAIT) and 3bit generic input/output Analog input (AN7, AN6) to A/D converter, analog output (DA1, DA0) from D/A converter, and generic input Analog input (AN5 to AN0) to A/D converter, and generic input Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 258 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port Description Pins Port 8 • 5-bit I/O port P84/CS0 • P82 to P80 have Schmitt inputs P83/CS1/IRQ3, P82/CS2/IRQ2, P81/CS3/IRQ1 Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 Generic input/ output DDR = 0: generic input DDR = 1 (after reset): CS0 output IRQ3 to IRQ1 input, CS1 to CS3 output, and generic input DDR = 0 (after reset): generic input DDR = 1: CS1 to CS3 output P80/RFSH/IRQ0 IRQ0 input, RFSH output, and generic input/output IRQ3 to IRQ0 input and generic input/ output Port 9 • 6-bit I/O port P95/SCK1/IRQ5, Input and output (SCK1, SCK0, RxD1, RxD0, TxD1, TxD0) for serial P94/SCK0/IRQ4, communication interfaces 1 and 0 (SCI1/0), IRQ5 and IRQ4 input, and 6P93/RxD1, bit generic input/output P92/RxD0, P91/TxD1, P90/TxD0 Port A • 8-bit I/O port PA7/TP7/ TIOCB2/A20 • Schmitt inputs Output (TP7) from Address output (A20) programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), input or output (TIOCB2) for 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), and generic input/output TPC output (TP6 to PA6/TP6/ TIOCA2/A21/CS4 TP4), ITU input and output (TIOCA2, PA5/TP5/ TIOCB1/A22/CS5 TIOCB1, TIOCA1), CS4 to CS6 output, PA4/TP4/ TIOCA1/A23/CS6 and generic input/ output TPC output (TP6 to TP4), ITU input and output (TIOCA2, TIOCB1, TIOCA1), address output (A23 to A21), CS4 to CS6 output, and generic input/output Address TPC output output (A20) (TP7), ITU input or output (TIOCB2), and generic input/ output TPC output (TP6 to TP4), ITU input and output (TIOCA2, TIOCB1, TIOCA1), CS4 to CS6 output, and generic input/ output TPC output (TP6 to TP4), ITU input and output (TIOCA2, TIOCB1, TIOCA1), address output (A23 to A21), CS4 to CS6 output, and generic input/out put TPC output (TP7), ITU input or output (TIOCB2), and generic input/ output TPC output (TP6 to TP4), ITU input and output (TIOCA2, TIOCB1, TIOCA1), and generic input/ output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 259 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port Description Pins Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 Mode 4 Mode 5 Mode 6 Mode 7 Port A • 8-bit I/O port PA3/TP3/ TPC output (TP3 to TP0), output (TEND1, TEND0) from DMA controller TIOCB0/ (DMAC), ITU input and output (TCLKD, TCLKC, TCLKB, TCLKA, • Schmitt TIOCB0, TIOCA0), and generic input/output TCLKD, inputs PA2/TP2/ TIOCA0/ TCLKC, PA1/TP1/ TEND1/TCLKB, PA0/TP0/ TEND0/TCLKA Port B • 8-bit I/O port PB7/TP15/ TPC output (TP15), DMAC input (DREQ1), trigger input (ADTRG) to A/D DREQ1/ADTR converter, and generic input/output • Can drive G LEDs • PB3 to PB0 PB6/TP14/ have Schmitt DREQ0/CS7 inputs PB5/TP13/ TOCXB4, PB4/TP12/ TOCXA4, PB3/TP11/ TIOCB4, PB2/TP10/ TIOCA4, PB1/TP9/ TIOCB3, PB0/TP8/ TIOCA3 TPC output (TP14), DMAC input (DREQ0), CS7 output, and generic input/output TPC output (TP14), DMAC input (DREQ0), and generic input/ output TPC output (TP13 to TP8), ITU input and output (TOCXB4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, TIOCA4, TIOCB3, TIOCA3), and generic input/output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 260 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.2 Port 1 9.2.1 Overview Port 1 is an 8-bit input/output port with the pin configuration shown in figure 9.1. The pin functions differ between the expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled, expanded modes with on-chip ROM enabled, and single-chip mode. In modes 1 to 4 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled), they are address bus output pins (A7 to A0). In modes 5 and 6 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM enabled), settings in the port 1 data direction register (P1DDR) can designate pins for address bus output (A7 to A0) or generic input. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), port 1 is a generic input/output port. When DRAM is connected to area 3, A7 to A0 output row and column addresses in read and write cycles. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller. Pins in port 1 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port 1 pins Port 1 Modes 1 to 4 Modes 5 and 6 Mode 7 P17 /A 7 A 7 (output) P17 (input)/A 7 (output) P17 (input/output) P16 /A 6 A 6 (output) P16 (input)/A 6 (output) P16 (input/output) P15 /A 5 A 5 (output) P15 (input)/A 5 (output) P15 (input/output) P14 /A 4 A 4 (output) P14 (input)/A 4 (output) P14 (input/output) P13 /A 3 A 3 (output) P13 (input)/A 3 (output) P13 (input/output) P12 /A 2 A 2 (output) P12 (input)/A 2 (output) P12 (input/output) P11 /A 1 A 1 (output) P11 (input)/A 1 (output) P11 (input/output) P10 /A 0 A 0 (output) P10 (input)/A 0 (output) P10 (input/output) Figure 9.1 Port 1 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 261 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.2.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.2 summarizes the registers of port 1. Table 9.2 Port 1 Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Modes 1 to 4 Modes 5 to 7 H'FFC0 Port 1 data direction register P1DDR W H'FF H'00 H'FFC2 Port 1 data register P1DR R/W H'00 H'00 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 1 Data Direction Register (P1DDR) P1DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 1. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P1 7 DDR P1 6 DDR P1 5 DDR P1 4 DDR P1 3 DDR P1 2 DDR P1 1 DDR P1 0 DDR Modes Initial value 1 to 4 Read/Write Modes Initial value 5 to 7 Read/Write 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 — — — — — — — — 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W W W W W W W W Port 1 data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 1 pins Modes 1 to 4 (Expanded Modes with On-Chip ROM Disabled): P1DDR values are fixed at 1 and cannot be modified. Port 1 functions as an address bus. Modes 5 and 6 (Expanded Modes with On-Chip ROM Enabled): A pin in port 1 becomes an address output pin if the corresponding P1DDR bit is set to 1, and a generic input pin if this bit is cleared to 0. Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 1 functions as an input/output port. A pin in port 1 becomes an output pin if the corresponding P1DDR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if this bit is cleared to 0. In modes 5 to 7, P1DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 262 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports P1DDR is initialized to H'FF in modes 1 to 4 and H'00 in modes 5 to 7 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a P1DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Port 1 Data Register (P1DR) P1DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores port 1 output data. While port 1 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When this register is read, the pin logic level of a pin is read for bits for which the P1DDR setting is 0, and the P1DR value is read for bits for which the P1DDR setting is 1. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P17 P16 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port 1 data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port 1 pins P1DR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 263 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.3 Port 2 9.3.1 Overview Port 2 is an 8-bit input/output port with the pin configuration shown in figure 9.2. The pin functions differ according to the operating mode. In modes 1 to 4 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled), port 2 consists of address bus output pins (A15 to A8). In modes 5 and 6 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM enabled), settings in the port 2 data direction register (P2DDR) can designate pins for address bus output (A15 to A8) or generic input. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), port 2 is a generic input/output port. When DRAM is connected to area 3, A9 and A8 output row and column addresses in read and write cycles. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller. Port 2 has software-programmable built-in pull-up MOS. Pins in port 2 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port 2 Port 2 pins Modes 1 to 4 Modes 5 and 6 Mode 7 P27 /A 15 A15 (output) P27 (input)/A15 (output) P27 (input/output) P26 /A 14 A14 (output) P26 (input)/A14 (output) P26 (input/output) P25 /A 13 A13 (output) P25 (input)/A13 (output) P25 (input/output) P24 /A 12 A12 (output) P24 (input)/A12 (output) P24 (input/output) P23 /A 11 A11 (output) P23 (input)/A11 (output) P23 (input/output) P22 /A 10 A10 (output) P22 (input)/A10 (output) P22 (input/output) P21 /A 9 A9 (output) P21 (input)/A9 (output) P21 (input/output) P20 /A 8 A8 (output) P20 (input)/A8 (output) P20 (input/output) Figure 9.2 Port 2 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 264 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.3.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.3 summarizes the registers of port 2. Table 9.3 Port 2 Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Modes 1 to 4 Modes 5 to 7 H'FFC1 Port 2 data direction register P2DDR W H'FF H'00 H'FFC3 Port 2 data register P2DR R/W H'00 H'00 H'FFD8 Port 2 input pull-up MOS control register P2PCR R/W H'00 H'00 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 2 Data Direction Register (P2DDR) P2DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 2. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P2 7 DDR P2 6 DDR P2 5 DDR P2 4 DDR P2 3 DDR P2 2 DDR P2 1 DDR P2 0 DDR Modes Initial value 1 to 4 Read/Write 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 — — — — — — — — Modes Initial value 5 to 7 Read/Write 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W W W W W W W W Port 2 data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 2 pins Modes 1 to 4 (Expanded Modes with On-Chip ROM Disabled): P2DDR values are fixed at 1 and cannot be modified. Port 2 functions as an address bus. Modes 5 and 6 (Expanded Modes with On-Chip ROM Enabled): Following a reset, port 2 is an input port. A pin in port 2 becomes an address output pin if the corresponding P2DDR bit is set to 1, and a generic input port if this bit is cleared to 0. Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 2 functions as an input/output port. A pin in port 2 becomes an output port if the corresponding P2DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. In modes 1 to 4, P2DDR always returns 1 when read. No value can be written to. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 265 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports In modes 5 to 7, P2DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P2DDR is initialized to H'FF in modes 1 to 4 and H'00 in modes 5 to 7 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a P2DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Port 2 Data Register (P2DR) P2DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P27 to P20. While port 2 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in P2DDR is set to 1, if port 2 is read the value of the corresponding P2DR bit is returned. When a bit in P2DDR is cleared to 0, if port 2 is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P2 7 P2 6 P2 5 P2 4 P2 3 P2 2 P2 1 P2 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port 2 data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port 2 pins P2DR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Port 2 Input Pull-Up MOS Control Register (P2PCR) P2PCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the MOS input pull-up transistors in port 2. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P2 7 PCR P2 6 PCR P2 5 PCR P2 4 PCR P2 3 PCR P2 2 PCR P2 1 PCR P2 0 PCR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port 2 input pull-up MOS control 7 to 0 These bits control input pull-up transistors built into port 2 In modes 5 to 7, when a P2DDR bit is cleared to 0 (selecting generic input), if the corresponding bit from P27PCR to P20PCR is set to 1, the input pull-up MOS is turned on. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 266 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports P2PCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Table 9.4 summarizes the states of the input pull-up transistors. Table 9.4 Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port 2) Mode Reset Hardware Standby Mode Software Standby Mode Other Modes 1 Off Off Off Off Off Off On/off On/off 2 3 4 5 6 7 Legend Off: The input pull-up MOS is always off. On/off: The input pull-up MOS is on if P2PCR = 1 and P2DDR = 0. Otherwise, it is off. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 267 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.4 Port 3 9.4.1 Overview Port 3 is an 8-bit input/output port with the pin configuration shown in figure 9.3. Port 3 is a data bus in modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes) and a generic input/output port in mode 7 (single-chip mode). Pins in port 3 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port 3 Port 3 pins Modes 1 to 6 Mode 7 P37 /D15 D15 (input/output) P37 (input/output) P36 /D14 D14 (input/output) P36 (input/output) P35 /D13 D13 (input/output) P35 (input/output) P34 /D12 D12 (input/output) P34 (input/output) P33 /D11 D11 (input/output) P33 (input/output) P32 /D10 D10 (input/output) P32 (input/output) P31 /D9 D9 (input/output) P31 (input/output) P30 /D8 D8 (input/output) P30 (input/output) Figure 9.3 Port 3 Pin Configuration 9.4.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.5 summarizes the registers of port 3. Table 9.5 Port 3 Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFC4 Port 3 data direction register P3DDR W H'00 H'FFC6 Port 3 data register P3DR R/W H'00 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 268 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port 3 Data Direction Register (P3DDR) P3DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 3. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P3 7 DDR P3 6 DDR P3 5 DDR P3 4 DDR P3 3 DDR P3 2 DDR P3 1 DDR P3 0 DDR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write W W W W W W W W Port 3 data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 3 pins Modes 1 to 6 (Expanded Modes): Port 3 functions as a data bus. P3DDR is ignored. Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 3 functions as an input/output port. A pin in port 3 becomes an output port if the corresponding P3DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. P3DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P3DDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a P3DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Port 3 Data Register (P3DR) P3DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P37 to P30. While port 3 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in P3DDR is set to 1, if port 3 is read the value of the corresponding P3DR bit is returned. When a bit in P3DDR is cleared to 0, if port 3 is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P3 7 P3 6 P3 5 P3 4 P3 3 P3 2 P3 1 P3 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port 3 data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port 3 pins P3DR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 269 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.5 Port 4 9.5.1 Overview Port 4 is an 8-bit input/output port with the pin configuration shown in figure 9.4. The pin functions differ according to the operating mode. In modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes), when the bus width control register (ABWCR) designates areas 0 to 7 all as 8-bit-access areas, the chip operates in 8-bit bus mode and port 4 is a generic input/output port. When at least one of areas 0 to 7 is designated as a 16-bit-access area, the chip operates in 16-bit bus mode and port 4 becomes part of the data bus. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), port 4 is a generic input/output port. Port 4 has software-programmable built-in pull-up MOS. Pins in port 4 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port 4 Port 4 pins Modes 1 to 6 Mode 7 P47 /D7 P47 (input/output)/D7 (input/output) P47 (input/output) P46 /D6 P46 (input/output)/D6 (input/output) P46 (input/output) P45 /D5 P45 (input/output)/D5 (input/output) P45 (input/output) P44 /D4 P44 (input/output)/D4 (input/output) P44 (input/output) P43 /D3 P43 (input/output)/D3 (input/output) P43 (input/output) P42 /D2 P42 (input/output)/D2 (input/output) P42 (input/output) P41 /D1 P41 (input/output)/D1 (input/output) P41 (input/output) P40 /D0 P40 (input/output)/D0 (input/output) P40 (input/output) Figure 9.4 Port 4 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 270 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.5.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.6 summarizes the registers of port 4. Table 9.6 Port 4 Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFC5 Port 4 data direction register P4DDR W H'00 H'FFC7 Port 4 data register P4DR R/W H'00 H'FFDA Port 4 input pull-up MOS control register P4PCR R/W H'00 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 4 Data Direction Register (P4DDR) P4DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 4. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P4 7 DDR P4 6 DDR P4 5 DDR P4 4 DDR P4 3 DDR P4 2 DDR P4 1 DDR P4 0 DDR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write W W W W W W W W Port 4 data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 4 pins Modes 1 to 6 (Expanded Modes): When all areas are designated as 8-bit-access areas using the bus width control register (ABWCR) of the bus controller, selecting 8-bit bus mode, port 4 functions as a generic input/output port. A pin in port 4 becomes an output port if the corresponding P4DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. When at least one area is designated as a 16-bit-access area, selecting 16-bit bus mode, port 4 functions as part of the data bus regardless of the value in P4DDR. Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 4 functions as an input/output port. A pin in port 4 becomes an output port if the corresponding P4DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. P4DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P4DDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 271 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports ABWCR and P4DDR are not initialized in software standby mode. When port 4 functions as a generic input/output port, if a P4DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Port 4 Data Register (P4DR) P4DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P47 to P40. While port 4 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in P4DDR is set to 1, if port 4 is read the value of the corresponding P4DR bit is returned. When a bit in P4DDR is cleared to 0, if port 4 is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P4 7 P4 6 P4 5 P4 4 P4 3 P4 2 P4 1 P4 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port 4 data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port 4 pins P4DR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Port 4 Input Pull-Up MOS Control Register (P4PCR) P4PCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the MOS input pull-up transistors in port 4. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P4 7 PCR P4 6 PCR P4 5 PCR P4 4 PCR P4 3 PCR P4 2 PCR P4 1 PCR P4 0 PCR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port 4 input pull-up MOS control 7 to 0 These bits control input pull-up MOS transistors built into port 4 In mode 7 (single-chip mode), and in 8-bit bus mode in modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes), when a P4DDR bit is cleared to 0 (selecting generic input), if the corresponding P4PCR bit is set to 1, the input pull-up MOS transistor is turned on. P4PCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 272 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.7 summarizes the states of the input pull-ups MOS in the 8-bit and 16-bit bus modes. Table 9.7 Input Pull-Up MOS Transistor States (Port 4) Mode 1 to 6 8-bit bus mode 16-bit bus mode 7 Reset Hardware Standby Mode Software Standby Mode Other Modes Off Off On/off On/off Off Off On/off On/off Legend Off: The input pull-up MOS transistor is always off. On/off: The input pull-up MOS transistor is on if P4PCR = 1 and P4DDR = 0. Otherwise, it is off. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 273 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.6 Port 5 9.6.1 Overview Port 5 is a 4-bit input/output port with the pin configuration shown in figure 9.5. The pin functions differ depending on the operating mode. In modes 1 to 4 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled), port 5 consists of address output pins (A19 to A16). In modes 5 and 6 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM enabled), settings in the port 5 data direction register (P5DDR) designate pins for address bus output (A19 to A16) or generic input. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), port 5 is a generic input/output port. Port 5 has software-programmable built-in pull-up MOS transistors. Pins in port 5 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive an LED or a darlington transistor pair. Port 5 Port 5 pins Modes 1 to 4 Modes 5 and 6 Mode 7 P53 /A 19 A19 (output) P5 3 (input)/A19 (output) P5 3 (input/output) P52 /A 18 A18 (output) P5 2 (input)/A18 (output) P5 2 (input/output) P51 /A 17 A17 (output) P5 1 (input)/A17 (output) P5 1 (input/output) P50 /A 16 A16 (output) P5 0 (input)/A16 (output) P5 0 (input/output) Figure 9.5 Port 5 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 274 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.6.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.8 summarizes the registers of port 5. Table 9.8 Port 5 Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Modes 1 to 4 Modes 5 to 7 H'FFC8 Port 5 data direction register P5DDR W H'FF H'F0 H'FFCA Port 5 data register P5DR R/W H'F0 H'F0 H'FFDB Port 5 input pull-up MOS control register P5PCR R/W H'F0 H'F0 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 5 Data Direction Register (P5DDR) P5DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 5. Bits 7 to 4 are reserved. They cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Bit Modes Initial value 1 to 4 Read/Write Modes Initial value 5 to 7 Read/Write 7 6 5 4 — — — — 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 — — — — — — — — 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 — — — — W W W W Reserved bits 3 2 1 0 P5 3 DDR P5 2 DDR P5 1 DDR P5 0 DDR Port 5 data direction 3 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 5 pins Modes 1 to 4 (Expanded Modes with On-Chip ROM Disabled): P5DDR values are fixed at 1 and cannot be modified. Port 5 functions as an address bus. Modes 5 and 6 (Expanded Modes with On-Chip ROM Enabled): Following a reset, port 5 is an input port. A pin in port 5 becomes an address output pin if the corresponding P5DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 275 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 5 functions as an input/output port. A pin in port 5 becomes an output port if the corresponding P5DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. In modes 1 to 4, P5DDR always returns 1 when read. No value can be written to. In modes 5 to 7, P5DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P5DDR is initialized to H'FF in modes 1 to 4 and H'F0 in modes 5 to 7 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting, so if a P5DDR bit is set to 1 while port 5 acts as an I/O port, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Port 5 Data Register (P5DR) P5DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P53 to P50. While port 5 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in P5DDR is set to 1, if port 5 is read the value of the corresponding P5DR bit is returned. When a bit in P5DDR is cleared to 0, if port 5 is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bits 7 to 4 are reserved. They cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — P5 3 P5 2 P5 1 P5 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Port 5 data 3 to 0 These bits store data for port 5 pins P5DR is initialized to H'F0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 276 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port 5 Input Pull-Up MOS Control Register (P5PCR) Bit 7 6 5 4 — — — — Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits 2 3 1 0 P5 3 PCR P5 2 PCR P5 1 PCR P5 0 PCR Port 5 input pull-up MOS control 3 to 0 These bits control input pull-up MOS transistors built into port 5 P5PCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the MOS input pull-up MOS transistors in port 5. Bits 7 to 4 are reserved. They cannot be modified and are always read as 1. In modes 5 to 7, when a P5DDR bit is cleared to 0 (selecting generic input), if the corresponding bit from P53PCR to P50PCR is set to 1, the input pull-up MOS transistor is turned on. P5PCR is initialized to H'F0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Table 9.9 summarizes the states of the input pull-ups MOS in each mode. Table 9.9 Input Pull-Up MOS Transistor States (Port 5) Mode Reset Hardware Standby Mode Software Standby Mode Other Modes 1 Off Off Off Off Off Off On/off On/off 2 3 4 5 6 7 Legend Off: The input pull-up MOS transistor is always off. On/off: The input pull-up MOS transistor is on if P5PCR = 1 and P5DDR = 0. Otherwise, it is off. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 277 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.7 Port 6 9.7.1 Overview Port 6 is a 7-bit input/output port that is also used for input and output of bus control signals (LWR, HWR, RD, AS, BACK, BREQ, and WAIT). When DRAM is connected to area 3, LWR, HWR, and RD also function as LW, UW, and CAS, or LCAS, UCAS, and WE, respectively. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller. Figure 9.6 shows the pin configuration of port 6. In modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes) the pin functions are LWR, HWR, RD, AS, P62/BACK, P61/BREQ, and P60/WAIT. See table 9.11 for the method of selecting the pin states. In mode 7 (single-chip mode) port 6 is a generic input/output port. Pins in port 6 can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port 6 pins Port 6 Mode 7 (single-chip mode) Modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes) P6 6 / LWR LWR (output) P6 6 (input/output) P6 5 / HWR HWR (output) P6 5 (input/output) P6 4 / RD RD (output) P6 4 (input/output) P6 3 / AS AS (output) P6 3 (input/output) P6 2 / BACK P6 2 (input/output)/ BACK (output) P6 2 (input/output) P6 1 / BREQ P6 1 (input/output)/ BREQ (input) P6 1 (input/output) P6 0 / WAIT P6 0 (input/output)/ WAIT (input) P6 0 (input/output) Figure 9.6 Port 6 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 278 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.7.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.10 summarizes the registers of port 6. Table 9.10 Port 6 Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Mode 1 to 5 Mode 6, 7 H'FFC9 Port 6 data direction register P6DDR W H'F8 H'80 H'FFCB Port 6 data register P6DR R/W H'80 H'80 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 6 Data Direction Register (P6DDR) P6DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 6. Bit 7 is reserved. It cannot be modified and is always read as 1. Bit 7 — 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P6 6 DDR P6 5 DDR P6 4 DDR P6 3 DDR P6 2 DDR P6 1 DDR P6 0 DDR Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — W W W W W W W Reserved bit Port 6 data direction 6 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 6 pins Modes 1 to 6 (Expanded Modes): Ports P66 to P63 function as bus control output pins (LWR, HWR, RD, AS), regardless of the settings of P66DDR to P63DDR. Ports P62 to P60 function as the bus control pins (BACK, BREQ, WAIT) or I/O ports. For selecting the pin function, see table 9.11. When ports P62 to P60 function as I/O ports and if P6DDR is set to 1, the corresponding pin of port 6 functions as an output port. If P6DDR is cleared to 0, the corresponding pin functions as an input port. Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 6 is a generic input/output port. A pin in port 6 becomes an output port if the corresponding P6DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. P6DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P6DDR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a P6DDR bit is set to 1 while port 6 acts as an I/O port, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 279 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port 6 Data Register (P6DR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — P6 6 P6 5 P6 4 P6 3 P6 2 P6 1 P6 0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bit Port 6 data 6 to 0 These bits store data for port 6 pins P6DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P66 to P60. When this register is read, bits 6 to 0 each returns the logic level of the pin, when the corresponding bit of P6DDR is 0. When the corresponding bit of P6DDR is 1, bits 6 to 0 return the P6DR value. Bit 7 is reserved, cannot be modified, and always read as 1. P6DR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Table 9.11 Port 6 Pin Functions in Modes 1 to 6 Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method P66/LWR Functions as follows regardless of P66DDR P66DDR 0 P65/HWR Functions as follows regardless of P65DDR P65DDR 0 1 HWR output Pin function P64/RD 1 LWR output Pin function Functions as follows regardless of P64DDR P64DDR 0 RD output Pin function P63/AS 1 Functions as follows regardless of P63DDR P63DDR Pin function Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 280 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 0 1 AS output Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method P62/BACK Bit BRLE in BRCR and bit P62DDR select the pin function as follows BRLE 0 P62DDR Pin function P61/BREQ 0 1 — P62 input P62 output BACK output Bit BRLE in BRCR and bit P61DDR select the pin function as follows BRLE 0 P61DDR Pin function P60/WAIT 1 1 0 1 — P61 input P61 output BREQ input Bits WCE7 to WCE0 in WCER, bit WMS1 in WCR, and bit P60DDR select the pin function as follows WCER All 1s WMS1 P60DDR Pin function 0 0 1 P60 input P60 output Not all 1s 1 — 0* 0* WAIT input Note: * Do not set bit P60DDR to 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 281 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.8 Port 7 9.8.1 Overview Port 7 is an 8-bit input port that is also used for analog input to the A/D converter and analog output from the D/A converter. The pin functions are the same in all operating modes. Figure 9.7 shows the pin configuration of port 7. For the analog input pins of the A/D converter, see section 15, A/D Converter. For the analog input pins of the D/A converter, see section 16, D/A Converter. Port 7 pins P77 (input)/AN 7 (input)/DA 1 (output) P76 (input)/AN 6 (input)/DA 0 (output) P75 (input)/AN 5 (input) Port 7 P74 (input)/AN 4 (input) P73 (input)/AN 3 (input) P72 (input)/AN 2 (input) P71 (input)/AN 1 (input) P70 (input)/AN 0 (input) Figure 9.7 Port 7 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 282 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.8.2 Register Description Table 9.12 summarizes the port 7 register. Port 7 is an input-only port, so it has no data direction register. Table 9.12 Port 7 Data Register Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFCE Port 7 data register P7DR R Undetermined Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 7 Data Register (P7DR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 P77 P76 P75 P74 P73 P72 P71 P70 Initial value —* —* —* —* —* —* —* —* Read/Write R R R R R R R R Note: * Determined by pins P7 7 to P70 . When P7DR is read, the logic level of the pin is always read. No data can be written to. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 283 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.9 Port 8 9.9.1 Overview Port 8 is a 5-bit input/output port that is also used for CS3 to CS0 output, RFSH output, and IRQ3 to IRQ0 input. Figure 9.8 shows the pin configuration of port 8. In modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes), port 8 can provide CS3 to CS0 output, RFSH output, and IRQ3 to IRQ0 input. See table 9.14 for the selection of pin functions in expanded modes. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), port 8 can provide IRQ3 to IRQ0 input. See table 9.15 for the selection of pin functions in single-chip mode. The IRQ3 to IRQ0 functions are selected by IER settings, regardless of whether the pin is used for input or output. For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Pins in port 8 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Pins P82 to P80 have Schmitt-trigger inputs. Port 8 Port 8 pins Pin functions in modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes) P84 / CS 0 P84 (input)/ CS 0 (output) P83 / CS 1 / IRQ 3 P83 (input)/ CS 1 (output)/ IRQ 3 (input) P82 / CS 2 / IRQ 2 P82 (input)/ CS 2 (output)/ IRQ 2 (input) P81 / CS 3 / IRQ 1 P81 (input)/ CS 3 (output)/ IRQ 1 (input) P80 / RFSH /IRQ 0 P80 (input/output)/ RFSH (output)/ IRQ 0 (input) Pin functions in mode 7 (single-chip mode) P84 /(input/output) P83 /(input/output)/ IRQ 3 (input) P82 /(input/output)/ IRQ 2 (input) P81 /(input/output)/ IRQ 1 (input) P80 /(input/output)/ IRQ 0 (input) Figure 9.8 Port 8 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 284 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.9.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.13 summarizes the registers of port 8. Table 9.13 Port 8 Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Mode 1 to 4 Mode 5 to 7 H'FFCD Port 8 data direction register P8DDR W H'F0 H'E0 H'FFCF Port 8 data register P8DR R/W H'E0 H'E0 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 8 Data Direction Register (P8DDR) P8DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 8. Bits 7 to 5 are reserved. They cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Bit Modes Initial value 1 to 4 Read/Write Modes Initial value 5 to 7 Read/Write 7 6 5 — — — 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 — — — W W W W W 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 — — — W W W W W Reserved bits 4 3 2 1 0 P8 4 DDR P8 3 DDR P8 2 DDR P8 1 DDR P8 0 DDR Port 8 data direction 4 to 0 These bits select input or output for port 8 pins Modes 1 to 6 (Expanded Modes): When bits in P8DDR bit are set to 1, P84 to P81 become CS0 to CS3 output pins. When bits in P8DDR are cleared to 0, the corresponding pins become input ports. In modes 1 to 4 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM disabled), following a reset only CS0 is output. The other three pins are input ports. In modes 5 and 6 (expanded modes with on-chip ROM enabled), following a reset all four pins are input ports. When the refresh controller is enabled, P80 is used unconditionally for RFSH output. When the refresh controller is disabled, P80 becomes a generic input/output port according to the P8DDR setting. For details see table 9.15. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 285 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Mode 7 (Single-Chip Mode): Port 8 is a generic input/output port. A pin in port 8 becomes an output port if the corresponding P8DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. P8DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P8DDR is initialized to H'F0 in modes 1 to 4 and H'E0 in modes 5 to 7 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting, so if a P8DDR bit is set to 1 while port 8 acts as an I/O port, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Port 8 Data Register (P8DR) P8DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P84 to P80. While port 8 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in P8DDR is set to 1, if port 8 is read the value of the corresponding P8DR bit is returned. When a bit in P8DDR is cleared to 0, if port 8 is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bits 7 to 5 are reserved. They cannot be modified and always are read as 1. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — P8 4 P8 3 P8 2 P8 1 P8 0 Initial value 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Port 8 data 4 to 0 These bits store data for port 8 pins P8DR is initialized to H'E0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 286 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.14 Port 8 Pin Functions in Modes 1 to 6 Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method P84/CS0 Bit P84DDR selects the pin function as follows P84DDR Pin function P83/CS1/IRQ3 0 1 P84 input CS0 output Bit P83DDR selects the pin function as follows P83DDR Pin function 0 1 P83 input CS1 output IRQ3 input P82/CS2/IRQ2 Bit P82DDR selects the pin function as follows P82DDR Pin function 0 1 P82 input CS2 output IRQ2 input P81/CS3/IRQ1 Bit P81DDR selects the pin function as follows P81DDR Pin function 0 1 P81 input CS3 output IRQ1 input P80/RFSH/IRQ0 Bit RFSHE in RFSHCR and bit P80DDR select the pin function as follows RFSHE P80DDR Pin function 0 1 0 1 — P80 input P80 output RFSH output IRQ0 input Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 287 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.15 Port 8 Pin Functions in Mode 7 Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method P84 Bit P84DDR selects the pin function as follows P84DDR Pin function P83/IRQ3 0 1 P84 input P84 output Bit P83DDR selects the pin function as follows P83DDR Pin function 0 1 P83 input P83 output IRQ3 input P82/IRQ2 Bit P82DDR selects the pin function as follows P82DDR Pin function 0 1 P82 input P82 output IRQ2 input P81/IRQ1 Bit P81DDR selects the pin function as follows P81DDR Pin function 0 1 P81 input P81 output IRQ1 input P80/IRQ0 Bit P80DDR select the pin function as follows P80DDR Pin function 0 1 P80 input P80 output IRQ0 input Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 288 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.10 Port 9 9.10.1 Overview Port 9 is a 6-bit input/output port that is also used for input and output (TxD0, TxD1, RxD0, RxD1, SCK0, SCK1) by serial communication interface channels 0 and 1 (SCI0 and SCI1), and for IRQ5 and IRQ4 input. See table 9.17 for the selection of pin functions. The IRQ5 and IRQ4 functions are selected by IER settings, regardless of whether the pin is used for input or output. For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Port 9 has the same set of pin functions in all operating modes. Figure 9.9 shows the pin configuration of port 9. Pins in port 9 can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port 9 pins P95 (input/output)/SCK 1 (input/output)/IRQ 5 (input) P94 (input/output)/SCK 0 (input/output)/IRQ 4 (input) Port 9 P93 (input/output)/RxD1 (input) P92 (input/output)/RxD0 (input) P91 (input/output)/TxD1 (output) P90 (input/output)/TxD0 (output) Figure 9.9 Port 9 Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 289 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.10.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.16 summarizes the registers of port 9. Table 9.16 Port 9 Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFD0 Port 9 data direction register P9DDR W H'C0 H'FFD2 Port 9 data register P9DR R/W H'C0 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port 9 Data Direction Register (P9DDR) P9DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port 9. Bits 7 and 6 are reserved. They cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PA 7 PA 6 PA 5 PA 4 PA 3 PA 2 PA 1 PA 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port A data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port A pins While port 9 acts as an I/O port, a pin in port 9 becomes an output port if the corresponding P9DDR bit is set to 1, and an input port if this bit is cleared to 0. For selecting the pin function, see table 9.17. P9DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. P9DDR is initialized to H'C0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a P9DDR bit is set to 1 while port 9 acts as an I/O port, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 290 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port 9 Data Register (P9DR) P9DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins P95 to P90. While port 9 acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in P9DDR is set to 1, if port 9 is read the value of the corresponding P9DR bit is returned. When a bit in P9DDR is cleared to 0, if port 9 is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — P9 5 P9 4 P9 3 P9 2 P9 1 P9 0 Initial value 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Port 9 data 5 to 0 These bits store data for port 9 pins Bits 7 and 6 are reserved. They cannot be modified and are always read as 1. P9DR is initialized to H'C0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 291 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Table 9.17 Port 9 Pin Functions Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method P95/SCK1/IRQ5 Bit C/A in SMR of SCI1, bits CKE0 and CKE1 in SCR of SCI1, and bit P95DDR select the pin function as follows CKE1 0 C/A 0 CKE0 0 P95DDR Pin function 1 1 — 1 — — 0 1 — — — P95 input P95 output SCK1 output SCK1 output SCK1 input IRQ5 input P94/SCK0/IRQ4 Bit C/A in SMR of SCI0, bits CKE0 and CKE1 in SCR of SCI0, and bit P94DDR select the pin function as follows CKE1 0 C/A 0 CKE0 0 P94DDR Pin function 1 1 — 1 — — 0 1 — — — P94 input P94 output SCK0 output SCK0 output SCK0 input IRQ4 input P93/RxD1 Bit RE in SCR of SCI1 and bit P93DDR select the pin function as follows RE 0 P93DDR Pin function P92/RxD0 1 0 1 — P93 input P93 output RxD1 input Bit RE in SCR of SCI0, bit SMIF in SCMR, and bit P92DDR select the pin function as follows SMIF 0 RE 0 1 — 0 1 — — P92 input P92 output RxD0 input RxD0 input P92DDR Pin function 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 292 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method P91/TxD1 Bit TE in SCR of SCI1 and bit P91DDR select the pin function as follows TE 0 P91DDR Pin function P90/TxD0 1 0 1 — P91 input P91 output TxD1 output Bit TE in SCR of SCI0, bit SMIF in SCMR, and bit P90DDR select the pin function as follows SMIF 0 TE P90DDR Pin function 0 1 1 — 0 1 — — P90 input P90 output TxD0 output TxD0 output* Note: * Functions as the TxD0 output pin, but there are two states: one in which the pin is driven, and another in which the pin is at high-impedance. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 293 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.11 Port A 9.11.1 Overview Port A is an 8-bit input/output port that is also used for output (TP7 to TP0) from the programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), input and output (TIOCB2, TIOCA2, TIOCB1, TIOCA1, TIOCB0, TIOCA0, TCLKD, TCLKC, TCLKB, TCLKA) by the 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), output (TEND1, TEND0) from the DMA controller (DMAC), CS4 to CS6 output, and address output (A23 to A20). A reset or hardware standby leaves port A as an input port, except that in modes 3, 4, and 6, one pin is always used for A20 output. For selecting the pin function, see table 9.19. Usage of pins for TPC, ITU, and DMAC input and output is described in the sections on those modules. For output of address bits A23 to A21 in modes 3, 4, and 6, see section 6.2.5, Bus Release Control Register (BRCR). For output of CS4 to CS6 in modes 1 to 6, see section 6.3.2, Chip Select Signals. Pins not assigned to any of these functions are available for generic input/output. Figure 9.10 shows the pin configuration of port A. Pins in port A can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a darlington transistor pair. Port A has Schmitt-trigger inputs. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 294 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port A pins PA 7/TP7 /TIOCB2 /A 20 PA 6/TP6 /TIOCA2 /A21/CS4 PA 5/TP5 /TIOCB1 /A22/CS5 PA 4/TP4 /TIOCA1 /A23/CS6 Port A PA 3/TP3 /TIOCB 0 /TCLKD PA 2/TP2 /TIOCA 0 /TCLKC PA 1/TP1 /TEND1 /TCLKB PA 0/TP0 /TEND0 /TCLKA Pin functions in modes 1, 2, and 5 PA 7 (input/output)/TP7 (output)/TIOCB 2 (input/output) PA 6 (input/output)/TP6 (output)/TIOCA 2 (input/output)/CS4 (output) PA 5 (input/output)/TP5 (output)/TIOCB 1 (input/output)/CS5(output) PA 4 (input/output)/TP4 (output)/TIOCA 1 (input/output)/CS6(output) PA 3 (input/output)/TP3 (output)/TIOCB 0 (input/output)/TCLKD (input) PA 2 (input/output)/TP2 (output)/TIOCA 0 (input/output)/TCLKC (input) PA 1 (input/output)/TP1 (output)/TEND 1 (output)/TCLKB (input) PA 0 (input/output)/TP0 (output)/TEND 0 (output)/TCLKA (input) Pin functions in modes 3, 4, and 6 A20 (output) PA 6 (input/output)/TP6 (output)/TIOCA 2 (input/output)/A 21 (output)/CS4 (output) PA 5 (input/output)/TP5 (output)/TIOCB 1 (input/output)/A 22 (output)/CS5 (output) PA 4 (input/output)/TP4 (output)/TIOCA 1 (input/output)/A 23 (output)/CS6 (output) PA 3 (input/output)/TP3 (output)/TIOCB 0 (input/output)/TCLKD (input) PA 2 (input/output)/TP2 (output)/TIOCA 0 (input/output)/TCLKC (input) PA 1 (input/output)/TP1 (output)/TEND 1 (output)/TCLKB (input) PA 0 (input/output)/TP0 (output)/TEND 0 (output)/TCLKA (input) Pin functions in mode 7 PA7 (input/output)/TP7 (output)/TIOCB2 (input/output) PA6 (input/output)/TP6 (output)/TIOCA2 (input/output) PA5 (input/output)/TP5 (output)/TIOCB1 (input/output) PA4 (input/output)/TP4 (output)/TIOCA1 (input/output) PA3 (input/output)/TP3 (output)/TIOCB0 (input/output)/TCLKD (input) PA2 (input/output)/TP2 (output)/TIOCA0 (input/output)/TCLKC (input) PA1 (input/output)/TP1 (output)/TEND1 (output)/TCLKB (input) PA0 (input/output)/TP0 (output)/TEND0 (output)/TCLKA (input) Figure 9.10 Port A Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 295 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.11.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.18 summarizes the registers of port A. Table 9.18 Port A Registers Initial Value Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Modes 1, 2, 5, and 7 Modes 3, 4, and 6 H'FFD1 Port A data direction register PADDR W H'00 H'80 H'FFD3 Port A data register PADR R/W H'00 H'00 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) PADDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port A. When pins are used for TPC output, the corresponding PADDR bits must also be set. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PA7 DDR PA6 DDR PA5 DDR PA4 DDR PA3 DDR PA2 DDR PA1 DDR PA0 DDR Modes 3, 4, and 6 Modes 1, 2, 5, and 7 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — W W W W W W W Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write W W W W W W W W Port A data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port A pins While port A acts as an I/O port, a pin in port A becomes an output pin if the corresponding PADDR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if this bit is cleared to 0. In modes 3, 4, and 6, PA7DDR is fixed at 1 and PA7 functions as an address output pin. PADDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. PADDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode in modes 1, 2, 5, and 7. It is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in hardware standby mode in modes 3, 4, and 6. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a PADDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 296 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port A Data Register (PADR) PADR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins PA7 to PA0. While port A acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in PADDR is set to 1, if port A is read the value of the corresponding PADR bit is returned. When a bit in PADDR is cleared to 0, if port A is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PA 7 PA 6 PA 5 PA 4 PA 3 PA 2 PA 1 PA 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port A data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port A pins PADR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 297 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.11.3 Pin Functions Table 9.19 describes the selection of pin functions. Table 9.19 Port A Pin Functions Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method The mode setting, ITU channel 2 settings (bit PWM2 in TMDR and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in PA7/TP7/ TIOCB2/A20 TIOR2), bit NDER7 in NDERA, and bit PA7DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows Mode 1, 2, 5, 7 3, 4, 6 ITU channel 2 settings (1) in table below PA7DDR — 0 1 1 — NDER7 — — 0 1 — TIOCB2 output PA7 input PA7 output TP7 output A20 output Pin function (2) in table below — TIOCB2 input* Note: * TIOCB2 input when IOB2 = 1 and PWM2 = 0. ITU channel 2 settings (2) IOB2 (1) (2) 0 1 IOB1 0 0 1 — IOB0 0 1 — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 298 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA6/TP6/ TIOCA2/ A21/CS4 The mode setting, bit A21E in BRCR, bit CS4E in CSCR, ITU channel 2 settings (bit PWM2 in TMDR and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR2), bit NDER6 in NDERA, and bit PA6DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows Mode 1, 2, 5 3, 4, 6 CS4E 0 1 A21E — — 0 1 (2) in table table below — 0 — — — — (1) in (2) in table channel 2 table below settings below PA6DDR — 0 1 1 — — 0 1 1 — — — 0 1 1 NDER6 — — 0 1 — — — 0 1 — — — — 0 1 function (1) in 1 ITU Pin — 7 below (1) in (2) in table table below below PA6 TP6 CS4 TIOCA2 PA6 PA6 TP6 A21 CS4 TIOCA2 PA6 PA6 TP6 output input out- out- out- output input out- out- out- out- output input out- out- put put put put put put put put put TIOCA2 PA6 TIOCA2 input* TIOCA2 input* TIOCA2 input* Note: * TIOCA2 input when IOA2 = 1. ITU channel 2 (2) (1) (2) (1) settings PWM2 0 IOA2 1 0 1 — IOA1 0 0 1 — — IOA0 0 1 — — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 299 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA5/TP5/ The mode setting, bit A22E in BRCR, bit CS5E in CSCR, ITU channel 1 settings (bit PWM1 in TMDR and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR1), bit NDER5 in NDERA, and bit PA5DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows TIOCB1/ A22/CS5 Mode 1, 2, 5 3, 4, 6 CS5E 0 1 A22E — — 0 1 (2) in table table below — 0 — — — — (1) in (2) in table channel 1 table below settings below PA5DDR — 0 1 1 — — 0 1 1 — — — 0 1 1 NDER5 — — 0 1 — — — 0 1 — — — — 0 1 function (1) in 1 ITU Pin — 7 below (1) in (2) in table table below below PA5 TP5 CS5 TIOCB1 PA5 PA5 TP5 A22 CS5 TIOCB1 PA5 PA5 TP5 output input out- out- out- output input out- out- out- out- output input out- out- put put put put put put put put put TIOCB1 PA5 TIOCB1 input* TIOCB1 input* TIOCB1 input* Note: * TIOCB1 input when IOB2 = 1 and PWM1 = 0. ITU channel 1 (2) (1) (2) settings IOB2 0 1 IOB1 0 0 1 — IOB0 0 1 — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 300 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA4/TP4/ TIOCA1/ A23/CS6 The mode setting, bit A23E in BRCR, bit CS6E in CSCR, ITU channel 1 settings (bit PWM1 in TMDR and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR1), bit NDER4 in NDERA, and bit PA4DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows Mode 1, 2, 5 3, 4, 6 CS6E 0 1 A23E — — ITU (1) in (2) in table channel 2 table below settings below — 7 0 1 (1) in (2) in table table below 1 — 0 — — — — below (1) in (2) in table table below below PA4DDR — 0 1 1 — — 0 1 1 — — — 0 1 1 NDER4 — — 0 1 — — — 0 1 — — — — 0 1 Pin function PA4 TP4 CS6 TIOCA1 PA4 PA4 TP4 A23 CS6 TIOCA1 PA4 PA4 TP4 output input out- out- out- output input out- out- out- out- output input out- out- put put put put put put put put put TIOCA1 PA4 TIOCA1 input* TIOCA1 input* TIOCA1 input* Note: * TIOCA1 input when IOA2 = 1. ITU channel 1 (2) (1) (2) (1) settings PWM1 0 IOA2 1 0 1 — IOA1 0 0 1 — — IOA0 0 1 — — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 301 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA3/TP3/ TIOCB0/ TCLKD ITU channel 0 settings (bit PWM0 in TMDR and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR0), bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR4 to TCR0, bit NDER3 in NDERA, and bit PA3DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows ITU channel 0 settings PA3DDR NDER3 Pin function (1) in table below — (2) in table below 0 1 1 — — 0 1 TIOCB0 output PA3 input PA3 output TP3 output 1 TIOCB0 input* 2 TCLKD input* Notes: 1. TIOCB0 input when IOB2 = 1 and PWM0 = 0. 2. TCLKD input when TPSC2 = TPSC1 = TPSC0 = 1 in any of TCR4 to TCR0. ITU channel 0 settings (2) IOB2 (1) (2) 0 1 IOB1 0 0 1 — IOB0 0 1 — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 302 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA2/TP2/ TIOCA0/ TCLKC ITU channel 0 settings (bit PWM0 in TMDR and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR0), bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR4 to TCR0, bit NDER2 in NDERA, and bit PA2DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows ITU channel 0 settings (1) in table below PA2DDR — NDER2 Pin function (2) in table below 0 1 1 — — 0 1 IOCA0 output PA2 input PA2 output TP2 output 1 TIOCA0 input* 2 TCLKC input* Notes: 1. TIOCA0 input when IOA2 = 1. 2. TCLKC input when TPSC2 = TPSC1 = 1 and TPSC0 = 0 in any of TCR4 to TCR0. ITU channel 0 settings (2) (1) PWM0 (2) 0 IOA2 (1) 1 1 — IOA1 0 0 0 1 — — IOA0 0 1 — — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 303 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA1/TP1/ TCLKB/ TEND1 DMAC channel 1 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR1A and DTCR1B), bit NDER1 in NDERA, and bit PA1DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows DMAC channel 1 settings (1) in table below PA1DDR — NDER1 Pin function (2) in table below 0 1 1 — — 0 1 TEND1 output PA1 input PA1 output TP1 output TCLKB input* Note: * TCLKB input when MDF = 1 in TMDR, or when TPSC2 = 1, TPSC1 = 0, and TPSC0 = 1 in any of TCR4 to TCR0. DMAC channel 1 settings (2) (1) DTS2A, DTS1A Not both 1 DTS0A — (2) (1) (2) (1) Both 1 0 0 1 1 1 DTS2B 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 DTS1B — 0 1 — — — 0 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 304 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PA0/TP0/ TCLKA/ TEND0 DMAC channel 0 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR0A and DTCR0B), bit NDER0 in NDERA, and bit PA0DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows DMAC channel 0 settings (1) in table below PA0DDR — NDER0 Pin function (2) in table below 0 1 1 — — 0 1 TEND0 output PA0 input PA0 output TP0 output TCLKA input* Note: * TCLKA input when MDF = 1 in TMDR, or when TPSC2 = 1 and TPSC1 = 0 in any of TCR4 to TCR0. DMAC channel 0 settings (2) (1) DTS2A, DTS1A Not both 1 DTS0A — (2) (1) (2) (1) Both 1 0 0 1 1 1 DTS2B 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 DTS1B — 0 1 — — — 0 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 305 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.12 Port B 9.12.1 Overview Port B is an 8-bit input/output port that is also used for output (TP15 to TP8) from the programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), input/output (TIOCB4, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TIOCA3) and output (TOCXB4, TOCXA4) by the 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), input (DREQ1, DREQ0) to the DMA controller (DMAC), ADTRG input to the A/D converter, and CS7 output. A reset or hardware standby leaves port B as an input port. For selecting the pin function, see table 9.21. Usage of pins for TPC, ITU, DMAC, and A/D converter input and output is described in the sections on those modules. For output of CS7 in modes 1 to 6, see section 6.3.2, Chip Select Signals. Pins not assigned to any of these functions are available for generic input/output. Figure 9.11 shows the pin configuration of port B. Pins in port B can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive an LED or darlington transistor pair. Pins PB3 to PB0 have Schmitt-trigger inputs. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 306 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port B pins PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG PB6/TP14/DREQ0/CS7 PB5/TP13/TOCXB4 PB4/TP12/TOCXA4 Port B PB3/TP11/TIOCB4 PB2/TP10/TIOCA4 PB1/TP9/TIOCB3 PB0/TP8/TIOCA3 Pin functions in modes 1 to 6 PB7 (input/output)/TP15 (output)/DREQ1 (input)/ADTRG (input) PB6 (input/output)/TP14 (output)/DREQ0 (input)/CS7 (output) PB5 (input/output)/TP13 (output)/TOCXB4 (output) PB4 (input/output)/TP12 (output)/TOCXA4 (output) PB3 (input/output)/TP11 (output)/TIOCB4 (input/output) PB2 (input/output)/TP10 (output)/TIOCA4 (input/output) PB1 (input/output)/TP9 (output)/TIOCB3 (input/output) PB0 (input/output)/TP8 (output)/TIOCA3 (input/output) Pin functions in mode 7 PB7 (input/output)/TP15 (output)/DREQ1 (input)/ADTRG (input) PB6 (input/output)/TP14 (output)/DREQ0 (input) PB5 (input/output)/TP13 (output)/TOCXB4 (output) PB4 (input/output)/TP12 (output)/TOCXA4 (output) PB3 (input/output)/TP11 (output)/TIOCB4 (input/output) PB2 (input/output)/TP10 (output)/TIOCA4 (input/output) PB1 (input/output)/TP9 (output)/TIOCB3 (input/output) PB0 (input/output)/TP8 (output)/TIOCA3 (input/output) Figure 9.11 Port B Pin Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 307 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.12.2 Register Descriptions Table 9.20 summarizes the registers of port B. Table 9.20 Port B Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFD4 Port B data direction register PBDDR W H'00 H'FFD6 Port B data register PBDR R/W H'00 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) PBDDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select input or output for each pin in port B. When pins are used for TPC output, the corresponding PBDDR bits must also be set. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PB7 DDR PB6 DDR PB5 DDR PB4 DDR PB3 DDR PB2 DDR PB1 DDR PB0 DDR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write W W W W W W W W Port B data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port B pins While port B acts as an I/O port, a pin in port B becomes an output pin if the corresponding PBDDR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if this bit is cleared to 0. PBDDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read. PBDDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. If a PBDDR bit is set to 1 while port B acts as an I/O port, the corresponding pin maintains its output state in software standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 308 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Port B Data Register (PBDR) PBDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores output data for pins PB7 to PB0. While port B acts as an output port, the value of this register is output. When a bit in PBDDR is set to 1, if port B is read the value of the corresponding PBDR bit is returned. When a bit in PBDDR is cleared to 0, if port B is read the corresponding pin level is read. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PB 7 PB 6 PB 5 PB 4 PB 3 PB 2 PB 1 PB 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Port B data 7 to 0 These bits store data for port B pins PBDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous setting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 309 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports 9.12.3 Pin Functions Table 9.21 describes the selection of pin functions. Table 9.21 Port B Pin Functions Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PB7/TP15/ DREQ1/ ADTRG DMAC channel 1 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR1A and DTCR1B), bit TRGE in ADCR, bit NDER15 in NDERB, and bit PB7DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows PB7DDR 0 1 1 NDER15 — 0 1 PB7 input PB7 output Pin function TP15 output 1 DREQ1 input* 2 ADTRG input* Notes: 1. DREQ1 input under DMAC channel 1 settings (1) in the table below. 2. ADTRG input when TRGE = 1. DMAC channel 1 settings (2) DTS2A, DTS1A Not both 1 DTS0A (1) (2) (1) (2) (1) Both 1 — 0 0 1 1 1 DTS2B 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 DTS1B — 0 1 — — — 0 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 310 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PB6/TP14/ DREQ0/ CS7 Bit CS7E in CSCR, DMAC channel 0 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR0A and DTCR0B), bit NDER14 in NDERB, and bit PB6DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows PB6DDR 0 1 1 — CS7E 0 0 0 1 NDER14 — 0 1 — PB6 input PB6 output TP14 output — Pin function DREQ0 input* CS7 output Note: * DREQ0 input under DMAC channel 0 settings (1) in the table below. DMAC channel 0 settings (2) DTS2A, DTS1A Not both 1 DTS0A PB5/TP13/ TOCXB4 (1) (1) (2) (1) Both 1 — 0 0 1 1 1 DTS2B 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 DTS1B — 0 1 — — — 0 1 ITU channel 4 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR and bit EXB4 in TOER), bit NDER13 in NDERB, and bit PB5DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows EXB4, CMD1 Not both 1 Both 1 PB5DDR 0 1 1 — NDER13 — 0 1 — PB5 input PB5 output TP13 output TOCXB4 output Pin function PB4/TP12/ TOCXA4 (2) ITU channel 4 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR and bit EXA4 in TOER), bit NDER12 in NDERB, and bit PB4DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows EXA4, CMD1 Not both 1 Both 1 PB4DDR 0 1 1 — NDER12 — 0 1 — PB4 input PB4 output TP12 output TOCXA4 output Pin function Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 311 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PB3/TP11/ TIOCB4 ITU channel 4 settings (bit PWM4 in TMDR, bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EB4 in TOER, and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR4), bit NDER11 in NDERB, and bit PB3DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows ITU channel 4 settings (1) in table below (2) in table below PB3DDR — 0 1 1 NDER11 — — 0 1 TIOCB4 output PB3 input PB3 output TP11 output Pin function TIOCB4 input* Note: * TIOCB4 input when CMD1 = PWM4 = 0 and IOB2 = 1. ITU channel 4 settings PB2/TP10/ TIOCA4 (2) (2) (1) (2) (1) EB4 0 CMD1 — 1 IOB2 — 0 0 0 1 — IOB1 — 0 0 1 — — IOB0 — 0 1 — — — 0 1 ITU channel 4 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EA4 in TOER, bit PWM4 in TMDR, and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR4), bit NDER10 in NDERB, and bit PB2DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows ITU channel 4 settings (1) in table below (2) in table below PB2DDR — 0 1 1 NDER10 — — 0 1 TIOCA4 output PB2 input PB2 output TP10 output Pin function TIOCA4 input* Note: * TIOCA4 input when CMD1 = PWM4 = 0 and IOA2 = 1. ITU channel 4 settings (2) (2) (1) EA4 0 CMD1 — PWM4 — IOA2 — 0 0 IOA1 — 0 IOA0 — 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 312 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (2) (1) 1 0 1 0 1 — 0 1 — — 0 1 — — — 1 — — — — Section 9 I/O Ports Pin Pin Functions and Selection Method PB1/TP9/ TIOCB3 ITU channel 3 settings (bit PWM3 in TMDR, bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EB3 in TOER, and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR3), bit NDER9 in NDERB, and bit PB1DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows ITU channel 3 settings (1) in table below (2) in table below PB1DDR — 0 1 1 NDER9 — — 0 1 TIOCB3 output PB1 input PB1 output TP9 output Pin function TIOCB3 input* Note: * TIOCB3 input when CMD1 = PWM3 = 0 and IOB2 = 1. ITU channel 3 settings PB0/TP8/ TIOCA3 (2) (2) (1) (2) (1) EB3 0 CMD1 — 1 IOB2 — 0 0 0 1 — IOB1 — 0 0 1 — — IOB0 — 0 1 — — — 0 1 ITU channel 3 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EA3 in TOER, bit PWM3 in TMDR, and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR3), bit NDER8 in NDERB, and bit PB0DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows ITU channel 3 settings (1) in table below (2) in table below PB0DDR — 0 1 1 NDER8 — — 0 1 TIOCA3 output PB0 input PB0 output TP8 output Pin function TIOCA3 input* Note: * TIOCA3 input when CMD1 = PWM3 = 0 and IOA2 = 1. ITU channel 3 settings (2) (2) (1) EA3 0 CMD1 — PWM3 — IOA2 — 0 0 IOA1 — 0 IOA0 — 0 (2) (1) 1 0 1 0 1 — 0 1 — — 0 1 — — — 1 — — — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 313 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 9 I/O Ports Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 314 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has a built-in 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) with five 16-bit timer channels. When the ITU is not used, it can be independently halted to conserve power. For details see section 21.6, Module Standby Function. 10.1.1 Features ITU features are listed below. • Capability to process up to 12 pulse outputs or 10 pulse inputs • Ten general registers (GRs, two per channel) with independently-assignable output compare or input capture functions • Selection of eight counter clock sources for each channel: Internal clocks: φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 External clocks: TCLKA, TCLKB, TCLKC, TCLKD • Five operating modes selectable in all channels: Waveform output by compare match Selection of 0 output, 1 output, or toggle output (only 0 or 1 output in channel 2) Input capture function Rising edge, falling edge, or both edges (selectable) Counter clearing function Counters can be cleared by compare match or input capture Synchronization Two or more timer counters (TCNTs) can be preset simultaneously, or cleared simultaneously by compare match or input capture. Counter synchronization enables synchronous register input and output. PWM mode PWM output can be provided with an arbitrary duty cycle. With synchronization, up to five-phase PWM output is possible • Phase counting mode selectable in channel 2 Two-phase encoder output can be counted automatically. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 315 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) • Three additional modes selectable in channels 3 and 4 Reset-synchronized PWM mode If channels 3 and 4 are combined, three-phase PWM output is possible with three pairs of complementary waveforms. Complementary PWM mode If channels 3 and 4 are combined, three-phase PWM output is possible with three pairs of non-overlapping complementary waveforms. Buffering Input capture registers can be double-buffered. Output compare registers can be updated automatically. • High-speed access via internal 16-bit bus The 16-bit timer counters, general registers, and buffer registers can be accessed at high speed via a 16-bit bus. • Fifteen interrupt sources Each channel has two compare match/input capture interrupts and an overflow interrupt. All interrupts can be requested independently. • Activation of DMA controller (DMAC) Four of the compare match/input capture interrupts from channels 0 to 3 can start the DMAC. • Output triggering of programmable timing pattern controller (TPC) Compare match/input capture signals from channels 0 to 3 can be used as TPC output triggers. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 316 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Table 10.1 summarizes the ITU functions. Table 10.1 ITU Functions Item Channel 0 Clock sources Internal clocks: φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 3 Channel 4 External clocks: TCLKA, TCLKB, TCLKC, TCLKD, selectable independently General registers (output compare/input capture registers) GRA0, GRB0 GRA1, GRB1 GRA2, GRB2 GRA3, GRB3 GRA4, GRB4 Buffer registers — — — BRA3, BRB3 BRA4, BRB4 Input/output pins TIOCA0, TIOCB0 TIOCA1, TIOCB1 TIOCA2, TIOCB2 TIOCA3, TIOCB3 TIOCA4, TIOCB4 Output pins — — — — TOCXA4, TOCXB4 Counter clearing function GRA0/GRB0 GRA1/GRB1 GRA2/GRB2 GRA3/GRB3 GRA4/GRB4 compare match compare match compare match compare match compare match or input capture or input capture or input capture or input capture or input capture Compare match 0 output 1 O O O O O O O O O O O O — O O Input capture function O O O O O Synchronization O O O O O PWM mode O O O O O Reset-synchronized PWM mode — — — O O Complementary PWM mode — — — O O Phase counting mode — — O — — Buffering — — — O O DMAC activation GRA0 compare GRA1 compare GRA2 compare GRA3 compare — match or input match or input match or input match or input capture capture capture capture Toggle Interrupt sources Three sources Three sources Three sources • Compare match/input capture A0 • Compare match/input capture A1 • Compare • Compare match/input match/input capture A2 capture A3 • Compare match/input capture A4 • Compare match/input capture B0 • Compare match/input capture B1 • Compare • Compare match/input match/input capture B2 capture B3 • Compare match/input capture B4 • Overflow • Overflow • Overflow Three sources • Three sources Overflow • Overflow Legend O: Available —: Not available Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 317 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.1.2 Block Diagrams ITU Block Diagram (Overall): Figure 10.1 is a block diagram of the ITU. TCLKA to TCLKD IMIA0 to IMIA4 IMIB0 to IMIB4 OVI0 to OVI4 Clock selector φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 Control logic TOCXA4, TOCXB4 TIOCA0 to TIOCA4 TIOCB0 to TIOCB4 TSTR TSNC TMDR TFCR Module data bus Legend TOER: TOCR: TSTR: TSNC: TMDR: TFCR: Timer output master enable register (8 bits) Timer output control register (8 bits) Timer start register (8 bits) Timer synchro register (8 bits) Timer mode register (8 bits) Timer function control register (8 bits) Figure 10.1 ITU Block Diagram (Overall) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 318 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Internal data bus TOCR Bus interface 16-bit timer channel 0 16-bit timer channel 1 16-bit timer channel 2 16-bit timer channel 3 16-bit timer channel 4 TOER Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Block Diagram of Channels 0 and 1: ITU channels 0 and 1 are functionally identical. Both have the structure shown in figure 10.2. TCLKA to TCLKD φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 TIOCA0 TIOCB0 Clock selector Control logic IMIA0 IMIB0 OVI0 TSR TIER TIOR TCR GRB GRA TCNT Comparator Module data bus Legend TCNT: GRA, GRB: TCR: TIOR: TIER: TSR: Timer counter (16 bits) General registers A and B (input capture/output compare registers) (16 bits × 2) Timer control register (8 bits) Timer I/O control register (8 bits) Timer interrupt enable register (8 bits) Timer status register (8 bits) Figure 10.2 Block Diagram of Channels 0 and 1 (for Channel 0) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 319 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Block Diagram of Channel 2: Figure 10.3 is a block diagram of channel 2. This is the channel that provides only 0 output and 1 output. TCLKA to TCLKD φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 TIOCA2 TIOCB2 Clock selector Control logic IMIA2 IMIB2 OVI2 TSR2 TIER2 TIOR2 TCR2 GRB2 GRA2 TCNT2 Comparator Module data bus Legend Timer counter 2 (16 bits) TCNT2: GRA2, GRB2: General registers A2 and B2 (input capture/output compare registers) (16 bits × 2) Timer control register 2 (8 bits) TCR2: Timer I/O control register 2 (8 bits) TIOR2: Timer interrupt enable register 2 (8 bits) TIER2: Timer status register 2 (8 bits) TSR2: Figure 10.3 Block Diagram of Channel 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 320 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Block Diagrams of Channels 3 and 4: Figure 10.4 is a block diagram of channel 3. Figure 10.5 is a block diagram of channel 4. TCLKA to TCLKD φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 TIOCA3 TIOCB3 Clock selector Control logic IMIA3 IMIB3 OVI3 TSR3 TIER3 TIOR3 TCR3 GRB3 BRB3 GRA3 BRA3 TCNT3 Comparator Module data bus Legend Timer counter 3 (16 bits) TCNT3: GRA3, GRB3: General registers A3 and B3 (input capture/output compare registers) (16 bits × 2) BRA3, BRB3: Buffer registers A3 and B3 (input capture/output compare buffer registers) (16 bits × 2) Timer control register 3 (8 bits) TCR3: TIOR3: Timer I/O control register 3 (8 bits) TIER3: Timer interrupt enable register 3 (8 bits) TSR3: Timer status register 3 (8 bits) Figure 10.4 Block Diagram of Channel 3 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 321 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) TCLKA to TCLKD φ, φ/2, φ/4, φ/8 TOCXA4 TOCXB4 TIOCA4 TIOCB4 IMIA4 IMIB4 OVI4 Clock selector Control logic TSR4 TIER4 TIOR4 TCR4 GRB4 BRB4 GRA4 BRA4 TCNT4 Comparator Module data bus Legend Timer counter 4 (16 bits) TCNT4: GRA4, GRB4: General registers A4 and B4 (input capture/output compare registers) (16 bits × 2) BRA4, BRB4: Buffer registers A4 and B4 (input capture/output compare buffer registers) (16 bits × 2) Timer control register 4 (8 bits) TCR4: TIOR4: Timer I/O control register 4 (8 bits) TIER4: Timer interrupt enable register 4 (8 bits) TSR4: Timer status register 4 (8 bits) Figure 10.5 Block Diagram of Channel 4 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 322 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.1.3 Input/Output Pins Table 10.2 summarizes the ITU pins. Table 10.2 ITU Pins Abbreviation Input/ Output Common Clock input A TCLKA Input External clock A input pin (phase-A input pin in phase counting mode) Clock input B TCLKB Input External clock B input pin (phase-B input pin in phase counting mode) Clock input C TCLKC Input External clock C input pin Clock input D TCLKD Input External clock D input pin Input capture/output compare A0 TIOCA0 Input/ output GRA0 output compare or input capture pin PWM output pin in PWM mode Input capture/output compare B0 TIOCB0 Input/ output GRB0 output compare or input capture pin Input capture/output compare A1 TIOCA1 Input/ output GRA1 output compare or input capture pin PWM output pin in PWM mode Input capture/output compare B1 TIOCB1 Input/ output GRB1 output compare or input capture pin Input capture/output compare A2 TIOCA2 Input/ output GRA2 output compare or input capture pin PWM output pin in PWM mode Input capture/output compare B2 TIOCB2 Input/ output GRB2 output compare or input capture pin Input capture/output compare A3 TIOCA3 Input/ output Input capture/output compare B3 TIOCB3 Input/ output GRA3 output compare or input capture pin PWM output pin in PWM mode, t compare PWM or dinput capture t pin GRB3l output Input capture/output compare A4 TIOCA4 Input/ output Input capture/output compare B4 TIOCB4 Input/ output Channel 0 1 2 3 4 Name Output compare XA4 TOCXA4 Output Output compare XB4 TOCXB4 Output Function PWM output pin in complementary PWM d output tcompare h or i input d PWM GRA4 captured pin PWM output pin in PWM mode, t compare PWM or dinput capture t pin GRB4l output PWM output pin in complementary PWM d output pin t in complementary h i d PWM PWM d PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode PWM output pin in complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 323 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.1.4 Register Configuration Table 10.3 summarizes the ITU registers. Table 10.3 ITU Registers Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FF60 Timer start register TSTR R/W H'E0 H'FF61 Timer synchro register TSNC R/W H'E0 H'FF62 Timer mode register TMDR R/W H'80 H'FF63 Timer function control register TFCR R/W H'C0 H'FF90 Timer output master enable register TOER R/W H'FF H'FF91 Timer output control register TOCR R/W H'FF H'FF64 Timer control register 0 TCR0 R/W H'80 H'FF65 Timer I/O control register 0 TIOR0 R/W H'88 H'FF66 Timer interrupt enable register 0 TIER0 R/W Channel Address* Common 0 1 1 H'F8 2 H'FF67 Timer status register 0 TSR0 R/(W)* H'F8 H'FF68 Timer counter 0 (high) TCNT0H R/W H'00 H'FF69 Timer counter 0 (low) TCNT0L R/W H'00 H'FF6A General register A0 (high) GRA0H R/W H'FF H'FF6B General register A0 (low) GRA0L R/W H'FF H'FF6C General register B0 (high) GRB0H R/W H'FF H'FF6D General register B0 (low) GRB0L R/W H'FF H'FF6E Timer control register 1 TCR1 R/W H'80 H'FF6F Timer I/O control register 1 TIOR1 R/W H'88 H'FF70 Timer interrupt enable register 1 TIER1 R/W H'F8 2 H'FF71 Timer status register 1 TSR1 R/(W)* H'F8 H'FF72 Timer counter 1 (high) TCNT1H R/W H'00 H'FF73 Timer counter 1 (low) TCNT1L R/W H'00 H'FF74 General register A1 (high) GRA1H R/W H'FF H'FF75 General register A1 (low) GRA1L R/W H'FF H'FF76 General register B1 (high) GRB1H R/W H'FF H'FF77 General register B1 (low) GRB1L R/W H'FF Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 324 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value Timer control register 2 TCR2 R/W H'80 H'FF79 Timer I/O control register 2 TIOR2 R/W H'88 H'FF7A Timer interrupt enable register 2 TIER2 R/W Channel Address* 2 H'FF78 3 1 H'F8 2 H'FF7B Timer status register 2 TSR2 R/(W)* H'F8 H'FF7C Timer counter 2 (high) TCNT2H R/W H'00 H'FF7D Timer counter 2 (low) TCNT2L R/W H'00 H'FF7E General register A2 (high) GRA2H R/W H'FF H'FF7F General register A2 (low) GRA2L R/W H'FF H'FF80 General register B2 (high) GRB2H R/W H'FF H'FF81 General register B2 (low) GRB2L R/W H'FF H'FF82 Timer control register 3 TCR3 R/W H'80 H'FF83 Timer I/O control register 3 TIOR3 R/W H'88 H'FF84 Timer interrupt enable register 3 TIER3 R/W H'F8 2 H'FF85 Timer status register 3 TSR3 R/(W)* H'F8 H'FF86 Timer counter 3 (high) TCNT3H R/W H'00 H'FF87 Timer counter 3 (low) TCNT3L R/W H'00 H'FF88 General register A3 (high) GRA3H R/W H'FF H'FF89 General register A3 (low) GRA3L R/W H'FF H'FF8A General register B3 (high) GRB3H R/W H'FF H'FF8B General register B3 (low) GRB3L R/W H'FF H'FF8C Buffer register A3 (high) BRA3H R/W H'FF H'FF8D Buffer register A3 (low) BRA3L R/W H'FF H'FF8E Buffer register B3 (high) BRB3H R/W H'FF H'FF8F Buffer register B3 (low) BRB3L R/W H'FF Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 325 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value Timer control register 4 TCR4 R/W H'80 H'FF93 Timer I/O control register 4 TIOR4 R/W H'88 H'FF94 Timer interrupt enable register 4 TIER4 R/W Channel Address* 4 H'FF92 1 H'F8 2 H'FF95 Timer status register 4 TSR4 R/(W)* H'F8 H'FF96 Timer counter 4 (high) TCNT4H R/W H'00 H'FF97 Timer counter 4 (low) TCNT4L R/W H'00 H'FF98 General register A4 (high) GRA4H R/W H'FF H'FF99 General register A4 (low) GRA4L R/W H'FF H'FF9A General register B4 (high) GRB4H R/W H'FF H'FF9B General register B4 (low) GRB4L R/W H'FF H'FF9C Buffer register A4 (high) BRA4H R/W H'FF H'FF9D Buffer register A4 (low) BRA4L R/W H'FF H'FF9E Buffer register B4 (high) BRB4H R/W H'FF H'FF9F Buffer register B4 (low) BRB4L R/W H'FF Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 326 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2 Register Descriptions 10.2.1 Timer Start Register (TSTR) TSTR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that starts and stops the timer counter (TCNT) in channels 0 to 4. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — STR4 STR3 STR2 STR1 STR0 Initial value 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Counter start 4 to 0 These bits start and stop TCNT4 to TCNT0 TSTR is initialized to H'E0 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 to 5—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 4—Counter Start 4 (STR4): Starts and stops timer counter 4 (TCNT4). Bit 4: STR4 Description 0 TCNT4 is halted 1 TCNT4 is counting (Initial value) Bit 3—Counter Start 3 (STR3): Starts and stops timer counter 3 (TCNT3). Bit 3: STR3 Description 0 TCNT3 is halted 1 TCNT3 is counting (Initial value) Bit 2—Counter Start 2 (STR2): Starts and stops timer counter 2 (TCNT2). Bit 2: STR2 Description 0 TCNT2 is halted 1 TCNT2 is counting (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 327 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 1—Counter Start 1 (STR1): Starts and stops timer counter 1 (TCNT1). Bit 1: STR1 Description 0 TCNT1 is halted 1 TCNT1 is counting (Initial value) Bit 0—Counter Start 0 (STR0): Starts and stops timer counter 0 (TCNT0). Bit 0: STR0 Description 0 TCNT0 is halted 1 TCNT0 is counting 10.2.2 (Initial value) Timer Synchro Register (TSNC) TSNC is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects whether channels 0 to 4 operate independently or synchronously. Channels are synchronized by setting the corresponding bits to 1. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — SYNC4 SYNC3 SYNC2 SYNC1 SYNC0 Initial value 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Timer sync 4 to 0 These bits synchronize channels 4 to 0 TSNC is initialized to H'E0 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 to 5—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 4—Timer Sync 4 (SYNC4): Selects whether channel 4 operates independently or synchronously. Bit 4: SYNC4 Description 0 Channel 4’s timer counter (TCNT4) operates independently TCNT4 is preset and cleared independently of other channels 1 Channel 4 operates synchronously TCNT4 can be synchronously preset and cleared Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 328 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 3—Timer Sync 3 (SYNC3): Selects whether channel 3 operates independently or synchronously. Bit 3: SYNC3 Description 0 Channel 3’s timer counter (TCNT3) operates independently (Initial value) TCNT3 is preset and cleared independently of other channels 1 Channel 3 operates synchronously TCNT3 can be synchronously preset and cleared Bit 2—Timer Sync 2 (SYNC2): Selects whether channel 2 operates independently or synchronously. Bit 2: SYNC2 Description 0 Channel 2’s timer counter (TCNT2) operates independently 1 Channel 2 operates synchronously (Initial value) TCNT2 is preset and cleared independently of other channels TCNT2 can be synchronously preset and cleared Bit 1—Timer Sync 1 (SYNC1): Selects whether channel 1 operates independently or synchronously. Bit 1: SYNC1 Description 0 Channel 1’s timer counter (TCNT1) operates independently 1 Channel 1 operates synchronously (Initial value) TCNT1 is preset and cleared independently of other channels TCNT1 can be synchronously preset and cleared Bit 0—Timer Sync 0 (SYNC0): Selects whether channel 0 operates independently or synchronously. Bit 0: Bit 0 Description 0 Channel 0’s timer counter (TCNT0) operates independently 1 Channel 0 operates synchronously (Initial value) TCNT0 is preset and cleared independently of other channels TCNT0 can be synchronously preset and cleared Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 329 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2.3 Timer Mode Register (TMDR) TMDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects PWM mode for channels 0 to 4. It also selects phase counting mode and the overflow flag (OVF) setting conditions for channel 2. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — MDF FDIR PWM4 PWM3 PWM2 PWM1 PWM0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W PWM mode 4 to 0 These bits select PWM mode for channels 4 to 0 Flag direction Selects the setting condition for the overflow flag (OVF) in timer status register 2 (TSR2) Phase counting mode flag Selects phase counting mode for channel 2 Reserved bit TMDR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Bit 6—Phase Counting Mode Flag (MDF): Selects whether channel 2 operates normally or in phase counting mode. Bit 6: MDF Description 0 Channel 2 operates normally 1 Channel 2 operates in phase counting mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 330 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) When MDF is set to 1 to select phase counting mode, TCNT2 operates as an up/down-counter and pins TCLKA and TCLKB become counter clock input pins. TCNT2 counts both rising and falling edges of TCLKA and TCLKB, and counts up or down as follows. Counting Direction Down-Counting TCLKA pin ↑ Low TCLKB pin High ↑ Up-Counting ↓ High Low ↓ ↑ High Low ↓ ↓ Low High ↓ In phase counting mode channel 2 operates as above regardless of the external clock edges selected by bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 and the clock source selected by bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR2. Phase counting mode takes precedence over these settings. The counter clearing condition selected by the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR2 and the compare match/input capture settings and interrupt functions of TIOR2, TIER2, and TSR2 remain effective in phase counting mode. Bit 5—Flag Direction (FDIR): Designates the setting condition for the OVF flag in TSR2. The FDIR designation is valid in all modes in channel 2. Bit 5: FDIR Description 0 OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows or underflows 1 OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows (Initial value) Bit 4—PWM Mode 4 (PWM4): Selects whether channel 4 operates normally or in PWM mode. Bit 4: PWM4 Description 0 Channel 4 operates normally 1 Channel 4 operates in PWM mode (Initial value) When bit PWM4 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA4 becomes a PWM output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA4, and to 0 at compare match with GRB4. If complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected by bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR, the CMD1 and CMD0 setting takes precedence and the PWM4 setting is ignored. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 331 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 3—PWM Mode 3 (PWM3): Selects whether channel 3 operates normally or in PWM mode. Bit 3: PWM3 Description 0 Channel 3 operates normally 1 Channel 3 operates in PWM mode (Initial value) When bit PWM3 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA3 becomes a PWM output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA3, and to 0 at compare match with GRB3. If complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected by bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR, the CMD1 and CMD0 setting takes precedence and the PWM3 setting is ignored. Bit 2—PWM Mode 2 (PWM2): Selects whether channel 2 operates normally or in PWM mode. Bit 2: PWM2 Description 0 Channel 2 operates normally 1 Channel 2 operates in PWM mode (Initial value) When bit PWM2 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA2 becomes a PWM output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA2, and to 0 at compare match with GRB2. Bit 1—PWM Mode 1 (PWM1): Selects whether channel 1 operates normally or in PWM mode. Bit 1: PWM1 Description 0 Channel 1 operates normally 1 Channel 1 operates in PWM mode (Initial value) When bit PWM1 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA1 becomes a PWM output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA1, and to 0 at compare match with GRB1. Bit 0—PWM Mode 0 (PWM0): Selects whether channel 0 operates normally or in PWM mode. Bit 0: PWM0 Description 0 Channel 0 operates normally 1 Channel 0 operates in PWM mode (Initial value) When bit PWM0 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA0 becomes a PWM output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA0, and to 0 at compare match with GRB0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 332 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2.4 Timer Function Control Register (TFCR) TFCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects complementary PWM mode, resetsynchronized PWM mode, and buffering for channels 3 and 4. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — CMD1 CMD0 BFB4 BFA4 BFB3 BFA3 Initial value 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Combination mode 1/0 These bits select complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode for channels 3 and 4 Buffer mode B4 and A4 These bits select buffering of general registers (GRB4 and GRA4) by buffer registers (BRB4 and BRA4) in channel 4 Buffer mode B3 and A3 These bits select buffering of general registers (GRB3 and GRA3) by buffer registers (BRB3 and BRA3) in channel 3 TFCR is initialized to H'C0 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bits 5 and 4—Combination Mode 1 and 0 (CMD1, CMD0): These bits select whether channels 3 and 4 operate in normal mode, complementary PWM mode, or reset-synchronized PWM mode. Bit 5: CMD1 Bit 4: CMD0 Description 0 0 Channels 3 and 4 operate normally (Initial value) 1 1 0 Channels 3 and 4 operate together in complementary PWM mode 1 Channels 3 and 4 operate together in reset-synchronized PWM mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 333 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Before selecting reset-synchronized PWM mode or complementary PWM mode, halt the timer counter or counters that will be used in these modes. When these bits select complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode, they take precedence over the setting of the PWM mode bits (PWM4 and PWM3) in TMDR. Settings of complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode and settings of timer sync bits SYNC4 and SYNC3 in TSNC are valid simultaneously, however, when complementary PWM mode is selected, channels 3 and 4 must not be synchronized (do not set bits SYNC3 and SYNC4 both to 1 in TSNC). Bit 3—Buffer Mode B4 (BFB4): Selects whether GRB4 operates normally in channel 4, or whether GRB4 is buffered by BRB4. Bit 3: BFB4 Description 0 GRB4 operates normally 1 GRB4 is buffered by BRB4 (Initial value) Bit 2—Buffer Mode A4 (BFA4): Selects whether GRA4 operates normally in channel 4, or whether GRA4 is buffered by BRA4. Bit 2: BFA4 Description 0 GRA4 operates normally 1 GRA4 is buffered by BRA4 (Initial value) Bit 1—Buffer Mode B3 (BFB3): Selects whether GRB3 operates normally in channel 3, or whether GRB3 is buffered by BRB3. Bit 1: BFB3 Description 0 GRB3 operates normally 1 GRB3 is buffered by BRB3 (Initial value) Bit 0—Buffer Mode A3 (BFA3): Selects whether GRA3 operates normally in channel 3, or whether GRA3 is buffered by BRA3. Bit 0: BFA3 Description 0 GRA3 operates normally 1 GRA3 is buffered by BRA3 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 334 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2.5 Timer Output Master Enable Register (TOER) TOER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables output settings for channels 3 and 4. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — EXB4 EXA4 EB3 EB4 EA4 EA3 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Master enable TOCXA4, TOCXB4 These bits enable or disable output settings for pins TOCXA4 and TOCXB4 Master enable TIOCA3, TIOCB3 , TIOCA4, TIOCB4 These bits enable or disable output settings for pins TIOCA3, TIOCB3 , TIOCA4, and TIOCB4 TOER is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 5—Master Enable TOCXB4 (EXB4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TOCXB4. Bit 5: EXB4 Description 0 TOCXB4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings (TOCXB4 operates as a generic input/output pin). If XTGD = 0, EXB4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1. 1 TOCXB4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings (Initial value) Bit 4—Master Enable TOCXA4 (EXA4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TOCXA4. Bit 4: EXA4 Description 0 TOCXA4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings (TOCXA4 operates as a generic input/output pin). If XTGD = 0, EXA4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1. 1 TOCXA4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 335 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 3—Master Enable TIOCB3 (EB3): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCB3. Bit 3: EB3 Description 0 TIOCB3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3 and TFCR settings (TIOCB3 operates as a generic input/output pin). If XTGD = 0, EB3 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1. 1 TIOCB3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3 and TFCR settings (Initial value) Bit 2—Master Enable TIOCB4 (EB4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCB4. Bit 2: EB4 Description 0 TIOCB4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4 and TFCR settings (TIOCB4 operates as a generic input/output pin). 1 TIOCB4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4 and TFCR settings (Initial value) If XTGD = 0, EB4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1. Bit 1—Master Enable TIOCA4 (EA4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCA4. Bit 1: EA4 Description 0 TIOCA4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings (TIOCA4 operates as a generic input/output pin). If XTGD = 0, EA4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1. 1 TIOCA4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings (Initial value) Bit 0—Master Enable TIOCA3 (EA3): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCA3. Bit 0: EA3 Description 0 TIOCA3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings (TIOCA3 operates as a generic input/output pin). 1 TIOCA3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings (Initial value) If XTGD = 0, EA3 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 336 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2.6 Timer Output Control Register (TOCR) TOCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects externally triggered disabling of output in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode, and inverts the output levels. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — XTGD — — OLS4 OLS3 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — R/W — — R/W R/W Reserved bits Output level select 3, 4 These bits select output levels in complementary PWM mode and resetsynchronized PWM mode Reserved bits External trigger disable Selects externally triggered disabling of output in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode The settings of the XTGD, OLS4, and OLS3 bits are valid only in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode. These settings do not affect other modes. TOCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 to 5—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 4—External Trigger Disable (XTGD): Selects externally triggered disabling of ITU output in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode. Bit 4: XTGD Description 0 Input capture A in channel 1 is used as an external trigger signal in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode. When an external trigger occurs, bits 5 to 0 in TOER are cleared to 0, disabling ITU output. 1 External triggering is disabled (Initial value) Bits 3 and 2—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 337 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 1—Output Level Select 4 (OLS4): Selects output levels in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode. Bit 1: OLS4 Description 0 TIOCA3, TIOCA4, and TIOCB4 outputs are inverted 1 TIOCA3, TIOCA4, and TIOCB4 outputs are not inverted (Initial value) Bit 0—Output Level Select 3 (OLS3): Selects output levels in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode. Bit 0: OLS3 Description 0 TIOCB3, TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 outputs are inverted 1 TIOCB3, TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 outputs are not inverted 10.2.7 (Initial value) Timer Counters (TCNT) TCNT is a 16-bit counter. The ITU has five TCNTs, one for each channel. Channel Abbreviation Function 0 TCNT0 Up-counter 1 TCNT1 2 TCNT2 Phase counting mode: up/down-counter Other modes: up-counter 3 TCNT3 Complementary PWM mode: up/down-counter 4 TCNT4 Other modes: up-counter Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Each TCNT is a 16-bit readable/writable register that counts pulse inputs from a clock source. The clock source is selected by bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. TCNT0 and TCNT1 are up-counters. TCNT2 is an up/down-counter in phase counting mode and an up-counter in other modes. TCNT3 and TCNT4 are up/down-counters in complementary PWM mode and up-counters in other modes. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 338 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) TCNT can be cleared to H'0000 by compare match with GRA or GRB or by input capture to GRA or GRB (counter clearing function) in the same channel. When TCNT overflows (changes from H'FFFF to H'0000), the OVF flag is set to 1 in TSR of the corresponding channel. When TCNT underflows (changes from H'0000 to H'FFFF), the OVF flag is set to 1 in TSR of the corresponding channel. The TCNTs are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit bus and can be written or read by either word access or byte access. Each TCNT is initialized to H'0000 by a reset and in standby mode. 10.2.8 General Registers (GRA, GRB) The general registers are 16-bit registers. The ITU has 10 general registers, two in each channel. Channel Abbreviation Function 0 GRA0, GRB0 Output compare/input capture register 1 GRA1, GRB1 2 GRA2, GRB2 3 GRA3, GRB3 4 GRA4, GRB4 Bit Initial value Read/Write Output compare/input capture register; can be buffered by buffer registers BRA and BRB 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W A general register is a 16-bit readable/writable register that can function as either an output compare register or an input capture register. The function is selected by settings in TIOR. When a general register is used as an output compare register, its value is constantly compared with the TCNT value. When the two values match (compare match), the IMFA or IMFB flag is set to 1 in TSR. Compare match output can be selected in TIOR. When a general register is used as an input capture register, rising edges, falling edges, or both edges of an external input capture signal are detected and the current TCNT value is stored in the Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 339 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) general register. The corresponding IMFA or IMFB flag in TSR is set to 1 at the same time. The valid edge or edges of the input capture signal are selected in TIOR. TIOR settings are ignored in PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, and reset-synchronized PWM mode. General registers are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit bus and can be written or read by either word access or byte access. General registers are initialized to the output compare function (with no output signal) by a reset and in standby mode. The initial value is H'FFFF. 10.2.9 Buffer Registers (BRA, BRB) The buffer registers are 16-bit registers. The ITU has four buffer registers, two each in channels 3 and 4. Channel Abbreviation Function 3 BRA3, BRB3 Used for buffering 4 BRA4, BRB4 • When the corresponding GRA or GRB functions as an output compare register, BRA or BRB can function as an output compare buffer register: the BRA or BRB value is automatically transferred to GRA or GRB at compare match • When the corresponding GRA or GRB functions as an input capture register, BRA or BRB can function as an input capture buffer register: the GRA or GRB value is automatically transferred to BRA or BRB at input capture Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W A buffer register is a 16-bit readable/writable register that is used when buffering is selected. Buffering can be selected independently by bits BFB4, BFA4, BFB3, and BFA3 in TFCR. The buffer register and general register operate as a pair. When the general register functions as an output compare register, the buffer register functions as an output compare buffer register. When the general register functions as an input capture register, the buffer register functions as an input capture buffer register. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 340 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) The buffer registers are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit bus and can be written or read by either word or byte access. Buffer registers are initialized to H'FFFF by a reset and in standby mode. 10.2.10 Timer Control Registers (TCR) TCR is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TCRs, one in each channel. Channel Abbreviation Function 0 TCR0 1 TCR1 2 TCR2 TCR controls the timer counter. The TCRs in all channels are functionally identical. When phase counting mode is selected in channel 2, the settings of bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 and TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR2 are ignored. 3 TCR3 4 TCR4 Bit 7 6 5 — CCLR1 CCLR0 4 3 CKEG1 CKEG0 2 1 0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Timer prescaler 2 to 0 These bits select the counter clock Clock edge 1/0 These bits select external clock edges Counter clear 1/0 These bits select the counter clear source Reserved bit Each TCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the timer counter clock source, selects the edge or edges of external clock sources, and selects how the counter is cleared. TCR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 341 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bits 6 and 5—Counter Clear 1/0 (CCLR1, CCLR0): These bits select how TCNT is cleared. Bit 6: CCLR1 Bit 5: CCLR0 Description 0 0 TCNT is not cleared 1 TCNT is cleared by GRA compare match or input 1 capture* 0 TCNT is cleared by GRB compare match or input 1 capture* 1 Synchronous clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization 2 with other synchronized timers* 1 (Initial value) Notes: 1. TCNT is cleared by compare match when the general register functions as an output compare register, and by input capture when the general register functions as an input capture register. 2. Selected in TSNC. Bits 4 and 3—Clock Edge 1/0 (CKEG1, CKEG0): These bits select external clock input edges when an external clock source is used. Bit 4: CKEG1 Bit 3: CKEG0 Description 0 0 Count rising edges 1 Count falling edges — Count both edges 1 (Initial value) When channel 2 is set to phase counting mode, bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR2 are ignored. Phase counting takes precedence. Bits 2 to 0—Timer Prescaler 2 to 0 (TPSC2 to TPSC0): These bits select the counter clock source. Bit 2: TPSC2 Bit 1: TPSC1 Bit 0: TPSC0 Description 0 0 0 Internal clock: φ 1 Internal clock: φ/2 0 Internal clock: φ/4 1 Internal clock: φ/8 0 External clock A: TCLKA input 1 External clock B: TCLKB input 0 External clock C: TCLKC input 1 External clock D: TCLKD input 1 1 0 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 342 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) When bit TPSC2 is cleared to 0 an internal clock source is selected, and the timer counts only falling edges. When bit TPSC2 is set to 1 an external clock source is selected, and the timer counts the edge or edges selected by bits CKEG1 and CKEG0. When channel 2 is set to phase counting mode (MDF = 1 in TMDR), the settings of bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR2 are ignored. Phase counting takes precedence. 10.2.11 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR) TIOR is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TIORs, one in each channel. Channel Abbreviation Function 0 TIOR0 1 TIOR1 2 TIOR2 TIOR controls the general registers. Some functions differ in PWM mode. TIOR3 and TIOR4 settings are ignored when complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected in channels 3 and 4. 3 TIOR3 4 TIOR4 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W — R/W R/W R/W I/O control A2 to A0 These bits select GRA functions Reserved bit I/O control B2 to B0 These bits select GRB functions Reserved bit Each TIOR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the output compare or input capture function for GRA and GRB, and specifies the functions of the TIOCA and TIOCB pins. If the output compare function is selected, TIOR also selects the type of output. If input capture is selected, TIOR also selects the edge or edges of the input capture signal. TIOR is initialized to H'88 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 343 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bits 6 to 4—I/O Control B2 to B0 (IOB2 to IOB0): These bits select the GRB function. Bit 6: IOB2 Bit 5: IOB1 Bit 4: IOB0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 No output at compare match (Initial value) 1 0 output at GRB compare match* 1 0 1 output at GRB compare match* 1 Output toggles at GRB compare match 1 2 (1 output in channel 2)* * 0 1 1 Description GRB is an output compare register GRB is an input capture register 0 GRB captures rising edge of input GRB captures falling edge of input GRB captures both edges of input 1 Notes: 1. After a reset, the output is 0 until the first compare match. 2. Channel 2 output cannot be toggled by compare match. This setting selects 1 output instead. Bit 3—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Bits 2 to 0—I/O Control A2 to A0 (IOA2 to IOA0): These bits select the GRA function. Bit 2: IOA2 Bit 1: IOA1 Bit 0: IOA0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 GRA is an output compare register No output at compare match (Initial value) 1 0 output at GRA compare match* 1 0 1 output at GRA compare match* 1 Output toggles at GRA compare match 1 2 (1 output in channel 2)* * 0 1 1 Description GRA is an input capture register 0 GRA captures rising edge of input GRA captures falling edge of input GRA captures both edges of input 1 Notes: 1. After a reset, the output is 0 until the first compare match. 2. Channel 2 output cannot be toggled by compare match. This setting selects 1 output instead. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 344 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2.12 Timer Status Register (TSR) TSR is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TSRs, one in each channel. Channel Abbreviation Function 0 TSR0 Indicates input capture, compare match, and overflow status 1 TSR1 2 TSR2 3 TSR3 4 TSR4 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Reserved bits Overflow flag Status flag indicating overflow or underflow Input capture/compare match flag B Status flag indicating GRB compare match or input capture Input capture/compare match flag A Status flag indicating GRA compare match or input capture Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. Each TSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register containing flags that indicate TCNT overflow or underflow and GRA or GRB compare match or input capture. These flags are interrupt sources and generate CPU interrupts if enabled by corresponding bits in TIER. TSR is initialized to H'F8 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 to 3—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 345 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 2—Overflow Flag (OVF): This status flag indicates TCNT overflow or underflow. Bit 2: OVF Description 0 [Clearing condition] (Initial value) Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF 1 [Setting condition] TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000, or underflowed from H'0000 to H'FFFF* Notes: 1. Channel 2 operates in phase counting mode (MDF = 1 in TMDR) 2. Channel 3 and 4 operate in complementary PWM mode (CMD1 = 1 and CMD0 = 0 in TFCR) * TCNT underflow occurs when TCNT operates as an up/down-counter. Underflow occurs only under the following conditions: Bit 1—Input Capture/Compare Match Flag B (IMFB): This status flag indicates GRB compare match or input capture events. Bit 1: IMFB Description 0 [Clearing condition] (Initial value) Read IMFB when IMFB = 1, then write 0 in IMFB 1 [Setting conditions] TCNT = GRB when GRB functions as an output compare register. TCNT value is transferred to GRB by an input capture signal, when GRB functions as an input capture register. Bit 0—Input Capture/Compare Match Flag A (IMFA): This status flag indicates GRA compare match or input capture events. Bit 0: IMFA Description 0 [Clearing condition] (Initial value) Read IMFA when IMFA = 1, then write 0 in IMFA. DMAC activated by IMIA interrupt (channels 0 to 3 only). 1 [Setting conditions] TCNT = GRA when GRA functions as an output compare register. TCNT value is transferred to GRA by an input capture signal, when GRA functions as an input capture register. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 346 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.2.13 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER) TIER is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TIERs, one in each channel. Channel Abbreviation Function 0 TIER0 Enables or disables interrupt requests. 1 TIER1 2 TIER2 3 TIER3 4 TIER4 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Overflow interrupt enable Enables or disables OVF interrupts Input capture/compare match interrupt enable B Enables or disables IMFB interrupts Input capture/compare match interrupt enable A Enables or disables IMFA interrupts Each TIER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables and disables overflow interrupt requests and general register compare match and input capture interrupt requests. TIER is initialized to H'F8 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 to 3—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 347 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Bit 2—Overflow Interrupt Enable (OVIE): Enables or disables the interrupt requested by the OVF flag in TSR when OVF is set to 1. Bit 2: OVIE Description 0 OVI interrupt requested by OVF is disabled 1 OVI interrupt requested by OVF is enabled (Initial value) Bit 1—Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupt Enable B (IMIEB): Enables or disables the interrupt requested by the IMFB flag in TSR when IMFB is set to 1. Bit 1: IMIEB Description 0 IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB is disabled 1 IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB is enabled (Initial value) Bit 0—Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupt Enable A (IMIEA): Enables or disables the interrupt requested by the IMFA flag in TSR when IMFA is set to 1. Bit 0: IMIEA Description 0 IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA is disabled 1 IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 348 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.3 CPU Interface 10.3.1 16-Bit Accessible Registers The timer counters (TCNTs), general registers A and B (GRAs and GRBs), and buffer registers A and B (BRAs and BRBs) are 16-bit registers, and are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit data bus. These registers can be written or read a word at a time, or a byte at a time. Figures 10.6 and 10.7 show examples of word access to a timer counter (TCNT). Figures 10.8 to 10.11 show examples of byte access to TCNTH and TCNTL. On-chip data bus H CPU H L Bus interface L TCNTH Module data bus TCNTL Figure 10.6 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCNT, Word) On-chip data bus H CPU L H Bus interface L TCNTH Module data bus TCNTL Figure 10.7 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCNT, Word) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 349 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) On-chip data bus H CPU L H Bus interface L TCNTH Module data bus TCNTL Figure 10.8 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCNT, Upper Byte) On-chip data bus H CPU L H Bus interface L TCNTH Module data bus TCNTL Figure 10.9 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCNT, Lower Byte) On-chip data bus H CPU L H Bus interface L TCNTH Module data bus TCNTL Figure 10.10 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCNT, Upper Byte) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 350 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) On-chip data bus H CPU H L Bus interface L TCNTH Module data bus TCNTL Figure 10.11 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCNT, Lower Byte) 10.3.2 8-Bit Accessible Registers The registers other than the timer counters, general registers, and buffer registers are 8-bit registers. These registers are linked to the CPU by an internal 8-bit data bus. Figures 10.12 and 10.13 show examples of byte read and write access to a TCR. If a word-size data transfer instruction is executed, two byte transfers are performed. On-chip data bus H CPU L H Bus interface L Module data bus TCR Figure 10.12 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCR) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 351 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) On-chip data bus H CPU H L Bus interface L Module data bus TCR Figure 10.13 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCR) 10.4 Operation 10.4.1 Overview A summary of operations in the various modes is given below. Normal Operation: Each channel has a timer counter and general registers. The timer counter counts up, and can operate as a free-running counter, periodic counter, or external event counter. General registers A and B can be used for input capture or output compare. Synchronous Operation: The timer counters in designated channels are preset synchronously. Data written to the timer counter in any one of these channels is simultaneously written to the timer counters in the other channels as well. The timer counters can also be cleared synchronously if so designated by the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in the TCRs. PWM Mode: A PWM waveform is output from the TIOCA pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match A and to 0 at compare match B. The duty cycle can be varied from 0% to 100% depending on the settings of GRA and GRB. When a channel is set to PWM mode, its GRA and GRB automatically become output compare registers. Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode: Channels 3 and 4 are paired for three-phase PWM output with complementary waveforms. (The three phases are related by having a common transition point.) When reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected GRA3, GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4 automatically function as output compare registers, TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, and TOCXB4 function as PWM output pins, and TCNT3 operates as an up-counter. TCNT4 operates independently, and is not compared with GRA4 or GRB4. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 352 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Complementary PWM Mode: Channels 3 and 4 are paired for three-phase PWM output with non-overlapping complementary waveforms. When complementary PWM mode is selected GRA3, GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4 automatically function as output compare registers, and TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, and TOCXB4 function as PWM output pins. TCNT3 and TCNT4 operate as up/down-counters. Phase Counting Mode: The phase relationship between two clock signals input at TCLKA and TCLKB is detected and TCNT2 counts up or down accordingly. When phase counting mode is selected TCLKA and TCLKB become clock input pins and TCNT2 operates as an up/downcounter. Buffering • If the general register is an output compare register When compare match occurs the buffer register value is transferred to the general register. • If the general register is an input capture register When input capture occurs the TCNT value is transferred to the general register, and the previous general register value is transferred to the buffer register. • Complementary PWM mode The buffer register value is transferred to the general register when TCNT3 and TCNT4 change counting direction. • Reset-synchronized PWM mode The buffer register value is transferred to the general register at GRA3 compare match. 10.4.2 Basic Functions Counter Operation: When one of bits STR0 to STR4 is set to 1 in the timer start register (TSTR), the timer counter (TCNT) in the corresponding channel starts counting. The counting can be freerunning or periodic. • Sample setup procedure for counter Figure 10.14 shows a sample procedure for setting up a counter. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 353 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Counter setup Select counter clock Type of counting? 1 No Yes Free-running counting Periodic counting Select counter clear source 2 Select output compare register function 3 Set period 4 Start counter 5 Periodic counter Start counter 5 Free-running counter Figure 10.14 Counter Setup Procedure (Example) 1. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to select the counter clock source. If an external clock source is selected, set bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR to select the desired edge(s) of the external clock signal. 2. For periodic counting, set CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR to have TCNT cleared at GRA compare match or GRB compare match. 3. Set TIOR to select the output compare function of GRA or GRB, whichever was selected in step 2. 4. Write the count period in GRA or GRB, whichever was selected in step 2. 5. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 354 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) • Free-running and periodic counter operation A reset leaves the counters (TCNTs) in ITU channels 0 to 4 all set as free-running counters. A free-running counter starts counting up when the corresponding bit in TSTR is set to 1. When the count overflows from H'FFFF to H'0000, the OVF flag is set to 1 in TSR. If the corresponding OVIE bit is set to 1 in TIER, a CPU interrupt is requested. After the overflow, the counter continues counting up from H'0000. Figure 10.15 illustrates free-running counting. TCNT value H'FFFF H'0000 Time STR0 to STR4 bit OVF Figure 10.15 Free-Running Counter Operation When a channel is set to have its counter cleared by compare match, in that channel TCNT operates as a periodic counter. Select the output compare function of GRA or GRB, set bit CCLR1 or CCLR0 in TCR to have the counter cleared by compare match, and set the count period in GRA or GRB. After these settings, the counter starts counting up as a periodic counter when the corresponding bit is set to 1 in TSTR. When the count matches GRA or GRB, the IMFA or IMFB flag is set to 1 in TSR and the counter is cleared to H'0000. If the corresponding IMIEA or IMIEB bit is set to 1 in TIER, a CPU interrupt is requested at this time. After the compare match, TCNT continues counting up from H'0000. Figure 10.16 illustrates periodic counting. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 355 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) TCNT value Counter cleared by general register compare match GR H'0000 Time STR bit IMF Figure 10.16 Periodic Counter Operation • TCNT count timing Internal clock source Bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR select the system clock (φ) or one of three internal clock sources obtained by prescaling the system clock (φ/2, φ/4, φ/8). Figure 10.17 shows the timing. φ Internal clock TCNT input TCNT N–1 N N+1 Figure 10.17 Count Timing for Internal Clock Sources External clock source Bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR select an external clock input pin (TCLKA to TCLKD), and its valid edge or edges are selected by bits CKEG1 and CKEG0. The rising edge, falling edge, or both edges can be selected. The pulse width of the external clock signal must be at least 1.5 system clocks when a single edge is selected, and at least 2.5 system clocks when both edges are selected. Shorter pulses will not be counted correctly. Figure 10.18 shows the timing when both edges are detected. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 356 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) φ External clock input TCNT input TCNT N–1 N N+1 Figure 10.18 Count Timing for External Clock Sources (when Both Edges are Detected) Waveform Output by Compare Match: In ITU channels 0, 1, 3, and 4, compare match A or B can cause the output at the TIOCA or TIOCB pin to go to 0, go to 1, or toggle. In channel 2 the output can only go to 0 or go to 1. • Sample setup procedure for waveform output by compare match Figure 10.19 shows a sample procedure for setting up waveform output by compare match. Output setup 1. Select the compare match output mode (0, 1, or toggle) in TIOR. When a waveform output mode is selected, the pin switches from its generic input/ output function to the output compare function (TIOCA or TIOCB). An output compare pin outputs 0 until the first compare match occurs. Select waveform output mode 1 Set output timing 2 2. Set a value in GRA or GRB to designate the compare match timing. Start counter 3 3. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. Waveform output Figure 10.19 Setup Procedure for Waveform Output by Compare Match (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 357 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) • Examples of waveform output Figure 10.20 shows examples of 0 and 1 output. TCNT operates as a free-running counter, 0 output is selected for compare match A, and 1 output is selected for compare match B. When the pin is already at the selected output level, the pin level does not change. TCNT value H'FFFF GRB GRA H'0000 Time TIOCB No change No change TIOCA No change No change 1 output 0 output Figure 10.20 0 and 1 Output (Examples) Figure 10.21 shows examples of toggle output. TCNT operates as a periodic counter, cleared by compare match B. Toggle output is selected for both compare match A and B. TCNT value Counter cleared by compare match with GRB GRB GRA H'0000 Time TIOCB Toggle output TIOCA Toggle output Figure 10.21 Toggle Output (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 358 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) • Output compare timing The compare match signal is generated in the last state in which TCNT and the general register match (when TCNT changes from the matching value to the next value). When the compare match signal is generated, the output value selected in TIOR is output at the output compare pin (TIOCA or TIOCB). When TCNT matches a general register, the compare match signal is not generated until the next counter clock pulse. Figure 10.22 shows the output compare timing. φ TCNT input clock TCNT N GR N N+1 Compare match signal TIOCA, TIOCB Figure 10.22 Output Compare Timing Input Capture Function: The TCNT value can be captured into a general register when a transition occurs at an input capture/output compare pin (TIOCA or TIOCB). Capture can take place on the rising edge, falling edge, or both edges. The input capture function can be used to measure pulse width or period. • Sample setup procedure for input capture Figure 10.23 shows a sample procedure for setting up input capture. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 359 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Input selection Select input-capture input 1 Start counter 2 1. Set TIOR to select the input capture function of a general register and the rising edge, falling edge, or both edges of the input capture signal. Clear the port data direction bit to 0 before making these TIOR settings. 2. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. Input capture Figure 10.23 Setup Procedure for Input Capture (Example) • Examples of input capture Figure 10.24 illustrates input capture when the falling edge of TIOCB and both edges of TIOCA are selected as capture edges. TCNT is cleared by input capture into GRB. TCNT value Counter cleared by TIOCB input (falling edge) H'0180 H'0160 H'0005 H'0000 Time TIOCB TIOCA GRA H'0005 GRB H'0160 H'0180 Figure 10.24 Input Capture (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 360 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) • Input capture signal timing Input capture on the rising edge, falling edge, or both edges can be selected by settings in TIOR. Figure 10.25 shows the timing when the rising edge is selected. The pulse width of the input capture signal must be at least 1.5 system clocks for single-edge capture, and 2.5 system clocks for capture of both edges. φ Input-capture input Internal input capture signal TCNT N N GRA, GRB Figure 10.25 Input Capture Signal Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 361 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.3 Synchronization The synchronization function enables two or more timer counters to be synchronized by writing the same data to them simultaneously (synchronous preset). With appropriate TCR settings, two or more timer counters can also be cleared simultaneously (synchronous clear). Synchronization enables additional general registers to be associated with a single time base. Synchronization can be selected for all channels (0 to 4). Sample Setup Procedure for Synchronization: Figure 10.26 shows a sample procedure for setting up synchronization. Setup for synchronization Select synchronization 1 Synchronous preset Write to TCNT Synchronous clear 2 Clearing synchronized to this channel? No Yes Select counter clear source 3 Select counter clear source 4 Start counter 5 Start counter 5 Synchronous preset Counter clear Synchronous clear 1. Set the SYNC bits to 1 in TSNC for the channels to be synchronized. 2. When a value is written in TCNT in one of the synchronized channels, the same value is simultaneously written in TCNT in the other channels (synchronized preset). 3. Set the CCLR1 or CCLR0 bit in TCR to have the counter cleared by compare match or input capture. 4. Set the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR to have the counter cleared synchronously. 5. Set the STR bits in TSTR to 1 to start the synchronized counters. Figure 10.26 Setup Procedure for Synchronization (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 362 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Example of Synchronization: Figure 10.27 shows an example of synchronization. Channels 0, 1, and 2 are synchronized, and are set to operate in PWM mode. Channel 0 is set for counter clearing by compare match with GRB0. Channels 1 and 2 are set for synchronous counter clearing. The timer counters in channels 0, 1, and 2 are synchronously preset, and are synchronously cleared by compare match with GRB0. A three-phase PWM waveform is output from pins TIOCA0, TIOCA1, and TIOCA2. For further information on PWM mode, see section 10.4.4, PWM Mode. Value of TCNT0 to TCNT2 Cleared by compare match with GRB0 GRB0 GRB1 GRA0 GRB2 GRA1 GRA2 Time H'0000 TIOCA0 TIOCA1 TIOCA2 Figure 10.27 Synchronization (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 363 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.4 PWM Mode In PWM mode GRA and GRB are paired and a PWM waveform is output from the TIOCA pin. GRA specifies the time at which the PWM output changes to 1. GRB specifies the time at which the PWM output changes to 0. If either GRA or GRB is selected as the counter clear source, a PWM waveform with a duty cycle from 0% to 100% is output at the TIOCA pin. PWM mode can be selected in all channels (0 to 4). Table 10.4 summarizes the PWM output pins and corresponding registers. If the same value is set in GRA and GRB, the output does not change when compare match occurs. Table 10.4 PWM Output Pins and Registers Channel Output Pin 1 Output 0 Output 0 TIOCA0 GRA0 GRB0 1 TIOCA1 GRA1 GRB1 2 TIOCA2 GRA2 GRB2 3 TIOCA3 GRA3 GRB3 4 TIOCA4 GRA4 GRB4 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 364 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Sample Setup Procedure for PWM Mode: Figure 10.28 shows a sample procedure for setting up PWM mode. PWM mode Select counter clock 1 Select counter clear source 2 Set GRA 3 Set GRB 4 Select PWM mode 5 Start counter 6 PWM mode 1. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to select the counter clock source. If an external clock source is selected, set bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR to select the desired edge(s) of the external clock signal. 2. Set bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR to select the counter clear source. 3. Set the time at which the PWM waveform should go to 1 in GRA. 4. Set the time at which the PWM waveform should go to 0 in GRB. 5. Set the PWM bit in TMDR to select PWM mode. When PWM mode is selected, regardless of the TIOR contents, GRA and GRB become output compare registers specifying the times at which the PWM output goes to 1 and 0. The TIOCA pin automatically becomes the PWM output pin. The TIOCB pin conforms to the settings of bits IOB1 and IOB0 in TIOR. If TIOCB output is not desired, clear both IOB1 and IOB0 to 0. 6. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. Figure 10.28 Setup Procedure for PWM Mode (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 365 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Examples of PWM Mode: Figure 10.29 shows examples of operation in PWM mode. In PWM mode TIOCA becomes an output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA, and to 0 at compare match with GRB. In the examples shown, TCNT is cleared by compare match with GRA or GRB. Synchronized operation and free-running counting are also possible. TCNT value Counter cleared by compare match with GRA GRA GRB Time H'0000 TIOCA a. Counter cleared by GRA TCNT value Counter cleared by compare match with GRB GRB GRA Time H'0000 TIOCA b. Counter cleared by GRB Figure 10.29 PWM Mode (Example 1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 366 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Figure 10.30 shows examples of the output of PWM waveforms with duty cycles of 0% and 100%. If the counter is cleared by compare match with GRB, and GRA is set to a higher value than GRB, the duty cycle is 0%. If the counter is cleared by compare match with GRA, and GRB is set to a higher value than GRA, the duty cycle is 100%. TCNT value Counter cleared by compare match with GRB GRB GRA H'0000 Time TIOCA Write to GRA Write to GRA a. 0% duty cycle TCNT value Counter cleared by compare match with GRA GRA GRB H'0000 Time TIOCA Write to GRB Write to GRB b. 100% duty cycle Figure 10.30 PWM Mode (Example 2) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 367 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.5 Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode In reset-synchronized PWM mode channels 3 and 4 are combined to produce three pairs of complementary PWM waveforms, all having one waveform transition point in common. When reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, and TOCXB4 automatically become PWM output pins, and TCNT3 functions as an up-counter. Table 10.5 lists the PWM output pins. Table 10.6 summarizes the register settings. Table 10.5 Output Pins in Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode Channel Output Pin Description 3 TIOCA3 PWM output 1 TIOCB3 PWM output 1´ (complementary waveform to PWM output 1) 4 TIOCA4 PWM output 2 TOCXA4 PWM output 2´ (complementary waveform to PWM output 2) TIOCB4 PWM output 3 TOCXB4 PWM output 3´ (complementary waveform to PWM output 3) Table 10.6 Register Settings in Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode Register Setting TCNT3 Initially set to H'0000 TCNT4 Not used (operates independently) GRA3 Specifies the count period of TCNT3 GRB3 Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA3 and TIOCB3 GRA4 Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA4 and TOCXA4 GRB4 Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCB4 and TOCXB4 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 368 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Sample Setup Procedure for Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode: Figure 10.31 shows a sample procedure for setting up reset-synchronized PWM mode. Reset-synchronized PWM mode Stop counter 1 Select counter clock 2 Select counter clear source 3 Select reset-synchronized PWM mode 4 Set TCNT 5 Set general registers 6 Start counter 7 Reset-synchronized PWM mode 1. Clear the STR3 bit in TSTR to 0 to halt TCNT3. Reset-synchronized PWM mode must be set up while TCNT3 is halted. 2. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to select the counter clock source for channel 3. If an external clock source is selected, select the external clock edge(s) with bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR. 3. Set bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR3 to select GRA3 compare match as the counter clear source. 4. Set bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR to select reset-synchronized PWM mode. TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TIOCB4, TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 automatically become PWM output pins. 5. Preset TCNT3 to H'0000. TCNT4 need not be preset. 6. GRA3 is the waveform period register. Set the waveform period value in GRA3. Set transition times of the PWM output waveforms in GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4. Set times within the compare match range of TCNT3. X ≤ GRA3 (X: setting value) 7. Set the STR3 bit in TSTR to 1 to start TCNT3. Figure 10.31 Setup Procedure for Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 369 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Example of Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode: Figure 10.32 shows an example of operation in reset-synchronized PWM mode. TCNT3 operates as an up-counter in this mode. TCNT4 operates independently, detached from GRA4 and GRB4. When TCNT3 matches GRA3, TCNT3 is cleared and resumes counting from H'0000. The PWM outputs toggle at compare match of TCNT3 with GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4 respectively, and all toggle when the counter is cleared. TCNT3 value Counter cleared at compare match with GRA3 GRA3 GRB3 GRA4 GRB4 H'0000 Time TIOCA3 TIOCB3 TIOCA4 TOCXA4 TIOCB4 TOCXB4 Figure 10.32 Operation in Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode (Example) (when OLS3 = OLS4 = 1) For the settings and operation when reset-synchronized PWM mode and buffer mode are both selected, see section 10.4.8, Buffering. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 370 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.6 Complementary PWM Mode In complementary PWM mode channels 3 and 4 are combined to output three pairs of complementary, non-overlapping PWM waveforms. When complementary PWM mode is selected TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, and TOCXB4 automatically become PWM output pins, and TCNT3 and TCNT4 function as up/down-counters. Table 10.7 lists the PWM output pins. Table 10.8 summarizes the register settings. Table 10.7 Output Pins in Complementary PWM Mode Channel Output Pin Description 3 TIOCA3 PWM output 1 TIOCB3 PWM output 1´ (non-overlapping complementary waveform to PWM output 1) TIOCA4 PWM output 2 TOCXA4 PWM output 2´ (non-overlapping complementary waveform to PWM output 2) TIOCB4 PWM output 3 TOCXB4 PWM output 3´ (non-overlapping complementary waveform to PWM output 3) 4 Table 10.8 Register Settings in Complementary PWM Mode Register Setting TCNT3 Initially specifies the non-overlap margin (difference to TCNT4) TCNT4 Initially set to H'0000 GRA3 Specifies the upper limit value of TCNT3 minus 1 GRB3 Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA3 and TIOCB3 GRA4 Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA4 and TOCXA4 GRB4 Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCB4 and TOCXB4 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 371 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Setup Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode: Figure 10.33 shows a sample procedure for setting up complementary PWM mode. Complementary PWM mode Stop counting 1 Select counter clock 2 Select complementary PWM mode 3 Set TCNTs 4 Set general registers 5 Start counters 6 Complementary PWM mode 1. Clear bits STR3 and STR4 to 0 in TSTR to halt the timer counters. Complementary PWM mode must be set up while TCNT3 and TCNT4 are halted. 2. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to select the same counter clock source for channels 3 and 4. If an external clock source is selected, select the external clock edge(s) with bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR. Do not select any counter clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR. 3. Set bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR to select complementary PWM mode. TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TIOCB4, TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 automatically become PWM output pins. 4. Clear TCNT4 to H'0000. Set the non-overlap margin in TCNT3. Do not set TCNT3 and TCNT4 to the same value. 5. GRA3 is the waveform period register. Set the upper limit value of TCNT3 minus 1 in GRA3. Set transition times of the PWM output waveforms in GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4. Set times within the compare match range of TCNT3 and TCNT4. T ≤ X (X: initial setting of GRB3, GRA4, or GRB4. T: initial setting of TCNT3) 6. Set bits STR3 and STR4 in TSTR to 1 to start TCNT3 and TCNT4. Note: After exiting complementary PWM mode, to resume operating in complementary PWM mode, follow the entire setup procedure from step 1 again. Figure 10.33 Setup Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 372 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Clearing Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode: Figure 10.34 shows the steps to clear complementary PWM mode. Complementary PWM mode 1. Clear the CMD1 bit of TFCR to 0 to set channels 3 and 4 to normal operating mode. Clear complementary PWM mode 1 Stop counter operation 2 2. After setting channels 3 and 4 to normal operating mode, wait at least one counter clock period, then clear bits STR3 and STR4 of TSTR to 0 to stop counter operation of TCNT3 and TCNT4. Normal operating mode Figure 10.34 Clearing Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 373 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Examples of Complementary PWM Mode: Figure 10.35 shows an example of operation in complementary PWM mode. TCNT3 and TCNT4 operate as up/down-counters, counting down from compare match between TCNT3 and GRA3 and counting up from the point at which TCNT4 underflows. During each up-and-down counting cycle, PWM waveforms are generated by compare match with general registers GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4. Since TCNT3 is initially set to a higher value than TCNT4, compare match events occur in the sequence TCNT3, TCNT4, TCNT4, TCNT3. TCNT3 and TCNT4 values Down-counting starts at compare match between TCNT3 and GRA3 GRA3 TCNT3 GRB3 GRA4 GRB4 TCNT4 Time H'0000 TIOCA3 Up-counting starts when TCNT4 underflows TIOCB3 TIOCA4 TOCXA4 TIOCB4 TOCXB4 Figure 10.35 Operation in Complementary PWM Mode (Example 1, OLS3 = OLS4 = 1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 374 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Figure 10.36 shows examples of waveforms with 0% and 100% duty cycles (in one phase) in complementary PWM mode. In this example the outputs change at compare match with GRB3, so waveforms with duty cycles of 0% or 100% can be output by setting GRB3 to a value larger than GRA3. The duty cycle can be changed easily during operation by use of the buffer registers. For further information see section 10.4.8, Buffering. TCNT3 and TCNT4 values GRA3 GRB3 H'0000 Time TIOCA3 TIOCB3 0% duty cycle a. 0% duty cycle TCNT3 and TCNT4 values GRA3 GRB3 Time H'0000 TIOCA3 TIOCB3 100% duty cycle b. 100% duty cycle Figure 10.36 Operation in Complementary PWM Mode (Example 2, OLS3 = OLS4 = 1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 375 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) In complementary PWM mode, TCNT3 and TCNT4 overshoot and undershoot at the transitions between up-counting and down-counting. The setting conditions for the IMFA bit in channel 3 and the OVF bit in channel 4 differ from the usual conditions. In buffered operation the buffer transfer conditions also differ. Timing diagrams are shown in figures 10.37 and 10.38. TCNT3 N–1 GRA3 N N+1 N N–1 N Flag not set IMFA Set to 1 Buffer transfer signal (BR to GR) GR Buffer transfer No buffer transfer Figure 10.37 Overshoot Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 376 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Underflow TCNT4 H'0001 H'0000 Overflow H'FFFF H'0000 Flag not set OVF Set to 1 Buffer transfer signal (BR to GR) GR Buffer transfer No buffer transfer Figure 10.38 Undershoot Timing In channel 3, IMFA is set to 1 only during up-counting. In channel 4, OVF is set to 1 only when an underflow occurs. When buffering is selected, buffer register contents are transferred to the general register at compare match A3 during up-counting, and when TCNT4 underflows. General Register Settings in Complementary PWM Mode: When setting up general registers for complementary PWM mode or changing their settings during operation, note the following points. • Initial settings Do not set values from H'0000 to T – 1 (where T is the initial value of TCNT3). After the counters start and the first compare match A3 event has occurred, however, settings in this range also become possible. • Changing settings Use the buffer registers. Correct waveform output may not be obtained if a general register is written to directly. • Cautions on changes of general register settings Figure 10.39 shows six correct examples and one incorrect example. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 377 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) GRA3 GR H'0000 Not allowed BR GR Figure 10.39 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Example 1) Buffer transfer at transition from up-counting to down-counting If the general register value is in the range from GRA3 – T + 1 to GRA3, do not transfer a buffer register value outside this range. Conversely, if the general register value is outside this range, do not transfer a value within this range. See figure 10.40. GRA3 + 1 GRA3 GRA3 – T + 1 GRA3 – T Illegal changes TCNT3 TCNT4 Figure 10.40 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Caution 1) Buffer transfer at transition from down-counting to up-counting If the general register value is in the range from H'0000 to T – 1, do not transfer a buffer register value outside this range. Conversely, when a general register value is outside this range, do not transfer a value within this range. See figure 10.41. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 378 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) TCNT3 TCNT4 T T–1 Illegal changes H'0000 H'FFFF Figure 10.41 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Caution 2) General register settings outside the counting range (H'0000 to GRA3) Waveforms with a duty cycle of 0% or 100% can be output by setting a general register to a value outside the counting range. When a buffer register is set to a value outside the counting range, then later restored to a value within the counting range, the counting direction (up or down) must be the same both times. See figure 10.42. GRA3 GR H'0000 0% duty cycle 100% duty cycle Output pin Output pin BR GR Write during down-counting Write during up-counting Figure 10.42 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Example 2) Settings can be made in this way by detecting GRA3 compare match or TCNT4 underflow before writing to the buffer register. They can also be made by using GRA3 compare match to activate the DMAC. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 379 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.7 Phase Counting Mode In phase counting mode the phase difference between two external clock inputs (at the TCLKA and TCLKB pins) is detected, and TCNT2 counts up or down accordingly. In phase counting mode, the TCLKA and TCLKB pins automatically function as external clock input pins and TCNT2 becomes an up/down-counter, regardless of the settings of bits TPSC2 to TPSC0, CKEG1, and CKEG0 in TCR2. Settings of bits CCLR1, CCLR0 in TCR2, and settings in TIOR2, TIER2, TSR2, GRA2, and GRB2 are valid. The input capture and output compare functions can be used, and interrupts can be generated. Phase counting is available only in channel 2. Sample Setup Procedure for Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.43 shows a sample procedure for setting up phase counting mode. Phase counting mode Select phase counting mode 1 Select flag setting condition 2 Start counter 3 1. Set the MDF bit in TMDR to 1 to select phase counting mode. 2. Select the flag setting condition with the FDIR bit in TMDR. 3. Set the STR2 bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. Phase counting mode Figure 10.43 Setup Procedure for Phase Counting Mode (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 380 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Example of Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.44 shows an example of operations in phase counting mode. Table 10.9 lists the up-counting and down-counting conditions for TCNT2. In phase counting mode both the rising and falling edges of TCLKA and TCLKB are counted. The phase difference between TCLKA and TCLKB must be at least 1.5 states, the phase overlap must also be at least 1.5 states, and the pulse width must be at least 2.5 states. See figure 10.45. TCNT2 value Counting up Counting down Time TCLKB TCLKA Figure 10.44 Operation in Phase Counting Mode (Example) Table 10.9 Up/Down Counting Conditions Counting Direction Up-Counting TCLKB ↑ Low TCLKA Phase difference High ↑ Down-Counting ↓ High Phase difference Low High ↓ ↓ Pulse width ↓ Low Low ↑ ↑ High Pulse width TCLKA TCLKB Overlap Overlap Phase difference and overlap: at least 1.5 states Pulse width: at least 2.5 states Figure 10.45 Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Counting Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 381 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.8 Buffering Buffering operates differently depending on whether a general register is an output compare register or an input capture register, with further differences in reset-synchronized PWM mode and complementary PWM mode. Buffering is available only in channels 3 and 4. Buffering operations under the conditions mentioned above are described next. • General register used for output compare The buffer register value is transferred to the general register at compare match. See figure 10.46. Compare match signal BR GR Comparator TCNT Figure 10.46 Compare Match Buffering • General register used for input capture The TCNT value is transferred to the general register at input capture. The previous general register value is transferred to the buffer register. See figure 10.47. Input capture signal BR GR Figure 10.47 Input Capture Buffering Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 382 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 TCNT Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) • Complementary PWM mode The buffer register value is transferred to the general register when TCNT3 and TCNT4 change counting direction. This occurs at the following two times: When TCNT3 compare matches GRA3 When TCNT4 underflows • Reset-synchronized PWM mode The buffer register value is transferred to the general register at compare match A3. Sample Buffering Setup Procedure: Figure 10.48 shows a sample buffering setup procedure. Buffering Select general register functions 1 Set buffer bits 2 Start counters 3 1. Set TIOR to select the output compare or input capture function of the general registers. 2. Set bits BFA3, BFA4, BFB3, and BFB4 in TFCR to select buffering of the required general registers. 3. Set the STR bits to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counters. Buffered operation Figure 10.48 Buffering Setup Procedure (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 383 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Examples of Buffering: Figure 10.49 shows an example in which GRA is set to function as an output compare register buffered by BRA, TCNT is set to operate as a periodic counter cleared by GRB compare match, and TIOCA and TIOCB are set to toggle at compare match A and B. Because of the buffer setting, when TIOCA toggles at compare match A, the BRA value is simultaneously transferred to GRA. This operation is repeated each time compare match A occurs. Figure 10.50 shows the transfer timing. TCNT value Counter cleared by compare match B GRB H'0250 H'0200 H'0100 H'0000 Time BRA H'0200 GRA H'0250 H'0200 H'0100 H'0200 H'0100 H'0200 TIOCB Toggle output TIOCA Toggle output Compare match A Figure 10.49 Register Buffering (Example 1: Buffering of Output Compare Register) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 384 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) φ n TCNT n+1 Compare match signal Buffer transfer signal N BR GR n N Figure 10.50 Compare Match and Buffer Transfer Timing (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 385 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Figure 10.51 shows an example in which GRA is set to function as an input capture register buffered by BRA, and TCNT is cleared by input capture B. The falling edge is selected as the input capture edge at TIOCB. Both edges are selected as input capture edges at TIOCA. Because of the buffer setting, when the TCNT value is captured into GRA at input capture A, the previous GRA value is simultaneously transferred to BRA. Figure 10.52 shows the transfer timing. TCNT value Counter cleared by input capture B H'0180 H'0160 H'0005 H'0000 Time TIOCB TIOCA GRA H'0005 H'0160 H'0005 BRA GRB H'0160 H'0180 Input capture A Figure 10.51 Register Buffering (Example 2: Buffering of Input Capture Register) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 386 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) φ TIOC pin Input capture signal TCNT n n+1 N N+1 GR M n n N BR m M M n Figure 10.52 Input Capture and Buffer Transfer Timing (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 387 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Figure 10.53 shows an example in which GRB3 is buffered by BRB3 in complementary PWM mode. Buffering is used to set GRB3 to a higher value than GRA3, generating a PWM waveform with 0% duty cycle. The BRB3 value is transferred to GRB3 when TCNT3 matches GRA3, and when TCNT4 underflows. TCNT3 and TCNT4 values TCNT3 H'1FFF GRA3 GRB3 TCNT4 H'0999 H'0000 BRB3 GRB3 Time H'1FFF H'0999 H'0999 H'0999 H'1FFF H'0999 H'1FFF H'0999 TIOCA3 TIOCB3 Figure 10.53 Register Buffering (Example 3: Buffering in Complementary PWM Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 388 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.4.9 ITU Output Timing The ITU outputs from channels 3 and 4 can be disabled by bit settings in TOER or by an external trigger, or inverted by bit settings in TOCR. Timing of Enabling and Disabling of ITU Output by TOER: In this example an ITU output is disabled by clearing a master enable bit to 0 in TOER. An arbitrary value can be output by appropriate settings of the data register (DR) and data direction register (DDR) of the corresponding input/output port. Figure 10.54 illustrates the timing of the enabling and disabling of ITU output by TOER. T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus TOER address TOER ITU output pin Timer output ITU output I/O port Generic input/output Figure 10.54 Timing of Disabling of ITU Output by Writing to TOER (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 389 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Timing of Disabling of ITU Output by External Trigger: If the XTGD bit is cleared to 0 in TOCR in reset-synchronized PWM mode or complementary PWM mode, when an input capture A signal occurs in channel 1, the master enable bits are cleared to 0 in TOER, disabling ITU output. Figure 10.55 shows the timing. φ TIOCA1 pin Input capture signal N TOER ITU output pins H'C0 N ITU output I/O port ITU output Generic input/output ITU output ITU output H'C0 I/O port Generic input/output N: Arbitrary setting (H'C1 to H'FF) Figure 10.55 Timing of Disabling of ITU Output by External Trigger (Example) Timing of Output Inversion by TOCR: The output levels in reset-synchronized PWM mode and complementary PWM mode can be inverted by inverting the output level select bits (OLS4 and OLS3) in TOCR. Figure 10.56 shows the timing. T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus TOCR address TOCR ITU output pin Inverted Figure 10.56 Timing of Inverting of ITU Output Level by Writing to TOCR (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 390 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.5 Interrupts The ITU has two types of interrupts: input capture/compare match interrupts, and overflow interrupts. 10.5.1 Setting of Status Flags Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB at Compare Match: IMFA and IMFB are set to 1 by a compare match signal generated when TCNT matches a general register (GR). The compare match signal is generated in the last state in which the values match (when TCNT is updated from the matching count to the next count). Therefore, when TCNT matches a general register, the compare match signal is not generated until the next timer clock input. Figure 10.57 shows the timing of the setting of IMFA and IMFB. φ TCNT input clock TCNT GR N N+1 N Compare match signal IMF IMI Figure 10.57 Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB by Compare Match Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 391 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB by Input Capture: IMFA and IMFB are set to 1 by an input capture signal. The TCNT contents are simultaneously transferred to the corresponding general register. Figure 10.58 shows the timing. φ Input capture signal IMF N TCNT GR N IMI Figure 10.58 Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB by Input Capture Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 392 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF): OVF is set to 1 when TCNT overflows from H'FFFF to H'0000 or underflows from H'0000 to H'FFFF. Figure 10.59 shows the timing. φ TCNT H'FFFF H'0000 Overflow signal OVF OVI Figure 10.59 Timing of Setting of OVF 10.5.2 Clearing of Status Flags If the CPU reads a status flag while it is set to 1, then writes 0 in the status flag, the status flag is cleared. Figure 10.60 shows the timing. TSR write cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address TSR address IMF, OVF Figure 10.60 Timing of Clearing of Status Flags Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 393 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.5.3 Interrupt Sources and DMA Controller Activation Each ITU channel can generate a compare match/input capture A interrupt, a compare match/input capture B interrupt, and an overflow interrupt. In total there are 15 interrupt sources, all independently vectored. An interrupt is requested when the interrupt request flag and interrupt enable bit are both set to 1. The priority order of the channels can be modified in interrupt priority registers A and B (IPRA and IPRB). For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller. Compare match/input capture A interrupts in channels 0 to 3 can activate the DMA controller (DMAC). When the DMAC is activated a CPU interrupt is not requested. Table 10.10 lists the interrupt sources. Table 10.10 ITU Interrupt Sources Channel Interrupt Source Description DMAC Activatable Priority* 0 IMIA0 Compare match/input capture A0 Yes High IMIB0 Compare match/input capture B0 No OVI0 Overflow 0 No IMIA1 Compare match/input capture A1 Yes IMIB1 Compare match/input capture B1 No ↑ 1 2 3 4 OVI1 Overflow 1 No IMIA2 Compare match/input capture A2 Yes IMIB2 Compare match/input capture B2 No OVI2 Overflow 2 No IMIA3 Compare match/input capture A3 Yes IMIB3 Compare match/input capture B3 No OVI3 Overflow 3 No IMIA4 Compare match/input capture A4 No IMIB4 Compare match/input capture B4 No OVI4 Overflow 4 No Low Note: * The priority immediately after a reset is indicated. Inter-channel priorities can be changed by settings in IPRA and IPRB. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 394 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) 10.6 Usage Notes This section describes contention and other matters requiring special attention during ITU operations. Contention between TCNT Write and Clear: If a counter clear signal occurs in the T3 state of a TCNT write cycle, clearing of the counter takes priority and the write is not performed. See figure 10.61. TCNT write cycle T2 T1 T3 φ Address bus TCNT address Internal write signal Counter clear signal TCNT N H'0000 Figure 10.61 Contention between TCNT Write and Clear Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 395 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between TCNT Word Write and Increment: If an increment pulse occurs in the T3 state of a TCNT word write cycle, writing takes priority and TCNT is not incremented. See figure 10.62. TCNT word write cycle T2 T1 T3 φ Address bus TCNT address Internal write signal TCNT input clock TCNT N M TCNT write data Figure 10.62 Contention between TCNT Word Write and Increment Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 396 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between TCNT Byte Write and Increment: If an increment pulse occurs in the T2 or T3 state of a TCNT byte write cycle, writing takes priority and TCNT is not incremented. The TCNT byte that was not written retains its previous value. See figure 10.63, which shows an increment pulse occurring in the T2 state of a byte write to TCNTH. TCNTH byte write cycle T1 T2 T3 φ TCNTH address Address bus Internal write signal TCNT input clock TCNTH N M TCNT write data TCNTL X X+1 X Figure 10.63 Contention between TCNT Byte Write and Increment Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 397 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between General Register Write and Compare Match: If a compare match occurs in the T3 state of a general register write cycle, writing takes priority and the compare match signal is inhibited. See figure 10.64. General register write cycle T1 T2 T3 φ GR address Address bus Internal write signal TCNT N GR N N+1 M General register write data Compare match signal Inhibited Figure 10.64 Contention between General Register Write and Compare Match Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 398 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow or Underflow: If an overflow occurs in the T3 state of a TCNT write cycle, writing takes priority and the counter is not incremented. OVF is set to 1. The same holds for underflow. See figure 10.65. TCNT write cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus TCNT address Internal write signal TCNT input clock Overflow signal TCNT H'FFFF M TCNT write data OVF Figure 10.65 Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 399 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between General Register Read and Input Capture: If an input capture signal occurs during the T3 state of a general register read cycle, the value before input capture is read. See figure 10.66. General register read cycle T2 T1 T3 φ GR address Address bus Internal read signal Input capture signal GR Internal data bus X M X Figure 10.66 Contention between General Register Read and Input Capture Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 400 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between Counter Clearing by Input Capture and Counter Increment: If an input capture signal and counter increment signal occur simultaneously, the counter is cleared according to the input capture signal. The counter is not incremented by the increment signal. The value before the counter is cleared is transferred to the general register. See figure 10.67. φ Input capture signal Counter clear signal TCNT input clock TCNT GR N H'0000 N Figure 10.67 Contention between Counter Clearing by Input Capture and Counter Increment Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 401 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between General Register Write and Input Capture: If an input capture signal occurs in the T3 state of a general register write cycle, input capture takes priority and the write to the general register is not performed. See figure 10.68. General register write cycle T1 T2 T3 φ Address bus GR address Internal write signal Input capture signal TCNT GR M M Figure 10.68 Contention between General Register Write and Input Capture Note on Waveform Period Setting: When a counter is cleared by compare match, the counter is cleared in the last state at which the TCNT value matches the general register value, at the time when this value would normally be updated to the next count. The actual counter frequency is therefore given by the following formula: f= φ (N + 1) (f: counter frequency. φ: system clock frequency. N: value set in general register.) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 402 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture: If a buffer register is used for input capture buffering and an input capture signal occurs in the T3 state of a write cycle, input capture takes priority and the write to the buffer register is not performed. See figure 10.69. Buffer register write cycle T2 T1 T3 φ BR address Address bus Internal write signal Input capture signal GR N X TCNT value BR M N Figure 10.69 Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 403 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Note on Synchronous Preset: When channels are synchronized, if a TCNT value is modified by byte write access, all 16 bits of all synchronized counters assume the same value as the counter that was addressed. Example: When channels 2 and 3 are synchronized • Byte write to channel 2 or byte write to channel 3 TCNT2 W X TCNT3 Y Z Upper byte Lower byte Write A to upper byte of channel 2 TCNT2 A X TCNT3 A X Upper byte Lower byte Write A to lower byte of channel 3 TCNT2 Y A TCNT3 Y A Upper byte Lower byte • Word write to channel 2 or word write to channel 3 TCNT2 W X TCNT3 Y Z Write AB word to channel 2 or 3 Upper byte Lower byte TCNT2 A B TCNT3 A B Upper byte Lower byte Note on Setup of Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode and Complementary PWM Mode: When setting bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR, take the following precautions: • Write to bits CMD1 and CMD0 only when TCNT3 and TCNT4 are stopped. • Do not switch directly between reset-synchronized PWM mode and complementary PWM mode. First switch to normal mode (by clearing bit CMD1 to 0), then select reset-synchronized PWM mode or complementary PWM mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 404 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 : Setting available (valid). —: Setting does not affect this mode. — — — — — — — — — FDIR TMDR PWM0 = 0 PWM0 = 0 PWM0 = 0 PWM0 = 1 PWM TOCR Register Settings — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — ResetOutput CompleSynchro- BufferXTGD Level mentary nized ing Select PWM PWM TFCR — — — — — — — — — Master Enable TOER IOA2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOA2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted — IOA * IOB IOB2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOB2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted TIOR0 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 1 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 0 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 1 Clear Select TCR0 Clock Select Note: * The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited. Legend: — — Counter By compare clearing match/input capture A SYNC0 = 1 — Input capture B Synchronous clear — Input capture A — — Output compare B By compare match/input capture B — Output compare A — MDF — SYNC0 = 1 Synchronization PWM mode Synchronous preset Operating Mode TSNC Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) ITU Operating Modes Table 10.11 (a) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 0) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 405 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 406 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 — — Counter By compare clearing match/input capture A By compare match/input capture B : Setting available (valid). —: Setting does not affect this mode. — — — — — — — — — FDIR TMDR PWM1 = 0 PWM1 = 0 PWM1 = 0 PWM1 = 1 PWM TOCR Register Settings — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — *2 — — — — — — — — — — — — — ResetOutput CompleSynchro- BufferXTGD Level mentary nized ing Select PWM PWM TFCR — — — — — — — — — Master Enable TOER IOA2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOA2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted — IOA *1 IOB IOB2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOB2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted TIOR1 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 1 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 0 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 1 Clear Select TCR1 Clock Select Notes: 1. The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited. 2. Valid only when channels 3 and 4 are operating in complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode. Legend: — Input capture B — — Input capture A SYNC1 = 1 — Output compare B Synchronous clear — Output compare A — MDF — SYNC1 = 1 Synchronization PWM mode Synchronous preset Operating Mode TSNC Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Table 10.11 (b) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 1) : Setting available (valid). —: Setting does not affect this mode. MDF = 1 — — — — — — — — — FDIR TMDR PWM2 = 0 PWM2 = 0 PWM2 = 0 PWM2 = 1 PWM TOCR Register Settings — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — ResetOutput CompleSynchro- BufferXTGD Level mentary nized ing Select PWM PWM TFCR — — — — — — — — — — Master Enable TOER IOA2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOA2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted — IOA * IOB IOB2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOB2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted TIOR2 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 1 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 0 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 1 Clear Select TCR2 — Clock Select Note: * The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited. Legend: Phase counting mode — — Counter By compare clearing match/input capture A SYNC2 = 1 — Input capture B Synchronous clear — Input capture A — — Output compare B By compare match/input capture B — Output compare A — MDF — SYNC2 = 1 Synchronization PWM mode Synchronous preset Operating Mode TSNC Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Table 10.11 (c) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 2) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 407 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 408 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 — — — Counter By compare clearing match/input capture A By compare match/input capture B Synchronous clear — Buffering (BRB) — — — — — — — — — — — — — Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. *3 — — CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 1 CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 Illegal setting: CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 CMD1 = 0 Illegal setting: CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 PWM3 = 0 CMD1 = 0 PWM3 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 PWM3 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 1 CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 CMD1 = 0 *4 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 ResetSynchronized PWM TFCR BFA3 = 1 Other bits unrestricted BFA3 = 1 Other bits unrestricted Buffering — — — — — — — — — — — IOA2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted — IOA *1 — — — *6 *1 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 1 *1 — CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 0 *1 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 1 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 0 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 1 — IOA2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted Clear Select TCR3 *1 EB3 ignored Other bits unrestricted *2 IOB IOB2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted TIOR3 EA3 ignored IOA2 = 1 Other bits Other bits unrestricted unrestricted *1 Master Enable TOER *6 — — — — — — — — — — Output XTGD Level Select TOCR Register Settings *5 Clock Select Master enable bit settings are valid only during waveform output. The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited. Do not set both channels 3 and 4 for synchronous operation when complementary PWM mode is selected. The counter cannot be cleared by input capture A when reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected. In complementary PWM mode, select the same clock source for channels 3 and 4. Use the input capture A function in channel 1. : Setting available (valid). —: Setting does not affect this mode. — Buffering (BRA) Legend: — Reset-synchronized PWM mode — — Input capture B *3 — Input capture A Complementary PWM mode — Output compare B SYNC3 = 1 — Output compare A — — SYNC3 = 1 PWM Complementary PWM PWM3 = 1 CMD1 = 0 TMDR Synchro- MDF FDIR nization PWM mode Synchronous preset Operating Mode TSNC Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Table 10.11 (d) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 3) — — — Counter By compare clearing match/input capture A By compare match/input capture B Synchronous clear — Buffering (BRB) — — — — — — — — — — — — — Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. *3 — — CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 1 CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 Illegal setting: CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 Illegal setting: CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 Illegal setting: CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 PWM4 = 0 CMD1 = 0 PWM4 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 PWM4 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 1 BFA4 = 1 Other bits unrestricted — — — *4 CMD1 = 1 CMD0 = 0 — *4 — — — — — — — BFA4 = 1 Other bits unrestricted Buffering — — — — — — — — — — — Output XTGD Level Select TOCR Register Settings *4 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 CMD1 = 0 ResetSynchronized PWM TFCR IOA2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted — IOA *1 *1 *1 *1 *1 EB4 ignored Other bits unrestricted — — *2 IOB — — IOA2 = 1 Other bits unrestricted IOB2 = 0 Other bits unrestricted TIOR4 EA4 ignored IOA2 = 1 Other bits Other bits unrestricted unrestricted *1 Master Enable TOER *6 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 0 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 1 CCLR1 = 1 CCLR0 = 0 CCLR1 = 0 CCLR0 = 1 Clear Select TCR4 *6 *5 Clock Select Master enable bit settings are valid only during waveform output. The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited. Do not set both channels 3 and 4 for synchronous operation when complementary PWM mode is selected. When reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected, TCNT4 operates independently and the counter clearing function is available. Waveform output is not affected. In complementary PWM mode, select the same clock source for channels 3 and 4. TCR4 settings are valid in reset-synchronized PWM mode, but TCNT4 operates independently, without affecting waveform output. : Setting available (valid). —: Setting does not affect this mode. — Buffering (BRA) Legend: — Reset-synchronized PWM mode — — Input capture B *3 — Input capture A Complementary PWM mode — Output compare B SYNC4 = 1 — Output compare A — — SYNC4 = 1 PWM Complementary PWM PWM4 = 1 CMD1 = 0 TMDR Synchro- MDF FDIR nization PWM mode Synchronous preset Operating Mode TSNC Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Table 10.11 (e) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 4) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 409 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 410 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has a built-in programmable timing pattern controller (TPC) that provides pulse outputs by using the 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) as a time base. The TPC pulse outputs are divided into 4-bit groups (group 3 to group 0) that can operate simultaneously and independently. 11.1.1 Features TPC features are listed below. • 16-bit output data Maximum 16-bit data can be output. TPC output can be enabled on a bit-by-bit basis. • Four output groups Output trigger signals can be selected in 4-bit groups to provide up to four different 4-bit outputs. • Selectable output trigger signals Output trigger signals can be selected for each group from the compare-match signals of four ITU channels. • Non-overlap mode A non-overlap margin can be provided between pulse outputs. • Can operate together with the DMA controller (DMAC) The compare-match signals selected as trigger signals can activate the DMAC for sequential output of data without CPU intervention. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 411 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 11.1 shows a block diagram of the TPC. ITU compare match signals Control logic TP15 TP14 TP13 TP12 TP11 TP10 TP 9 TP 8 TP 7 TP 6 TP 5 TP 4 TP 3 TP 2 TP 1 TP 0 Legend TPMR: TPCR: NDERB: NDERA: PBDDR: PADDR: NDRB: NDRA: PBDR: PADR: PADDR PBDDR NDERA NDERB TPMR TPCR Internal data bus Pulse output pins, group 3 PBDR NDRB PADR NDRA Pulse output pins, group 2 Pulse output pins, group 1 Pulse output pins, group 0 TPC output mode register TPC output control register Next data enable register B Next data enable register A Port B data direction register Port A data direction register Next data register B Next data register A Port B data register Port A data register Figure 11.1 TPC Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 412 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.1.3 TPC Pins Table 11.1 summarizes the TPC output pins. Table 11.1 TPC Pins Name Symbol I/O Function TPC output 0 TP0 Output Group 0 pulse output TPC output 1 TP1 Output TPC output 2 TP2 Output TPC output 3 TP3 Output TPC output 4 TP4 Output TPC output 5 TP5 Output TPC output 6 TP6 Output TPC output 7 TP7 Output TPC output 8 TP8 Output TPC output 9 TP9 Output TPC output 10 TP10 Output TPC output 11 TP11 Output TPC output 12 TP12 Output TPC output 13 TP13 Output TPC output 14 TP14 Output TPC output 15 TP15 Output Group 1 pulse output Group 2 pulse output Group 3 pulse output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 413 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.1.4 Registers Table 11.2 summarizes the TPC registers. Table 11.2 TPC Registers Address* H'FFD1 1 Name Abbreviation R/W Port A data direction register PADDR W Initial Value H'00 2 H'FFD3 Port A data register PADR R/(W)* H'00 H'FFD4 Port B data direction register PBDDR W H'00 H'00 H'FFD6 Port B data register PBDR 2 R/(W)* H'FFA0 TPC output mode register TPMR R/W H'F0 H'FFA1 TPC output control register TPCR R/W H'FF H'FFA2 Next data enable register B NDERB R/W H'00 H'FFA3 Next data enable register A NDERA R/W H'00 H'FFA5/ 3 H'FFA7* Next data register A NDRA R/W H'00 H'FFA4 3 H'FFA6* Next data register B NDRB R/W H'00 Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Bits used for TPC output cannot be written. 3. The NDRA address is H'FFA5 when the same output trigger is selected for TPC output groups 0 and 1 by settings in TPCR. When the output triggers are different, the NDRA address is H'FFA7 for group 0 and H'FFA5 for group 1. Similarly, the address of NDRB is H'FFA4 when the same output trigger is selected for TPC output groups 2 and 3 by settings in TPCR. When the output triggers are different, the NDRB address is H'FFA6 for group 2 and H'FFA4 for group 3. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 414 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2 Register Descriptions 11.2.1 Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) PADDR is an 8-bit write-only register that selects input or output for each pin in port A. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PA7 DDR PA6 DDR PA5 DDR PA4 DDR PA3 DDR PA2 DDR PA1 DDR PA0 DDR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write W W W W W W W W Port A data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port A pins Port A is multiplexed with pins TP7 to TP0. Bits corresponding to pins used for TPC output must be set to 1. For further information about PADDR, see section 9.11, Port A. 11.2.2 Port A Data Register (PADR) PADR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores TPC output data for groups 0 and 1, when these TPC output groups are used. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PA 7 PA 6 PA 5 PA 4 PA 3 PA 2 PA 1 PA 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Port A data 7 to 0 These bits store output data for TPC output groups 0 and 1 Note: * Bits selected for TPC output by NDERA settings become read-only bits. For further information about PADR, see section 9.11, Port A. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 415 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.3 Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) PBDDR is an 8-bit write-only register that selects input or output for each pin in port B. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PB7 DDR PB6 DDR PB5 DDR PB4 DDR PB3 DDR PB2 DDR PB1 DDR PB0 DDR Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write W W W W W W W W Port B data direction 7 to 0 These bits select input or output for port B pins Port B is multiplexed with pins TP15 to TP8. Bits corresponding to pins used for TPC output must be set to 1. For further information about PBDDR, see section 9.12, Port B. 11.2.4 Port B Data Register (PBDR) PBDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores TPC output data for groups 2 and 3, when these TPC output groups are used. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PB 7 PB 6 PB 5 PB 4 PB 3 PB 2 PB 1 PB 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Port B data 7 to 0 These bits store output data for TPC output groups 2 and 3 Note: * Bits selected for TPC output by NDERB settings become read-only bits. For further information about PBDR, see section 9.12, Port B. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 416 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.5 Next Data Register A (NDRA) NDRA is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores the next output data for TPC output groups 1 and 0 (pins TP7 to TP0). During TPC output, when an ITU compare match event specified in TPCR occurs, NDRA contents are transferred to the corresponding bits in PADR. The address of NDRA differs depending on whether TPC output groups 0 and 1 have the same output trigger or different output triggers. NDRA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Same Trigger for TPC Output Groups 0 and 1: If TPC output groups 0 and 1 are triggered by the same compare match event, the NDRA address is H'FFA5. The upper 4 bits belong to group 1 and the lower 4 bits to group 0. Address H'FFA7 consists entirely of reserved bits that cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Address H'FFA5 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NDR7 NDR6 NDR5 NDR4 NDR3 NDR2 NDR1 NDR0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Next data 7 to 4 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 1 Next data 3 to 0 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 0 Address H'FFA7 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — — — — Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — Reserved bits Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 417 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Different Triggers for TPC Output Groups 0 and 1: If TPC output groups 0 and 1 are triggered by different compare match events, the address of the upper 4 bits of NDRA (group 1) is H'FFA5 and the address of the lower 4 bits (group 0) is H'FFA7. Bits 3 to 0 of address H'FFA5 and bits 7 to 4 of address H'FFA7 are reserved bits that cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Address H'FFA5 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NDR7 NDR6 NDR5 NDR4 — — — — Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W — — — — Next data 7 to 4 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 1 Reserved bits Address H'FFA7 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — NDR3 NDR2 NDR1 NDR0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 418 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Next data 3 to 0 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 0 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.6 Next Data Register B (NDRB) NDRB is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores the next output data for TPC output groups 3 and 2 (pins TP15 to TP8). During TPC output, when an ITU compare match event specified in TPCR occurs, NDRB contents are transferred to the corresponding bits in PBDR. The address of NDRB differs depending on whether TPC output groups 2 and 3 have the same output trigger or different output triggers. NDRB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Same Trigger for TPC Output Groups 2 and 3: If TPC output groups 2 and 3 are triggered by the same compare match event, the NDRB address is H'FFA4. The upper 4 bits belong to group 3 and the lower 4 bits to group 2. Address H'FFA6 consists entirely of reserved bits that cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Address H'FFA4 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NDR15 NDR14 NDR13 NDR12 NDR11 NDR10 NDR9 NDR8 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Next data 15 to 12 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 3 Next data 11 to 8 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 2 Address H'FFA6 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — — — — Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — Reserved bits Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 419 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Different Triggers for TPC Output Groups 2 and 3: If TPC output groups 2 and 3 are triggered by different compare match events, the address of the upper 4 bits of NDRB (group 3) is H'FFA4 and the address of the lower 4 bits (group 2) is H'FFA6. Bits 3 to 0 of address H'FFA4 and bits 7 to 4 of address H'FFA6 are reserved bits that cannot be modified and are always read as 1. Address H'FFA4 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NDR15 NDR14 NDR13 NDR12 — — — — Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W — — — — Next data 15 to 12 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 3 Reserved bits Address H'FFA6 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — NDR11 NDR10 NDR9 NDR8 Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 420 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Next data 11 to 8 These bits store the next output data for TPC output group 2 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.7 Next Data Enable Register A (NDERA) NDERA is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables TPC output groups 1 and 0 (TP7 to TP0) on a bit-by-bit basis. Bit 6 7 NDER7 5 NDER6 NDER5 4 3 NDER4 NDER3 2 NDER2 1 0 NDER1 NDER0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Next data enable 7 to 0 These bits enable or disable TPC output groups 1 and 0 If a bit is enabled for TPC output by NDERA, then when the ITU compare match event selected in the TPC output control register (TPCR) occurs, the NDRA value is automatically transferred to the corresponding PADR bit, updating the output value. If TPC output is disabled, the bit value is not transferred from NDRA to PADR and the output value does not change. NDERA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 0—Next Data Enable 7 to 0 (NDER7 to NDER0): These bits enable or disable TPC output groups 1 and 0 (TP7 to TP0) on a bit-by-bit basis. Bits 7 to 0: NDER7 to NDER0 Description 0 TPC outputs TP7 to TP0 are disabled (NDR7 to NDR0 are not transferred to PA7 to PA0) 1 TPC outputs TP7 to TP0 are enabled (NDR7 to NDR0 are transferred to PA7 to PA0) (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 421 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.8 Next Data Enable Register B (NDERB) NDERB is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables TPC output groups 3 and 2 (TP15 to TP8) on a bit-by-bit basis. Bit 7 6 4 5 3 2 1 0 NDER15 NDER14 NDER13 NDER12 NDER11 NDER10 NDER9 NDER8 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Next data enable 15 to 8 These bits enable or disable TPC output groups 3 and 2 If a bit is enabled for TPC output by NDERB, then when the ITU compare match event selected in the TPC output control register (TPCR) occurs, the NDRB value is automatically transferred to the corresponding PBDR bit, updating the output value. If TPC output is disabled, the bit value is not transferred from NDRB to PBDR and the output value does not change. NDERB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 0—Next Data Enable 15 to 8 (NDER15 to NDER8): These bits enable or disable TPC output groups 3 and 2 (TP15 to TP8) on a bit-by-bit basis. Bits 7 to 0: NDER15 to NDER8 Description 0 TPC outputs TP15 to TP8 are disabled (NDR15 to NDR8 are not transferred to PB7 to PB0) 1 TPC outputs TP15 to TP8 are enabled (NDR15 to NDR8 are transferred to PB7 to PB0) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 422 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.9 TPC Output Control Register (TPCR) TPCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects output trigger signals for TPC outputs on a group-by-group basis. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Group 3 compare match select 1 and 0 These bits select the compare match Group 2 compare event that triggers TPC output group 3 match select 1 and 0 These bits select (TP15 to TP12 ) the compare match event that triggers Group 1 compare TPC output group 2 match select 1 and 0 These bits select (TP11 to TP8 ) the compare match event that triggers Group 0 compare TPC output group 1 match select 1 and 0 These bits select (TP7 to TP4 ) the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0 ) TPCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 and 6—Group 3 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G3CMS1, G3CMS0): These bits select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12). Bit 7: G3CMS1 Bit 6: G3CMS0 Description 0 0 TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0 1 TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1 0 TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2 1 TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3 (Initial value) 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 423 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Bits 5 and 4—Group 2 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G2CMS1, G2CMS0): These bits select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8). Bit 5: G2CMS1 Bit 4: G2CMS0 Description 0 0 TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0 1 TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1 0 TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2 1 TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3 (Initial value) 1 Bits 3 and 2—Group 1 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G1CMS1, G1CMS0): These bits select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4). Bit 3: G1CMS1 Bit 2: G1CMS0 Description 0 0 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0 1 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1 0 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2 1 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3 (Initial value) 1 Bits 1 and 0—Group 0 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G0CMS1, G0CMS0): These bits select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0). Bit 1: G0CMS1 Bit 0: G0CMS0 Description 0 0 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0 1 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1 0 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2 1 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3 (Initial value) 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 424 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.2.10 TPC Output Mode Register (TPMR) TPMR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for each group. Bit 7 6 5 4 — — — — 3 2 G3NOV G2NOV 1 0 G1NOV G0NOV Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Reserved bits Group 3 non-overlap Selects non-overlapping TPC output for group 3 (TP15 to TP12 ) Group 2 non-overlap Selects non-overlapping TPC output for group 2 (TP11 to TP8 ) Group 1 non-overlap Selects non-overlapping TPC output for group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) Group 0 non-overlap Selects non-overlapping TPC output for group 0 (TP3 to TP0 ) The output trigger period of a non-overlapping TPC output waveform is set in general register B (GRB) in the ITU channel selected for output triggering. The non-overlap margin is set in general register A (GRA). The output values change at compare match A and B. For details see section 11.3.4, Non-Overlapping TPC Output. TPMR is initialized to H'F0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 4—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 425 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Bit 3—Group 3 Non-Overlap (G3NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for group 3 (TP15 to TP12). Bit 3: G3NOV Description 0 Normal TPC output in group 3 (output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel) (Initial value) 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 3 (independent 1 and 0 output at compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel) Bit 2—Group 2 Non-Overlap (G2NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for group 2 (TP11 to TP8). Bit 2: G2NOV Description 0 Normal TPC output in group 2 (output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel) (Initial value) 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 2 (independent 1 and 0 output at compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel) Bit 1—Group 1 Non-Overlap (G1NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for group 1 (TP7 to TP4). Bit 1: G1NOV Description 0 Normal TPC output in group 1 (output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel) (Initial value) 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 1 (independent 1 and 0 output at compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel) Bit 0—Group 0 Non-Overlap (G0NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for group 0 (TP3 to TP0). Bit 0: G0NOV Description 0 Normal TPC output in group 0 (output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel) (Initial value) 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 0 (independent 1 and 0 output at compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 426 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.3 Operation 11.3.1 Overview When corresponding bits in PADDR or PBDDR and NDERA or NDERB are set to 1, TPC output is enabled. The TPC output initially consists of the corresponding PADR or PBDR contents. When a compare-match event selected in TPCR occurs, the corresponding NDRA or NDRB bit contents are transferred to PADR or PBDR to update the output values. Figure 11.2 illustrates the TPC output operation. Table 11.3 summarizes the TPC operating conditions. DDR NDER Q Q Output trigger signal C Q DR D Q NDR D Internal data bus TPC output pin Figure 11.2 TPC Output Operation Table 11.3 TPC Operating Conditions NDER DDR Pin Function 0 0 Generic input port 1 Generic output port 1 0 Generic input port (but the DR bit is a read-only bit, and when compare match occurs, the NDR bit value is transferred to the DR bit) 1 TPC pulse output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 427 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Sequential output of up to 16-bit patterns is possible by writing new output data to NDRA and NDRB before the next compare match. For information on non-overlapping operation, see section 11.3.4, Non-Overlapping TPC Output. 11.3.2 Output Timing If TPC output is enabled, NDRA/NDRB contents are transferred to PADR/PBDR and output when the selected compare match event occurs. Figure 11.3 shows the timing of these operations for the case of normal output in groups 2 and 3, triggered by compare match A. φ TCNT N GRA N+1 N Compare match A signal NDRB n PBDR m n TP8 to TP15 m n Figure 11.3 Timing of Transfer of Next Data Register Contents and Output (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 428 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.3.3 Normal TPC Output Sample Setup Procedure for Normal TPC Output: Figure 11.4 shows a sample procedure for setting up normal TPC output. Normal TPC output Select GR functions 1 Set GRA value 2 Select counting operation 3 Select interrupt request 4 Set initial output data 5 Select port output 6 Enable TPC output 7 Select TPC output trigger 8 Set next TPC output data 9 Start counter 10 ITU setup Port and TPC setup ITU setup Compare match? 1. Set TIOR to make GRA an output compare register (with output inhibited). 2. Set the TPC output trigger period. 3. Select the counter clock source with bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. Select the counter clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0. 4. Enable the IMFA interrupt in TIER. The DMAC can also be set up to transfer data to the next data register. 5. Set the initial output values in the DR bits of the input/output port pins to be used for TPC output. 6. Set the DDR bits of the input/output port pins to be used for TPC output to 1. 7. Set the NDER bits of the pins to be used for TPC output to 1. 8. Select the ITU compare match event to be used as the TPC output trigger in TPCR. 9. Set the next TPC output values in the NDR bits. 10. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. 11. At each IMFA interrupt, set the next output values in the NDR bits. No Yes Set next TPC output data 11 Figure 11.4 Setup Procedure for Normal TPC Output (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 429 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Example of Normal TPC Output (Example of Five-Phase Pulse Output): Figure 11.5 shows an example in which the TPC is used for cyclic five-phase pulse output. TCNT value Compare match TCNT GRA H'0000 Time NDRB 80 PBDR 00 C0 80 40 C0 60 40 20 60 30 20 10 30 18 10 08 18 88 08 80 88 C0 80 40 C0 TP15 TP14 TP13 TP12 TP11 • • • • The ITU channel to be used as the output trigger channel is set up so that GRA is an output compare register and the counter will be cleared by compare match A. The trigger period is set in GRA. The IMIEA bit is set to 1 in TIER to enable the compare match A interrupt. H'F8 is written in PBDDR and NDERB, and bits G3CMS1, G3CMS0, G2CMS1, and G2CMS0 are set in TPCR to select compare match in the ITU channel set up in step 1 as the output trigger. Output data H'80 is written in NDRB. The timer counter in this ITU channel is started. When compare match A occurs, the NDRB contents are transferred to PBDR and output. The compare match/input capture A (IMFA) interrupt service routine writes the next output data (H'C0) in NDRB. Five-phase overlapping pulse output (one or two phases active at a time) can be obtained by writing H'40, H'60, H'20, H'30, H'10, H'18, H'08, H'88… at successive IMFA interrupts. If the DMAC is set for activation by this interrupt, pulse output can be obtained without loading the CPU. Figure 11.5 Normal TPC Output Example (Five-Phase Pulse Output) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 430 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.3.4 Non-Overlapping TPC Output Sample Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping TPC Output: Figure 11.6 shows a sample procedure for setting up non-overlapping TPC output. Non-overlapping TPC output Select GR functions 1 Set GR values 2 Select counting operation 3 Select interrupt requests 4 Set initial output data 5 Set up TPC output 6 Enable TPC transfer 7 Select TPC transfer trigger 8 Select non-overlapping groups 9 Set next TPC output data 10 Start counter 11 ITU setup Port and TPC setup ITU setup Compare match A? 1. Set TIOR to make GRA and GRB output compare registers (with output inhibited). 2. Set the TPC output trigger period in GRB and the non-overlap margin in GRA. 3. Select the counter clock source with bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. Select the counter clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0. 4. Enable the IMFA interrupt in TIER. The DMAC can also be set up to transfer data to the next data register. 5. Set the initial output values in the DR bits of the input/output port pins to be used for TPC output. 6. Set the DDR bits of the input/output port pins to be used for TPC output to 1. 7. Set the NDER bits of the pins to be used for TPC output to 1. 8. In TPCR, select the ITU compare match event to be used as the TPC output trigger. 9. In TPMR, select the groups that will operate in non-overlap mode. 10. Set the next TPC output values in the NDR bits. 11. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter. 12. At each IMFA interrupt, write the next output value in the NDR bits. No Yes Set next TPC output data 12 Figure 11.6 Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping TPC Output (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 431 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Example of Non-Overlapping TPC Output (Example of Four-Phase Complementary NonOverlapping Output): Figure 11.7 shows an example of the use of TPC output for four-phase complementary non-overlapping pulse output. TCNT value GRB TCNT GRA H'0000 Time NDRB 95 PBDR 00 65 95 59 05 65 56 41 59 95 50 56 65 14 95 05 65 Non-overlap margin TP15 TP14 TP13 TP12 TP11 TP10 TP9 TP8 This operation example is described below. • The output trigger ITU channel is set up so that GRA and GRB are output compare registers and the counter will be cleared by compare match B. The TPC output trigger period is set in GRB. The nonoverlap margin is set in GRA. The IMIEA bit is set to 1 in TIER to enable IMFA interrupts. • H'FF is written in PBDDR and NDERB, and bits G3CMS1, G3CMS0, G2CMS1, and G2CMS0 are set in TPCR to select compare match in the ITU channel set up in step 1 as the output trigger. Bits G3NOV and G2NOV are set to 1 in TPMR to select non-overlapping output. Output data H'95 is written in NDRB. • The timer counter in this ITU channel is started. When compare match B occurs, outputs change from 1 to 0. When compare match A occurs, outputs change from 0 to 1 (the change from 0 to 1 is delayed by the value of GRA). The IMFA interrupt service routine writes the next output data (H'65) in NDRB. • Four-phase complementary non-overlapping pulse output can be obtained by writing H'59, H'56, H'95… at successive IMFA interrupts. If the DMAC is set for activation by this interrupt, pulse output can be obtained without loading the CPU. Figure 11.7 Non-Overlapping TPC Output Example (Four-Phase Complementary Non-Overlapping Pulse Output) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 432 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.3.5 TPC Output Triggering by Input Capture TPC output can be triggered by ITU input capture as well as by compare match. If GRA and GRB functions as an input capture register in the ITU channel selected in TPCR, TPC output will be triggered by the input capture signal. Figure 11.8 shows the timing. φ TIOC pin Input capture signal N NDR DR M N Figure 11.8 TPC Output Triggering by Input Capture (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 433 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller 11.4 Usage Notes 11.4.1 Operation of TPC Output Pins TP0 to TP15 are multiplexed with ITU, DMAC, address bus, and other pin functions. When ITU, DMAC, or address output is enabled, the corresponding pins cannot be used for TPC output. The data transfer from NDR bits to DR bits takes place, however, regardless of the usage of the pin. Pin functions should be changed only under conditions in which the output trigger event will not occur. 11.4.2 Note on Non-Overlapping Output During non-overlapping operation, the transfer of NDR bit values to DR bits takes place as follows. 1. NDR bits are always transferred to DR bits at compare match A. 2. At compare match B, NDR bits are transferred only if their value is 0. Bits are not transferred if their value is 1. Figure 11.9 illustrates the non-overlapping TPC output operation. DDR NDER Q Q Compare match A Compare match B C Q DR D Q NDR TPC output pin Figure 11.9 Non-Overlapping TPC Output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 434 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 D Internal data bus Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Therefore, 0 data can be transferred ahead of 1 data by making compare match B occur before compare match A. NDR contents should not be altered during the interval from compare match B to compare match A (the non-overlap margin). This can be accomplished by having the IMFA interrupt service routine write the next data in NDR, or by having the IMFA interrupt activate the DMAC. The next data must be written before the next compare match B occurs. Figure 11.10 shows the timing relationships. Compare match A Compare match B NDR write NDR write NDR DR 0 output 0/1 output 0 output 0/1 output Write to NDR in this interval Do not write to NDR in this interval Write to NDR in this interval Do not write to NDR in this interval Figure 11.10 Non-Overlapping Operation and NDR Write Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 435 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 436 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has an on-chip watchdog timer (WDT). The WDT has two selectable functions: it can operate as a watchdog timer to supervise system operation, or it can operate as an interval timer. As a watchdog timer, it generates a reset signal for the chip if a system crash allows the timer counter (TCNT) to overflow before being rewritten. In interval timer operation, an interval timer interrupt is requested at each TCNT overflow. 12.1.1 Features WDT features are listed below. • Selection of eight counter clock sources φ/2, φ/32, φ/64, φ/128, φ/256, φ/512, φ/2048, or φ/4096 • Interval timer option • Timer counter overflow generates a reset signal or interrupt. The reset signal is generated in watchdog timer operation. An interval timer interrupt is generated in interval timer operation. • Watchdog timer reset signal resets the entire chip internally, and can also be output externally. The reset signal generated by timer counter overflow during watchdog timer operation resets the entire chip internally. An external reset signal can be output from the RESO pin to reset other system devices simultaneously. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 437 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 12.1 shows a block diagram of the WDT. Overflow TCNT Interrupt signal Interrupt control (interval timer) TCSR Reset control Internal data bus Internal clock sources φ/2 RSTCSR Reset (internal, external) Read/ write control φ/32 φ/64 Clock Clock selector φ/128 φ/256 φ/512 Legend TCNT: Timer counter TCSR: Timer control/status register RSTCSR: Reset control/status register φ/2048 φ/4096 Figure 12.1 WDT Block Diagram 12.1.3 Pin Configuration Table 12.1 describes the WDT output pin. Table 12.1 WDT Pin Name Abbreviation I/O Function Reset output RESO Output* External output of the watchdog timer reset signal Note: * Open-drain output. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 438 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.1.4 Register Configuration Table 12.2 summarizes the WDT registers. Table 12.2 WDT Registers Address* Write* 2 H'FFA8 H'FFAA 1 Read Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFA8 Timer control/status register TCSR 3 R/(W)* H'18 H'FFA9 Timer counter TCNT R/W H'00 H'FFAB Reset control/status register RSTCSR 3 R/(W)* H'3F Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Write word data starting at this address. 3. Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag. 12.2 Register Descriptions 12.2.1 Timer Counter (TCNT) TCNT is an 8-bit readable and writable* up-counter. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W When the TME bit is set to 1 in TCSR, TCNT starts counting pulses generated from an internal clock source selected by bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCSR. When the count overflows (changes from H'FF to H'00), the OVF bit is set to 1 in TCSR. TCNT is initialized to H'00 by a reset and when the TME bit is cleared to 0. Note: * TCNT is write-protected by a password. For details see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 439 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.2.2 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) TCSR is an 8-bit readable and writable* register. Its functions include selecting the timer mode and clock source. Note: * TCSR differs from other registers in being more difficult to write. For details see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access. Bit Initial value Read/Write 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OVF WT/IT TME — — CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 0 R/(W)* 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 R/W R/W — — R/W R/W R/W Clock select These bits select the TCNT clock source Reserved bits Timer enable Selects whether TCNT runs or halts Timer mode select Selects the mode Overflow flag Status flag indicating overflow Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. Bits 7 to 5 are initialized to 0 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 2 to 0 are initialized to 0 by a reset. In software standby mode bits 2 to 0 are not initialized, but retain their previous values. Bit 7—Overflow Flag (OVF): This status flag indicates that the timer counter has overflowed from H'FF to H'00. Bit 7: OVF Description 0 [Clearing condition] Cleared by reading OVF when OVF = 1, then writing 0 in OVF 1 [Setting condition] Set when TCNT changes from H'FF to H'00 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 440 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 12 Watchdog Timer Bit 6—Timer Mode Select (WT/IT IT): IT Selects whether to use the WDT as a watchdog timer or interval timer. If used as an interval timer, the WDT generates an interval timer interrupt request when TCNT overflows. If used as a watchdog timer, the WDT generates a reset signal when TCNT overflows. Bit 6: WT/IT IT Description 0 Interval timer: requests interval timer interrupts 1 Watchdog timer: generates a reset signal (Initial value) Bit 5—Timer Enable (TME): Selects whether TCNT runs or is halted. When WT/IT = 1, clear the SYSCR software standby bit (SSBY) to 0, then set the TME to 1. When SSBY is set to 1, clear TME to 0. Bit 5: TME Description 0 TCNT is initialized to H'00 and halted 1 TCNT is counting and CPU interrupt requests are enabled (Initial value) Bits 4 and 3—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bits 2 to 0—Clock Select 2 to 0 (CKS2/1/0): These bits select one of eight internal clock sources, obtained by prescaling the system clock (φ), for input to TCNT. Bit 2: CKS2 Bit 1: CKS1 Bit 0: CKS0 Description 0 0 0 φ/2 1 φ/32 1 0 φ/64 1 φ/128 0 φ/256 1 φ/512 0 φ/2048 1 φ/4096 1 0 1 (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 441 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.2.3 Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR) RSTCSR is an 8-bit readable and writable* register that indicates when a reset signal has been generated by watchdog timer overflow, and controls external output of the reset signal. Note: * RSTCSR differs from other registers in being more difficult to write. For details see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WRST RSTOE — — — — — — Initial value 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/(W)* R/W — — — — — — Reserved bits Reset output enable Enables or disables external output of the reset signal Watchdog timer reset Indicates that a reset signal has been generated Note: * Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag. Bits 7 and 6 are initialized by input of a reset signal at the RES pin. They are not initialized by reset signals generated by watchdog timer overflow. Bit 7—Watchdog Timer Reset (WRST): During watchdog timer operation, this bit indicates that TCNT has overflowed and generated a reset signal. This reset signal resets the entire chip internally. If bit RSTOE is set to 1, this reset signal is also output (low) at the RESO pin to initialize external system devices. Bit 7: WRST Description 0 [Clearing conditions] Cleared to 0 by reset signal input at RES pin (Initial value) Cleared by reading WRST when WRST = 1, then writing 0 in WRST 1 [Setting condition] Set when TCNT overflow generates a reset signal during watchdog timer operation Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 442 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer Bit 6—Reset Output Enable (RSTOE): Enables or disables external output at the RESO pin of the reset signal generated if TCNT overflows during watchdog timer operation. Bit 6: RSTOE Description 0 Reset signal is not output externally 1 Reset signal is output externally (Initial value) Bits 5 to 0—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. 12.2.4 Notes on Register Access The watchdog timer’s TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR registers differ from other registers in being more difficult to write. The procedures for writing and reading these registers are given below. Writing to TCNT and TCSR: These registers must be written by a word transfer instruction. They cannot be written by byte instructions. Figure 12.2 shows the format of data written to TCNT and TCSR. TCNT and TCSR both have the same write address. The write data must be contained in the lower byte of the written word. The upper byte must contain H'5A (password for TCNT) or H'A5 (password for TCSR). This transfers the write data from the lower byte to TCNT or TCSR. 15 TCNT write Address H'FFA8* H'5A 15 TCSR write Address 8 7 H'FFA8* 0 Write data 8 7 H'A5 0 Write data Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Figure 12.2 Format of Data Written to TCNT and TCSR Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 443 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer Writing to RSTCSR: RSTCSR must be written by a word transfer instruction. It cannot be written by byte transfer instructions. Figure 12.3 shows the format of data written to RSTCSR. To write 0 in the WRST bit, the write data must have H'A5 in the upper byte and H'00 in the lower byte. The H'00 in the lower byte clears the WRST bit in RSTCSR to 0. To write to the RSTOE bit, the upper byte must contain H'5A and the lower byte must contain the write data. Writing this word transfers a write data value into the RSTOE bit. Writing 0 in WRST bit Address H'FFAA* Writing to RSTOE bit Address 15 8 7 H'A5 15 H'FFAA* 0 H'00 8 7 H'5A 0 Write data Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Figure 12.3 Format of Data Written to RSTCSR Reading TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR: These registers are read like other registers. Byte access instructions can be used. The read addresses are H'FFA8 for TCSR, H'FFA9 for TCNT, and H'FFAB for RSTCSR, as listed in table 12.3. Table 12.3 Read Addresses of TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR Address* Register H'FFA8 TCSR H'FFA9 TCNT H'FFAB RSTCSR Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 444 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.3 Operation Operations when the WDT is used as a watchdog timer and as an interval timer are described below. 12.3.1 Watchdog Timer Operation Figure 12.4 illustrates watchdog timer operation. To use the WDT as a watchdog timer, set the WT/IT and TME bits to 1 in TCSR. Software must prevent TCNT overflow by rewriting the TCNT value (normally by writing H'00) before overflow occurs. If TCNT fails to be rewritten and overflows due to a system crash etc., the chip is internally reset for a duration of 518 states. The watchdog reset signal can be externally output from the RESO pin to reset external system devices. The reset signal is output externally for 132 states. External output can be enabled or disabled by the RSTOE bit in RSTCSR. A watchdog reset has the same vector as a reset generated by input at the RES pin. Software can distinguish a RES reset from a watchdog reset by checking the WRST bit in RSTCSR. If a RES reset and a watchdog reset occur simultaneously, the RES reset takes priority. WDT overflow H'FF TME set to 1 TCNT count value H'00 OVF = 1 Start Internal reset signal H'00 written in TCNT Reset H'00 written in TCNT 518 states RESO 132 states Figure 12.4 Watchdog Timer Operation Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 445 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.3.2 Interval Timer Operation Figure 12.5 illustrates interval timer operation. To use the WDT as an interval timer, clear bit WT/IT to 0 and set bit TME to 1 in TCSR. An interval timer interrupt request is generated at each TCNT overflow. This function can be used to generate interval timer interrupts at regular intervals. H'FF TCNT count value Time t H'00 WT/ IT = 0 TME = 1 Interval timer interrupt Interval timer interrupt Interval timer interrupt Interval timer interrupt Figure 12.5 Interval Timer Operation 12.3.3 Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF) Figure 12.6 shows the timing of setting of the OVF flag in TCSR. The OVF flag is set to 1 when TCNT overflows. At the same time, a reset signal is generated in watchdog timer operation, or an interval timer interrupt is generated in interval timer operation. φ TCNT H'FF H'00 Overflow signal OVF Figure 12.6 Timing of Setting of OVF Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 446 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.3.4 Timing of Setting of Watchdog Timer Reset Bit (WRST) The WRST bit in RSTCSR is valid when bits WT/IT and TME are both set to 1 in TCSR. Figure 12.7 shows the timing of setting of WRST and the internal reset timing. The WRST bit is set to 1 when TCNT overflows and OVF is set to 1. At the same time an internal reset signal is generated for the entire chip. This internal reset signal clears OVF to 0, but the WRST bit remains set to 1. The reset routine must therefore clear the WRST bit. φ H'FF TCNT H'00 Overflow signal OVF WDT internal reset WRST Figure 12.7 Timing of Setting of WRST Bit and Internal Reset Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 447 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.4 Interrupts During interval timer operation, an overflow generates an interval timer interrupt (WOVI). The interval timer interrupt is requested whenever the OVF bit is set to 1 in TCSR. 12.5 Usage Notes Contention between TCNT Write and Increment: If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T3 state of a write cycle to TCNT, the write takes priority and the timer count is not incremented. See figure 12.8. Write cycle: CPU writes to TCNT T1 T2 T3 φ TCNT Internal write signal TCNT input clock TCNT N M Counter write data Figure 12.8 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment Changing CKS2 to CKS0 Values: Halt TCNT by clearing the TME bit to 0 in TCSR before changing the values of bits CKS2 to CKS0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 448 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer 12.6 Notes This chip incorporates an WDT. The timer counter value of the on-chip WDT is not rewritten, even if a system crash occurs. If an overflow occurs, a reset signal is generated and the chip is reset. However, if the following three events occur due to a CPU overrun, for example, the above operations cannot be guaranteed since the WDT and the CPU are incorporated in the same chip. • When the internal I/O registers related to the on-chip WDT are rewritten. • When software standby mode is incorrectly entered. • When the break mode is incorrectly entered. In addition, as stated in the NMI above, if an abnormal level is input into the power supply pins or the system control pins, correct operations cannot be guaranteed. Except the above cases, the on-chip WDT functions as a device that supports recovery from a system crash. Accordingly, when a fail-safe function is required in your system, an additional circuit may be required as necessary. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 449 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 12 Watchdog Timer Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 450 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has a serial communication interface (SCI) with two independent channels. The two channels are functionally identical. The SCI can communicate in asynchronous or synchronous mode. It also has a multiprocessor communication function for serial communication among two or more processors. When the SCI is not used, it can be halted to conserve power. Each SCI channel can be halted independently. For details see section 21.6, Module Standby Function. Channel 0 (SCI0) also has a smart card interface function conforming to the ISO/IEC7816-3 (Identification Card) standard. This function supports serial communication with a smart card. For details, see section 14, Smart Card Interface. 13.1.1 Features SCI features are listed below. • Selection of asynchronous or synchronous mode for serial communication Asynchronous mode Serial data communication is synchronized one character at a time. The SCI can communicate with a universal asynchronous receiver/transmitter (UART), asynchronous communication interface adapter (ACIA), or other chip that employs standard asynchronous serial communication. It can also communicate with two or more other processors using the multiprocessor communication function. There are twelve selectable serial data communication formats. • Data length: 7 or 8 bits • Stop bit length: 1 or 2 bits • Parity bit: even, odd, or none • Multiprocessor bit: 1 or 0 • Receive error detection: parity, overrun, and framing errors • Break detection: by reading the RxD level directly when a framing error occurs Synchronous mode Serial data communication is synchronized with a clock signal. The SCI can communicate with other chips having a synchronous communication function. There is one serial data communication format. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 451 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface • Data length: 8 bits • Receive error detection: overrun errors • Full duplex communication The transmitting and receiving sections are independent, so the SCI can transmit and receive simultaneously. The transmitting and receiving sections are both double-buffered, so serial data can be transmitted and received continuously. • Built-in baud rate generator with selectable bit rates • Selectable transmit/receive clock sources: internal clock from baud rate generator, or external clock from the SCK pin. • Four types of interrupts Transmit-data-empty, transmit-end, receive-data-full, and receive-error interrupts are requested independently. The transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts from SCI0 can activate the DMA controller (DMAC) to transfer data. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 452 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.1.2 Block Diagram Bus interface Figure 13.1 shows a block diagram of the SCI. Module data bus RxD RDR TDR RSR TSR SSR SCR SMR BRR Transmit/ receive control TxD SCK Parity generate Parity check Internal data bus Baud rate generator φ φ/4 φ/16 φ/64 Clock External clock TEI TXI RXI ERI Legend RSR: Receive shift register RDR: Receive data register TSR: Transmit shift register TDR: Transmit data register SMR: Serial mode register SCR: Serial control register SSR: Serial status register BRR: Bit rate register Figure 13.1 SCI Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 453 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.1.3 Input/Output Pins The SCI has serial pins for each channel as listed in table 13.1. Table 13.1 SCI Pins Channel Name Abbreviation I/O Function 0 Serial clock pin SCK0 Input/output SCI0 clock input/output Receive data pin RxD0 Input SCI0 receive data input Transmit data pin TxD0 Output SCI0 transmit data output Serial clock pin SCK1 Input/output SCI1 clock input/output Receive data pin RxD1 Input SCI1 receive data input Transmit data pin TxD1 Output SCI1 transmit data output 1 13.1.4 Register Configuration The SCI has internal registers as listed in table 13.2. These registers select asynchronous or synchronous mode, specify the data format and bit rate, and control the transmitter and receiver sections. Table 13.2 Registers Channel Address* 0 1 1 Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFB0 Serial mode register SMR R/W H'00 H'FFB1 Bit rate register BRR R/W H'FF H'FFB2 Serial control register SCR R/W H'00 H'FFB3 Transmit data register TDR R/W H'FFB4 Serial status register SSR R/(W)* H'84 H'FFB5 Receive data register RDR R H'00 H'FFB8 Serial mode register SMR R/W H'00 H'FFB9 Bit rate register BRR R/W H'FF H'FFBA Serial control register SCR R/W H'00 H'FFBB Transmit data register TDR R/W H'FF H'FFBC Serial status register SSR R/(W)* H'84 H'FFBD Receive data register RDR R H'00 Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 454 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 H'FF 2 2 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.2 Register Descriptions 13.2.1 Receive Shift Register (RSR) RSR is the register that receives serial data. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Read/Write — — — — — — — — The SCI loads serial data input at the RxD pin into RSR in the order received, LSB (bit 0) first, thereby converting the data to parallel data. When 1 byte has been received, it is automatically transferred to RDR. The CPU cannot read or write RSR directly. 13.2.2 Receive Data Register (RDR) RDR is the register that stores received serial data. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R R R R R R R R When the SCI finishes receiving 1 byte of serial data, it transfers the received data from RSR into RDR for storage. RSR is then ready to receive the next data. This double buffering allows data to be received continuously. RDR is a read-only register. Its contents cannot be modified by the CPU. RDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 455 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.2.3 Transmit Shift Register (TSR) TSR is the register that transmits serial data. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Read/Write — — — — — — — — The SCI loads transmit data from TDR into TSR, then transmits the data serially from the TxD pin, LSB (bit 0) first. After transmitting one data byte, the SCI automatically loads the next transmit data from TDR into TSR and starts transmitting it. If the TDRE flag is set to 1 in SSR, however, the SCI does not load the TDR contents into TSR. The CPU cannot read or write TSR directly. 13.2.4 Transmit Data Register (TDR) TDR is an 8-bit register that stores data for serial transmission. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W When the SCI detects that TSR is empty, it moves transmit data written in TDR from TDR into TSR and starts serial transmission. Continuous serial transmission is possible by writing the next transmit data in TDR during serial transmission from TSR. The CPU can always read and write TDR. TDR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 456 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.2.5 Serial Mode Register (SMR) SMR is an 8-bit register that specifies the SCI serial communication format and selects the clock source for the baud rate generator. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 C/A CHR PE O/E STOP MP CKS1 CKS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Clock select 1/0 These bits select the baud rate generator’s clock source Multiprocessor mode Selects the multiprocessor function Stop bit length Selects the stop bit length Parity mode Selects even or odd parity Parity enable Selects whether a parity bit is added Character length Selects character length in asynchronous mode Communication mode Selects asynchronous or synchronous mode The CPU can always read and write SMR. SMR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Communication Mode (C/A A): Selects whether the SCI operates in asynchronous or synchronous mode. Bit 7: C/A A Description 0 Asynchronous mode 1 Synchronous mode (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 457 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 6—Character Length (CHR): Selects 7-bit or 8-bit data length in asynchronous mode. In synchronous mode the data length is 8 bits regardless of the CHR setting. Bit 6: CHR Description 0 8-bit data 1 7-bit data* (Initial value) Note: * When 7-bit data is selected, the MSB (bit 7) in TDR is not transmitted. Bit 5—Parity Enable (PE): In asynchronous mode, this bit enables or disables the addition of a parity bit to transmit data, and the checking of the parity bit in receive data. In synchronous mode the parity bit is neither added nor checked, regardless of the PE setting. Bit 5: PE Description 0 Parity bit not added or checked 1 Parity bit added and checked* (Initial value) Note: * When PE is set to 1, an even or odd parity bit is added to transmit data according to the even or odd parity mode selected by the O/E bit, and the parity bit in receive data is checked to see that it matches the even or odd mode selected by the O/E bit. Bit 4—Parity Mode (O/E E): Selects even or odd parity. The O/E bit setting is valid in asynchronous mode when the PE bit is set to 1 to enable the adding and checking of a parity bit. The O/E setting is ignored in synchronous mode, or when parity adding and checking is disabled in asynchronous mode. Bit 4: O/E E Description 0 Even parity* 1 Odd parity* 1 (Initial value) 2 Notes: 1. When even parity is selected, the parity bit added to transmit data makes an even number of 1s in the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data must have an even number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined. 2. When odd parity is selected, the parity bit added to transmit data makes an odd number of 1s in the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data must have an odd number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 458 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 3—Stop Bit Length (STOP): Selects one or two stop bits in asynchronous mode. This setting is used only in asynchronous mode. In synchronous mode no stop bit is added, so the STOP bit setting is ignored. Bit 3: STOP Description 0 One stop bit* 1 1 (Initial value) 2 Two stop bits* Notes: 1. One stop bit (with value 1) is added at the end of each transmitted character. 2. Two stop bits (with value 1) are added at the end of each transmitted character. In receiving, only the first stop bit is checked, regardless of the STOP bit setting. If the second stop bit is 1 it is treated as a stop bit. If the second stop bit is 0 it is treated as the start bit of the next incoming character. Bit 2—Multiprocessor Mode (MP): Selects a multiprocessor format. When a multiprocessor format is selected, parity settings made by the PE and O/E bits are ignored. The MP bit setting is valid only in asynchronous mode. It is ignored in synchronous mode. For further information on the multiprocessor communication function, see section 13.3.3, Multiprocessor Communication. Bit 2: MP Description 0 Multiprocessor function disabled 1 Multiprocessor format selected (Initial value) Bits 1 and 0—Clock Select 1 and 0 (CKS1/0): These bits select the clock source of the on-chip baud rate generator. Four clock sources are available: φ, φ/4, φ/16, and φ/64. For the relationship between the clock source, bit rate register setting, and baud rate, see section 13.2.8, Bit Rate Register (BRR). Bit 1: CKS1 Bit 0: CKS0 Description 0 0 φ 1 φ/4 0 φ/16 1 φ/64 1 (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 459 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.2.6 Serial Control Register (SCR) SCR enables the SCI transmitter and receiver, enables or disables serial clock output in asynchronous mode, enables or disables interrupts, and selects the transmit/receive clock source. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TIE RIE TE RE MPIE TEIE CKE1 CKE0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Clock enable 1/0 These bits select the SCI clock source Transmit-end interrupt enable Enables or disables transmitend interrupts (TEI) Multiprocessor interrupt enable Enables or disables multiprocessor interrupts Receive enable Enables or disables the receiver Transmit enable Enables or disables the transmitter Receive interrupt enable Enables or disables receive-data-full interrupts (RXI) and receive-error interrupts (ERI) Transmit interrupt enable Enables or disables transmit-data-empty interrupts (TXI) The CPU can always read and write SCR. SCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 460 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 7—Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE): Enables or disables the transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) requested when the TDRE flag in SSR is set to 1 due to transfer of serial transmit data from TDR to TSR. Bit 7: TIE Description 0 Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is disabled* 1 Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is enabled (Initial value) Note: * TXI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the value 1 from the TDRE flag, then clearing it to 0; or by clearing the TIE bit to 0. Bit 6—Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE): Enables or disables the receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) requested when the RDRF flag is set to 1 in SSR due to transfer of serial receive data from RSR to RDR; also enables or disables the receive-error interrupt (ERI). Bit 6: RIE Description 0 Receive-data-full (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are disabled* (Initial value) 1 Receive-data-full (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are enabled Note: * RXI and ERI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the value 1 from the RDRF, FER, PER, or ORER flag, then clearing it to 0; or by clearing the RIE bit to 0. Bit 5—Transmit Enable (TE): Enables or disables the start of SCI serial transmitting operations. Bit 5: TE Description 0 Transmitting disabled* 1 2 Transmitting enabled* 1 (Initial value) Notes: 1. The TDRE bit is locked at 1 in SSR. 2. In the enabled state, serial transmitting starts when the TDRE bit in SSR is cleared to 0 after writing of transmit data into TDR. Select the transmit format in SMR before setting the TE bit to 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 461 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 4—Receive Enable (RE): Enables or disables the start of SCI serial receiving operations. Bit 4: RE Description 0 Receiving disabled* 1 2 1 (Initial value) Receiving enabled* Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 does not affect the RDRF, FER, PER, and ORER flags. These flags retain their previous values. 2. In the enabled state, serial receiving starts when a start bit is detected in asynchronous mode, or serial clock input is detected in synchronous mode. Select the receive format in SMR before setting the RE bit to 1. Bit 3—Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (MPIE): Enables or disables multiprocessor interrupts. The MPIE setting is valid only in asynchronous mode, and only if the MP bit is set to 1 in SMR. The MPIE setting is ignored in synchronous mode or when the MP bit is cleared to 0. Bit 3: MPIE Description 0 Multiprocessor interrupts are disabled (normal receive operation) (Initial value) [Clearing conditions] The MPIE bit is cleared to 0. MPB = 1 in received data. 1 Multiprocessor interrupts are enabled* Receive-data-full interrupts (RXI), receive-error interrupts (ERI), and setting of the RDRF, FER, and ORER status flags in SSR are disabled until data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1 is received. Note: * The SCI does not transfer receive data from RSR to RDR, does not detect receive errors, and does not set the RDRF, FER, and ORER flags in SSR. When it receives data in which MPB = 1, the SCI sets the MPB bit to 1 in SSR, automatically clears the MPIE bit to 0, enables RXI and ERI interrupts (if the RIE bit is set to 1 in SCR), and allows the FER and ORER flags to be set. Bit 2—Transmit-End Interrupt Enable (TEIE): Enables or disables the transmit-end interrupt (TEI) requested if TDR does not contain new transmit data when the MSB is transmitted. Bit 2: TEIE Description 0 Transmit-end interrupt requests (TEI) are disabled* 1 Transmit-end interrupt requests (TEI) are enabled* (Initial value) Note: * TEI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the value 1 from the TDRE flag in SSR, then clearing the TDRE flag to 0, thereby also clearing the TEND flag to 0; or by clearing the TEIE bit to 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 462 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bits 1 and 0—Clock Enable 1 and 0 (CKE1/0): These bits select the SCI clock source and enable or disable clock output from the SCK pin. Depending on the settings of CKE1 and CKE0, the SCK pin can be used for generic input/output, serial clock output, or serial clock input. The CKE0 setting is valid only in asynchronous mode, and only when the SCI is internally clocked (CKE1 = 0). The CKE0 setting is ignored in synchronous mode, or when an external clock source is selected (CKE1 = 1). Select the SCI operating mode in SMR before setting the CKE1 and CKE0 bits. For further details on selection of the SCI clock source, see table 13.9 in section 13.3, Operation. Bit 1: CKE1 Bit 0: CKE0 Description 0 0 Asynchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin available for generic 1 input/output * Synchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for serial clock output * Asynchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for clock output* Synchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for serial clock output 0 Asynchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for clock input * Synchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for serial clock input 1 Asynchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for clock input * Synchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for serial clock input 1 1 1 2 3 3 Notes: 1. Initial value 2. The output clock frequency is the same as the bit rate. 3. The input clock frequency is 16 times the bit rate. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 463 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.2.7 Serial Status Register (SSR) SSR is an 8-bit register containing multiprocessor bit values, and status flags that indicate SCI operating status. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TDRE RDRF ORER FER PER TEND MPB MPBT Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 Read/Write R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R R R/W Multiprocessor bit transfer Value of multiprocessor bit to be transmitted Multiprocessor bit Stores the received multiprocessor bit value Transmit end Status flag indicating end of transmission Parity error Status flag indicating detection of a receive parity error Framing error Status flag indicating detection of a receive framing error Overrun error Status flag indicating detection of a receive overrun error Receive data register full Status flag indicating that data has been received and stored in RDR Transmit data register empty Status flag indicating that transmit data has been transferred from TDR into TSR and new data can be written in TDR Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. The CPU can always read and write SSR, but cannot write 1 in the TDRE, RDRF, ORER, PER, and FER flags. These flags can be cleared to 0 only if they have first been read while set to 1. The TEND and MPB flags are read-only bits that cannot be written. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 464 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface SSR is initialized to H'84 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Transmit Data Register Empty (TDRE): Indicates that the SCI has loaded transmit data from TDR into TSR and the next serial transmit data can be written in TDR. Bit 7: TDRE Description 0 TDR contains valid transmit data [Clearing conditions] Software reads TDRE while it is set to 1, then writes 0. The DMAC writes data in TDR. 1 TDR does not contain valid transmit data (Initial value) [Setting conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. The TE bit in SCR is cleared to 0. TDR contents are loaded into TSR, so new data can be written in TDR. Bit 6—Receive Data Register Full (RDRF): Indicates that RDR contains new receive data. Bit 6: RDRF Description 0 RDR does not contain new receive data (Initial value) [Clearing conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. Software reads RDRF while it is set to 1, then writes 0. The DMAC reads data from RDR. 1 RDR contains new receive data [Setting condition] When serial data is received normally and transferred from RSR to RDR. Note: The RDR contents and RDRF flag are not affected by detection of receive errors or by clearing of the RE bit to 0 in SCR. They retain their previous values. If the RDRF flag is still set to 1 when reception of the next data ends, an overrun error occurs and receive data is lost. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 465 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 5—Overrun Error (ORER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to an overrun error. Bit 5: ORER Description 0 Receiving is in progress or has ended normally 1 (Initial value)* [Clearing conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. Software reads ORER while it is set to 1, then writes 0. 1 2 A receive overrun error occurred* [Setting condition] Reception of the next serial data ends when RDRF = 1. Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the ORER flag, which retains its previous value. 2. RDR continues to hold the receive data before the overrun error, so subsequent receive data is lost. Serial receiving cannot continue while the ORER flag is set to 1. In synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled. Bit 4—Framing Error (FER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to a framing error in asynchronous mode. Bit 4: FER Description 0 Receiving is in progress or has ended normally 1 (Initial value)* [Clearing conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. Software reads FER while it is set to 1, then writes 0. 1 2 A receive framing error occurred* [Setting condition] The stop bit at the end of receive data is checked and found to be 0. Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the FER flag, which retains its previous value. 2. When the stop bit length is 2 bits, only the first bit is checked. The second stop bit is not checked. When a framing error occurs the SCI transfers the receive data into RDR but does not set the RDRF flag. Serial receiving cannot continue while the FER flag is set to 1. In synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 466 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 3—Parity Error (PER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to a parity error in asynchronous mode. Bit 3: PER Description 0 Receiving is in progress or has ended normally* 1 (Initial value) [Clearing conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. Software reads PER while it is set to 1, then writes 0. 1 2 A receive parity error occurred* [Setting condition] The number of 1s in receive data, including the parity bit, does not match the even or odd parity setting of O/E in SMR. Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the PER flag, which retains its previous value. 2. When a parity error occurs the SCI transfers the receive data into RDR but does not set the RDRF flag. Serial receiving cannot continue while the PER flag is set to 1. In synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled. Bit 2—Transmit End (TEND): Indicates that when the last bit of a serial character was transmitted TDR did not contain new transmit data, so transmission has ended. The TEND flag is a read-only bit and cannot be written. Bit 2: TEND Description 0 Transmission is in progress [Clearing conditions] Software reads TDRE while it is set to 1, then writes 0 in the TDRE flag. The DMAC writes data in TDR. 1 End of transmission (Initial value) [Setting conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. The TE bit is cleared to 0 in SCR. TDRE is 1 when the last bit of a serial character is transmitted. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 467 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Bit 1—Multiprocessor Bit (MPB): Stores the value of the multiprocessor bit in receive data when a multiprocessor format is used in asynchronous mode. MPB is a read-only bit and cannot be written. Bit 1: MPB Description 0 Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 0* 1 Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 1 (Initial value) Note: * If the RE bit is cleared to 0 when a multiprocessor format is selected, MPB retains its previous value. Bit 0—Multiprocessor Bit Transfer (MPBT): Stores the value of the multiprocessor bit added to transmit data when a multiprocessor format is selected for transmitting in asynchronous mode. The MPBT setting is ignored in synchronous mode, when a multiprocessor format is not selected, or when the SCI is not transmitting. Bit 0: MPBT Description 0 Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 0 1 Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 1 13.2.8 (Initial value) Bit Rate Register (BRR) BRR is an 8-bit register that, together with the CKS1 and CKS0 bits in SMR that select the baud rate generator clock source, determines the serial communication bit rate. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W The CPU can always read and write BRR. BRR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby mode. The two SCI channels have independent baud rate generator control, so different values can be set in the two channels. Table 13.3 shows examples of BRR settings in asynchronous mode. Table 13.4 shows examples of BRR settings in synchronous mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 468 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Table 13.3 Examples of Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Asynchronous Mode φ (MHz) 2 2.097152 2.4576 3 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 1 141 0.03 1 148 –0.04 1 174 –0.26 1 212 0.03 150 1 103 0.16 1 108 0.21 1 127 0.00 1 155 0.16 300 0 207 0.16 0 217 0.21 0 255 0.00 1 77 0.16 600 0 103 0.16 0 108 0.21 0 127 0.00 0 155 0.16 1200 0 51 0.16 0 54 –0.70 0 63 0.00 0 77 0.16 2400 0 25 0.16 0 26 1.14 0 31 0.00 0 38 0.16 4800 0 12 0.16 0 13 –2.48 0 15 0.00 0 19 –2.34 9600 0 6 –6.99 0 6 –2.48 0 7 0.00 0 9 –2.34 19200 0 2 8.51 0 2 13.78 0 3 0.00 0 4 –2.34 31250 0 1 0.00 0 1 4.86 0 1 22.88 0 2 0.00 38400 0 1 –18.62 0 1 –14.67 0 1 0.00 — — — φ (MHz) 3.6864 4 4.9152 5 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 64 0.70 2 70 0.03 2 86 0.31 2 88 –0.25 150 1 191 0.00 1 207 0.16 1 255 0.00 2 64 0.16 300 1 95 0.00 1 103 0.16 1 127 0.00 1 129 0.16 600 0 191 0.00 0 207 0.16 0 255 0.00 1 64 0.16 1200 0 95 0.00 0 103 0.16 0 127 0.00 0 129 0.16 2400 0 47 0.00 0 51 0.16 0 63 0.00 0 64 0.16 4800 0 23 0.00 0 25 0.16 0 31 0.00 0 32 –1.36 9600 0 11 0.00 0 12 0.16 0 15 0.00 0 15 1.73 19200 0 5 0.00 0 6 –6.99 0 7 0.00 0 7 1.73 31250 — — — 0 3 0.00 0 4 –1.70 0 4 0.00 38400 0 2 0.00 0 2 8.51 0 3 0.00 0 3 1.73 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 469 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface φ (MHz) 6 6.144 7.3728 8 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 106 –0.44 2 108 0.08 2 130 –0.07 2 141 0.03 150 2 77 0.16 2 79 0.00 2 95 0.00 2 103 0.16 300 1 155 0.16 1 159 0.00 1 191 0.00 1 207 0.16 600 1 77 0.16 1 79 0.00 1 95 0.00 1 103 0.16 1200 0 155 0.16 0 159 0.00 0 191 0.00 0 207 0.16 2400 0 77 0.16 0 79 0.00 0 95 0.00 0 103 0.16 4800 0 38 0.16 0 39 0.00 0 47 0.00 0 51 0.16 9600 0 19 –2.34 0 19 0.00 0 23 0.00 0 25 0.16 19200 0 9 –2.34 0 9 0.00 0 11 0.00 0 12 0.16 31250 0 5 0.00 0 5 2.40 0 6 5.33 0 7 0.00 38400 0 4 –2.34 0 4 0.00 0 5 0.00 0 6 –6.99 φ (MHz) 9.8304 10 12 12.288 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 174 –0.26 2 177 –0.25 2 212 0.03 2 217 0.08 150 2 127 0.00 2 129 0.16 2 155 0.16 2 159 0.00 300 1 255 0.00 2 64 0.16 2 77 0.16 2 79 0.00 600 1 127 0.00 1 129 0.16 1 155 0.16 1 159 0.00 1200 0 255 0.00 1 64 0.16 1 77 0.16 1 79 0.00 2400 0 127 0.00 0 129 0.16 0 155 0.16 0 159 0.00 4800 0 63 0.00 0 64 0.16 0 77 0.16 0 79 0.00 9600 0 31 0.00 0 32 –1.36 0 38 0.16 0 39 0.00 19200 0 15 0.00 0 15 1.73 0 19 –2.34 0 19 0.00 31250 0 9 –1.70 0 9 0.00 0 11 0.00 0 11 2.40 38400 0 7 0.00 0 7 1.73 0 9 –2.34 0 9 0.00 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 470 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface φ (MHz) 13 14 14.7456 16 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) n N Error (%) 110 2 230 –0.08 2 248 –0.17 3 64 0.70 3 70 0.03 150 2 168 0.16 2 181 0.16 2 191 0.00 2 207 0.16 300 2 84 –0.43 2 90 0.16 2 95 0.00 2 103 0.16 600 1 168 0.16 1 181 0.16 1 191 0.00 1 207 0.16 1200 1 84 –0.43 1 90 0.16 1 95 0.00 1 103 0.16 2400 0 168 0.16 0 181 0.16 0 191 0.00 0 207 0.16 4800 0 84 –0.43 0 90 0.16 0 95 0.00 0 103 0.16 9600 0 41 0.76 0 45 –0.93 0 47 0.00 0 51 0.16 19200 0 20 0.76 0 22 –0.93 0 23 0.00 0 25 0.16 31250 0 12 0.00 0 13 0.00 0 14 –1.70 0 15 0.00 38400 0 10 –3.82 0 10 3.57 0 11 0.00 0 12 0.16 n N Error (%) φ (MHz) 18 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N Error (%) 110 3 79 –0.12 150 2 233 0.16 300 2 116 0.16 600 1 233 0.16 1200 1 116 0.16 2400 0 233 0.16 4800 0 116 0.16 9600 0 58 –0.69 19200 0 28 1.02 31250 0 17 0.00 38400 0 14 –2.34 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 471 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Table 13.4 Examples of Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Synchronous Mode φ (MHz) 2 4 8 10 13 16 18 Bit Rate (bits/s) n N n N n N n N n N n N n N 110 3 70 — — — — — — — — — — — — 250 2 124 2 249 3 124 — — 3 202 3 249 — — 500 1 249 2 124 2 249 — — 3 101 3 124 3 140 1k 1 124 1 249 2 124 — — 2 202 2 249 3 69 2.5 k 0 199 1 99 1 199 1 249 2 80 2 99 2 112 5k 0 99 0 199 1 99 1 124 1 162 1 199 1 224 10 k 0 49 0 99 0 199 0 249 1 80 1 99 1 112 25 k 0 19 0 39 0 79 0 99 0 129 0 159 0 179 50 k 0 9 0 19 0 39 0 49 0 64 0 79 0 89 100 k 0 4 0 9 0 19 0 24 — — 0 39 0 44 250 k 0 1 0 3 0 7 0 9 0 12 0 15 0 17 500 k 0 0* 0 1 0 3 0 4 — — 0 7 0 8 0 0* 1M 0 1 — — — — 0 3 0 4 2M 0 0* — — — — 0 1 — — 2.5 M — — 0 0* — — — — — — 0 0* — — 4M Note: Settings with an error of 1% or less are recommended. Legend Blank: No setting available —: Setting possible, but error occurs *: Continuous transmit/receive not possible Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 472 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface The BRR setting is calculated as follows: Asynchronous mode: N= φ 64 × 22n–1 ×B × 106 – 1 Synchronous mode: N= B: N: φ: n: φ 8 × 22n–1 × B × 106 – 1 Bit rate (bits/s) BRR setting for baud rate generator (0 ≤ N ≤ 255) System clock frequency (MHz) Baud rate generator clock source (n = 0, 1, 2, 3) (For the clock sources and values of n, see the following table.) SMR Settings n Clock Source CKS1 CKS0 0 φ 0 0 1 φ/4 0 1 2 φ/16 1 0 3 φ/64 1 1 The bit rate error in asynchronous mode is calculated as follows. Error (%) = φ × 106 (N + 1) × B × 64 × 22n–1 – 1 × 100 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 473 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Table 13.5 indicates the maximum bit rates in asynchronous mode for various system clock frequencies. Tables 13.6 and 13.7 indicate the maximum bit rates with external clock input. Table 13.5 Maximum Bit Rates for Various Frequencies (Asynchronous Mode) Settings φ (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s) n N 2 62500 0 0 2.097152 65536 0 0 2.4576 76800 0 0 3 93750 0 0 3.6864 115200 0 0 4 125000 0 0 4.9152 153600 0 0 5 156250 0 0 6 187500 0 0 6.144 192000 0 0 7.3728 230400 0 0 8 250000 0 0 9.8304 307200 0 0 10 312500 0 0 12 375000 0 0 12.288 384000 0 0 14 437500 0 0 14.7456 460800 0 0 16 500000 0 0 17.2032 537600 0 0 18 562500 0 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 474 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Table 13.6 Maximum Bit Rates with External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode) φ (MHz) External Input Clock (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s) 2 0.5000 31250 2.097152 0.5243 32768 2.4576 0.6144 38400 3 0.7500 46875 3.6864 0.9216 57600 4 1.0000 62500 4.9152 1.2288 76800 5 1.2500 78125 6 1.5000 93750 6.144 1.5360 96000 7.3728 1.8432 115200 8 2.0000 125000 9.8304 2.4576 153600 10 2.5000 156250 12 3.0000 187500 12.288 3.0720 192000 14 3.5000 218750 14.7456 3.6864 230400 16 4.0000 250000 17.2032 4.3008 268800 18 4.5000 281250 Table 13.7 Maximum Bit Rates with External Clock Input (Synchronous Mode) φ (MHz) External Input Clock (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s) 2 0.3333 333333.3 4 0.6667 666666.7 6 1.0000 1000000.0 8 1.3333 1333333.3 10 1.6667 1666666.7 12 2.0000 2000000.0 14 2.3333 2333333.3 16 2.6667 2666666.7 18 3.0000 3000000.0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 475 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.3 Operation 13.3.1 Overview The SCI has an asynchronous mode in which characters are synchronized individually, and a synchronous mode in which communication is synchronized with clock pulses. Serial communication is possible in either mode. Asynchronous or synchronous mode and the communication format are selected in SMR, as shown in table 13.8. The SCI clock source is selected by the C/A bit in SMR and the CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR, as shown in table 13.9. Asynchronous Mode • Data length is selectable: 7 or 8 bits. • Parity and multiprocessor bits are selectable. So is the stop bit length (1 or 2 bits). These selections determine the communication format and character length. • In receiving, it is possible to detect framing errors, parity errors, overrun errors, and the break state. • An internal or external clock can be selected as the SCI clock source. When an internal clock is selected, the SCI operates using the on-chip baud rate generator, and can output a serial clock signal with a frequency matching the bit rate. When an external clock is selected, the external clock input must have a frequency 16 times the bit rate. (The on-chip baud rate generator is not used.) Synchronous Mode • The communication format has a fixed 8-bit data length. • In receiving, it is possible to detect overrun errors. • An internal or external clock can be selected as the SCI clock source. When an internal clock is selected, the SCI operates using the on-chip baud rate generator, and outputs a serial clock signal to external devices. When an external clock is selected, the SCI operates on the input serial clock. The on-chip baud rate generator is not used. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 476 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Table 13.8 SMR Settings and Serial Communication Formats SMR Settings SCI Communication Format Bit 7: Bit 6: Bit 2: Bit 5: Bit 3: C/A A CHR MP PE STOP Mode 0 0 0 0 Asynchronous mode 0 1 1 Data Length Multiprocessor Parity Bit Bit Stop Bit Length 8-bit data Absent 1 bit Absent 2 bits 0 Present 1 1 0 2 bits 0 7-bit data Absent 1 1 1 — 0 Present 0 0 Asynchronous mode (multiprocessor format) 8-bit data Synchronous mode 8-bit data Present Absent — — — 1 bit 2 bits 7-bit data 1 bit 1 1 1 bit 2 bits 1 1 1 bit 2 bits 1 0 1 bit 2 bits — Absent None Table 13.9 SMR and SCR Settings and SCI Clock Source Selection SMR SCR Settings Bit 7: C/A A Bit 1: CKE1 Bit 0: CKE0 0 0 0 1 1 SCI Transmit/Receive Clock Mode Asynchronous mode 0 Clock Source SCK Pin Function Internal SCI does not use the SCK pin Outputs a clock with frequency matching the bit rate External Inputs a clock with frequency 16 times the bit rate Internal Outputs the serial clock External Inputs the serial clock 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 Synchronous mode 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 477 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.3.2 Operation in Asynchronous Mode In asynchronous mode each transmitted or received character begins with a start bit and ends with a stop bit. Serial communication is synchronized one character at a time. The transmitting and receiving sections of the SCI are independent, so full duplex communication is possible. The transmitter and receiver are both double buffered, so data can be written and read while transmitting and receiving are in progress, enabling continuous transmitting and receiving. Figure 13.2 shows the general format of asynchronous serial communication. In asynchronous serial communication the communication line is normally held in the mark (high) state. The SCI monitors the line and starts serial communication when the line goes to the space (low) state, indicating a start bit. One serial character consists of a start bit (low), data (LSB first), parity bit (high or low), and stop bit (high), in that order. When receiving in asynchronous mode, the SCI synchronizes at the falling edge of the start bit. The SCI samples each data bit on the eighth pulse of a clock with a frequency 16 times the bit rate. Receive data is latched at the center of each bit. 1 Serial data (LSB) 0 D0 Idle (mark) state 1 (MSB) D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 Start bit Transmit or receive data 1 bit 7 bits or 8 bits D6 D7 0/1 Parity bit 1 Stop bit 1 bit or 1 bit or no bit 2 bits One unit of data (character or frame) Figure 13.2 Data Format in Asynchronous Communication (Example: 8-Bit Data with Parity and 2 Stop Bits) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 478 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 1 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Communication Formats: Table 13.10 shows the 12 communication formats that can be selected in asynchronous mode. The format is selected by settings in SMR. Table 13.10 Serial Communication Formats (Asynchronous Mode) SMR Settings Serial Communication Format and Frame Length CHR PE MP STOP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 0 0 0 0 S 8-bit data STOP 0 0 0 1 S 8-bit data STOP STOP 0 1 0 0 S 8-bit data P STOP 0 1 0 1 S 8-bit data P STOP STOP 1 0 0 0 S 7-bit data STOP 1 0 0 1 S 7-bit data STOP STOP 1 1 0 0 S 7-bit data P STOP 1 1 0 1 S 7-bit data P STOP STOP 0 — 1 0 S 8-bit data MPB STOP 0 — 1 1 S 8-bit data MPB STOP STOP 1 — 1 0 S 7-bit data MPB STOP 1 — 1 1 S 7-bit data MPB STOP STOP Legend S: Start bit STOP: Stop bit P: Parity bit MPB: Multiprocessor bit Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 479 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Clock: An internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input from the SCK pin can be selected as the SCI transmit/receive clock. The clock source is selected by the C/A bit in SMR and bits CKE1 and CKE0 in SCR. See table 13.9. When an external clock is input at the SCK pin, it must have a frequency equal to 16 times the desired bit rate. When the SCI operates on an internal clock, it can output a clock signal at the SCK pin. The frequency of this output clock is equal to the bit rate. The phase is aligned as in figure 13.3 so that the rising edge of the clock occurs at the center of each transmit data bit. 0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 0/1 1 1 1 frame Figure 13.3 Phase Relationship between Output Clock and Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode) Transmitting and Receiving Data • SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode) Before transmitting or receiving, clear the TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR, then initialize the SCI as follows. When changing the communication mode or format, always clear the TE and RE bits to 0 before following the procedure given below. Clearing TE to 0 sets the TDRE flag to 1 and initializes TSR. Clearing RE to 0, however, does not initialize the RDRF, PER, FER, and ORER flags and RDR, which retain their previous contents. When an external clock is used, the clock should not be stopped during initialization or subsequent operation. SCI operation becomes unreliable if the clock is stopped. Figure 13.4 is a sample flowchart for initializing the SCI. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 480 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Start of initialization Clear TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR (leaving TE and RE bits cleared to 0) 1 Select communication format in SMR 2 Set value in BRR 3 1. Select the clock source in SCR. Clear the RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, TE, and RE bits to 0. If clock output is selected in asynchronous mode, clock output starts immediately after the setting is made in SCR. 2. Select the communication format in SMR. 3. Write the value corresponding to the bit rate in BRR. This step is not necessary when an external clock is used. 4. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive 1 bit, then set the TE or RE bit to 1 in SCR. Set the RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits as necessary. Setting the TE or RE bit enables the SCI to use the TxD or RxD pin. Wait 1 bit interval elapsed? No Yes Set TE or RE bit to 1 in SCR Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits as necessary 4 Transmitting or receiving Figure 13.4 Sample Flowchart for SCI Initialization Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 481 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface • Transmitting Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode) Figure 13.5 shows a sample flowchart for transmitting serial data and indicates the procedure to follow. 1 Initialize Start transmitting 2 Read TDRE flag in SSR No TDRE = 1? Yes Write transmit data in TDR and clear TDRE flag to 0 in SSR All data transmitted? No 1. SCI initialization: the transmit data output function of the TxD pin is selected automatically. 2. SCI status check and transmit data write: read SSR, check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write transmit data in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. 3. To continue transmitting serial data: after checking that the TDRE flag is 1, indicating that data can be written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE flag to 0. When the DMAC is activated by a transmitdata-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the TDRE flag is checked and cleared automatically. 4. To output a break signal at the end of serial transmission: set the DDR bit to 1 and clear the DR bit to 0 (DDR and DR are I/O port registers), then clear the TE bit to 0 in SCR. 3 Yes Read TEND flag in SSR TEND = 1? No Yes Output break signal? No 4 Yes Clear DR bit to 0, set DDR bit to 1 Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR End Figure 13.5 Sample Flowchart for Transmitting Serial Data Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 482 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows. 1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. When the TDRE flag is cleared to 0 the SCI recognizes that TDR contains new data, and loads this data from TDR into TSR. 2. After loading the data from TDR into TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts transmitting. If the TIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, the SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) at this time. Serial transmit data is transmitted in the following order from the TxD pin: a. Start bit: One 0 bit is output. b. Transmit data: 7 or 8 bits are output, LSB first. c. Parity bit or multiprocessor bit: One parity bit (even or odd parity) or one multiprocessor bit is output. Formats in which neither a parity bit nor a multiprocessor bit is output can also be selected. d. Stop bit: One or two 1 bits (stop bits) are output. e. Mark state: Output of 1 bits continues until the start bit of the next transmit data. 3. The SCI checks the TDRE flag when it outputs the stop bit. If the TDRE flag is 0, the SCI loads new data from TDR into TSR, outputs the stop bit, then begins serial transmission of the next frame. If the TDRE flag is 1, the SCI sets the TEND flag to 1 in SSR, outputs the stop bit, then continues output of 1 bits in the mark state. If the TEIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, a transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time. Figure 13.6 shows an example of SCI transmit operation in asynchronous mode. 1 Start bit 0 Parity Stop Start bit bit bit Data D0 D1 D7 0/1 1 0 Parity Stop bit bit Data D0 D1 D7 0/1 1 1 Idle (mark) state TDRE TEND TXI interrupt request TXI interrupt handler writes data in TDR and clears TDRE flag to 0 TXI interrupt request TEI interrupt request 1 frame Figure 13.6 Example of SCI Transmit Operation in Asynchronous Mode (8-Bit Data with Parity and 1 Stop Bit) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 483 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface • Receiving Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode) Figure 13.7 shows a sample flowchart for receiving serial data and indicates the procedure to follow. 1 Initialize Start receiving Read ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR PER ∨ FER ∨ ORER = 1? 2 Yes 3 No Error handling (continued on next page) Read RDRF flag in SSR 4 No RDRF = 1? 1. SCI initialization: the receive data function of the RxD pin is selected automatically. 2, 3. Receive error handling and break detection: if a receive error occurs, read the ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR to identify the error. After executing the necessary error handling, clear the ORER, PER, and FER flags all to 0. Receiving cannot resume if any of the ORER, PER, and FER flags remains set to 1. When a framing error occurs, the RxD pin can be read to detect the break state. 4. SCI status check and receive data read: read SSR, check that RDRF is set to 1, then read receive data from RDR and clear the RDRF flag to 0. Notification that the RDRF flag has changed from 0 to 1 can also be given by the RXI interrupt. 5. To continue receiving serial data: check the RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear the RDRF flag to 0 before the stop bit of the current frame is received. If the DMAC is activated by an RXI interrupt to read the RDR value, the RDRF flag is cleared automatically. Yes Read receive data from RDR, and clear RDRF flag to 0 in SSR No Finished receiving? 5 Yes Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR End Figure 13.7 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Serial Data (1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 484 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 3 Error handling No ORER = 1? Yes Overrun error handling No FER = 1? Yes Break? Yes No Framing error handling Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR No PER = 1? Yes Parity error handling Clear ORER, PER, and FER flags to 0 in SSR End Figure 13.7 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Serial Data (2) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 485 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface In receiving, the SCI operates as follows. 1. The SCI monitors the receive data line. When it detects a start bit, the SCI synchronizes internally and starts receiving. 2. Receive data is stored in RSR in order from LSB to MSB. 3. The parity bit and stop bit are received. After receiving, the SCI makes the following checks: a. Parity check: The number of 1s in the receive data must match the even or odd parity setting of the O/E bit in SMR. b. Stop bit check: The stop bit value must be 1. If there are two stop bits, only the first stop bit is checked. c. Status check: The RDRF flag must be 0 so that receive data can be transferred from RSR into RDR. If these checks all pass, the RDRF flag is set to 1 and the received data is stored in RDR. If one of the checks fails (receive error), the SCI operates as indicated in table 13.11. Note: When a receive error occurs, further receiving is disabled. In receiving, the RDRF flag is not set to 1. Be sure to clear the error flags to 0. 4. When the RDRF flag is set to 1, if the RIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, a receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) is requested. If the ORER, PER, or FER flag is set to 1 and the RIE bit in SCR is also set to 1, a receive-error interrupt (ERI) is requested. Table 13.11 Receive Error Conditions Receive Error Abbreviation Condition Data Transfer Overrun error ORER Receiving of next data ends while RDRF flag is still set to 1 in SSR Receive data not transferred from RSR to RDR Framing error FER Stop bit is 0 Receive data transferred from RSR to RDR Parity error PER Parity of receive data differs from even/odd parity setting in SMR Receive data transferred from RSR to RDR Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 486 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Figure 13.8 shows an example of SCI receive operation in asynchronous mode. 1 Start bit 0 Parity Stop Start bit bit bit Data D0 D1 D7 0/1 1 0 Parity Stop bit bit Data D0 D1 D7 0/1 1 1 Idle (mark) state RDRF FER RXI request 1 frame RXI interrupt handler reads data in RDR and clears RDRF flag to 0 Framing error, ERI request Figure 13.8 Example of SCI Receive Operation (8-Bit Data with Parity and One Stop Bit) 13.3.3 Multiprocessor Communication The multiprocessor communication function enables several processors to share a single serial communication line. The processors communicate in asynchronous mode using a format with an additional multiprocessor bit (multiprocessor format). In multiprocessor communication, each receiving processor is addressed by an ID. A serial communication cycle consists of an ID-sending cycle that identifies the receiving processor, and a data-sending cycle. The multiprocessor bit distinguishes ID-sending cycles from data-sending cycles. The transmitting processor starts by sending the ID of the receiving processor with which it wants to communicate as data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. Next the transmitting processor sends transmit data with the multiprocessor bit cleared to 0. Receiving processors skip incoming data until they receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. When they receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1, receiving processors compare the data with their IDs. The receiving processor with a matching ID continues to receive further incoming data. Processors with IDs not matching the received data skip further incoming data until they again receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. Multiple processors can send and receive data in this way. Figure 13.9 shows an example of communication among different processors using a multiprocessor format. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 487 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Communication Formats: Four formats are available. Parity-bit settings are ignored when a multiprocessor format is selected. For details see table 13.10. Clock: See the description of asynchronous mode. Transmitting processor Serial communication line Receiving processor A Receiving processor B Receiving processor C Receiving processor D (ID = 01) (ID = 02) (ID = 03) (ID = 04) H'01 Serial data (MPB = 1) ID-sending cycle: receiving processor address H'AA (MPB = 0) Data-sending cycle: data sent to receiving processor specified by ID Legend MPB: Multiprocessor bit Figure 13.9 Example of Communication among Processors using Multiprocessor Format (Sending Data H'AA to Receiving Processor A) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 488 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Transmitting and Receiving Data • Transmitting Multiprocessor Serial Data Figure 13.10 shows a sample flowchart for transmitting multiprocessor serial data and indicates the procedure to follow. 1 Initialize Start transmitting 2 Read TDRE flag in SSR TDRE = 1? No Yes Write transmit data in TDR and set MPBT bit in SSR Clear TDRE flag to 0 All data transmitted? No 3 Yes 1. SCI initialization: the transmit data output function of the TxD pin is selected automatically. 2. SCI status check and transmit data write: read SSR, check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write transmit data in TDR. Also set the MPBT flag to 0 or 1 in SSR. Finally, clear the TDRE flag to 0. 3. To continue transmitting serial data: after checking that the TDRE flag is 1, indicating that data can be written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE flag to 0. When the DMAC is activated by a transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the TDRE flag is checked and cleared automatically. 4. To output a break signal at the end of serial transmission: set the DDR bit to 1 and clear the DR bit to 0 (DDR and DR are I/O port registers), then clear the TE bit to 0 in SCR. Read TEND flag in SSR TEND = 1? No Yes Output break signal? No 4 Yes Clear DR bit to 0, set DDR bit to 1 Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR End Figure 13.10 Sample Flowchart for Transmitting Multiprocessor Serial Data Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 489 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows. 1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. When the TDRE flag is cleared to 0 the SCI recognizes that TDR contains new data, and loads this data from TDR into TSR. 2. After loading the data from TDR into TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts transmitting. If the TIE bit in SCR is set to 1, the SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) at this time. Serial transmit data is transmitted in the following order from the TxD pin: a. Start bit: One 0 bit is output. b. Transmit data: 7 or 8 bits are output, LSB first. c. Multiprocessor bit: One multiprocessor bit (MPBT value) is output. d. Stop bit: One or two 1 bits (stop bits) are output. e. Mark state: Output of 1 bits continues until the start bit of the next transmit data. 3. The SCI checks the TDRE flag when it outputs the stop bit. If the TDRE flag is 0, the SCI loads data from TDR into TSR, outputs the stop bit, then begins serial transmission of the next frame. If the TDRE flag is 1, the SCI sets the TEND flag in SSR to 1, outputs the stop bit, then continues output of 1 bits in the mark state. If the TEIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, a transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time. Figure 13.11 shows an example of SCI transmit operation using a multiprocessor format. Multiprocessor bit 1 Start bit 0 Stop Start bit bit Data D0 D1 Multiprocessor bit D7 0/1 1 0 Stop bit Data D0 D1 D7 0/1 1 TDRE TEND TXI request TXI interrupt handler writes data in TDR and clears TDRE flag to 0 TXI request TEI request 1 frame Figure 13.11 Example of SCI Transmit Operation (8-Bit Data with Multiprocessor Bit and One Stop Bit) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 490 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 1 Idle (mark) state Section 13 Serial Communication Interface • Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data Figure 13.12 shows a sample flowchart for receiving multiprocessor serial data and indicates the procedure to follow. Initialize 1. SCI initialization: the receive data function of the RxD pin is selected automatically. 2. ID receive cycle: set the MPIE bit to 1 in SCR. 3. SCI status check and ID check: read SSR, check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read data from RDR and compare with the processor’s own ID. If the ID does not match, set the MPIE bit to 1 again and clear the RDRF flag to 0. If the ID matches, clear the RDRF flag to 0. 4. SCI status check and data receiving: read SSR, check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read data from RDR. 5. Receive error handling and break detection: if a receive error occurs, read the ORER and FER flags in SSR to identify the error. After executing the necessary error handling, clear the ORER and FER flags both to 0. Receiving cannot resume while either the ORER or FER flag remains set to 1. When a framing error occurs, the RxD pin can be read to detect the break state. 1 Start receiving Set MPIE bit to 1 in SCR 2 Read ORER and FER flags in SSR FER ∨ ORER = 1 Yes No Read RDRF flag in SSR 3 No RDRF = 1? Yes Read receive data from RDR No Own ID? Yes Read ORER and FER flags in SSR FER ∨ ORER = 1 Yes No Read RDRF flag in SSR 4 No RDRF = 1? Yes Read receive data from RDR No No Finished receiving? Yes 5 Error handling (continued on next page) Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR End Figure 13.12 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data (1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 491 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 5 Error handling No ORER = 1? Yes Overrun error handling No FER = 1? Yes Break? Yes No Framing error handling Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR Clear ORER, PER, and FER flags to 0 in SSR End Figure 13.12 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data (2) Figure 13.13 shows an example of SCI receive operation using a multiprocessor format. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 492 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 1 Start bit 0 MPB Data (ID1) D0 D1 D7 1 Stop Start Data (data1) bit bit 1 D0 0 D1 MPB D7 0 Stop bit 1 1 Idle (mark) state MPIE RDRF RDR value ID1 RXI request (multiprocessor interrupt) MPB detection MPIE= 0 RXI handler reads RDR data and clears RDRF flag to 0 Not own ID, so MPIE bit is set to 1 again No RXI request, RDR not updated a. Own ID does not match data 1 Start bit 0 MPB Data (ID2) D0 D1 D7 1 Stop Start Data (data2) bit bit 1 D0 0 D1 MPB D7 0 Stop bit 1 1 Idle (mark) state MPIE RDRF RDR value ID2 MPB detection MPIE= 0 RXI request (multiprocessor interrupt) Data 2 RXI interrupt handler Own ID, so receiving MPIE bit is set reads RDR data and continues, with data to 1 again clears RDRF flag to 0 received by RXI interrupt handler b. Own ID matches data Figure 13.13 Example of SCI Receive Operation (8-Bit Data with Multiprocessor Bit and One Stop Bit) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 493 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.3.4 Synchronous Operation In synchronous mode, the SCI transmits and receives data in synchronization with clock pulses. This mode is suitable for high-speed serial communication. The SCI transmitter and receiver share the same clock but are otherwise independent, so full duplex communication is possible. The transmitter and receiver are also double buffered, so continuous transmitting or receiving is possible by reading or writing data while transmitting or receiving is in progress. Figure 13.14 shows the general format in synchronous serial communication. One unit (character or frame) of serial data * * Serial clock LSB Serial data Bit 0 MSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Don’t care Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 Don’t care Note: * High except in continuous transmitting or receiving Figure 13.14 Data Format in Synchronous Communication In synchronous serial communication, each data bit is placed on the communication line from one falling edge of the serial clock to the next. Data is guaranteed valid at the rise of the serial clock. In each character, the serial data bits are transmitted in order from LSB (first) to MSB (last). After output of the MSB, the communication line remains in the state of the MSB. In synchronous mode the SCI receives data by synchronizing with the rise of the serial clock. Communication Format: The data length is fixed at 8 bits. No parity bit or multiprocessor bit can be added. Clock: An internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input from the SCK pin can be selected by clearing or setting the CKE1 bit in SCR. See table 13.9. When the SCI operates on an internal clock, it outputs the clock signal at the SCK pin. Eight clock pulses are output per transmitted or received character. When the SCI operates on an internal clock, the serial clock outputs the clock signal at the SCK pin. Eight clock pulses are output per transmitted or received character. When the SCI is not transmitting or receiving, the clock signal remains in the high state. However, when receiving only, overrun error may occur or the serial clock continues output until the RE bit clears at 0. When transmitting or receiving in single characters, select the external clock. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 494 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Transmitting and Receiving Data • SCI Initialization (Synchronous Mode) Before transmitting or receiving, clear the TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR, then initialize the SCI as follows. When changing the communication mode or format, always clear the TE and RE bits to 0 before following the procedure given below. Clearing the TE bit to 0 sets the TDRE flag to 1 and initializes TSR. Clearing the RE bit to 0, however, does not initialize the RDRF, PER, FER, and ORE flags and RDR, which retain their previous contents. Figure 13.15 is a sample flowchart for initializing the SCI. Start of initialization Clear TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, CKE1, and CKE0 bits in SCR (leaving TE and RE bits cleared to 0) 1 1. Select the clock source in SCR. Clear the RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, TE, and RE bits to 0. 2. Select the communication format in SMR. 3. Write the value corresponding to the bit rate in BRR. This step is not necessary when an external clock is used. 4. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive one bit, then set the TE or RE bit to 1 in SCR. Also set the RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits as necessary. Setting the TE or RE bit enables the SCI to use the TxD or RxD pin. 2 Select communication format in SMR 3 Set value in BRR Wait 1 bit interval elapsed? No Yes Set TE or RE to 1 in SCR Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits as necessary Start transmitting or receiving 4 Note: In simultaneous transmitting and receiving, the TE and RE bits should be cleared to 0 or set to 1 simultaneously. Figure 13.15 Sample Flowchart for SCI Initialization Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 495 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface • Transmitting Serial Data (Synchronous Mode) Figure 13.16 shows a sample flowchart for transmitting serial data and indicates the procedure to follow. 1 Initialize Start transmitting Read TDRE flag in SSR 2 No TDRE = 1? 1. SCI initialization: the transmit data output function of the TxD pin is selected automatically. 2. SCI status check and transmit data write: read SSR, check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write transmit data in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. 3. To continue transmitting serial data: after checking that the TDRE flag is 1, indicating that data can be written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE flag to 0. When the DMAC is activated by a transmitdata-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the TDRE flag is checked and cleared automatically. Yes Write transmit data in TDR and clear TDRE flag to 0 in SSR All data transmitted? No 3 Yes Read TEND flag in SSR TEND = 1? No Yes Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR End Figure 13.16 Sample Flowchart for Serial Transmitting Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 496 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows. 1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. When the TDRE flag is cleared to 0 the SCI recognizes that TDR contains new data, and loads this data from TDR into TSR. 2. After loading the data from TDR into TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts transmitting. If the TIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, the SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) at this time. If clock output is selected, the SCI outputs eight serial clock pulses. If an external clock source is selected, the SCI outputs data in synchronization with the input clock. Data is output from the TxD pin in order from LSB (bit 0) to MSB (bit 7). 3. The SCI checks the TDRE flag when it outputs the MSB (bit 7). If the TDRE flag is 0, the SCI loads data from TDR into TSR and begins serial transmission of the next frame. If the TDRE flag is 1, the SCI sets the TEND flag to 1 in SSR, and after transmitting the MSB, holds the TxD pin in the MSB state. If the TEIE bit in SCR is set to 1, a transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time. 4. After the end of serial transmission, the SCK pin is held in a constant state. Figure 13.17 shows an example of SCI transmit operation. Transmit direction Serial clock Serial data Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 7 Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 6 Bit 7 TDRE TEND TXI request TXI interrupt handler writes data in TDR and clears TDRE flag to 0 TXI request TEI request 1 frame Figure 13.17 Example of SCI Transmit Operation Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 497 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface • Receiving Serial Data Figure 13.18 shows a sample flowchart for receiving serial data and indicates the procedure to follow. When switching from asynchronous mode to synchronous mode, make sure that the ORER, PER, and FER flags are cleared to 0. If the FER or PER flag is set to 1 the RDRF flag will not be set and both transmitting and receiving will be disabled. SCI initialization: the receive data function of the RxD pin is selected automatically. 2, 3. Receive error handling: if a receive error Start receiving occurs, read the ORER flag in SSR, then after executing the necessary error handling, clear the ORER flag to 0. Neither transmitting nor receiving can resume while the ORER flag Read ORER flag in SSR 2 remains set to 1. 4. SCI status check and receive data read: read SSR, check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, Yes ORER = 1? then read receive data from RDR and clear 3 the RDRF flag to 0. Notification that the RDRF Error handling No flag has changed from 0 to 1 can also be given by the RXI interrupt. continued on next page 5. To continue receiving serial data: check the Read RDRF flag in SSR 4 RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear the RDRF flag to 0 before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is received. If the DMAC is activated No by a receive-data-full interrupt request (RXI) RDRF = 1? to read RDR, the RDRF flag is cleared automatically. Yes No Initialize 1 Read receive data from RDR, and clear RDRF flag to 0 in SSR 5 1. Finished receiving? Yes Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR End Figure 13.18 Sample Flowchart for Serial Receiving (1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 498 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 3 Error handling Overrun error handling Clear ORER flag to 0 in SSR End Figure 13.18 Sample Flowchart for Serial Receiving (2) In receiving, the SCI operates as follows. 1. The SCI synchronizes with serial clock input or output and initializes internally. 2. Receive data is stored in RSR in order from LSB to MSB. After receiving the data, the SCI checks that the RDRF flag is 0 so that receive data can be transferred from RSR to RDR. If this check passes, the RDRF flag is set to 1 and the received data is stored in RDR. If the check does not pass (receive error), the SCI operates as indicated in table 13.11. 3. After setting the RDRF flag to 1, if the RIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, the SCI requests a receive-data-full interrupt (RXI). If the ORER flag is set to 1 and the RIE bit in SCR is also set to 1, the SCI requests a receive-error interrupt (ERI). Figure 13.19 shows an example of SCI receive operation. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 499 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Receive direction Serial clock Serial data Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 6 Bit 7 RDRF ORER RXI request RXI interrupt handler reads data in RDR and clears RDRF flag to 0 RXI request Overrun error, ERI request 1 frame Figure 13.19 Example of SCI Receive Operation • Transmitting and Receiving Serial Data Simultaneously (Synchronous Mode) Figure 13.20 shows a sample flowchart for transmitting and receiving serial data simultaneously and indicates the procedure to follow. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 500 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Initialize 1 Start transmitting and receiving Read TDRE flag in SSR 2 No TDRE = 1? Yes Write transmit data in TDR and clear TDRE flag to 0 in SSR Read ORER flag in SSR Yes ORER = 1? 3 No Read RDRF flag in SSR Error handling 4 No RDRF = 1? Yes Read receive data from RDR and clear RDRF flag to 0 in SSR No End of transmitting and receiving? 5 Yes Clear TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR 1. SCI initialization: the transmit data output function of the TxD pin and receive data input function of the RxD pin are selected, enabling simultaneous transmitting and receiving. 2. SCI status check and transmit data write: read SSR, check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write transmit data in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. Notification that the TDRE flag has changed from 0 to 1 can also be given by the TXI interrupt. 3. Receive error handling: if a receive error occurs, read the ORER flag in SSR, then after executing the necessary error handling, clear the ORER flag to 0. Neither transmitting nor receiving can resume while the ORER flag remains set to 1. 4. SCI status check and receive data read: read SSR, check that the RDRF flag is 1, then read receive data from RDR and clear the RDRF flag to 0. Notification that the RDRF flag has changed from 0 to 1 can also be given by the RXI interrupt. 5. To continue transmitting and receiving serial data: check the RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear the RDRF flag to 0 before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is received. Also check that the TDRE flag is set to 1, indicating that data can be written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE flag to 0 before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is transmitted. When the DMAC is activated by a transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the TDRE flag is checked and cleared automatically. When the DMAC is activated by a receivedata-full interrupt request (RXI) to read RDR, the RDRF flag is cleared automatically. End Note: When switching from transmitting or receiving to simultaneous transmitting and receiving, clear both the TE bit and the RE bit to 0, then set both bits to 1. Figure 13.20 Sample Flowchart for Serial Transmitting Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 501 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.4 SCI Interrupts The SCI has four interrupt request sources: TEI (transmit-end interrupt), ERI (receive-error interrupt), RXI (receive-data-full interrupt), and TXI (transmit-data-empty interrupt). Table 13.12 lists the interrupt sources and indicates their priority. These interrupts can be enabled and disabled by the TIE, TEIE, and RIE bits in SCR. Each interrupt request is sent separately to the interrupt controller. The TXI interrupt is requested when the TDRE flag is set to 1 in SSR. The TEI interrupt is requested when the TEND flag is set to 1 in SSR. The TXI interrupt request can activate the DMAC to transfer data. Data transfer by the DMAC automatically clears the TDRE flag to 0. The TEI interrupt request cannot activate the DMAC. The RXI interrupt is requested when the RDRF flag is set to 1 in SSR. The ERI interrupt is requested when the ORER, PER, or FER flag is set to 1 in SSR. The RXI interrupt request can activate the DMAC to transfer data. Data transfer by the DMAC automatically clears the RDRF flag to 0. The ERI interrupt request cannot activate the DMAC. The DMAC can be activated by interrupts from SCI channel 0. Table 13.12 SCI Interrupt Sources Interrupt Description Priority ERI Receive error (ORER, FER, or PER) High RXI Receive data register full (RDRF) ↑ TXI Transmit data register empty (TDRE) TEI Transmit end (TEND) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 502 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Low Section 13 Serial Communication Interface 13.5 Usage Notes Note the following points when using the SCI. TDR Write and TDRE Flag: The TDRE flag in SSR is a status flag indicating the loading of transmit data from TDR into TSR. The SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 when it transfers data from TDR to TSR. Data can be written into TDR regardless of the state of the TDRE flag. If new data is written in TDR when the TDRE flag is 0, the old data stored in TDR will be lost because this data has not yet been transferred to TSR. Before writing transmit data in TDR, be sure to check that the TDRE flag is set to 1. Simultaneous Multiple Receive Errors: Table 13.13 indicates the state of SSR status flags when multiple receive errors occur simultaneously. When an overrun error occurs the RSR contents are not transferred to RDR, so receive data is lost. Table 13.13 SSR Status Flags and Transfer of Receive Data RDRF ORER FER PER Receive Data Transfer RSR → RDR 1 1 0 0 × Overrun error 0 0 1 0 O Framing error 0 0 0 1 O Parity error 1 1 1 0 × Overrun error + framing error 1 1 0 1 × Overrun error + parity error 0 0 1 1 O Framing error + parity error 1 1 1 1 × Overrun error + framing error + parity error Receive Errors Notes: O: Receive data is transferred from RSR to RDR. × : Receive data is not transferred from RSR to RDR. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 503 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Break Detection and Processing: Break signals can be detected by reading the RxD pin directly when a framing error (FER) is detected. In the break state the input from the RxD pin consists of all 0s, so the FER flag is set and the parity error flag (PER) may also be set. In the break state the SCI receiver continues to operate, so if the FER flag is cleared to 0 it will be set to 1 again. Sending a Break Signal: When the TE bit is cleared to 0 the TxD pin becomes an I/O port, the level and direction (input or output) of which are determined by DR and DDR bits. This feature can be used to send a break signal. After the serial transmitter is initialized, the DR value substitutes for the mark state until the TE bit is set to 1 (the TxD pin function is not selected until the TE bit is set to 1). The DDR and DR bits should therefore both be set to 1 beforehand. To send a break signal during serial transmission, clear the DR bit to 0, then clear the TE bit to 0. When the TE bit is cleared to 0 the transmitter is initialized, regardless of its current state, so the TxD pin becomes an output port outputting the value 0. Receive Error Flags and Transmitter Operation (Synchronous Mode Only): When a receive error flag (ORER, PER, or FER) is set to 1 the SCI will not start transmitting, even if the TDRE flag is cleared to 0. Be sure to clear the receive error flags to 0 when starting to transmit. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not clear the receive error flags to 0. Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode and Receive Margin: In asynchronous mode the SCI operates on a base clock with 16 times the bit rate frequency. In receiving, the SCI synchronizes internally with the fall of the start bit, which it samples on the base clock. Receive data is latched at the rising edge of the eighth base clock pulse. See figure 13.21. 16 clocks 8 clocks 0 7 15 0 7 15 0 Internal base clock Receive data (RxD) Start bit D0 D1 Synchronization sampling timing Data sampling timing Figure 13.21 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 504 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface The receive margin in asynchronous mode can therefore be expressed as in equation (1). M = (0.5 – 1 ) – (L – 0.5) F – D – 0.5 2N M: N: D: L: F: N (1 + F) × 100% ................... (1) Receive margin (%) Ratio of clock frequency to bit rate (N = 16) Clock duty cycle (D = 0 to 1.0) Frame length (L = 9 to 12) Absolute deviation of clock frequency From equation (1), if F = 0 and D = 0.5 the receive margin is 46.875%, as given by equation (2). D = 0.5, F = 0 M = {0.5 – 1/(2 × 16)} × 100% = 46.875% ............................................................................................. (2) This is a theoretical value. A reasonable margin to allow in system designs is 20% to 30%. Restrictions on Usage of DMAC: To have the DMAC read RDR, be sure to select the SCI receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) as the activation source with bits DTS2 to DTS0 in DTCR. Restrictions on Usage of the Serial Clock: When transmitting data using an external clock as the serial clock, an interval of at least 5 states is necessary between clearing the TDRE bit in SSR and the start (falling edge) of the first transmit clock pulse corresponding to each frame (see figure 13.22). This condition is also needed for continuous transmission. If it is not fulfilled, operational error will occur. SCK t* t* TDRE TXD X0 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 X7 Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Continuous transmission Note: * Ensure that t ≥ 5 states. Figure 13.22 Serial Clock Transmission (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 505 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Switching SCK Pin to Port Output Pin Function in Synchronous Mode: When the SCK pin is used as the serial clock output in synchronous mode, and is then switched to its output port function at the end of transmission, a low level may be output for one half-cycle. Half-cycle lowlevel output occurs when SCK is switched to its port function with the following settings when DDR = 1, DR = 1, C/A = 1, CKE1 = 0, CKE0 = 0, and TE = 1. 1. End of serial data transmission 2. TE bit = 0 3. C/A bit = 0 ... switchover to port output 4. Occurrence of low-level output (see figure 13.23) Half-cycle low-level output SCK/port 1. End of transmission Data Bit 6 4. Low-level output Bit 7 2. TE = 0 TE C/A 3. C/A = 0 CKE1 CKE0 Figure 13.23 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 506 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Sample Procedure for Preventing Low-Level Output As this sample procedure temporarily places the SCK pin in the input state, the SCK/port pin should be pulled up beforehand with an external circuit. With DDR = 1, DR = 1, C/A = 1, CKE1 = 0, CKE0 = 0, and TE = 1, make the following settings in the order shown. 1. End of serial data transmission 2. TE bit = 0 3. CKE1 bit = 1 4. C/A bit = 0 ... switchover to port output 5. CKE1 bit = 0 High-level output SCK/port 1. End of transmission Data Bit 6 Bit 7 2. TE = 0 TE 4. C/A = 0 C/A 3. CKE1 = 1 CKE1 5. CKE1 = 0 CKE0 Figure 13.24 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function (Example of Preventing Low-Level Output) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 507 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 13 Serial Communication Interface Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 508 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.1 Overview As an extension of its serial communication interface functions, SCI0 supports a smart card (IC card) interface conforming to the ISO/IEC7816-3 (Identification Card) standard. Switchover between normal serial communication and the smart card interface is controlled by a register setting. 14.1.1 Features Features of the smart-card interface supported by the H8/3048 Group are listed below. • Asynchronous communication Data length: 8 bits Parity bits generated and checked Error signal output in receive mode (parity error) Error signal detect and automatic data retransmit in transmit mode Supports both direct convention and inverse convention • Built-in baud rate generator with selectable bit rates • Three types of interrupts Transmit-data-empty, receive-data-full, and receive-error interrupts are requested independently. The transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts can activate the DMA controller (DMAC) to transfer data. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 509 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.1.2 Block Diagram Bus interface Figure 14.1 shows a block diagram of the smart card interface. Module data bus RxD0 RDR TDR RSR TSR SCMR SSR SCR SMR Transmit/receive control TxD0 Parity generate Parity check BRR φ φ/4 Baud rate generator φ/16 φ/64 Clock SCK0 TXI RXI ERI Legend SCMR: RSR: RDR: TSR: TDR: SMR: SCR: SSR: BRR: Smart card mode register Receive shift register Receive data register Transmit shift register Transmit data register Serial mode register Serial control register Serial status register Bit rate register Figure 14.1 Smart Card Interface Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 510 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Internal data bus Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.1.3 Input/Output Pins Table 14.1 lists the smart card interface pins. Table 14.1 Smart Card Interface Pins Name Abbreviation I/O Function Serial clock pin SCK0 Output Clock output Receive data pin RxD0 Input Receive data input Transmit data pin TxD0 Output Transmit data output 14.1.4 Register Configuration The smart card interface has the internal registers listed in table 14.2. BRR, TDR, and RDR have their normal serial communication interface functions, as described in section 13, Serial Communication Interface. Table 14.2 Registers Address* 1 Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFB0 Serial mode register SMR R/W H'00 H'FFB1 Bit rate register BRR R/W H'FF H'FFB2 Serial control register SCR R/W H'00 H'FFB3 Transmit data register TDR R/W H'FF 2 H'FFB4 Serial status register SSR R/(W)* F'84 H'FFB5 Receive data register RDR R H'00 H'FFB6 Smart card mode register SCMR R/W H'F2 Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 511 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.2 Register Descriptions This section describes the new or modified registers and bit functions in the smart card interface. 14.2.1 Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR) SCMR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects smart card interface functions. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — SDIR SINV — SMIF Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W — R/W Reserved bits Reserved bits Smart card interface mode select Enables or disables the smart card interface function Smart card data invert Inverts data logic levels Smart card data transfer direction Selects the serial/parallel conversion format SCMR is initialized to H'F2 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 7 to 4—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 3—Smart Card Data Transfer Direction (SDIR): Selects the serial/parallel conversion format. Bit 3: SDIR Description 0 TDR contents are transmitted LSB-first 1 TDR contents are transmitted MSB-first Received data is stored LSB-first in RDR Received data is stored MSB-first in RDR Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 512 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 14 Smart Card Interface Bit 2—Smart Card Data Inverter (SINV): Inverts data logic levels. This function is used in combination with bit 3 to communicate with inverse-convention cards. SINV does not affect the logic level of the parity bit. For parity settings, see section 14.3.4, Register Settings. Bit 2: SINV Description 0 Unmodified TDR contents are transmitted (Initial value) Received data is stored unmodified in RDR 1 Inverted TDR contents are transmitted Received data is inverted before storage in RDR Bit 1—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Bit 0—Smart Card Interface Mode Select (SMIF): Enables the smart card interface function. Bit 0: SMIF Description 0 Smart card interface function is disabled 1 Smart card interface function is enabled 14.2.2 (Initial value) Serial Status Register (SSR) The function of SSR bit 4 is modified in the smart card interface. This change also causes a modification to the setting conditions for bit 2 (TEND). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TDRE RDRF ORER ERS PER TEND MPB MPBT Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 Read/Write R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* R R R/W Transmit end Status flag indicating end of transmission Error signal status (ERS) Status flag indicating that an error signal has been received Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 513 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface Bits 7 to 5: These bits operate as in normal serial communication. For details see section 13, Serial Communication Interface. Bit 4—Error Signal Status (ERS): In smart card interface mode, this flag indicates the status of the error signal sent from the receiving device to the transmitting device. The smart card interface does not detect framing errors. Bit 4: ERS Description 0 Indicates normal data transmission, with no error signal returned (Initial value) [Clearing conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. Software reads ERS while it is set to 1, then writes 0. 1 Indicates that the receiving device sent an error signal reporting a parity error [Setting condition] A low error signal was sampled. Note: Clearing the TE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the ERS flag, which retains its previous value. Bits 3 to 0: These bits operate as in normal serial communication. For details see section 13, Serial Communication Interface. The setting conditions for transmit end (TEND, bit 2), however, are modified as follows. Bit 2: TEND Description 0 Transmission is in progress [Clearing conditions] Software reads TDRE while it is set to 1, then writes 0 in the TDRE flag. The DMAC writes data in TDR. 1 End of transmission (Initial value) [Setting conditions] The chip is reset or enters standby mode. The TE bit and FER/ERS bit are both cleared to 0 in SCR. TDRE is 1 and FER/ERS is 0 at a time 2.5 etu after the last bit of a 1-byte serial character is transmitted (normal transmission) Note: An etu (elementary time unit) is the time needed to transmit one bit. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 514 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.2.3 Serial Mode Register (SMR) Bit 7 of SMR has a different function in smart card interface mode. The related serial control register (SCR) changes from bit 1 to bit 0. However, this function does not exist in the flash memory version. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GM CHR PR O/E STOP MP CKS1 CKS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Bit 7-GSM Mode (GM): Set at 0 when using the regular smart card interface. In GSM mode, set to 1. When transmission is complete, initially the TEND flag set timing appears followed by clock output restriction mode. Clock output restriction mode comprises serial control register bit 1 and bit 0. Bit 7: GM Description 0 Using the regular smart card interface mode 1 • The TEND flag is set 12.5 etu after the beginning of the start bit • Clock output on/off control only (Initial value) Using the GSM mode smart card interface mode • The TEND flag is set 11.0 etu after the beginning of the start bit • Clock output on/off and fixed-high/fixed-low control Bits 6 to 0—Operate in the same way as for the normal SCI. For details, see section 13.2.5, Serial Mode Register (SMR). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 515 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.2.4 Serial Control Register (SCR) Bits 1 and 0 have different functions in smart card interface mode. However, this function does not exist in the flash memory version. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TIE RIE TE RE MPIE TEIE CKE1 CKE0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W Initial value 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W Bits 7 to 2—Operate in the same way as for the normal SCI. For details, see section 13.2.6, Serial Control Register (SCR). Bits 1 and 0—Clock Enable (CKE1, CKE0): Setting enable or disable for the SCI clock selection and clock output from the SCK pin. In smart card interface mode, it is possible to switch between enabling and disabling of the normal clock output, and specify a fixed high level or fixed low level for the clock output. SMR SCR Bit 7: GM Bit 1: CKE1 Bit 0: CKE0 Description 0 0 0 The internal clock/SCK0 pin functions as an I/O port 0 0 1 The internal clock/SCK0 pin functions as the clock output 1 0 0 The internal clock/SCK0 pin is fixed at low-level output 1 0 1 The internal clock/SCK0 pin functions as the clock output 1 1 0 The internal clock/SCK0 pin is fixed at high-level output 1 1 1 The internal clock/SCK0 pin functions as the clock output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 516 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.3 Operation 14.3.1 Overview The main features of the smart-card interface are as follows. • One frame consists of eight data bits and a parity bit. • In transmitting, a guard time of at least two elementary time units (2 etu) is provided between the end of the parity bit and the start of the next frame. (An elementary time unit is the time required to transmit one bit.) • In receiving, if a parity error is detected, a low error signal is output for 1 etu, beginning 10.5 etu after the start bit. • In transmitting, if an error signal is received, after at least 2 etu, the same data is automatically transmitted again. • Only asynchronous communication is supported. There is no synchronous communication function. 14.3.2 Pin Connections Figure 14.2 shows a pin connection diagram for the smart card interface. In communication with a smart card, data is transmitted and received over the same signal line. The TxD0 and RxD0 pins should both be connected to this line. The data transmission line should be pulled up to VCC through a resistor. If the smart card uses the clock generated by the smart card interface, connect the SCK0 output pin to the card’s CLK input. If the card uses its own internal clock, this connection is unnecessary. The reset signal should be output from one of the H8/3048 Group’s generic ports. In addition to these pin connections, power and ground connections will normally also be necessary. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 517 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface VCC TxD0 RxD0 Data line SCK0 Clock line Px (port) H8/3048 Group Chip Reset line I/O CLK RST Smart card Card-processing device Figure 14.2 Smart Card Interface Connection Diagram Note: A loop-back test can be performed by setting both RE and TE to 1 without connecting a smart card. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 518 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.3.3 Data Format Figure 14.3 shows the data format of the smart card interface. In receive mode, parity is checked once per frame. If a parity error is detected, an error signal is returned to the transmitting device to request retransmission. In transmit mode, the error signal is sampled and the same data is retransmitted if the error signal is low. No parity error Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp D6 D7 Dp Output from transmitting device Parity error Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 DE Output from transmitting device Output from receiving device Ds: D0 to D7: Dp: DE: Start bit Data bits Parity bit Error signal Figure 14.3 Smart Card Interface Data Format The operating sequence is as follows. 1. When not in use, the data line is in the high-impedance state, and is pulled up to the high level through a resistor. 2. To start transmitting a frame of data, the transmitting device transmits a low start bit (Ds), followed by eight data bits (D0 to D7) and a parity bit (Dp). 3. Next, in the smart card interface, the transmitting device returns the data line to the highimpedance state. The data line is pulled up to the high level through a resistor. 4. The receiving device performs a parity check. If there is no parity error, the receiving device waits to receive the next data. If a parity error is present, the receiving device outputs a low error signal (DE) to request retransmission of the data. After outputting the error signal for a designated interval, the receiving device returns the signal line to the high-impedance state. The signal line is pulled back up to the high level through the pull-up resistor. 5. If the transmitting device does not receive an error signal, it proceeds to transmit the next data. If it receives an error signal, it returns to step 2 and transmits the same data again. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 519 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.3.4 Register Settings Table 14.3 shows a bit map of the registers used in the smart card interface. Bits indicated as 0 or 1 should always be set to the indicated value. The settings of the other bits will be described in this section. Table 14.3 Register Settings in Smart Card Interface Register Address* SMR 1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 H'FFB0 GM 0 1 O/E 1 0 CKS1 CKS0 BRR H'FFB1 BRR7 BRR6 BRR5 BRR4 BRR3 BRR2 BRR1 SCR H'FFB2 TIE RIE TE RE 0 0 CKE1* CKE0 TDR H'FFB3 TDR7 TDR6 TDR5 TDR4 TDR3 TDR2 TDR1 TDR0 SSR H'FFB4 TDRE RDRF ORER ERS PER TEND 0 0 RDR H'FFB5 RDR7 RDR6 RDR5 RDR4 RDR3 RDR2 RDR1 RDR0 SCMR H'FFB6 — — — — SDIR SINV — SMIF BRR0 2 Notes: — Unused bit. 1. Lower 16 bits of the address. 2. When the GM of the SMR is set at 0, be sure the CKE1 bit is 0. Serial Mode Register (SMR) Settings: In regular smart card interface mode, set the GM bit at 0. In regular smart card mode, clear the GM bit to 0. In GSM mode, set the GM bit to 1. Clear the O/E bit to 0 if the smart card uses the direct convention. Set the O/E bit to 1 if the smart card uses the inverse convention. Bits CKS1 and CKS0 select the clock source of the built-in baud rate generator. See section 14.3.5, Clock. Bit Rate Register (BRR) Settings: This register sets the bit rate. Equations for calculating the setting are given in section 14.3.5, Clock. Serial Control Register (SCR): The TIE, RIE, TE, and RE bits have their normal serial communication functions. For details, see section 13, Serial Communication Interface. The CKE1 and CKE0 bits select clock output. When the GM bit of the SMR is cleared to 0, to disable clock output, clear this bit to 00. To enable clock output, set this bit to 01. When the GM bit of the SMR is set to 1, clock output is enabled. Clock output is fixed at high or low. Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR): If the smart card follows the direct convention, clear the SDIR and SINV bits to 0. If the smart card follows the indirect convention, set the SDIR and SINV bits to 1. To use the smart card interface, set the SMIF bit to 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 520 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface The register settings and examples of starting character waveforms are shown below for two smart cards, one following the direct convention and one the inverse convention. • Direct convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 0) (Z) A Z Z A Z Z Z A A Z Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp (Z) State In the direct convention, state Z corresponds to logic level 1, and state A to logic level 0. Characters are transmitted and received LSB-first. In the example above the first character data is H'3B. The parity bit is 1, following the even parity rule designated for smart cards. • Inverse convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 1) (Z) A Z Z A A A A A A Z Ds D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Dp (Z) State In the inverse convention, state A corresponds to the logic level 1, and state Z to the logic level 0. Characters are transmitted and received MSB-first. In the example above the first character data is H'3F. Following the even parity rule designated for smart cards, the parity bit logic level is 0, corresponding to state Z. In the H8/3048 Group, the SINV bit inverts only the data bits D7 to D0. The parity bit is not inverted, so the O/E bit in SMR must be set to odd parity mode. This applies in both transmitting and receiving. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 521 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.3.5 Clock As its serial communication clock, the smart card interface can use only the internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator. The bit rate can be selected by setting the bit rate register (BRR) and bits CKS1 and CKS0 in the serial mode register (SMR). The bit rate can be calculated from the equation given below. Table 14.5 lists some examples of bit rate settings. If bit CKE0 is set to 1, a clock signal with a frequency equal to 372 times the bit rate is output from the SCK0 pin. B= where, N: B: φ: n: φ 1488 × 22n–1 × (N + 1) × 106 BRR setting (0 ≤ N ≤ 255) Bit rate (bits/s) System clock frequency (MHz)* See table 14.4 Table 14.4 n-Values of CKS1 and CKS0 Settings n CKS1 CKS0 0 0 0 1 0 1 2 1 0 3 1 1 Note: * If the gear function is used to divide the system clock frequency, use the divided frequency to calculate the bit rate. The equation above applies directly to 1/1 frequency division. Table 14.5 Bit Rates (bits/s) for Different BRR Settings (when n = 0) φ (MHz) N 7.1424 10.00 10.7136 13.00 14.2848 16.00 18.00 0 9600.0 13440.9 14400.0 17473.1 19200.0 21505.4 24193.5 1 4800.0 6720.4 7200.0 8736.6 9600.0 10752.7 12096.8 2 3200.0 4480.3 4800.0 5824.4 6400.0 7168.5 8064.5 Note: Bit rates are rounded off to one decimal place. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 522 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface The following equation calculates the bit rate register (BRR) setting from the system clock frequency and bit rate. N is an integer from 0 to 255, specifying the value with the smaller error. N= φ 1488 × 22n–1 × B × 106 – 1 Table 14.6 BRR Settings for Typical Bit Rate (bits/s) (when n = 0) φ (MHz) 7.1424 10.00 10.7136 13.00 14.2848 16.00 18.00 Bit/s N Error N Error N Error N Error N Error N Error N Error 9600 0 0.00 1 30.00 1 25.00 1 8.99 1 0.00 1 12.01 2 15.99 Table 14.7 Maximum Bit Rates for Various Frequencies (Smart Card Interface) φ (MHz) Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s) N n 7.1424 9600 0 0 10.00 13441 0 0 10.7136 14400 0 0 13.00 17473 0 0 14.2848 19200 0 0 16.00 21505 0 0 18.00 24194 0 0 The bit rate error is calculated from the following equation. Error (%) = φ 1488 × 22n–1 × B × (N + 1) × 106 – 1 × 100 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 523 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.3.6 Transmitting and Receiving Data Initialization: Before transmitting or receiving data, initialize the smart card interface by the procedure below. Initialization is also necessary when switching from transmit mode to receive mode or from receive mode to transmit mode. 1. Clear the TE and RE bits to 0 in the serial control register (SCR). 2. Clear the ERS, PER, and ORER error flags to 0 in the serial status register (SSR). 3. Set the parity mode bit (O/E) and baud rate generator clock source select bits (CKS1 and CKS0) as required in the serial mode register (SMR). At the same time, clear the C/A, CHR, and MP bits to 0, and set the STOP and PE bits to 1. 4. Set the SMIF, SDIR, and SINV bits as required in the smart card mode register (SMR). When the SMIF bit is set to 1, the TxD0 and RxD0 pins switch from their I/O port functions to their serial communication interface functions, and are placed in the high-impedance state. 5. Set a value corresponding to the desired bit rate in the bit rate register (BRR). 6. Set clock enable bit 0 (CKE0) as required in the serial control register (SCR). Write 0 in the TIE, RIE, TE, RE, MPIE, TEIE, and CKE1 bits. If bit CKE0 is set to 1, a serial clock will be output from the SCK0 pin. 7. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive one bit, then set the TIE, RIE, TE, and RE bits as necessary in SCR. Do not set TE and RE both to 1, except when performing a loop-back test. Transmitting Serial Data: The transmitting procedure in smart card mode is different from the normal SCI procedure, because of the need to sample the error signal and retransmit. Figure 14.4 shows a flowchart for transmitting, and figure 14.5 shows the relation between a transmit operation and the internal registers. 1. Initialize the smart card interface by the procedure given above in Initialization. 2. Check that the ERS error flag is cleared to 0 in SSR. 3. Check that the TEND flag is set to 1 in SSR. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until this check passes. 4. Write transmit data in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0. The data will be transmitted and the TEND flag will be cleared to 0. 5. To continue transmitting data, return to step 2. 6. To terminate transmission, clear the TE bit to 0. This procedure may include interrupt handling and DMA transfer. If the TIE bit is set to 1 to enable interrupt requests, when transmission is completed and the TEND flag is set to 1, a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) is requested. If the RIE bit is set to 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 524 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface to enable interrupt requests, when a transmit error occurs and the ERS flag is set to 1, a transmit/receive-error interrupt (ERI) is requested. The timing of TEND flag setting depends on the GM bit in SMR. The timing is shown in figure 14.6. If the TXI interrupt activates the DMAC, the number of bytes designated in the DMAC can be transmitted automatically, including automatic retransmit. For details, see Interrupt Operations and Data Transfer by DMAC in this section. Start Initialize Start transmitting FER/ERS = 0 ? No Yes Error handling No TEND = 1 ? Yes Write data in TDR and clear TDRE flag to 0 in SSR No All data transmitted ? Yes FER/ERS = 0 ? No Yes Error handling No TEND = 1 ? Yes Clear TE bit to 0 End Figure 14.4 Transmit Flowchart (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 525 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface TDR (1) Data write Data 1 (2) Transfer from TDR to TSR Data 1 (3) Serial data output Data 1 TSR (shift register) Data 1 ; Data remains in TDR Data 1 I/O signal line output In case of normal transmission: TEND flag is set In case of transmit error: ERS flag is set Steps (2) and (3) above are repeated until the TEND flag is set Note: When the ERS flag is set, it should be cleared until transfer of the last bit (D7 in LSB-first transmission, D0 in MSB-first transmission) of the next transfer data to be transmitted has been completed. Figure 14.5 Relation Between Transmit Operation and Internal Registers I/O data DS Da Db Dc Dd De Df Dg Dh Dp DE Guard time TXI (TEND interrupt) 12.5 etu When GM = 0 11.0 etu When GM = 1 Figure 14.6 TEND Flag Occurrence Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 526 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface Receiving Serial Data: The receiving procedure in smart card mode is the same as the normal SCI procedure. Figure 14.7 shows a flowchart for receiving. 1. Initialize the smart card interface by the procedure given in Initialization at the beginning of this section. 2. Check that the ORER and PER error flags are cleared to 0 in SSR. If either flag is set, carry out the necessary error handling, then clear both the ORER and PER flags to 0. 3. Check that the RDRF flag is set to 1. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until this check passes. 4. Read receive data from RDR. 5. To continue receiving data, clear the RDRF flag to 0 and return to step 2. 6. To terminate receiving, clear the RE bit to 0. Start Initialize Start receiving ORER = 0 and PER = 0 ? No Yes Error handling No RDRF = 1 ? Yes Read RDR and clear RDRF flag to 0 in SSR No All data received ? Yes Clear RE bit to 0 Figure 14.7 Receive Flowchart (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 527 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface This procedure may include interrupt handling and DMA transfer. If the RIE bit is set to 1 to enable interrupt requests, when receiving is completed and the RDRF flag is set to 1, a receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) is requested. If a receive error occurs, either the ORER or PER flag is set to 1 and a transmit/receive-error interrupt (ERI) is requested. If the RXI interrupt activates the DMAC, the number of bytes designated in the DMAC will be transferred, skipping receive data in which an error occurred. For details, see Interrupt Operations and Data Transfer by DMAC below. When a parity error occurs and PER is set to 1, the receive data is transferred to RDR, so the erroneous data can be read. Switching Modes: To switch from receive mode to transmit mode, check that receiving operations have completed, then initialize the smart card interface, clearing RE to 0 and setting TE to 1. Completion of receive operations is indicated by the RDRF, PER, or ORER flag. To switch from transmit mode to receive mode, check that transmitting operations have completed, then initialize the smart card interface, clearing TE to 0 and setting RE to 1. Completion of transmit operations can be verified from the TEND flag. Fixing Clock Output: When the GM bit of the SMR is set to 1, clock output is fixed by CKE1 and CKE0 of SCR. In this case, the clock pulse can be set at minimum value. Figure 14.8 shows clock output fixed timing: CKE0 is restricted with GM = 1 and CKE1 = 1. Specified pulse width Specified pulse width CKE1 value SCK SCR write (CKE0 = 0) SCR write (CKE0 = 1) Figure 14.8 Clock Output Fixed Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 528 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface Interrupt Operations: The smart card interface has three interrupt sources: transmit-data-empty (TXI), transmit/receive-error (ERI), and receive-data-full (RXI). The transmit-end interrupt request (TEI) is not available in smart card mode. A TXI interrupt is requested when the TEND flag is set to 1 in SSR. An RXI interrupt is requested when the RDRF flag is set to 1 in SSR. An ERI interrupt is requested when the ORER, PER, or ERS flag is set to 1 in SSR. These relationships are shown in table 14.8. Table 14.8 Smart Card Mode Operating States and Interrupt Sources Flag Mask Bit Interrupt Source DMAC Activation Normal operation TEND TIE TXI Available Error ERS RIE ERI Not available Normal operation RDRF RIE RXI Available Error PER, ORER RIE ERI Not available Operating State Transmit mode Receive mode Data Transfer by DMAC: The DMAC can be used to transmit and receive in smart card mode, as in normal SCI operations. In transmit mode, when the TEND flag is set to 1 in SSR, the TDRE flag is set simultaneously, generating a TXI interrupt. If TXI is designated in advance as a DMAC activation source, the DMAC will be activated by the TXI request and will transfer the next transmit data. This data transfer by the DMAC automatically clears the TDRE and TEND flags to 0. When an error occurs, the SCI automatically retransmits the same data, keeping TEND cleared to 0 so that the DMAC is not activated. The SCI and DMAC will therefore automatically transmit the designated number of bytes, including retransmission when an error occurs. When an error occurs the ERS flag is not cleared automatically, so the RIE bit should be set to 1 to enable the error to generate an ERI request, and the ERI interrupt handler should clear ERS. When using the DMAC to transmit or receive, first set up and enable the DMAC, then make SCI settings. DMAC settings are described in section 8, DMA Controller. In receive operations, when the RDRF flag is set to 1 in SSR, an RXI interrupt is requested. If RXI is designated in advance as a DMAC activation source, the DMAC will be activated by the RXI request and will transfer the received data. This data transfer by the DMAC automatically clears the RDRF flag to 0. When an error occurs, the RDRF flag is not set and an error flag is set instead. The DMAC is not activated. The ERI interrupt request is directed to the CPU. The ERI interrupt handler should clear the error flags. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 529 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface Examples of Operation in GSM Mode: When switching between smart card interface mode and software standby mode, use the following procedures to maintain the clock duty cycle. • Switching from smart card interface mode to software standby mode 1. Set the P94 data register (DR) and data direction register (DDR) to the values for the fixed output state in software standby mode. 2. Write 0 to the TE and RE bits in the serial control register (SCR) to stop transmit/receive operations. At the same time, set the CKE1 bit to the value for the fixed output state in software standby mode. 3. Write 0 to the CKE0 bit in SCR to stop the clock. 4. Wait for one serial clock cycle. During this period, the duty cycle is preserved and clock output is fixed at the specified level. 5. Write H'00 to the serial mode register (SMR) and smart card mode register (SCMR). 6. Make the transition to the software standby state. • Returning from software standby mode to smart card interface mode 1. Clear the software standby state. 2. Set the CKE1 bit in SCR to the value for the fixed output state at the start of software standby (the current P94 pin state). 3. Set smart card interface mode and output the clock. Clock signal generation is started with the normal duty cycle. Normal operation (1)(2)(3) Software standby mode (4) (5)(6) Normal operation (1) (2)(3) Figure 14.9 Procedure for Stopping and Restarting the Clock Use the following procedure to secure the clock duty cycle after powering on. 1. The initial state is port input and high impedance. Use pull-up or pull-down resistors to fix the potential. 2. Fix at the output specified by the CKE1 bit in SCR. 3. Set SMR and SCMR, and switch to smart card interface mode operation. 4. Set the CKE0 bit in SCR to 1 to start clock output. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 530 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface 14.4 Usage Notes When using the SCI as a smart card interface, note the following points. Receive Data Sampling Timing in Smart Card Mode and Receive Margin: In smart card mode the SCI operates on a base clock with 372 times the bit rate frequency. In receiving, the SCI synchronizes internally with the fall of the start bit, which it samples on the base clock. Receive data is latched at the rising edge of the 186th base clock pulse. See figure 14.10. 372 clocks 186 clocks 0 185 371 0 185 371 0 Internal base clock Start bit Receive data (RxD) D0 D1 Synchronization sampling timing Data sampling timing Figure 14.10 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Smart Card Mode The receive margin can therefore be expressed as follows. Receive margin in smart card mode: M= 0.5 – 1 2N – (L – 0.5) F – D – 0.5 (1 + F) × 100% N M: Receive margin (%) N: Ratio of clock frequency to bit rate (N = 372) D: Clock duty cycle (D = 0 to 1.0) L: Frame length (L = 10) F: Absolute deviation of clock frequency Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 531 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface From this equation, if F = 0 and D = 0.5 the receive margin is as follows. D = 0.5, F = 0 M = {0.5 – 1/(2 × 372)} × 100% = 49.866% Retransmission: Retransmission is described below for the separate cases of transmit mode and receive mode. • Retransmission when SCI is in Receive Mode (see figure 14.11) (1) The SCI checks the received parity bit. If it detects an error, it automatically sets the PER flag to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to the enable state, an ERI interrupt is requested. The PER flag should be cleared to 0 in SSR before the next parity bit sampling timing. (2) The RDRF bit in SSR is not set to 1 for the error frame. (3) If an error is not detected when the parity bit is checked, the PER flag is not set in SSR. (4) If an error is not detected when the parity bit is checked, receiving operations are assumed to have ended normally, and the RDRF bit is automatically set to 1 in SSR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to the enable state, an RXI interrupt is requested. If RXI is enabled as a DMA transfer activation source, the RDR contents can be read automatically. When the DMAC reads the RDR data, it automatically clears RDRF to 0. (5) When a normal frame is received, at the error signal transmit timing, the data pin is held in the high-impedance state. Frame n Retransmitted frame Frame n + 1 (DE) Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 RDRF (2) (4) (1) (3) PER Figure 14.11 Retransmission in SCI Receive Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 532 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface • Retransmission when SCI is in Transmit Mode (see figure 14.12) (6) After transmitting one frame, if the receiving device returns an error signal, the SCI sets the ERS flag to 1 in SSR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to the enable state, an ERI interrupt is requested. The ERS flag should be cleared to 0 in SSR before the next parity bit sampling timing. (7) The TEND bit in SSR is not set for the frame in which the error signal was received, indicating an error. (8) If no error signal is returned from the receiving device, the ERS flag is not set in SSR. (9) If no error signal is returned from the receiving device, transmission of the frame, including retransmission, is assumed to be complete, and the TEND bit is set to 1 in SSR. If the TIE bit in SCR is set to the enable state, a TXI interrupt is requested. If TXI is enabled as a DMA transfer activation source, the next data can be written in TDR automatically. When the DMAC writes data in TDR, it automatically clears the TDRE bit to 0. Frame n Retransmitted frame Frame n + 1 (DE) Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 TDRE Transfer from TDR to TSR Transfer from TDR to TSR Transfer from TDR to TSR TEND (7) (9) ERS (6) (8) Figure 14.12 Retransmission in SCI Transmit Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 533 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 14 Smart Card Interface Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 534 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter Section 15 A/D Converter 15.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group includes a 10-bit successive-approximations A/D converter with a selection of up to eight analog input channels. When the A/D converter is not used, it can be halted independently to conserve power. For details see section 21.6, Module Standby Function. 15.1.1 Features A/D converter features are listed below. • 10-bit resolution • Eight input channels • Selectable analog conversion voltage range The analog voltage conversion range can be programmed by input of an analog reference voltage at the VREF pin. • High-speed conversion Conversion time: Minimum 7.45 µs per channel (with 18 MHz system clock) • Two conversion modes Single mode: A/D conversion of one channel Scan mode: continuous conversion on one to four channels • Four 16-bit data registers A/D conversion results are transferred for storage into data registers corresponding to the channels. • Sample-and-hold function • A/D conversion can be externally triggered • A/D interrupt requested at end of conversion At the end of A/D conversion, an A/D end interrupt (ADI) can be requested. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 535 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.1.2 Block Diagram Figure 15.1 shows a block diagram of the A/D converter. Internal data bus AV SS AN 0 AN 5 ADCR ADCSR ADDRD – AN 2 AN 4 ADDRC + AN 1 AN 3 ADDRB 10-bit D/A ADDRA V REF Successiveapproximations register AVCC Bus interface Module data bus Analog multiplexer φ/8 Comparator Control circuit Sample-andhold circuit φ/16 AN 6 AN 7 ADI ADTRG Legend ADCR: ADCSR: ADDRA: ADDRB: ADDRC: ADDRD: A/D control register A/D control/status register A/D data register A A/D data register B A/D data register C A/D data register D Figure 15.1 A/D Converter Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 536 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.1.3 Input Pins Table 15.1 summarizes the A/D converter’s input pins. The eight analog input pins are divided into two groups: group 0 (AN0 to AN3), and group 1 (AN4 to AN7). AVCC and AVSS are the power supply for the analog circuits in the A/D converter. VREF is the A/D conversion reference voltage. Table 15.1 A/D Converter Pins Pin Name Abbreviation I/O Function Analog power supply pin AVCC Input Analog power supply Analog ground pin AVSS Input Analog ground and reference voltage Reference voltage pin VREF Input Analog reference voltage Analog input pin 0 AN0 Input Group 0 analog inputs Analog input pin 1 AN1 Input Analog input pin 2 AN2 Input Analog input pin 3 AN3 Input Analog input pin 4 AN4 Input Analog input pin 5 AN5 Input Analog input pin 6 AN6 Input Analog input pin 7 AN7 Input A/D external trigger input pin ADTRG Input Group 1 analog inputs External trigger input for starting A/D conversion Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 537 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.1.4 Register Configuration Table 15.2 summarizes the A/D converter’s registers. Table 15.2 A/D Converter Registers Address* 1 Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFE0 A/D data register A (high) ADDRAH R H'00 H'FFE1 A/D data register A (low) ADDRAL R H'00 H'FFE2 A/D data register B (high) ADDRBH R H'00 H'FFE3 A/D data register B (low) ADDRBL R H'00 H'FFE4 A/D data register C (high) ADDRCH R H'00 H'FFE5 A/D data register C (low) ADDRCL R H'00 H'FFE6 A/D data register D (high) ADDRDH R H'00 H'FFE7 A/D data register D (low) ADDRDL R H'00 H'00 H'7F* H'FFE8 A/D control/status register ADCSR 2 R/(W)* H'FFE9 A/D control register ADCR R/W 3 Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address 2. Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag. 3. H8/3048F, H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 mask-ROM, H8/3047 mask-ROM, H8/3045 maskROM, and H8/3044 mask-ROM versions Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 538 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.2 Register Descriptions 15.2.1 A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD) 14 12 10 8 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 — 15 Bit 13 11 9 7 — — — — — Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write (n = A to D) R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R ADDRn A/D conversion data 10-bit data giving an A/D conversion result Reserved bits The four A/D data registers (ADDRA to ADDRD) are 16-bit read-only registers that store the results of A/D conversion. An A/D conversion produces 10-bit data, which is transferred for storage into the A/D data register corresponding to the selected channel. The upper 8 bits of the result are stored in the upper byte of the A/D data register. The lower 2 bits are stored in the lower byte. Bits 5 to 0 of an A/D data register are reserved bits that are always read as 0. Table 15.3 indicates the pairings of analog input channels and A/D data registers. The CPU can always read and write the A/D data registers. The upper byte can be read directly, but the lower byte is read through a temporary register (TEMP). For details see section 15.3, CPU Interface. The A/D data registers are initialized to H'0000 by a reset and in standby mode. Table 15.3 Analog Input Channels and A/D Data Registers Analog Input Channel Group 0 Group 1 A/D Data Register AN0 AN4 ADDRA AN1 AN5 ADDRB AN2 AN6 ADDRC AN3 AN7 ADDRD Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 539 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.2.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADF ADIE ADST SCAN CKS CH2 CH1 CH0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/(W)* R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Channel select 2 to 0 These bits select analog input channels Clock select Selects the A/D conversion time Scan mode Selects single mode or scan mode A/D start Starts or stops A/D conversion A/D interrupt enable Enables and disables A/D end interrupts A/D end flag Indicates end of A/D conversion Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. ADCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the mode and controls the A/D converter. ADCSR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—A/D End Flag (ADF): Indicates the end of A/D conversion. Bit 7: ADF Description 0 [Clearing condition] Cleared by reading ADF while ADF = 1, then writing 0 in ADF 1 [Setting conditions] Single mode: A/D conversion ends Scan mode: A/D conversion ends in all selected channels Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 540 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 15 A/D Converter Bit 6—A/D Interrupt Enable (ADIE): Enables or disables the interrupt (ADI) requested at the end of A/D conversion. Bit 6: ADIE Description 0 A/D end interrupt request (ADI) is disabled 1 A/D end interrupt request (ADI) is enabled (Initial value) Bit 5—A/D Start (ADST): Starts or stops A/D conversion. The ADST bit remains set to 1 during A/D conversion. It can also be set to 1 by external trigger input at the ADTRG pin. Bit 5: ADST Description 0 A/D conversion is stopped 1 Single mode: A/D conversion starts; ADST is automatically cleared to 0 when conversion ends. (Initial value) Scan mode: A/D conversion starts and continues, cycling among the selected channels, until ADST is cleared to 0 by software, by a reset, or by a transition to standby mode. Bit 4—Scan Mode (SCAN): Selects single mode or scan mode. For further information on operation in these modes, see section 15.4, Operation. Clear the ADST bit to 0 before switching the conversion mode. Bit 4: SCAN Description 0 Single mode 1 Scan mode (Initial value) Bit 3—Clock Select (CKS): Selects the A/D conversion time. Clear the ADST bit to 0 before switching the conversion time. Bit 3: CKS Description 0 Conversion time = 266 states (maximum) 1 Conversion time = 134 states (maximum) (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 541 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter Bits 2 to 0—Channel Select 2 to 0 (CH2 to CH0): These bits and the SCAN bit select the analog input channels. Clear the ADST bit to 0 before changing the channel selection. Group Selection Channel Selection Description CH2 CH1 CH0 Single Mode Scan Mode 0 0 0 AN0 (Initial value) AN0 1 AN1 AN0, AN1 0 AN2 AN0 to AN2 1 AN3 AN0 to AN3 0 AN4 AN4 1 AN5 AN4, AN5 0 AN6 AN4 to AN6 1 AN7 AN4 to AN7 1 1 0 1 15.2.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TRGE — — — — — — — Initial value 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W — — — — — — — Reserved bits Trigger enable Enables or disables external triggering of A/D conversion ADCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables external triggering of A/D conversion. ADCR is initialized to H'7F by a reset and in standby mode. Bit 7—Trigger Enable (TRGE): Enables or disables external triggering of A/D conversion. Bit 7: TRGE Description 0 A/D conversion cannot be externally triggered 1 A/D conversion starts at the falling edge of the external trigger signal (ADTRG) Bits 6 to 0—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 542 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 15 A/D Converter 15.3 CPU Interface ADDRA to ADDRD are 16-bit registers, but they are connected to the CPU by an 8-bit data bus. Therefore, although the upper byte can be be accessed directly by the CPU, the lower byte is read through an 8-bit temporary register (TEMP). An A/D data register is read as follows. When the upper byte is read, the upper-byte value is transferred directly to the CPU and the lower-byte value is transferred into TEMP. Next, when the lower byte is read, the TEMP contents are transferred to the CPU. When reading an A/D data register, always read the upper byte before the lower byte. It is possible to read only the upper byte, but if only the lower byte is read, incorrect data may be obtained. Figure 15.2 shows the data flow for access to an A/D data register. Upper-byte read CPU (H'AA) Module data bus Bus interface TEMP (H'40) ADDRnH (H'AA) ADDRnL (H'40) (n = A to D) Lower-byte read CPU (H'40) Module data bus Bus interface TEMP (H'40) ADDRnH (H'AA) ADDRnL (H'40) (n = A to D) Figure 15.2 A/D Data Register Access Operation (Reading H'AA40) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 543 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.4 Operation The A/D converter operates by successive approximations with 10-bit resolution. It has two operating modes: single mode and scan mode. 15.4.1 Single Mode (SCAN = 0) Single mode should be selected when only one A/D conversion on one channel is required. A/D conversion starts when the ADST bit is set to 1 by software, or by external trigger input. The ADST bit remains set to 1 during A/D conversion and is automatically cleared to 0 when conversion ends. When conversion ends the ADF bit is set to 1. If the ADIE bit is also set to 1, an ADI interrupt is requested at this time. To clear the ADF flag to 0, first read ADCSR, then write 0 in ADF. When the mode or analog input channel must be switched during analog conversion, to prevent incorrect operation, first clear the ADST bit to 0 in ADCSR to halt A/D conversion. After making the necessary changes, set the ADST bit to 1 to start A/D conversion again. The ADST bit can be set at the same time as the mode or channel is changed. Typical operations when channel 1 (AN1) is selected in single mode are described next. Figure 15.3 shows a timing diagram for this example. 1. Single mode is selected (SCAN = 0), input channel AN1 is selected (CH2 = CH1 = 0, CH0 = 1), the A/D interrupt is enabled (ADIE = 1), and A/D conversion is started (ADST = 1). 2. When A/D conversion is completed, the result is transferred into ADDRB. At the same time the ADF flag is set to 1, the ADST bit is cleared to 0, and the A/D converter becomes idle. 3. Since ADF = 1 and ADIE = 1, an ADI interrupt is requested. 4. The A/D interrupt handling routine starts. 5. The routine reads ADCSR, then writes 0 in the ADF flag. 6. The routine reads and processes the conversion result (ADDRB). 7. Execution of the A/D interrupt handling routine ends. After that, if the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion starts again and steps 2 to 7 are repeated. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 544 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Note: * Vertical arrows ( ) indicate instructions executed by software. ADDRD ADDRC ADDRB Read conversion result A/D conversion result (2) Idle Clear * A/D conversion result (1) A/D conversion (2) Set * Read conversion result Idle State of channel 3 (AN 3) ADDRA Idle State of channel 2 (AN 2) Idle Clear * State of channel 1 (AN 1) A/D conversion (1) Set * Idle Idle A/D conversion starts State of channel 0 (AN 0) ADF ADST ADIE Set * Section 15 A/D Converter Figure 15.3 Example of A/D Converter Operation (Single Mode, Channel 1 Selected) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 545 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.4.2 Scan Mode (SCAN = 1) Scan mode is useful for monitoring analog inputs in a group of one or more channels. When the ADST bit is set to 1 by software or external trigger input, A/D conversion starts on the first channel in the group (AN0 when CH2 = 0, AN4 when CH2 = 1). When two or more channels are selected, after conversion of the first channel ends, conversion of the second channel (AN1 or AN5) starts immediately. A/D conversion continues cyclically on the selected channels until the ADST bit is cleared to 0. The conversion results are transferred for storage into the A/D data registers corresponding to the channels. When the mode or analog input channel selection must be changed during analog conversion, to prevent incorrect operation, first clear the ADST bit to 0 in ADCSR to halt A/D conversion. After making the necessary changes, set the ADST bit to 1. A/D conversion will start again from the first channel in the group. The ADST bit can be set at the same time as the mode or channel selection is changed. Typical operations when three channels in group 0 (AN0 to AN2) are selected in scan mode are described next. Figure 15.4 shows a timing diagram for this example. 1. Scan mode is selected (SCAN = 1), scan group 0 is selected (CH2 = 0), analog input channels AN0 to AN2 are selected (CH1 = 1, CH0 = 0), and A/D conversion is started (ADST = 1). 2. When A/D conversion of the first channel (AN0) is completed, the result is transferred into ADDRA. Next, conversion of the second channel (AN1) starts automatically. 3. Conversion proceeds in the same way through the third channel (AN2). 4. When conversion of all selected channels (AN0 to AN2) is completed, the ADF flag is set to 1 and conversion of the first channel (AN0) starts again. If the ADIE bit is set to 1, an ADI interrupt is requested at this time. 5. Steps 2 to 4 are repeated as long as the ADST bit remains set to 1. When the ADST bit is cleared to 0, A/D conversion stops. After that, if the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion starts again from the first channel (AN0). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 546 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Idle Idle Idle A/D conversion (1) Transfer Idle A/D conversion (3) Idle Idle Clear*1 Idle A/D conversion result (3) A/D conversion result (2) A/D conversion result (4) Idle A/D conversion (5)*2 A/D conversion time A/D conversion (4) A/D conversion result (1) A/D conversion (2) Idle Notes: 1. Vertical arrows ( ) indicate instructions executed by software. 2. Data currently being converted is ignored. ADDRD ADDRC ADDRB ADDRA State of channel 3 (AN 3) State of channel 2 (AN 2) State of channel 1 (AN 1) State of channel 0 (AN 0) ADF ADST Set *1 Continuous A/D conversion Clear* 1 Section 15 A/D Converter Figure 15.4 Example of A/D Converter Operation (Scan Mode, Channels AN0 to AN2 Selected) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 547 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.4.3 Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time The A/D converter has a built-in sample-and-hold circuit. The A/D converter samples the analog input at a time tD after the ADST bit is set to 1, then starts conversion. Figure 15.5 shows the A/D conversion timing. Table 15.4 indicates the A/D conversion time. As indicated in figure 15.5, the A/D conversion time includes tD and the input sampling time. The length of tD varies depending on the timing of the write access to ADCSR. The total conversion time therefore varies within the ranges indicated in table 15.4. In scan mode, the values given in table 15.4 apply to the first conversion. In the second and subsequent conversions the conversion time is fixed at 256 states when CKS = 0 or 128 states when CKS = 1. (1) φ Address bus (2) Write signal Input sampling timing ADF t SPL tD t CONV Legend (1): ADCSR write cycle (2): ADCSR address tD : Synchronization delay t SPL : Input sampling time t CONV: A/D conversion time Figure 15.5 A/D Conversion Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 548 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter Table 15.4 A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode) CKS = 0 CKS = 1 Symbol Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Synchronization delay tD 10 — 17 6 — 9 Input sampling time tSPL — 63 — — 31 — A/D conversion time tCONV 259 — 266 131 — 134 Note: Values in the table are numbers of states. 15.4.4 External Trigger Input Timing A/D conversion can be externally triggered. When the TRGE bit is set to 1 in ADCR, external trigger input is enabled at the ADTRG pin. A high-to-low transition at the ADTRG pin sets the ADST bit to 1 in ADCSR, starting A/D conversion. Other operations, in both single and scan modes, are the same as if the ADST bit had been set to 1 by software. Figure 15.6 shows the timing. φ ADTRG Internal trigger signal ADST A/D conversion Figure 15.6 External Trigger Input Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 549 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 15.5 Interrupts The A/D converter generates an interrupt (ADI) at the end of A/D conversion. The ADI interrupt request can be enabled or disabled by the ADIE bit in ADCSR. 15.6 Usage Notes When using the A/D converter, note the following points: 1. Analog Input Voltage Range: During A/D conversion, the voltages input to the analog input pins should be in the range AVSS ≤ ANn ≤ VREF. 2. Relationships of AVCC and AVSS to VCC and VSS: AVCC, AVSS, VCC, and VSS should be related as follows: AVSS = VSS. AVCC and AVSS must not be left open, even if the A/D converter is not used. 3. VREF Programming Range: The reference voltage input at the VREF pin should be in the range VREF ≤ AVCC. 4. Analog Voltage: When using an A/D converter, make the following voltage settings. a. VCC ≥ AVCC – 0.3V b. AVCC ≥ VREF ≥ ANn ≥ AVSS = VSS (N = 0 to 7) Note: Restriction for the ZTAT version only; The S-mask version of ZTAT, the Flash Memory version and Mask ROM version can be used regularly without restriction. Failure to observe points 1, 2, 3, and 4 above may degrade chip reliability. 5. Note on Board Design: In board layout, separate the digital circuits from the analog circuits as much as possible. Particularly avoid layouts in which the signal lines of digital circuits cross or closely approach the signal lines of analog circuits. Induction and other effects may cause the analog circuits to operate incorrectly, or may adversely affect the accuracy of A/D conversion. The analog input signals (AN0 to AN7), analog reference voltage (VREF), and analog supply voltage (AVCC) must be separated from digital circuits by the analog ground (AVSS). The analog ground (AVSS) should be connected to a stable digital ground (VSS) at one point on the board. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 550 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 6. Note on Noise: To prevent damage from surges and other abnormal voltages at the analog input pins (AN0 to AN7) and analog reference voltage pin (VREF), connect a protection circuit like the one in figure 15.7 between AVCC and AVSS. The bypass capacitors connected to AVCC and VREF and the filter capacitors connected to AN0 to AN7 must be connected to AVSS. If filter capacitors like the ones in figure 15.7 are connected, the voltage values input to the analog input pins (AN0 to AN7) will be smoothed, which may give rise to error. Error can also occur if A/D conversion is frequently performed in scan mode so that the current that charges and discharges the capacitor in the sample-and-hold circuit of the A/D converter becomes greater than that input to the analog input pins via input impedance Rin. The circuit constants should therefore be selected carefully. AVCC VREF Rin*2 *1 100 Ω AN0 to AN7 *1 0.1 µF AVSS Notes: 1. Numeric values are approximate. 10 µF 0.01 µF 2. Rin: input impedance Figure 15.7 Example of Analog Input Protection Circuit Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 551 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 10 kΩ AN0 to AN7 To A/D converter 20 pF Note: Numeric values are approximate. Figure 15.8 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit Table 15.5 Analog Input Pin Ratings Item Min Max Unit Analog input capacitance — 20 pF Allowable signal-source impedance — 10* kΩ Note: * When VCC = 4.0 V to 5.5 V and φ ≤ 12 MHz. 7. A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions: A/D conversion accuracy in the H8/3048 Group is defined as follows: • Resolution • Offset error Digital output code length of A/D converter Deviation from ideal A/D conversion characteristic of analog input voltage required to raise digital output from minimum voltage value B'0000000000 to B'0000000001 (figure 15.10) • Full-scale error Deviation from ideal A/D conversion characteristic of analog input voltage required to raise digital output from B'1111111110 to B'1111111111 (figure 15.10) • Quantization error Intrinsic error of the A/D converter; 1/2 LSB (figure 15.9) • Nonlinearity error Deviation from ideal A/D conversion characteristic in range from zero volts to full scale, exclusive of offset error, full-scale error, and quantization error. • Absolute accuracy Deviation of digital value from analog input value, including offset error, full-scale error, quantization error, and nonlinearity error. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 552 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter Digital output 111 Ideal A/D conversion characteristic 110 101 100 011 010 Quantization error 001 000 1/8 2/8 3/8 4/8 5/8 6/8 7/8 FS Analog input voltage Figure 15.9 A/D Converter Accuracy Definitions (1) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 553 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter Full-scale error Digital output Ideal A/D conversion characteristic Nonlinearity error Actual A/D conversion characteristic FS Offset error Analog input voltage Figure 15.10 A/D Converter Accuracy Definitions (2) 8. Allowable Signal-Source Impedance: The analog inputs of the H8/3048 Group are designed to assure accurate conversion of input signals with a signal-source impedance not exceeding 10 kΩ. The reason for this rating is that it enables the input capacitor in the sample-and-hold circuit in the A/D converter to charge within the sampling time. If the sensor output impedance exceeds 10 kΩ, charging may be inadequate and the accuracy of A/D conversion cannot be guaranteed. If a large external capacitor is provided in scan mode, then the internal 10-kΩ input resistance becomes the only significant load on the input. In this case the impedance of the signal source is not a problem. A large external capacitor, however, acts as a low-pass filter. This may make it impossible to track analog signals with high dv/dt (e.g. a variation of 5 mV/µs) (figure 15.11). To convert high-speed analog signals or to use scan mode, insert a low-impedance buffer. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 554 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter 9. Effect on Absolute Accuracy: Attaching an external capacitor creates a coupling with ground, so if there is noise on the ground line, it may degrade absolute accuracy. The capacitor must be connected to an electrically stable ground, such as AVSS. If a filter circuit is used, be careful of interference with digital signals on the same board, and make sure the circuit does not act as an antenna. H8/3048 Group Sensor output impedance Sensor input 10 kΩ Up to 10 kΩ Low-pass filter Up to 0.1 µF Equivalent circuit of A/D converter Cin = 15 pF 20 pF Figure 15.11 Analog Input Circuit (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 555 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 15 A/D Converter Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 556 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 16 D/A Converter Section 16 D/A Converter 16.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group includes a D/A converter with two channels. 16.1.1 Features D/A converter features are listed below. • Eight-bit resolution • Two output channels • Conversion time: maximum 10 µs (with 20-pF capacitive load) • Output voltage: 0 V to 255/256 * VREF • D/A outputs can be sustained in software standby mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 557 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 16 D/A Converter 16.1.2 Block Diagram Bus interface Figure 16.1 shows a block diagram of the D/A converter. Module data bus DACR 8-bit D/A DADR1 DA 0 DADR0 AVCC DASTCR VREF DA 1 AVSS Legend DACR: D/A control register DADR0: D/A data register 0 DADR1: D/A data register 1 DASTCR: D/A standby control register Control circuit Figure 16.1 D/A Converter Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 558 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Internal data bus Section 16 D/A Converter 16.1.3 Input/Output Pins Table 16.1 summarizes the D/A converter’s input and output pins. Table 16.1 D/A Converter Pins Pin Name Abbreviation I/O Function Analog power supply pin AVCC Input Analog power supply Analog ground pin AVSS Input Analog ground and reference voltage Analog output pin 0 DA0 Output Analog output, channel 0 Analog output pin 1 DA1 Output Analog output, channel 1 Reference voltage input pin VREF Input Analog reference voltage 16.1.4 Register Configuration Table 16.2 summarizes the D/A converter’s registers. Table 16.2 D/A Converter Registers Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFDC D/A data register 0 DADR0 R/W H'00 H'FFDD D/A data register 1 DADR1 R/W H'00 H'FFDE D/A control register DACR R/W H'1F H'FF5C D/A standby control register DASTCR R/W H'FE Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 559 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 16 D/A Converter 16.2 Register Descriptions 16.2.1 D/A Data Registers 0 and 1 (DADR0/1) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W The D/A data registers (DADR0 and DADR1) are 8-bit readable/writable registers that store the data to be converted. When analog output is enabled, the D/A data register values are constantly converted and output at the analog output pins. The D/A data registers are initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode. 16.2.2 D/A Control Register (DACR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DAOE1 DAOE0 DAE — — — — — Initial value 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W — — — — — D/A enable Controls D/A conversion D/A output enable 0 Controls D/A conversion and analog output D/A output enable 1 Controls D/A conversion and analog output DACR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the operation of the D/A converter. DACR is initialized to H'1F by a reset and in standby mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 560 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 16 D/A Converter Bit 7—D/A Output Enable 1 (DAOE1): Controls D/A conversion and analog output. Bit 7: DAOE1 Description 0 DA1 analog output is disabled 1 Channel-1 D/A conversion and DA1 analog output are enabled (Initial value) Bit 6—D/A Output Enable 0 (DAOE0): Controls D/A conversion and analog output. Bit 6: DAOE0 Description 0 DA0 analog output is disabled 1 Channel-0 D/A conversion and DA0 analog output are enabled (Initial value) Bit 5—D/A Enable (DAE): Controls D/A conversion, together with bits DAOE0 and DAOE1. When the DAE bit is cleared to 0, analog conversion is controlled independently in channels 0 and 1. When the DAE bit is set to 1, analog conversion is controlled together in channels 0 and 1. Output of the conversion results is always controlled independently by DAOE0 and DAOE1. Bit 7: DAOE1 Bit 6: DAOE0 Bit 5: DAE 0 0 — D/A conversion is disabled in channels 0 and 1 1 0 D/A conversion is enabled in channel 0 Description D/A conversion is disabled in channel 1 1 0 1 D/A conversion is enabled in channels 0 and 1 0 D/A conversion is disabled in channel 0 1 D/A conversion is enabled in channels 0 and 1 — D/A conversion is enabled in channels 0 and 1 D/A conversion is enabled in channel 1 1 When the DAE bit is set to 1, even if bits DAOE0 and DAOE1 in DACR and the ADST bit in ADCSR are cleared to 0, the same current is drawn from the analog power supply as during A/D and D/A conversion. Bits 4 to 0—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 561 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 16 D/A Converter 16.2.3 D/A Standby Control Register (DASTCR) DASTCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables D/A output in software standby mode. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — — — DASTE Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 Read/Write — — — — — — — R/W Reserved bits D/A standby enable Enables or disables D/A output in software standby mode DASTCR is initialized to H'FE by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 1—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 0—D/A Standby Enable (DASTE): Enables or disables D/A output in software standby mode. Bit 0: DASTE Description 0 D/A output is disabled in software standby mode 1 D/A output is enabled in software standby mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 562 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 16 D/A Converter 16.3 Operation The D/A converter has two built-in D/A conversion circuits that can perform conversion independently. D/A conversion is performed constantly while enabled in DACR. If the DADR0 or DADR1 value is modified, conversion of the new data begins immediately. The conversion results are output when bits DAOE0 and DAOE1 are set to 1. An example of D/A conversion on channel 0 is given next. Timing is indicated in figure 16.2. 1. Data to be converted is written in DADR0. 2. Bit DAOE0 is set to 1 in DACR. D/A conversion starts and DA0 becomes an output pin. The converted result is output after the conversion time. The output value is (DADR0 contents/256) × VREF. Output of this conversion result continues until the value in DADR0 is modified or the DAOE0 bit is cleared to 0. 3. If the DADR0 value is modified, conversion starts immediately, and the result is output after the conversion time. 4. When the DAOE0 bit is cleared to 0, DA0 becomes an input pin. DADR0 write cycle DACR write cycle DADR0 write cycle DACR write cycle φ Address bus Conversion data 1 DADR0 Conversion data 2 DAOE0 DA 0 Conversion result 2 Conversion result 1 High-impedance state t DCONV t DCONV Legend t DCONV : D/A conversion time Figure 16.2 Example of D/A Converter Operation Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 563 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 16 D/A Converter 16.4 D/A Output Control In the H8/3048 Group, D/A converter output can be enabled or disabled in software standby mode. When the DASTE bit is set to 1 in DASTCR, D/A converter output is enabled in software standby mode. The D/A converter registers retain the values they held prior to the transition to software standby mode. When D/A output is enabled in software standby mode, the reference supply current is the same as during normal operation. 16.5 Usage Notes When using an D/A converter, note the following. 1. VCC ≥ AVCC – 0.3V 2. AVCC ≥ VREF ≥ ANn ≥ AVSS = VSS (N = 0 to 7) Note: Restriction for the ZTATTM version only; The S Mask version of ZTATTM, the Flash Memory version and Mask ROM version can be used regularly without restriction. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 564 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 17 RAM Section 17 RAM 17.1 Overview The H8/3048 and H8/3047 have 4 kbytes of high-speed static RAM on-chip. The H8/3045 and H8/3044 have 2 kbytes. The RAM is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data bus. The CPU accesses both byte data and word data in two states, making the RAM useful for rapid data transfer. The on-chip RAM of the H8/3048 and H8/3047 is assigned to addresses H'FEF10 to H'FFF0F in modes 1, 2, 5, and 7, and to addresses H'FFEF10 to H'FFFF0F in modes 3, 4, and 6. The on-chip RAM of the H8/3045 and H8/3044 are assigned to addresses H'FF710 to H'FFF0F in modes 1, 2, 5, and 7, and to addresses H'FFF710 to H'FFFF0F in modes 3, 4, and 6. The RAM enable bit (RAME) in the system control register (SYSCR) can enable or disable the on-chip RAM. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 565 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 17 RAM 17.1.1 Block Diagram Figure 17.1 shows a block diagram of the on-chip RAM. Internal data bus (upper 8 bits) Internal data bus (lower 8 bits) Bus interface H'FEF10* H'FEF11* H'FEF12* H'FEF13* SYSCR On-chip RAM H'FFF0E* Even addresses Legend SYSCR: System control register H'FFF0F* Odd addresses Note: * This example is of the H8/3048 operating in mode 7. The lower 20 bits of the address are shown. Figure 17.1 RAM Block Diagram 17.1.2 Register Configuration The on-chip RAM is controlled by SYSCR. Table 17.1 gives the address and initial value of SYSCR. Table 17.1 System Control Register Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFF2 System control register SYSCR R/W H'0B Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 566 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 17 RAM 17.2 System Control Register (SYSCR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSBY STS2 STS1 STS0 UE NMIEG — RAME Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W — R/W RAM enable Enables or disables on-chip RAM Reserved bit NMI edge select User bit enable Standby timer select 2 to 0 Software standby One function of SYSCR is to enable or disable access to the on-chip RAM. The on-chip RAM is enabled or disabled by the RAME bit in SYSCR. For details about the other bits, see section 3.3, System Control Register (SYSCR). Bit 0—RAM Enable (RAME): Enables or disables the on-chip RAM. The RAME bit is initialized at the rising edge of the input at the RES pin. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bit 0: RAME Description 0 On-chip RAM is disabled 1 On-chip RAM is enabled (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 567 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 17 RAM 17.3 Operation When the RAME bit is set to 1, the on-chip RAM is enabled. Accesses to addresses H'FEF10 to H'FFF0F in the H8/3048 and H8/3047 in modes 1, 2, 5, and 7, addresses H'FFEF10 to H'FFFF0F in the H8/3048 and H8/3047 in modes 3, 4, and 6, addresses H'FF710 to H'FFF0F in the H8/3045 and H8/3044 in modes 1, 2, 5, and 7, and addresses H'FFF710 to H'FFFF0F in the H8/3045 and H8/3044 in modes 3, 4, and 6 are directed to the on-chip RAM. In modes 1 to 6 (expanded modes), when the RAME bit is cleared to 0, the off-chip address space is accessed. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), when the RAME bit is cleared to 0, the on-chip RAM is not accessed: read access always results in H'FF data, and write access is ignored. Since the on-chip RAM is connected to the CPU by an internal 16-bit data bus, it can be written and read by word access. It can also be written and read by byte access. Byte data is accessed in two states using the upper 8 bits of the data bus. Word data starting at an even address is accessed in two states using all 16 bits of the data bus. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 568 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM Section 18 ROM (H8/3048ZTAT and Mask-ROM Versions) 18.1 Overview The H8/3048 has 128 kbytes of on-chip ROM, the H8/3047 has 96 kbytes, the H8/3045 has 64 kbytes and the H8/3044 has 32 kbytes. The ROM is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data bus. The CPU accesses both byte data and word data in two states, enabling rapid data transfer. The mode pins (MD2 to MD0) can be set to enable or disable the on-chip ROM as indicated in table 18.1. Table 18.1 Operating Mode and ROM Mode Pins Mode MD2 MD1 MD0 On-Chip ROM Mode 1 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 0 0 1 Mode 2 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 0 1 0 Disabled (external address area) Mode 3 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 0 1 1 Mode 4 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 1 0 0 Mode 5 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) 1 0 1 Mode 6 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) 1 1 0 Mode 7 (single-chip mode) 1 1 1 Enabled The PROM version (H8/3048ZTAT) can be set to PROM mode and programmed with a generalpurpose PROM programmer. Note: Care is required when changing from the H8/3048F-ONE to a model with on-chip mask ROM (H8/3048, H8/3047, H8/3045, or H8/3044). For details, refer to the H8/3048F-ONE Hardware Manual (Rev. 1.0) 1.4.5, Note on Changeover to Mask ROM Version. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 569 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM 18.1.1 Block Diagram Figure 18.1 shows a block diagram of the ROM. Internal data bus (upper 8 bits) Internal data bus (lower 8 bits) Bus interface H'0000 H'0001 H'0002 H'0003 On-chip ROM H'1FFFE H'1FFFF Even addresses Odd addresses Figure 18.1 ROM Block Diagram (H8/3048, Mode 7) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 570 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM 18.2 PROM Mode 18.2.1 PROM Mode Setting In PROM mode, the H8/3048 (H8/3048ZTAT) version with on-chip PROM suspends its microcontroller functions, enabling the on-chip PROM to be programmed. The programming method is the same as for the HN27C101, except that page programming is not supported. Table 18.2 indicates how to select PROM mode. Table 18.2 Selecting PROM Mode Pins Setting Three mode pins (MD2, MD1, MD0) Low STBY pin P51 and P50 18.2.2 High Socket Adapter and Memory Map The PROM is programmed using a general-purpose PROM programmer with a socket adapter to convert to 32 pins. Table 18.3 lists the socket adapter for each package option. Figure 18.2 shows the pin assignments of the socket adapter. Figure 18.3 shows a memory map in PROM mode. Table 18.3 Socket Adapter Microcontroller Package Socket Adapter H8/3048 100-pin QFP (FP-100B) HS3042ESHS1H 100-pin TQFP (TFP-100B) HS3042ESNS1H The size of the H8/3048 PROM is 128 kbytes. Figure 18.3 shows a memory map in PROM mode. H'FF data should be specified for unused address areas in the on-chip PROM. When programming the H8/3048 with a PROM programmer, set the address range to H'00000 to H'1FFFF. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 571 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM H8/3048 FP-100B, TFP-100B 10 64 58 87 88 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 77 76 1 35 68 73 74 75 62 86 11 22 44 57 65 92 Pin RESO NMI P6 0 P8 0 P8 1 P3 0 P3 1 P3 2 P3 3 P3 4 P3 5 P3 6 P3 7 P1 0 P1 1 P1 2 P1 3 P1 4 P1 5 P1 6 P1 7 P2 0 P2 1 P2 2 P2 3 P2 4 P2 5 P2 6 P2 7 P5 0 P5 1 VREF AVCC VCC VCC VCC MD0 MD1 MD2 STBY AVSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS Pin VPP EA 9 EA15 EA16 PGM EO0 EO1 EO2 EO3 EO4 EO5 EO6 EO7 EA 0 EA 1 EA 2 EA 3 EA 4 EA 5 EA 6 EA 7 EA 8 OE EA 10 EA 11 EA 12 EA 13 EA 14 CE VCC PROM Socket HN27C101 (32 Pins) 1 26 3 2 31 13 14 15 17 18 19 20 21 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 27 24 23 25 4 28 29 22 32 VSS Legend V PP : EO 7 to EO0 : EA16 to EA 0 : OE: CE: PGM: 16 Programming voltage (12.5 V) Data input/output Address input Output enable Chip enable Program Note: Pins not shown in this diagram should be left open. This figure shows pin assignments, and does not show the entire socket adapter circuit. When undertaking a new design, board design (power supply voltage stabilization, noise countermeasures, etc.) as a high-speed CMOS LSI is necessary. Figure 18.2 Socket Adapter Pin Assignments Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 572 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM Address in MCU mode Address in PROM mode H'00000 H'00000 On-chip PROM H'1FFFF H'1FFFF Figure 18.3 H8/3048ZTAT Memory Map in PROM Mode 18.3 PROM Programming Table 18.4 indicates how to select the program, verify, and other modes in PROM mode. Table 18.4 Mode Selection in PROM Mode Pins Mode CE OE PGM VPP VCC EO7 to EO0 EA16 to EA0 Program L H L VPP VCC Data input Address input Verify L L H VPP VCC Data output Address input Program inhibited L L L VPP VCC High impedance Address input L H H H L L H H H Legend L: Low voltage level H: High voltage level VPP: VPP voltage level VCC:VCC voltage level Read/write specifications are the same as for the standard HN27C101 EPROM, except that page programming is not supported. Do not select page programming mode. A PROM programmer that supports only page-programming mode cannot be used. When selecting a PROM programmer, check that it supports a byte-at-a-time high-speed programming mode. Be sure to set the address range to H'00000 to H'1FFFF. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 573 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM 18.3.1 Programming and Verification An efficient, high-speed programming procedure can be used to program and verify PROM data. This procedure programs the chip quickly without subjecting it to voltage stress and without sacrificing data reliability. Unused address areas contain H'FF data. Figure 18.4 shows the basic high-speed programming flowchart. Tables 18.5 and 18.6 list the electrical characteristics of the chip during programming. Figure 18.5 shows a timing chart. Start V Set programming/verification mode 6.0 V ± 0.25 V, V PP = 12.5 V ± 0.3 V CC= Address = 0 n=0 n + 1→ n No Yes n < 25 Program with t PW = 0.2 ms ± 5% No Address + 1 → address Verification OK? Yes Program with t OPW = 0.2n ms Last address? No Yes Set read mode V CC = 5.0 V ± 0.25 V, VPP = V CC No Fail All addresses read? Yes End Figure 18.4 High-Speed Programming Flowchart Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 574 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM Table 18.5 DC Characteristics in PROM Mode (Conditions: VCC = 6.0 V ± 0.25 V, VPP = 12.5 V ± 0.3 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ± 5°C) Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions Input high voltage EO7 to EO0, EA16 to EA0, OE, CE, PGM VIH 2.4 — VCC + 0.3 V Input low voltage EO7 to EO0, EA16 to EA0, OE, CE, PGM VIL –0.3 — 0.8 V Output high voltage EO7 to EO0 VOH 2.4 — — V IOH = –200 µA Output low voltage EO7 to EO0 VOL — — 0.45 V IOL = 1.6 mA Input leakage current EO7 to EO0, EA16 to EA0, OE, CE, PGM |ILI| — — 2 µA Vin = 5.25 V/0.5 V VCC current ICC — — 40 mA VPP current IPP — — 40 mA Note: For details on absolute maximum ratings, see section 22.1.1, Absolute Maximum Ratings. Using an LSI in excess of absolute maximum ratings may result in permanent damage. VPP peak overshoot should not exceed 13 V. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 575 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM Table 18.6 AC Characteristics in PROM Mode (Conditions: VCC = 6.0 V ± 0.25 V, VPP = 12.5 V ± 0.3 V, Ta = 25°C ± 5°C) Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions Address setup time tAS 2 — — µs Figure 18.5* OE setup time tOES 2 — — µs Data setup time tDS 2 — — µs Address hold time tAH 0 — — µs Data hold time tDH 2 — — µs 2 Data output disable time tDF* — — 130 ns VPP setup time tVPS 2 — — µs Programming pulse width tPW 0.19 0.20 0.21 ms PGM pulse width for overwrite programming tOPW * 0.19 — 5.25 ms VCC setup time tVCS 2 — — µs CE setup time tCES 2 — — µs Data output delay time tOE 0 — 150 ns 3 Notes: 1. Input pulse level: 0.8 V to 2.2 V Input rise time and fall time ≤ 20 ns Timing reference levels: 1.0 V and 2.0 V for input; 0.8 V and 2.0 V for output 2. tDF is defined at the point where the output is in the open state and the output level cannot be read. 3. tOPW is defined by the value given in the flowchart. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 576 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 1 Section 18 ROM Program Verify Address tAH tAS Data Input data tDS VPP VCC Output data tDH tDF VPP VCC tVPS VCC+1 VCC tVCS CE tCES PGM tPW OE tOES tOE tOPW* Note: * t OPW is defined by the value given in the flowchart. Figure 18.5 PROM Program/Verify Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 577 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM 18.3.2 Programming Precautions • Program with the specified voltages and timing. The programming voltage (VPP) in PROM mode is 12.5 V. Applied voltages in excess of the rated values can permanently destroy the chip. Be particularly careful about the PROM programmer’s overshoot characteristics. If the PROM programmer is set to Renesas Technology HN27C101 specifications, VPP will be 12.5 V. • Before programming, check that the chip is correctly mounted in the PROM programmer. Overcurrent damage to the chip can result if the index marks on the PROM programmer, socket adapter, and chip are not correctly aligned. • Don’t touch the socket adapter or chip while programming. Touching either of these can cause contact faults and write errors. • Select the programming mode carefully. The chip cannot be programmed in page programming mode. • The H8/3048 PROM size is 128 kbytes. Set the address range to H'00000 to H'1FFFF. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 578 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM 18.3.3 Reliability of Programmed Data A highly effective way to improve data retention characteristics is to bake the programmed chips at 150°C, then screen them for data errors. This procedure quickly eliminates chips with PROM memory cells prone to early failure. Figure 18.6 shows the recommended screening procedure. Program chip and verify programmed data Bake chip for 24 to 48 hours at 125 C to 150 C with power off Read and check program Install Figure 18.6 Recommended Screening Procedure If a series of programming errors occurs while the same PROM programmer is in use, stop programming and check the PROM programmer and socket adapter for defects. Please inform Renesas Technology of any abnormal conditions noted during or after programming or in screening of program data after high-temperature baking. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 579 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM 18.4 Notes on Ordering Mask ROM Version Chip When ordering the H8/3048 Group chips with a mask ROM, note the following. • When ordering through an EPROM, use a 128-kbyte one. • Fill all the unused addresses with H'FF as shown in figure 18.7 to make the ROM data size 128 kbytes for all H8/3048 Group chips, which incorporate different sizes of ROM. This applies to ordering through an EPROM and through electrical data transfer. HD6433048 (ROM: 128 kbytes) Address: H'00000–H'1FFFF HD6433047 (ROM: 96 kbytes) Address: H'00000–H'17FFF H'00000 HD6433045 (ROM: 64 kbytes) Address: H'00000–H'0FFFF H'00000 HD6433044 (ROM: 32 kbytes) Address: H'00000–H'07FFF H'00000 H'00000 H'07FFF H'08000 H'0FFFF H'10000 Not used* H'17FFF H'18000 Not used* Not used* H'1FFFF H'1FFFF H'1FFFF Note: * Program H'FF to all addresses in these areas. Figure 18.7 Masked ROM Addresses and Data Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 580 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 H'1FFFF Section 18 ROM • The flash memory control registers (FLMCR, EBR1, EBR2, and RAMCR)* for use only by the on-chip flash memory version (H8/3048F (dual-power-supply model)) are not provided in the mask ROM version. Reading a corresponding address will always return a value of 1, and writes to the corresponding addresses are invalid. This point must be noted when switching from a flash memory model to a mask ROM version. • In the case of the H8/3048F-ONE (single-power-supply model) on-chip flash memory version, the 5 V version has a VCL pin and requires connection of an external capacitor. Care is therefore required with the board design when switching to a mask ROM version. (For details, see section 1.4.5, Notes on Switching to Mask ROM Version, in the H8/3048F-ONE Hardware Manual (First Edition). Note: * In the H8/3048F-ONE with on-chip flash memory, the flash memory control registers are FLMCR1, FLMCR2, EBR, and RAMCR. (For details, see appendix B, Internal I/O Registers, in the H8/3048F-ONE Hardware Manual (First Edition)). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 581 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 18 ROM Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 582 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.1 Overview The H8/3048F has 128 kbytes of on-chip flash memory. The flash memory is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data bus. The CPU accesses both byte data and word data in two states, enabling rapid data transfer. The mode pins (MD2 to MD0) can be set to enable or disable the on-chip ROM as indicated in table 19.1. Table 19.1 Operating Mode and ROM Mode Pins Mode MD2 MD1 MD0 On-Chip ROM Mode 1 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 0 0 1 Mode 2 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 0 1 0 Disabled (external address area) Mode 3 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 0 1 1 Mode 4 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM disabled) 1 0 0 Mode 5 (1-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) 1 0 1 Mode 6 (16-Mbyte expanded mode with on-chip ROM enabled) 1 1 0 Mode 7 (single-chip mode) 1 1 1 Enabled The H8/3048F (dual-power supply flash memory version) can be set to PROM mode and programmed with a general-purpose PROM programmer. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 583 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.2 Flash Memory Overview 19.2.1 Flash Memory Operation Table 19.2 illustrates the principle of operation of the on-chip flash memory of the H8/3048F (dual-power supply). Like EPROM, flash memory is programmed by applying a high gate-to-drain voltage that draws hot electrons generated in the vicinity of the drain into a floating gate. The threshold voltage of a programmed memory cell is therefore higher than that of an erased cell. Cells are erased by grounding the gate and applying a high voltage to the source, causing the electrons stored in the floating gate to tunnel out. After erasure, the threshold voltage drops. A memory cell is read like an EPROM cell, by driving the gate to the high level and detecting the drain current, which depends on the threshold voltage. Erasing must be done carefully, because if a memory cell is overerased, its threshold voltage may become negative, causing the cell to operate incorrectly. Section 19.5.6, Erasing Flowchart and Sample Program shows an optimal erase control flowchart and sample program. Table 19.2 Principle of Memory Cell Operation Erase Program Memory cell Memory array Read Vg = VPP Vg = VCC Vs = VPP Vd Vd 0V Open Open Open Vd Vd 0V VPP 0V VCC 0V VPP 0V 0V 0V 0V Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 584 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.2.2 Mode Programming and Flash Memory Address Space As its on-chip ROM, the H8/3048F has 128 kbytes of flash memory. The flash memory is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data bus. The CPU accesses both byte data and word data in two states. The flash memory is assigned to addresses H'00000 to H'1FFFF on the memory map. The mode pins enable either on-chip flash memory or external memory to be selected for this area. Table 19.3 summarizes the mode pin settings and usage of the flash memory area. Table 19.3 Mode Pin Settings and Flash Memory Area Mode Pin Setting Mode MD2 MD1 MD0 Flash Memory Area Usage Mode 0 0 0 0 Illegal setting Mode 1 0 0 1 External memory area Mode 2 0 1 0 External memory area Mode 3 0 1 1 External memory area Mode 4 1 0 0 External memory area Mode 5 1 0 1 On-chip flash memory area Mode 6 1 1 0 On-chip flash memory area Mode 7 1 1 1 On-chip flash memory area Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 585 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.2.3 Features Features of the flash memory are listed below. • Five flash memory operating modes The flash memory has five operating modes: program mode, program-verify mode, erase mode, erase-verify mode, and prewrite-verify mode. • Block erase designation Blocks to be erased in the flash memory address space can be selected by bit settings. The address space includes a large-block area (eight blocks with sizes from 12 kbytes to 16 kbytes) and a small-block area (eight 512-byte blocks). • Program and erase time Programming one byte of flash memory typically takes 50 µs. Erasing all blocks (128 kbytes) typically takes 1 s. • Erase-program cycles Flash memory contents can be erased and reprogrammed up to 100 times. • On-board programming modes These modes can be used to program, erase, and verify flash memory contents. There are two modes: boot mode, and user programming mode. • Automatic bit-rate alignment In boot-mode data transfer, the H8/3048F aligns its bit rate automatically to the host bit rate (9600 bps, 4800 bps and 2400 bps). • Flash memory emulation by RAM Part of the RAM area can be overlapped onto flash memory, to emulate flash memory updates in real time. • PROM mode As an alternative to on-board programming, the flash memory can be programmed and erased in PROM mode, using a general-purpose PROM programmer. • Protect modes Flash memory can be program-, erase-, and/or verify-protected in hardware and software protect modes. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 586 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.2.4 Block Diagram Figure 19.1 shows a block diagram of the flash memory. 8 Internal data bus (upper) 8 Internal data bus (lower) FLMCR Bus interface and control section EBR1 H'00000 H'00001 H'00002 H'00003 H'00004 H'00005 On-chip flash memory (128 kbytes) H'1FFFC H'1FFFD H'1FFFE H'1FFFF EBR2 Upper byte (even address) Operating mode MD2 MD1 MD0 Lower byte (odd address) Legend FLMCR: Flash memory control register* EBR1: Erase block register 1* EBR2: Erase block register 2* Note: * The flash memory control registers (FLMCR, EBR1, and EBR2) and RAMCR are used only by the flash memory version, and must not be accessed in the mask ROM (ZTAT) version. Figure 19.1 Flash Memory Block Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 587 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.2.5 Input/Output Pins Flash memory is controlled by the pins listed in table 19.4. Table 19.4 Flash Memory Pins Pin Name Abbreviation Input/Output Function Programming power VPP Power supply Apply 12.0 V Mode 2 MD2 Input H8/3048F operating mode programming Mode 1 MD1 Input H8/3048F operating mode programming Mode 0 MD0 Input H8/3048F operating mode programming Transmit data TXD1 Output Serial transmit data output Receive data RXD1 Input Serial receive data input The transmit data and receive data pins are used in boot mode. 19.2.6 Register Configuration The flash memory is controlled by the registers listed in table 19.5. Table 19.5 Flash Memory Registers Address Name H'FF40 3 Flash memory control register* Abbreviation R/W Initial Value FLMCR 2 R/W * H'00* H'FF42 Erase block register 1* 3 EBR1 R/W * 2 H'00* H'FF43 Erase block register 2* 3 EBR2 R/W * 2 H'00* H'FF48 RAM control register RAMCR R/W H'70 1 1 1 Notes: 1. The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). 2. In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. 3. Dedicated registers for controlling flash memory, which are not provided by the maskROM and ZTAT versions. Therefore, these registers must not be accessed in the maskROM and ZTAT versions. These registers cannot be modified in the mask-ROM and ZTAT versions. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 588 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.3 Flash Memory Register Descriptions 19.3.1 Flash Memory Control Register The flash memory control register (FLMCR) is an eight-bit register that controls the flash memory operating modes. Transitions to program mode, erase mode, program-verify mode, and eraseverify mode are made by setting bits in this register. FLMCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset, in the standby modes, and when 12 V is not applied to VPP. When 12 V is applied to VPP, a reset or entry to a standby mode initializes FLMCR to H'80. Bit Initial value* R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 VPP VPP E — — EV PV E P 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 — R/W* R/W* R/W * R/W * R R/W — Program mode Designates transition to or exit from program mode Erase mode Designates transition to or exit from erase mode Program-verify mode Designates transition to or exit from program-verify mode Erase-verify mode Designates transition to or exit from erase-verify mode Reserved bits VPP enable Disables or enables 12-V application to VPP pin Programming power Status flag indicating the power to VPP Note: * The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 589 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Bit 7—Programming Power (VPP): Programming power bit (VPP) detects VPP, and level is displayed as “1” or “0.” The permissible output currents for impressed high voltage VH are given in 22.2.2, “DC Characteristics.” The value of VH ranges from VCC + 2 V to 11.4 V. If a voltage in excess of VH is applied, “1” is displayed; otherwise “0” is displayed. This bit restricts the hardware protect functions during write and erase operations for the flash memory. For details on hardware protect, see section 19.5.8, “Protect Modes.” For notes on VPP usage, see section 19.8, “Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply).” Bit 7: VPP Description 0 [Clear condition] (Initial value) This is the regular operational mode when a voltage exceeding VH is not applied to the VPP pin. The flash memory cannot be written or erased. “Hardware Protect” is displayed. 1 [Set condition] This is the operational mode when a voltage exceeding VH is applied to the VPP pin. The flash memory can be written and erased. “Hardware Protect Disabled” is displayed*. Note: * For correct write and erase functions, the setting should be VPP = 12.0 V to 0.6 V (11.4 V to 12.6 V). Bit 6—VPP Enable (VPPE): Disables or enables 12-V application to the VPP pin. After this bit is set, it is necessary to wait for at least 5 µs for the internal power supply to stabilize; programming and erasing cannot be performed until stabilization is complete. After this bit is cleared, it is necessary to wait for the flash memory read setup time (tFRS) in order to read flash memory. Bit 6: VPPE Description 0 VPP pin 12-V power supply is disabled 1 VPP pin 12-V supply is enabled (Initial value) Note: The power supply system used for the flash memory is switched by means of the VppE bit. After switching, operation is not guaranteed during the period before the power supply system stabilizes. It is therefore prohibited to fetch from flash memory and execute an instruction that sets or resets the VppE bit. Bits 5 and 4—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 590 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Bit 3—Erase-Verify Mode (EV)*1: Selects transition to or exit from erase-verify mode. Bit 3: EV Description 0 Exit from erase-verify mode 1 Transition to erase-verify mode (Initial value) Bit 2—Erase-Verify Mode (PV)*1: Selects transition to or exit from program-verify mode. Bit 2: PV Description 0 Exit from program-verify mode 1 Transition to program-verify mode (Initial value) Bit 1—Erase Mode (E)*1 *2: Selects transition to or exit from erase mode. Bit 1: E Description 0 Exit from erase mode 1 Transition to erase mode (Initial value) Bit 0—Program Mode (P)*1 *2: Selects transition to or exit from program mode. Bit 0: P Description 0 Exit from program mode 1 Transition to program mode (Initial value) Notes: 1. Do not set two or more of these bits simultaneously. Do not turn off power supply (VCC–VPP) while a bit is set. 2. For each bit setting procedure, follow the algorithm described in section 19.5, Programming and Erasing Flash Memory. For the notes on programming and erasing, refer to section 19.8, Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (DualPower Supply). Particularly, be sure to set the watchdog timer beforehand to prevent program runaway, when the E or P bit is set. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 591 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.3.2 Erase Block Register 1 Erase block register 1 (EBR1) is an eight-bit register that designates large flash-memory blocks for programming and erasure. EBR1 is initialized to H'00 by a reset, in the standby modes, when 12 V is applied to VPP while the VPPE bit is 0, and when 12 V is not applied to VPP. When a bit in EBR1 is set to 1, the corresponding block is selected and can be programmed and erased. Figure 19.2 shows a block map. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LB7 LB6 LB5 LB4 LB3 LB2 LB1 LB0 Initial value* 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* Note: * The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. Bits 7 to 0—Large Block 7 to 0 (LB7 to LB0): These bits select large blocks (LB7 to LB0) to be programmed and erased. Bits 7 to 0: LB7 to LB0 Description 0 Block LB7 to LB0 is not selected 1 Block LB7 to LB0 is selected Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 592 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.3.3 Erase Block Register 2 Erase block register 2 (EBR2) is an eight-bit register that designates small flash-memory blocks for programming and erasure. EBR2 is initialized to H'00 by a reset, in the standby modes, when 12 V is applied to VPP while the VPPE bit is 0, and when 12 V is not applied to VPP. When a bit in EBR2 is set to 1, the corresponding block is selected and can be programmed and erased. Figure 19.2 shows a block map. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SB7 SB6 SB5 SB4 SB3 SB2 SB1 SB0 Initial value* 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* Note: * The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. Bits 7 to 0—Small Block 7 to 0 (SB7 to SB0): These bits select small blocks (SB7 to SB0) to be programmed and erased. Bits 7 to 0: SB7 to SB0 Description 0 Block SB7 to SB0 is not selected 1 Block SB7 to SB0 is selected (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 593 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Bit Addresses LB0 H'00000–H'03FFF LB1 H'04000–H'07FFF LB2 H'08000–H'0BFFF LB3 H'0C000–H'0FFFF LB4 H'10000–H'13FFF LB5 H'14000–H'17FFF LB6 H'18000–H'1BFFF LB7 H'1C000-H'1EFFF SB0 H'1F000–H'1F1FF SB1 H'1F200–H'1F3FF SB2 H'1F400–H'1F5FF SB3 H'1F600–H'1F7FF SB4 H'1F800–H'1F9FF SB5 H'1FA00–H'1FBFF SB6 H'1FC00–H'1FDFF SB7 H'1FE00–H'1FFFF H'00000 Large block area (124 kbytes) Small block area (4 kbytes) H'03FFF H'04000 H'07FFF H'08000 H'0BFFF H'0C000 H'0FFFF H'10000 H'13FFF H'14000 H'17FFF H'18000 H'1BFFF H'1C000 H'1EFFF H'1F000 H'1F1FF H'1F200 H'1F3FF H'1F400 H'1F5FF H'1F600 H'1F7FF H'1F800 H'1F9FF H'1FA00 H'1FBFF H'1FC00 H'1FDFF H'1FE00 H'1FFFF Figure 19.2 Erase Block Map Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 594 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 16 kbytes 16 kbytes 16 kbytes 16 kbytes 16 kbytes 16 kbytes 16 kbytes 12 kbytes 512 bytes 512 bytes 512 bytes 512 bytes 512 bytes 512 bytes 512 bytes 512 bytes Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.3.4 RAM Control Register (RAMCR) The RAM control register (RAMCR) enables flash-memory updates to be emulated in RAM, and indicates flash memory errors. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FLER — — — RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 Initial value 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Bit 7—Flash Memory Error (FLER): Indicates that an error occurred while flash memory was being programmed or erased. When bit 7 is set, flash memory is placed in an error-protect mode.*1 Bit 7: FLER Description 0 Flash memory is not write/erase-protected (is not in error protect mode* ) (Initial value) 1 [Clearing condition] Reset or hardware standby mode 1 Indicates that an error occurred while flash memory was being programmed or 1 erased, and error protection* is in effect [Setting conditions] 2 Flash memory was read* while being programmed or erased (including vector or instruction fetch, but not including reading of a RAM area overlapped onto flash memory). A hardware exception-handling sequence (other than a reset, trace exception, invalid instruction, trap instruction, or zero-divide exception) was executed just before programming or erasing. The SLEEP instruction (for transition to sleep mode or software standby mode) was executed during programming or erasing. A bus was released during programming or erasing. Notes: 1. For details, see section 19.5.8, Protect Modes. 2. The read data has undetermined values. Bits 6 to 4—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Bit 3—RAM Select (RAMS)*: Is used with bits 2 to 0 to reassign an area to RAM (see table 19.6). When bit 3 is set, all flash-memory blocks are protected from programming and erasing, regardless of the values of bits 2 to 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 595 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) It is initialized by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 2 to 0—RAM2 to RAM0*: These bits are used with bit 3 to reassign an area to RAM (see table 19.6). They are initialized by a reset and in hardware standby mode. They are not initialized in software standby mode. Note: * These bits can be written to in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In other modes, they are always read as 0 and cannot be modified. Table 19.6 RAM Area Reassignment Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RAM Area RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF 0 0/1 0/1 0/1 H'01F000 to H'01F1FF 1 0 0 0 H'01F200 to H'01F3FF 1 0 0 1 H'01F400 to H'01F5FF 1 0 1 0 H'01F600 to H'01F7FF 1 0 1 1 H'01F800 to H'01F9FF 1 1 0 0 H'01FA00 to H'01FBFF 1 1 0 1 H'01FC00 to H'01FDFF 1 1 1 0 H'01FE00 to H'01FFFF 1 1 1 1 19.4 On-Board Programming Modes When an on-board programming mode is selected, the on-chip flash memory can be programmed, erased, and verified. There are two on-board programming modes: boot mode, and user program mode. These modes are selected by inputs at the mode pins (MD2 to MD0) and VPP pin. Table 19.7 indicates how to select the on-board programming modes. For information about turning VPP on and off, see note (4) in section 19.8, Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (DualPower Supply). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 596 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Table 19.7 On-Board Programming Mode Selection Mode Selections Boot mode User program mode 19.4.1 VPP MD2 MD1 MD0 Notes 12 V 12 V 0 1 0: VIL Mode 6 12 V 1 0 1: VIH Mode 7 12 V 1 1 Mode 5 1 0 1 Mode 6 1 1 0 Mode 7 1 1 1 Mode 5 Boot Mode To use boot mode, a user program for programming and erasing the flash memory must be provided in advance on the host machine (which may be a personal computer). Serial communication interface 1 (SCI1) is used in asynchronous mode (see figure 19.3). If the H8/3048F is placed in boot mode, after it comes out of reset, a built-in boot program is activated. This program starts by measuring the low period of data transmitted from the host and setting the bit rate register (BRR) accordingly. The H8/3048F’s built-in serial communication interface (SCI) can then be used to download the user program from the host machine. The user program is stored in on-chip RAM. After the program has been stored, execution branches to address H'FF300 in modes 5 and 6 and H'FFF300 in mode 7 in the on-chip RAM, and the program stored on RAM is executed to program and erase the flash memory. Figure 19.4 shows the boot-mode execution procedure. H8/3048F Receive data to be programmed HOST Transmit verification data RXD1 SCI1 TXD1 Figure 19.3 Boot-Mode System Configuration Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 597 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Boot-Mode Execution Procedure: Figure 19.4 shows the boot-mode execution procedure. Start 1. Program the H8/3048F pins for boot mode, and start the H8/3048F from a reset. 1 Program H8/3048F pins for boot mode, and resets. 2 Host transmits H'00 data continuously at desired bit rate. 2. Set the host's data format to 8 bits + 1 stop bit, select the desired bit rate (2400, 4800 or 9600), and transmit H'00 data continuously. H8/3048F measures H'00 low period for data transmitted from the host. 3. H8/3048F measures the duration of repeat when the RDX pin is "Low," then computes the bit rate of the serial transmission from the host. H8/3048F computes the bit rate, then sets the value in the bit rate register. 4. After H8/3048F completes SCI bit rate adjustment, one byte of H'00 data is transmitted to indicate completion. 4 After completing bit rate adjustment, H8/3048F transmits one H'00 byte to the host to indicate completion. 5. On receiving one byte from H8/3048F to indicate completion of bit rate adjustment, the host confirms regular reception then transmits one byte of H'55. H8/3048F transmits H'AA to indicate regular reception. 5 The host confirms that bit rate adjustment was completed successfully, then transmits one H'55 byte. 6 H8/3048F receives, as 2 bytes, number of program bytes (N) to be transferred to on-chip RAM*1 3 6. The host transmits the number of user program bytes to be transferred to the H8/3048F. The number of bytes should be sent as two bytes, upper byte followed by lower byte. The host should then sequentially transmit the program set by the user. The H8/3048F transmits the received byte count and user program sequentially to the host, one byte at a time, as verify data (echo-back). H8/3048F transfers user program to RAM*2 7. The H8/3048F sequentially writes the received user program to on-chip RAM area H'FFF300 to H'FFFEFF. 8. The H8/3048F transfers part of the boot program to on-chip RAM area H'FFEF10 to H'FFF2FF. H8/3048F calculates remaining bytes to be transferred (N = N–1) No 7 Transfer end byte count N = 0? 8 H8/3048F transfers part of boot program to RAM Yes 9. The H8/3048F branches to the RAM boot program area (H'FFEF10 to H'FFF2FF) and checks for the presence of data written in the flash memory. If data has been written in the flash memory, the H8/3048F erases all blocks. When erasing ends normally, the H8/3048F transmits one H'AA byte. 10. The H8/3048F branches to on-chip RAM address H'FFF300 and executes the user program written in that area. H8/3048F branches to RAM boot area, then checks flash memory user area data 9 10 Notes: 1. The user can use 3072 bytes of RAM. The number of bytes transferred must not exceed 3072 bytes. Be sure to transmit the byte length in two bytes, most No significant byte first and least significant byte second. All data = H'FF? For example, if the byte length of the program to be transferred is 256 bytes, (H'0100), transmit H'01 as Yes Delete all flash memory the most significant byte, followed by H'00 as the blocks*3,*4 least significant byte. 2. The part of the user program that controls the flash memory should be coded according to the flash H8/3048F confirms that all flash memory program/erase algorithms given later. memory data is H'FF, then 3. If a memory cell malfunctions and cannot be erased, transmits one H'AA byte to host the H8/3048F transmits one H'FF byte to report an erase error, halts erasing, and halts further H8/3048F branches to RAM area operations. address H'FFF300 and executes 4. The allotted boot program area is H'FFF300 to user program transferred to RAM H'FFFEFF. Figure 19.4 Boot Mode Flowchart Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 598 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Automatic Alignment of SCI Bit Rate Start bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Stop bit This low period (9 bits) is measured (H'00 data) High for at least 1 bit Figure 19.5 Measurement of Low Period in Data Transmitted from Host When started in boot mode, the H8/3048F measures the low period in asynchronous SCI data transmitted from the host (figure 19.5). The data format is eight data bits, one stop bit, and no parity bit. From the measured low period (nine bits), the H8/3048F computes the host’s transmission bit rate. After aligning its own bit rate, the H8/3048F sends the host one byte of H'00 data to indicate that bit-rate alignment is completed. The host should check that this alignmentcompleted indication is received normally, then transmit one H'55 byte. If the host does not receive a normal alignment-completed indication, the H8/3048F should be reset, then restarted in boot mode to measure the low period again. There may be some alignment error between the host’s and H8/3048F’s bit rates, depending on the host’s bit rate and the H8/3048F’s system clock frequency. To have the SCI operate normally, set the host’s bit rate to a value 2400, 4800, or 9600 bps*1. Table 19.8 lists typical host bit rates and indicates the clock-frequency ranges over which the H8/3048F can align its bit rate automatically. Boot mode should be used within these frequency ranges.*2 Table 19.8 System Clock Frequencies Permitting Automatic Bit-Rate Alignment by H8/3048F Host Bit Rate* 1 System Clock Frequencies Permitting Automatic Bit-Rate Alignment by H8/3048F 9600 bps 8 MHz to 16 MHz 4800 bps 4 MHz to 16 MHz 2400 bps 2 MHz to 16 MHz Notes: 1. Host bit rate settings are 2400, 4800, and 9600 bps; no other settings should be used. 2. Although the H8/3048F may perform automatic bit-rate alignment with combinations of bit rate and system clock other than those shown in table 19.8, there may be a discrepancy between the bit rates of the host and the H8/3048F, preventing subsequent transfer from being performed normally. Boot mode execution should therefore be confined to the range of combinations shown in table 19.8. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 599 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) RAM Area Allocation in Boot Mode: In boot mode, the H'3F0 bytes from H'FEF10 to H'FF2FF in modes 5 and 7, and from H'FFEF10 to H'FFF2FF in mode 6 are reserved for use by the boot program. The user program is transferred into the area from H'FF300 to H'FFEFF, in modes 5 and 7, and from H'FFF300 to H'FFFEFF in mode 6 (H'C00 bytes). The boot program area is used during the transition to execution of the user program transferred into RAM. H'FEF10 H'FFEF10 Boot program area*1 H'FF300 Boot program area*1 H'FFF300 User program transfer area (H'C00 bytes) H'FFEFF H'FFF00 H'FFF0F User program transfer area (H'C00 bytes) H'FFFEFF Reserved*2 H'FFFF00 H'FFFF0F Modes 5 and 7 Reserved*2 Mode 6 Notes: 1. This area is unavailable until the user program transferred into RAM enters execution state (branch to H'FF300 in modes 5 and 7, and H'FFF300 in mode 6). After branching to the user program area, the boot program is retained in the boot program area (H'FEF10 to H'FF2FF in modes 5 and 7, and H'FFEF10 to H'FFF2FF in mode 6). 2. Do not use reversed areas. Figure 19.6 RAM Areas in Boot Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 600 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Notes on Use of Boot Mode 1. When the H8/3048F comes out of reset in boot mode, it measures the low period of the input at the SCI1’s RXD1 pin. The reset should end with RXD1 high. After the reset ends, it takes about 100 states for the H8/3048F to get ready to measure the low period of the RXD1 input. 2. In boot mode, if any data has been programmed into the flash memory (if all data are not H'FF), all flash memory blocks are erased. Boot mode is for use when user program mode is unavailable, e.g. the first time on-board programming is performed, or if the update program activated in user program mode is accidentally erased. 3. Interrupts cannot be used while the flash memory is being programmed or erased. 4. The RXD1 and TXD1 lines should be pulled up on-board. 5. Before branching to the user program (at address H'F300 in the RAM area), the H8/3048F terminates transmit and receive operations by the on-chip SCI (channel 1) (by clearing the RE and TE bits in serial control register (SCR) to 0 in channel 1), but the auto-aligned bit rate remains set in bit rate register BRR1. The transmit data pin (TXD1) is in the high output state (in port 9, the P91DDR bit in port 9 data direction register P9DDR and P91DR bit in port 9 data register are set to 1). When the branch to the user program occurs, the contents of general registers in the CPU are undetermined. After the branch, the user program should begin by initializing general registers, especially the stack pointer (SP), which is used implicitly in subroutine calls and at other times. The stack pointer must be set to provide a stack area for use by the user program. The other on-chip registers do not have specific initialization requirements. 6. Transition to boot mode are shown in figure 19.7, User Program Mode Operation (Example). This is possible after applying 12 V to pins MD2 and VPP and restarting. In this case, H8/3048F reset is erased (startup with Low → High) timing*1, mode pin status latches the personal computer internally to maintain boot mode. Boot mode can be erased if the 12 V applied to the MD2 pin and the VPP pin is erased, then reset is erased*1. However, please note the following. a. When transferring from boot mode to regular mode (VPP ≠ 12 V, MD2 ≠ 12 V), before transfer the erase must be carried out by the reset input personal computer internal boot mode RES pin. After VPP interrupt, erase reset. The time needed until reset vector lead is flash memory read setup (tFRS)*2. b. While in boot mode, if the 12 V applied to the MD2 pin is erased, as long as reset input from the RES pin does not occur, the personal computer internal boot mode status will be maintained and boot mode will continue. In boot mode, if watchdog timer reset occur, the personal computer internal boot mode is not erased, and despite mode pin status the internal boot program restarts. c. When transferring to boot mode (reset erase timing) or during boot mode operation, program voltage VPP should be within the range 12 V to 0.6 V. If this range is exceeded, Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 601 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) boot mode will not operate correctly. In addition, during boot program operation or writing and erasing the flash memory, do not interrupt VPP*2. 7. During reset (when RES pin input is Low), if MD2 pin input changes from 0 V to 12 V or vice versa, by instantaneous transfer to 5 V input, the personal computer switches to operation mode. As a result, the address port or bus control output signal (AS, RD, HWR, LWR) status changes, so do not these pins as output signals during reset, as the personal computer internal section needs to be shut down. 8. Regarding 12 V application to the VPP and MD2 pins, insure that peak overshoot does not exceed the maximum rating of 13 V. Also, be sure to connect bypass capacitors to the Vpp and MD2 pins*1. Notes: 1. Mode pin input must satisfy the mode programming setup time (tMDS) with respect to the reset release timing. When 12 V is applied to or disconnected from the MD2 pin, a delay occurs in the fall and rise waveforms due to the influence of the pull-up/pulldown resistor connected to the MD2 pin, etc. For reset release timing, therefore, this delay must be confirmed with the actual waveform on the board. 2. For notes on applying and cutting VPP, refer to 19.8, note (4) of “Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply).” 19.4.2 User Program Mode When set to user program mode, the H8/3048F can erase and program its flash memory by executing a user program. On-board updates of the on-chip flash memory can be carried out by providing on-board circuits for supplying VPP and data, and storing an update program in part of the program area. To select user program mode, select a mode that enables the on-chip ROM (mode 5, 6, or 7) and apply 12 V to the VPP pin. In this mode, the on-chip peripheral modules operate as they normally would in mode 5, 6, or 7, except for the flash memory. A watchdog timer overflow, however, cannot output a reset signal while 12 V is applied to VPP. The watchdog timer’s reset output enable bit (RSTOE) should not be set to 1. The flash memory cannot be read while being programmed or erased, so the update program must either be stored in external memory, or transferred temporarily to the RAM area and executed in RAM. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 602 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) User Program Mode Execution Procedure: Figure 19.7 shows the procedure for user program mode execution in RAM. Procedure 1 Store user application programs Set MD2 to MD0 to 101, 110, or 111 Apply 0 to 5 V to MD2 2 VPP = 12 V (user program mode) 3 Transfer on-board update program into RAM Execute on-board update program in RAM Set VPPE bit 4 Wait 5 to 10 µs 1. The user stores application programs in flash memory. One of these is an on-board update program that will execute steps 3 to 5 below. 2. Pin inputs are set up for user program mode. 3. A reset starts the CPU, which transfers the on-board update program into RAM. 4. Following a branch to the program in RAM, the on-board update program is executed. VPPE bit in FLMCR is set to update flash memory. Wait 5 to 10 µs to stabilize internal power supply. Update program is executed. 5. After the on-board update ends, clear the VPPE bit then a branch is made to the updated user application program and this program is executed. After clearing the VPPE bit, before the flash memory program executes, flash memory read setup time (tFRS) is needed. Update flash memory 5 Execute user application program Note: To prevent microcontroller errors caused by accidental programming or erasing, apply 12 V to VPP only when the flash memory is programmed or erased, or when flash memory is emulated by RAM; do not apply 12 V to the VPP pin during normal operation. While 12 V is applied, the watchdog timer should be running and enabled to halt runaway program execution, so that program runaway will not lead to overprogramming or overerasing. For further information about turning VPP on and off, see section 19.8, Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply). Figure 19.7 User Program Mode Operation (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 603 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.5 Programming and Erasing Flash Memory The H8/3048F’s on-chip flash memory is programmed and erased by software, using the CPU. The flash memory operating modes and state transition diagram are shown in figure 19.8. Program/erase modes comprise program mode, erase mode, program-verify mode, erase-verify mode, and prewrite-verify mode. Transitions to these modes can be made by setting the P, E, PV, and EV bits in the flash memory control register (FLMCR). Transition to the prewrite-verify mode can also be made by clearing all the bits in FLMCR. The flash memory cannot be read while being programmed or erased. The program that controls the programming and erasing of the flash memory must be stored and executed in on-chip RAM or in external memory. A description of each mode is given below, with recommended flowcharts and sample programs for programming and erasing. High-reliability programming and erasing algorithms are used, which double the programming or erase processing time for each step. Section 19.8, Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply), gives further notes on programming and erasing. Normal ROM access mode VPPE= 0 VPP off VPP= 12 V and VPPE= 1 Prewrite-verify mode P= 1 P= 0 Program mode E= 1 Erase mode EV= 0 PV= 0 E= 0 PV= 1 Flash memory program/erase operations EV= 1 Program-verify mode Erase-verify mode Note: Do not perform simultaneous setting/clearing of the P, E, PV, and EV bits. Figure 19.8 Flash Memory Program/Erase Operating Mode State Transition Diagram Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 604 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.5.1 Program Mode To write data into the flash memory, follow the programming algorithm shown in figure 19.9. This programming algorithm can write data without subjecting the device to voltage stress or impairing the reliability of programmed data. To program data, first set the VPPE bit in FLMCR, wait 5 to 10 µs, then designate the blocks to be programmed by erase block registers 1 and 2 (EBR1, EBR2), and write the data to the address to be programmed, as in writing to RAM. The flash memory latches the address and data in an address latch and data latch. Next set the P bit in FLMCR, selecting program mode. The programming duration is the time during which the P bit is set. A software timer should be used to provide an initial programming duration of 15.8 µs or less. Programming for too long a time, due to program runaway for example, can cause device damage. Before selecting program mode, set up the watchdog timer so as to prevent overprogramming. 19.5.2 Program-Verify Mode In program-verify mode, after data has been programmed in program mode, the data is read to check that it has been programmed correctly. After the programming time has elapsed, exit programming mode (clear the P bit to 0) and select program-verify mode (set the PV bit to 1). In program-verify mode, a program-verify voltage is applied to the memory cells at the latched address. If the flash memory is read in this state, the data at the latched address will be read. After selecting program-verify mode, wait 4 µs before reading, then compare the programmed data with the verify data. If they agree, exit programverify mode and program the next address. If they do not agree, select program mode again and repeat the same program and program-verify sequence. Do not repeat the program and programverify sequence more than 6 times for the same bit. (When a bit is programmed repeatedly, set a loop counter so that the total programming time will not exceed 1 ms.) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 605 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.5.3 Programming Flowchart and Sample Program Flowchart for Programming One Byte Start n=1 Set VPP E bit (VPP E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (z) µs Set erase block register (set bit of block to be programmed to 1) Write data to flash memory (flash memory latches write address and data)*1 Wait initial value setting x = 15 µs Enable watchdog timer*2 Select program mode (P bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) µs Clear P bit Disable watchdog timer Select program-verify mode (PV bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (tVS1) µs *4 Verify (read memory)*3 Notes: 1. Write the data to be programmed using a byte transfer instruction. 2. Set the watchdog timer overflow interval by setting CKS2 and CKS1 to 0 and CKS0 to 1. 3. Read to verify data from the memory using a byte transfer instruction. Programming ends 4. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs N: 6 (set N so that total programming time does not exceed 1 ms) 5. Programming time x, which is determined by the initial time × 2n–1 (n = 1 to 6), increases in proportion to n. Thus, set the initial time to 15.8 µs or less to make total programming time 1 ms or less. No good OK Clear PV bit Clear PV bit n ≥ N? Clear erase block register (clear bit of programmed block to 0) No n+1→n Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be programmed to 0) Clear VPP E bit Verify ends Double the programming time (x × 2 → x)*5 End (1-byte data programmed) Clear VPP E bit Programming error Figure 19.9 Programming Flowchart Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 606 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Sample Program for Programming One Byte: This program uses the following registers. R0: Program-verify fail counter R1: Program-verify timing loop counter ER2: Stores the address to be programmed as long word data. Valid addresses are H'00000000 to H'0001FFFF. R3H: Stores data to be programmed as byte data R4: Sets and clears TCSR and FLMCR E4: Stores the initial program loop counter value R5: Clears FLMCR E5: Stores the program loop counter value Arbitrary data can be programmed at an arbitrary address by setting the address in ER2 and the data in R3H. The values of #a, #b, and #g depend on the clock frequency. They can be calculated as indicated under table 19.9. FLMCR: .EQU FFFF40 EBR1: .EQU FFFF42 EBR2: .EQU FFFF43 TCSR: .EQU FFFFA8 PRGM: MOV.W #0001, R0 ; Program-verify fail count MOV.W #g, R1 ; Set program loop counter MOV.W #4140, R4 ; MOV.B R4L, @FLMCR:8 ; Set VPPE bit DEC.W #1, R1 ; BPL LOOP0 MOV.B #**, R0H ; MOV.B R0H, @EBR*:8 ; Set EBR* MOV.B R3H, @ER2 ; Dummy write MOV.W #a, E4 ; Set initial program loop counter value MOV.W #A579, R4 ; Start watchdog timer MOV.W R4, @TCSR:16 ; MOV:W E4, E5 ; Set program loop counter MOV.W #4140, R4 ; MOV.B R4H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set P bit DEC.W #1, E5 BPL LOOP1 LOOP0: PRGMS: LOOP1: ; Program ; Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 607 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) LOOP2: PVNG: MOV.B R4L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear P bit MOV.W #A500, R4 MOV.W R4, @TCSR:16 ; Stop watchdog timer MOV:W #b , R1 ; Set program-verify loop counter MOV.B #44, R4H ; MOV.B R4H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set PV bit DEC.W #1, R1 BPL LOOP2 MOV.B @ER2, R1H ; Read programmed address CMP.B R3H, R1H ; Compare programmed data with read data BEQ PVOK MOV.B #40, R5H MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear PV bit CMP.B #06, R0L BEQ NGEND ; If program-verify executed 6 times, branch to INC.B R0L ; Program-verify fail count + 1 → R0L SHLL.W E4 ; Double program loop counter value BRA PRGMS ; Program again MOV.W #4000, R5 MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear PV bit MOV.B R5L, @EBR*:8 MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit ; ; Wait ; ; Program-verify decision ; ; Program-verify executed 6 times? NGEND PVOK: ; ; Clear EBR* ............................ One byte programmed NGEND: MOV.W #4000, R5 ; MOV.B R5L, @EBR*:8 ; Clear EBR* MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit Programming error Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 608 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.5.4 Erase Mode To erase the flash memory, follow the erasing algorithm shown in figure 19.10. This erasing algorithm can erase data without subjecting the device to voltage stress or impairing the reliability of programmed data. To erase flash memory, before starting to erase, first place all memory data in all blocks to be erased in the programmed state (program all memory data to H'00). If all memory data is not in the programmed state, follow the sequence described later to program the memory data to zero. To select the flash memory areas to be erased, first set the VPPE bit in the flash memory control register (FLMCR), wait 5 to 10 µs, and set up erase block registers 1 and 2 (EBR1 and EBR2). Next set the E bit in FLMCR, selecting erase mode. The erase time is the time during which the E bit is set. To prevent overerasing, use a software timer to divide the erase time. Overerasing, due to program runaway for example, can give memory cells a negative threshold voltage and cause them to operate incorrectly. Before selecting erase mode, set up the watchdog timer so as to prevent overerasing. 19.5.5 Erase-Verify Mode In program-verify mode, after data has been erased, it is read to check that it has been erased correctly. After the erase time has elapsed, exit erase mode (clear the E bit to 0), select eraseverify mode (set the EV bit to 1), and wait 4 µs. Before reading data in erase-verify mode, write H'FF dummy data to the address to be read. This dummy write applies an erase-verify voltage to the memory cells at the latched address. If the flash memory is read in this state, the data at the latched address will be read. After the dummy write, wait 2 µs before reading. If the read data has been successfully erased, perform the dummy write, wait 2 µs, and erase-verify for the next address. If the read data has not been erased, select erase mode again and repeat the same erase and erase-verify sequence through the last address, until all memory data has been erased to 1. Do not repeat the erase and erase-verify sequence more than 602 times, however. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 609 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.5.6 Erasing Flowchart and Sample Program Flowchart for Erasing One Block Start Notes: 1. Program all addresses to be erased by following the prewrite flowchart. 2. Set the watchdog timer overflow interval to the value indicated in table 19.10. 3. For the erase-verify dummy write, write H'FF using a byte transfer instruction. 4. Read to verify data from the memory using a byte transfer instruction. 5. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs tVS2: 2 µs N: 602 Write 0 data in all addresses to be erased (prewrite)*1 n=1 Set VPP E bit ( VPP E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (z) µs Set erase block register (set bit of block to be erased to 1) Set top address in block as verify address Wait initial value setting x = 6.25 ms 6. The erase time x is successively incremented by the initial set value × 2n–1 (n = 1, 2, 3, 4). An initial value of 6.25 ms or less should be set, and the time for one erasure should be 50 ms or less. Enable watchdog timer*2 Select erase mode (E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) ms Clear E bit Erasing ends Disable watchdog timer Select erase-verify mode (EV bit = 1) Wait (tVS1) µs*5 Dummy write to verify address*3 (flash memory latches address) Wait (tVS2) µs*5 Verify (read memory)*4 Clear EV bit OK No Address + 1 → address No good Last address? n ≥ N? Yes Clear EV bit Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of erased block to 0) Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be erased to 0) Clear VPP E bit Clear VPP E bit End of block erase Erase error Erase-verify ends No n+1→n n ≥ 5? No Figure 19.10 Erasing Flowchart Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 610 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Double the erase time*6 (x × 2 → x) Yes Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Prewrite Flowchart Start Address = top address Set VPP E bit ( VPP E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (z) µs Set erase block register (set bit of block to be erased to 1) n=1 Address + 1 → address Wait initial value setting x = 15 µs Notes: 1. Use a byte transfer instruction. 2. Set the watchdog timer overflow interval by setting CKS2 = 0, CKS1 = 0 and CKS0 = 1. 3. In prewrite-verify mode P, E, PV, and EV are all cleared to 0 and 12 V is applied to VPP. Use a byte transfer instruction. 4. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs N: 6 (set N so that total Programming ends programming time does not exceed 1 ms) Write H'00 to flash memory (flash memory latches write address and write data)*1 Enable watchdog timer*2 Select program mode (set P bit to 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) µs Clear P bit Disable watchdog timer Wait (tVS1) µs*4 No good Prewrite verify*3 (read data = H'00?) No n ≥ N? OK n+1→n Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be erased to 0) Double the programming time (x × 2 → x) Clear VPPE bit Programming error No Last address? Yes Clear erase block register (clear bit of block to be erased to 0) Clear VPP E bit End of prewrite Figure 19.11 Prewrite Flowchart Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 611 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Sample Program for Erasing One Block: This program uses the following registers. R0: ER1: ER2: ER3: ER4: R5: R6: Prewrite-verify and erase-verify fail counter Stores address used in prewrite Stores address used in prewrite and erase-verify Stores address used in erase-verify Timing loop counter Sets appropriate registers Sets appropriate registers The values of #a, #c, #d, #e, #f, #g, and #h, in the program depend on the clock frequency. They can be calculated as indicated in tables 19.9 and 19.10. FLMCR: .EQU FFFF40 EBR1: .EQU FFFF42 EBR2: .EQU FFFF43 TCSR: .EQU FFFFA8 ; #BLKSTR is top address of block to be erased ; #BLKEND is last address of block to be erased MOV.L #BLKSTR:32, ER1 ; ER1: top address of block to be erased MOV.L #BLKEND:32, ER2 ; ER2: last address of block to be erased #g, R4 ; Set wait counter MOV.W #4140, R6 ; MOV.B R6L, @FLMCR:8 ; Set VPPE bit #1, R4 ; Execute prewrite PREWRT: MOV.W LOOPR0: DEC.W BPL LOOPR0 ; ; ;SET EBR1 or EBR2 bit of block to be erased MOV.B #**, R5H ; MOV.B R5H, @EBR* ; Set EBR* PREWRN: SUB.B R0H, R0H ; R0: prewrite-verify fail count #a, E4 ; Set initial prewrite loop counter value PREWRS: MOV.B #00, R5H ; Write #00 data MOV.B R5H, @ER1 ; MOV.W #A579, R5 ; Start watchdog timer MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; MOV.W E4, R4 ; Set prewrite loop counter MOV.W #4140, R6 ; MOV.W Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 612 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) MOV.B LOOPR1: DEC.W R6H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set P bit #1, R4 ; Prewrite BPL LOOPR1 MOV.B R6L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear P bit MOV.W #A500, R5 MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; MOV.W #c , R5 ; Set prewrite-verify loop counter #1, R5 ; Wait LOOPR2: DEC.W ; ; Stop watchdog timer BPL LOOPR2 ; MOV.B @ER1, BEQ PWVFOK CMP.B #05, BEQ ABEND1 ; If prewrite-verify executed 6 times, branch to SHLL.W E4 ; Double prewrite loop counter value INC.B R0H ; Prewrite-verify fail count + 1 → R0H BRA PREWRS ; Prewrite again R5H ; Read data = H'00? ; If read data = H'00, branch to PWVFOK R0H ; Prewrite-verify executed 6 times? ABEND1 PWVFOK: CMP.L ER2, BEQ ERASES INC.L #1, BRA PREWRN ER1 ; Last address? ; ER1 ; Address + 1 → R1 ; If not last address, prewrite next address ;Execute erase ERASES: SUB.W ERASE: LOOPE: R0, R0 ; R0: erase-verify fail count MOV.L #BLKSTR:32,ER3 ; ER3: top address of block to be erased MOV.W #d, E4 ; Set initial erase loop counter value CMP.W #025A, R0 ; R0 = H'025A? (erase-verify fail count = 603?) BEQ ABEND2 INC.W #1, R0 ; Erase-verify fail count + 1 → R0 MOV.W E4, R4 ; MOV.W #f, R5 ; Start watchdog timer MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; MOV.B #42, R5H MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; PUSH.L ER5 POP.L ER5 ; If R0 = H'025A, branch to ABEND2 ; Set E bit Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 613 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) PUSH.L ER5 POP.L ER5 PUSH.L ER5 POP.L ER5 DEC.W #1, BPL LOOPE MOV.B #40, R5H MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear E bit MOV.W #A500, R5 MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; Stop watchdog timer MOV.B #48, R5H MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set EV bit MOV.W #e , R4 ; R4: erase-verify loop counter #1, R4 ; R4 ; Erase ; ; ; ; Execute erase-verify LOOPEV: DEC.W ; ; Wait BPL LOOPEV MOV.B #FF, @ER3 ; Dummy write MOV.W #h, R4 ; R4: erase-verify loop counter LOOPDW: DEC.W #1, R4 ; EVR2: ; Wait BPL LOOPDW MOV.B @ER3+, R4H ; Read CMP.B #FF, R4H ; Read data = H'FF? BNE RERASE CMP.L ER2, BGT EVR2 ; If not last address in block, erase-verify next BRA OKEND, ; Branch to OKEND ; If read data ≠ H'FF, branch to RERASE ER3 ; Last address in block? address RERASE: MOV.W #4000, R5 ; MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear EV bit DEC.L #1, ER3 ; Erase-verify address – 1 → R3 CMP.W #0004, R0 ; BGE KEEP ; Erase executed 4 times? SHLL.W E4 ; Double erase loop counter value KEEP: BRA ERASE OKEND: MOV.W #4000, ; Erase again R5 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 614 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ; Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear EV bit MOV.W #0000, R5 MOV.W R5, @EBR1:16 ; Clear EBR1 and EBR2 MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit ; ............................. One block erased ABEND1: MOV.W #0000, R5 MOV.W R5, @EBR1:16 ; Clear EBR1 and EBR2 ; MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit Programming error ABEND2: MOV.W #0000, R5 MOV.W R5, @EBR1:16 ; Clear EBR1 and EBR2 ; MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit Erase error Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 615 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Flowchart for Erasing Multiple Blocks Notes: 1. Program all addresses to be erased by following the prewrite flowchart. 2. Set the watchdog timer overflow interval to the value indicated in table 19.10. 3. For the erase-verify dummy write, write H'FF with a byte transfer instruction. 4. When erasing two or more blocks, clear the bits of erased blocks in the erase block register, so that only unerased blocks will be erased again. 5. tVS1: 4 µs z: 5 to 10 µs Start Write 0 data to all addresses to be erased (prewrite)*1 n=1 Set VPP E bit (VPP E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (z) µs Set erase block registers (set bits of blocks to be erased to 1) Wait initial value setting x = 6.25 ms Enable watchdog timer*2 Select erase mode (E bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (x) ms Erasing ends Clear E bit Disable watchdog timer tVS2: 2 µs N: 602 6. The erase time x is successively incremented by the initial set value × 2n–1 (n = 1, 2, 3, 4). An initial value of 10 ms or less should be set, and the time for one erasure should be 50 ms or less. Select erase-verify mode (EV bit = 1 in FLMCR) Wait (tVS1) µs *5 Set top address of block as verify address Erase-verify next block Dummy write to verify address*3 (flash memory latches address) Wait (tVS2) µs *5 Verify (read memory) Erase-verify next block No good OK Address + 1 → address No Last address in block? All erased blocks verified? Yes No Yes Clear EBR bit of erase-verified block *4 No All erased blocks verified? Yes Clear EV bit All blocks erased? (EBR1 = EBR2 = 0?) Yes Clear VPP E bit End of erase No n ≥ 4? Yes No Double the erase time (x × 2 → x)*6 n ≥ N? No Yes Clear erase block registers (clear bits of blocks to be erased to 0) Clear VPP E bit Erase error Figure 19.12 Multiple-Block Erase Flowchart Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 616 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 n+1→n Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Sample Program for Erasing Multiple Blocks: This program uses the following registers. R0, R6: Specifies blocks to be erased (set as explained below) R1H: Prewrite-verify fail counter R1L: Used to test bits 0 to 15 of R0 ER2: Specifies address where address used in prewrite and erase-verify is stored ER3: Stores address used in prewrite and erase-verify ER4: Stores address used in prewrite and erase-verify ER5: Sets appropriate registers E0, E1: Timing loop counter E6: Erase-verify fail counter Arbitrary blocks can be erased by setting bits in R6. A bit map of R6 and an example setting for erasing specific blocks are shown next. Bit 15 14 13 R6 LB7 LB6 LB5 12 11 10 LB4 LB3 LB2 9 LB1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LB0 SB7 SB6 SB5 SB4 SB3 SB2 SB1 SB0 Corresponds to EBR1 Corresponds to EBR2 Example: to erase blocks LB2, SB7, and SB0 Bit 15 14 13 R6 LB7 LB6 LB5 12 11 10 LB4 LB3 LB2 9 LB1 8 7 6 0 0 0 0 0 1 4 3 2 1 0 LB0 SB7 SB6 SB5 SB4 SB3 SB2 SB1 SB0 Corresponds to EBR1 Setting 5 Corresponds to EBR2 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 R6 is set as follows: MOV.W #0481, R6 MOV.W R6, @EBR1 The values of #a, #c, #d, #e, #f, #g, and #h in the program depend on the clock frequency. They can be calculated as indicated in tables 19.9 and 19.10. For #RAMSTR in the program, substitute the starting destination address in RAM, to be used when this program is moved from flash memory into RAM. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 617 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) FLMCR: .EQU FFFF40 EBR1: .EQU FFFF42 EBR2: .EQU FFFF43 TCSR: .EQU FFFFA8 ; Set R0 value START: MOV.W #FFFF, R6 ; Select blocks to be erased (R6: EBR1/EBR2) MOV.W R6, R0 ; R0: EBR1/EBR2 SUB.W R1, R1 ; R1L: used to test R1-th bit in R0 ; #RAMSTR is starting destination address to which program is transferred in RAM ; Set #RAMSTR to even number MOV.L #RAMSTR:32, ER2 ; Starting transfer destination address ADD.L #ERVADR:32, ER2 ; #RAMSTR + #ERVADR → ER2 SUB.L #START:32, ; ER2: address of data area used in RAM PRETST: CMP.B BC0: #10, ER2 R1L ; R1L = #10? ; If finished checking all R0 bits, branch to ERASES BEQ ERASES CMP.B #08, BCC BC0 BTST R1L, BNE PREWRT ; BRA PWADD1 ; BTST R1L, BNE PREWRT ; If R1-th bit in R0 is 1, branch to PREWRT R1L ; R1L + 1 → R1L PWADD1: INC.B R1L ; ; R0H R0L ; ; Test R1-th bit in R0 ER3 ; Dummy-increment ER2 @ER2+, ER3 ; ER3: prewrite starting address MOV.L @ER2, ER4 ; ER4: top address of next block MOV.W #g, E5 ; Wait counter MOV.W #4140, R5 ; MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Set VPPE bit DEC.W #1, E5 BPL LOOPR0 MOV.W R6, @EBR1:16 ; Set EBR (R6: EBR1/EBR2) MOV.B #01, R1H MOV.L @ER2+, BRA PRETST ; Execute prewrite PREWRT: MOV.L LOOPR0 PREW: ; ; Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 618 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ; Prewrite-verify fail count Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) #a, E0 ; Set initial prewrite loop counter value PREWRS: MOV.B #00, R5H ; Write #00 data MOV.B R5H, @ER3 ; MOV.W #A579, E5 ; MOV.W E5, @TCSR:16 ; Start watchdog timer MOV.W E0, E1 ; Set program loop counter MOV.W #4140, R5 ; MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set P bit #1, E1 MOV.W LOOPR1: DEC.W ; Program BPL LOOPR1 MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear P bit MOV.W #A500, R5 MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; Stop watchdog timer MOV.W #c, R5 ; Prewrite-verify loop counter LOOPR2: DEC.W #1, R5 ; BPL LOOPR2 MOV.B @ER3, BEQ PWVFOK PWVFNG: CMP.B #06, ; ; ; R5H ; Read data = #'00? ; If read data = #'00, branch to PWVFOK R1H ; Prewrite-verify executed 6 times? BEQ ABEND1 ; If prewrite-verify executed 6 times, branch to INC.B R1H ; Prewrite-verify fail count + 1 → R1H SHLL.W E0 ; Double prewrite loop counter value BRA PREWRS ; Prewrite again ABEND1 #1, ER3 ; Address + 1 → ER3 CMP.L ER4, ER3 ; Last address? BEQ PWADD2 ; BRA PREW ; R1L ; Used to test (R1L + 1)–th bit in R0 PRETST ; Branch to PRETST PWVFOK: INC.L PWADD2: INC.B BRA ; Execute erase ERASES: MOV.W R6, @EBR1:16 ; Set EBR1/EBR2 SUB.W E6, E6 ; E6: erase-verify fail count MOV.W #d, E0 ; Set initial erase loop counter value MOV.W #f , R5 ; ERASE: Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 619 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) LOOPE: MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; Start watchdog timer MOV.W E0, E1 ; Set erase-loop counter MOV.W #4240, R5 ; MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set E bit PUSH.L ER5 POP.L ER5 PUSH.L ER5 POP.L ER5 PUSH.L ER5 POP.L ER5 DEC.W #1, BPL LOOPE MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear E bit MOV.W #A500, R5 MOV.W R5, @TCSR:16 ; Stop watchdog timer MOV.W R6, R0 ; R0: EBR1/EBR2 SUB.W R1, R1 ; R1: used to test R1-th bit in R0 ; Erase E1 ; ; Execute erase-verify EVR: ; #RAMSTR is starting destination address to which program is transferred in RAM MOV.L #RAMSTR:32, ER2 ; Starting transfer destination address (RAM) ADD.L #ERVADR:32, ER2 ; #RAMSTR + #ERVADR → ER2 SUB.L #START:32, ; ER2: address of data area used in RAM MOV.B #48, R5H MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Set EV bit MOV.W #e , R5 ; R5: set erase-verify loop counter #1, R5 ; Program LOOPEV: DEC.W BPL EBRTST: CMP.B ER2 ; Wait LOOPEV #10, ; R1L ; R1L = #10? ; If finished checking all R0 bits, branch to HANTEI BEQ HANTEI CMP.B #08, BCC BC1 BTST R1L, BNE ERSEVF ; BRA ADD01 ; R1L ; ; R0H Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 620 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ; Test R1-th bit in R0H (EBR1) Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) BC1: ADD01: R1L, BNE ERSEVF ; If R1-th bit in R0 is 1, branch to ERSEVF INC.B R1L ; R1L + 1 → R1L MOV.L @ER2+, BRA EBRTST ER3 ; Dummy-increment R2 ; @ER2+, ER3 ; ER3: top address of block to be erase-verified MOV.L @ER2, ER4 ; ER4: top address of next block MOV.B #FF, R5H ; MOV.B R5H, @ER3 ; Dummy write MOV.W #h , R5 ; R5: erase-verify loop counter #1, R5 ; ERSEVF: MOV.L EVR2: R0L ; Test R1-th bit in R0L (EBR2) BTST LOOPDW: DEC.W ; Wait BPL LOOPDW MOV.B @ER3+, R5L ; Read CMP.B #FF, R5L ; Read data = #FF? BNE ADD02 CMP.L ER4, BNE EVR2 CMP.B #08, BCC BC2 BCLR R1L, BRA ADD02 BC2: BCLR R1L, ADD02: INC.B R1L ; R1L + 1 → R1L BRA EBRTST ; Erase-verify next erased block HANTEI: MOV.W KEEP: ; If read data ≠ #FF, branch to ADD02 ER3 ; Last address in block? ; If not last address in block, branch to EVR2 R1L ; ; R0H ; Clear R1L-th bit in R0H (EBR1) ; R0L ; Clear R1L-th bit in R0L (EBR2) #4000, R5 ; MOV.B R5H, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear EV bit MOV.W R0, @EBR1:16 ; Clear bit of erased block to 0 BEQ EOWARI CMP.W #025A, BEQ ABEND2 INC.W #1, E6 ; Erase-verify fail count + 1 → E6 CMP.W #0004, E6 ; BGE KEEP ; Erase executed 4-times? SHLL.W E0 ; Double erase loop counter value BRA ERASE ; Erase again ; If EBR1/EBR2 is all 0, erasing ended normally E6 ; E6 = 025A? (erase-verify fail count = 602?) ; If E6 = 025A, branch to ABEND2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 621 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) ;————<Block address table used in erase-verify>—————————————————— .ALIGN2 ERVADR: .DATA.L 00000000 ; #0000 LB0 .DATA.L 00004000 ; #4000 LB1 .DATA.L 00008000 ; #8000 LB2 .DATA.L 0000C000 ; #C000 LB3 .DATA.L 00010000 ; #10000 LB4 .DATA.L 00014000 ; #14000 LB5 .DATA.L 00018000 ; #18000 LB6 .DATA.L 0001C000 ; #1C000 LB7 .DATA.L 0001F000 ; #1F000 SB0 .DATA.L 0001F200 ; #1F200 SB1 .DATA.L 0001F400 ; #1F400 SB2 .DATA.L 0001F600 ; #1F600 SB3 .DATA.L 0001F800 ; #1F800 SB4 .DATA.L 0001FA00 ; #1FA00 SB5 .DATA.L 0001FC00 ; #1FC00 SB6 .DATA.L 0001FE00 ; #1FE00 SB7 .DATA.L 00020000 ; #20000 FLASH AREA END ADDRESS EOWARI: MOV.B #00, R5L ; MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit #0000, R5 MOV.W R5, @EBR1:16 ; Clear EBR1 and EBR2 MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit Erase end ABEND1: MOV.W ; Programming error ABEND2: MOV.W #0000, R5 MOV.W R5, @EBR1:16 ; Clear EBR1 and EBR2 MOV.B R5L, @FLMCR:8 ; Clear VPPE bit Erase error Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 622 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ; Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Loop Counter Values in Programs and Watchdog Timer Overflow Interval Settings: The values of a to h in the programs depend on the clock frequency. Table 19.9 indicates the values for 10 MHz. Values for other frequencies can be calculated as shown below, but use the settings in table 19.10 for the value off. Table 19.9 Loop Counter Values in Program (10 MHz) Variable Clock Frequency a (f) b (f) c (f) d (f) f = 10 MHz Hexadecimal H'0019 H'0007 H'0007 H'03B3 H'0007 H'0009 H'0004 Decimal 25 7 7 947 9 Comments Program tVS1 tVS2 Erase at write at pre-write e (f) 7 g (f) tVS1 z at erase h (f) 4 tVS2 Formula: Clock frequency f [MHz] × {a (f = 10) to h (f = 10)} 10 a (f) to h (f) = Examples for 16 MHz: a (f) = b (f) = c (f) = d (f) = e (f) = g (f) = h (f) = 16 10 16 10 16 10 16 10 16 10 16 10 16 10 × 25 = 40 ≈ H'0028 × 7 = 11.2 ≈ H'000C × 7 = 11.2 ≈ H'000C × 947 = 1515.2 ≈ H'05EC × 7 = 11.2 ≈ H'000C × 9 = 14.4 ≈ H'000F × 4 = 6.4 ≈ H'0007 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 623 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Table 19.10 Watchdog Timer Overflow Interval Settings Variable Clock Frequency f 10 MHz ≤ frequency ≤ 16 MHz H'A57F 2 MHz ≤ frequency < 10 MHz H'A57E 1 MHz ≤ frequency < 2 MHz H'A57D Note: The watchdog timer (WDT) set value is calculated based on the number of instructions including write time and erase time from start to stop of WDT operation. In this program example, therefore, no more instructions should be added between the start and stop of WDT operation. 19.5.7 Prewrite-Verify Mode Prewrite-verify mode is a verify mode used after writing 0 to all bits to equalize their threshold voltages before erasure. To program all bits, write H'00 in accordance with the algorithm shown in figure 19.11. Use this procedure to set all data in the flash memory to H'00 after programming. After the necessary programming time has elapsed, exit program mode (by clearing the P bit to 0) and select prewriteverify mode (leave the P, E, PV, and EV bits all cleared to 0). In prewrite-verify mode, a prewriteverify voltage is applied to the memory cells at the read address. If the flash memory is read in this state, the data at the read address will be read. After selecting prewrite-verify mode, wait 4 µs before reading. Note: For a sample prewriting program, see the sample erasing program. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 624 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.5.8 Protect Modes Flash memory can be protected from programming and erasing by software or hardware methods. These two protection modes are described below. Software Protection: Prevents transitions to program mode and erase mode even if the P or E bit is set in the flash memory control register (FLMCR). Details are as follows. Function Protection Description Program Erase 1 Verify* Block protect Individual blocks can be erase and program-protected by the erase block registers (EBR1 and EBR2). If EBR1 and EBR2 are both set to H'00, all blocks are erase- and program-protected. Disabled Disabled Enabled Emulation protect When the RAMS bit is set in the RAM control register (RAMCR), all blocks are protected from both programming and erasing. Disabled* 2 3 Disabled* Enabled Notes: 1. Three modes: program-verify, erase-verify, and prewrite-verify. 2. Except in RAM areas overlapped onto flash memory. 3. All blocks are erase-disabled. It is not possible to specify individual blocks. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 625 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Hardware Protection: Suspends or disables the programming and erasing of flash memory, and resets the flash memory control register (FLMCR) and erase block registers (EBR1 and EBR2). The error-protect function permits the P and E bits to be set, but prevents transitions to program mode and erase mode. Details of hardware protection are as follows. Function 1 Verify* Protection Description Program Erase Programing voltage (VPP) protect When VPP is not applied, FLMCR, EBR1, and EBR2 are initialized, disabling programming and erasing. To obtain this 3 protection, VPP should not exceed VCC.* Disabled Disabled* Reset and standby protect When a reset occurs (including a watchdog timer reset) or standby mode is entered, FLMCR, EBR1, and EBR2 are initialized, disabling programming and erasing. Note that RES input does not ensure a reset unless the RES pin is held low for at least 20 ms at power-up (to enable the oscillator to settle), or at least 10 system clock cycles (φ) during operation. Disabled Disabled* Error protect If an operational error is detected during Disabled programming or erasing of flash memory (FLER = 1), the FLMCR, EBR1, and EBR2 settings are preserved, but programming or erasing is aborted immediately. This type of protection can be cleared only by a reset or hardware standby. Disabled* 2 Disabled 2 Disabled 2 Enabled Notes: 1. Program-verify, erase-verify, and prewrite-verify modes. 2. All blocks are erase-disabled. It is not possible to specify individual blocks. 3. For details, see section 19.8, Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply). Error Protect: This protection mode is entered if one of the error conditions that set the FLER bit in RAMCR is detected while flash memory is being programmed or erased (while the P bit or E bit is set in FLMCR). These conditions can occur if microcontroller operations do not follow the programming or erasing algorithm. Error protect is a flash-memory state. It does not affect other microcontroller operations. In this state the settings of the flash memory control register (FLMCR) and erase block registers (EBR1 and EBR2) are preserved*, but program mode or erase mode is terminated as soon as the error is detected. While the FLER bit is set, it is not possible to enter program mode or erase Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 626 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) mode, even by setting the P bit or E bit in FLMCR again. The PV and EV bits in FLMCR remain valid, however. Transitions to verify modes are possible in the error-protect state. The error-protect state can be cleared only by a reset or entry to hardware standby mode. Note: * It is possible to write to these registers. Note that a transition to software standby mode initializes these registers. Memory read or verify mode RES = 0 or STBY = 0 or software standby RD VF PR ER FLER = 0 RES = 1 and STBY = 1 and not software standby P = 1 or E = 1 P = 0 and E = 0 Error occurs (software standby) RES = 0 or STBY = 0 Error occurs RD: VF: PR: ER: RD: VF: PR: ER: INIT.: RD VF PR ER INIT. FLER = 0 RES = 0 or STBY = 0 Program mode or erase mode RD VF PR ER FLER = 0 Reset or standby (hardware protect) Memory read enabled Verify read enabled Error-protect mode Programming enabled Erase enabled Memory read disabled RD VF PR ER Verify read disabled FLER = 1 Programming disabled Erase disabled Initialized state of registers (FLMCR, EBR1, EBR2) Software standby RES = 0 or STBY = 0 Error-protect mode (software standby) RD VF PR ER INIT. FLER = 1 Software standby cleared Figure 19.13 Flash Memory State Transitions in Modes 5, 6, and 7 (On-Chip ROM Enabled) when Programming Voltage (VPP) is Applied The purpose of error-protect mode is to prevent overprogramming or overerasing damage to flash memory by detecting abnormal conditions that occur if the programming or erasing algorithm is not followed, or if a program crashes while the flash memory is being programmed or erased. This protection function does not cover abnormal conditions other than the setting conditions of the flash memory error bit (FLER), however. Also, if too much time elapses before the errorprotect state is reached, the flash memory may already have been damaged. This function accordingly does not offer foolproof protection from damage to flash memory. To prevent abnormal operations, when programming voltage (VPP) is applied, follow the programming and erasing algorithms correctly, and keep microcontroller operations under Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 627 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) constant internal and external supervision, using the watchdog timer for example. If a transition to error-protect mode occurs, the flash memory may contain incorrect data due to errors in programming or erasing, or it may contain data that has been insufficiently programmed or erased because of the suspension of these operations. Boot mode should be used to recover to a normal state. If the memory contains overerased memory cells, boot mode may not operate correctly. This is because the H8/3048F’s built-in boot program is located in part of flash memory, and will not read correctly if memory cells have been overerased. 19.5.9 NMI Input Masking NMI input is disabled when flash memory is being programmed or erased (when the P or E bit is set in FLMCR). NMI input is also disabled while the boot program is executing in boot mode, until the branch to the on-chip RAM area takes place*1. There are three reasons for this. • NMI input during programming or erasing might cause a violation of the programming or erasing algorithm. Normal operation could not be assured. • In the NMI exception-handling sequence during programming or erasing, the vector would not be read correctly*2. The result might be a program runaway. • If NMI input occurred during boot program execution, the normal boot-mode sequence could not be executed. NMI input is also disabled in the error-protect state while the P or E bit remains set in the flash memory control register (FLMCR). NMI requests should be disabled externally whenever VPP is applied. Notes: 1. The disabled state lasts until the branch to the boot program area in on-chip RAM (addresses H'FFEF10 to H'FFF2FF) that takes place as soon as the transfer of the user program is completed. After the branch to the RAM area, NMI input is enabled except during programming or erasing. NMI interrupt requests must therefore be disabled externally until the user program has completed initial programming (including the vector table and the NMI interrupt-handling program). 2. The vector may not be read correctly for the following two reasons. • If flash memory is read while being programmed or erased (while the P or E bit is set in FLMCR), correct read data will not be obtained. Undetermined values are returned. • If the NMI entry in the vector table has not been programmed yet, NMI exception handling will not be executed correctly. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 628 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.6 Flash Memory Emulation by RAM Erasing and programming flash memory takes time, which can make it difficult to tune parameters and other data in real time. If necessary, real-time updates of flash memory can be emulated by overlapping the small-block flash-memory area with part of the RAM (H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF). This RAM reassignment is performed using bits 3 to 0 of the RAM control register (RAMCR). After a flash memory area has been overlapped by RAM, it can be accessed from two address areas: the overlapped flash memory area, and the original RAM area (H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF). Table 19.11 indicates how to reassign RAM. RAM Control Register (RAMCR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FLER — — — RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 Initial value* 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: * Bit 7 and bits 3 to 0 are initialized by a reset and in hardware standby mode. They are not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 3 to 0 can be written to in modes 5, 6, and 7 (onchip flash memory enabled). In other modes, they are always read as 0 and cannot be modified. Table 19.11 RAM Area Reassignment Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RAM Area RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF 0 0/1 0/1 0/1 H'01F000 to H'01F1FF 1 0 0 0 H'01F200 to H'01F3FF 1 0 0 1 H'01F400 to H'01F5FF 1 0 1 0 H'01F600 to H'01F7FF 1 0 1 1 H'01F800 to H'01F9FF 1 1 0 0 H'01FA00 to H'01FBFF 1 1 0 1 H'01FC00 to H'01FDFF 1 1 1 0 H'01FE00 to H'01FFFF 1 1 1 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 629 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Example of Emulation of Real-Time Flash-Memory Update Procedure H'01F000 1. Set the RAME bit to 1 in SYSCR to enable the on-chip RAM. 2. Overlap part of RAM (H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF) onto the area requiring real-time update (SB5). Flash memory address space (Set RAMCR bits 3 to 0 to 1101.) Overlapped by RAM H'01F9FF H'01FA00 Small-block area (SB5) H'01FBFF 3. Perform real-time updates in the overlapping RAM. 4. After finalization of the update data, clear the RAM overlap (by clearing the RAMS bit). H'01FDFF H'01FE00 5. Program the data written in RAM addresses H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF into the flash memory area. H'01FFFF H'FFEF10 H'FFF000 H'FFF1FF H'FFF200 On-chip RAM area H'FFFF0F Notes: 1. When part of RAM (H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF) is overlapped onto a small-block area in flash memory, the overlapped flash memory area cannot be accessed. Access is enabled when the overlap is cleared. 2. When the RAMS bit is set to 1, all flash memory blocks are write-protected and erase-protected, regardless of the values of bits RAM2 to RAM0. In this state, no transition to program or erase mode will take place if the P or E bit is set in the flash memory control register (FLMCR). To actually program or erase a flash memory area, the RAMS bit must be cleared to 0. Figure 19.14 Example of RAM Overlap Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 630 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.7 Flash Memory PROM Mode 19.7.1 PROM Mode Setting The on-chip flash memory of the H8/3048F can be programmed and erased not only in the onboard programming modes but also in PROM mode, using a general-purpose PROM programmer. Table 19.12 indicates how to select PROM mode. Be sure to use the indicated table 19.13 socket adapter in PROM mode. Table 19.12 Selecting PROM Mode Pins Setting Mode pins: MD2, MD1, MD0 Low P80, P81, and P92 STBY and HWR High P50, P51, and P82 RES Power on reset circuit XTAL and EXTAL Oscillator circuit Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 631 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.7.2 Socket Adapter and Memory Map Programs can be written and verified by attaching a special 100-pin/32-pin socket adapter to the PROM programmer. Table 19.13 gives ordering information for the socket adapter. Figure 19.15 shows a memory map in PROM mode. Figure 19.16 shows the socket adapter pin interconnections. Table 19.13 Socket Adapter Microcontroller Package Socket Adapter HD64F3048F 100-pin plastic QFP (FP-100B) HS3048ESHF1H 100-pin plastic TQFP (TFP-100B) HS3048ESNF1H HD64F3048VF HD64F3048TF HD64F3048VTF H8/3048F MCU mode H'000000 PROM mode H'00000 On-chip ROM area H'01FFFF H'1FFFF Figure 19.15 Memory Map in PROM Mode Note: The FP-100B and TFP-100B pin pitch is only 0.5 mm. Use an appropriate tool when inserting the device in the IC socket and removing it. For example, the tool listed in table 19.14 can be used. Table 19.14 Manufacturer Part Number ENPLAS CORPORATION HP-100 (vacuum pen) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 632 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) H8/3048F Pin No. Pin Name Socket Adapter FP-100B, TFP-100B Pin No. 10 RESO VPP 1 64 NMI A9 26 69 P63 A 16 2 58 P6 0 A 15 3 90 P83 WE 31 27 P30 I/O 0 13 28 P31 I/O 1 14 29 P32 I/O 2 15 30 P33 I/O 3 17 31 P34 I/O 4 18 32 P35 I/O 5 19 33 P36 I/O 6 20 34 P37 I/O 7 21 36 P1 0 A0 12 37 P1 1 A1 11 38 P1 2 A2 10 39 P1 3 A3 9 40 P1 4 A4 8 41 P1 5 A5 7 42 P1 6 A6 6 43 P1 7 A7 5 45 P2 0 A8 27 46 P2 1 OE 24 47 P2 2 A 10 23 48 P2 3 A 11 25 49 P2 4 A 12 4 50 P2 5 A 13 28 51 P2 6 A 14 29 52 P2 7 CE 22 P5 0, P5 1, P82 VCC 32 STBY, HWR VSS 16 53, 54, 89 62, 71 73 to 75 87, 88, 14 76, 77 MD0, MD1, MD2, AVCC, VREF VCC 86 AVSS VSS 57, 65, 92 63 66, 67 Other pins Legend VPP: P80, P81, P92 1, 35, 68 11, 22, 44 Note: HN28F101 (32 Pins) Pin Name RES EXTAL, XTAL Power-on reset circuit Programming power supply I/O 7 to I/O0 : Data input/output A 16 to A 0 : Address input Output enable OE: Chip enable CE: WE: Write enable Oscillator circuit NC (OPEN) This figure shows pin assignments, and does not show the entire socket adapter circuit. When undertaking a new design, board design (power supply voltage stabilization, noise countermeasures, etc.) and operating timing design as a high-speed CMOS LSI are necessary. Figure 19.16 Wiring of Socket Adapter Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 633 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.7.3 Operation in PROM Mode The program/erase/verify specifications in PROM mode are the same as for the standard HN28F101 flash memory. Table 19.15 indicates how to select the various operating modes. The H8/3048F does not have a device recognition code, so the programmer cannot read the device name automatically. Table 19.15 Operating Mode Selection in PROM Mode Pins VPP VCC CE OE WE I/O7 to I/O0 A16 to A0 Read VCC VCC L L H Data output Address input Output disable VCC VCC L H H High impedance Standby VCC VCC H X X High impedance Read VPP VCC L L H Data output Output disable VPP VCC L H H High impedance Standby VPP VCC H X X High impedance Write VPP VCC L H L Data input Mode Read Command write Legend L: Low level H: High level VPP: VPP level VCC:VCC level X: Don’t care Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 634 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Table 19.16 PROM Mode Commands 1st Cycle 2nd Cycle Command Cycles Mode Address Data Mode Address Data Memory read 1 Write X H'00 Read RA Dout Erase setup/erase 2 Write X H'20 Write X H'20 Erase-verify 2 Write EA H'A0 Read X EVD Auto-erase setup/ auto-erase 2 Write X H'30 Write X H'30 Program setup/ program 2 Write X H'40 Write PA PD Program-verify 2 Write X H'C0 Read X PVD Reset 2 Write X H'FF Write X H'FF PA: EA: RA: PD: PVD: EVD: Program address Erase-verify address Read address Program data Program-verify output data Erase-verify output data Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 635 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) High-Speed, High-Reliability Programming: Unused areas of the H8/3048F flash memory contain H'FF data (initial value). The H8/3048F flash memory uses a high-speed, high-reliability programming procedure. This procedure provides enhanced programming speed without subjecting the device to voltage stress and without sacrificing the reliability of programmed data. Figure 19.17 shows the basic high-speed, high-reliability programming flowchart. Tables 19.17 and 19.18 list the electrical characteristics during programming. Start Set VPP = 12.0 V ±0.6 V Address = 0 n=0 n+1→n Program setup command Program command Wait (25 µs) Program-verify command Wait (6 µs) Address + 1 → address Verification? No good OK No n = 20? No Last address? Yes Yes Set VPP = VCC End Fail Figure 19.17 High-Speed, High-Reliability Programming Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 636 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) High-Speed, High-Reliability Erasing: The H8/3048F flash memory uses a high-speed, highreliability erasing procedure. This procedure provides enhanced erasing speed without subjecting the device to voltage stress and without sacrificing data reliability. Figure 19.18 shows the basic high-speed, high-reliability erasing flowchart. Tables 19.17 and 19.18 list the electrical characteristics during programming. Start Program 0 to all bits * Address = 0 n=0 n+1→n Erase setup/erase command Wait (10 ms) Erase-verify command Wait (6 µs) Address + 1 → address Verification? No good OK No n = 3000? No Last address? Yes Yes End Fail Note: * Follow the high-speed, high-reliability flowchart in programming all bits. Figure 19.18 High-Speed, High-Reliability Erasing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 637 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Table 19.17 DC Characteristics in PROM Mode (Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VPP = 12.0 V ±0.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C) Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions Input high voltage I/O7 to I/O0, A16 to A0, OE, CE, WE VIH 2.2 — VCC + 0.3 V Input low voltage I/O7 to I/O0, A16 to A0, OE, CE, WE VIL –0.3 — 0.8 V Output high voltage I/O7 to I/O0 VOH 2.4 — — V IOH = –200 µA Output low voltage I/O7 to I/O0 VOL — — 0.45 V IOL = 1.6 mA Input leakage current I/O7 to I/O0, A16 to A0, OE, CE, WE ILI — — 2 µA VIN = 0 to VCC V VCC current Read ICC — 40 80 mA Program ICC — 40 80 mA Erase ICC — 40 80 mA Read IPP — — 200 µA VPP = 5.0 V — 10 20 mA VPP = 12.6 V VPP current Program IPP — 20 40 mA Erase IPP — 20 40 mA Note: For details on absolute maximum ratings, see section 22.2.1. Using an LSI in excess of absolute maximum ratings may result in permanent damage*. * VPP peak overshoot should not exceed 13 V. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 638 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Table 19.18 AC Characteristics in PROM Mode (Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VPP = 12.0 V ± 0.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ± 5°C) Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions Command write cycle tCWC 120 — — ns Address setup time tAS 0 — — ns Address hold time tAH 60 — — ns Figure 19.19 Figure 19.20* Figure 19.21 Data setup time tDS 50 — — ns Data hold time tDH 10 — — ns CE setup time tCES 0 — — ns CE hold time tCEH 0 — — ns VPP setup time tVPS 100 — — ns VPP hold time tVPH 100 — — ns WE programming pulse width tWEP 70 — — ns WE programming pulse high time tWEH 20 — — ns OE setup time before command write tOEWS 0 — — ns OE setup time before verify tOERS 6 — — µs Verify access time tVA — — 500 ns OE setup time before status polling tOEPS 120 — — ns Status polling access time tSPA — — 120 ns Program wait time tPPW 25 — — ns Erase wait time tET 9 — 11 ms Output disable time tDF 0 — 40 ns Total auto-erase time tAET 0.5 — 30 s Note: CE, OE, and WE should be high during transitions of VPP from 5 V to 12 V and from 12 V to 5 V. * Input pulse level: 0.45 V to 2.4 V Input rise time and fall time ≤ 10 ns Timing reference levels: 0.8 V and 2.0 V for input; 0.8 V and 2.0 V for output Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 639 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Auto-erase setup VCC VPP Auto-erase and status polling 5.0 V 12 V 5.0 V tVPS tVPH Address CE tCEH OE tCES tOEWS tWEP WE tDS I/O 7 tOEPS tCWC tCES tCEH tWEH tDH Command in tCES tAET tWEP tDH tDS tSPA Command in Status polling I/O 0 to I/O 6 Command in Command in Figure 19.19 Auto-Erase Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 640 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 tDF Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Program setup VCC Program Program-verify 5.0 V 12 V VPP 5.0 V tVPS tVPH Address Valid address tAH tAS CE tCEH tCES OE tOEWS tWEP tCWC tCEH tWEH tDH WE tDS tCES tCES tPPW tWEP tDH tDS tCEH tWEP tOERS tDH tDS tVA tDF I/O 7 Command in Data in Command in Valid data out I/O 0 to I/O 6 Command in Data in Command in Valid data out Note: Program-verify data output values may be intermediate between 1 and 0 if programming is insufficient. Figure 19.20 High-Speed, High-Reliability Programming Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 641 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Erase setup VCC Erase Erase-verify 5.0 V 12 V VPP 5.0 V tVPS tVPH Address Valid address tAS tAH CE OE tOEWS tCES WE tCES tCEH tDS I/O0 to I/O7 tCEH tCES tCEH tCWC tWEP tET tWEP tOERS tWEP tVA tWEH tDH tDS Command in Command in tDH tDS Command in tDH tDF Valid data out Note: Erase-verify data output values may be intermediate between 1 and 0 if erasing is insufficient. Figure 19.21 Erase Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 642 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.8 Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions (Dual-Power Supply) (1) Program with the specified voltages and timing. The rated programming voltage (VPP) of the flash memory is 12.0 V. If the PROM programmer is set to Renesas Technology HN28F101 specifications, VPP will be 12.0 V. Applied voltages in excess of the rating can permanently damage the device. Insure, in particular, that peak overshoot at the Vpp and MD2 pins does not exceed the maximum rating of 13 V. Also, be very careful about PROM programmer overshoot. (2) Before programming, check that the chip is correctly mounted in the PROM programmer. Overcurrent damage to the device can result if the index marks on the PROM programmer socket, socket adapter, and chip are not correctly aligned. (3) Don’t touch the socket adapter or chip while programming. Touching either of these can cause contact faults and write errors. (4) Precautions in turning the programming voltage (VPP) on and off (see figures 19.22 to 19.24): • Apply the programming voltage (VPP) after the rise of VCC, when the microcontroller is in a stable condition. Shut off VPP before VCC, again while the microcontroller is in a stable condition. If VPP is turned on or off while VCC is not within its rated voltage range (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V), since microcontroller operation is unstable and flash memory protection is not functioning, the flash memory may be programmed or erased by mistake. This can occur even if VCC = 0 V. The same danger of incorrect programming or erasing exists when VCC is within its rated voltage range (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V) if the clock oscillator has not stabilized, if the clock oscillator has stopped (except in standby), or if a program runaway has occurred. After VCC power-up, do not apply VPP until the clock oscillator has had time to settle (tOSC1 = 20 ms min) and the microcontroller is safely in the reset state, or the reset has been cleared. These power-on and power-off timing requirements should also be satisfied in the event of a power failure and recovery from a power failure. If these requirements are not satisfied, the flash memory may not only be unintentionally programmed or erased; it may be permanently damaged. • The VPP bit in the flash memory control register (FLMCR) is set or cleared when the VPPE bit in FLMCR is set or cleared while a voltage of 12.0 ± 0.6 V is being applied to the VPP pin. After the VPPE bit is set, it becomes possible to write the erase block registers (EBR1 and EBR2) and the EV, PV, E, and P bits in FLMCR. Accordingly, program or erase flash memory Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 643 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 5 to 10 µs after the VPPE bit is set. VPP should be turned off only when the P, E and VPPE bits in FLMCR are cleared. Be sure that these bits are not set by mistaken access to FLMCR. tVPS* Programming/ erasing tFRS possible φ min 0 µs tosc1 2.7 to 5.5 V VCC 12±0.6 V VPP min 0 µs 0 to Vcc V min 10 φ 0 to Vcc V 12±0.6 V 0 to Vcc V 0 to Vcc V tMDS MD2 min 0µs RES VppE set VppE cleared VPPE bit Period during which flash memory access is prohibited Period during which flash memory can be rewritten (Execution of program in flash memory prohibited, and data reads other than verify operations prohibited) Note: * tVPS: 5 to 10µs Figure 19.22 Power-On and Power-Off Timing (Boot Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 644 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) tVPS* 1 Programming/ erasing possible t FRS φ min 0 µs tosc1 VCC 2.7 to 5.5 V 12±0.6 V VPP MD2 to 0 0 to Vcc V *2 *2 0 to Vcc V 0 to Vcc V 0 to Vcc V tMDS RES VppE set VppE cleared VPPE bit Period during which flash memory access is prohibited Period during which flash memory can be rewritten (Execution of program in flash memory prohibited, and data reads other than verify operations prohibited) Notes: 1. tVPS: 5 to 10 µs 2. The level of the mode pins (MD2 to MD0) must be fixed from power-on to power-off by pulling the pins up or down. Figure 19.23 Power-On and Power-Off Timing (User Program Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 645 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) tVPS tVPS Programming/ erasing possible tFRS tVPS Programming/ erasing possible tFRS tVPS Programming/ erasing possible tFRS Programming/ erasing possible φ tosc1 VCC VPP 2.7 to 5.5 V 0 to Vcc V 12±0.6 V min 0 µs min 10 φ 12±0.6 V MD2 to 0 0 to Vcc V tMDS*2 min 0µs tMDS RES VppE set VppE cleared tFRS*2 Clear VppE VPPE bit Mode switching*1 Boot mode Mode switching*1 User mode User program mode User mode User program mode Period during which flash memory access is prohibited Period during which flash memory can be rewritten (Execution of program in flash memory prohibited, and data reads other than verify operations prohibited) Notes: 1. When entering boot mode or making a transition from boot mode to another mode, mode switching must be carried out by means of RES input. The pin output states change during this switchover interval (the interval during which the RES pin is low), and therefore these pins should not be used as output signals during this time. 2. When making a transition from boot mode to another mode, the flash memory read setup time tFRS and mode programming setup time tMDS must be satisfied with respect to RES clearance timing. Figure 19.24 Mode Transition Timing (Example: Boot Mode → User Mode ↔ User Program Mode) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 646 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) (5) Do not apply 12 V to the VPP pin during normal operation. To prevent microcontroller errors caused by accidental programming or erasing, apply 12 V to VPP only when the flash memory is programmed or erased, or when flash memory is emulated by RAM. While 12 V is applied, the watchdog timer should be running and enabled to halt runaway program execution, so that program runaway will not lead to overprogramming or overerasing. (6) Disable watchdog-timer reset output (RESO RESO) RESO while the programming voltage (VPP) is turned on. If 12 V is applied during watchdog timer reset output (while the RESO pin is low), overcurrent flow will permanently destroy the reset output circuit. The watchdog timers reset output enable bit (RSTOE) should not be set to 1. If a pull-up resistor is externally attached to the VPP/RESO pin, a diode is necessary to prevent reverse current from flowing to VCC when VPP is applied (figure 19.25). (7) If the watchdog timer generates a reset output signal when 12 V is not applied, the rise and fall of the reset output waveform will be delayed by any decoupling capacitors connected to the VPP pin. +5 V Pull-up resistor and a diode VPP / RESO +12 V H8/3048F (dual-power supply) 1.0 µF 0.01 µF Figure 19.25 VPP Power Supply Circuit Design (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 647 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) (8) Notes concerning mounting board development—handling of VPP and mode MD2 pins 1. The standard 12 V high voltage is applied to the VPP and mode MD2 pins when erasing or programming flash memory. The voltage at these pins also includes overshoot and noise, and the following points should be noted to ensure that the 13 V maximum rated voltage is not exceeded. a. Bypass capacitors should be inserted to eliminate overshoot and noise. These should be positioned as close as possible to the chip’s VPP and mode MD2 pins. 1.0 µF: Stabilizes fluctuations in the low-frequency components, such as power supply ripple. 0.01 µF: Bypasses high-frequency components such as induction noise. b. The VPP and mode MD2 pin wiring should be kept as short as possible to suppress induction noise. When designing a new board, in particular, noise may be increased by jumper wires, etc. In this case too, the power supply waveform should be monitored and measures taken to prevent the maximum rating from being exceeded. c. The maximum rated voltage is based on the potential of the VSS pin. If the potential of this pin oscillates due to current fluctuations, etc., the voltage of the VPP and mode MD2 pins may reciprocally exceed the maximum rated voltage. Careful attention must therefore be paid to stabilizing the reference potential. Note: When the user system’s 12 V power supply is connected, attention must be paid to the current capacity. A power supply with a small current capacity will not be able to handle fluctuations in the chip’s operating voltage, resulting in voltage drops and rises or oscillation that may make it impossible to obtain the rated operating voltage. If the power supply has a large current capacity, or if the 12 V voltage is turned on abruptly by means of a switch, etc., caution is required since a voltage exceeding the maximum rating may be generated due to the inductance component of the power supply wiring or the power supply characteristics. Before using the power supply, check the power supply waveform to ensure that the above problems will not arise. 2. 12 V is applied to the VPP and mode MD2 pins when programming or erasing flash memory. When these pins are pulled up to the VCC line in normal operation, diodes should be inserted to prevent reverse current from flowing to the VCC line when 12 V is applied. Note: In normal operation, if the mode MD2 pin to which 12 V is applied is to be set to 0, it should be pulled down with a resistor. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 648 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) A sample circuit is shown figure 19.26. VCC VPP pin 12 V VPP H8/3048F (dualpower supply) VCC 0.01 µF 1.0 µF 12 V MD2 mode pin Mode pin 0.01 µF 1.0 µF Adapter board User system Figure 19.26 Example of Mounting Board Design for the H8/3048F-ZTAT with the DualPower Supply (Connection to Adapter Board—When VPP Pin and Mode Pin Settings Are 1) (9) Do not set or clear the VppE bit during execution of a program in flash memory. Flash memory data cannot be read normally when the VppE bit is set or cleared. After the VppE bit is cleared, flash memory data can be rewritten after waiting for the elapse of the Vpp enable setup time (tVPS: 5 10 µs), but flash memory cannot be accessed for purposes other than verification (verification during programming, erasing, or prewriting). After the VppE is cleared, wait for the elapse of the flash memory read setup time before performing program execution and data reading in flash memory. (10) Do not use interrupts while programming or erasing flash memory. When Vpp is applied, disable all interrupt requests, including NMI, to give the programming or erase operation (including RAM emulation) the highest priority. (11) The Vpp flag is set and cleared by a threshold decision on the voltage applied to the Vpp pin. The threshold level is approximately in the range from Vcc +2 V to 11.4 V. When this flag is set, it becomes possible to write to the flash memory control register (FLMCR) and the erase block registers (EBR1 and EBR2), even though the Vpp voltage may not yet have Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 649 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) reached the programming voltage range of 12.0 V ±0.6 V. Do not actually program or erase the flash memory until Vpp has reached the programming voltage range. The programming voltage range for programming and erasing flash memory is 12.0 V ±0.6 V (11.4 V to 12.6 V). Programming and erasing cannot be performed correctly outside this range. When not programming or erasing the flash memory, ensure that the Vpp voltage does not exceed the Vcc voltage. This will prevent unintentional programming and erasing. (12) After the Vpp enable bit (VppE) is cleared, the flash memory read setup time (tFRS)* must elapse before the flash memory is read. When switching from boot mode or user program mode to normal mode (Vpp ≠ 12 V, MD2 ≠ 12 V), this setup time is required as the period from VppE bit clearance until the flash memory is read. When switching from boot mode to another mode, a mode programming setup time (tMDS) is required with respect to the RES release timing. Note: * The flash memory read setup time stipulates the interval before flash memory is read after the VppE bit is cleared (figure 19.24). Also, when using an external clock (EXTAL input), after powering on and when returning from standby mode, the flash memory read setup time must elapse before the flash memory is read. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 650 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) 19.9 Notes when Converting the F-ZTAT (Dual-Power Supply) Application Software to the Mask-ROM Versions Please note the following when converting the F-ZTAT (dual-power supply) application software to the mask-ROM versions. The values read from the internal registers (refer to appendix B, Internal I/O Register, Table B.1) for the flash ROM of the mask-ROM version and F-ZTAT (dual-power supply) version differ as follows. Status Register Bit FLMCR VPP F-ZTAT (Dual-Power Supply) Version Mask-ROM Version 0: Application software running 1: Programming 0: Not read out 1: Application software running Note: This difference applies to all the F-ZTAT (dual-power supply) versions and all the maskROM versions that have different ROM size. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 651 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 19 Flash Memory (H8/3048F: Dual Power Supply (VPP = 12 V)) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 652 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator 20.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has a built-in clock pulse generator (CPG) that generates the system clock (φ) and other internal clock signals (φ/2 to φ/4096). After duty adjustment, a frequency divider divides the clock frequency to generate the system clock (φ). The system clock is output at the φ pin*1 and furnished as a master clock to prescalers that supply clock signals to the on-chip supporting modules. Frequency division ratios of 1/1, 1/2, 1/4, and 1/8 can be selected for the frequency divider by settings in a division control register (DIVCR). Power consumption in the chip is reduced in almost direct proportion to the frequency division ratio*2. Notes: 1. Usage of the φ pin differs depending on the chip operating mode and the PSTOP bit setting in the module standby control register (MSTCR). For details, see section 21.7, System Clock Output Disabling Function. 2. The division ratio of the frequency divider can be changed dynamically during operation. The clock output at the φ pin also changes when the division ratio is changed. The frequency output at the φ pin is shown below. φ = EXTAL × n where, EXTAL: Frequency of crystal resonator or external clock signal n: Frequency division ratio (n = 1/1, 1/2, 1/4, or 1/8) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 653 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator 20.1.1 Block Diagram Figure 20.1 shows a block diagram of the clock pulse generator. CPG XTAL Oscillator EXTAL Duty adjustment circuit Frequency divider Prescalers Division control register Data bus φ Figure 20.1 Block Diagram of Clock Pulse Generator Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 654 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 φ/2 to φ/4096 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator 20.2 Oscillator Circuit Clock pulses can be supplied by connecting a crystal resonator, or by input of an external clock signal. 20.2.1 Connecting a Crystal Resonator Circuit Configuration: A crystal resonator can be connected as in the example in figure 20.2. The damping resistance Rd should be selected according to table 20.1. An AT-cut parallelresonance crystal should be used. C L1 EXTAL XTAL Rd C L2 CL1 = CL2 = 10 pF to 22 pF Figure 20.2 Connection of Crystal Resonator (Example) In order to improve the accuracy of the oscillation frequency, a thorough study of oscillation matching evaluation, etc., should be carried out when deciding the circuit constants. Table 20.1 Damping Resistance Value Damping Resistance Value Rd (Ω) Frequency f (MHz) 2 2<f≤4 4<f≤8 8 < f ≤ 10 10 < f ≤ 13 13 < f ≤ 16 16 < f ≤ 18 For products listed below* 1k 500 200 0 0 0 0 H8/3048F 1k 1k 500 200 100 0 — Note: A crystal resonator between 2 MHz and 18 MHz can be used. If the chip is to be operated at less than 2 MHz, the on-chip frequency divider should be used. (A crystal resonator of less than 2 MHz cannot be used.) * H8/3048ZTAT, H8/3048 mask-ROM, H8/3047 mask-ROM, H8/3045 mask-ROM, H8/3044 mask-ROM Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 655 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator Crystal Resonator: Figure 20.3 shows an equivalent circuit of the crystal resonator. The crystal resonator should have the characteristics listed in table 20.2. CL L Rs XTAL EXTAL AT-cut parallel-resonance type C0 Figure 20.3 Crystal Resonator Equivalent Circuit Table 20.2 Crystal Resonator Parameters Frequency (MHz) Rs max (Ω Ω) 2 4 8 10 12 16 18 500 120 80 70 60 50 40 C0 max (pF) 7 Use a crystal resonator with a frequency equal to the system clock frequency (φ). Notes on Board Design: When a crystal resonator is connected, the following points should be noted: Other signal lines should be routed away from the oscillator circuit to prevent induction from interfering with correct oscillation. See figure 20.4. When the board is designed, the crystal resonator and its load capacitors should be placed as close as possible to the XTAL and EXTAL pins. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 656 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator Avoid Signal A Signal B C L2 H8/3048 Group XTAL EXTAL C L1 Figure 20.4 Example of Incorrect Board Design 20.2.2 External Clock Input Circuit Configuration: An external clock signal can be input as shown in the examples in figure 20.5. The external clock is input from the EXTAL pin. If the XTAL pin is left open, the stray capacitance should not exceed 10 pF. If the stray capacitance at the XTAL pin exceeds 10 pF in configuration a, use configuration b instead and hold the clock high in standby mode. External clock input EXTAL Open XTAL a. XTAL pin left open External clock input EXTAL 74HC04 XTAL b. Complementary clock input at XTAL pin Figure 20.5 External Clock Input (Examples) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 657 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator External Clock: The external clock frequency should be equal to the system clock frequency (φ) when not divided by the on-chip frequency divider. Table 20.3, figures 20.6 and 20.7 indicate the clock timing. When the appropriate external clock is input via the EXTAL pin, its waveform is corrected by the on-chip oscillator and duty adjustment circuit. The resulting stable clock is output to external devices after the external clock settling time (tDEXT) has passed after the clock input. The system must remain reset with the reset signal low during tDEXT, while the clock output is unstable. Table 20.3 Clock Timing VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10% Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Unit Test Conditions External clock input low pulse width tEXL 40 — 20 — ns Figure 20.6 External clock input high pulse width tEXH 40 — 20 — ns External clock rise time tEXr — 10 — 5 ns External clock fall time tEXf — 10 — 5 ns Clock low pulse width tCL 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 tcyc φ ≥ 5 MHz 80 — 80 — ns φ < 5 MHz Clock high pulse width tCH 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 tcyc φ ≥ 5 MHz 80 — 80 — ns φ < 5 MHz External clock output settling delay time tDEXT* 500 — 500 — µs Figure 20.7 Note: * tDEXT includes 10 tcyc of RES (tRESW). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 658 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Figure 22.7 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator tEXH tEXL VCC × 0.7 EXTAL VCC × 0.5 0.3 V tEXf tEXr Figure 20.6 External Clock Input Timing VCC STBY VIH EXTAL φ (internal or external) RES tDEXT Figure 20.7 External Clock Output Settling Delay Timing 20.3 Duty Adjustment Circuit When the oscillator frequency is 5 MHz or higher, the duty adjustment circuit adjusts the duty cycle of the clock signal from the oscillator to generate the signal that becomes the system clock. 20.4 Prescalers The prescalers divide the system clock (φ) to generate internal clocks (φ/2 to φ/4096). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 659 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator 20.5 Frequency Divider The frequency divider divides the duty-adjusted clock signal to generate the system clock (φ). The frequency division ratio can be changed dynamically by modifying the value in DIVCR, as described below. Power consumption in the chip is reduced in almost direct proportion to the frequency division ratio. The system clock generated by the frequency divider can be output at the φ pin. 20.5.1 Register Configuration Table 20.4 summarizes the frequency division register. Table 20.4 Frequency Division Register Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FF5D Division control register DIVCR R/W H'FC Note: * The lower 16 bits of the address are shown. 20.5.2 Division Control Register (DIVCR) DIVCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the division ratio of the frequency divider. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — — DIV1 DIV0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — — R/W R/W Reserved bits Divide bits 1 and 0 These bits select the frequency division ratio DIVCR is initialized to H'FC by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bits 7 to 2—Reserved: Read-only bits, always read as 1. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 660 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator Bits 1 and 0—Divide (DIV1 and DIV0): These bits select the frequency division ratio, as follows. Bit 1: DIV1 Bit 0: DIV0 Frequency Division Ratio 0 0 1/1 1 1/2 0 1/4 1 1/8 1 20.5.3 (Initial value) Usage Notes The DIVCR setting changes the φ frequency, so note the following points. • Select a frequency division ratio that stays within the assured operation range specified for the clock cycle time tcyc in the AC electrical characteristics. Note that φMIN must be in the lower limit of the clock frequency range. Avoid settings that give system clock frequencies less than the lower limit. Table 20.5 shows the comparison with the clock frequency range for each version. Table 20.5 Comparison with the Clock Frequency Ranges in the H8/3048 Group F-ZTAT ZTAT Product type H8/3048F H8/3048 Guaranteed 4.5–5.5 V clock 3.15–5.5 V frequency 2.7–5.5 V range 1–16 MHz 1–18 MHz 1–18 MHz — 1–13 MHz 1–13 MHz 1–8 MHz 1–8 MHz 1–8 MHz Crystal oscillation range 2–16 MHz 2–18 MHz 2–18 MHz ROM type Mask ROM H8/3048 Mask ROM Version H8/3047 Mask ROM Version H8/3045 Mask ROM Version H8/3044 Mask ROM Version • All on-chip module operations are based on φ. Note that the timing of timer operations, serial communication, and other time-dependent processing differs before and after any change in the division ratio. The waiting time for exit from software standby mode also changes when the division ratio is changed. For details, see section 21.4.3, Selection of Waiting Time for Exit from Software Standby Mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 661 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 20 Clock Pulse Generator Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 662 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State Section 21 Power-Down State 21.1 Overview The H8/3048 Group has a power-down state that greatly reduces power consumption by halting the CPU, and a module standby function that reduces power consumption by selectively halting on-chip modules. The power-down state includes the following three modes: • Sleep mode • Software standby mode • Hardware standby mode The module standby function can halt on-chip supporting modules independently of the powerdown state. The modules that can be halted are the ITU, SCI0, SCI1, DMAC, refresh controller, and A/D converter. Table 21.1 indicates the methods of entering and exiting the power-down modes and module standby mode, and gives the status of the CPU and on-chip supporting modules in each mode. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 663 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Halted*2 Halted*2 and and reset held*1 Halted and reset Halted and reset Active Halted and reset Halted and reset Active A/D Halted and reset Halted and reset Active — • NMI • IRQ0 to IRQ2 • RES • STBY • Interrupt • RES • STBY Exiting Conditions High — impedance*2 • STBY • RES • Clear MSTCR bit to 0*4 High • STBY impedance • RES Held Held φ output High output I/O Ports φ Clock Output Held*3 High impedance Held Held Other Modules RAM Halted*2 Halted*2 Halted*2 Halted*2 Active and and and and reset reset reset reset Halted and reset Halted and reset Halted and reset Halted and reset Active Active SCI1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 664 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Legend SYSCR: System control register SSBY: Software standby bit MSTCR: Module standby control register RTCNT and bits 7 and 6 of RTMCSR are initialized. Other bits and registers hold their previous states. State in which the corresponding MSTCR bit was set to 1. For details see section 21.2.2, Module Standby Control Register (MSTCR). The RAME bit must be cleared to 0 in SYSCR before the transition from the program execution state to hardware standby mode. When a MSTCR bit is set to 1, the registers of the corresponding on-chip supporting module are initialized. To restart the module, first clear the MSTCR bit to 0, then set up the module registers again. — Halted and reset Halted and held*1 Active SCI0 Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. Active Halted and reset Halted and reset Active Refresh Controller ITU Corresponding Active bit set to 1 in MSTCR Undetermined Held Held CPU Registers DMAC Module standby Halted Halted Halted CPU Hardware Low input at standby STBY pin mode Active Clock Halted Halted SLEEP instruction executed while SSBY = 0 in SYSCR Entering Conditions Software SLEEP standby instruction mode executed while SSBY = 1 in SYSCR Sleep mode Mode State Section 21 Power-Down State Table 21.1 Power-Down State and Module Standby Function Section 21 Power-Down State 21.2 Register Configuration The H8/3048 Group has a system control register (SYSCR) that controls the power-down state, and a module standby control register (MSTCR) that controls the module standby function. Table 21.2 summarizes these registers. Table 21.2 Control Register Address* Name Abbreviation R/W Initial Value H'FFF2 System control register SYSCR R/W H'0B H'FF5E Module standby control register MSTCR R/W H'40 Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address. 21.2.1 System Control Register (SYSCR) Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSBY STS2 STS1 STS0 UE NMIEG — RAME Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W — R/W RAM enable Reserved bit NMI edge select User bit enable Standby timer select 2 to 0 These bits select the waiting time at exit from software standby mode Software standby Enables transition to software standby mode SYSCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register. Bit 7 (SSBY) and bits 6 to 4 (STS2 to STS0) control the power-down state. For information on the other SYSCR bits, see section 3.3, System Control Register (SYSCR). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 665 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State Bit 7—Software Standby (SSBY): Enables transition to software standby mode. When software standby mode is exited by an external interrupt, this bit remains set to 1 after the return to normal operation. To clear this bit, write 0. Bit 7: SSBY Description 0 SLEEP instruction causes transition to sleep mode 1 SLEEP instruction causes transition to software standby mode (Initial value) Bits 6 to 4—Standby Timer Select (STS2 to STS0): These bits select the length of time the CPU and on-chip supporting modules wait for the clock to settle when software standby mode is exited by an external interrupt. If the clock is generated by a crystal resonator, set these bits according to the clock frequency so that the waiting time will be at least 7 ms. See table 21.3. If an external clock is used, any value may be selected. Bit 6: STS2 Bit 5: STS1 Bit 4: STS0 Description 0 0 0 Waiting time = 8,192 states 1 Waiting time = 16,384 states 0 Waiting time = 32,768 states 1 Waiting time = 65,536 states 0 Waiting time = 131,072 states 1 Waiting time = 1,024 states — Illegal setting 1 1 0 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 666 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 21 Power-Down State 21.2.2 Module Standby Control Register (MSTCR) MSTCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls output of the system clock (φ). It also controls the module standby function, which places individual on-chip supporting modules in the standby state. Module standby can be designated for the ITU, SCI0, SCI1, DMAC, refresh controller, and A/D converter modules. Bit 7 6 PSTOP — Initial value 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 4 5 3 2 1 0 MSTOP5 MSTOP4 MSTOP3 MSTOP2 MSTOP1 MSTOP0 Reserved bit Module standby 5 to 0 These bits select modules to be placed in standby ø clock stop Enables or disables output of the system clock MSTCR is initialized to H'40 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. Bit 7—φ φ Clock Stop (PSTOP): Enables or disables output of the system clock (φ). Bit 1: PSTOP Description 0 System clock output is enabled 1 System clock output is disabled (Initial value) Bit 6—Reserved: Read-only bit, always read as 1. Bit 5—Module Standby 5 (MSTOP5): Selects whether to place the ITU in standby. Bit 5: MSTOP5 Description 0 ITU operates normally 1 ITU is in standby state (Initial value) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 667 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State Bit 4—Module Standby 4 (MSTOP4): Selects whether to place SCI0 in standby. Bit 4: MSTOP4 Description 0 SCI0 operates normally 1 SCI0 is in standby state (Initial value) Bit 3—Module Standby 3 (MSTOP3): Selects whether to place SCI1 in standby. Bit 3: MSTOP3 Description 0 SCI1 operates normally 1 SCI1 is in standby state (Initial value) Bit 2—Module Standby 2 (MSTOP2): Selects whether to place the DMAC in standby. Bit 2: MSTOP2 Description 0 DMAC operates normally 1 DMAC is in standby state (Initial value) Bit 1—Module Standby 1 (MSTOP1): Selects whether to place the refresh controller in standby. Bit 1: MSTOP1 Description 0 Refresh controller operates normally 1 Refresh controller is in standby state (Initial value) Bit 0—Module Standby 0 (MSTOP0): Selects whether to place the A/D converter in standby. Bit 0: MSTOP0 Description 0 A/D converter operates normally 1 A/D converter is in standby state Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 668 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) Section 21 Power-Down State 21.3 Sleep Mode 21.3.1 Transition to Sleep Mode When the SSBY bit is cleared to 0 in SYSCR, execution of the SLEEP instruction causes a transition from the program execution state to sleep mode. Immediately after executing the SLEEP instruction the CPU halts, but the contents of its internal registers are retained. The DMA controller (DMAC), refresh controller, and on-chip supporting modules do not halt in sleep mode. Modules which have been placed in standby by the module standby function, however, remain halted. 21.3.2 Exit from Sleep Mode Sleep mode is exited by an interrupt, or by input at the RES or STBY pin. Exit by Interrupt: An interrupt terminates sleep mode and causes a transition to the interrupt exception handling state. Sleep mode is not exited by an interrupt source in an on-chip supporting module if the interrupt is disabled in the on-chip supporting module. Sleep mode is not exited by an interrupt other than NMI if the interrupt is masked by the I and UI bits in CCR and IPR. Exit by RES Input: Low input at the RES pin exits from sleep mode to the reset state. Exit by STBY Input: Low input at the STBY pin exits from sleep mode to hardware standby mode. 21.4 Software Standby Mode 21.4.1 Transition to Software Standby Mode To enter software standby mode, execute the SLEEP instruction while the SSBY bit is set to 1 in SYSCR. In software standby mode, current dissipation is reduced to an extremely low level because the CPU, clock, and on-chip supporting modules all halt. The DMAC and on-chip supporting modules are reset. As long as the specified voltage is supplied, however, CPU register contents and on-chip RAM data are retained. The settings of the I/O ports and refresh controller* are also held. Note: * RTCNT and bits 7 and 6 of RTMCSR are initialized. Other bits and registers hold their previous states. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 669 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State When the WDT is used as a watchdog timer (WT/IT = 1), the TME bit must be cleared to 0 before setting SSBY. Also, when setting TME to 1, SSBY should be cleared to 0. Clear the BRLE bit in BRCR (inhibiting bus release) before making a transition to software standby mode. 21.4.2 Exit from Software Standby Mode Software standby mode can be exited by input of an external interrupt at the NMI, IRQ0, IRQ1, or IRQ2 pin, or by input at the RES or STBY pin. Exit by Interrupt: When an NMI, IRQ0, IRQ1, or IRQ2 interrupt request signal is received, the clock oscillator begins operating. After the oscillator settling time selected by bits STS2 to STS0 in SYSCR, stable clock signals are supplied to the entire chip, software standby mode ends, and interrupt exception handling begins. Software standby mode is not exited if the interrupt enable bits of interrupts IRQ0, IRQ1, and IRQ2 are cleared to 0, or if these interrupts are masked in the CPU. Exit by RES Input: When the RES input goes low, the clock oscillator starts and clock pulses are supplied immediately to the entire chip. The RES signal must be held low long enough for the clock oscillator to stabilize. When RES goes high, the CPU starts reset exception handling. Exit by STBY Input: Low input at the STBY pin causes a transition to hardware standby mode. 21.4.3 Selection of Waiting Time for Exit from Software Standby Mode Bits STS2 to STS0 in SYSCR and bits DIV1 and DIV0 in DIVCR should be set as follows. Crystal Resonator: Set STS2 to STS0, DIV1, and DIV0 so that the waiting time (for the clock to stabilize) is at least 7 ms. Table 21.3 indicates the waiting times that are selected by STS2 to STS0, DIV1, and DIV0 settings at various system clock frequencies. Refer to table 21.3 for the operating frequency and the waiting time needed for the oscillator to settle. External Clock: Any values may be set. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 670 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State Table 21.3 Clock Frequency and Waiting Time for Clock to Settle DIV1 DIV0 STS2 STS1 STS0 Waiting Time 18 MHz 16 MHz 12 MHz 10 MHz 8 MHz 6 MHz 4 MHz 2 MHz 1 MHz Unit 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 8192 states 0.46 0.51 0.65 0.8 0 0 1 16384 states 0.91 0 1 0 32768 states 1.8 1.0 1.3 2.0 2.7 0 1 1 65536 states 3.6 4.1 1 0 0 1 0 1 131072 states 7.3* 1024 states 1 1 — 0 0 0 8192 states 0.91 1.02 1.4 1.6 2.0 2.7 4.0 8.2* 16.4* ms 0 0 1 16384 states 1.8 2.0 2.7 3.3 4.1 5.5 8.2* 16.4 32.8 0 1 0 32768 states 3.6 4.1 5.5 6.6 8.2* 10.9* 16.4 32.8 65.5 0 1 1 65536 states 7.3* 8.2* 10.9* 13.1* 16.4 21.8 32.8 65.5 131.1 1 0 0 131072 states 14.6 16.4 21.8 26.2 32.8 43.7 65.5 131.1 262.1 1 0 1 1024 states 0.11 0.13 0.17 0.20 0.26 0.34 0.51 1.0 0.057 1.0 1.3 2.0 4.1 1.6 2.0 3.3 4.1 5.5 6.6 8.2* 10.9* 0.064 0.085 8.2* 2.7 4.1 8.2* 16.4 5.5 8.2* 16.4 32.8 8.2* 10.9* 16.4 32.8 65.5 13.1* 16.4 21.8 32.8 65.5 131.1 0.10 0.13 0.17 0.26 0.51 1.0 Illegal setting 1 1 — 0 0 0 8192 states 1.8 2.0 2.7 3.3 4.1 5.5 0 0 1 16384 states 3.6 4.1 5.5 6.6 8.2* 10.9* 16.4 2.0 Illegal setting 8.2* 16.4* 32.8* ms 32.8 65.5 131.1 0 1 0 32768 states 7.3* 8.2* 10.9* 13.1* 16.4 21.8 32.8 65.5 0 1 1 65536 states 14.6 16.4 21.8 26.2 32.8 43.7 65.5 131.1 262.1 1 0 0 131072 states 29.1 32.8 43.7 52.4 65.5 87.4 131.1 262.1 524.3 1 0 1 1024 states 0.23 0.26 0.34 0.41 0.51 0.68 1.02 2.0 4.1 1 1 — 0 0 0 8192 states 3.6 4.1 5.5 6.6 8.2* 10.9* 16.4* 32.8* 65.5 0 0 1 16384 states 7.3* 8.2* 10.9* 13.1* 16.4 21.8 32.8 65.5 0 1 0 32768 states 14.6 16.4 21.8 26.2 32.8 43.7 65.5 131.1 262.1 0 1 1 65536 states 29.1 32.8 43.7 52.4 65.5 87.4 131.1 262.1 524.3 1 0 0 131072 states 58.3 65.5 87.4 104.9 131.1 174.8 262.1 524.3 1048.6 1024 states 0.51 0.68 0.82 1.0 1 0 1 1 1 — ms Illegal setting 0.46 1.4 2.0 4.1 ms 131.1 8.2 Illegal setting *: Recommended setting Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 671 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State 21.4.4 Sample Application of Software Standby Mode Figure 21.1 shows an example in which software standby mode is entered at the fall of NMI and exited at the rise of NMI. With the NMI edge select bit (NMIEG) cleared to 0 in SYSCR (selecting the falling edge), an NMI interrupt occurs. Next the NMIEG bit is set to 1 (selecting the rising edge) and the SSBY bit is set to 1; then the SLEEP instruction is executed to enter software standby mode. Software standby mode is exited at the next rising edge of the NMI signal. Clock oscillator φ NMI NMIEG SSBY NMI interrupt handler NMIEG = 1 SSBY = 1 Software standby mode (powerdown state) Oscillator settling time (tosc2) NMI exception handling SLEEP instruction Figure 21.1 NMI Timing for Software Standby Mode (Example) 21.4.5 Note The I/O ports retain their existing states in software standby mode. If a port is in the high output state, its output current is not reduced. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 672 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State 21.5 Hardware Standby Mode 21.5.1 Transition to Hardware Standby Mode Regardless of its current state, the chip enters hardware standby mode whenever the STBY pin goes low. Hardware standby mode reduces power consumption drastically by halting all functions of the CPU, DMAC, refresh controller, and on-chip supporting modules. All modules are reset except the on-chip RAM. As long as the specified voltage is supplied, on-chip RAM data is retained. I/O ports are placed in the high-impedance state. Clear the RAME bit to 0 in SYSCR before STBY goes low to retain on-chip RAM data. The inputs at the mode pins (MD2 to MD0) should not be changed during hardware standby mode. 21.5.2 Exit from Hardware Standby Mode Hardware standby mode is exited by inputs at the STBY and RES pins. While RES is low, when STBY goes high, the clock oscillator starts running. RES should be held low long enough for the clock oscillator to settle. When RES goes high, reset exception handling begins, followed by a transition to the program execution state. 21.5.3 Timing for Hardware Standby Mode Figure 21.2 shows the timing relationships for hardware standby mode. To enter hardware standby mode, first drive RES low, then drive STBY low. To exit hardware standby mode, first drive STBY high, wait for the clock to settle, then bring RES from low to high. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 673 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State Clock oscillator RES STBY Oscillator settling time Reset exception handling Figure 21.2 Hardware Standby Mode Timing 21.6 Module Standby Function 21.6.1 Module Standby Timing The module standby function can halt several of the on-chip supporting modules (the ITU, SCI0, SCI1, DMAC, refresh controller, and A/D converter) independently of the power-down state. This standby function is controlled by bits MSTOP5 to MSTOP0 in MSTCR. When one of these bits is set to 1, the corresponding on-chip supporting module is placed in standby and halts at the beginning of the next bus cycle after the MSTCR write cycle. 21.6.2 Read/Write in Module Standby When an on-chip supporting module is in module standby, read/write access to its registers is disabled. Read access always results in H'FF data. Write access is ignored. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 674 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State 21.6.3 Usage Notes When using the module standby function, note the following points. DMAC and Refresh Controller: When setting bit MSTOP2 or MSTOP1 to 1 to place the DMAC or refresh controller in module standby, make sure that the DMAC or refresh controller is not currently requesting the bus right. If bit MSTOP2 or MSTOP1 is set to 1 when a bus request is present, operation of the bus arbiter becomes ambiguous and a malfunction may occur. Internal Peripheral Module Interrupt: When MSTCR is set to “1”, prevent module interrupt in advance. When an on-chip supporting module is placed in standby by the module standby function, its registers, including the interrupt flag, are initialized. Pin States: Pins used by an on-chip supporting module lose their module functions when the module is placed in module standby. What happens after that depends on the particular pin. For details, see section 9, I/O Ports. Pins that change from the input to the output state require special care. For example, if SCI1 is placed in module standby, the receive data pin loses its receive data function and becomes a generic I/O pin. If its data direction bit is set to 1, the pin becomes a data output pin, and its output may collide with external serial data. Data collisions should be prevented by clearing the data direction bit to 0 or taking other appropriate action. Register Resetting: When an on-chip supporting module is halted by the module standby function, all its registers are initialized. To restart the module, after its MSTCR bit is cleared to 0, its registers must be set up again. It is not possible to write to the registers while the MSTCR bit is set to 1. MSTCR Access from DMAC Disabled: To prevent malfunctions, MSTCR can only be accessed from the CPU. It can be read by the DMAC, but it cannot be written by the DMAC. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 675 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 21 Power-Down State 21.7 System Clock Output Disabling Function Output of the system clock (φ) can be controlled by the PSTOP bit in MSTCR. When the PSTOP bit is set to 1, output of the system clock halts and the φ pin is placed in the high-impedance state. Figure 21.3 shows the timing of the stopping and starting of system clock output. When the PSTOP bit is cleared to 0, output of the system clock is enabled. Table 21.4 indicates the state of the φ pin in various operating states. MSTCR write cycle MSTCR write cycle (PSTOP = 1) (PSTOP = 0) T1 T2 T3 T1 T2 T3 φ pin High impedance Figure 21.3 Starting and Stopping of System Clock Output Table 21.4 φ Pin State in Various Operating States Operating State PSTOP = 0 PSTOP = 1 Hardware standby High impedance High impedance Software standby Always high High impedance Sleep mode System clock output High impedance Normal operation System clock output High impedance Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 676 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.1 shows the electrical characteristics of the various products in the H8/3048 Group. Table 22.1 Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048 Group Products Unit H8/3048 F-ZTAT (Dual Power Supply) H8/3048 H8/3047 H8/3045 H8/3044 MHz 1 to 16 1 to 18 1 to 18 2 to 25 VCC = 3.15 to 5.5 V — 1 to 13 1 to 13 — VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V 1 to 8 1 to 8 1 to 8 VCC = 3.0 to 3.6 V — — — 2 to 25 –20 to +75 –20 to +75 –20 to +75 –20 to +75*1 –40 to +85 –40 to +85 –40 to +85 –40 to +85*1 Item Operating range Symbol VCC = 4.5 to 5.5 V Operating Regular temperature specifications range Wide-range specifications Topr Absolute maximum ratings Vin VPP pin rating °C H8/3048 ZTAT H8/3048 F-ONE (Single Power Supply)*5 — Yes — Yes — FWE pin rating — — — Yes VCL pin — — — Cannot be connected to power supply*2 (5 V operation model only) –0.3 to +7.0 –0.3 to +7.0 Power supply voltage Vin V –0.3 to +7.0 –0.3 to +7.0 (5 V operation model) –0.3 to +4.6 (3 V operation model) DC characteristics RESO pin specification Yes Yes Yes — FWE pin specification — — — Yes Yes — — — Determination level for applying high voltage (12 V) Standby current (Ta ≤ 50°C) Standby current (50°C < Ta) ICC*3 µA Max 5 Max 5 Max 5 Max 10 Max 20 Max 20 Max 20 Max 80 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 677 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Symbol Unit H8/3048 F-ZTAT (Dual Power Supply) Clock cycle time tcyc ns Max 1000 RES pulse width tRESW tcyc Min 10 Min 10 Min 10 RESO output delay time tRESD ns Max 100 Max 100 Max 100 — RESO output pulse width tRESOW tcyc Min 132 Min 132 Min 132 — Item AC characteristics Flash memory characteristics*4 Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Other wait times See table 22.20 H8/3048 H8/3047 H8/3045 H8/3044 H8/3048 ZTAT Max 1000 Max 1000 Max 500 Min 20 — — H8/3048 F-ONE (Single Power Supply)*5 See table 21.11 The operating temperature range for flash memory programming/erasing is 0°C to +75°. Connect an external capacitor between the VCL pin and GND. See the DC Characteristics table for current dissipation during operation. Refer to the program/erase algorithms for details of flash memory characteristics. Refer to the H8/3048F-ONE Hardware Manual (Rev. 1.0) for details. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 678 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.1 Electrical Characteristics for H8/3048 ZTAT (PROM) and On-Chip Mask ROM Versions Target product types: H8/3048 ZTAT, H8/3048 mask-ROM, H8/3047 mask-ROM, H8/3045 mask-ROM, H8/3044 mask-ROM 22.1.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 22.2 lists the absolute maximum ratings. Table 22.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings Item Symbol Value Unit Power supply voltage VCC –0.3 to +7.0 V Programming voltage (H8/3048 ZTAT) VPP –0.3 to +13.5 V Input voltage (except for port 7) Vin –0.3 to VCC + 0.3 V Input voltage (port 7) Vin –0.3 to AVCC + 0.3 V Reference voltage VREF –0.3 to AVCC + 0.3 V Analog power supply voltage AVCC –0.3 to +7.0 V Analog input voltage VAN –0.3 to AVCC + 0.3 V Operating temperature Topr Regular specifications: –20 to +75 °C Wide-range specifications: –40 to +85 °C –55 to +125 °C Storage temperature Tstg Caution: Permanent damage to the chip may result if absolute maximum ratings are exceeded. Particularly, insure that peak overshoot at the VPP pin does not exceed 13 V. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 679 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.1.2 DC Characteristics Table 22.3 lists the DC characteristics. Table 22.4 lists the permissible output currents. Table 22.3 DC Characteristics (1) Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Schmitt trigger input voltages Port A, P82 to P80, PB3 to PB0 Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions VT– 1.0 — — V VT+ — — VCC × 0.7 V — — VT+ – VT– 0.4 Input high voltage Input low voltage Output high voltage Output low voltage Input leakage current RES, STBY, NMI, EXTAL VIH V VCC – 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V VCC × 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V Port 7 2.0 — Ports 1 to 6, 9, P83, P84, PB4 RES, STBY, VIL MD2 to MD0 NMI, EXTAL, ports 1 to 7, 9, All output pins VOH (except RESO) 2.0 — AVCC + V 0.3 VCC + 0.3 V –0.3 — 0.5 V –0.3 — 0.8 V VCC – 0.5 — — V IOH = –200 µA 3.5 — — V IOH = –1 mA — — 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA — — 1.0 V IOL = 10 mA — — 0.4 V IOL = 2.6 mA — — 1.0 µA — — 1.0 µA VIN = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V VIN = 0.5 to AVCC – 0.5 V All output pins VOL (except RESO) Ports 1, 2, 5, and B RESO STBY, NMI, RES, Port 7 |IIN| Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 680 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item Three-state leakage current (off state) Ports 1 to 6, 8 to B Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions |ITS1| — — 1.0 µA — — 10.0 µA 50 — 300 µA VIN = 0 V RESO Input pull-up Ports 2, 4, current and 5 –IP Input NMI capacitance All input pins except NMI CIN Current Normal 2 dissipation* operation ICC — 50 pF VIN = 0 V — 15 pF f = 1 MHz — 50 65 mA f = 16 MHz — 55 75 mA f = 18 MHz — 35 50 mA f = 16 MHz — 40 55 mA f = 18 MHz Module standby 4 mode* — 20 25 mA f = 16 MHz — 25 27 mA f = 18 MHz Standby 3 mode* — 0.01 5.0 µA Ta ≤ 50°C — — 20.0 µA 50°C < Ta — 1.2 2.0 mA — 1.2 2.0 mA — 0.01 5.0 µA DASTE = 0 — 0.3 0.6 mA VREF = 5.0 V During A/D and D/A conversion — 1.3 3.0 mA Idle — 0.01 5.0 µA 2.0 — — V During A/D conversion AICC During A/D and D/A conversion Idle Reference current — — Ta = 25°C Sleep mode Analog power supply current VIN = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V During A/D conversion RAM standby voltage AICC VRAM DASTE = 0 Notes: 1. If the A/D and D/A converters are not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open. Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS. 2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state. 3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 4.5 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V. 4. Module standby current values apply in sleep mode with all modules halted. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 681 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.2 DC Characteristics (2) Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions Schmitt trigger input voltages Port A, P82 to P80, PB3 to PB0 VT– VCC × 0.2 — — V VT+ — — VCC × 0.7 V — — Input high voltage RES, STBY, NMI, MD2 to MD0 VIH VT+ – VT– VCC × 0.07 Typ V VCC × 0.9 — VCC + 0.3 V EXTAL VCC × 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V Port 7 VCC × 0.7 — AVCC + 0.3 Ports 1 to 6, 9, P84, P83, PB7 to PB4 VCC × 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V –0.3 — VCC × 0.1 V NMI, EXTAL, ports 1 to 7, 9, P83, P84 PB4 to PB7 –0.3 — VCC × 0.2 V VCC < 4.0 V 0.8 V VCC = 4.0 V to 5.5 V Output high voltage All output pins VOH (except RESO) VCC – 0.5 — — V IOH = –200 µA VCC – 1.0 — — V IOH = –1 mA Output low voltage All output pins VOL (except RESO) — — 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA Ports 1, 2, 5, and B — — 1.0 V VCC ≤ 4 V IOL = 5 mA, 4 V < VCC ≤ 5.5 V IOL = 10 mA — — 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA — — 1.0 µA VIN = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V — — 1.0 µA VIN = 0.5 to AVCC – 0.5 V Input low voltage RES, STBY, MD2 to MD0 VIL RESO Input leakage current STBY, NMI, RES, MD2 to MD0 |IIN| Port 7 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 682 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 V Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item Three-state leakage current (off state) Ports 1 to 6, 8 to B Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions |ITS1| — — 1.0 µA — — 10.0 µA 10 — 300 µA VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VIN = 0 V pF VIN = 0 V RESO Input pull-up Ports 2, 4, current and 5 –IP Input NMI capacitance All input pins except NMI CIN Current Normal 2 dissipation* operation 4 ICC* 50 15 f = 1 MHz — 12 (3.0 V) 35 (5.5 V) mA f = 8 MHz — 20 (3.3 V) 55 (5.5 V) mA f = 13 MHz (VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V) — 8 (3.0 V) 25 (5.5 V) mA f = 8 MHz — 12 (3.3 V) 40 (5.5 V) mA f = 13 MHz (VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V) — 5 (3.0 V) 14 (5.5 V) mA f = 8 MHz — 7 (3.3 V) 20 (5.5 V) mA 13 MHz (VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V) — 0.01 5.0 µA Ta ≤ 50°C — — 20.0 µA 50°C < Ta — 0.4 1.0 mA AVCC = 3.0 V — 1.2 — mA AVCC = 5.0 V During A/D and D/A conversion — 0.4 1.0 mA AVCC = 3.0 V — 1.2 — mA AVCC = 5.0 V Idle — 0.01 5.0 µA DASTE = 0 — 0.2 0.4 mA VREF = 3.0 V — 0.3 — mA VREF = 5.0 V During A/D and D/A conversion — 0.8 2.0 mA VREF = 3.0 V — 1.3 — mA VREF = 5.0 V Idle — 0.01 5.0 µA DASTE = 0 2.0 — — V Module standby 5 mode* Standby 3 mode* Reference current — — Ta = 25°C Sleep mode Analog power supply current — — VIN = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V During A/D conversion During A/D conversion RAM standby voltage AICC AICC VRAM Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 683 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Notes: 1. If the A/D and D/A converters are not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open. Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS. 2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state. 3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 2.7 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V. 4. ICC depends on VCC and f as follows: ICCmax = 3.0 (mA) + 0.75 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [normal mode] ICCmax = 3.0 (mA) + 0.55 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [sleep mode] [module standby mode] ICCmax = 3.0 (mA) + 0.25 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f 5. Module standby current values apply in sleep mode with all modules halted. Table 22.4 Permissible Output Currents Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Permissible output low current (per pin) Ports 1, 2, 5, and B Permissible output low current (total) Total of 28 pins in ports 1, 2, 5, and B Symbol Min Typ Max Unit IOL — — 10 mA — — 2.0 mA — — 80 mA — — 120 mA Other output pins ΣIOL Total of all output pins, including the above Permissible output high current (per pin) All output pins IOH — — 2.0 mA Permissible output high current (total) Total of all output pins ΣIOH — — 40 mA Notes: 1. To protect chip reliability, do not exceed the output current values in table 22.4. 2. When driving a darlington pair or LED, always insert a current-limiting resistor in the output line, as shown in figures 22.1 and 22.2. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 684 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics H8/3048 Group 2 kΩ Port Darlington pair Figure 22.1 Darlington Pair Drive Circuit (Example) H8/3048 Group Ports 1, 2, 5, and B 600 Ω LED Figure 22.2 LED Drive Circuit (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 685 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.1.3 AC Characteristics Bus timing parameters are listed in table 22.5. Refresh controller bus timing parameters are listed in table 22.6. Control signal timing parameters are listed in table 22.7. Timing parameters of the on-chip supporting modules are listed in table 22.8. Table 22.5 Bus Timing Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition B: VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.15 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 13 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 18 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A 8 MHz Item Condition B 13 MHz 16 MHz Min Max 18 MHz Min Test Max Unit Conditions Symbol Min Max Min Clock cycle time tCYC 125 1000 76.9 1000 62.5 1000 55.5 1000 ns Clock pulse low width tCL 40 — 20 — 20 — 17 — Clock pulse high width tCH 40 — 20 — 20 — 17 — Clock rise time tCR — 20 — 15 — 10 — 10 Clock fall time tCF — 20 — 15 — 10 — 10 Address delay time tAD — 60 — 50 — 30 — 25 Address hold time tAH 25 — 20 — 10 — 10 — Address strobe delay time tASD — 60 — 50 — 30 — 25 Write strobe delay time tWSD — 60 — 50 — 30 — 25 Strobe delay time tSD — 60 — 50 — 30 — 25 Write data strobe pulse width 1 tWSW1* 85 — 40 — 35 — 32 — Write data strobe pulse width 2 tWSW2* 150 — 90 — 65 — 62 — Address setup time 1 tAS1 20 — 15 — 10 — 10 — Address setup time 2 tAS2 80 — 45 — 40 — 38 — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 686 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Max Condition C Figure 22.7, Figure 22.8 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Condition A Condition B 8 MHz 13 MHz Condition C 16 MHz 18 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Test Max Unit Conditions Read data setup time tRDS 50 — 30 — 20 — 15 — Read data hold time tRDH 0 — 0 — 0 — 0 — Write data delay time tWDD — 75 — 75 — 60 — 55 Write data setup time 1 tWDS1 60 — 20 — 15 — 10 — Write data setup time 2 tWDS2 5 — –10 — –5 — –10 — Write data hold time tWDH 25 — 15 — 20 — 20 — Read data access time 1 tACC1* — 120 — 60 — 60 — 50 Read data access time 2 tACC2* — 240 — 140 — 120 — 105 Read data access time 3 tACC3* — 70 — 30 — 30 — 20 Read data access time 4 tACC4* — 180 — 100 — 95 — 80 Precharge time tPCH* 85 — 55 — 45 — 40 — Wait setup time tWTS 40 — 40 — 25 — 25 — Wait hold time tWTH 10 — 10 — 5 — 5 — Bus request setup ime tBRQS 40 — 40 — 40 — 40 — Bus acknowledge delay time 1 tBACD1 — 60 — 50 — 30 — 30 Bus acknowledge delay time 2 tBACD2 — 60 — 50 — 30 — 30 Bus-floating time tBZD — 70 — 70 — 40 — 40 ns Figure 22.7, Figure 22.8 ns Figure 22.9 ns Figure 22.21 Note: * At 8 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 68 (ns) tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 73 (ns) tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 38 (ns) tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 55 (ns) tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 70 (ns) At 13 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 56 (ns) tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 37 (ns) tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 26 (ns) tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 53 (ns) tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 47 (ns) tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 32 (ns) tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 54 (ns) At 16 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 34 (ns) tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 28 (ns) tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 37 (ns) tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 29 (ns) tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 28 (ns) tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 33 (ns) tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 30 (ns) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 687 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics At 18 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 24 (ns) tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 34 (ns) tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 34 (ns) tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 22 (ns) tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 21 (ns) tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 36 (ns) tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 31 (ns) Table 22.6 Refresh Controller Bus Timing Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition B: VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.15 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 13 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 18 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition B Condition C 8 MHz 13 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Test Max Unit Conditions RAS delay time 1 tRAD1 — 60 — 50 — 30 — 30 RAS delay time 2 tRAD2 — 60 — 50 — 30 — 30 RAS delay time 3 tRAD3 — 60 — 50 — 30 — 30 Row address hold time* tRAH 25 — 20 — 15 — 15 — RAS precharge time* tRP 85 — 55 — 45 — 40 — CAS to RAS precharge time* tCRP 85 — 55 — 45 — 40 — CAS pulse width tCAS 100 — 55 — 40 — 35 — RAS access time* tRAC — 160 — 80 — 85 — 70 Address access time tAA — 105 — 45 — 55 — 45 CAS access time* tCAC — 50 — 30 — 30 — 25 Write data setup time 3 tWDS3 50 — 20 — 15 — 10 — CAS setup time* tCSR 20 — 10 — 15 — 10 — Read strobe delay time tRSD — 60 — 50 — 30 — 30 Note: * At 8 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 38 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 75 (ns) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 688 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ns Figure 22.10 to Figure 22.16 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 90 (ns) tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 43 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) At 13 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 19 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 47 (ns) tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 29 (ns) tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 74 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 22 (ns) At 16 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 17 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 33 (ns) tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 17 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 18 (ns) At 18 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 13 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 31 (ns) tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 41 (ns) tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 18 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 16 (ns) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 689 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.7 Control Signal Timing Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition B: VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.15 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 13 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 18 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition B Condition C 8 MHz 13 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Test Max Unit Conditions RES setup time tRESS 200 — 200 — 200 — 200 — ns RES pulse width tRESW 10 — 10 — 10 — 10 — tCYC Mode programming setup tMDS time 200 — 200 — 200 — 200 — ns RESO output delay time — 100 — 100 — 100 — 100 ns RESO output pulse width tRESOW 132 — 132 — 132 — 132 — tCYC NMI setup time (NMI, IRQ5 to IRQ0) tNMIS 200 — 200 — 150 — 150 — ns Figure 22.20 NMI hold time (NMI, IRQ5 to IRQ0) tNMIH 10 — 10 — 10 — 10 — Interrupt pulse width (NMI, IRQ2 to IRQ0 when exiting software standby mode) tNMIW 200 — 200 — 200 — 200 — Clock oscillator settling time at reset (crystal) tOSC1 20 — 20 — 20 — 20 — ms Figure 22.22 Clock oscillator settling time in software standby (crystal) tOSC2 7 — 7 — 7 — 7 — ms Figure 21.1 tRESD Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 690 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Figure 22.18 Figure 22.19 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.8 Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition B: VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.15 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 13 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 18 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition B Condition C 8 MHz 13 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Test Max Unit Conditions DMAC DREQ setup time tDRQS 40 — 40 — 30 — 30 — DREQ hold time tDRQH 10 — 10 — 10 — 10 — TEND delay time 1 tTED1 — 100 — 100 — 50 — 50 TEND delay time 2 tTED2 — 100 — 100 — 50 — 50 Timer output delay time tTOCD — 100 — 100 — 100 — 100 Timer input setup time tTICS 50 — 50 — 50 — 50 — Timer clock input setup time tTCKS 50 — 50 — 50 — 50 — Timer Single clock edge pulse Both width edges tTCKWH 1.5 — 1.5 — 1.5 — 1.5 — tTCKWL 2.5 — 2.5 — 2.5 — 2.5 — tSCYC Asynchronous 4 — 4 — 4 — 4 — SyntSCYC chronous 6 — 6 — 6 — 6 — ITU SCI Input clock cycle Input clock rise time tSCKr — 1.5 — 1.5 — 1.5 — 1.5 Input clock fall time tSCKf — 1.5 — 1.5 — 1.5 — 1.5 Input clock pulse width tSCKW 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 ns Figure 22.30 Figure 22.28, Figure 22.29 ns Figure 22.24 Figure 22.25 tCYC tCYC Figure 22.26 tSCYC Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 691 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Condition A 8 MHz 13 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Test Max Unit Conditions Transmit data delay time tTXD — 100 — 100 — 100 — 100 Receive data setup time (synchronous) tRXS 100 — 100 — 100 — 100 — Clock tRXH input 100 — 100 — 100 — 100 — Clock output 0 — 0 — 0 — 0 — Receive data hold time (synchronous) Ports and TPC Condition C Symbol Item SCI Condition B Output data delay time tPWD — 100 — 100 — 100 — 100 Input data setup time tPRS 50 — 50 — 50 — 50 — Input data hold time tPRH 50 — 50 — 50 — 50 — RL ns Figure 22.27 ns Figure 22.23 C = 90 pF: ports 4, 5, 6, 8, A (19 to 0), D (15 to 8), φ C = 30 pF: ports 9, A, B, RESO H8/3048 Group output pin R L = 2.4 k Ω R H = 12 k Ω C RH Input/output timing measurement levels • Low: 0.8 V • High: 2.0 V Figure 22.3 Output Load Circuit Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 692 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.1.4 A/D Conversion Characteristics Table 22.9 lists the A/D conversion characteristics. Table 22.9 A/D Converter Characteristics Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition B: VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.15 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 13 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 18 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition B 8 MHz Condition C 13 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz Item Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit Resolution 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 bits Conversion time 16.75 — — 10.31 — — 8.375 — — 7.45 — — µs Analog input capacitance — — 20 — — 20 — — 20 — — 20 pF Permissible signal-source impedance — — 10*1 — — 10*1 — — 10*3 — — 10*3 kΩ — — 5*2 — — 5*2 — — 5*4 — — 5*4 Nonlinearity error — — ±6.0 — — ±6.0 — — ±3.0 — — ±3.0 LSB Offset error — — ±4.0 — — ±4.0 — — ±2.0 — — ±2.0 LSB Full-scale error — — ±4.0 — — ±4.0 — — ±2.0 — — ±2.0 LSB Quantization error — — ±0.5 — — ±0.5 — — ±0.5 — — ±0.5 LSB Absolute accuracy — — ±8.0 — — ±8.0 — — ±4.0 — — ±4.0 LSB Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. The value is for 4.0 ≤ AVCC ≤ 5.5. The value is for 2.7 ≤ AVCC ≤ 4.0. The value is for φ ≤ 12 MHz. The value is for φ > 12 MHz. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 693 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.1.5 D/A Conversion Characteristics Table 22.10 lists the D/A conversion characteristics. Table 22.10 D/A Converter Characteristics Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition B: VCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.15 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.15 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 13 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 18 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition B 8 MHz Condition C 13 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz Item Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Test Typ Max Unit Conditions Resolution 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 Bits Conversion time — — 10 — — 10 — — 10 — — 10 µs Absolute accuracy — ±2.0 ±3.0 — ±2.0 ±3.0 — ±1.0 ±1.5 — ±1.0 ±1.5 LSB 2-MΩ resistive load — — — — — — — — ±2.0 ±2.0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 694 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ±1.0 20-pF capacitive load ±1.0 LSB 4-MΩ resistive load Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2 Electrical Characteristics of H8/3048F (Dual-Power Supply) 22.2.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 22.11 lists the absolute maximum ratings. Table 22.11 Absolute Maximum Ratings Item Symbol Value Unit Power supply voltage VCC –0.3 to +7.0 V Programming voltage VPP –0.3 to +13.0 V Input voltage (except for MD2 and port 7 Vin –0.3 to VCC + 0.3 V Input voltage (MD2) Vin –0.3 to +13.0 V Input voltage (port 7) Vin –0.3 to AVCC + 0.3 V Reference voltage VREF –0.3 to AVCC + 0.3 V Analog power supply voltage AVCC –0.3 to +7.0 V Analog input voltage VAN –0.3 to AVCC + 0.3 V Operating temperature Topr Regular specifications: –20 to +75 °C Wide-range specifications: –40 to +85 °C –55 to +125 °C Storage temperature Tstg Caution: Permanent damage to the chip may result if absolute maximum ratings are exceeded. Particularly, insure that peak overshoot at the VPP and MD2 pins does not exceed 13 V. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 695 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2.2 DC Characteristics Table 22.12 lists the DC characteristics. Table 22.13 lists the permissible output currents. Table 22.12 DC Characteristics (1) Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions Schmitt trigger input voltages Port A, P82 to P80, PB3 to PB0 VT– 1.0 — — V VT+ — — VCC × 0.7 V — — Input high voltage RES, STBY, NMI, MD2 to MD0 VIH Input low voltage VT+ – VT– 0.4 V VCC – 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V EXTAL VCC × 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V Port 7 2.0 — AVCC + 0.3 Ports 1 to 6, 9, P84, P83, PB7 to PB4 2.0 — VCC + 0.3 V –0.3 — 0.5 V –0.3 — 0.8 V RES, STBY, MD2 to MD0 VIL NMI, EXTAL, ports 1 to 7, 9, P84, P83, PB7 to PB4 Output high voltage All output pins Output low voltage VCC – 0.5 — — V IOH = –200 µA 3.5 — — V IOH = –1 mA All output pins VOL (except RESO) — — 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA Ports 1, 2, 5, and B — — 1.0 V IOL = 10 mA RESO — — 0.4 V IOL = 2.6 mA 11.4 V VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5 V High voltage RESO/VPP (12 V) MD2 application criterion 5 level* VOH V VH Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 696 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 VCC + 2.0 — Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item Input leakage current Three-state leakage current (off state) Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions |Iin| STBY, NMI, RES, MD1, MD0 — — 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V MD2 — — 10.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to VCC + 0.5 V MD2 — — 50.0 µA Vin = VCC + 0.5 to 12.6 V Port 7 — — 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to AVCC – 0.5 V — — 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V — — 20.0 mA VCC to 5 V < Vin ≤ 12.6 V — — 10.0 µA 0.5 V ≤ Vin ≤ VCC to 0.5 V Ports 1 to 6, 8 to B |ITSI| RESO/VPP Input pull-up Ports 2, 4, current and 5 –IP 50 — 300 µA Vin = 0 V Input NMI capacitance All input pins except NMI Cin — — 50 pF VIN = 0 V — — 15 pF f = 1 MHz Current Normal 2 dissipation* operation ICC Analog power supply current Reference current Ta = 25°C — 50 65 mA f = 16 MHz Sleep mode — 35 50 mA f = 16 MHz Module standby 4 mode* — 20 25 mA f = 16 MHz Standby 3 mode* — 0.01 5.0 µA Ta ≤ 50°C — — 20.0 µA 50°C < Ta — 1.2 2.0 mA During A/D and D/A conversion — 1.2 2.0 mA Idle — 0.01 5.0 µA DASTE = 0 — 0.3 0.6 mA VREF = 5.0 V During A/D and D/A conversion — 1.3 3.0 mA Idle — 0.01 5.0 µA During A/D conversion During A/D conversion AICC AICC DASTE = 0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 697 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item VPP pin current Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions IPP — — 10 µA VPP = 5.0 V — 10 20 mA VPP = 12.6 V Program execution — 20 40 mA Erase — 20 40 mA 2.0 — — V Read output RAM standby voltage VRAM Notes: 1. If the A/D and D/A converters are not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open. Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS. 2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state. 3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 4.5 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V. 4. Module standby current values apply in sleep mode with all modules halted. 5. The high-voltage application criterion level is as shown above. However, in boot mode and during flash memory write and erase it should be set at 12.0 V ±0.6 V. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 698 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.12 DC Characteristics (2) Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Min Max Unit Test Conditions Schmitt trigger input voltages Port A, P82 to P80, PB3 to PB0 VT– VCC × 0.2 — — V VT+ — — VCC × 0.7 V — — Input high voltage RES, STBY, NMI, MD2 to MD0 VIH Input low voltage VT+ – VT– VCC × 0.07 Typ V VCC × 0.9 — VCC + 0.3 V EXTAL VCC × 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V Port 7 VCC × 0.7 — AVCC + 0.3 Ports 1 to 6, 9, P84, P83, PB7 to PB4 VCC × 0.7 — VCC + 0.3 V –0.3 — VCC × 0.1 V –0.3 — VCC × 0.2 V VCC < 4.0 V 0.8 V VCC = 4.0 V to 5.5 V VCC – 0.5 — — V IOH = –200 µA VCC – 1.0 — — V IOH = –1 mA RES, STBY, MD2 to MD0 VIL NMI, EXTAL, ports 1 to 7, 9, P84, P83, PB7 to PB4 VOH V Output high voltage All output pins Output low voltage All output pins VOL (except RESO) — — 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA Ports 1, 2, 5, and B — — 1.0 V VCC ≤ 4 V IOL = 5 mA, 4 V < VCC ≤ 5.5 V IOL = 10 mA — — 0.4 V IOL = 1.6 mA 11.4 V VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V RESO High voltage RESO/VPP MD2 (12 V) application criterion 6 level* VH VCC + 2.0 — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 699 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item Input leakage current Three-state leakage current (off state) Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions STBY, NMI, |Iin| RES, MD1, MD0 — — 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V MD2 — — 10.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to VCC + 0.5 V MD2 — — 50.0 µA Vin = VCC + 0.5 to 12.6 V Port 7 — — 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to AVCC – 0.5 V — — 1.0 µA Vin = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V — — 20.0 mA VCC + 0.5 < Vin — — 10.0 µA ≤ 12.6 0.5 ≤ Vin ≤ VCC 10 — 300 µA +0.5V VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, Vin = 0 V pF Vin = 0 V Ports 1 to 6, 8 to B |ITSI| RESO/VPP Input pull-up Ports 2, 4, current and 5 –IP Input NMI capacitance All input pins except NMI Cin Current Normal 2 dissipation* operation 4 ICC* Analog power supply current — 50 — 15 f = 1 MHz Ta = 25°C — 12 (3.0 V) 35 (5.5 V) mA f = 8 MHz Sleep mode — 8 (3.0 V) 25 (5.5 V) mA f = 8 MHz Module 5 standby mode* — 5 (3.0 V) 14 (5.5 V) mA f = 8 MHz Standby 3 mode* — 0.01 5.0 µA Ta ≤ 50°C — — 20.0 µA 50°C < Ta — 0.4 1.0 mA AVCC = 3.0 V — 1.2 — mA AVCC = 5.0 V — 0.4 1.0 mA AVCC = 3.0 V — 1.2 — mA AVCC = 5.0 V — 0.01 5.0 µA DASTE = 0 — 0.2 0.4 mA VREF = 3.0 V — 0.3 — mA VREF = 5.0 V During A/D and D/A conversion — 0.8 2.0 mA VREF = 3.0 V — 1.3 — mA VREF = 5.0 V Idle — 0.01 5.0 µA DASTE = 0 During A/D conversion AICC During A/D and D/A conversion Idle Reference current — — During A/D conversion AICC Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 700 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Item VPP pin current Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions IPP — — 10 µA — 10 20 mA Program execution — 20 40 mA Erase — 20 40 mA 2.0 — — V Read output RAM standby voltage VRAM VPP = 5.0 V VPP = 12.6 V Notes: 1. If the A/D and D/A converters are not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open. Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS. 2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state. 3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 2.7 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V. 4. ICC depends on VCC and f as follows: ICCmax = 3.0 (mA) + 0.75 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [normal mode] ICCmax = 3.0 (mA) + 0.55 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [sleep mode] ICCmax = 3.0 (mA) + 0.25 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [module standby mode] 5. Module standby current values apply in sleep mode with all modules halted. 6. The high-voltage application criterion level is as shown above. However, in boot mode and during flash memory write and erase it should be set at 12.0 V ±0.6 V. Table 22.13 Permissible Output Currents Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Permissible output low current (per pin) Ports 1, 2, 5, and B Permissible output low current (total) Total of 28 pins in ports 1, 2, 5, and B IOL Other output pins ΣIOL Total of all output pins, including the above Min Typ Max Unit — — 10 mA — — 2.0 mA — — 80 mA — — 120 mA Permissible output high current (per pin) All output pins IOH — — 2.0 mA Permissible output high current (total) Total of all output pins ΣIOH — — 40 mA Notes: 1. To protect chip reliability, do not exceed the output current values in table 22.13. 2. When driving a darlington pair or LED, always insert a current-limiting resistor in the output line, as shown in figures 22.4 and 22.5. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 701 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics H8/3048 Group 2 kΩ Port Darlington pair Figure 22.4 Darlington Pair Drive Circuit (Example) H8/3048 Group Ports 1, 2, 5, and B 600 Ω LED Figure 22.5 LED Drive Circuit (Example) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 702 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2.3 AC Characteristics Bus timing parameters are listed in table 22.14. Refresh controller bus timing parameters are listed in table 22.15. Control signal timing parameters are listed in table 22.16. Timing parameters of the on-chip supporting modules are listed in table 22.17. Table 22.14 Bus Timing Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Unit Test Conditions Clock cycle time tCYC 125 1000 62.5 1000 ns Figure 22.7, Clock pulse low width tCL 40 — 20 — Clock pulse high width tCH 40 — 20 — Clock rise time tCR — 20 — 10 Clock fall time tCF — 20 — 10 Address delay time tAD — 60 — 30 Address hold time tAH 25 — 10 — Address strobe delay time tASD — 60 — 30 Write strobe delay time tWSD — 60 — 30 Strobe delay time tSD — 60 — 30 Write data strobe pulse width 1 tWSW1* 85 — 35 — Write data strobe pulse width 2 tWSW2* 150 — 65 — Address setup time 1 tAS1 20 — 10 — Address setup time 2 tAS2 80 — 40 — Read data setup time tRDS 50 — 20 — Read data hold time tRDH 0 — 0 — Figure 22.8 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 703 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Max Unit Test Conditions — 60 ns Figure 22.7, 15 — –5 — — 20 — 120 — 60 — 240 — 120 — 70 — 30 — 180 — 95 85 — 45 — tWTS 40 — 25 — Wait hold time tWTH 10 — 5 — Bus request setup time tBRQS 40 — 40 — Bus acknowledge delay time 1 tBACD1 — 60 — 30 Bus acknowledge delay time 2 tBACD2 — 60 — 30 Bus-floating time tBZD — 70 — 40 Item Symbol Min Max Min Write data delay time tWDD Write data setup time 1 tWDS1 — 75 60 — Write data setup time 2 tWDS2 5 — Write data hold time Read data access time 1 tWDH 25 tACC1* — Read data access time 2 tACC2* Read data access time 3 tACC3* Read data access time 4 Precharge time tACC4* tPCH* Wait setup time Figure 22.8 ns Figure 22.9 ns Figure 22.21 Note: * At 8 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 68 (ns) tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 73 (ns) tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 38 (ns) tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 55 (ns) tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 70 (ns) At 16 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 34 (ns) tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 28 (ns) tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 37 (ns) tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 29 (ns) tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 33 (ns) tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 28 (ns) tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 30 (ns) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 704 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.15 Refresh Controller Bus Timing Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Unit RAS delay time 1 tRAD1 — 60 RAS delay time 2 tRAD2 — 60 — 30 ns — 30 RAS delay time 3 tRAD3 — 60 — 30 Row address hold time* tRAH 25 — 15 — RAS precharge time* tRP 85 — 45 — CAS to RAS precharge time* tCRP 85 — 45 — CAS pulse width tCAS 100 — 40 — RAS access time* tRAC — 160 — 85 Address access time tAA — 105 — 55 CAS access time* tCAC — 50 — 30 Write data setup time 3 tWDS3 50 — 15 — CAS setup time* tCSR 20 — 15 — Read strobe delay time tRSD — 60 — 30 Test Conditions Figure 22.10 to Figure 22.16 Note: * At 8 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 38 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 75 (ns) tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 90 (ns) tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 43 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) At 16 MHz, the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time. tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 17 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 33 (ns) tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns) tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 17 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 18 (ns) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 705 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.16 Control Signal Timing Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Item Symbol Min Max Min Max Unit Test Conditions RES setup time tRESS 200 — 200 — ns Figure 22.18 RES pulse width tRESW 10 — 10 — tCYC Mode programming setup time tMDS 200 — 200 — ns RESO output delay time tRESD — 100 — 100 ns RESO output pulse width tRESOW 132 — 132 — tCYC NMI setup time (NMI, IRQ5 to IRQ0) tNMIS 200 — 150 — ns Figure 22.20 NMI hold time (NMI, IRQ5 to IRQ0) tNMIH 10 — 10 — Interrupt pulse width (NMI, IRQ2 to IRQ0 when exiting software standby mode) tNMIW 200 — 200 — Clock oscillator settling time at reset (crystal) tOSC1 20 — 20 — ms Figure 22.22 Clock oscillator settling time in software standby (crystal) tOSC2 7 — 7 — ms Figure 21.1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 706 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Figure 22.19 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics Table 22.17 Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item DMAC DREQ setup time ITU SCI SCI Ports and TPC Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Symbol Min Max Min Max Unit Test Conditions ns Figure 22.30 tDRQS 40 — 30 — DREQ hold time tDRQH 10 — 10 — TEND delay time 1 tTED1 — 100 — 50 Figure 22.28 TEND delay time 2 tTED2 — 100 — 50 Figure 22.29 Timer output delay time tTOCD — 100 — 100 Timer input setup time tTICS 50 — 50 — Timer clock input setup time tTCKS 50 — 50 — Timer clock pulse width Single edge tTCKWH 1.5 — 1.5 — Both edges tTCKWL 2.5 — 2.5 — Input clock cycle Asynchronous tSCYC 4 — 4 — Synchronous tSCYC 6 — 6 — Input clock rise time tSCKr — 1.5 — 1.5 Input clock fall time tSCKf — 1.5 — 1.5 Input clock pulse width tSCKW 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 tSCYC Transmit data delay time tTXD — 100 — 100 ns Figure 22.27 Receive data setup time (synchronous) tRXS 100 — 100 — Receive data hold time (synchronous) Clock input tRXH 100 — 100 — Clock output tRXH 0 — 0 — tPWD — 100 — 100 ns Figure 22.23 Input data setup time tPRS 50 — 50 — Input data hold time tPRH 50 — 50 — Output data delay time ns Figure 22.24 Figure 22.25 tCYC tCYC Figure 22.26 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 707 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics RL C = 90 pF: ports 4, 5, 6, 8, A (19 to 0), D (15 to 8), φ C = 30 pF: ports 9, A, B, RESO H8/3048 Group output pin R L = 2.4 k Ω R H = 12 k Ω C RH Input/output timing measurement levels • Low: 0.8 V • High: 2.0 V Figure 22.6 Output Load Circuit Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 708 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2.4 A/D Conversion Characteristics Table 22.18 lists the A/D conversion characteristics. Table 22.18 A/D Converter Characteristics Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Item Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit Resolution 10 10 10 10 10 10 bits Conversion time 16.75 — — 8.375 — — µs Analog input capacitance — — 20 — — 20 pF Permissible signal-source impedance — — 10*1 — — 10*3 kΩ — — 5*2 — — 5*4 Nonlinearity error — — ±6.0 — — ±3.0 LSB Offset error — — ±4.0 — — ±2.0 LSB Full-scale error — — ±4.0 — — ±2.0 LSB Quantization error — — ±0.5 — — ±0.5 LSB Absolute accuracy — — ±8.0 — — ±4.0 LSB Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. The value is for 4.0 ≤ AVCC ≤ 5.5. The value is for 2.7 ≤ AVCC < 4.0. The value is for φ ≤ 12 MHz. The value is for φ > 12 MHz. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 709 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2.5 D/A Conversion Characteristics Table 22.19 lists the D/A conversion characteristics. Table 22.19 D/A Converter Characteristics Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition A Condition C 8 MHz 16 MHz Item Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Unit Resolution 8 8 8 8 8 8 Bits Conversion time — — 10 — — 10 µs 20-pF capacitive load Absolute accuracy — ±2.0 ±3.0 — ±1.0 ±1.5 LSB 2-MΩ resistive load — — ±2.0 — — ±1.0 LSB 4-MΩ resistive load Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 710 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Test Conditions Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.2.6 Flash Memory Characteristics Table 22.20 lists the flash memory characteristics. Table 22.20 Flash Memory Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, VPP = 12 V ± 0.6 V, φ = 1 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, VPP = 12 V ± 0.6 V, φ = 1 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications) Item Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Programming time*1 Test Conditions tP — 50 1000 µs Erase time*1 tE — 1 30 s Erase-program cycle NWEC — — 100 time *1 tVS1 4 — — µs Verify setup time 2*1 tVS2 2 — — µs Flash memory read setup time*2 tFRS 50 — — µs VCC ≥ 4.5 V 100 — — µs VCC < 4.5 V Verify setup time 1 Notes: 1. To specify each time, follow the appropriate algorithm. 2. Before reading the flash memory, wait at least for the read setup time after clearing the VPPE bit; lowering the voltage supplied to VPP from 12 V to 0–5 V; turning on the power when the external clock is used; or returning from standby mode. When the VPP voltage is cut off, tFRS indicates the time from when the VPP falls below VCC + 2 V to when the flash memory is read. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 711 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3 Operational Timing This section shows timing diagrams. 22.3.1 Bus Timing Bus timing is shown as follows: • Basic bus cycle: two-state access Figure 22.7 shows the timing of the external two-state access cycle. • Basic bus cycle: three-state access Figure 22.8 shows the timing of the external three-state access cycle. • Basic bus cycle: three-state access with one wait state Figure 22.9 shows the timing of the external three-state access cycle with one wait state inserted. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 712 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 T2 tCYC tCH tCL φ tCF tcyc tAD tCR A23 to A0, CS 7 to CS 0 AS tPCH tASD tACC3 tSD tAH tASD tACC3 tSD tAH tAS1 tPCH RD (read) tAS1 tACC1 tRDS tRDH D15 to D0 (read) tPCH tASD HWR, LWR (write) tSD tAH tAS1 tWSW1 tWDD tWDS1 tWDH D15 to D0 (write) Figure 22.7 Basic Bus Cycle: Two-State Access Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 713 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 T2 T3 φ A23 to A0 tACC4 AS tACC4 RD (read) tRDS tACC2 D15 to D0 (read) tWSD HWR, LWR (write) tWSW2 tAS2 tWDS2 D15 to D0 (write) Figure 22.8 Basic Bus Cycle: Three-State Access Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 714 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 T2 TW T3 φ A23 to A0 AS RD (read) D15 to D0 (read) HWR, LWR (write) D15 to D0 (write) tWTS tWTH tWTS tWTH WAIT Figure 22.9 Basic Bus Cycle: Three-State Access with One Wait State Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 715 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.2 Refresh Controller Bus Timing Refresh controller bus timing is shown as follows: • DRAM bus timing Figures 22.10 to 22.15 show the DRAM bus timing in each operating mode. • PSRAM bus timing Figures 22.16 and 22.17 show the pseudo-static RAM bus timing in each operating mode. T2 T1 φ tAD T3 tAD A9 to A1 AS tRAD1 CS 3 (RAS) tRAD3 tRAH tAS1 tRP tASD RD (CAS) tAS1 HWR (UW), LWR (LW ) (read) HWR (UW), LWR (LW ) (write) tCAS tRAC tASD tSD tCRP tSD tAA tCAC RFSH tWDH tRDS D15 to D0 (read) tRDH tWDS3 D15 to D0 (write) Figure 22.10 DRAM Bus Timing (Read/Write): Three-State Access — 2WE WE Mode — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 716 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 T2 T3 φ A9 to A1 tASD tSD AS tCSR tRAD3 CS3 (RAS) tASD tRAD2 tSD tRAD2 tRAD3 RD (CAS) HWR (UW), LWR (LW) RFSH tCSR Figure 22.11 DRAM Bus Timing (Refresh Cycle): Three-State Access — 2WE WE Mode — φ CS3 (RAS) RD (CAS) tCSR tCSR RFSH Figure 22.12 DRAM Bus Timing (Self-Refresh Mode) — 2WE WE Mode — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 717 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 φ T2 tAD T3 tAD A9 to A1 AS tAS1 CS 3 (RAS) tRAD3 tRAD1 tRAH tRP tASD HWR (UCAS), LWR (LCAS) tCAS tAS1 RD (WE) (read) tRAC tCAC RD (WE) (write) RFSH tCRP tSD tAA tASD tSD tWDH tRDS tRDH D15 to D0 (read) tWDS3 D15 to D0 (write) Figure 22.13 DRAM Bus Timing (Read/Write): Three-State Access — 2CAS CAS Mode — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 718 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 T2 T3 φ A9 to A1 tASD tSD AS tCSR tRAD3 CS 3 (RAS) tASD tRAD2 tSD tRAD2 tRAD3 HWR (UCAS), LWR (LCAS) RD (WE) RFSH tCSR Figure 22.14 DRAM Bus Timing (Refresh Cycle): Three-State Access — 2CAS CAS Mode — φ CS 3 (RAS) tCSR HWR (UCAS), LWR (LCAS) tCSR RFSH Figure 22.15 DRAM Bus Timing (Self-Refresh Mode) — 2CAS CAS Mode — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 719 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics T1 φ T2 T3 tAD A23 to A0 AS tRAD1 tRAD3 tRP CS3 tAS1 RD (read) tSD tRSD tRDS D15 to D0 (read) tRDH tWSD tSD HWR, LWR (write) tWDS2 D15 to D0 (write) RFSH Figure 22.16 PSRAM Bus Timing (Read/Write): Three-State Access T1 T2 T3 φ A23 to A0 AS CS3, HWR, LWR, RD tRAD2 tRAD3 RFSH Figure 22.17 PSRAM Bus Timing (Refresh Cycle): Three-State Access Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 720 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.3 Control Signal Timing Control signal timing is shown as follows: • Reset input timing Figure 22.18 shows the reset input timing. • Reset output timing Figure 22.19 shows the reset output timing. • Interrupt input timing Figure 22.20 shows the input timing for NMI and IRQ5 to IRQ0. • Bus-release mode timing Figure 22.21 shows the bus-release mode timing. φ tRESS tRESS RES tMDS tRESW MD2 to MD0 Figure 22.18 Reset Input Timing φ tRESD tRESD RESO tRESOW Figure 22.19 Reset Output Timing* Note: * This is a function for models with on-chip mask ROM (H8/3048, H8/3047, H8/3045, and H8/3044), PROM (H8/3048ZTAT), and on-chip flash memory with a dual power supply (H8/3048F). The function does not exist in the product with on-chip flash memory with a single power supply (H8/3048F-ONE). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 721 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics φ tNMIS tNMIH tNMIS tNMIH NMI IRQ E tNMIS IRQ L IRQ E : Edge-sensitive IRQ i IRQ L : Level-sensitive IRQ i (i = 0 to 5) tNMIW NMI IRQ j (j = 0 to 2) Figure 22.20 Interrupt Input Timing φ tBRQS tBRQS BREQ tBACD2 tBACD1 BACK tBZD A23 to A0, AS, RD, HWR, LWR Figure 22.21 Bus-Release Mode Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 722 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 tBZD Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.4 Clock Timing Clock timing is shown as follows: • Oscillator settling timing Figure 22.22 shows the oscillator settling timing. φ VCC STBY tOSC1 tOSC1 RES Figure 22.22 Oscillator Settling Timing 22.3.5 TPC and I/O Port Timing Figure 22.23 shows the TPC and I/O port timing. T1 T2 T3 φ tPRS tPRH Port 1 to B (read) tPWD Port 1 to 6, 8 to B (write) Figure 22.23 TPC and I/O Port Input/Output Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 723 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.6 ITU Timing ITU timing is shown as follows: • ITU input/output timing Figure 22.24 shows the ITU input/output timing. • ITU external clock input timing Figure 22.25 shows the ITU external clock input timing. φ tTOCD Output compare*1 tTICS Input capture*2 Notes: 1. TIOCA0 to TIOCA4, TIOCB0 to TIOCB4, TOCXA4, TOCXB4 2. TIOCA0 to TIOCA4, TIOCB0 to TIOCB4 Figure 22.24 ITU Input/Output Timing tTCKS φ tTCKS TCLKA to TCLKD tTCKWL tTCKWH Figure 22.25 ITU External Clock Input Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 724 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.7 SCI Input/Output Timing SCI timing is shown as follows: • SCI input clock timing Figure 22.26 shows the SCK input clock timing. • SCI input/output timing (synchronous mode) Figure 22.27 shows the SCI input/output timing in synchronous mode. tSCKW tSCKr tSCKf SCK0, SCK1 tScyc Figure 22.26 SCK Input Clock Timing tScyc SCK0, SCK1 tTXD TxD0, TxD1 (transmit data) tRXS tRXH RxD0, RxD1 (receive data) Figure 22.27 SCI Input/Output Timing in Synchronous Mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 725 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Section 22 Electrical Characteristics 22.3.8 DMAC Timing DMAC timing is shown as follows. • DMAC TEND output timing for 2 state access Figure 22.28 shows the DMAC TEND output timing for 2 state access. • DMAC TEND output timing for 3 state access Figure 22.29 shows the DMAC TEND output timing for 3 state access. • DMAC DREQ input timing Figure 22.30 shows DMAC DREQ input timing. T1 T2 φ tTED1 tTED2 TEND Figure 22.28 DMAC TEND Output Timing for 2 State Access T1 φ T2 T3 tTED2 tTED1 TEND Figure 22.29 DMAC TEND Output Timing for 3 State Access φ tDRQS tDRQH DREQ Figure 22.30 DMAC DREQ Input Timing Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 726 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Appendix A Instruction Set A.1 Instruction List Operand Notation Symbol Description Rd General destination register Rs General source register Rn General register ERd General destination register (address register or 32-bit register) ERs General source register (address register or 32-bit register) ERn General register (32-bit register) (EAd) Destination operand (EAs) Source operand PC Program counter SP Stack pointer CCR Condition code register N N (negative) flag in CCR Z Z (zero) flag in CCR V V (overflow) flag in CCR C C (carry) flag in CCR disp Displacement → Transfer from the operand on the left to the operand on the right, or transition from the state on the left to the state on the right + Addition of the operands on both sides – Subtraction of the operand on the right from the operand on the left × Multiplication of the operands on both sides ÷ Division of the operand on the left by the operand on the right ∧ Logical AND of the operands on both sides ∨ Logical OR of the operands on both sides ⊕ Exclusive logical OR of the operands on both sides ¬ NOT (logical complement) ( ), < > Contents of operand Note: General registers include 8-bit registers (R0H to R7H and R0L to R7L) and 16-bit registers (R0 to R7 and E0 to E7). Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 727 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Symbol Description ↔ Condition Code Notation Changed according to execution result * Undetermined (no guaranteed value) 0 Cleared to 0 1 Set to 1 — Not affected by execution of the instruction ∆ Varies depending on conditions, described in notes Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 728 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Table A.1 Instruction Set 1. Data transfer instructions No. of States*1 MOV.B @(d:16, ERs), Rd B @(d:16, ERs) → Rd8 4 — — MOV.B @(d:24, ERs), Rd B @(d:24, ERs) → Rd8 8 — — MOV.B @ERs+, Rd B @ERs → Rd8 ERs32+1 → ERs32 MOV.B @aa:8, Rd B @aa:8 → Rd8 2 — — MOV.B @aa:16, Rd B @aa:16 → Rd8 4 — — MOV.B @aa:24, Rd B @aa:24 → Rd8 6 — — MOV.B Rs, @ERd B Rs8 → @ERd MOV.B Rs, @(d:16, ERd) B Rs8 → @(d:16, ERd) 4 — — MOV.B Rs, @(d:24, ERd) B Rs8 → @(d:24, ERd) 8 — — MOV.B Rs, @–ERd B ERd32–1 → ERd32 Rs8 → @ERd MOV.B Rs, @aa:8 B Rs8 → @aa:8 2 — — MOV.B Rs, @aa:16 B Rs8 → @aa:16 4 — — MOV.B Rs, @aa:24 B Rs8 → @aa:24 6 — — MOV.W #xx:16, Rd W #xx:16 → Rd16 MOV.W Rs, Rd W Rs16 → Rd16 MOV.W @ERs, Rd W @ERs → Rd16 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 4 — — 2 — — 2 MOV.W @(d:16, ERs), Rd W @(d:16, ERs) → Rd16 4 — — MOV.W @(d:24, ERs), Rd W @(d:24, ERs) → Rd16 8 — — MOV.W @ERs+, Rd W @ERs → Rd16 ERs32+2 → @ERd32 MOV.W @aa:16, Rd W @aa:16 → Rd16 4 — — MOV.W @aa:24, Rd W @aa:24 → Rd16 6 — — MOV.W Rs, @ERd W Rs16 → @ERd — — 2 — — 2 MOV.W Rs, @(d:16, ERd) W Rs16 → @(d:16, ERd) 4 — — MOV.W Rs, @(d:24, ERd) W Rs16 → @(d:24, ERd) 8 — — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ B @ERs → Rd8 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ MOV.B @ERs, Rd — — 2 0 — 0 — 0 — Advanced Normal C 0 — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ B Rs8 → Rd8 V ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ Z ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ N MOV.B Rs, Rd 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ I B #xx:8 → Rd8 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ H — — MOV.B #xx:8, Rd ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 2 0 — 2 0 — 4 0 — 6 0 — 10 0 — 6 4 0 — 6 0 — 8 0 — 4 0 — 6 0 — 10 0 — 6 4 0 — 6 0 — 8 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 4 0 — 6 0 — 10 0 — 6 6 0 — 8 0 — 4 0 — 6 0 — 10 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 729 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set No. of States*1 N Z 4 — — 6 — — V L @(d:24, ERs) → ERd32 10 MOV.L @ERs+, ERd L @ERs → ERd32 ERs32+4 → ERs32 MOV.L @aa:16, ERd L @aa:16 → ERd32 MOV.L @aa:24, ERd L @aa:24 → ERd32 MOV.L ERs, @ERd L ERs32 → @ERd MOV.L ERs, @(d:16, ERd) L ERs32 → @(d:16, ERd) 6 MOV.L ERs, @(d:24, ERd) L ERs32 → @(d:24, ERd) 10 MOV.L ERs, @–ERd L ERd32–4 → ERd32 ERs32 → @ERd MOV.L ERs, @aa:16 L ERs32 → @aa:16 MOV.L ERs, @aa:24 L ERs32 → @aa:24 6 — — POP.W Rn W @SP → Rn16 SP+2 → SP 8 2 — — POP.L ERn L @SP → ERn32 SP+4 → SP 4 — — PUSH.W Rn W SP–2 → SP Rn16 → @SP 2 — — PUSH.L ERn L SP–4 → SP ERn32 → @SP 4 — — MOVFPE @aa:16, Rd B Cannot be used in the H8/3048 Group 4 Cannot be used in the H8/3048 Group B Cannot be used in the H8/3048 Group 4 Cannot be used in the H8/3048 Group MOVTPE Rs, @aa:16 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 730 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 — — — — 4 — — 4 6 — — 8 — — — — — — — — 4 — — ↔ MOV.L @(d:24, ERs), ERd — — ↔ 6 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ L @(d:16, ERs) → ERd32 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ MOV.L @(d:16, ERs), ERd — — 4 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ L @ERs → ERd32 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ MOV.L @ERs, ERd — — 2 0 — 0 — 8 0 — 10 0 — 14 0 — 10 ↔ ↔ ↔ L ERs32 → ERd32 ↔ ↔ ↔ MOV.L ERs, ERd — — 6 0 — 10 0 — 12 0 — 6 ↔ L #xx:32 → Rd32 ↔ MOV.L #xx:32, Rd 0 — 0 — 10 ↔ W Rs16 → @aa:24 ↔ W Rs16 → @aa:16 MOV.W Rs, @aa:24 C 0 — 0 — 6 ↔ MOV.W Rs, @aa:16 2 Advanced I W ERd32–2 → ERd32 Rs16 → @ERd ↔ H — — MOV.W Rs, @–ERd Normal — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 0 — 10 6 6 0 — 8 0 — 6 0 — 2 0 — 8 0 — 10 0 — 14 0 — 10 10 0 — 12 Appendix A Instruction Set 2. Arithmetic instructions No. of States*1 Advanced N Z V C ↔ ↔ — (2) ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 2 — (2) ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 2 ↔ ↔ (3) ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ I Normal H ↔ ↔ — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 2 — — — — — — 2 B Rd8+#xx:8 → Rd8 ADD.B Rs, Rd B Rd8+Rs8 → Rd8 ADD.W #xx:16, Rd W Rd16+#xx:16 → Rd16 ADD.W Rs, Rd W Rd16+Rs16 → Rd16 ADD.L #xx:32, ERd L ERd32+#xx:32 → ERd32 ADD.L ERs, ERd L ERd32+ERs32 → ERd32 ADDX.B #xx:8, Rd B Rd8+#xx:8 +C → Rd8 ADDX.B Rs, Rd B Rd8+Rs8 +C → Rd8 2 — ADDS.L #1, ERd L ERd32+1 → ERd32 2 ADDS.L #2, ERd L ERd32+2 → ERd32 2 — — — — — — 2 ADDS.L #4, ERd L ERd32+4 → ERd32 2 — — — — — — 2 INC.B Rd B Rd8+1 → Rd8 2 — — INC.W #1, Rd W Rd16+1 → Rd16 2 — — INC.W #2, Rd W Rd16+2 → Rd16 2 — — INC.L #1, ERd L ERd32+1 → ERd32 2 — — INC.L #2, ERd L ERd32+2 → ERd32 2 — — DAA Rd B Rd8 decimal adjust → Rd8 2 — * 2 — — (1) 2 6 2 2 — (1) (3) 2 4 2 6 2 — 2 — 2 — 2 — 2 — 2 * — 2 SUB.W Rs, Rd W Rd16–Rs16 → Rd16 SUB.L #xx:32, ERd L ERd32–#xx:32 → ERd32 SUB.L ERs, ERd L ERd32–ERs32 → ERd32 SUBX.B #xx:8, Rd B Rd8–#xx:8–C → Rd8 SUBX.B Rs, Rd B Rd8–Rs8–C → Rd8 2 — SUBS.L #1, ERd L ERd32–1 → ERd32 2 — — — — — — 2 SUBS.L #2, ERd L ERd32–2 → ERd32 2 — — — — — — 2 SUBS.L #4, ERd L ERd32–4 → ERd32 2 — — — — — — 2 DEC.B Rd B Rd8–1 → Rd8 2 — — DEC.W #1, Rd W Rd16–1 → Rd16 2 — — DEC.W #2, Rd W Rd16–2 → Rd16 2 — — 2 6 — (1) — (2) 2 — (2) — ↔ ↔ 2 (3) (3) ↔ ↔ ↔ — (1) ↔ ↔ ↔ 4 ↔ ↔ ↔ 2 W Rd16–#xx:16 → Rd16 ↔ B Rd8–Rs8 → Rd8 SUB.W #xx:16, Rd ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ SUB.B Rs, Rd ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 4 — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ADD.B #xx:8, Rd 4 2 6 2 2 2 — 2 — 2 — 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 731 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set No. of States*1 Advanced V C — — L ERd32–2 → ERd32 2 — — ↔ ↔ — 2 DAS.Rd B Rd8 decimal adjust → Rd8 2 — * ↔ ↔ ↔ 2 DEC.L #2, ERd ↔ ↔ ↔ — * — 2 MULXU. B Rs, Rd B Rd8 × Rs8 → Rd16 (unsigned multiplication) 2 — — — — — — 14 MULXU. W Rs, ERd W Rd16 × Rs16 → ERd32 (unsigned multiplication) 2 — — — — — — 22 MULXS. B Rs, Rd B Rd8 × Rs8 → Rd16 (signed multiplication) 4 — — ↔ I Normal Z 2 MULXS. W Rs, ERd W Rd16 × Rs16 → ERd32 (signed multiplication) 4 — — DIVXU. B Rs, Rd B Rd16 ÷ Rs8 → Rd16 (RdH: remainder, RdL: quotient) (unsigned division) DIVXU. W Rs, ERd 2 — — (6) (7) — — 14 W ERd32 ÷ Rs16 → ERd32 (Ed: remainder, Rd: quotient) (unsigned division) 2 — — (6) (7) — — 22 DIVXS. B Rs, Rd B Rd16 ÷ Rs8 → Rd16 (RdH: remainder, RdL: quotient) (signed division) 4 — — (8) (7) — — 16 DIVXS. W Rs, ERd W ERd32 ÷ Rs16 → ERd32 (Ed: remainder, Rd: quotient) (signed division) 4 — — (8) (7) — — 24 CMP.B #xx:8, Rd B Rd8–#xx:8 CMP.B Rs, Rd B Rd8–Rs8 CMP.W #xx:16, Rd W Rd16–#xx:16 CMP.W Rs, Rd W Rd16–Rs16 CMP.L #xx:32, ERd L ERd32–#xx:32 CMP.L ERs, ERd L ERd32–ERs32 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 732 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 2 — 2 — — (1) 4 2 — (1) — (2) 6 2 — (2) ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 24 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 16 ↔ ↔ — — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ N L ERd32–1 → ERd32 ↔ H DEC.L #1, ERd ↔ — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 2 2 4 2 4 2 Appendix A Instruction Set No. of States*1 ↔ ↔ ↔ W 0–Rd16 → Rd16 2 — NEG.L ERd L 0–ERd32 → ERd32 2 — EXTU.W Rd W 0 → (<bits 15 to 8> of Rd16) 2 — — 0 EXTU.L ERd L 0 → (<bits 31 to 16> of ERd32) 2 — — 0 EXTS.W Rd W (<bit 7> of Rd16) → (<bits 15 to 8> of Rd16) 2 — — EXTS.L ERd L (<bit 15> of ERd32) → (<bits 31 to 16> of ERd32) 2 — — Advanced ↔ ↔ ↔ NEG.W Rd Normal C ↔ ↔ ↔ V ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — 2 0 — 2 ↔ 2 0 — 2 ↔ H B 0–Rd8 → Rd8 0 — 2 ↔ Z ↔ I NEG.B Rd ↔ ↔ ↔ N ↔ — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 0 — 2 2 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 733 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set 3. Logic instructions No. of States*1 Z B Rd8∧#xx:8 → Rd8 AND.B Rs, Rd B Rd8∧Rs8 → Rd8 AND.W #xx:16, Rd W Rd16∧#xx:16 → Rd16 AND.W Rs, Rd W Rd16∧Rs16 → Rd16 AND.L #xx:32, ERd L ERd32∧#xx:32 → ERd32 AND.L ERs, ERd L ERd32∧ERs32 → ERd32 OR.B #xx:8, Rd B Rd8∨#xx:8 → Rd8 OR.B Rs, Rd B Rd8∨Rs8 → Rd8 OR.W #xx:16, Rd W Rd16∨#xx:16 → Rd16 OR.W Rs, Rd W Rd16∨Rs16 → Rd16 OR.L #xx:32, ERd L ERd32∨#xx:32 → ERd32 OR.L ERs, ERd L ERd32∨ERs32 → ERd32 XOR.B #xx:8, Rd B Rd8⊕#xx:8 → Rd8 XOR.B Rs, Rd B Rd8⊕Rs8 → Rd8 XOR.W #xx:16, Rd W Rd16⊕#xx:16 → Rd16 XOR.W Rs, Rd W Rd16⊕Rs16 → Rd16 XOR.L #xx:32, ERd L ERd32⊕#xx:32 → ERd32 6 XOR.L ERs, ERd L ERd32⊕ERs32 → ERd32 4 — — NOT.B Rd B ¬ Rd8 → Rd8 2 — — NOT.W Rd W ¬ Rd16 → Rd16 2 — — NOT.L ERd L ¬ Rd32 → Rd32 2 — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 734 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 2 2 — — — — 4 2 — — — — 6 4 — — — — 2 2 — — — — 4 2 — — — — 6 4 — — — — 2 2 — — — — 4 2 — — — — V C Advanced N ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ I AND.B #xx:8, Rd Normal H — — ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 0 — 2 0 — 2 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 6 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 2 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 6 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 2 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 6 0 — 4 0 — 2 0 — 2 0 — 2 Appendix A Instruction Set 4. Shift instructions SHAL.L ERd L SHAR.B Rd B SHAR.W Rd W SHAR.L ERd L SHLL.B Rd B SHLL.W Rd W SHLL.L ERd L SHLR.B Rd B SHLR.W Rd W SHLR.L ERd L ROTXL.B Rd B ROTXL.W Rd W ROTXL.L ERd L ROTXR.B Rd B ROTXR.W Rd W ROTXR.L ERd L ROTL.B Rd B ROTL.W Rd W ROTL.L ERd L ROTR.B Rd B ROTR.W Rd W ROTR.L ERd L C 0 MSB LSB C MSB LSB C 0 MSB LSB 0 C MSB LSB C MSB LSB C MSB LSB C MSB LSB C MSB LSB Z 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — 2 — — V C 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Advanced I Normal — @@aa @(d, PC) @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn N — — ↔ ↔ ↔ W H 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ SHAL.W Rd Condition Code ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ B No. of States*1 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ SHAL.B Rd Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 735 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set 5. Bit manipulation instructions BSET #xx:3, @ERd B (#xx:3 of @ERd) ← 1 BSET #xx:3, @aa:8 B (#xx:3 of @aa:8) ← 1 BSET Rn, Rd B (Rn8 of Rd8) ← 1 BSET Rn, @ERd B (Rn8 of @ERd) ← 1 BSET Rn, @aa:8 B (Rn8 of @aa:8) ← 1 BCLR #xx:3, Rd B (#xx:3 of Rd8) ← 0 BCLR #xx:3, @ERd B (#xx:3 of @ERd) ← 0 BCLR #xx:3, @aa:8 B (#xx:3 of @aa:8) ← 0 BCLR Rn, Rd B (Rn8 of Rd8) ← 0 BCLR Rn, @ERd B (Rn8 of @ERd) ← 0 BCLR Rn, @aa:8 B (Rn8 of @aa:8) ← 0 BNOT #xx:3, Rd B (#xx:3 of Rd8) ← ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) BNOT #xx:3, @ERd B (#xx:3 of @ERd) ← ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd) BNOT #xx:3, @aa:8 B (#xx:3 of @aa:8) ← ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) BNOT Rn, Rd B (Rn8 of Rd8) ← ¬ (Rn8 of Rd8) BNOT Rn, @ERd B (Rn8 of @ERd) ← ¬ (Rn8 of @ERd) BNOT Rn, @aa:8 B (Rn8 of @aa:8) ← ¬ (Rn8 of @aa:8) BTST #xx:3, Rd B ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → Z BTST #xx:3, @ERd B ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd) → Z BTST #xx:3, @aa:8 B ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → Z BTST Rn, Rd B ¬ (Rn8 of @Rd8) → Z BTST Rn, @ERd B ¬ (Rn8 of @ERd) → Z BTST Rn, @aa:8 B ¬ (Rn8 of @aa:8) → Z BLD #xx:3, Rd B (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 736 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 2 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 N 4 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 4 4 C 2 — — — 2 V — — — — — — — — — 4 Z Advanced H Normal — @@aa I — — — — — — — — — 2 2 @(d, PC) @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Condition Code — — — — — 2 — — 6 — — 6 — — 2 — — 6 — — 6 ↔ B (#xx:3 of Rd8) ← 1 No. of States*1 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ BSET #xx:3, Rd Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 2 — — — — — Appendix A Instruction Set BLD #xx:3, @aa:8 B (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BILD #xx:3, Rd B ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BILD #xx:3, @ERd B ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd) → C BILD #xx:3, @aa:8 B ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BST #xx:3, Rd B C → (#xx:3 of Rd8) BST #xx:3, @ERd B C → (#xx:3 of @ERd24) BST #xx:3, @aa:8 B C → (#xx:3 of @aa:8) BIST #xx:3, Rd B ¬ C → (#xx:3 of Rd8) BIST #xx:3, @ERd B ¬ C → (#xx:3 of @ERd24) BIST #xx:3, @aa:8 B ¬ C → (#xx:3 of @aa:8) BAND #xx:3, Rd B C∧(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BAND #xx:3, @ERd B C∧(#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C BAND #xx:3, @aa:8 B C∧(#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BIAND #xx:3, Rd B C∧ ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BIAND #xx:3, @ERd B C∧ ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C BIAND #xx:3, @aa:8 B C∧ ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BOR #xx:3, Rd B C∨(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BOR #xx:3, @ERd B C∨(#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C BOR #xx:3, @aa:8 B C∨(#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BIOR #xx:3, Rd B C∨ ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BIOR #xx:3, @ERd B C∨ ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C BIOR #xx:3, @aa:8 B C∨ ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BXOR #xx:3, Rd B C⊕(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BXOR #xx:3, @ERd B C⊕(#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C BXOR #xx:3, @aa:8 B C⊕(#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C BIXOR #xx:3, Rd B C⊕ ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C BIXOR #xx:3, @ERd B C⊕ ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C BIXOR #xx:3, @aa:8 B C⊕ ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C 4 4 I H N Z C 6 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 8 — — — — — — 8 2 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — — — — — 2 — — — — — 4 4 Advanced V — — — — — Normal — @@aa @(d, PC) @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Condition Code ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ B (#xx:3 of @ERd) → C No. of States*1 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ BLD #xx:3, @ERd Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) — — — — — 6 2 6 6 6 6 2 6 6 2 6 6 2 6 6 2 6 6 2 6 6 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 737 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set 6. Branching instructions BRA d:8 (BT d:8) BRN d:16 (BF d:16) — If condition Always — is true then PC ← PC+d Never — else next; — BHI d:8 — BHI d:16 — BLS d:8 — BLS d:16 — BCC d:8 (BHS d:8) — BCC d:16 (BHS d:16) — BCS d:8 (BLO d:8) — BCS d:16 (BLO d:16) — BNE d:8 — BNE d:16 — BEQ d:8 — BEQ d:16 — BVC d:8 — BVC d:16 — BVS d:8 — BVS d:16 — BPL d:8 — BPL d:16 — BMI d:8 — BMI d:16 — BGE d:8 — BGE d:16 — BLT d:8 — BLT d:16 — BGT d:8 — BGT d:16 — BLE d:8 — BLE d:16 — BRA d:16 (BT d:16) BRN d:8 (BF d:8) C∨Z=0 C∨Z=1 C=0 C=1 Z=0 Z=1 V=0 V=1 N=0 N=1 N⊕V = 0 N⊕V = 1 Z ∨ (N⊕V) = 0 Z ∨ (N⊕V) = 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 738 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 No. of States*1 H N Z V C Advanced I Normal — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Branch Condition Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 2 — — — — — — 4 4 — — — — — — 6 Appendix A Instruction Set JMP @ERn — PC ← ERn JMP @aa:24 — PC ← aa:24 JMP @@aa:8 — PC ← @aa:8 BSR d:8 — PC → @–SP PC ← PC+d:8 BSR d:16 — PC → @–SP PC ← PC+d:16 JSR @ERn — PC → @–SP PC ← @ERn JSR @aa:24 — PC → @–SP PC ← @aa:24 JSR @@aa:8 — PC → @–SP PC ← @aa:8 RTS — PC ← @SP+ No. of States*1 H N Z V C — — — — — — 2 4 — — — — — — 4 Advanced I Normal — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 6 — — — — — — 8 10 2 — — — — — — 6 8 4 — — — — — — 8 10 — — — — — — 6 8 — — — — — — 8 10 — — — — — — 8 12 2 — — — — — — 8 10 2 2 4 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 739 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set 7. System control instructions No. of States*1 6 LDC @(d:24, ERs), CCR W @(d:24, ERs) → CCR 10 LDC @ERs+, CCR W @ERs → CCR ERs32+2 → ERs32 LDC @aa:16, CCR W @aa:16 → CCR 6 LDC @aa:24, CCR W @aa:24 → CCR 8 @@aa Advanced W @(d:16, ERs) → CCR Normal LDC @(d:16, ERs), CCR — — — — — — 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 4 10 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ 4 C ↔ W @ERs → CCR 2 V ↔ LDC @ERs, CCR 2 ↔ B Rs8 → CCR Z ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ B #xx:8 → CCR LDC Rs, CCR ↔ LDC #xx:8, CCR N ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — Transition to powerdown state 16 H ↔ SLEEP 1 — — — — — 14 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ — CCR ← @SP+ PC ← @SP+ I 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ ↔ RTE — — PC → @–SP CCR → @–SP <vector> → PC ↔ TRAPA #x:2 @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) 12 — — — — — — 2 — — — — — — 6 2 2 6 8 8 8 10 6 — — — — — — 8 STC CCR, @(d:24, ERd) W CCR → @(d:24, ERd) 10 — — — — — — 12 STC CCR, @–ERd W ERd32–2 → ERd32 CCR → @ERd — — — — — — 8 STC CCR, @aa:16 W CCR → @aa:16 6 — — — — — — 8 STC CCR, @aa:24 W CCR → @aa:24 8 — — — — — — 10 ANDC #xx:8, CCR B CCR∧#xx:8 → CCR 2 ORC #xx:8, CCR B CCR∨#xx:8 → CCR 2 XORC #xx:8, CCR B CCR⊕#xx:8 → CCR 2 NOP — PC ← PC+2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 740 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ↔ ↔ ↔ 4 ↔ ↔ ↔ W CCR → @(d:16, ERd) 4 ↔ ↔ ↔ STC CCR, @(d:16, ERd) 2 ↔ ↔ ↔ W CCR → @ERd ↔ ↔ ↔ B CCR → Rd8 STC CCR, @ERd ↔ ↔ ↔ STC CCR, Rd 2 2 — — — — — — 2 2 2 Appendix A Instruction Set 8. Block transfer instructions No. of States*1 H N Z V C EEPMOV. B — if R4L ≠ 0 then repeat @R5 → @R6 R5+1 → R5 R6+1 → R6 R4L–1 → R4L until R4L=0 else next 4 — — — — — — 8+ 4n*2 EEPMOV. W — if R4 ≠ 0 then repeat @R5 → @R6 R5+1 → R5 R6+1 → R6 R4–1 → R4 until R4=0 else next 4 — — — — — — 8+ 4n*2 Advanced I Normal — @@aa @(d, PC) Condition Code @aa @–ERn/@ERn+ @(d, ERn) @ERn Rn Operation #xx Mnemonic Operand Size Addressing Mode and Instruction Length (bytes) Notes: 1. The number of states is the number of states required for execution when the instruction and its operands are located in on-chip memory. For other cases see section A.3, Number of States Required for Execution. 2. n is the value set in register R4L or R4. (1) Set to 1 when a carry or borrow occurs at bit 11; otherwise cleared to 0. (2) Set to 1 when a carry or borrow occurs at bit 27; otherwise cleared to 0. (3) Retains its previous value when the result is zero; otherwise cleared to 0. (4) Set to 1 when the adjustment produces a carry; otherwise retains its previous value. (5) The number of states required for execution of an instruction that transfers data in synchronization with the E clock is variable. (6) Set to 1 when the divisor is negative; otherwise cleared to 0. (7) Set to 1 when the divisor is zero; otherwise cleared to 0. (8) Set to 1 when the quotient is negative; otherwise cleared to 0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 741 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 742 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 MULXU 5 STC Table A-2 (2) LDC 3 SUBX OR XOR AND MOV C D E F BILD BIST BLD BST TRAPA BEQ B BIAND BAND AND RTE BNE CMP BIXOR BXOR XOR BSR BCS A BIOR BOR OR RTS BCC MOV.B Table A-2 (2) LDC 7 ADDX BTST DIVXU BLS AND.B ANDC 6 9 BCLR MULXU BHI XOR.B XORC 5 ADD BNOT DIVXU BRN OR.B ORC 4 8 7 BSET BRA 6 2 1 Table A-2 Table A-2 Table A-2 Table A-2 (2) (2) (2) (2) NOP 4 3 2 1 0 0 MOV BVS 9 B JMP BPL BMI MOV Table A-2 Table A-2 (2) (2) Table A-2 Table A-2 (2) (2) A Table A-2 Table A-2 EEPMOV (2) (2) SUB ADD Table A-2 (2) BVC 8 BSR BGE C CMP MOV Instruction when most significant bit of BH is 1. Instruction when most significant bit of BH is 0. JSR BGT SUBX ADDX E Table A-2 (3) BLT D BLE Table A-2 (2) Table A-2 (2) F Table A.2 AL 1st byte 2nd byte AH AL BH BL A.2 AH Instruction code: Appendix A Instruction Set Operation Code Map Operation Code Map SUBS DAS BRA MOV MOV 1B 1F 58 79 7A CMP CMP ADD ADD 2 BHI 1 SUB SUB BLS OR OR XOR XOR BCS AND AND BEQ BVC SUB 9 BVS NEG NOT DEC ROTR ROTXR DEC ROTL ADDS SLEEP 8 ROTXL EXTU INC 7 SHAR BNE 6 SHLR EXTU INC 5 SHAL BCC LDC/STC 4 SHLL 3 1st byte 2nd byte AH AL BH BL BRN NOT 17 DEC ROTXR 13 1A ROTXL 12 DAA 0F SHLR ADDS 0B 11 INC 0A SHLL MOV 01 10 0 BH AH AL Instruction code: BPL A MOV BMI NEG CMP SUB ROTR ROTL SHAR C D BGE BLT DEC EXTS INC Table A-2 Table A-2 (3) (3) ADD SHAL B BGT E BLE DEC EXTS INC Table A-2 (3) F Appendix A Instruction Set Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 743 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 CL Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 744 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 DIVXS 3 BSET 7Faa7 * 2 BNOT BNOT BCLR BCLR Notes: 1. r is the register designation field. 2. aa is the absolute address field. BSET 7Faa6 * 2 BTST BCLR 7Eaa7 * 2 BNOT BTST BSET 7Dr07 * 1 7Eaa6 * 2 BSET 7Dr06 * 1 BTST BCLR MULXS 2 7Cr07 * 1 BNOT DIVXS 1 BTST MULXS 0 BIOR BOR BIOR BOR OR 4 BIXOR BXOR BIXOR BXOR XOR 5 BIAND BAND BIAND BAND AND 6 7 BIST BILD BST BLD BIST BILD BST BLD 1st byte 2nd byte 3rd byte 4th byte AH AL BH BL CH CL DH DL 7Cr06 * 1 01F06 01D05 01C05 01406 AH ALBH BLCH Instruction code: 8 LDC STC 9 A LDC STC B C LDC STC D E LDC STC F Instruction when most significant bit of DH is 1. Instruction when most significant bit of DH is 0. Appendix A Instruction Set Appendix A Instruction Set A.3 Number of States Required for Execution The tables in this section can be used to calculate the number of states required for instruction execution by the H8/300H CPU. Table A.4 indicates the number of instruction fetch, data read/write, and other cycles occurring in each instruction. Table A.3 indicates the number of states required per cycle according to the bus size. The number of states required for execution of an instruction can be calculated from these two tables as follows: Number of states = I × SI + J × SJ + K × SK + L × SL + M × SM + N × SN Examples of Calculation of Number of States Required for Execution Examples: Advanced mode, stack located in external address space, on-chip supporting modules accessed with 8-bit bus width, external devices accessed in three states with one wait state and 16-bit bus width. BSET #0, @FFFFC7:8 From table A.4, I = L = 2 and J = K = M = N = 0 From table A.3, SI = 4 and SL = 3 Number of states = 2 × 4 + 2 × 3 = 14 JSR @@30 From table A.4, I = J = K = 2 and L = M = N = 0 From table A.3, SI = SJ = SK = 4 Number of states = 2 × 4 + 2 × 4 + 2 × 4 = 24 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 745 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Table A.3 Number of States per Cycle Access Conditions On-Chip Supporting Module Cycle Instruction fetch SI Branch address read SJ Stack operation SK Byte data access SL Word data access SM Internal operation SN External Device 8-Bit Bus 16-Bit Bus On-Chip Memory 8-Bit Bus 16-Bit Bus 2-State Access 3-State Access 2-State Access 3-State Access 2 6 3 4 6 + 2m 2 3+m 2 3+m 1 1 3 6 1 1 1 4 6 + 2m 1 1 Legend m: Number of wait states inserted into external device access Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 746 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Table A.4 Number of Cycles per Instruction Instruction Mnemonic Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N ADD ADD.B #xx:8, Rd 1 ADD.B Rs, Rd 1 ADD.W #xx:16, Rd 2 ADD.W Rs, Rd 1 ADD.L #xx:32, ERd 3 ADD.L ERs, ERd 1 ADDS ADDS #1/2/4, ERd 1 ADDX ADDX #xx:8, Rd 1 ADDX Rs, Rd 1 AND AND.B #xx:8, Rd 1 AND.B Rs, Rd 1 AND.W #xx:16, Rd 2 AND.W Rs, Rd 1 AND.L #xx:32, ERd 3 AND.L ERs, ERd 2 ANDC ANDC #xx:8, CCR 1 BAND BAND #xx:3, Rd 1 Bcc BAND #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BAND #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 BRA d:8 (BT d:8) 2 BRN d:8 (BF d:8) 2 BHI d:8 2 BLS d:8 2 BCC d:8 (BHS d:8) 2 BCS d:8 (BLO d:8) 2 BNE d:8 2 BEQ d:8 2 BVC d:8 2 BVS d:8 2 BPL d:8 2 BMI d:8 2 BGE d:8 2 BLT d:8 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 747 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Mnemonic Bcc BCLR BIAND BILD BIOR BIST Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N BGT d:8 2 BLE d:8 2 BRA d:16 (BT d:16) 2 2 BRN d:16 (BF d:16) 2 2 BHI d:16 2 2 BLS d:16 2 2 BCC d:16 (BHS d:16) 2 2 BCS d:16 (BLO d:16) 2 2 BNE d:16 2 2 BEQ d:16 2 2 BVC d:16 2 2 BVS d:16 2 2 BPL d:16 2 2 BMI d:16 2 2 BGE d:16 2 2 BLT d:16 2 2 BGT d:16 2 2 2 BLE d:16 2 BCLR #xx:3, Rd 1 BCLR #xx:3, @ERd 2 2 BCLR #xx:3, @aa:8 2 2 BCLR Rn, Rd 1 BCLR Rn, @ERd 2 2 BCLR Rn, @aa:8 2 2 BIAND #xx:3, Rd 1 BIAND #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BIAND #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 BILD #xx:3, Rd 1 BILD #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BILD #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 BIOR #xx:8, Rd 1 BIOR #xx:8, @ERd 2 1 BIOR #xx:8, @aa:8 2 1 BIST #xx:3, Rd 1 BIST #xx:3, @ERd 2 2 BIST #xx:3, @aa:8 2 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 748 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N Instruction Mnemonic BIXOR BLD BNOT BOR BSET BIXOR #xx:3, Rd 1 BIXOR #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BIXOR #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 BLD #xx:3, Rd 1 BLD #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BLD #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 BNOT #xx:3, Rd 1 BNOT #xx:3, @ERd 2 2 BNOT #xx:3, @aa:8 2 2 BNOT Rn, Rd 1 BNOT Rn, @ERd 2 2 BNOT Rn, @aa:8 2 2 BOR #xx:3, Rd 1 BOR #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 1 BOR #xx:3, @aa:8 2 BSET #xx:3, Rd 1 BSET #xx:3, @ERd 2 2 BSET #xx:3, @aa:8 2 2 BSET Rn, Rd 1 BSET Rn, @ERd 2 BSET Rn, @aa:8 BSR BST BTST 2 2 2 BSR d:8 Normal*1 2 1 Advanced 2 2 BSR d:16 Normal*1 2 1 2 Advanced 2 2 2 BST #xx:3, Rd 1 BST #xx:3, @ERd 2 2 BST #xx:3, @aa:8 2 2 BTST #xx:3, Rd 1 BTST #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BTST #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 BTST Rn, Rd 1 BTST Rn, @ERd 2 1 BTST Rn, @aa:8 2 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 749 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N Instruction Mnemonic BXOR CMP DAA BXOR #xx:3, Rd 1 BXOR #xx:3, @ERd 2 1 BXOR #xx:3, @aa:8 2 1 CMP.B #xx:8, Rd 1 CMP.B Rs, Rd 1 CMP.W #xx:16, Rd 2 CMP.W Rs, Rd 1 CMP.L #xx:32, ERd 3 CMP.L ERs, ERd 1 DAA Rd 1 DAS DAS Rd 1 DEC DEC.B Rd 1 DIVXS DIVXU EEPMOV EXTS DEC.W #1/2, Rd 1 DEC.L #1/2, ERd 1 DIVXS.B Rs, Rd 2 12 DIVXS.W Rs, ERd 2 20 DIVXU.B Rs, Rd 1 12 DIVXU.W Rs, ERd 1 EEPMOV.B 2 EEPMOV.W 2 2n + 2*2 EXTS.W Rd 1 EXTS.L ERd 1 EXTU EXTU.W Rd 1 EXTU.L ERd 1 INC INC.B Rd 1 JMP 20 2n + 2*2 INC.W #1/2, Rd 1 INC.L #1/2, ERd 1 JMP @ERn 2 JMP @aa:24 2 JMP @@aa:8 Normal*1 Advanced 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 750 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N Instruction Mnemonic JSR JSR @ERn JSR @aa:24 Normal*1 2 1 Advanced 2 2 Normal*1 2 1 2 Advanced 2 2 2 JSR @@aa:8 Normal*1 Advanced LDC MOV 2 1 1 2 2 2 LDC #xx:8, CCR 1 LDC Rs, CCR 1 LDC @ERs, CCR 2 1 LDC @(d:16, ERs), CCR 3 1 LDC @(d:24, ERs), CCR 5 1 LDC @ERs+, CCR 2 1 LDC @aa:16, CCR 3 1 LDC @aa:24, CCR 4 1 MOV.B #xx:8, Rd 1 MOV.B Rs, Rd 1 MOV.B @ERs, Rd 1 1 MOV.B @(d:16, ERs), Rd 2 1 MOV.B @(d:24, ERs), Rd 4 1 MOV.B @ERs+, Rd 1 1 MOV.B @aa:8, Rd 1 1 MOV.B @aa:16, Rd 2 1 MOV.B @aa:24, Rd 3 1 MOV.B Rs, @ERd 1 1 MOV.B Rs, @(d:16, ERd) 2 1 MOV.B Rs, @(d:24, ERd) 4 1 MOV.B Rs, @–ERd 1 1 MOV.B Rs, @aa:8 1 1 MOV.B Rs, @aa:16 2 1 MOV.B Rs, @aa:24 3 1 2 2 2 MOV.W #xx:16, Rd 2 MOV.W Rs, Rd 1 MOV.W @ERs, Rd 1 1 MOV.W @(d:16, ERs), Rd 2 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 751 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Mnemonic MOV Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N MOV.W @(d:24, ERs), Rd 4 1 MOV.W @ERs+, Rd 1 1 MOV.W @aa:16, Rd 2 1 MOV.W @aa:24, Rd 3 1 MOV.W Rs, @ERd 1 1 MOV.W Rs, @(d:16, ERd) 2 1 MOV.W Rs, @(d:24, ERd) 4 1 MOV.W Rs, @–ERd 1 1 MOV.W Rs, @aa:16 2 1 MOV.W Rs, @aa:24 3 1 MOV.L #xx:32, ERd 3 MOV.L ERs, ERd 1 MOV.L @ERs, ERd 2 2 MOV.L @(d:16, ERs), ERd 3 2 MOV.L @(d:24, ERs), ERd 5 2 MOV.L @ERs+, ERd 2 2 MOV.L @aa:16, ERd 3 2 MOV.L @aa:24, ERd 4 2 MOV.L ERs, @ERd 2 2 2 2 2 MOV.L ERs, @(d:16, ERd) 3 2 MOV.L ERs, @(d:24, ERd) 5 2 MOV.L ERs, @–ERd 2 2 MOV.L ERs, @aa:16 3 2 MOV.L ERs, @aa:24 4 2 MOVFPE MOVFPE @aa:16, Rd*1 2 1 MOVTPE MOVTPE Rs, @aa:16*1 2 1 MULXS MULXS.B Rs, Rd 2 12 MULXS.W Rs, ERd 2 20 MULXU.B Rs, Rd 1 12 MULXU.W Rs, ERd 1 20 NEG.B Rd 1 NEG.W Rd 1 MULXU NEG NOP NEG.L ERd 1 NOP 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 752 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 2 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N Instruction Mnemonic NOT OR ORC POP PUSH ROTL ROTR ROTXL ROTXR RTE RTS SHAL SHAR NOT.B Rd 1 NOT.W Rd 1 NOT.L ERd 1 OR.B #xx:8, Rd 1 OR.B Rs, Rd 1 OR.W #xx:16, Rd 2 OR.W Rs, Rd 1 OR.L #xx:32, ERd 3 OR.L ERs, ERd 2 ORC #xx:8, CCR 1 POP.W Rn 1 1 2 POP.L ERn 2 2 2 PUSH.W Rn 1 1 2 PUSH.L ERn 2 2 2 ROTL.B Rd 1 ROTL.W Rd 1 ROTL.L ERd 1 ROTR.B Rd 1 ROTR.W Rd 1 ROTR.L ERd 1 ROTXL.B Rd 1 ROTXL.W Rd 1 ROTXL.L ERd 1 ROTXR.B Rd 1 ROTXR.W Rd 1 ROTXR.L ERd 1 RTE 2 RTS 2 2 Normal*1 2 1 2 Advanced 2 2 2 SHAL.B Rd 1 SHAL.W Rd 1 SHAL.L ERd 1 SHAR.B Rd 1 SHAR.W Rd 1 SHAR.L ERd 1 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 753 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix A Instruction Set Instruction Mnemonic Instruction Branch Stack Byte Data Word Data Internal Fetch Addr. Read Operation Access Access Operation I J K L M N SHLL SHLL.B Rd 1 SHLL.W Rd 1 SHLR SHLL.L ERd 1 SHLR.B Rd 1 SHLR.W Rd 1 SHLR.L ERd 1 SLEEP SLEEP 1 STC STC CCR, Rd 1 STC CCR, @ERd 2 1 STC CCR, @(d:16, ERd) 3 1 SUB STC CCR, @(d:24, ERd) 5 1 STC CCR, @–ERd 2 1 STC CCR, @aa:16 3 1 STC CCR, @aa:24 4 1 SUB.B Rs, Rd 1 SUB.W #xx:16, Rd 2 SUB.W Rs, Rd 1 SUB.L #xx:32, ERd 3 2 SUB.L ERs, ERd 1 SUBS SUBS #1/2/4, ERd 1 SUBX SUBX #xx:8, Rd 1 SUBX Rs, Rd 1 TRAPA TRAPA #x:2 Normal*1 2 1 2 4 2 2 2 4 XOR XOR.B #xx:8, Rd 1 XOR.B Rs, Rd 1 XOR.W #xx:16, Rd 2 Advanced XORC XOR.W Rs, Rd 1 XOR.L #xx:32, ERd 3 XOR.L ERs, ERd 2 XORC #xx:8, CCR 1 Notes: 1. Not available in the H8/3048 Group. 2. n is the value set in register R4L or R4. The source and destination are accessed n + 1 times each. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 754 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register Appendix B Internal I/O Register Table B.1 Comparison of H8/3048 Group Internal I/O Register Specifications Address (Low) H8/3048 ZTAT H8/3048 Mask ROM Version, H8/3047 Mask ROM Version, H8/3045 Mask ROM Version, H8/3044 Mask ROM Version H8/3048F H'FF40 — — FLMCR H'FF41 — — — H'FF42 — — EBR1 H'FF43 — — EBR2 H'FF47 — — — H'FF48 — — RAMCR Module Flash memory Note: A dash (“—”) indicates that access is prohibited. Normal operation is not guaranteed if these addresses are accessed. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 755 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register B.1 Addresses Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 Bit Names Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module Name H'1C H'1D H'1E H'1F H'20 MAR0AR 8 H'21 MAR0AE 8 H'22 MAR0AH 8 H'23 MAR0AL 8 H'24 ETCR0AH 8 H'25 ETCR0AL 8 H'26 IOAR0A 8 H'27 DTCR0A 8 H'28 MAR0BR 8 H'29 MAR0BE 8 H'2A MAR0BH 8 H'2B MAR0BL 8 H'2C ETCR0BH 8 H'2D ETCR0BL 8 H'2E IOAR0B 8 H'2F DTCR0B 8 DMAC channel 0A DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Short address mode DTE DTSZ SAID SAIDE DTIE DTS2A DTS1A DTS0A Full address mode DMAC channel 0B DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Short address mode DTME — DAID DAIDE TMS DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Full address mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 756 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 H'30 MAR1AR 8 H'31 MAR1AE 8 H'32 MAR1AH 8 H'33 MAR1AL 8 H'34 ETCR1AH 8 H'35 ETCR1AL 8 H'36 IOAR1A 8 H'37 DTCR1A 8 H'38 MAR1BR 8 H'39 MAR1BE 8 H'3A MAR1BH 8 H'3B MAR1BL 8 H'3C ETCR1BH 8 H'3D ETCR1BL 8 H'3E IOAR1B 8 H'3F DTCR1B 8 Bit Names Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module Name DMAC channel 1A DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Short address mode DTE DTSZ SAID SAIDE DTIE DTS2A DTS1A DTS0A Full address mode DMAC channel 1B DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Short address mode DTME — DAID DAIDE TMS DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Full address mode E P Flash memory H'40 FLMCR 8 VPP VPPE — — EV PV H'41 — — — — — — — — — — H'42 EBR1 8 LB7 LB6 LB5 LB4 LB3 LB2 LB1 LB0 H'43 EBR2 8 SB7 SB6 SB5 SB4 SB3 SB2 SB1 SB0 H'44 — — — — — — — — — — H'45 — — — — — — — — — — H'46 — — — — — — — — — — H'47 — — — — — — — — — — H'48 RAMCR 8 FLER — — — RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 H'49 — — — — — — — — — — H'4A — — — — — — — — — — H'4B — — — — — — — — — — H'4C — — — — — — — — — — H'4D — — — — — — — — — — Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 757 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 H'4E — — — — — — — — — — H'4F — — — — — — — — — — H'50 — — — — — — — — — — H'51 — — — — — — — — — — H'52 — — — — — — — — — — H'53 — — — — — — — — — — H'54 — — — — — — — — — — H'55 — — — — — — — — — — H'56 — — — — — — — — — — H'57 — — — — — — — — — — H'58 — — — — — — — — — — H'59 — — — — — — — — — — H'5A — — — — — — — — — — H'5B — — — — — — — — — — H'5C DASTCR 8 — — — — — — — DASTE D/A converter H'5D DIVCR 8 — — — — — — DIV1 DIV0 H'5E MSTCR 8 PSTOP — MSTOP5 MSTOP4 MSTOP3 MSTOP2 MSTOP1 MSTOP0 System control H'5F CSCR 8 CS7E CS6E CS5E CS4E — — — — Bus controller H'60 TSTR 8 — — — STR4 STR3 STR2 STR1 STR0 — ITU (all channels) H'61 TSNC 8 H'62 TMDR 8 H'63 TFCR 8 — Bit Names — — SYNC4 SYNC3 SYNC2 SYNC1 SYNC0 MDF FDIR PWM4 PWM3 PWM2 PWM1 PWM0 — CMD1 CMD0 BFB4 BFA4 BFB3 BFA3 H'64 TCR0 8 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 H'65 TIOR0 8 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 H'66 TIER0 8 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA H'67 TSR0 8 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA H'68 TCNT0H 16 H'69 TCNT0L H'6A GRA0H H'6B GRA0L H'6C GRB0H H'6D GRB0L Module Name ITU channel 0 16 16 H'6E TCR1 8 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 H'6F TIOR1 8 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 758 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 ITU channel 1 Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 Bit Names Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module Name H'70 TIER1 8 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA ITU channel 1 H'71 TSR1 8 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA H'72 TCNT1H 16 H'73 TCNT1L H'74 GRA1H H'75 GRA1L H'76 GRB1H H'77 GRB1L 16 16 H'78 TCR2 8 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 H'79 TIOR2 8 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 H'7A TIER2 8 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA H'7B TSR2 8 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA H'7C TCNT2H 16 H'7D TCNT2L H'7E GRA2H H'7F GRA2L H'80 GRB2H H'81 GRB2L H'82 TCR3 8 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 H'83 TIOR3 8 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 H'84 TIER3 8 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA H'85 TSR3 8 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA H'86 TCNT3H 16 H'87 TCNT3L H'88 GRA3H H'89 GRA3L H'8A GRB3H H'8B GRB3L H'8C BRA3H H'8D BRA3L H'8E BRB3H H'8F BRB3L ITU channel 2 16 16 ITU channel 3 16 16 16 16 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 759 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 Bit Names Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 H'90 TOER 8 — — EXB4 EXA4 EB3 EB4 EA4 EA3 H'91 TOCR 8 — — — XTGD — — OLS4 OLS3 H'92 TCR4 8 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 H'93 TIOR4 8 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 H'94 TIER4 8 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA H'95 TSR4 8 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA H'96 TCNT4H 16 H'97 TCNT4L H'98 GRA4H H'99 GRA4L H'9A GRB4H H'9B GRB4L H'9C BRA4H H'9D BRA4L H'9E BRB4H H'9F BRB4L H'A0 TPMR 8 — — — — G3NOV G2NOV G1NOV G0NOV H'A1 TPCR 8 G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0 H'A2 NDERB 8 NDER15 NDER14 NDER13 NDER12 NDER11 NDER10 NDER9 NDER8 16 16 NDERA 8 NDER7 NDER6 NDER5 NDER4 NDER3 NDER2 NDER1 NDER0 NDRB*1 8 NDR15 NDR14 NDR13 NDR12 NDR11 NDR10 NDR9 NDR8 8 NDR15 NDR14 NDR13 NDR12 — — — — 8 NDR7 NDR6 NDR5 NDR4 NDR3 NDR2 NDR1 NDR0 8 NDR7 NDR6 NDR5 NDR4 — — — — 8 — — — — — — — — 8 — — — — NDR11 NDR10 NDR9 NDR8 8 — — — — — — — — 8 — — — — NDR3 NDR2 NDR1 NDR0 OVF WT/IT TME — — CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 H'A6 H'A7 NDRB*1 NDRA*1 ITU channel 4 16 H'A4 H'A5 ITU (all channels) 16 H'A3 NDRA*1 Module Name H'A8 TCSR*2 8 H'A9 2 TCNT* 8 H'AA — — — — — — — — — H'AB RSTCSR*3 8 WRST RSTOE — — — — — — H'AC RFSHCR 8 SRFMD PSRAME DRAME CAS/WE M9/M8 RFSHE — RCYCE H'AD RTMCSR 8 CMF CMIE — — — H'AE RTCNT 8 H'AF RTCOR 8 CKS2 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 760 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 CKS1 CKS0 TPC WDT Refresh controller Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 H'B0 SMR 8 H'B1 BRR 8 Bit Names Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module Name C/A GM CHR PE O/E STOP MP CKS1 CKS0 SCI channel 0 TIE RIE TE RE MPIE TEIE CKE1 CKE0 TDRE RDRF ORER FER/ ERS PER TEND MPB MPBT Bit 6 / H'B2 SCR 8 H'B3 TDR 8 H'B4 SSR 8 H'B5 RDR 8 H'B6 SCMR 8 — — — — SDIR SINV — SMIF H'B8 SMR 8 C/A CHR PE O/E STOP MP CKS1 CKS0 H'B9 BRR 8 H'BA SCR 8 TIE RIE TE RE MPIE TEIE CKE1 CKE0 H'BB TDR 8 H'BC SSR 8 TDRE RDRF ORER FER PER TEND MPB MPBT H'BD RDR 8 H'BE — — — — — — — — — H'B7 SCI channel 1 H'BF H'C0 P1DDR 8 P17DDR P16DDR P15DDR P14DDR P13DDR P12DDR P11DDR P10DDR Port 1 H'C1 P2DDR 8 P27DDR P26DDR P25DDR P24DDR P23DDR P22DDR P21DDR P20DDR Port 2 H'C2 P1DR 8 P17 P16 P15 P14 P13 P12 P11 P10 Port 1 H'C3 P2DR 8 P27 P26 P25 P24 P23 P22 P21 P20 Port 2 H'C4 P3DDR 8 P37DDR P36DDR P35DDR P34DDR P33DDR P32DDR P31DDR P30DDR Port 3 H'C5 P4DDR 8 P47DDR P46DDR P45DDR P44DDR P43DDR P42DDR P41DDR P40DDR Port 4 H'C6 P3DR 8 P37 P36 P35 P34 P33 P32 P31 P30 Port 3 H'C7 P4DR 8 P47 P46 P45 P44 P43 P42 P41 P40 Port 4 H'C8 P5DDR 8 — — — — P53DDR P52DDR P51DDR P50DDR Port 5 H'C9 P6DDR 8 — P66DDR P65DDR P64DDR P63DDR P62DDR P61DDR P60DDR Port 6 H'CA P5DR 8 — — — — P53 P52 P51 P50 Port 5 H'CB P6DR 8 — P66 P65 P64 P63 P62 P61 P60 Port 6 H'CC — — — — — — — — — H'CD P8DDR 8 — — — P84DDR P83DDR P82DDR P81DDR P80DDR Port 8 H'CE P7DR 8 P77 P76 P75 P74 P73 P72 P71 P70 Port 7 H'CF P8DR 8 — — — P84 P83 P82 P81 P80 Port 8 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 761 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 Bit Names Bit 6 Bit 5 — P95DDR P94DDR P93DDR P92DDR P91DDR P90DDR Port 9 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module Name H'D0 P9DDR 8 — H'D1 PADDR 8 PA7DDR PA6DDR PA5DDR PA4DDR PA3DDR PA2DDR PA1DDR PA0DDR Port A H'D2 P9DR 8 — — P95 P94 P93 P92 P91 P90 Port 9 H'D3 PADR 8 PA7 PA6 PA5 PA4 PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0 Port A H'D4 PBDDR 8 PB7DDR PB6DDR PB5DDR PB4DDR PB3DDR PB2DDR PB1DDR PB0DDR Port B H'D5 — — — — — — — — — — — H'D6 PBDR 8 PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PB2 PB1 PB0 Port B H'D7 — — — — — — — — — — — H'D8 P2PCR P27PCR P26PCR P25PCR P24PCR P23PCR P22PCR P21PCR P20PCR Port 2 H'D9 — — H'DA P4PCR 8 P47PCR P46PCR P45PCR P44PCR P43PCR P42PCR P41PCR P40PCR Port 4 H'DB P5PCR 8 — H'DC DADR0 8 H'DD DADR1 8 H'DE DACR 8 H'DF — H'E0 ADDRAH H'E1 ADDRAL H'E2 — — — — — — — — — — P53PCR P52PCR P51PCR P50PCR Port 5 D/A converter DAOE1 DAOE0 DAE — — — — — — — — — — — — — 8 AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 8 AD1 AD0 — — — — — — ADDRBH 8 AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 H'E3 ADDRBL 8 AD1 AD0 — — — — — — H'E4 ADDRCH 8 AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 H'E5 ADDRCL 8 AD1 AD0 — — — — — — H'E6 ADDRDH 8 AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 H'E7 ADDRDL 8 AD1 AD0 — — — — — — H'E8 ADCSR 8 ADF ADIE ADST SCAN CKS CH2 CH1 CH0 H'E9 ADCR 8 TRGE — — — — — — — H'EA — — — — — — — — — H'EB — — — — — — — — — H'EC ABWCR ABW7 ABW6 ABW5 ABW4 ABW3 ABW2 ABW1 ABW0 8 H'ED ASTCR 8 AST7 AST6 AST5 AST4 AST3 AST2 AST1 AST0 H'EE WCR 8 — — — — WMS1 WMS0 WC1 WC0 H'EF WCER 8 WCE7 WCE6 WCE5 WCE4 WCE3 WCE2 WCE1 WCE0 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 762 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 A/D converter Bus controller Appendix B Internal I/O Register Address Register (low) Name Data Bus Width Bit 7 Bit Names Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Module Name H'F0 — — — — — — — — — H'F1 MDCR 8 — — — — — MDS2 MDS1 MDS0 H'F2 SYSCR 8 SSBY STS2 STS1 STS0 UE NMIEG — RAME H'F3 BRCR 8 A23E A22E A21E — — — — BRLE H'F4 ISCR 8 — — H'F5 IER 8 — — IRQ5SC IRQ4SC IRQ3SC IRQ2SC IRQ1SC IRQ0SC Interrupt controller IRQ5E IRQ4E IRQ3E IRQ2E IRQ1E IRQ0E H'F6 ISR 8 — — IRQ5F IRQ4F IRQ3F H'F7 — — — — — — — — — H'F8 IPRA 8 IPRA7 IPRA6 IPRA5 IPRA4 IPRA3 IPRA2 IPRA1 IPRA0 H'F9 IPRB 8 IPRB7 IPRB6 IPRB5 — IPRB3 IPRB2 IPRB1 — H'FA — — — — — — — — — H'FB — — — — — — — — — H'FD — — — — — — — — — H'FE — — — — — — — — — H'FF — — — — — — — — — IRQ2F IRQ1F System control Bus controller IRQ0F H'FC Notes: 1. The address depends on the output trigger setting. 2. For write access to TCSR and TCNT, see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access. 3. For write access to RSTCSR, see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access. Legend DMAC: DMA controller ITU: 16-bit integrated timer unit TPC: Programmable timing pattern controller SCI: Serial communication interface WDT: Watchdog timer Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 763 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register B.2 Function Register acronym Register name TSTR Timer Start Register Address to which the register is mapped H'60 Name of on-chip supporting module ITU (all channels) Bit numbers Bit Initial bit values 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — STR4 STR3 STR2 STR1 STR0 Initial value 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Names of the bits. Dashes (—) indicate reserved bits. Possible types of access R Read only W Write only R/W Read and write Counter start 0 0 TCNT0 is halted 1 TCNT0 is counting Counter start 1 0 TCNT1 is halted 1 TCNT1 is counting Full name of bit Counter start 2 0 TCNT2 is halted 1 TCNT2 is counting Counter start 3 0 TCNT3 is halted 1 TCNT3 is counting Counter start 4 0 TCNT4 is halted 1 TCNT4 is counting Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 764 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Descriptions of bit settings Appendix B Internal I/O Register MAR0A R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 0A R/E/H/L 23 H'20, H'21, H'22, H'23 22 21 Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 15 14 13 12 11 19 18 17 16 Undetermined MAR0AR Bit 20 DMAC0 MAR0AE 10 Undetermined 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W MAR0AH MAR0AL Source or destination address Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 765 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register ETCR0A H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0A H/L H'24, H'25 DMAC0 • Short address mode I/O mode and idle mode Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Transfer counter Repeat mode Bit 7 6 5 R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W ETCR0AH Transfer counter Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR0AL Initial count Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 766 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register ETCR0A H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0A H/L (cont) H'24, H'25 DMAC0 • Full address mode Normal mode Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Transfer counter Block transfer mode Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR0AH Block size counter Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR0AL Initial block size Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 767 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register IOAR0A—I/O Address Register 0A Bit 7 6 H'26 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 DMAC0 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Short address mode: source or destination address Full address mode: not used Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 768 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register DTCR0A—Data Transfer Control Register 0A H'27 DMAC0 • Short address mode Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer select Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 Data Transfer Activation Source Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3 SCI0 transmit-data-empty interrupt SCI0 receive-data-full interrupt Transfer in full address mode (channel A) Transfer in full address mode (channel A) Data transfer interrupt enable 0 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is disabled 1 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is enabled Repeat enable RPE 0 1 DTIE 0 1 0 1 Description I/O mode Repeat mode Idle mode Data transfer increment/decrement 0 Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after each transfer 1 Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after each transfer Data transfer size 0 Byte-size transfer 1 Word-size transfer Data transfer enable 0 Data transfer is disabled 1 Data transfer is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 769 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register DTCR0A—Data Transfer Control Register 0A (cont) H'27 DMAC0 • Full address mode Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ SAID SAIDE DTIE DTS2A DTS1A DTS0A Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer select 0A 0 Normal mode 1 Block transfer mode Data transfer select 2A and 1A Set both bits to 1 Data transfer interrupt enable 0 Interrupt request by DTE bit is disabled 1 Interrupt request by DTE bit is enabled Source address increment/decrement (bit 5) Source address increment/decrement enable (bit 4) Bit 5 Bit 4 SAID SAIDE Increment/Decrement Enable 0 0 MARA is held fixed 1 Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARA is incremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MARA is incremented by 2 after each transfer 1 0 MARA is held fixed 1 Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARA is decremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MARA is decremented by 2 after each transfer Data transfer size 0 Byte-size transfer 1 Word-size transfer Data transfer enable 0 Data transfer is disabled 1 Data transfer is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 770 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register MAR0B R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 0B R/E/H/L 23 H'28, H'29, H'2A, H'2B 22 21 Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 15 14 13 12 11 19 18 17 16 Undetermined MAR0BR Bit 20 DMAC0 MAR0BE 10 Undetermined 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W MAR0BH MAR0BL Source or destination address Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 771 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register ETCR0B H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0B H/L H'2C, H'2D DMAC0 • Short address mode I/O mode and idle mode Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Not used Repeat mode Bit 7 6 5 R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W ETCR0BH Transfer counter Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR0BL Initial count Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 772 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register ETCR0B H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0B H/L (cont) H'2C, H'2D DMAC0 • Full address mode Normal mode Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 5 6 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Not used Block transfer mode Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 5 6 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Block transfer counter IOAR0B—I/O Address Register 0B Bit 7 6 H'2E 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 DMAC0 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Short address mode: source or destination address Full address mode: not used Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 773 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register DTCR0B—Data Transfer Control Register 0B H'2F DMAC0 • Short address mode Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer select Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 1 Data Transfer Activation Source Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2 Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3 SCI0 transmit-data-empty interrupt SCI0 receive-data-full interrupt Falling edge of DREQ input Low level of DREQ input Data transfer interrupt enable 0 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is disabled 1 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is enabled An interrupt request is issued to the CPU when the DTE bit = 0 Repeat enable RPE DTIE Description 0 0 I/O mode 1 0 1 Repeat mode 1 Idle mode Data transfer increment/decrement 0 Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after each transfer 1 Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after each transfer Data transfer size 0 Byte-size transfer 1 Word-size transfer Data transfer enable 0 Data transfer is disabled 1 Data transfer is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 774 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register DTCR0B—Data Transfer Control Register 0B (cont) H'2F DMAC0 • Full address mode Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTME — DAID DAIDE TMS DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Data transfer select 2B to 0B Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Data Transfer Activation Source DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Normal Mode Block Transfer Mode 0 0 0 Auto-request Compare match/input capture (burst mode) A from ITU channel 0 Not available Compare match/input capture 1 A from ITU channel 1 Compare match/input capture Auto-request 1 0 A from ITU channel 2 (cycle-steal mode) Compare match/input capture Not available 1 A from ITU channel 3 Not available Not available 1 0 0 Not available Not available 1 Falling edge of DREQ Falling edge of DREQ 1 0 1 Low level input at DREQ Not available Transfer mode select 0 Destination is the block area in block transfer mode 1 Source is the block area in block transfer mode Destination address increment/decrement (bit 5) Destination address increment/decrement enable (bit 4) Bit 5 Bit 4 DAID DAIDE Increment/Decrement Enable 0 0 MARB is held fixed 1 Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARB is incremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MARB is incremented by 2 after each transfer 1 0 MARB is held fixed 1 Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARB is decremented by 1 after each transfer If DTSZ = 1, MARB is decremented by 2 after each transfer Data transfer master enable 0 Data transfer is disabled 1 Data transfer is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 775 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register MAR1A R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 1A R/E/H/L Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 H'30, H'31, H'32, H'33 22 21 20 19 DMAC1 18 17 16 Undetermined Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W MAR1AR Bit Initial value Read/Write 15 14 13 12 11 MAR1AE 10 9 Undetermined 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W MAR1AH Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 776 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 MAR1AL Appendix B Internal I/O Register ETCR1A H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 1A H/L Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 H'34, H'35 6 5 4 DMAC1 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR1AH Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR1AL Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. IOAR1A—I/O Address Register 1A Bit H'36 7 6 5 R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 4 3 DMAC1 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 777 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register DTCR1A—Data Transfer Control Register 1A H'37 DMAC1 • Short address mode Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 • Full address mode Bit DTE DTSZ SAID SAIDE DTIE DTS2A DTS1A DTS0A Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. MAR1B R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 1B R/E/H/L 23 H'38, H'39, H'3A, H'3B 22 21 Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — — — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 15 14 13 12 11 19 18 17 16 Undetermined MAR1BR Bit 20 DMAC1 MAR1BE 10 9 Undetermined 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W MAR1BH Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 778 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 MAR1BL Appendix B Internal I/O Register ETCR1B H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 1B H/L Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 H'3C, H'3D 6 5 4 DMAC1 3 2 1 0 Initial value Undetermined Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Bit 7 6 5 R/W R/W R/W Initial value Read/Write 4 3 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W ETCR1BH Bit 7 6 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ETCR1BL Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. IOAR1B—I/O Address Register 1B Bit 7 6 H'3E 5 Initial value Read/Write 4 3 DMAC1 2 1 0 R/W R/W R/W Undetermined R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 779 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register DTCR1B—Data Transfer Control Register 1B H'3F DMAC1 • Short address mode Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DTE DTSZ DTID RPE DTIE DTS2 DTS1 DTS0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 • Full address mode Bit DTME — DAID DAIDE TMS DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 780 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register FLMCR—Flash Memory Control Register Bit Initial value* R/W H'40 Flash memory 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 VPP VPP E — — EV PV E P 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 — R/W* R/W* R/W * R/W * R R/W — Program mode 0 Exit from program mode (Initial value) 1 Transition to program mode Erase mode 0 Exit from erase mode 1 Transition to erase mode (Initial value) Program-verify mode 0 Exit from program-verify mode 1 Transition to program-verify mode (Initial value) Erase-verify mode 0 Exit from erase-verify mode 1 Transition to erase-verify mode (Initial value) VPP enable 0 VPP pin 12 V power supply is disabled 1 VPP pin 12 V power supply is enabled Programming power 0 Cleared when 12 V is not applied to VPP 1 Set when 12 V is applied to VPP (Initial value) (Initial value) Note: * The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. H8/3048F Include this register H8/3048ZTAT Not include this register H8/3048 mask ROM version H8/3047 mask ROM version H8/3045 mask ROM version H8/3044 mask ROM version Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 781 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register EBR1—Erase Block Register 1 Bit Initial value* R/W H'42 Flash memory 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LB7 LB6 LB5 LB4 LB3 LB2 LB1 LB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* Large block 7 to 0 0 Block LB7 to LB0 is not selected 1 Block LB7 to LB0 is selected (Initial value) Note: * The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. H8/3048F Include this register H8/3048ZTAT Not include this register H8/3048 mask ROM version H8/3047 mask ROM version H8/3045 mask ROM version H8/3044 mask ROM version Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 782 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register EBR2—Erase Block Register 2 Bit Initial value* R/W H'43 Flash memory 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SB7 SB6 SB5 SB4 SB3 SB2 SB1 SB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* R/W* Small block 7 to 0 0 Block SB7 to SB0 is not selected 1 Block SB7 to SB0 is selected (Initial value) Note: * The initial value is H'00 in modes 5, 6, and 7 (on-chip flash memory enabled). In modes 1, 2, 3, and 4 (on-chip flash memory disabled), this register cannot be modified and is always read as H'FF. H8/3048F Include this register H8/3048ZTAT Not include this register H8/3048 mask ROM version H8/3047 mask ROM version H8/3045 mask ROM version H8/3044 mask ROM version Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 783 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register RAMCR—RAM Control Register H'48 Flash memory 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FLER — — — RAMS RAM2 RAM1 RAM0 Initial value 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 R/W R — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W Bit RAM select, RAM 2 to RAM 0 Bit 3 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 2 RAMS RAM 2 RAM 1 RAM 0 1/0 0 1/0 1/0 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 Flash memory error 0 Flash memory is not write/erase-protected (is not in error protect mode) 1 Flash memory is write/erase-protected (is in error protect mode) H8/3048F Include this register H8/3048ZTAT Not include this register H8/3048 mask ROM version H8/3047 mask ROM version H8/3045 mask ROM version H8/3044 mask ROM version Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 784 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 RAM Area H'FFF000 to H'FFF1FF H'01F000 to H'01F1FF H'01F200 to H'01F3FF H'01F400 to H'01F5FF H'01F600 to H'01F7FF H'01F800 to H'01F9FF H'01FA00 to H'01FBFF H'01FC00 to H'01FDFF H'01FE00 to H'01FFFF (Initial value) Appendix B Internal I/O Register DASTCR—D/A Standby Control Register Bit H'5C System control 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — — — DASTE Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 Read/Write — — — — — — — R/W D/A standby enable 0 D/A output is disabled in software standby mode 1 D/A output is enabled in software standby mode DIVCR—Division Control Register H'5D System control 7 6 5 7 3 2 1 0 — — — — — — DIV1 DIV0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — — R/W R/W Bit Divide 1 and 0 Bit 1 Bit 0 DIV1 DIV0 0 0 1 0 1 1 Frequency Division Ratio 1/1 1/2 1/4 1/8 Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 785 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register MSTCR—Module Standby Control Register Bit 7 6 H'5E 4 5 3 2 System control 1 0 MSTOP5 MSTOP4 MSTOP3 MSTOP2 MSTOP1 MSTOP0 PSTOP — Initial value 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Module standby 0 0 A/D converter operates normally (Initial value) 1 A/D converter is in standby state Module standby 1 0 Refresh controller operates normally 1 Refresh controller is in standby state Module standby 2 0 DMAC operates normally 1 DMAC is in standby state Module standby 3 0 SCI1 operates normally 1 SCI1 is in standby state Module standby 4 0 SCI0 operates normally 1 SCI0 is in standby state 0 ITU operates normally 1 ITU is in standby state (Initial value) ø clock stop 0 ø clock output is enabled (Initial value) 1 ø clock output is disabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 786 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 (Initial value) (Initial value) Module standby 5 (Initial value) (Initial value) Appendix B Internal I/O Register CSCR—Chip Select Control Register Bit H'5F System control 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CS7E CS6E CS5E CS4E — — — — Initial value 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W — — — — Chip select 7 to 4 enable Bit n CSnE Description 0 Output of chip select signal CSn is disabled 1 Output of chip select signal CSn is enabled (Initial value) (n = 7 to 4) TSTR—Timer Start Register Bit H'60 ITU (all channels) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — STR4 STR3 STR2 STR1 STR0 Initial value 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Counter start 0 0 TCNT0 is halted 1 TCNT0 is counting Counter start 1 0 TCNT1 is halted 1 TCNT1 is counting Counter start 2 0 TCNT2 is halted 1 TCNT2 is counting Counter start 3 0 TCNT3 is halted 1 TCNT3 is counting Counter start 4 0 TCNT4 is halted 1 TCNT4 is counting Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 787 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TSNC—Timer Synchro Register Bit H'61 ITU (all channels) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — SYNC4 SYNC3 SYNC2 SYNC1 SYNC0 Initial value 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Timer sync 0 0 TCNT0 operates independently 1 TCNT0 is synchronized Timer sync 1 0 TCNT1 operates independently 1 TCNT1 is synchronized Timer sync 2 0 TCNT2 operates independently 1 TCNT2 is synchronized Timer sync 3 0 TCNT3 operates independently 1 TCNT3 is synchronized Timer sync 4 0 TCNT4 operates independently 1 TCNT4 is synchronized Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 788 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TMDR—Timer Mode Register Bit H'62 ITU (all channels) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — MDF FDIR PWM4 PWM3 PWM2 PWM1 PWM0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W PWM mode 0 0 Channel 0 operates normally 1 Channel 0 operates in PWM mode PWM mode 1 0 Channel 1 operates normally 1 Channel 1 operates in PWM mode PWM mode 2 0 Channel 2 operates normally 1 Channel 2 operates in PWM mode PWM mode 3 0 Channel 3 operates normally 1 Channel 3 operates in PWM mode PWM mode 4 0 Channel 4 operates normally 1 Channel 4 operates in PWM mode Flag direction 0 OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows or underflows 1 OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows Phase counting mode flag 0 Channel 2 operates normally 1 Channel 2 operates in phase counting mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 789 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TFCR—Timer Function Control Register Bit H'63 ITU (all channels) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — CMD1 CMD0 BFB4 BFA4 BFB3 BFA3 Initial value 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Buffer mode A3 0 GRA3 operates normally 1 GRA3 is buffered by BRA3 Buffer mode B3 0 GRB3 operates normally 1 GRB3 is buffered by BRB3 Buffer mode A4 0 GRA4 operates normally 1 GRA4 is buffered by BRA4 Buffer mode B4 0 GRB4 operates normally 1 GRB4 is buffered by BRB4 Combination mode 1 and 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 CMD1 CMD0 Operating Mode of Channels 3 and 4 0 0 Channels 3 and 4 operate normally 1 0 1 Channels 3 and 4 operate together in complementary PWM mode 1 Channels 3 and 4 operate together in reset-synchronized PWM mode Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 790 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TCR0—Timer Control Register 0 Bit H'64 7 6 5 4 3 ITU0 2 1 0 — CCLR1 CCLR0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W CKEG1 CKEG0 Timer prescaler 2 to 0 Bit 0 Bit 2 Bit 1 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 TCNT Clock Source Internal clock: φ Internal clock: φ/2 Internal clock: φ/4 Internal clock: φ/8 External clock A: TCLKA input External clock B: TCLKB input External clock C: TCLKC input External clock D: TCLKD input Clock edge 1 and 0 Bit 4 Bit 3 CKEG1 CKEG0 0 0 1 1 — Counted Edges of External Clock Rising edges counted Falling edges counted Both edges counted Counter clear 1 and 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 CCLR1 CCLR0 TCNT Clear Source 0 0 TCNT is not cleared 1 TCNT is cleared by GRA compare match or input capture 1 0 TCNT is cleared by GRB compare match or input capture 1 Synchronous clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization with other synchronized timers Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 791 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TIOR0—Timer I/O Control Register 0 Bit H'65 ITU0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W — R/W R/W R/W I/O control A2 to A0 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 I/O control B2 to B0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 GRA Function GRA is an output compare register GRA is an input capture register GRB Function GRB is an output compare register GRB is an input capture register Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 792 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 No output at compare match 0 output at GRA compare match 1 output at GRA compare match Output toggles at GRA compare match GRA captures rising edge of input GRA captures falling edge of input GRA captures both edges of input No output at compare match 0 output at GRB compare match 1 output at GRB compare match Output toggles at GRB compare match GRB captures rising edge of input GRB captures falling edge of input GRB captures both edges of input Appendix B Internal I/O Register TIER0—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 0 Bit H'66 ITU0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/W R/W R/W Input capture/compare match interrupt enable A 0 IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA flag is disabled 1 IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA flag is enabled Input capture/compare match interrupt enable B 0 IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB flag is disabled 1 IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB flag is enabled Overflow interrupt enable 0 OVI interrupt requested by OVF flag is disabled 1 OVI interrupt requested by OVF flag is enabled Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 793 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TSR0—Timer Status Register 0 Bit H'67 ITU0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Input capture/compare match flag A 0 [Clearing condition] Read IMFA when IMFA = 1, then write 0 in IMFA 1 [Setting conditions] TCNT = GRA when GRA functions as an output compare register. TCNT value is transferred to GRA by an input capture signal, when GRA functions as an input capture register. Input capture/compare match flag B 0 [Clearing condition] Read IMFB when IMFB = 1, then write 0 in IMFB 1 [Setting conditions] TCNT = GRB when GRB functions as an output compare register. TCNT value is transferred to GRB by an input capture signal, when GRB functions as an input capture register. Overflow flag 0 [Clearing condition] Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF 1 [Setting condition] TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000 or underflowed from H'0000 to H'FFFF Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 794 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TCNT0 H/L—Timer Counter 0 H/L H'68, H'69 ITU0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Up-counter GRA0 H/L—General Register A0 H/L H'6A, H'6B ITU0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Output compare or input capture register GRB0 H/L—General Register B0 H/L Bit Initial value Read/Write H'6C, H'6D ITU0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Output compare or input capture register TCR1—Timer Control Register 1 Bit H'6E ITU1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 795 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TIOR1—Timer I/O Control Register 1 Bit H'6F ITU1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TIER1—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 1 Bit H'70 ITU1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TSR1—Timer Status Register 1 Bit H'71 ITU1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Notes: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. TCNT1 H/L—Timer Counter 1 H/L Bit Initial value Read/Write H'72, H'73 ITU1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 796 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register GRA1 H/L—General Register A1 H/L H'74, H'75 ITU1 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. GRB1 H/L—General Register B1 H/L H'76, H'77 ITU1 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TCR2—Timer Control Register 2 Bit H'78 ITU2 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Notes: 1. Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. 2. When channel 2 is used in phase counting mode, the counter clock source selection by bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 is ignored. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 797 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TIOR2—Timer I/O Control Register 2 Bit H'79 ITU2 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TIER2—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 2 Bit H'7A ITU2 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TSR2—Timer Status Register 2 Bit H'7B ITU2 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Notes: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. The function is the same as ITU0. Overflow flag 0 [Clearing condition] Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF. [Setting condition] 1 The TCNT value overflows (from H'FFFF to H'0000) or underflows (from H'0000 to H'FFFF) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 798 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TCNT2 H/L—Timer Counter 2 H/L H'7C, H'7D ITU2 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Phase counting mode: up/down counter Other modes: up-counter GRA2 H/L—General Register A2 H/L H'7E, H'7F ITU2 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. GRB2 H/L—General Register B2 H/L H'80, H'81 ITU2 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 799 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TCR3—Timer Control Register 3 Bit H'82 ITU3 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TIOR3—Timer I/O Control Register 3 Bit H'83 ITU3 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TIER3—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 3 Bit H'84 ITU3 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 800 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TSR3—Timer Status Register 3 Bit H'85 ITU3 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Bit functions are the same as for ITU0 Overflow flag 0 [Clearing condition] Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 1 in OVF 1 [Setting condition] TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000 or underflowed from H'0000 to H'FFFF Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. TCNT3 H/L—Timer Counter 3 H/L Bit Initial value Read/Write H'86, H'87 ITU3 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Complementary PWM mode: up/down counter Other modes: up-counter GRA3 H/L—General Register A3 H/L H'88, H'89 ITU3 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Output compare or input capture register (can be buffered) Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 801 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register GRB3 H/L—General Register B3 H/L H'8A, H'8B ITU3 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Output compare or input capture register (can be buffered) BRA3 H/L—Buffer Register A3 H/L H'8C, H'8D ITU3 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Used to buffer GRA BRB3 H/L—Buffer Register B3 H/L Bit Initial value Read/Write H'8E, H'8F ITU3 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Used to buffer GRB Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 802 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TOER—Timer Output Enable Register Bit H'90 ITU (all channels) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — EXB4 EXA4 EB3 EB4 EA4 EA3 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Master enable TIOCA3 0 TIOCA 3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings 1 TIOCA 3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings Master enable TIOCA4 0 TIOCA 4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings 1 TIOCA 4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings Master enable TIOCB4 0 TIOCB4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4 and TFCR settings 1 TIOCB4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4 and TFCR settings Master enable TIOCB3 0 TIOCB 3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3 and TFCR settings 1 TIOCB 3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3 and TFCR settings Master enable TOCXA4 0 TOCXA 4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings 1 TOCXA 4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings Master enable TOCXB4 0 TOCXB4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings 1 TOCXB4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 803 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TOCR—Timer Output Control Register Bit H'91 ITU (all channels) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — XTGD — — OLS4 OLS3 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write — — — R/W — — R/W R/W Output level select 3 0 TIOCB 3 , TOCXA 4 , and TOCXB 4 outputs are inverted 1 TIOCB 3 , TOCXA 4 , and TOCXB 4 outputs are not inverted Output level select 4 0 TIOCA 3 , TIOCA 4, and TIOCB4 outputs are inverted 1 TIOCA 3 , TIOCA 4, and TIOCB4 outputs are not inverted External trigger disable 0 Input capture A in channel 1 is used as an external trigger signal in reset-synchronized PWM mode and complementary PWM mode * 1 External triggering is disabled Note: * When an external trigger occurs, bits 5 to 0 in TOER are cleared to 0, disabling ITU output. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 804 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TCR4—Timer Control Register 4 Bit H'92 ITU4 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — CCLR1 CCLR0 CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TIOR4—Timer I/O Control Register 4 Bit H'93 ITU4 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 — IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Initial value 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — R/W R/W R/W — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TIER4—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 4 Bit H'94 ITU4 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVIE IMIEB IMIEA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. TSR4—Timer Status Register 4 Bit H'95 ITU4 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 — — — — — OVF IMFB IMFA Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — — R/(W)* R/(W)* R/(W)* Notes: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0. * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 805 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TCNT4 H/L—Timer Counter 4 H/L H'96, H'97 ITU4 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3. GRA4 H/L—General Register A4 H/L H'98, H'99 ITU4 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3. GRB4 H/L—General Register B4 H/L H'9A, H'9B ITU4 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3. BRA4 H/L—Buffer Register A4 H/L H'9C, H'9D ITU4 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3. Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 806 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register BRB4 H/L—Buffer Register B4 H/L H'9E, H'9F ITU4 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3. TPMR—TPC Output Mode Register Bit H'A0 TPC 7 6 5 4 — — — — Initial value 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Read/Write — — — — R/W R/W R/W R/W 3 2 G3NOV G2NOV 0 1 G1NOV G0NOV Group 0 non-overlap 0 Normal TPC output in group 0 Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 0, controlled by compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel Group 1 non-overlap 0 Normal TPC output in group 1 Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 1, controlled by compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel Group 2 non-overlap 0 Normal TPC output in group 2 Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 2, controlled by compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel Group 3 non-overlap 0 Normal TPC output in group 3 Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel 1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 3, controlled by compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel Rev. 7.00 Sep 21, 2005 page 807 of 878 REJ09B0259-0700 Appendix B Internal I/O Register TPCR—TPC Output Control Register Bit 7 6 H'A1 5 4 3 2 TPC 1 0 G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0 Initial value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read/Write R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Group 0 compare match select 1 and 0 Bit 1 Bit 0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0 0 0 1 1 0 1 ITU Channel Selected as Output Trigger TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2 TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3 Group 1 compare match select 1 and 0 Bit 3 Bit 2 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 0 0 1 1 0 1 ITU Channel Selected as Output Trigger TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2 TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3 Group 2 compare match select 1 and 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 0 0 1 1 0 1 ITU Channel Select